gnu: wisp: update to 1.0.2.
[jackhill/guix/guix.git] / doc / guix.texi
1 \input texinfo
2 @c -*-texinfo-*-
3
4 @c %**start of header
5 @setfilename guix.info
6 @documentencoding UTF-8
7 @settitle GNU Guix Reference Manual
8 @c %**end of header
9
10 @include version.texi
11
12 @c Identifier of the OpenPGP key used to sign tarballs and such.
13 @set OPENPGP-SIGNING-KEY-ID 3CE464558A84FDC69DB40CFB090B11993D9AEBB5
14 @set KEY-SERVER pool.sks-keyservers.net
15
16 @c Base URL for downloads.
17 @set BASE-URL https://ftp.gnu.org/gnu/guix
18
19 @c The official substitute server used by default.
20 @set SUBSTITUTE-SERVER ci.guix.gnu.org
21 @set SUBSTITUTE-URL https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}
22
23 @copying
24 Copyright @copyright{} 2012, 2013, 2014, 2015, 2016, 2017, 2018, 2019 Ludovic Courtès@*
25 Copyright @copyright{} 2013, 2014, 2016 Andreas Enge@*
26 Copyright @copyright{} 2013 Nikita Karetnikov@*
27 Copyright @copyright{} 2014, 2015, 2016 Alex Kost@*
28 Copyright @copyright{} 2015, 2016 Mathieu Lirzin@*
29 Copyright @copyright{} 2014 Pierre-Antoine Rault@*
30 Copyright @copyright{} 2015 Taylan Ulrich Bayırlı/Kammer@*
31 Copyright @copyright{} 2015, 2016, 2017 Leo Famulari@*
32 Copyright @copyright{} 2015, 2016, 2017, 2018, 2019 Ricardo Wurmus@*
33 Copyright @copyright{} 2016 Ben Woodcroft@*
34 Copyright @copyright{} 2016, 2017, 2018 Chris Marusich@*
35 Copyright @copyright{} 2016, 2017, 2018, 2019 Efraim Flashner@*
36 Copyright @copyright{} 2016 John Darrington@*
37 Copyright @copyright{} 2016, 2017 ng0@*
38 Copyright @copyright{} 2016, 2017, 2018, 2019 Jan Nieuwenhuizen@*
39 Copyright @copyright{} 2016 Julien Lepiller@*
40 Copyright @copyright{} 2016 Alex ter Weele@*
41 Copyright @copyright{} 2016, 2017, 2018, 2019 Christopher Baines@*
42 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2018 Clément Lassieur@*
43 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2018 Mathieu Othacehe@*
44 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 Federico Beffa@*
45 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2018 Carlo Zancanaro@*
46 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 Thomas Danckaert@*
47 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 humanitiesNerd@*
48 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 Christopher Allan Webber@*
49 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2018 Marius Bakke@*
50 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 Hartmut Goebel@*
51 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 Maxim Cournoyer@*
52 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2018 Tobias Geerinckx-Rice@*
53 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 George Clemmer@*
54 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 Andy Wingo@*
55 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2018, 2019 Arun Isaac@*
56 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 nee@*
57 Copyright @copyright{} 2018 Rutger Helling@*
58 Copyright @copyright{} 2018 Oleg Pykhalov@*
59 Copyright @copyright{} 2018 Mike Gerwitz@*
60 Copyright @copyright{} 2018 Pierre-Antoine Rouby@*
61 Copyright @copyright{} 2018, 2019 Gábor Boskovits@*
62 Copyright @copyright{} 2018, 2019 Florian Pelz@*
63 Copyright @copyright{} 2018 Laura Lazzati@*
64 Copyright @copyright{} 2018 Alex Vong@*
65 Copyright @copyright{} 2019 Josh Holland@*
66 Copyright @copyright{} 2019 Diego Nicola Barbato@*
67 Copyright @copyright{} 2019 Ivan Petkov@*
68 Copyright @copyright{} 2019 Jakob L. Kreuze@*
69
70 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
71 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
72 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
73 Invariant Sections, no Front-Cover Texts, and no Back-Cover Texts. A
74 copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free
75 Documentation License''.
76 @end copying
77
78 @dircategory System administration
79 @direntry
80 * Guix: (guix). Manage installed software and system configuration.
81 * guix package: (guix)Invoking guix package. Installing, removing, and upgrading packages.
82 * guix gc: (guix)Invoking guix gc. Reclaiming unused disk space.
83 * guix pull: (guix)Invoking guix pull. Update the list of available packages.
84 * guix system: (guix)Invoking guix system. Manage the operating system configuration.
85 * guix deploy: (guix)Invoking guix deploy. Manage operating system configurations for remote hosts.
86 @end direntry
87
88 @dircategory Software development
89 @direntry
90 * guix environment: (guix)Invoking guix environment. Building development environments with Guix.
91 * guix build: (guix)Invoking guix build. Building packages.
92 * guix pack: (guix)Invoking guix pack. Creating binary bundles.
93 @end direntry
94
95 @titlepage
96 @title GNU Guix Reference Manual
97 @subtitle Using the GNU Guix Functional Package Manager
98 @author The GNU Guix Developers
99
100 @page
101 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
102 Edition @value{EDITION} @*
103 @value{UPDATED} @*
104
105 @insertcopying
106 @end titlepage
107
108 @contents
109
110 @c *********************************************************************
111 @node Top
112 @top GNU Guix
113
114 This document describes GNU Guix version @value{VERSION}, a functional
115 package management tool written for the GNU system.
116
117 @c TRANSLATORS: You can replace the following paragraph with information on
118 @c how to join your own translation team and how to report issues with the
119 @c translation.
120 This manual is also available in Simplified Chinese (@pxref{Top,,, guix.zh_CN,
121 GNU Guix参考手册}), French (@pxref{Top,,, guix.fr, Manuel de référence de GNU
122 Guix}), German (@pxref{Top,,, guix.de, Referenzhandbuch zu GNU Guix}),
123 Spanish (@pxref{Top,,, guix.es, Manual de referencia de GNU Guix}), and
124 Russian (@pxref{Top,,, guix.ru, Руководство GNU Guix}). If you
125 would like to translate it in your native language, consider joining the
126 @uref{https://translationproject.org/domain/guix-manual.html, Translation
127 Project}.
128
129 @menu
130 * Introduction:: What is Guix about?
131 * Installation:: Installing Guix.
132 * System Installation:: Installing the whole operating system.
133 * Package Management:: Package installation, upgrade, etc.
134 * Development:: Guix-aided software development.
135 * Programming Interface:: Using Guix in Scheme.
136 * Utilities:: Package management commands.
137 * System Configuration:: Configuring the operating system.
138 * Documentation:: Browsing software user manuals.
139 * Installing Debugging Files:: Feeding the debugger.
140 * Security Updates:: Deploying security fixes quickly.
141 * Bootstrapping:: GNU/Linux built from scratch.
142 * Porting:: Targeting another platform or kernel.
143 * Contributing:: Your help needed!
144
145 * Acknowledgments:: Thanks!
146 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license of this manual.
147 * Concept Index:: Concepts.
148 * Programming Index:: Data types, functions, and variables.
149
150 @detailmenu
151 --- The Detailed Node Listing ---
152
153 Introduction
154
155 * Managing Software the Guix Way:: What's special.
156 * GNU Distribution:: The packages and tools.
157
158 Installation
159
160 * Binary Installation:: Getting Guix running in no time!
161 * Requirements:: Software needed to build and run Guix.
162 * Running the Test Suite:: Testing Guix.
163 * Setting Up the Daemon:: Preparing the build daemon's environment.
164 * Invoking guix-daemon:: Running the build daemon.
165 * Application Setup:: Application-specific setup.
166
167 Setting Up the Daemon
168
169 * Build Environment Setup:: Preparing the isolated build environment.
170 * Daemon Offload Setup:: Offloading builds to remote machines.
171 * SELinux Support:: Using an SELinux policy for the daemon.
172
173 System Installation
174
175 * Limitations:: What you can expect.
176 * Hardware Considerations:: Supported hardware.
177 * USB Stick and DVD Installation:: Preparing the installation medium.
178 * Preparing for Installation:: Networking, partitioning, etc.
179 * Guided Graphical Installation:: Easy graphical installation.
180 * Manual Installation:: Manual installation for wizards.
181 * After System Installation:: When installation succeeded.
182 * Installing Guix in a VM:: Guix System playground.
183 * Building the Installation Image:: How this comes to be.
184
185 Manual Installation
186
187 * Keyboard Layout and Networking and Partitioning:: Initial setup.
188 * Proceeding with the Installation:: Installing.
189
190 Package Management
191
192 * Features:: How Guix will make your life brighter.
193 * Invoking guix package:: Package installation, removal, etc.
194 * Substitutes:: Downloading pre-built binaries.
195 * Packages with Multiple Outputs:: Single source package, multiple outputs.
196 * Invoking guix gc:: Running the garbage collector.
197 * Invoking guix pull:: Fetching the latest Guix and distribution.
198 * Channels:: Customizing the package collection.
199 * Inferiors:: Interacting with another revision of Guix.
200 * Invoking guix describe:: Display information about your Guix revision.
201 * Invoking guix archive:: Exporting and importing store files.
202
203 Substitutes
204
205 * Official Substitute Server:: One particular source of substitutes.
206 * Substitute Server Authorization:: How to enable or disable substitutes.
207 * Substitute Authentication:: How Guix verifies substitutes.
208 * Proxy Settings:: How to get substitutes via proxy.
209 * Substitution Failure:: What happens when substitution fails.
210 * On Trusting Binaries:: How can you trust that binary blob?
211
212 Development
213
214 * Invoking guix environment:: Setting up development environments.
215 * Invoking guix pack:: Creating software bundles.
216
217 Programming Interface
218
219 * Package Modules:: Packages from the programmer's viewpoint.
220 * Defining Packages:: Defining new packages.
221 * Build Systems:: Specifying how packages are built.
222 * The Store:: Manipulating the package store.
223 * Derivations:: Low-level interface to package derivations.
224 * The Store Monad:: Purely functional interface to the store.
225 * G-Expressions:: Manipulating build expressions.
226 * Invoking guix repl:: Fiddling with Guix interactively.
227
228 Defining Packages
229
230 * package Reference:: The package data type.
231 * origin Reference:: The origin data type.
232
233 Utilities
234
235 * Invoking guix build:: Building packages from the command line.
236 * Invoking guix edit:: Editing package definitions.
237 * Invoking guix download:: Downloading a file and printing its hash.
238 * Invoking guix hash:: Computing the cryptographic hash of a file.
239 * Invoking guix import:: Importing package definitions.
240 * Invoking guix refresh:: Updating package definitions.
241 * Invoking guix lint:: Finding errors in package definitions.
242 * Invoking guix size:: Profiling disk usage.
243 * Invoking guix graph:: Visualizing the graph of packages.
244 * Invoking guix publish:: Sharing substitutes.
245 * Invoking guix challenge:: Challenging substitute servers.
246 * Invoking guix copy:: Copying to and from a remote store.
247 * Invoking guix container:: Process isolation.
248 * Invoking guix weather:: Assessing substitute availability.
249 * Invoking guix processes:: Listing client processes.
250
251 Invoking @command{guix build}
252
253 * Common Build Options:: Build options for most commands.
254 * Package Transformation Options:: Creating variants of packages.
255 * Additional Build Options:: Options specific to 'guix build'.
256 * Debugging Build Failures:: Real life packaging experience.
257
258 System Configuration
259
260 * Using the Configuration System:: Customizing your GNU system.
261 * operating-system Reference:: Detail of operating-system declarations.
262 * File Systems:: Configuring file system mounts.
263 * Mapped Devices:: Block device extra processing.
264 * User Accounts:: Specifying user accounts.
265 * Keyboard Layout:: How the system interprets key strokes.
266 * Locales:: Language and cultural convention settings.
267 * Services:: Specifying system services.
268 * Setuid Programs:: Programs running with root privileges.
269 * X.509 Certificates:: Authenticating HTTPS servers.
270 * Name Service Switch:: Configuring libc's name service switch.
271 * Initial RAM Disk:: Linux-Libre bootstrapping.
272 * Bootloader Configuration:: Configuring the boot loader.
273 * Invoking guix system:: Instantiating a system configuration.
274 * Invoking guix deploy:: Deploying a system configuration to a remote host.
275 * Running Guix in a VM:: How to run Guix System in a virtual machine.
276 * Defining Services:: Adding new service definitions.
277
278 Services
279
280 * Base Services:: Essential system services.
281 * Scheduled Job Execution:: The mcron service.
282 * Log Rotation:: The rottlog service.
283 * Networking Services:: Network setup, SSH daemon, etc.
284 * X Window:: Graphical display.
285 * Printing Services:: Local and remote printer support.
286 * Desktop Services:: D-Bus and desktop services.
287 * Sound Services:: ALSA and Pulseaudio services.
288 * Database Services:: SQL databases, key-value stores, etc.
289 * Mail Services:: IMAP, POP3, SMTP, and all that.
290 * Messaging Services:: Messaging services.
291 * Telephony Services:: Telephony services.
292 * Monitoring Services:: Monitoring services.
293 * Kerberos Services:: Kerberos services.
294 * Web Services:: Web servers.
295 * Certificate Services:: TLS certificates via Let's Encrypt.
296 * DNS Services:: DNS daemons.
297 * VPN Services:: VPN daemons.
298 * Network File System:: NFS related services.
299 * Continuous Integration:: The Cuirass service.
300 * Power Management Services:: Extending battery life.
301 * Audio Services:: The MPD.
302 * Virtualization Services:: Virtualization services.
303 * Version Control Services:: Providing remote access to Git repositories.
304 * Game Services:: Game servers.
305 * Miscellaneous Services:: Other services.
306
307 Defining Services
308
309 * Service Composition:: The model for composing services.
310 * Service Types and Services:: Types and services.
311 * Service Reference:: API reference.
312 * Shepherd Services:: A particular type of service.
313
314 @end detailmenu
315 @end menu
316
317 @c *********************************************************************
318 @node Introduction
319 @chapter Introduction
320
321 @cindex purpose
322 GNU Guix@footnote{``Guix'' is pronounced like ``geeks'', or ``ɡiːks''
323 using the international phonetic alphabet (IPA).} is a package
324 management tool for and distribution of the GNU system.
325 Guix makes it easy for unprivileged
326 users to install, upgrade, or remove software packages, to roll back to a
327 previous package set, to build packages from source, and generally
328 assists with the creation and maintenance of software environments.
329
330 @cindex Guix System
331 @cindex GuixSD, now Guix System
332 @cindex Guix System Distribution, now Guix System
333 You can install GNU@tie{}Guix on top of an existing GNU/Linux system where it
334 complements the available tools without interference (@pxref{Installation}),
335 or you can use it as a standalone operating system distribution,
336 @dfn{Guix@tie{}System}@footnote{We used to refer to Guix System as ``Guix
337 System Distribution'' or ``GuixSD''. We now consider it makes more sense to
338 group everything under the ``Guix'' banner since, after all, Guix System is
339 readily available through the @command{guix system} command, even if you're
340 using a different distro underneath!}. @xref{GNU Distribution}.
341
342 @menu
343 * Managing Software the Guix Way:: What's special.
344 * GNU Distribution:: The packages and tools.
345 @end menu
346
347 @node Managing Software the Guix Way
348 @section Managing Software the Guix Way
349
350 @cindex user interfaces
351 Guix provides a command-line package management interface
352 (@pxref{Package Management}), tools to help with software development
353 (@pxref{Development}), command-line utilities for more advanced usage,
354 (@pxref{Utilities}), as well as Scheme programming interfaces
355 (@pxref{Programming Interface}).
356 @cindex build daemon
357 Its @dfn{build daemon} is responsible for building packages on behalf of
358 users (@pxref{Setting Up the Daemon}) and for downloading pre-built
359 binaries from authorized sources (@pxref{Substitutes}).
360
361 @cindex extensibility of the distribution
362 @cindex customization, of packages
363 Guix includes package definitions for many GNU and non-GNU packages, all
364 of which @uref{https://www.gnu.org/philosophy/free-sw.html, respect the
365 user's computing freedom}. It is @emph{extensible}: users can write
366 their own package definitions (@pxref{Defining Packages}) and make them
367 available as independent package modules (@pxref{Package Modules}). It
368 is also @emph{customizable}: users can @emph{derive} specialized package
369 definitions from existing ones, including from the command line
370 (@pxref{Package Transformation Options}).
371
372 @cindex functional package management
373 @cindex isolation
374 Under the hood, Guix implements the @dfn{functional package management}
375 discipline pioneered by Nix (@pxref{Acknowledgments}).
376 In Guix, the package build and installation process is seen
377 as a @emph{function}, in the mathematical sense. That function takes inputs,
378 such as build scripts, a compiler, and libraries, and
379 returns an installed package. As a pure function, its result depends
380 solely on its inputs---for instance, it cannot refer to software or
381 scripts that were not explicitly passed as inputs. A build function
382 always produces the same result when passed a given set of inputs. It
383 cannot alter the environment of the running system in
384 any way; for instance, it cannot create, modify, or delete files outside
385 of its build and installation directories. This is achieved by running
386 build processes in isolated environments (or @dfn{containers}), where only their
387 explicit inputs are visible.
388
389 @cindex store
390 The result of package build functions is @dfn{cached} in the file
391 system, in a special directory called @dfn{the store} (@pxref{The
392 Store}). Each package is installed in a directory of its own in the
393 store---by default under @file{/gnu/store}. The directory name contains
394 a hash of all the inputs used to build that package; thus, changing an
395 input yields a different directory name.
396
397 This approach is the foundation for the salient features of Guix: support
398 for transactional package upgrade and rollback, per-user installation, and
399 garbage collection of packages (@pxref{Features}).
400
401
402 @node GNU Distribution
403 @section GNU Distribution
404
405 @cindex Guix System
406 Guix comes with a distribution of the GNU system consisting entirely of
407 free software@footnote{The term ``free'' here refers to the
408 @url{https://www.gnu.org/philosophy/free-sw.html,freedom provided to
409 users of that software}.}. The
410 distribution can be installed on its own (@pxref{System Installation}),
411 but it is also possible to install Guix as a package manager on top of
412 an installed GNU/Linux system (@pxref{Installation}). When we need to
413 distinguish between the two, we refer to the standalone distribution as
414 Guix@tie{}System.
415
416 The distribution provides core GNU packages such as GNU libc, GCC, and
417 Binutils, as well as many GNU and non-GNU applications. The complete
418 list of available packages can be browsed
419 @url{https://www.gnu.org/software/guix/packages,on-line} or by
420 running @command{guix package} (@pxref{Invoking guix package}):
421
422 @example
423 guix package --list-available
424 @end example
425
426 Our goal is to provide a practical 100% free software distribution of
427 Linux-based and other variants of GNU, with a focus on the promotion and
428 tight integration of GNU components, and an emphasis on programs and
429 tools that help users exert that freedom.
430
431 Packages are currently available on the following platforms:
432
433 @table @code
434
435 @item x86_64-linux
436 Intel/AMD @code{x86_64} architecture, Linux-Libre kernel;
437
438 @item i686-linux
439 Intel 32-bit architecture (IA32), Linux-Libre kernel;
440
441 @item armhf-linux
442 ARMv7-A architecture with hard float, Thumb-2 and NEON,
443 using the EABI hard-float application binary interface (ABI),
444 and Linux-Libre kernel.
445
446 @item aarch64-linux
447 little-endian 64-bit ARMv8-A processors, Linux-Libre kernel.
448
449 @item mips64el-linux
450 little-endian 64-bit MIPS processors, specifically the Loongson series,
451 n32 ABI, and Linux-Libre kernel. This configuration is no longer fully
452 supported; in particular, the project's build farms no longer provide
453 substitutes for this architecture.
454
455 @end table
456
457 With Guix@tie{}System, you @emph{declare} all aspects of the operating system
458 configuration and Guix takes care of instantiating the configuration in a
459 transactional, reproducible, and stateless fashion (@pxref{System
460 Configuration}). Guix System uses the Linux-libre kernel, the Shepherd
461 initialization system (@pxref{Introduction,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd
462 Manual}), the well-known GNU utilities and tool chain, as well as the
463 graphical environment or system services of your choice.
464
465 Guix System is available on all the above platforms except
466 @code{mips64el-linux}.
467
468 @noindent
469 For information on porting to other architectures or kernels,
470 @pxref{Porting}.
471
472 Building this distribution is a cooperative effort, and you are invited
473 to join! @xref{Contributing}, for information about how you can help.
474
475
476 @c *********************************************************************
477 @node Installation
478 @chapter Installation
479
480 @cindex installing Guix
481
482 @quotation Note
483 We recommend the use of this
484 @uref{https://git.savannah.gnu.org/cgit/guix.git/plain/etc/guix-install.sh,
485 shell installer script} to install Guix on top of a running GNU/Linux system,
486 thereafter called a @dfn{foreign distro}.@footnote{This section is concerned
487 with the installation of the package manager, which can be done on top of a
488 running GNU/Linux system. If, instead, you want to install the complete GNU
489 operating system, @pxref{System Installation}.} The script automates the
490 download, installation, and initial configuration of Guix. It should be run
491 as the root user.
492 @end quotation
493
494 @cindex foreign distro
495 @cindex directories related to foreign distro
496 When installed on a foreign distro, GNU@tie{}Guix complements the available
497 tools without interference. Its data lives exclusively in two directories,
498 usually @file{/gnu/store} and @file{/var/guix}; other files on your system,
499 such as @file{/etc}, are left untouched.
500
501 Once installed, Guix can be updated by running @command{guix pull}
502 (@pxref{Invoking guix pull}).
503
504 If you prefer to perform the installation steps manually or want to tweak
505 them, you may find the following subsections useful. They describe the
506 software requirements of Guix, as well as how to install it manually and get
507 ready to use it.
508
509 @menu
510 * Binary Installation:: Getting Guix running in no time!
511 * Requirements:: Software needed to build and run Guix.
512 * Running the Test Suite:: Testing Guix.
513 * Setting Up the Daemon:: Preparing the build daemon's environment.
514 * Invoking guix-daemon:: Running the build daemon.
515 * Application Setup:: Application-specific setup.
516 @end menu
517
518 @node Binary Installation
519 @section Binary Installation
520
521 @cindex installing Guix from binaries
522 @cindex installer script
523 This section describes how to install Guix on an arbitrary system from a
524 self-contained tarball providing binaries for Guix and for all its
525 dependencies. This is often quicker than installing from source, which
526 is described in the next sections. The only requirement is to have
527 GNU@tie{}tar and Xz.
528
529 @c Note duplicated from the ``Installation'' node.
530 @quotation Note
531 We recommend the use of this
532 @uref{https://git.savannah.gnu.org/cgit/guix.git/plain/etc/guix-install.sh,
533 shell installer script}. The script automates the download, installation, and
534 initial configuration steps described below. It should be run as the root
535 user.
536 @end quotation
537
538 Installing goes along these lines:
539
540 @enumerate
541 @item
542 @cindex downloading Guix binary
543 Download the binary tarball from
544 @indicateurl{@value{BASE-URL}/guix-binary-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.tar.xz},
545 where @var{system} is @code{x86_64-linux} for an @code{x86_64} machine
546 already running the kernel Linux, and so on.
547
548 @c The following is somewhat duplicated in ``System Installation''.
549 Make sure to download the associated @file{.sig} file and to verify the
550 authenticity of the tarball against it, along these lines:
551
552 @example
553 $ wget @value{BASE-URL}/guix-binary-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.tar.xz.sig
554 $ gpg --verify guix-binary-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.tar.xz.sig
555 @end example
556
557 If that command fails because you do not have the required public key,
558 then run this command to import it:
559
560 @example
561 $ gpg --keyserver @value{KEY-SERVER} \
562 --recv-keys @value{OPENPGP-SIGNING-KEY-ID}
563 @end example
564
565 @noindent
566 and rerun the @code{gpg --verify} command.
567 @c end authentication part
568
569 @item
570 Now, you need to become the @code{root} user. Depending on your distribution,
571 you may have to run @code{su -} or @code{sudo -i}. As @code{root}, run:
572
573 @example
574 # cd /tmp
575 # tar --warning=no-timestamp -xf \
576 /path/to/guix-binary-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.tar.xz
577 # mv var/guix /var/ && mv gnu /
578 @end example
579
580 This creates @file{/gnu/store} (@pxref{The Store}) and @file{/var/guix}.
581 The latter contains a ready-to-use profile for @code{root} (see next
582 step.)
583
584 Do @emph{not} unpack the tarball on a working Guix system since that
585 would overwrite its own essential files.
586
587 The @code{--warning=no-timestamp} option makes sure GNU@tie{}tar does
588 not emit warnings about ``implausibly old time stamps'' (such
589 warnings were triggered by GNU@tie{}tar 1.26 and older; recent
590 versions are fine.)
591 They stem from the fact that all the
592 files in the archive have their modification time set to zero (which
593 means January 1st, 1970.) This is done on purpose to make sure the
594 archive content is independent of its creation time, thus making it
595 reproducible.
596
597 @item
598 Make the profile available under @file{~root/.config/guix/current}, which is
599 where @command{guix pull} will install updates (@pxref{Invoking guix pull}):
600
601 @example
602 # mkdir -p ~root/.config/guix
603 # ln -sf /var/guix/profiles/per-user/root/current-guix \
604 ~root/.config/guix/current
605 @end example
606
607 Source @file{etc/profile} to augment @code{PATH} and other relevant
608 environment variables:
609
610 @example
611 # GUIX_PROFILE="`echo ~root`/.config/guix/current" ; \
612 source $GUIX_PROFILE/etc/profile
613 @end example
614
615 @item
616 Create the group and user accounts for build users as explained below
617 (@pxref{Build Environment Setup}).
618
619 @item
620 Run the daemon, and set it to automatically start on boot.
621
622 If your host distro uses the systemd init system, this can be achieved
623 with these commands:
624
625 @c Versions of systemd that supported symlinked service files are not
626 @c yet widely deployed, so we should suggest that users copy the service
627 @c files into place.
628 @c
629 @c See this thread for more information:
630 @c https://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/guix-devel/2017-01/msg01199.html
631
632 @example
633 # cp ~root/.config/guix/current/lib/systemd/system/guix-daemon.service \
634 /etc/systemd/system/
635 # systemctl start guix-daemon && systemctl enable guix-daemon
636 @end example
637
638 If your host distro uses the Upstart init system:
639
640 @example
641 # initctl reload-configuration
642 # cp ~root/.config/guix/current/lib/upstart/system/guix-daemon.conf \
643 /etc/init/
644 # start guix-daemon
645 @end example
646
647 Otherwise, you can still start the daemon manually with:
648
649 @example
650 # ~root/.config/guix/current/bin/guix-daemon \
651 --build-users-group=guixbuild
652 @end example
653
654 @item
655 Make the @command{guix} command available to other users on the machine,
656 for instance with:
657
658 @example
659 # mkdir -p /usr/local/bin
660 # cd /usr/local/bin
661 # ln -s /var/guix/profiles/per-user/root/current-guix/bin/guix
662 @end example
663
664 It is also a good idea to make the Info version of this manual available
665 there:
666
667 @example
668 # mkdir -p /usr/local/share/info
669 # cd /usr/local/share/info
670 # for i in /var/guix/profiles/per-user/root/current-guix/share/info/* ;
671 do ln -s $i ; done
672 @end example
673
674 That way, assuming @file{/usr/local/share/info} is in the search path,
675 running @command{info guix} will open this manual (@pxref{Other Info
676 Directories,,, texinfo, GNU Texinfo}, for more details on changing the
677 Info search path.)
678
679 @item
680 @cindex substitutes, authorization thereof
681 To use substitutes from @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} or one of its mirrors
682 (@pxref{Substitutes}), authorize them:
683
684 @example
685 # guix archive --authorize < \
686 ~root/.config/guix/current/share/guix/@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}.pub
687 @end example
688
689 @item
690 Each user may need to perform a few additional steps to make their Guix
691 environment ready for use, @pxref{Application Setup}.
692 @end enumerate
693
694 Voilà, the installation is complete!
695
696 You can confirm that Guix is working by installing a sample package into
697 the root profile:
698
699 @example
700 # guix install hello
701 @end example
702
703 The binary installation tarball can be (re)produced and verified simply
704 by running the following command in the Guix source tree:
705
706 @example
707 make guix-binary.@var{system}.tar.xz
708 @end example
709
710 @noindent
711 ...@: which, in turn, runs:
712
713 @example
714 guix pack -s @var{system} --localstatedir \
715 --profile-name=current-guix guix
716 @end example
717
718 @xref{Invoking guix pack}, for more info on this handy tool.
719
720 @node Requirements
721 @section Requirements
722
723 This section lists requirements when building Guix from source. The
724 build procedure for Guix is the same as for other GNU software, and is
725 not covered here. Please see the files @file{README} and @file{INSTALL}
726 in the Guix source tree for additional details.
727
728 @cindex official website
729 GNU Guix is available for download from its website at
730 @url{https://www.gnu.org/software/guix/}.
731
732 GNU Guix depends on the following packages:
733
734 @itemize
735 @item @url{https://gnu.org/software/guile/, GNU Guile}, version 2.2.x;
736 @item @url{https://notabug.org/cwebber/guile-gcrypt, Guile-Gcrypt}, version
737 0.1.0 or later;
738 @item
739 @uref{https://gnutls.org/, GnuTLS}, specifically its Guile bindings
740 (@pxref{Guile Preparations, how to install the GnuTLS bindings for
741 Guile,, gnutls-guile, GnuTLS-Guile});
742 @item
743 @uref{https://notabug.org/guile-sqlite3/guile-sqlite3, Guile-SQLite3}, version 0.1.0
744 or later;
745 @item
746 @c FIXME: Specify a version number once a release has been made.
747 @uref{https://gitlab.com/guile-git/guile-git, Guile-Git}, from August
748 2017 or later;
749 @item @uref{https://savannah.nongnu.org/projects/guile-json/, Guile-JSON};
750 @item @url{https://zlib.net, zlib};
751 @item @url{https://www.gnu.org/software/make/, GNU Make}.
752 @end itemize
753
754 The following dependencies are optional:
755
756 @itemize
757 @item
758 @c Note: We need at least 0.10.2 for 'channel-send-eof'.
759 Support for build offloading (@pxref{Daemon Offload Setup}) and
760 @command{guix copy} (@pxref{Invoking guix copy}) depends on
761 @uref{https://github.com/artyom-poptsov/guile-ssh, Guile-SSH},
762 version 0.10.2 or later.
763
764 @item
765 When @url{https://www.nongnu.org/lzip/lzlib.html, lzlib} is available, lzlib
766 substitutes can be used and @command{guix publish} can compress substitutes
767 with lzlib.
768
769 @item
770 When @url{http://www.bzip.org, libbz2} is available,
771 @command{guix-daemon} can use it to compress build logs.
772 @end itemize
773
774 Unless @code{--disable-daemon} was passed to @command{configure}, the
775 following packages are also needed:
776
777 @itemize
778 @item @url{https://gnupg.org/, GNU libgcrypt};
779 @item @url{https://sqlite.org, SQLite 3};
780 @item @url{https://gcc.gnu.org, GCC's g++}, with support for the
781 C++11 standard.
782 @end itemize
783
784 @cindex state directory
785 When configuring Guix on a system that already has a Guix installation,
786 be sure to specify the same state directory as the existing installation
787 using the @code{--localstatedir} option of the @command{configure}
788 script (@pxref{Directory Variables, @code{localstatedir},, standards,
789 GNU Coding Standards}). The @command{configure} script protects against
790 unintended misconfiguration of @var{localstatedir} so you do not
791 inadvertently corrupt your store (@pxref{The Store}).
792
793 @cindex Nix, compatibility
794 When a working installation of @url{https://nixos.org/nix/, the Nix package
795 manager} is available, you
796 can instead configure Guix with @code{--disable-daemon}. In that case,
797 Nix replaces the three dependencies above.
798
799 Guix is compatible with Nix, so it is possible to share the same store
800 between both. To do so, you must pass @command{configure} not only the
801 same @code{--with-store-dir} value, but also the same
802 @code{--localstatedir} value. The latter is essential because it
803 specifies where the database that stores metadata about the store is
804 located, among other things. The default values for Nix are
805 @code{--with-store-dir=/nix/store} and @code{--localstatedir=/nix/var}.
806 Note that @code{--disable-daemon} is not required if
807 your goal is to share the store with Nix.
808
809 @node Running the Test Suite
810 @section Running the Test Suite
811
812 @cindex test suite
813 After a successful @command{configure} and @code{make} run, it is a good
814 idea to run the test suite. It can help catch issues with the setup or
815 environment, or bugs in Guix itself---and really, reporting test
816 failures is a good way to help improve the software. To run the test
817 suite, type:
818
819 @example
820 make check
821 @end example
822
823 Test cases can run in parallel: you can use the @code{-j} option of
824 GNU@tie{}make to speed things up. The first run may take a few minutes
825 on a recent machine; subsequent runs will be faster because the store
826 that is created for test purposes will already have various things in
827 cache.
828
829 It is also possible to run a subset of the tests by defining the
830 @code{TESTS} makefile variable as in this example:
831
832 @example
833 make check TESTS="tests/store.scm tests/cpio.scm"
834 @end example
835
836 By default, tests results are displayed at a file level. In order to
837 see the details of every individual test cases, it is possible to define
838 the @code{SCM_LOG_DRIVER_FLAGS} makefile variable as in this example:
839
840 @example
841 make check TESTS="tests/base64.scm" SCM_LOG_DRIVER_FLAGS="--brief=no"
842 @end example
843
844 Upon failure, please email @email{bug-guix@@gnu.org} and attach the
845 @file{test-suite.log} file. Please specify the Guix version being used
846 as well as version numbers of the dependencies (@pxref{Requirements}) in
847 your message.
848
849 Guix also comes with a whole-system test suite that tests complete
850 Guix System instances. It can only run on systems where
851 Guix is already installed, using:
852
853 @example
854 make check-system
855 @end example
856
857 @noindent
858 or, again, by defining @code{TESTS} to select a subset of tests to run:
859
860 @example
861 make check-system TESTS="basic mcron"
862 @end example
863
864 These system tests are defined in the @code{(gnu tests @dots{})}
865 modules. They work by running the operating systems under test with
866 lightweight instrumentation in a virtual machine (VM). They can be
867 computationally intensive or rather cheap, depending on whether
868 substitutes are available for their dependencies (@pxref{Substitutes}).
869 Some of them require a lot of storage space to hold VM images.
870
871 Again in case of test failures, please send @email{bug-guix@@gnu.org}
872 all the details.
873
874 @node Setting Up the Daemon
875 @section Setting Up the Daemon
876
877 @cindex daemon
878 Operations such as building a package or running the garbage collector
879 are all performed by a specialized process, the @dfn{build daemon}, on
880 behalf of clients. Only the daemon may access the store and its
881 associated database. Thus, any operation that manipulates the store
882 goes through the daemon. For instance, command-line tools such as
883 @command{guix package} and @command{guix build} communicate with the
884 daemon (@i{via} remote procedure calls) to instruct it what to do.
885
886 The following sections explain how to prepare the build daemon's
887 environment. See also @ref{Substitutes}, for information on how to allow
888 the daemon to download pre-built binaries.
889
890 @menu
891 * Build Environment Setup:: Preparing the isolated build environment.
892 * Daemon Offload Setup:: Offloading builds to remote machines.
893 * SELinux Support:: Using an SELinux policy for the daemon.
894 @end menu
895
896 @node Build Environment Setup
897 @subsection Build Environment Setup
898
899 @cindex build environment
900 In a standard multi-user setup, Guix and its daemon---the
901 @command{guix-daemon} program---are installed by the system
902 administrator; @file{/gnu/store} is owned by @code{root} and
903 @command{guix-daemon} runs as @code{root}. Unprivileged users may use
904 Guix tools to build packages or otherwise access the store, and the
905 daemon will do it on their behalf, ensuring that the store is kept in a
906 consistent state, and allowing built packages to be shared among users.
907
908 @cindex build users
909 When @command{guix-daemon} runs as @code{root}, you may not want package
910 build processes themselves to run as @code{root} too, for obvious
911 security reasons. To avoid that, a special pool of @dfn{build users}
912 should be created for use by build processes started by the daemon.
913 These build users need not have a shell and a home directory: they will
914 just be used when the daemon drops @code{root} privileges in build
915 processes. Having several such users allows the daemon to launch
916 distinct build processes under separate UIDs, which guarantees that they
917 do not interfere with each other---an essential feature since builds are
918 regarded as pure functions (@pxref{Introduction}).
919
920 On a GNU/Linux system, a build user pool may be created like this (using
921 Bash syntax and the @code{shadow} commands):
922
923 @c See https://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/bug-guix/2013-01/msg00239.html
924 @c for why `-G' is needed.
925 @example
926 # groupadd --system guixbuild
927 # for i in `seq -w 1 10`;
928 do
929 useradd -g guixbuild -G guixbuild \
930 -d /var/empty -s `which nologin` \
931 -c "Guix build user $i" --system \
932 guixbuilder$i;
933 done
934 @end example
935
936 @noindent
937 The number of build users determines how many build jobs may run in
938 parallel, as specified by the @option{--max-jobs} option
939 (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon, @option{--max-jobs}}). To use
940 @command{guix system vm} and related commands, you may need to add the
941 build users to the @code{kvm} group so they can access @file{/dev/kvm},
942 using @code{-G guixbuild,kvm} instead of @code{-G guixbuild}
943 (@pxref{Invoking guix system}).
944
945 The @code{guix-daemon} program may then be run as @code{root} with the
946 following command@footnote{If your machine uses the systemd init system,
947 dropping the @file{@var{prefix}/lib/systemd/system/guix-daemon.service}
948 file in @file{/etc/systemd/system} will ensure that
949 @command{guix-daemon} is automatically started. Similarly, if your
950 machine uses the Upstart init system, drop the
951 @file{@var{prefix}/lib/upstart/system/guix-daemon.conf}
952 file in @file{/etc/init}.}:
953
954 @example
955 # guix-daemon --build-users-group=guixbuild
956 @end example
957
958 @cindex chroot
959 @noindent
960 This way, the daemon starts build processes in a chroot, under one of
961 the @code{guixbuilder} users. On GNU/Linux, by default, the chroot
962 environment contains nothing but:
963
964 @c Keep this list in sync with libstore/build.cc! -----------------------
965 @itemize
966 @item
967 a minimal @code{/dev} directory, created mostly independently from the
968 host @code{/dev}@footnote{``Mostly'', because while the set of files
969 that appear in the chroot's @code{/dev} is fixed, most of these files
970 can only be created if the host has them.};
971
972 @item
973 the @code{/proc} directory; it only shows the processes of the container
974 since a separate PID name space is used;
975
976 @item
977 @file{/etc/passwd} with an entry for the current user and an entry for
978 user @file{nobody};
979
980 @item
981 @file{/etc/group} with an entry for the user's group;
982
983 @item
984 @file{/etc/hosts} with an entry that maps @code{localhost} to
985 @code{127.0.0.1};
986
987 @item
988 a writable @file{/tmp} directory.
989 @end itemize
990
991 You can influence the directory where the daemon stores build trees
992 @i{via} the @code{TMPDIR} environment variable. However, the build tree
993 within the chroot is always called @file{/tmp/guix-build-@var{name}.drv-0},
994 where @var{name} is the derivation name---e.g., @code{coreutils-8.24}.
995 This way, the value of @code{TMPDIR} does not leak inside build
996 environments, which avoids discrepancies in cases where build processes
997 capture the name of their build tree.
998
999 @vindex http_proxy
1000 The daemon also honors the @code{http_proxy} environment variable for
1001 HTTP downloads it performs, be it for fixed-output derivations
1002 (@pxref{Derivations}) or for substitutes (@pxref{Substitutes}).
1003
1004 If you are installing Guix as an unprivileged user, it is still possible
1005 to run @command{guix-daemon} provided you pass @code{--disable-chroot}.
1006 However, build processes will not be isolated from one another, and not
1007 from the rest of the system. Thus, build processes may interfere with
1008 each other, and may access programs, libraries, and other files
1009 available on the system---making it much harder to view them as
1010 @emph{pure} functions.
1011
1012
1013 @node Daemon Offload Setup
1014 @subsection Using the Offload Facility
1015
1016 @cindex offloading
1017 @cindex build hook
1018 When desired, the build daemon can @dfn{offload} derivation builds to
1019 other machines running Guix, using the @code{offload} @dfn{build
1020 hook}@footnote{This feature is available only when
1021 @uref{https://github.com/artyom-poptsov/guile-ssh, Guile-SSH} is
1022 present.}. When that
1023 feature is enabled, a list of user-specified build machines is read from
1024 @file{/etc/guix/machines.scm}; every time a build is requested, for
1025 instance via @code{guix build}, the daemon attempts to offload it to one
1026 of the machines that satisfy the constraints of the derivation, in
1027 particular its system type---e.g., @file{x86_64-linux}. Missing
1028 prerequisites for the build are copied over SSH to the target machine,
1029 which then proceeds with the build; upon success the output(s) of the
1030 build are copied back to the initial machine.
1031
1032 The @file{/etc/guix/machines.scm} file typically looks like this:
1033
1034 @example
1035 (list (build-machine
1036 (name "eightysix.example.org")
1037 (system "x86_64-linux")
1038 (host-key "ssh-ed25519 AAAAC3Nza@dots{}")
1039 (user "bob")
1040 (speed 2.)) ;incredibly fast!
1041
1042 (build-machine
1043 (name "meeps.example.org")
1044 (system "mips64el-linux")
1045 (host-key "ssh-rsa AAAAB3Nza@dots{}")
1046 (user "alice")
1047 (private-key
1048 (string-append (getenv "HOME")
1049 "/.ssh/identity-for-guix"))))
1050 @end example
1051
1052 @noindent
1053 In the example above we specify a list of two build machines, one for
1054 the @code{x86_64} architecture and one for the @code{mips64el}
1055 architecture.
1056
1057 In fact, this file is---not surprisingly!---a Scheme file that is
1058 evaluated when the @code{offload} hook is started. Its return value
1059 must be a list of @code{build-machine} objects. While this example
1060 shows a fixed list of build machines, one could imagine, say, using
1061 DNS-SD to return a list of potential build machines discovered in the
1062 local network (@pxref{Introduction, Guile-Avahi,, guile-avahi, Using
1063 Avahi in Guile Scheme Programs}). The @code{build-machine} data type is
1064 detailed below.
1065
1066 @deftp {Data Type} build-machine
1067 This data type represents build machines to which the daemon may offload
1068 builds. The important fields are:
1069
1070 @table @code
1071
1072 @item name
1073 The host name of the remote machine.
1074
1075 @item system
1076 The system type of the remote machine---e.g., @code{"x86_64-linux"}.
1077
1078 @item user
1079 The user account to use when connecting to the remote machine over SSH.
1080 Note that the SSH key pair must @emph{not} be passphrase-protected, to
1081 allow non-interactive logins.
1082
1083 @item host-key
1084 This must be the machine's SSH @dfn{public host key} in OpenSSH format.
1085 This is used to authenticate the machine when we connect to it. It is a
1086 long string that looks like this:
1087
1088 @example
1089 ssh-ed25519 AAAAC3NzaC@dots{}mde+UhL hint@@example.org
1090 @end example
1091
1092 If the machine is running the OpenSSH daemon, @command{sshd}, the host
1093 key can be found in a file such as
1094 @file{/etc/ssh/ssh_host_ed25519_key.pub}.
1095
1096 If the machine is running the SSH daemon of GNU@tie{}lsh,
1097 @command{lshd}, the host key is in @file{/etc/lsh/host-key.pub} or a
1098 similar file. It can be converted to the OpenSSH format using
1099 @command{lsh-export-key} (@pxref{Converting keys,,, lsh, LSH Manual}):
1100
1101 @example
1102 $ lsh-export-key --openssh < /etc/lsh/host-key.pub
1103 ssh-rsa AAAAB3NzaC1yc2EAAAAEOp8FoQAAAQEAs1eB46LV@dots{}
1104 @end example
1105
1106 @end table
1107
1108 A number of optional fields may be specified:
1109
1110 @table @asis
1111
1112 @item @code{port} (default: @code{22})
1113 Port number of SSH server on the machine.
1114
1115 @item @code{private-key} (default: @file{~root/.ssh/id_rsa})
1116 The SSH private key file to use when connecting to the machine, in
1117 OpenSSH format. This key must not be protected with a passphrase.
1118
1119 Note that the default value is the private key @emph{of the root
1120 account}. Make sure it exists if you use the default.
1121
1122 @item @code{compression} (default: @code{"zlib@@openssh.com,zlib"})
1123 @itemx @code{compression-level} (default: @code{3})
1124 The SSH-level compression methods and compression level requested.
1125
1126 Note that offloading relies on SSH compression to reduce bandwidth usage
1127 when transferring files to and from build machines.
1128
1129 @item @code{daemon-socket} (default: @code{"/var/guix/daemon-socket/socket"})
1130 File name of the Unix-domain socket @command{guix-daemon} is listening
1131 to on that machine.
1132
1133 @item @code{parallel-builds} (default: @code{1})
1134 The number of builds that may run in parallel on the machine.
1135
1136 @item @code{speed} (default: @code{1.0})
1137 A ``relative speed factor''. The offload scheduler will tend to prefer
1138 machines with a higher speed factor.
1139
1140 @item @code{features} (default: @code{'()})
1141 A list of strings denoting specific features supported by the machine.
1142 An example is @code{"kvm"} for machines that have the KVM Linux modules
1143 and corresponding hardware support. Derivations can request features by
1144 name, and they will be scheduled on matching build machines.
1145
1146 @end table
1147 @end deftp
1148
1149 The @command{guix} command must be in the search path on the build
1150 machines. You can check whether this is the case by running:
1151
1152 @example
1153 ssh build-machine guix repl --version
1154 @end example
1155
1156 There is one last thing to do once @file{machines.scm} is in place. As
1157 explained above, when offloading, files are transferred back and forth
1158 between the machine stores. For this to work, you first need to
1159 generate a key pair on each machine to allow the daemon to export signed
1160 archives of files from the store (@pxref{Invoking guix archive}):
1161
1162 @example
1163 # guix archive --generate-key
1164 @end example
1165
1166 @noindent
1167 Each build machine must authorize the key of the master machine so that
1168 it accepts store items it receives from the master:
1169
1170 @example
1171 # guix archive --authorize < master-public-key.txt
1172 @end example
1173
1174 @noindent
1175 Likewise, the master machine must authorize the key of each build machine.
1176
1177 All the fuss with keys is here to express pairwise mutual trust
1178 relations between the master and the build machines. Concretely, when
1179 the master receives files from a build machine (and @i{vice versa}), its
1180 build daemon can make sure they are genuine, have not been tampered
1181 with, and that they are signed by an authorized key.
1182
1183 @cindex offload test
1184 To test whether your setup is operational, run this command on the
1185 master node:
1186
1187 @example
1188 # guix offload test
1189 @end example
1190
1191 This will attempt to connect to each of the build machines specified in
1192 @file{/etc/guix/machines.scm}, make sure Guile and the Guix modules are
1193 available on each machine, attempt to export to the machine and import
1194 from it, and report any error in the process.
1195
1196 If you want to test a different machine file, just specify it on the
1197 command line:
1198
1199 @example
1200 # guix offload test machines-qualif.scm
1201 @end example
1202
1203 Last, you can test the subset of the machines whose name matches a
1204 regular expression like this:
1205
1206 @example
1207 # guix offload test machines.scm '\.gnu\.org$'
1208 @end example
1209
1210 @cindex offload status
1211 To display the current load of all build hosts, run this command on the
1212 main node:
1213
1214 @example
1215 # guix offload status
1216 @end example
1217
1218
1219 @node SELinux Support
1220 @subsection SELinux Support
1221
1222 @cindex SELinux, daemon policy
1223 @cindex mandatory access control, SELinux
1224 @cindex security, guix-daemon
1225 Guix includes an SELinux policy file at @file{etc/guix-daemon.cil} that
1226 can be installed on a system where SELinux is enabled, in order to label
1227 Guix files and to specify the expected behavior of the daemon. Since
1228 Guix System does not provide an SELinux base policy, the daemon policy cannot
1229 be used on Guix System.
1230
1231 @subsubsection Installing the SELinux policy
1232 @cindex SELinux, policy installation
1233 To install the policy run this command as root:
1234
1235 @example
1236 semodule -i etc/guix-daemon.cil
1237 @end example
1238
1239 Then relabel the file system with @code{restorecon} or by a different
1240 mechanism provided by your system.
1241
1242 Once the policy is installed, the file system has been relabeled, and
1243 the daemon has been restarted, it should be running in the
1244 @code{guix_daemon_t} context. You can confirm this with the following
1245 command:
1246
1247 @example
1248 ps -Zax | grep guix-daemon
1249 @end example
1250
1251 Monitor the SELinux log files as you run a command like @code{guix build
1252 hello} to convince yourself that SELinux permits all necessary
1253 operations.
1254
1255 @subsubsection Limitations
1256 @cindex SELinux, limitations
1257
1258 This policy is not perfect. Here is a list of limitations or quirks
1259 that should be considered when deploying the provided SELinux policy for
1260 the Guix daemon.
1261
1262 @enumerate
1263 @item
1264 @code{guix_daemon_socket_t} isn’t actually used. None of the socket
1265 operations involve contexts that have anything to do with
1266 @code{guix_daemon_socket_t}. It doesn’t hurt to have this unused label,
1267 but it would be preferrable to define socket rules for only this label.
1268
1269 @item
1270 @code{guix gc} cannot access arbitrary links to profiles. By design,
1271 the file label of the destination of a symlink is independent of the
1272 file label of the link itself. Although all profiles under
1273 $localstatedir are labelled, the links to these profiles inherit the
1274 label of the directory they are in. For links in the user’s home
1275 directory this will be @code{user_home_t}. But for links from the root
1276 user’s home directory, or @file{/tmp}, or the HTTP server’s working
1277 directory, etc, this won’t work. @code{guix gc} would be prevented from
1278 reading and following these links.
1279
1280 @item
1281 The daemon’s feature to listen for TCP connections might no longer work.
1282 This might require extra rules, because SELinux treats network sockets
1283 differently from files.
1284
1285 @item
1286 Currently all files with a name matching the regular expression
1287 @code{/gnu/store/.+-(guix-.+|profile)/bin/guix-daemon} are assigned the
1288 label @code{guix_daemon_exec_t}; this means that @emph{any} file with
1289 that name in any profile would be permitted to run in the
1290 @code{guix_daemon_t} domain. This is not ideal. An attacker could
1291 build a package that provides this executable and convince a user to
1292 install and run it, which lifts it into the @code{guix_daemon_t} domain.
1293 At that point SELinux could not prevent it from accessing files that are
1294 allowed for processes in that domain.
1295
1296 We could generate a much more restrictive policy at installation time,
1297 so that only the @emph{exact} file name of the currently installed
1298 @code{guix-daemon} executable would be labelled with
1299 @code{guix_daemon_exec_t}, instead of using a broad regular expression.
1300 The downside is that root would have to install or upgrade the policy at
1301 installation time whenever the Guix package that provides the
1302 effectively running @code{guix-daemon} executable is upgraded.
1303 @end enumerate
1304
1305 @node Invoking guix-daemon
1306 @section Invoking @command{guix-daemon}
1307
1308 The @command{guix-daemon} program implements all the functionality to
1309 access the store. This includes launching build processes, running the
1310 garbage collector, querying the availability of a build result, etc. It
1311 is normally run as @code{root} like this:
1312
1313 @example
1314 # guix-daemon --build-users-group=guixbuild
1315 @end example
1316
1317 @noindent
1318 For details on how to set it up, @pxref{Setting Up the Daemon}.
1319
1320 @cindex chroot
1321 @cindex container, build environment
1322 @cindex build environment
1323 @cindex reproducible builds
1324 By default, @command{guix-daemon} launches build processes under
1325 different UIDs, taken from the build group specified with
1326 @code{--build-users-group}. In addition, each build process is run in a
1327 chroot environment that only contains the subset of the store that the
1328 build process depends on, as specified by its derivation
1329 (@pxref{Programming Interface, derivation}), plus a set of specific
1330 system directories. By default, the latter contains @file{/dev} and
1331 @file{/dev/pts}. Furthermore, on GNU/Linux, the build environment is a
1332 @dfn{container}: in addition to having its own file system tree, it has
1333 a separate mount name space, its own PID name space, network name space,
1334 etc. This helps achieve reproducible builds (@pxref{Features}).
1335
1336 When the daemon performs a build on behalf of the user, it creates a
1337 build directory under @file{/tmp} or under the directory specified by
1338 its @code{TMPDIR} environment variable. This directory is shared with
1339 the container for the duration of the build, though within the container,
1340 the build tree is always called @file{/tmp/guix-build-@var{name}.drv-0}.
1341
1342 The build directory is automatically deleted upon completion, unless the
1343 build failed and the client specified @option{--keep-failed}
1344 (@pxref{Invoking guix build, @option{--keep-failed}}).
1345
1346 The daemon listens for connections and spawns one sub-process for each session
1347 started by a client (one of the @command{guix} sub-commands.) The
1348 @command{guix processes} command allows you to get an overview of the activity
1349 on your system by viewing each of the active sessions and clients.
1350 @xref{Invoking guix processes}, for more information.
1351
1352 The following command-line options are supported:
1353
1354 @table @code
1355 @item --build-users-group=@var{group}
1356 Take users from @var{group} to run build processes (@pxref{Setting Up
1357 the Daemon, build users}).
1358
1359 @item --no-substitutes
1360 @cindex substitutes
1361 Do not use substitutes for build products. That is, always build things
1362 locally instead of allowing downloads of pre-built binaries
1363 (@pxref{Substitutes}).
1364
1365 When the daemon runs with @code{--no-substitutes}, clients can still
1366 explicitly enable substitution @i{via} the @code{set-build-options}
1367 remote procedure call (@pxref{The Store}).
1368
1369 @item --substitute-urls=@var{urls}
1370 @anchor{daemon-substitute-urls}
1371 Consider @var{urls} the default whitespace-separated list of substitute
1372 source URLs. When this option is omitted,
1373 @indicateurl{https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} is used.
1374
1375 This means that substitutes may be downloaded from @var{urls}, as long
1376 as they are signed by a trusted signature (@pxref{Substitutes}).
1377
1378 @cindex build hook
1379 @item --no-build-hook
1380 Do not use the @dfn{build hook}.
1381
1382 The build hook is a helper program that the daemon can start and to
1383 which it submits build requests. This mechanism is used to offload
1384 builds to other machines (@pxref{Daemon Offload Setup}).
1385
1386 @item --cache-failures
1387 Cache build failures. By default, only successful builds are cached.
1388
1389 When this option is used, @command{guix gc --list-failures} can be used
1390 to query the set of store items marked as failed; @command{guix gc
1391 --clear-failures} removes store items from the set of cached failures.
1392 @xref{Invoking guix gc}.
1393
1394 @item --cores=@var{n}
1395 @itemx -c @var{n}
1396 Use @var{n} CPU cores to build each derivation; @code{0} means as many
1397 as available.
1398
1399 The default value is @code{0}, but it may be overridden by clients, such
1400 as the @code{--cores} option of @command{guix build} (@pxref{Invoking
1401 guix build}).
1402
1403 The effect is to define the @code{NIX_BUILD_CORES} environment variable
1404 in the build process, which can then use it to exploit internal
1405 parallelism---for instance, by running @code{make -j$NIX_BUILD_CORES}.
1406
1407 @item --max-jobs=@var{n}
1408 @itemx -M @var{n}
1409 Allow at most @var{n} build jobs in parallel. The default value is
1410 @code{1}. Setting it to @code{0} means that no builds will be performed
1411 locally; instead, the daemon will offload builds (@pxref{Daemon Offload
1412 Setup}), or simply fail.
1413
1414 @item --max-silent-time=@var{seconds}
1415 When the build or substitution process remains silent for more than
1416 @var{seconds}, terminate it and report a build failure.
1417
1418 The default value is @code{0}, which disables the timeout.
1419
1420 The value specified here can be overridden by clients (@pxref{Common
1421 Build Options, @code{--max-silent-time}}).
1422
1423 @item --timeout=@var{seconds}
1424 Likewise, when the build or substitution process lasts for more than
1425 @var{seconds}, terminate it and report a build failure.
1426
1427 The default value is @code{0}, which disables the timeout.
1428
1429 The value specified here can be overridden by clients (@pxref{Common
1430 Build Options, @code{--timeout}}).
1431
1432 @item --rounds=@var{N}
1433 Build each derivation @var{n} times in a row, and raise an error if
1434 consecutive build results are not bit-for-bit identical. Note that this
1435 setting can be overridden by clients such as @command{guix build}
1436 (@pxref{Invoking guix build}).
1437
1438 When used in conjunction with @option{--keep-failed}, the differing
1439 output is kept in the store, under @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-check}.
1440 This makes it easy to look for differences between the two results.
1441
1442 @item --debug
1443 Produce debugging output.
1444
1445 This is useful to debug daemon start-up issues, but then it may be
1446 overridden by clients, for example the @code{--verbosity} option of
1447 @command{guix build} (@pxref{Invoking guix build}).
1448
1449 @item --chroot-directory=@var{dir}
1450 Add @var{dir} to the build chroot.
1451
1452 Doing this may change the result of build processes---for instance if
1453 they use optional dependencies found in @var{dir} when it is available,
1454 and not otherwise. For that reason, it is not recommended to do so.
1455 Instead, make sure that each derivation declares all the inputs that it
1456 needs.
1457
1458 @item --disable-chroot
1459 Disable chroot builds.
1460
1461 Using this option is not recommended since, again, it would allow build
1462 processes to gain access to undeclared dependencies. It is necessary,
1463 though, when @command{guix-daemon} is running under an unprivileged user
1464 account.
1465
1466 @item --log-compression=@var{type}
1467 Compress build logs according to @var{type}, one of @code{gzip},
1468 @code{bzip2}, or @code{none}.
1469
1470 Unless @code{--lose-logs} is used, all the build logs are kept in the
1471 @var{localstatedir}. To save space, the daemon automatically compresses
1472 them with bzip2 by default.
1473
1474 @item --disable-deduplication
1475 @cindex deduplication
1476 Disable automatic file ``deduplication'' in the store.
1477
1478 By default, files added to the store are automatically ``deduplicated'':
1479 if a newly added file is identical to another one found in the store,
1480 the daemon makes the new file a hard link to the other file. This can
1481 noticeably reduce disk usage, at the expense of slightly increased
1482 input/output load at the end of a build process. This option disables
1483 this optimization.
1484
1485 @item --gc-keep-outputs[=yes|no]
1486 Tell whether the garbage collector (GC) must keep outputs of live
1487 derivations.
1488
1489 @cindex GC roots
1490 @cindex garbage collector roots
1491 When set to ``yes'', the GC will keep the outputs of any live derivation
1492 available in the store---the @code{.drv} files. The default is ``no'',
1493 meaning that derivation outputs are kept only if they are reachable from a GC
1494 root. @xref{Invoking guix gc}, for more on GC roots.
1495
1496 @item --gc-keep-derivations[=yes|no]
1497 Tell whether the garbage collector (GC) must keep derivations
1498 corresponding to live outputs.
1499
1500 When set to ``yes'', as is the case by default, the GC keeps
1501 derivations---i.e., @code{.drv} files---as long as at least one of their
1502 outputs is live. This allows users to keep track of the origins of
1503 items in their store. Setting it to ``no'' saves a bit of disk space.
1504
1505 In this way, setting @code{--gc-keep-derivations} to ``yes'' causes liveness
1506 to flow from outputs to derivations, and setting @code{--gc-keep-outputs} to
1507 ``yes'' causes liveness to flow from derivations to outputs. When both are
1508 set to ``yes'', the effect is to keep all the build prerequisites (the
1509 sources, compiler, libraries, and other build-time tools) of live objects in
1510 the store, regardless of whether these prerequisites are reachable from a GC
1511 root. This is convenient for developers since it saves rebuilds or downloads.
1512
1513 @item --impersonate-linux-2.6
1514 On Linux-based systems, impersonate Linux 2.6. This means that the
1515 kernel's @code{uname} system call will report 2.6 as the release number.
1516
1517 This might be helpful to build programs that (usually wrongfully) depend
1518 on the kernel version number.
1519
1520 @item --lose-logs
1521 Do not keep build logs. By default they are kept under
1522 @code{@var{localstatedir}/guix/log}.
1523
1524 @item --system=@var{system}
1525 Assume @var{system} as the current system type. By default it is the
1526 architecture/kernel pair found at configure time, such as
1527 @code{x86_64-linux}.
1528
1529 @item --listen=@var{endpoint}
1530 Listen for connections on @var{endpoint}. @var{endpoint} is interpreted
1531 as the file name of a Unix-domain socket if it starts with
1532 @code{/} (slash sign). Otherwise, @var{endpoint} is interpreted as a
1533 host name or host name and port to listen to. Here are a few examples:
1534
1535 @table @code
1536 @item --listen=/gnu/var/daemon
1537 Listen for connections on the @file{/gnu/var/daemon} Unix-domain socket,
1538 creating it if needed.
1539
1540 @item --listen=localhost
1541 @cindex daemon, remote access
1542 @cindex remote access to the daemon
1543 @cindex daemon, cluster setup
1544 @cindex clusters, daemon setup
1545 Listen for TCP connections on the network interface corresponding to
1546 @code{localhost}, on port 44146.
1547
1548 @item --listen=128.0.0.42:1234
1549 Listen for TCP connections on the network interface corresponding to
1550 @code{128.0.0.42}, on port 1234.
1551 @end table
1552
1553 This option can be repeated multiple times, in which case
1554 @command{guix-daemon} accepts connections on all the specified
1555 endpoints. Users can tell client commands what endpoint to connect to
1556 by setting the @code{GUIX_DAEMON_SOCKET} environment variable
1557 (@pxref{The Store, @code{GUIX_DAEMON_SOCKET}}).
1558
1559 @quotation Note
1560 The daemon protocol is @emph{unauthenticated and unencrypted}. Using
1561 @code{--listen=@var{host}} is suitable on local networks, such as
1562 clusters, where only trusted nodes may connect to the build daemon. In
1563 other cases where remote access to the daemon is needed, we recommend
1564 using Unix-domain sockets along with SSH.
1565 @end quotation
1566
1567 When @code{--listen} is omitted, @command{guix-daemon} listens for
1568 connections on the Unix-domain socket located at
1569 @file{@var{localstatedir}/guix/daemon-socket/socket}.
1570 @end table
1571
1572
1573 @node Application Setup
1574 @section Application Setup
1575
1576 @cindex foreign distro
1577 When using Guix on top of GNU/Linux distribution other than Guix System---a
1578 so-called @dfn{foreign distro}---a few additional steps are needed to
1579 get everything in place. Here are some of them.
1580
1581 @subsection Locales
1582
1583 @anchor{locales-and-locpath}
1584 @cindex locales, when not on Guix System
1585 @vindex LOCPATH
1586 @vindex GUIX_LOCPATH
1587 Packages installed @i{via} Guix will not use the locale data of the
1588 host system. Instead, you must first install one of the locale packages
1589 available with Guix and then define the @code{GUIX_LOCPATH} environment
1590 variable:
1591
1592 @example
1593 $ guix install glibc-locales
1594 $ export GUIX_LOCPATH=$HOME/.guix-profile/lib/locale
1595 @end example
1596
1597 Note that the @code{glibc-locales} package contains data for all the
1598 locales supported by the GNU@tie{}libc and weighs in at around
1599 110@tie{}MiB. Alternatively, the @code{glibc-utf8-locales} is smaller but
1600 limited to a few UTF-8 locales.
1601
1602 The @code{GUIX_LOCPATH} variable plays a role similar to @code{LOCPATH}
1603 (@pxref{Locale Names, @code{LOCPATH},, libc, The GNU C Library Reference
1604 Manual}). There are two important differences though:
1605
1606 @enumerate
1607 @item
1608 @code{GUIX_LOCPATH} is honored only by the libc in Guix, and not by the libc
1609 provided by foreign distros. Thus, using @code{GUIX_LOCPATH} allows you
1610 to make sure the programs of the foreign distro will not end up loading
1611 incompatible locale data.
1612
1613 @item
1614 libc suffixes each entry of @code{GUIX_LOCPATH} with @code{/X.Y}, where
1615 @code{X.Y} is the libc version---e.g., @code{2.22}. This means that,
1616 should your Guix profile contain a mixture of programs linked against
1617 different libc version, each libc version will only try to load locale
1618 data in the right format.
1619 @end enumerate
1620
1621 This is important because the locale data format used by different libc
1622 versions may be incompatible.
1623
1624 @subsection Name Service Switch
1625
1626 @cindex name service switch, glibc
1627 @cindex NSS (name service switch), glibc
1628 @cindex nscd (name service caching daemon)
1629 @cindex name service caching daemon (nscd)
1630 When using Guix on a foreign distro, we @emph{strongly recommend} that
1631 the system run the GNU C library's @dfn{name service cache daemon},
1632 @command{nscd}, which should be listening on the
1633 @file{/var/run/nscd/socket} socket. Failing to do that, applications
1634 installed with Guix may fail to look up host names or user accounts, or
1635 may even crash. The next paragraphs explain why.
1636
1637 @cindex @file{nsswitch.conf}
1638 The GNU C library implements a @dfn{name service switch} (NSS), which is
1639 an extensible mechanism for ``name lookups'' in general: host name
1640 resolution, user accounts, and more (@pxref{Name Service Switch,,, libc,
1641 The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
1642
1643 @cindex Network information service (NIS)
1644 @cindex NIS (Network information service)
1645 Being extensible, the NSS supports @dfn{plugins}, which provide new name
1646 lookup implementations: for example, the @code{nss-mdns} plugin allow
1647 resolution of @code{.local} host names, the @code{nis} plugin allows
1648 user account lookup using the Network information service (NIS), and so
1649 on. These extra ``lookup services'' are configured system-wide in
1650 @file{/etc/nsswitch.conf}, and all the programs running on the system
1651 honor those settings (@pxref{NSS Configuration File,,, libc, The GNU C
1652 Reference Manual}).
1653
1654 When they perform a name lookup---for instance by calling the
1655 @code{getaddrinfo} function in C---applications first try to connect to
1656 the nscd; on success, nscd performs name lookups on their behalf. If
1657 the nscd is not running, then they perform the name lookup by
1658 themselves, by loading the name lookup services into their own address
1659 space and running it. These name lookup services---the
1660 @file{libnss_*.so} files---are @code{dlopen}'d, but they may come from
1661 the host system's C library, rather than from the C library the
1662 application is linked against (the C library coming from Guix).
1663
1664 And this is where the problem is: if your application is linked against
1665 Guix's C library (say, glibc 2.24) and tries to load NSS plugins from
1666 another C library (say, @code{libnss_mdns.so} for glibc 2.22), it will
1667 likely crash or have its name lookups fail unexpectedly.
1668
1669 Running @command{nscd} on the system, among other advantages, eliminates
1670 this binary incompatibility problem because those @code{libnss_*.so}
1671 files are loaded in the @command{nscd} process, not in applications
1672 themselves.
1673
1674 @subsection X11 Fonts
1675
1676 @cindex fonts
1677 The majority of graphical applications use Fontconfig to locate and
1678 load fonts and perform X11-client-side rendering. The @code{fontconfig}
1679 package in Guix looks for fonts in @file{$HOME/.guix-profile}
1680 by default. Thus, to allow graphical applications installed with Guix
1681 to display fonts, you have to install fonts with Guix as well.
1682 Essential font packages include @code{gs-fonts}, @code{font-dejavu}, and
1683 @code{font-gnu-freefont-ttf}.
1684
1685 To display text written in Chinese languages, Japanese, or Korean in
1686 graphical applications, consider installing
1687 @code{font-adobe-source-han-sans} or @code{font-wqy-zenhei}. The former
1688 has multiple outputs, one per language family (@pxref{Packages with
1689 Multiple Outputs}). For instance, the following command installs fonts
1690 for Chinese languages:
1691
1692 @example
1693 guix install font-adobe-source-han-sans:cn
1694 @end example
1695
1696 @cindex @code{xterm}
1697 Older programs such as @command{xterm} do not use Fontconfig and instead
1698 rely on server-side font rendering. Such programs require to specify a
1699 full name of a font using XLFD (X Logical Font Description), like this:
1700
1701 @example
1702 -*-dejavu sans-medium-r-normal-*-*-100-*-*-*-*-*-1
1703 @end example
1704
1705 To be able to use such full names for the TrueType fonts installed in
1706 your Guix profile, you need to extend the font path of the X server:
1707
1708 @c Note: 'xset' does not accept symlinks so the trick below arranges to
1709 @c get at the real directory. See <https://bugs.gnu.org/30655>.
1710 @example
1711 xset +fp $(dirname $(readlink -f ~/.guix-profile/share/fonts/truetype/fonts.dir))
1712 @end example
1713
1714 @cindex @code{xlsfonts}
1715 After that, you can run @code{xlsfonts} (from @code{xlsfonts} package)
1716 to make sure your TrueType fonts are listed there.
1717
1718 @cindex @code{fc-cache}
1719 @cindex font cache
1720 After installing fonts you may have to refresh the font cache to use
1721 them in applications. The same applies when applications installed via
1722 Guix do not seem to find fonts. To force rebuilding of the font cache
1723 run @code{fc-cache -f}. The @code{fc-cache} command is provided by the
1724 @code{fontconfig} package.
1725
1726 @subsection X.509 Certificates
1727
1728 @cindex @code{nss-certs}
1729 The @code{nss-certs} package provides X.509 certificates, which allow
1730 programs to authenticate Web servers accessed over HTTPS.
1731
1732 When using Guix on a foreign distro, you can install this package and
1733 define the relevant environment variables so that packages know where to
1734 look for certificates. @xref{X.509 Certificates}, for detailed
1735 information.
1736
1737 @subsection Emacs Packages
1738
1739 @cindex @code{emacs}
1740 When you install Emacs packages with Guix, the elisp files may be placed
1741 either in @file{$HOME/.guix-profile/share/emacs/site-lisp/} or in
1742 sub-directories of
1743 @file{$HOME/.guix-profile/share/emacs/site-lisp/guix.d/}. The latter
1744 directory exists because potentially there may exist thousands of Emacs
1745 packages and storing all their files in a single directory may not be
1746 reliable (because of name conflicts). So we think using a separate
1747 directory for each package is a good idea. It is very similar to how
1748 the Emacs package system organizes the file structure (@pxref{Package
1749 Files,,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}).
1750
1751 By default, Emacs (installed with Guix) ``knows'' where these packages
1752 are placed, so you do not need to perform any configuration. If, for
1753 some reason, you want to avoid auto-loading Emacs packages installed
1754 with Guix, you can do so by running Emacs with @code{--no-site-file}
1755 option (@pxref{Init File,,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}).
1756
1757 @subsection The GCC toolchain
1758
1759 @cindex GCC
1760 @cindex ld-wrapper
1761
1762 Guix offers individual compiler packages such as @code{gcc} but if you
1763 are in need of a complete toolchain for compiling and linking source
1764 code what you really want is the @code{gcc-toolchain} package. This
1765 package provides a complete GCC toolchain for C/C++ development,
1766 including GCC itself, the GNU C Library (headers and binaries, plus
1767 debugging symbols in the @code{debug} output), Binutils, and a linker
1768 wrapper.
1769
1770 The wrapper's purpose is to inspect the @code{-L} and @code{-l} switches
1771 passed to the linker, add corresponding @code{-rpath} arguments, and
1772 invoke the actual linker with this new set of arguments. You can instruct the
1773 wrapper to refuse to link against libraries not in the store by setting the
1774 @code{GUIX_LD_WRAPPER_ALLOW_IMPURITIES} environment variable to @code{no}.
1775
1776 @c TODO What else?
1777
1778 @c *********************************************************************
1779 @node System Installation
1780 @chapter System Installation
1781
1782 @cindex installing Guix System
1783 @cindex Guix System, installation
1784 This section explains how to install Guix System
1785 on a machine. Guix, as a package manager, can
1786 also be installed on top of a running GNU/Linux system,
1787 @pxref{Installation}.
1788
1789 @ifinfo
1790 @quotation Note
1791 @c This paragraph is for people reading this from tty2 of the
1792 @c installation image.
1793 You are reading this documentation with an Info reader. For details on
1794 how to use it, hit the @key{RET} key (``return'' or ``enter'') on the
1795 link that follows: @pxref{Top, Info reader,, info-stnd, Stand-alone GNU
1796 Info}. Hit @kbd{l} afterwards to come back here.
1797
1798 Alternately, run @command{info info} in another tty to keep the manual
1799 available.
1800 @end quotation
1801 @end ifinfo
1802
1803 @menu
1804 * Limitations:: What you can expect.
1805 * Hardware Considerations:: Supported hardware.
1806 * USB Stick and DVD Installation:: Preparing the installation medium.
1807 * Preparing for Installation:: Networking, partitioning, etc.
1808 * Guided Graphical Installation:: Easy graphical installation.
1809 * Manual Installation:: Manual installation for wizards.
1810 * After System Installation:: When installation succeeded.
1811 * Installing Guix in a VM:: Guix System playground.
1812 * Building the Installation Image:: How this comes to be.
1813 @end menu
1814
1815 @node Limitations
1816 @section Limitations
1817
1818 We consider Guix System to be ready for a wide range of ``desktop'' and server
1819 use cases. The reliability guarantees it provides---transactional upgrades
1820 and rollbacks, reproducibility---make it a solid foundation.
1821
1822 Nevertheless, before you proceed with the installation, be aware of the
1823 following noteworthy limitations applicable to version @value{VERSION}:
1824
1825 @itemize
1826 @item
1827 Support for the Logical Volume Manager (LVM) is missing.
1828
1829 @item
1830 More and more system services are provided (@pxref{Services}), but some
1831 may be missing.
1832
1833 @item
1834 GNOME, Xfce, LXDE, and Enlightenment are available (@pxref{Desktop Services}),
1835 as well as a number of X11 window managers. However, KDE is currently
1836 missing.
1837 @end itemize
1838
1839 More than a disclaimer, this is an invitation to report issues (and success
1840 stories!), and to join us in improving it. @xref{Contributing}, for more
1841 info.
1842
1843
1844 @node Hardware Considerations
1845 @section Hardware Considerations
1846
1847 @cindex hardware support on Guix System
1848 GNU@tie{}Guix focuses on respecting the user's computing freedom. It
1849 builds around the kernel Linux-libre, which means that only hardware for
1850 which free software drivers and firmware exist is supported. Nowadays,
1851 a wide range of off-the-shelf hardware is supported on
1852 GNU/Linux-libre---from keyboards to graphics cards to scanners and
1853 Ethernet controllers. Unfortunately, there are still areas where
1854 hardware vendors deny users control over their own computing, and such
1855 hardware is not supported on Guix System.
1856
1857 @cindex WiFi, hardware support
1858 One of the main areas where free drivers or firmware are lacking is WiFi
1859 devices. WiFi devices known to work include those using Atheros chips
1860 (AR9271 and AR7010), which corresponds to the @code{ath9k} Linux-libre
1861 driver, and those using Broadcom/AirForce chips (BCM43xx with
1862 Wireless-Core Revision 5), which corresponds to the @code{b43-open}
1863 Linux-libre driver. Free firmware exists for both and is available
1864 out-of-the-box on Guix System, as part of @code{%base-firmware}
1865 (@pxref{operating-system Reference, @code{firmware}}).
1866
1867 @cindex RYF, Respects Your Freedom
1868 The @uref{https://www.fsf.org/, Free Software Foundation} runs
1869 @uref{https://www.fsf.org/ryf, @dfn{Respects Your Freedom}} (RYF), a
1870 certification program for hardware products that respect your freedom
1871 and your privacy and ensure that you have control over your device. We
1872 encourage you to check the list of RYF-certified devices.
1873
1874 Another useful resource is the @uref{https://www.h-node.org/, H-Node}
1875 web site. It contains a catalog of hardware devices with information
1876 about their support in GNU/Linux.
1877
1878
1879 @node USB Stick and DVD Installation
1880 @section USB Stick and DVD Installation
1881
1882 An ISO-9660 installation image that can be written to a USB stick or
1883 burnt to a DVD can be downloaded from
1884 @indicateurl{@value{BASE-URL}/guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.iso.xz},
1885 where @var{system} is one of:
1886
1887 @table @code
1888 @item x86_64-linux
1889 for a GNU/Linux system on Intel/AMD-compatible 64-bit CPUs;
1890
1891 @item i686-linux
1892 for a 32-bit GNU/Linux system on Intel-compatible CPUs.
1893 @end table
1894
1895 @c start duplication of authentication part from ``Binary Installation''
1896 Make sure to download the associated @file{.sig} file and to verify the
1897 authenticity of the image against it, along these lines:
1898
1899 @example
1900 $ wget @value{BASE-URL}/guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.iso.xz.sig
1901 $ gpg --verify guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.iso.xz.sig
1902 @end example
1903
1904 If that command fails because you do not have the required public key,
1905 then run this command to import it:
1906
1907 @example
1908 $ gpg --keyserver @value{KEY-SERVER} \
1909 --recv-keys @value{OPENPGP-SIGNING-KEY-ID}
1910 @end example
1911
1912 @noindent
1913 and rerun the @code{gpg --verify} command.
1914 @c end duplication
1915
1916 This image contains the tools necessary for an installation.
1917 It is meant to be copied @emph{as is} to a large-enough USB stick or DVD.
1918
1919 @unnumberedsubsec Copying to a USB Stick
1920
1921 To copy the image to a USB stick, follow these steps:
1922
1923 @enumerate
1924 @item
1925 Decompress the image using the @command{xz} command:
1926
1927 @example
1928 xz -d guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.iso.xz
1929 @end example
1930
1931 @item
1932 Insert a USB stick of 1@tie{}GiB or more into your machine, and determine
1933 its device name. Assuming that the USB stick is known as @file{/dev/sdX},
1934 copy the image with:
1935
1936 @example
1937 dd if=guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.iso of=/dev/sdX
1938 sync
1939 @end example
1940
1941 Access to @file{/dev/sdX} usually requires root privileges.
1942 @end enumerate
1943
1944 @unnumberedsubsec Burning on a DVD
1945
1946 To copy the image to a DVD, follow these steps:
1947
1948 @enumerate
1949 @item
1950 Decompress the image using the @command{xz} command:
1951
1952 @example
1953 xz -d guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.iso.xz
1954 @end example
1955
1956 @item
1957 Insert a blank DVD into your machine, and determine
1958 its device name. Assuming that the DVD drive is known as @file{/dev/srX},
1959 copy the image with:
1960
1961 @example
1962 growisofs -dvd-compat -Z /dev/srX=guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.iso
1963 @end example
1964
1965 Access to @file{/dev/srX} usually requires root privileges.
1966 @end enumerate
1967
1968 @unnumberedsubsec Booting
1969
1970 Once this is done, you should be able to reboot the system and boot from
1971 the USB stick or DVD. The latter usually requires you to get in the
1972 BIOS or UEFI boot menu, where you can choose to boot from the USB stick.
1973
1974 @xref{Installing Guix in a VM}, if, instead, you would like to install
1975 Guix System in a virtual machine (VM).
1976
1977
1978 @node Preparing for Installation
1979 @section Preparing for Installation
1980
1981 Once you have booted, you can use the guided graphical installer, which makes
1982 it easy to get started (@pxref{Guided Graphical Installation}). Alternately,
1983 if you are already familiar with GNU/Linux and if you want more control than
1984 what the graphical installer provides, you can choose the ``manual''
1985 installation process (@pxref{Manual Installation}).
1986
1987 The graphical installer is available on TTY1. You can obtain root shells on
1988 TTYs 3 to 6 by hitting @kbd{ctrl-alt-f3}, @kbd{ctrl-alt-f4}, etc. TTY2 shows
1989 this documentation and you can reach it with @kbd{ctrl-alt-f2}. Documentation
1990 is browsable using the Info reader commands (@pxref{Top,,, info-stnd,
1991 Stand-alone GNU Info}). The installation system runs the GPM mouse daemon,
1992 which allows you to select text with the left mouse button and to paste it
1993 with the middle button.
1994
1995 @quotation Note
1996 Installation requires access to the Internet so that any missing
1997 dependencies of your system configuration can be downloaded. See the
1998 ``Networking'' section below.
1999 @end quotation
2000
2001 @node Guided Graphical Installation
2002 @section Guided Graphical Installation
2003
2004 The graphical installer is a text-based user interface. It will guide you,
2005 with dialog boxes, through the steps needed to install GNU@tie{}Guix System.
2006
2007 The first dialog boxes allow you to set up the system as you use it during the
2008 installation: you can choose the language, keyboard layout, and set up
2009 networking, which will be used during the installation. The image below shows
2010 the networking dialog.
2011
2012 @image{images/installer-network,5in,, networking setup with the graphical installer}
2013
2014 Later steps allow you to partition your hard disk, as shown in the image
2015 below, to choose whether or not to use encrypted file systems, to enter the
2016 host name and root password, and to create an additional account, among other
2017 things.
2018
2019 @image{images/installer-partitions,5in,, partitioning with the graphical installer}
2020
2021 Note that, at any time, the installer allows you to exit the current
2022 installation step and resume at a previous step, as show in the image below.
2023
2024 @image{images/installer-resume,5in,, resuming the installation process}
2025
2026 Once you're done, the installer produces an operating system configuration and
2027 displays it (@pxref{Using the Configuration System}). At that point you can
2028 hit ``OK'' and installation will proceed. On success, you can reboot into the
2029 new system and enjoy. @xref{After System Installation}, for what's next!
2030
2031
2032 @node Manual Installation
2033 @section Manual Installation
2034
2035 This section describes how you would ``manually'' install GNU@tie{}Guix System
2036 on your machine. This option requires familiarity with GNU/Linux, with the
2037 shell, and with common administration tools. If you think this is not for
2038 you, consider using the guided graphical installer (@pxref{Guided Graphical
2039 Installation}).
2040
2041 The installation system provides root shells on TTYs 3 to 6; press
2042 @kbd{ctrl-alt-f3}, @kbd{ctrl-alt-f4}, and so on to reach them. It includes
2043 many common tools needed to install the system. But it is also a full-blown
2044 Guix System, which means that you can install additional packages, should you
2045 need it, using @command{guix package} (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
2046
2047 @menu
2048 * Keyboard Layout and Networking and Partitioning:: Initial setup.
2049 * Proceeding with the Installation:: Installing.
2050 @end menu
2051
2052 @node Keyboard Layout and Networking and Partitioning
2053 @subsection Keyboard Layout, Networking, and Partitioning
2054
2055 Before you can install the system, you may want to adjust the keyboard layout,
2056 set up networking, and partition your target hard disk. This section will
2057 guide you through this.
2058
2059 @subsubsection Keyboard Layout
2060
2061 @cindex keyboard layout
2062 The installation image uses the US qwerty keyboard layout. If you want
2063 to change it, you can use the @command{loadkeys} command. For example,
2064 the following command selects the Dvorak keyboard layout:
2065
2066 @example
2067 loadkeys dvorak
2068 @end example
2069
2070 See the files under @file{/run/current-system/profile/share/keymaps} for
2071 a list of available keyboard layouts. Run @command{man loadkeys} for
2072 more information.
2073
2074 @subsubsection Networking
2075
2076 Run the following command to see what your network interfaces are called:
2077
2078 @example
2079 ifconfig -a
2080 @end example
2081
2082 @noindent
2083 @dots{} or, using the GNU/Linux-specific @command{ip} command:
2084
2085 @example
2086 ip a
2087 @end example
2088
2089 @c https://cgit.freedesktop.org/systemd/systemd/tree/src/udev/udev-builtin-net_id.c#n20
2090 Wired interfaces have a name starting with @samp{e}; for example, the
2091 interface corresponding to the first on-board Ethernet controller is
2092 called @samp{eno1}. Wireless interfaces have a name starting with
2093 @samp{w}, like @samp{w1p2s0}.
2094
2095 @table @asis
2096 @item Wired connection
2097 To configure a wired network run the following command, substituting
2098 @var{interface} with the name of the wired interface you want to use.
2099
2100 @example
2101 ifconfig @var{interface} up
2102 @end example
2103
2104 @item Wireless connection
2105 @cindex wireless
2106 @cindex WiFi
2107 To configure wireless networking, you can create a configuration file
2108 for the @command{wpa_supplicant} configuration tool (its location is not
2109 important) using one of the available text editors such as
2110 @command{nano}:
2111
2112 @example
2113 nano wpa_supplicant.conf
2114 @end example
2115
2116 As an example, the following stanza can go to this file and will work
2117 for many wireless networks, provided you give the actual SSID and
2118 passphrase for the network you are connecting to:
2119
2120 @example
2121 network=@{
2122 ssid="@var{my-ssid}"
2123 key_mgmt=WPA-PSK
2124 psk="the network's secret passphrase"
2125 @}
2126 @end example
2127
2128 Start the wireless service and run it in the background with the
2129 following command (substitute @var{interface} with the name of the
2130 network interface you want to use):
2131
2132 @example
2133 wpa_supplicant -c wpa_supplicant.conf -i @var{interface} -B
2134 @end example
2135
2136 Run @command{man wpa_supplicant} for more information.
2137 @end table
2138
2139 @cindex DHCP
2140 At this point, you need to acquire an IP address. On a network where IP
2141 addresses are automatically assigned @i{via} DHCP, you can run:
2142
2143 @example
2144 dhclient -v @var{interface}
2145 @end example
2146
2147 Try to ping a server to see if networking is up and running:
2148
2149 @example
2150 ping -c 3 gnu.org
2151 @end example
2152
2153 Setting up network access is almost always a requirement because the
2154 image does not contain all the software and tools that may be needed.
2155
2156 @cindex installing over SSH
2157 If you want to, you can continue the installation remotely by starting
2158 an SSH server:
2159
2160 @example
2161 herd start ssh-daemon
2162 @end example
2163
2164 Make sure to either set a password with @command{passwd}, or configure
2165 OpenSSH public key authentication before logging in.
2166
2167 @subsubsection Disk Partitioning
2168
2169 Unless this has already been done, the next step is to partition, and
2170 then format the target partition(s).
2171
2172 The installation image includes several partitioning tools, including
2173 Parted (@pxref{Overview,,, parted, GNU Parted User Manual}),
2174 @command{fdisk}, and @command{cfdisk}. Run it and set up your disk with
2175 the partition layout you want:
2176
2177 @example
2178 cfdisk
2179 @end example
2180
2181 If your disk uses the GUID Partition Table (GPT) format and you plan to
2182 install BIOS-based GRUB (which is the default), make sure a BIOS Boot
2183 Partition is available (@pxref{BIOS installation,,, grub, GNU GRUB
2184 manual}).
2185
2186 @cindex EFI, installation
2187 @cindex UEFI, installation
2188 @cindex ESP, EFI system partition
2189 If you instead wish to use EFI-based GRUB, a FAT32 @dfn{EFI System Partition}
2190 (ESP) is required. This partition can be mounted at @file{/boot/efi} for
2191 instance and must have the @code{esp} flag set. E.g., for @command{parted}:
2192
2193 @example
2194 parted /dev/sda set 1 esp on
2195 @end example
2196
2197 @quotation Note
2198 @vindex grub-bootloader
2199 @vindex grub-efi-bootloader
2200 Unsure whether to use EFI- or BIOS-based GRUB? If the directory
2201 @file{/sys/firmware/efi} exists in the installation image, then you should
2202 probably perform an EFI installation, using @code{grub-efi-bootloader}.
2203 Otherwise you should use the BIOS-based GRUB, known as
2204 @code{grub-bootloader}. @xref{Bootloader Configuration}, for more info on
2205 bootloaders.
2206 @end quotation
2207
2208 Once you are done partitioning the target hard disk drive, you have to
2209 create a file system on the relevant partition(s)@footnote{Currently
2210 Guix System only supports ext4 and btrfs file systems. In particular, code
2211 that reads file system UUIDs and labels only works for these file system
2212 types.}. For the ESP, if you have one and assuming it is
2213 @file{/dev/sda1}, run:
2214
2215 @example
2216 mkfs.fat -F32 /dev/sda1
2217 @end example
2218
2219 Preferably, assign file systems a label so that you can easily and
2220 reliably refer to them in @code{file-system} declarations (@pxref{File
2221 Systems}). This is typically done using the @code{-L} option of
2222 @command{mkfs.ext4} and related commands. So, assuming the target root
2223 partition lives at @file{/dev/sda2}, a file system with the label
2224 @code{my-root} can be created with:
2225
2226 @example
2227 mkfs.ext4 -L my-root /dev/sda2
2228 @end example
2229
2230 @cindex encrypted disk
2231 If you are instead planning to encrypt the root partition, you can use
2232 the Cryptsetup/LUKS utilities to do that (see @inlinefmtifelse{html,
2233 @uref{https://linux.die.net/man/8/cryptsetup, @code{man cryptsetup}},
2234 @code{man cryptsetup}} for more information.) Assuming you want to
2235 store the root partition on @file{/dev/sda2}, the command sequence would
2236 be along these lines:
2237
2238 @example
2239 cryptsetup luksFormat /dev/sda2
2240 cryptsetup open --type luks /dev/sda2 my-partition
2241 mkfs.ext4 -L my-root /dev/mapper/my-partition
2242 @end example
2243
2244 Once that is done, mount the target file system under @file{/mnt}
2245 with a command like (again, assuming @code{my-root} is the label of the
2246 root file system):
2247
2248 @example
2249 mount LABEL=my-root /mnt
2250 @end example
2251
2252 Also mount any other file systems you would like to use on the target
2253 system relative to this path. If you have opted for @file{/boot/efi} as an
2254 EFI mount point for example, mount it at @file{/mnt/boot/efi} now so it is
2255 found by @code{guix system init} afterwards.
2256
2257 Finally, if you plan to use one or more swap partitions (@pxref{Memory
2258 Concepts, swap space,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}), make
2259 sure to initialize them with @command{mkswap}. Assuming you have one
2260 swap partition on @file{/dev/sda3}, you would run:
2261
2262 @example
2263 mkswap /dev/sda3
2264 swapon /dev/sda3
2265 @end example
2266
2267 Alternatively, you may use a swap file. For example, assuming that in
2268 the new system you want to use the file @file{/swapfile} as a swap file,
2269 you would run@footnote{This example will work for many types of file
2270 systems (e.g., ext4). However, for copy-on-write file systems (e.g.,
2271 btrfs), the required steps may be different. For details, see the
2272 manual pages for @command{mkswap} and @command{swapon}.}:
2273
2274 @example
2275 # This is 10 GiB of swap space. Adjust "count" to change the size.
2276 dd if=/dev/zero of=/mnt/swapfile bs=1MiB count=10240
2277 # For security, make the file readable and writable only by root.
2278 chmod 600 /mnt/swapfile
2279 mkswap /mnt/swapfile
2280 swapon /mnt/swapfile
2281 @end example
2282
2283 Note that if you have encrypted the root partition and created a swap
2284 file in its file system as described above, then the encryption also
2285 protects the swap file, just like any other file in that file system.
2286
2287 @node Proceeding with the Installation
2288 @subsection Proceeding with the Installation
2289
2290 With the target partitions ready and the target root mounted on
2291 @file{/mnt}, we're ready to go. First, run:
2292
2293 @example
2294 herd start cow-store /mnt
2295 @end example
2296
2297 This makes @file{/gnu/store} copy-on-write, such that packages added to it
2298 during the installation phase are written to the target disk on @file{/mnt}
2299 rather than kept in memory. This is necessary because the first phase of
2300 the @command{guix system init} command (see below) entails downloads or
2301 builds to @file{/gnu/store} which, initially, is an in-memory file system.
2302
2303 Next, you have to edit a file and
2304 provide the declaration of the operating system to be installed. To
2305 that end, the installation system comes with three text editors. We
2306 recommend GNU nano (@pxref{Top,,, nano, GNU nano Manual}), which
2307 supports syntax highlighting and parentheses matching; other editors
2308 include GNU Zile (an Emacs clone), and
2309 nvi (a clone of the original BSD @command{vi} editor).
2310 We strongly recommend storing that file on the target root file system, say,
2311 as @file{/mnt/etc/config.scm}. Failing to do that, you will have lost your
2312 configuration file once you have rebooted into the newly-installed system.
2313
2314 @xref{Using the Configuration System}, for an overview of the
2315 configuration file. The example configurations discussed in that
2316 section are available under @file{/etc/configuration} in the
2317 installation image. Thus, to get started with a system configuration
2318 providing a graphical display server (a ``desktop'' system), you can run
2319 something along these lines:
2320
2321 @example
2322 # mkdir /mnt/etc
2323 # cp /etc/configuration/desktop.scm /mnt/etc/config.scm
2324 # nano /mnt/etc/config.scm
2325 @end example
2326
2327 You should pay attention to what your configuration file contains, and
2328 in particular:
2329
2330 @itemize
2331 @item
2332 Make sure the @code{bootloader-configuration} form refers to the target
2333 you want to install GRUB on. It should mention @code{grub-bootloader} if
2334 you are installing GRUB in the legacy way, or @code{grub-efi-bootloader}
2335 for newer UEFI systems. For legacy systems, the @code{target} field
2336 names a device, like @code{/dev/sda}; for UEFI systems it names a path
2337 to a mounted EFI partition, like @code{/boot/efi}; do make sure the path is
2338 currently mounted and a @code{file-system} entry is specified in your
2339 configuration.
2340
2341 @item
2342 Be sure that your file system labels match the value of their respective
2343 @code{device} fields in your @code{file-system} configuration, assuming
2344 your @code{file-system} configuration uses the @code{file-system-label}
2345 procedure in its @code{device} field.
2346
2347 @item
2348 If there are encrypted or RAID partitions, make sure to add a
2349 @code{mapped-devices} field to describe them (@pxref{Mapped Devices}).
2350 @end itemize
2351
2352 Once you are done preparing the configuration file, the new system must
2353 be initialized (remember that the target root file system is mounted
2354 under @file{/mnt}):
2355
2356 @example
2357 guix system init /mnt/etc/config.scm /mnt
2358 @end example
2359
2360 @noindent
2361 This copies all the necessary files and installs GRUB on
2362 @file{/dev/sdX}, unless you pass the @option{--no-bootloader} option. For
2363 more information, @pxref{Invoking guix system}. This command may trigger
2364 downloads or builds of missing packages, which can take some time.
2365
2366 Once that command has completed---and hopefully succeeded!---you can run
2367 @command{reboot} and boot into the new system. The @code{root} password
2368 in the new system is initially empty; other users' passwords need to be
2369 initialized by running the @command{passwd} command as @code{root},
2370 unless your configuration specifies otherwise
2371 (@pxref{user-account-password, user account passwords}).
2372 @xref{After System Installation}, for what's next!
2373
2374
2375 @node After System Installation
2376 @section After System Installation
2377
2378 Success, you've now booted into Guix System! From then on, you can update the
2379 system whenever you want by running, say:
2380
2381 @example
2382 guix pull
2383 sudo guix system reconfigure /etc/config.scm
2384 @end example
2385
2386 @noindent
2387 This builds a new system generation with the latest packages and services
2388 (@pxref{Invoking guix system}). We recommend doing that regularly so that
2389 your system includes the latest security updates (@pxref{Security Updates}).
2390
2391 @c See <https://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/guix-devel/2019-01/msg00268.html>.
2392 @quotation Note
2393 @cindex sudo vs. @command{guix pull}
2394 Note that @command{sudo guix} runs your user's @command{guix} command and
2395 @emph{not} root's, because @command{sudo} leaves @code{PATH} unchanged. To
2396 explicitly run root's @command{guix}, type @command{sudo -i guix @dots{}}.
2397 @end quotation
2398
2399 Join us on @code{#guix} on the Freenode IRC network or on
2400 @email{guix-devel@@gnu.org} to share your experience!
2401
2402
2403 @node Installing Guix in a VM
2404 @section Installing Guix in a Virtual Machine
2405
2406 @cindex virtual machine, Guix System installation
2407 @cindex virtual private server (VPS)
2408 @cindex VPS (virtual private server)
2409 If you'd like to install Guix System in a virtual machine (VM) or on a
2410 virtual private server (VPS) rather than on your beloved machine, this
2411 section is for you.
2412
2413 To boot a @uref{https://qemu.org/,QEMU} VM for installing Guix System in a
2414 disk image, follow these steps:
2415
2416 @enumerate
2417 @item
2418 First, retrieve and decompress the Guix system installation image as
2419 described previously (@pxref{USB Stick and DVD Installation}).
2420
2421 @item
2422 Create a disk image that will hold the installed system. To make a
2423 qcow2-formatted disk image, use the @command{qemu-img} command:
2424
2425 @example
2426 qemu-img create -f qcow2 guixsd.img 50G
2427 @end example
2428
2429 The resulting file will be much smaller than 50 GB (typically less than
2430 1 MB), but it will grow as the virtualized storage device is filled up.
2431
2432 @item
2433 Boot the USB installation image in an VM:
2434
2435 @example
2436 qemu-system-x86_64 -m 1024 -smp 1 -enable-kvm \
2437 -net user -net nic,model=virtio -boot menu=on \
2438 -drive file=guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.iso \
2439 -drive file=guixsd.img
2440 @end example
2441
2442 The ordering of the drives matters. @code{-enable-kvm} is optional, but
2443 significantly improves performance, @pxref{Running Guix in a VM}.
2444
2445 In the VM console, quickly press the @kbd{F12} key to enter the boot
2446 menu. Then press the @kbd{2} key and the @kbd{RET} key to validate your
2447 selection.
2448
2449 @item
2450 You're now root in the VM, proceed with the installation process.
2451 @xref{Preparing for Installation}, and follow the instructions.
2452 @end enumerate
2453
2454 Once installation is complete, you can boot the system that's on your
2455 @file{guixsd.img} image. @xref{Running Guix in a VM}, for how to do
2456 that.
2457
2458 @node Building the Installation Image
2459 @section Building the Installation Image
2460
2461 @cindex installation image
2462 The installation image described above was built using the @command{guix
2463 system} command, specifically:
2464
2465 @example
2466 guix system disk-image --file-system-type=iso9660 \
2467 gnu/system/install.scm
2468 @end example
2469
2470 Have a look at @file{gnu/system/install.scm} in the source tree,
2471 and see also @ref{Invoking guix system} for more information
2472 about the installation image.
2473
2474 @section Building the Installation Image for ARM Boards
2475
2476 Many ARM boards require a specific variant of the
2477 @uref{https://www.denx.de/wiki/U-Boot/, U-Boot} bootloader.
2478
2479 If you build a disk image and the bootloader is not available otherwise
2480 (on another boot drive etc), it's advisable to build an image that
2481 includes the bootloader, specifically:
2482
2483 @example
2484 guix system disk-image --system=armhf-linux -e '((@@ (gnu system install) os-with-u-boot) (@@ (gnu system install) installation-os) "A20-OLinuXino-Lime2")'
2485 @end example
2486
2487 @code{A20-OLinuXino-Lime2} is the name of the board. If you specify an invalid
2488 board, a list of possible boards will be printed.
2489
2490 @c *********************************************************************
2491 @node Package Management
2492 @chapter Package Management
2493
2494 @cindex packages
2495 The purpose of GNU Guix is to allow users to easily install, upgrade, and
2496 remove software packages, without having to know about their build
2497 procedures or dependencies. Guix also goes beyond this obvious set of
2498 features.
2499
2500 This chapter describes the main features of Guix, as well as the
2501 package management tools it provides. Along with the command-line
2502 interface described below (@pxref{Invoking guix package, @code{guix
2503 package}}), you may also use the Emacs-Guix interface (@pxref{Top,,,
2504 emacs-guix, The Emacs-Guix Reference Manual}), after installing
2505 @code{emacs-guix} package (run @kbd{M-x guix-help} command to start
2506 with it):
2507
2508 @example
2509 guix install emacs-guix
2510 @end example
2511
2512 @menu
2513 * Features:: How Guix will make your life brighter.
2514 * Invoking guix package:: Package installation, removal, etc.
2515 * Substitutes:: Downloading pre-built binaries.
2516 * Packages with Multiple Outputs:: Single source package, multiple outputs.
2517 * Invoking guix gc:: Running the garbage collector.
2518 * Invoking guix pull:: Fetching the latest Guix and distribution.
2519 * Channels:: Customizing the package collection.
2520 * Inferiors:: Interacting with another revision of Guix.
2521 * Invoking guix describe:: Display information about your Guix revision.
2522 * Invoking guix archive:: Exporting and importing store files.
2523 @end menu
2524
2525 @node Features
2526 @section Features
2527
2528 When using Guix, each package ends up in the @dfn{package store}, in its
2529 own directory---something that resembles
2530 @file{/gnu/store/xxx-package-1.2}, where @code{xxx} is a base32 string.
2531
2532 Instead of referring to these directories, users have their own
2533 @dfn{profile}, which points to the packages that they actually want to
2534 use. These profiles are stored within each user's home directory, at
2535 @code{$HOME/.guix-profile}.
2536
2537 For example, @code{alice} installs GCC 4.7.2. As a result,
2538 @file{/home/alice/.guix-profile/bin/gcc} points to
2539 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-gcc-4.7.2/bin/gcc}. Now, on the same machine,
2540 @code{bob} had already installed GCC 4.8.0. The profile of @code{bob}
2541 simply continues to point to
2542 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-gcc-4.8.0/bin/gcc}---i.e., both versions of GCC
2543 coexist on the same system without any interference.
2544
2545 The @command{guix package} command is the central tool to manage
2546 packages (@pxref{Invoking guix package}). It operates on the per-user
2547 profiles, and can be used @emph{with normal user privileges}.
2548
2549 @cindex transactions
2550 The command provides the obvious install, remove, and upgrade
2551 operations. Each invocation is actually a @emph{transaction}: either
2552 the specified operation succeeds, or nothing happens. Thus, if the
2553 @command{guix package} process is terminated during the transaction,
2554 or if a power outage occurs during the transaction, then the user's
2555 profile remains in its previous state, and remains usable.
2556
2557 In addition, any package transaction may be @emph{rolled back}. So, if,
2558 for example, an upgrade installs a new version of a package that turns
2559 out to have a serious bug, users may roll back to the previous instance
2560 of their profile, which was known to work well. Similarly, the global
2561 system configuration on Guix is subject to
2562 transactional upgrades and roll-back
2563 (@pxref{Using the Configuration System}).
2564
2565 All packages in the package store may be @emph{garbage-collected}.
2566 Guix can determine which packages are still referenced by user
2567 profiles, and remove those that are provably no longer referenced
2568 (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}). Users may also explicitly remove old
2569 generations of their profile so that the packages they refer to can be
2570 collected.
2571
2572 @cindex reproducibility
2573 @cindex reproducible builds
2574 Guix takes a @dfn{purely functional} approach to package
2575 management, as described in the introduction (@pxref{Introduction}).
2576 Each @file{/gnu/store} package directory name contains a hash of all the
2577 inputs that were used to build that package---compiler, libraries, build
2578 scripts, etc. This direct correspondence allows users to make sure a
2579 given package installation matches the current state of their
2580 distribution. It also helps maximize @dfn{build reproducibility}:
2581 thanks to the isolated build environments that are used, a given build
2582 is likely to yield bit-identical files when performed on different
2583 machines (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon, container}).
2584
2585 @cindex substitutes
2586 This foundation allows Guix to support @dfn{transparent binary/source
2587 deployment}. When a pre-built binary for a @file{/gnu/store} item is
2588 available from an external source---a @dfn{substitute}, Guix just
2589 downloads it and unpacks it;
2590 otherwise, it builds the package from source, locally
2591 (@pxref{Substitutes}). Because build results are usually bit-for-bit
2592 reproducible, users do not have to trust servers that provide
2593 substitutes: they can force a local build and @emph{challenge} providers
2594 (@pxref{Invoking guix challenge}).
2595
2596 Control over the build environment is a feature that is also useful for
2597 developers. The @command{guix environment} command allows developers of
2598 a package to quickly set up the right development environment for their
2599 package, without having to manually install the dependencies of the
2600 package into their profile (@pxref{Invoking guix environment}).
2601
2602 @cindex replication, of software environments
2603 @cindex provenance tracking, of software artifacts
2604 All of Guix and its package definitions is version-controlled, and
2605 @command{guix pull} allows you to ``travel in time'' on the history of Guix
2606 itself (@pxref{Invoking guix pull}). This makes it possible to replicate a
2607 Guix instance on a different machine or at a later point in time, which in
2608 turn allows you to @emph{replicate complete software environments}, while
2609 retaining precise @dfn{provenance tracking} of the software.
2610
2611 @node Invoking guix package
2612 @section Invoking @command{guix package}
2613
2614 @cindex installing packages
2615 @cindex removing packages
2616 @cindex package installation
2617 @cindex package removal
2618 The @command{guix package} command is the tool that allows users to
2619 install, upgrade, and remove packages, as well as rolling back to
2620 previous configurations. It operates only on the user's own profile,
2621 and works with normal user privileges (@pxref{Features}). Its syntax
2622 is:
2623
2624 @example
2625 guix package @var{options}
2626 @end example
2627
2628 @cindex transactions
2629 Primarily, @var{options} specifies the operations to be performed during
2630 the transaction. Upon completion, a new profile is created, but
2631 previous @dfn{generations} of the profile remain available, should the user
2632 want to roll back.
2633
2634 For example, to remove @code{lua} and install @code{guile} and
2635 @code{guile-cairo} in a single transaction:
2636
2637 @example
2638 guix package -r lua -i guile guile-cairo
2639 @end example
2640
2641 @cindex aliases, for @command{guix package}
2642 For your convenience, we also provide the following aliases:
2643
2644 @itemize
2645 @item
2646 @command{guix search} is an alias for @command{guix package -s},
2647 @item
2648 @command{guix install} is an alias for @command{guix package -i},
2649 @item
2650 @command{guix remove} is an alias for @command{guix package -r},
2651 @item
2652 and @command{guix upgrade} is an alias for @command{guix package -u}.
2653 @end itemize
2654
2655 These aliases are less expressive than @command{guix package} and provide
2656 fewer options, so in some cases you'll probably want to use @command{guix
2657 package} directly.
2658
2659 @command{guix package} also supports a @dfn{declarative approach}
2660 whereby the user specifies the exact set of packages to be available and
2661 passes it @i{via} the @option{--manifest} option
2662 (@pxref{profile-manifest, @option{--manifest}}).
2663
2664 @cindex profile
2665 For each user, a symlink to the user's default profile is automatically
2666 created in @file{$HOME/.guix-profile}. This symlink always points to the
2667 current generation of the user's default profile. Thus, users can add
2668 @file{$HOME/.guix-profile/bin} to their @code{PATH} environment
2669 variable, and so on.
2670 @cindex search paths
2671 If you are not using Guix System, consider adding the
2672 following lines to your @file{~/.bash_profile} (@pxref{Bash Startup
2673 Files,,, bash, The GNU Bash Reference Manual}) so that newly-spawned
2674 shells get all the right environment variable definitions:
2675
2676 @example
2677 GUIX_PROFILE="$HOME/.guix-profile" ; \
2678 source "$HOME/.guix-profile/etc/profile"
2679 @end example
2680
2681 In a multi-user setup, user profiles are stored in a place registered as
2682 a @dfn{garbage-collector root}, which @file{$HOME/.guix-profile} points
2683 to (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}). That directory is normally
2684 @code{@var{localstatedir}/guix/profiles/per-user/@var{user}}, where
2685 @var{localstatedir} is the value passed to @code{configure} as
2686 @code{--localstatedir}, and @var{user} is the user name. The
2687 @file{per-user} directory is created when @command{guix-daemon} is
2688 started, and the @var{user} sub-directory is created by @command{guix
2689 package}.
2690
2691 The @var{options} can be among the following:
2692
2693 @table @code
2694
2695 @item --install=@var{package} @dots{}
2696 @itemx -i @var{package} @dots{}
2697 Install the specified @var{package}s.
2698
2699 Each @var{package} may specify either a simple package name, such as
2700 @code{guile}, or a package name followed by an at-sign and version number,
2701 such as @code{guile@@1.8.8} or simply @code{guile@@1.8} (in the latter
2702 case, the newest version prefixed by @code{1.8} is selected.)
2703
2704 If no version number is specified, the
2705 newest available version will be selected. In addition, @var{package}
2706 may contain a colon, followed by the name of one of the outputs of the
2707 package, as in @code{gcc:doc} or @code{binutils@@2.22:lib}
2708 (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}). Packages with a corresponding
2709 name (and optionally version) are searched for among the GNU
2710 distribution modules (@pxref{Package Modules}).
2711
2712 @cindex propagated inputs
2713 Sometimes packages have @dfn{propagated inputs}: these are dependencies
2714 that automatically get installed along with the required package
2715 (@pxref{package-propagated-inputs, @code{propagated-inputs} in
2716 @code{package} objects}, for information about propagated inputs in
2717 package definitions).
2718
2719 @anchor{package-cmd-propagated-inputs}
2720 An example is the GNU MPC library: its C header files refer to those of
2721 the GNU MPFR library, which in turn refer to those of the GMP library.
2722 Thus, when installing MPC, the MPFR and GMP libraries also get installed
2723 in the profile; removing MPC also removes MPFR and GMP---unless they had
2724 also been explicitly installed by the user.
2725
2726 Besides, packages sometimes rely on the definition of environment
2727 variables for their search paths (see explanation of
2728 @code{--search-paths} below). Any missing or possibly incorrect
2729 environment variable definitions are reported here.
2730
2731 @item --install-from-expression=@var{exp}
2732 @itemx -e @var{exp}
2733 Install the package @var{exp} evaluates to.
2734
2735 @var{exp} must be a Scheme expression that evaluates to a
2736 @code{<package>} object. This option is notably useful to disambiguate
2737 between same-named variants of a package, with expressions such as
2738 @code{(@@ (gnu packages base) guile-final)}.
2739
2740 Note that this option installs the first output of the specified
2741 package, which may be insufficient when needing a specific output of a
2742 multiple-output package.
2743
2744 @item --install-from-file=@var{file}
2745 @itemx -f @var{file}
2746 Install the package that the code within @var{file} evaluates to.
2747
2748 As an example, @var{file} might contain a definition like this
2749 (@pxref{Defining Packages}):
2750
2751 @example
2752 @verbatiminclude package-hello.scm
2753 @end example
2754
2755 Developers may find it useful to include such a @file{guix.scm} file
2756 in the root of their project source tree that can be used to test
2757 development snapshots and create reproducible development environments
2758 (@pxref{Invoking guix environment}).
2759
2760 @item --remove=@var{package} @dots{}
2761 @itemx -r @var{package} @dots{}
2762 Remove the specified @var{package}s.
2763
2764 As for @code{--install}, each @var{package} may specify a version number
2765 and/or output name in addition to the package name. For instance,
2766 @code{-r glibc:debug} would remove the @code{debug} output of
2767 @code{glibc}.
2768
2769 @item --upgrade[=@var{regexp} @dots{}]
2770 @itemx -u [@var{regexp} @dots{}]
2771 @cindex upgrading packages
2772 Upgrade all the installed packages. If one or more @var{regexp}s are
2773 specified, upgrade only installed packages whose name matches a
2774 @var{regexp}. Also see the @code{--do-not-upgrade} option below.
2775
2776 Note that this upgrades package to the latest version of packages found
2777 in the distribution currently installed. To update your distribution,
2778 you should regularly run @command{guix pull} (@pxref{Invoking guix
2779 pull}).
2780
2781 @item --do-not-upgrade[=@var{regexp} @dots{}]
2782 When used together with the @code{--upgrade} option, do @emph{not}
2783 upgrade any packages whose name matches a @var{regexp}. For example, to
2784 upgrade all packages in the current profile except those containing the
2785 substring ``emacs'':
2786
2787 @example
2788 $ guix package --upgrade . --do-not-upgrade emacs
2789 @end example
2790
2791 @item @anchor{profile-manifest}--manifest=@var{file}
2792 @itemx -m @var{file}
2793 @cindex profile declaration
2794 @cindex profile manifest
2795 Create a new generation of the profile from the manifest object
2796 returned by the Scheme code in @var{file}.
2797
2798 This allows you to @emph{declare} the profile's contents rather than
2799 constructing it through a sequence of @code{--install} and similar
2800 commands. The advantage is that @var{file} can be put under version
2801 control, copied to different machines to reproduce the same profile, and
2802 so on.
2803
2804 @c FIXME: Add reference to (guix profile) documentation when available.
2805 @var{file} must return a @dfn{manifest} object, which is roughly a list
2806 of packages:
2807
2808 @findex packages->manifest
2809 @example
2810 (use-package-modules guile emacs)
2811
2812 (packages->manifest
2813 (list emacs
2814 guile-2.0
2815 ;; Use a specific package output.
2816 (list guile-2.0 "debug")))
2817 @end example
2818
2819 @findex specifications->manifest
2820 In this example we have to know which modules define the @code{emacs}
2821 and @code{guile-2.0} variables to provide the right
2822 @code{use-package-modules} line, which can be cumbersome. We can
2823 instead provide regular package specifications and let
2824 @code{specifications->manifest} look up the corresponding package
2825 objects, like this:
2826
2827 @example
2828 (specifications->manifest
2829 '("emacs" "guile@@2.2" "guile@@2.2:debug"))
2830 @end example
2831
2832 @item --roll-back
2833 @cindex rolling back
2834 @cindex undoing transactions
2835 @cindex transactions, undoing
2836 Roll back to the previous @dfn{generation} of the profile---i.e., undo
2837 the last transaction.
2838
2839 When combined with options such as @code{--install}, roll back occurs
2840 before any other actions.
2841
2842 When rolling back from the first generation that actually contains
2843 installed packages, the profile is made to point to the @dfn{zeroth
2844 generation}, which contains no files apart from its own metadata.
2845
2846 After having rolled back, installing, removing, or upgrading packages
2847 overwrites previous future generations. Thus, the history of the
2848 generations in a profile is always linear.
2849
2850 @item --switch-generation=@var{pattern}
2851 @itemx -S @var{pattern}
2852 @cindex generations
2853 Switch to a particular generation defined by @var{pattern}.
2854
2855 @var{pattern} may be either a generation number or a number prefixed
2856 with ``+'' or ``-''. The latter means: move forward/backward by a
2857 specified number of generations. For example, if you want to return to
2858 the latest generation after @code{--roll-back}, use
2859 @code{--switch-generation=+1}.
2860
2861 The difference between @code{--roll-back} and
2862 @code{--switch-generation=-1} is that @code{--switch-generation} will
2863 not make a zeroth generation, so if a specified generation does not
2864 exist, the current generation will not be changed.
2865
2866 @item --search-paths[=@var{kind}]
2867 @cindex search paths
2868 Report environment variable definitions, in Bash syntax, that may be
2869 needed in order to use the set of installed packages. These environment
2870 variables are used to specify @dfn{search paths} for files used by some
2871 of the installed packages.
2872
2873 For example, GCC needs the @code{CPATH} and @code{LIBRARY_PATH}
2874 environment variables to be defined so it can look for headers and
2875 libraries in the user's profile (@pxref{Environment Variables,,, gcc,
2876 Using the GNU Compiler Collection (GCC)}). If GCC and, say, the C
2877 library are installed in the profile, then @code{--search-paths} will
2878 suggest setting these variables to @code{@var{profile}/include} and
2879 @code{@var{profile}/lib}, respectively.
2880
2881 The typical use case is to define these environment variables in the
2882 shell:
2883
2884 @example
2885 $ eval `guix package --search-paths`
2886 @end example
2887
2888 @var{kind} may be one of @code{exact}, @code{prefix}, or @code{suffix},
2889 meaning that the returned environment variable definitions will either
2890 be exact settings, or prefixes or suffixes of the current value of these
2891 variables. When omitted, @var{kind} defaults to @code{exact}.
2892
2893 This option can also be used to compute the @emph{combined} search paths
2894 of several profiles. Consider this example:
2895
2896 @example
2897 $ guix package -p foo -i guile
2898 $ guix package -p bar -i guile-json
2899 $ guix package -p foo -p bar --search-paths
2900 @end example
2901
2902 The last command above reports about the @code{GUILE_LOAD_PATH}
2903 variable, even though, taken individually, neither @file{foo} nor
2904 @file{bar} would lead to that recommendation.
2905
2906
2907 @item --profile=@var{profile}
2908 @itemx -p @var{profile}
2909 Use @var{profile} instead of the user's default profile.
2910
2911 @cindex collisions, in a profile
2912 @cindex colliding packages in profiles
2913 @cindex profile collisions
2914 @item --allow-collisions
2915 Allow colliding packages in the new profile. Use at your own risk!
2916
2917 By default, @command{guix package} reports as an error @dfn{collisions}
2918 in the profile. Collisions happen when two or more different versions
2919 or variants of a given package end up in the profile.
2920
2921 @item --bootstrap
2922 Use the bootstrap Guile to build the profile. This option is only
2923 useful to distribution developers.
2924
2925 @end table
2926
2927 In addition to these actions, @command{guix package} supports the
2928 following options to query the current state of a profile, or the
2929 availability of packages:
2930
2931 @table @option
2932
2933 @item --search=@var{regexp}
2934 @itemx -s @var{regexp}
2935 @cindex searching for packages
2936 List the available packages whose name, synopsis, or description matches
2937 @var{regexp} (in a case-insensitive fashion), sorted by relevance.
2938 Print all the metadata of matching packages in
2939 @code{recutils} format (@pxref{Top, GNU recutils databases,, recutils,
2940 GNU recutils manual}).
2941
2942 This allows specific fields to be extracted using the @command{recsel}
2943 command, for instance:
2944
2945 @example
2946 $ guix package -s malloc | recsel -p name,version,relevance
2947 name: jemalloc
2948 version: 4.5.0
2949 relevance: 6
2950
2951 name: glibc
2952 version: 2.25
2953 relevance: 1
2954
2955 name: libgc
2956 version: 7.6.0
2957 relevance: 1
2958 @end example
2959
2960 Similarly, to show the name of all the packages available under the
2961 terms of the GNU@tie{}LGPL version 3:
2962
2963 @example
2964 $ guix package -s "" | recsel -p name -e 'license ~ "LGPL 3"'
2965 name: elfutils
2966
2967 name: gmp
2968 @dots{}
2969 @end example
2970
2971 It is also possible to refine search results using several @code{-s} flags to
2972 @command{guix package}, or several arguments to @command{guix search}. For
2973 example, the following command returns a list of board games (this time using
2974 the @command{guix search} alias):
2975
2976 @example
2977 $ guix search '\<board\>' game | recsel -p name
2978 name: gnubg
2979 @dots{}
2980 @end example
2981
2982 If we were to omit @code{-s game}, we would also get software packages
2983 that deal with printed circuit boards; removing the angle brackets
2984 around @code{board} would further add packages that have to do with
2985 keyboards.
2986
2987 And now for a more elaborate example. The following command searches
2988 for cryptographic libraries, filters out Haskell, Perl, Python, and Ruby
2989 libraries, and prints the name and synopsis of the matching packages:
2990
2991 @example
2992 $ guix search crypto library | \
2993 recsel -e '! (name ~ "^(ghc|perl|python|ruby)")' -p name,synopsis
2994 @end example
2995
2996 @noindent
2997 @xref{Selection Expressions,,, recutils, GNU recutils manual}, for more
2998 information on @dfn{selection expressions} for @code{recsel -e}.
2999
3000 @item --show=@var{package}
3001 Show details about @var{package}, taken from the list of available packages, in
3002 @code{recutils} format (@pxref{Top, GNU recutils databases,, recutils, GNU
3003 recutils manual}).
3004
3005 @example
3006 $ guix package --show=python | recsel -p name,version
3007 name: python
3008 version: 2.7.6
3009
3010 name: python
3011 version: 3.3.5
3012 @end example
3013
3014 You may also specify the full name of a package to only get details about a
3015 specific version of it:
3016 @example
3017 $ guix package --show=python@@3.4 | recsel -p name,version
3018 name: python
3019 version: 3.4.3
3020 @end example
3021
3022
3023
3024 @item --list-installed[=@var{regexp}]
3025 @itemx -I [@var{regexp}]
3026 List the currently installed packages in the specified profile, with the
3027 most recently installed packages shown last. When @var{regexp} is
3028 specified, list only installed packages whose name matches @var{regexp}.
3029
3030 For each installed package, print the following items, separated by
3031 tabs: the package name, its version string, the part of the package that
3032 is installed (for instance, @code{out} for the default output,
3033 @code{include} for its headers, etc.), and the path of this package in
3034 the store.
3035
3036 @item --list-available[=@var{regexp}]
3037 @itemx -A [@var{regexp}]
3038 List packages currently available in the distribution for this system
3039 (@pxref{GNU Distribution}). When @var{regexp} is specified, list only
3040 installed packages whose name matches @var{regexp}.
3041
3042 For each package, print the following items separated by tabs: its name,
3043 its version string, the parts of the package (@pxref{Packages with
3044 Multiple Outputs}), and the source location of its definition.
3045
3046 @item --list-generations[=@var{pattern}]
3047 @itemx -l [@var{pattern}]
3048 @cindex generations
3049 Return a list of generations along with their creation dates; for each
3050 generation, show the installed packages, with the most recently
3051 installed packages shown last. Note that the zeroth generation is never
3052 shown.
3053
3054 For each installed package, print the following items, separated by
3055 tabs: the name of a package, its version string, the part of the package
3056 that is installed (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}), and the
3057 location of this package in the store.
3058
3059 When @var{pattern} is used, the command returns only matching
3060 generations. Valid patterns include:
3061
3062 @itemize
3063 @item @emph{Integers and comma-separated integers}. Both patterns denote
3064 generation numbers. For instance, @code{--list-generations=1} returns
3065 the first one.
3066
3067 And @code{--list-generations=1,8,2} outputs three generations in the
3068 specified order. Neither spaces nor trailing commas are allowed.
3069
3070 @item @emph{Ranges}. @code{--list-generations=2..9} prints the
3071 specified generations and everything in between. Note that the start of
3072 a range must be smaller than its end.
3073
3074 It is also possible to omit the endpoint. For example,
3075 @code{--list-generations=2..}, returns all generations starting from the
3076 second one.
3077
3078 @item @emph{Durations}. You can also get the last @emph{N}@tie{}days, weeks,
3079 or months by passing an integer along with the first letter of the
3080 duration. For example, @code{--list-generations=20d} lists generations
3081 that are up to 20 days old.
3082 @end itemize
3083
3084 @item --delete-generations[=@var{pattern}]
3085 @itemx -d [@var{pattern}]
3086 When @var{pattern} is omitted, delete all generations except the current
3087 one.
3088
3089 This command accepts the same patterns as @option{--list-generations}.
3090 When @var{pattern} is specified, delete the matching generations. When
3091 @var{pattern} specifies a duration, generations @emph{older} than the
3092 specified duration match. For instance, @code{--delete-generations=1m}
3093 deletes generations that are more than one month old.
3094
3095 If the current generation matches, it is @emph{not} deleted. Also, the
3096 zeroth generation is never deleted.
3097
3098 Note that deleting generations prevents rolling back to them.
3099 Consequently, this command must be used with care.
3100
3101 @end table
3102
3103 Finally, since @command{guix package} may actually start build
3104 processes, it supports all the common build options (@pxref{Common Build
3105 Options}). It also supports package transformation options, such as
3106 @option{--with-source} (@pxref{Package Transformation Options}).
3107 However, note that package transformations are lost when upgrading; to
3108 preserve transformations across upgrades, you should define your own
3109 package variant in a Guile module and add it to @code{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH}
3110 (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
3111
3112 @node Substitutes
3113 @section Substitutes
3114
3115 @cindex substitutes
3116 @cindex pre-built binaries
3117 Guix supports transparent source/binary deployment, which means that it
3118 can either build things locally, or download pre-built items from a
3119 server, or both. We call these pre-built items @dfn{substitutes}---they
3120 are substitutes for local build results. In many cases, downloading a
3121 substitute is much faster than building things locally.
3122
3123 Substitutes can be anything resulting from a derivation build
3124 (@pxref{Derivations}). Of course, in the common case, they are
3125 pre-built package binaries, but source tarballs, for instance, which
3126 also result from derivation builds, can be available as substitutes.
3127
3128 @menu
3129 * Official Substitute Server:: One particular source of substitutes.
3130 * Substitute Server Authorization:: How to enable or disable substitutes.
3131 * Substitute Authentication:: How Guix verifies substitutes.
3132 * Proxy Settings:: How to get substitutes via proxy.
3133 * Substitution Failure:: What happens when substitution fails.
3134 * On Trusting Binaries:: How can you trust that binary blob?
3135 @end menu
3136
3137 @node Official Substitute Server
3138 @subsection Official Substitute Server
3139
3140 @cindex build farm
3141 The @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} server is a front-end to an official build farm
3142 that builds packages from Guix continuously for some
3143 architectures, and makes them available as substitutes. This is the
3144 default source of substitutes; it can be overridden by passing the
3145 @option{--substitute-urls} option either to @command{guix-daemon}
3146 (@pxref{daemon-substitute-urls,, @code{guix-daemon --substitute-urls}})
3147 or to client tools such as @command{guix package}
3148 (@pxref{client-substitute-urls,, client @option{--substitute-urls}
3149 option}).
3150
3151 Substitute URLs can be either HTTP or HTTPS.
3152 HTTPS is recommended because communications are encrypted; conversely,
3153 using HTTP makes all communications visible to an eavesdropper, who
3154 could use the information gathered to determine, for instance, whether
3155 your system has unpatched security vulnerabilities.
3156
3157 Substitutes from the official build farm are enabled by default when
3158 using Guix System (@pxref{GNU Distribution}). However,
3159 they are disabled by default when using Guix on a foreign distribution,
3160 unless you have explicitly enabled them via one of the recommended
3161 installation steps (@pxref{Installation}). The following paragraphs
3162 describe how to enable or disable substitutes for the official build
3163 farm; the same procedure can also be used to enable substitutes for any
3164 other substitute server.
3165
3166 @node Substitute Server Authorization
3167 @subsection Substitute Server Authorization
3168
3169 @cindex security
3170 @cindex substitutes, authorization thereof
3171 @cindex access control list (ACL), for substitutes
3172 @cindex ACL (access control list), for substitutes
3173 To allow Guix to download substitutes from @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} or a
3174 mirror thereof, you
3175 must add its public key to the access control list (ACL) of archive
3176 imports, using the @command{guix archive} command (@pxref{Invoking guix
3177 archive}). Doing so implies that you trust @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} to not
3178 be compromised and to serve genuine substitutes.
3179
3180 The public key for @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} is installed along with Guix, in
3181 @code{@var{prefix}/share/guix/@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}.pub}, where @var{prefix} is
3182 the installation prefix of Guix. If you installed Guix from source,
3183 make sure you checked the GPG signature of
3184 @file{guix-@value{VERSION}.tar.gz}, which contains this public key file.
3185 Then, you can run something like this:
3186
3187 @example
3188 # guix archive --authorize < @var{prefix}/share/guix/@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}.pub
3189 @end example
3190
3191 Once this is in place, the output of a command like @code{guix build}
3192 should change from something like:
3193
3194 @example
3195 $ guix build emacs --dry-run
3196 The following derivations would be built:
3197 /gnu/store/yr7bnx8xwcayd6j95r2clmkdl1qh688w-emacs-24.3.drv
3198 /gnu/store/x8qsh1hlhgjx6cwsjyvybnfv2i37z23w-dbus-1.6.4.tar.gz.drv
3199 /gnu/store/1ixwp12fl950d15h2cj11c73733jay0z-alsa-lib-1.0.27.1.tar.bz2.drv
3200 /gnu/store/nlma1pw0p603fpfiqy7kn4zm105r5dmw-util-linux-2.21.drv
3201 @dots{}
3202 @end example
3203
3204 @noindent
3205 to something like:
3206
3207 @example
3208 $ guix build emacs --dry-run
3209 112.3 MB would be downloaded:
3210 /gnu/store/pk3n22lbq6ydamyymqkkz7i69wiwjiwi-emacs-24.3
3211 /gnu/store/2ygn4ncnhrpr61rssa6z0d9x22si0va3-libjpeg-8d
3212 /gnu/store/71yz6lgx4dazma9dwn2mcjxaah9w77jq-cairo-1.12.16
3213 /gnu/store/7zdhgp0n1518lvfn8mb96sxqfmvqrl7v-libxrender-0.9.7
3214 @dots{}
3215 @end example
3216
3217 @noindent
3218 This indicates that substitutes from @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} are usable and
3219 will be downloaded, when possible, for future builds.
3220
3221 @cindex substitutes, how to disable
3222 The substitute mechanism can be disabled globally by running
3223 @code{guix-daemon} with @code{--no-substitutes} (@pxref{Invoking
3224 guix-daemon}). It can also be disabled temporarily by passing the
3225 @code{--no-substitutes} option to @command{guix package}, @command{guix
3226 build}, and other command-line tools.
3227
3228 @node Substitute Authentication
3229 @subsection Substitute Authentication
3230
3231 @cindex digital signatures
3232 Guix detects and raises an error when attempting to use a substitute
3233 that has been tampered with. Likewise, it ignores substitutes that are
3234 not signed, or that are not signed by one of the keys listed in the ACL.
3235
3236 There is one exception though: if an unauthorized server provides
3237 substitutes that are @emph{bit-for-bit identical} to those provided by
3238 an authorized server, then the unauthorized server becomes eligible for
3239 downloads. For example, assume we have chosen two substitute servers
3240 with this option:
3241
3242 @example
3243 --substitute-urls="https://a.example.org https://b.example.org"
3244 @end example
3245
3246 @noindent
3247 @cindex reproducible builds
3248 If the ACL contains only the key for @code{b.example.org}, and if
3249 @code{a.example.org} happens to serve the @emph{exact same} substitutes,
3250 then Guix will download substitutes from @code{a.example.org} because it
3251 comes first in the list and can be considered a mirror of
3252 @code{b.example.org}. In practice, independent build machines usually
3253 produce the same binaries, thanks to bit-reproducible builds (see
3254 below).
3255
3256 When using HTTPS, the server's X.509 certificate is @emph{not} validated
3257 (in other words, the server is not authenticated), contrary to what
3258 HTTPS clients such as Web browsers usually do. This is because Guix
3259 authenticates substitute information itself, as explained above, which
3260 is what we care about (whereas X.509 certificates are about
3261 authenticating bindings between domain names and public keys.)
3262
3263 @node Proxy Settings
3264 @subsection Proxy Settings
3265
3266 @vindex http_proxy
3267 Substitutes are downloaded over HTTP or HTTPS.
3268 The @code{http_proxy} environment
3269 variable can be set in the environment of @command{guix-daemon} and is
3270 honored for downloads of substitutes. Note that the value of
3271 @code{http_proxy} in the environment where @command{guix build},
3272 @command{guix package}, and other client commands are run has
3273 @emph{absolutely no effect}.
3274
3275 @node Substitution Failure
3276 @subsection Substitution Failure
3277
3278 Even when a substitute for a derivation is available, sometimes the
3279 substitution attempt will fail. This can happen for a variety of
3280 reasons: the substitute server might be offline, the substitute may
3281 recently have been deleted, the connection might have been interrupted,
3282 etc.
3283
3284 When substitutes are enabled and a substitute for a derivation is
3285 available, but the substitution attempt fails, Guix will attempt to
3286 build the derivation locally depending on whether or not
3287 @code{--fallback} was given (@pxref{fallback-option,, common build
3288 option @code{--fallback}}). Specifically, if @code{--fallback} was
3289 omitted, then no local build will be performed, and the derivation is
3290 considered to have failed. However, if @code{--fallback} was given,
3291 then Guix will attempt to build the derivation locally, and the success
3292 or failure of the derivation depends on the success or failure of the
3293 local build. Note that when substitutes are disabled or no substitute
3294 is available for the derivation in question, a local build will
3295 @emph{always} be performed, regardless of whether or not
3296 @code{--fallback} was given.
3297
3298 To get an idea of how many substitutes are available right now, you can
3299 try running the @command{guix weather} command (@pxref{Invoking guix
3300 weather}). This command provides statistics on the substitutes provided
3301 by a server.
3302
3303 @node On Trusting Binaries
3304 @subsection On Trusting Binaries
3305
3306 @cindex trust, of pre-built binaries
3307 Today, each individual's control over their own computing is at the
3308 mercy of institutions, corporations, and groups with enough power and
3309 determination to subvert the computing infrastructure and exploit its
3310 weaknesses. While using @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} substitutes can be
3311 convenient, we encourage users to also build on their own, or even run
3312 their own build farm, such that @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} is less of an
3313 interesting target. One way to help is by publishing the software you
3314 build using @command{guix publish} so that others have one more choice
3315 of server to download substitutes from (@pxref{Invoking guix publish}).
3316
3317 Guix has the foundations to maximize build reproducibility
3318 (@pxref{Features}). In most cases, independent builds of a given
3319 package or derivation should yield bit-identical results. Thus, through
3320 a diverse set of independent package builds, we can strengthen the
3321 integrity of our systems. The @command{guix challenge} command aims to
3322 help users assess substitute servers, and to assist developers in
3323 finding out about non-deterministic package builds (@pxref{Invoking guix
3324 challenge}). Similarly, the @option{--check} option of @command{guix
3325 build} allows users to check whether previously-installed substitutes
3326 are genuine by rebuilding them locally (@pxref{build-check,
3327 @command{guix build --check}}).
3328
3329 In the future, we want Guix to have support to publish and retrieve
3330 binaries to/from other users, in a peer-to-peer fashion. If you would
3331 like to discuss this project, join us on @email{guix-devel@@gnu.org}.
3332
3333 @node Packages with Multiple Outputs
3334 @section Packages with Multiple Outputs
3335
3336 @cindex multiple-output packages
3337 @cindex package outputs
3338 @cindex outputs
3339
3340 Often, packages defined in Guix have a single @dfn{output}---i.e., the
3341 source package leads to exactly one directory in the store. When running
3342 @command{guix install glibc}, one installs the default output of the
3343 GNU libc package; the default output is called @code{out}, but its name
3344 can be omitted as shown in this command. In this particular case, the
3345 default output of @code{glibc} contains all the C header files, shared
3346 libraries, static libraries, Info documentation, and other supporting
3347 files.
3348
3349 Sometimes it is more appropriate to separate the various types of files
3350 produced from a single source package into separate outputs. For
3351 instance, the GLib C library (used by GTK+ and related packages)
3352 installs more than 20 MiB of reference documentation as HTML pages.
3353 To save space for users who do not need it, the documentation goes to a
3354 separate output, called @code{doc}. To install the main GLib output,
3355 which contains everything but the documentation, one would run:
3356
3357 @example
3358 guix install glib
3359 @end example
3360
3361 @cindex documentation
3362 The command to install its documentation is:
3363
3364 @example
3365 guix install glib:doc
3366 @end example
3367
3368 Some packages install programs with different ``dependency footprints''.
3369 For instance, the WordNet package installs both command-line tools and
3370 graphical user interfaces (GUIs). The former depend solely on the C
3371 library, whereas the latter depend on Tcl/Tk and the underlying X
3372 libraries. In this case, we leave the command-line tools in the default
3373 output, whereas the GUIs are in a separate output. This allows users
3374 who do not need the GUIs to save space. The @command{guix size} command
3375 can help find out about such situations (@pxref{Invoking guix size}).
3376 @command{guix graph} can also be helpful (@pxref{Invoking guix graph}).
3377
3378 There are several such multiple-output packages in the GNU distribution.
3379 Other conventional output names include @code{lib} for libraries and
3380 possibly header files, @code{bin} for stand-alone programs, and
3381 @code{debug} for debugging information (@pxref{Installing Debugging
3382 Files}). The outputs of a packages are listed in the third column of
3383 the output of @command{guix package --list-available} (@pxref{Invoking
3384 guix package}).
3385
3386
3387 @node Invoking guix gc
3388 @section Invoking @command{guix gc}
3389
3390 @cindex garbage collector
3391 @cindex disk space
3392 Packages that are installed, but not used, may be @dfn{garbage-collected}.
3393 The @command{guix gc} command allows users to explicitly run the garbage
3394 collector to reclaim space from the @file{/gnu/store} directory. It is
3395 the @emph{only} way to remove files from @file{/gnu/store}---removing
3396 files or directories manually may break it beyond repair!
3397
3398 @cindex GC roots
3399 @cindex garbage collector roots
3400 The garbage collector has a set of known @dfn{roots}: any file under
3401 @file{/gnu/store} reachable from a root is considered @dfn{live} and
3402 cannot be deleted; any other file is considered @dfn{dead} and may be
3403 deleted. The set of garbage collector roots (``GC roots'' for short)
3404 includes default user profiles; by default, the symlinks under
3405 @file{/var/guix/gcroots} represent these GC roots. New GC roots can be
3406 added with @command{guix build --root}, for example (@pxref{Invoking
3407 guix build}). The @command{guix gc --list-roots} command lists them.
3408
3409 Prior to running @code{guix gc --collect-garbage} to make space, it is
3410 often useful to remove old generations from user profiles; that way, old
3411 package builds referenced by those generations can be reclaimed. This
3412 is achieved by running @code{guix package --delete-generations}
3413 (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
3414
3415 Our recommendation is to run a garbage collection periodically, or when
3416 you are short on disk space. For instance, to guarantee that at least
3417 5@tie{}GB are available on your disk, simply run:
3418
3419 @example
3420 guix gc -F 5G
3421 @end example
3422
3423 It is perfectly safe to run as a non-interactive periodic job
3424 (@pxref{Scheduled Job Execution}, for how to set up such a job).
3425 Running @command{guix gc} with no arguments will collect as
3426 much garbage as it can, but that is often inconvenient: you may find
3427 yourself having to rebuild or re-download software that is ``dead'' from
3428 the GC viewpoint but that is necessary to build other pieces of
3429 software---e.g., the compiler tool chain.
3430
3431 The @command{guix gc} command has three modes of operation: it can be
3432 used to garbage-collect any dead files (the default), to delete specific
3433 files (the @code{--delete} option), to print garbage-collector
3434 information, or for more advanced queries. The garbage collection
3435 options are as follows:
3436
3437 @table @code
3438 @item --collect-garbage[=@var{min}]
3439 @itemx -C [@var{min}]
3440 Collect garbage---i.e., unreachable @file{/gnu/store} files and
3441 sub-directories. This is the default operation when no option is
3442 specified.
3443
3444 When @var{min} is given, stop once @var{min} bytes have been collected.
3445 @var{min} may be a number of bytes, or it may include a unit as a
3446 suffix, such as @code{MiB} for mebibytes and @code{GB} for gigabytes
3447 (@pxref{Block size, size specifications,, coreutils, GNU Coreutils}).
3448
3449 When @var{min} is omitted, collect all the garbage.
3450
3451 @item --free-space=@var{free}
3452 @itemx -F @var{free}
3453 Collect garbage until @var{free} space is available under
3454 @file{/gnu/store}, if possible; @var{free} denotes storage space, such
3455 as @code{500MiB}, as described above.
3456
3457 When @var{free} or more is already available in @file{/gnu/store}, do
3458 nothing and exit immediately.
3459
3460 @item --delete-generations[=@var{duration}]
3461 @itemx -d [@var{duration}]
3462 Before starting the garbage collection process, delete all the generations
3463 older than @var{duration}, for all the user profiles; when run as root, this
3464 applies to all the profiles @emph{of all the users}.
3465
3466 For example, this command deletes all the generations of all your profiles
3467 that are older than 2 months (except generations that are current), and then
3468 proceeds to free space until at least 10 GiB are available:
3469
3470 @example
3471 guix gc -d 2m -F 10G
3472 @end example
3473
3474 @item --delete
3475 @itemx -D
3476 Attempt to delete all the store files and directories specified as
3477 arguments. This fails if some of the files are not in the store, or if
3478 they are still live.
3479
3480 @item --list-failures
3481 List store items corresponding to cached build failures.
3482
3483 This prints nothing unless the daemon was started with
3484 @option{--cache-failures} (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon,
3485 @option{--cache-failures}}).
3486
3487 @item --list-roots
3488 List the GC roots owned by the user; when run as root, list @emph{all} the GC
3489 roots.
3490
3491 @item --clear-failures
3492 Remove the specified store items from the failed-build cache.
3493
3494 Again, this option only makes sense when the daemon is started with
3495 @option{--cache-failures}. Otherwise, it does nothing.
3496
3497 @item --list-dead
3498 Show the list of dead files and directories still present in the
3499 store---i.e., files and directories no longer reachable from any root.
3500
3501 @item --list-live
3502 Show the list of live store files and directories.
3503
3504 @end table
3505
3506 In addition, the references among existing store files can be queried:
3507
3508 @table @code
3509
3510 @item --references
3511 @itemx --referrers
3512 @cindex package dependencies
3513 List the references (respectively, the referrers) of store files given
3514 as arguments.
3515
3516 @item --requisites
3517 @itemx -R
3518 @cindex closure
3519 List the requisites of the store files passed as arguments. Requisites
3520 include the store files themselves, their references, and the references
3521 of these, recursively. In other words, the returned list is the
3522 @dfn{transitive closure} of the store files.
3523
3524 @xref{Invoking guix size}, for a tool to profile the size of the closure
3525 of an element. @xref{Invoking guix graph}, for a tool to visualize
3526 the graph of references.
3527
3528 @item --derivers
3529 @cindex derivation
3530 Return the derivation(s) leading to the given store items
3531 (@pxref{Derivations}).
3532
3533 For example, this command:
3534
3535 @example
3536 guix gc --derivers `guix package -I ^emacs$ | cut -f4`
3537 @end example
3538
3539 @noindent
3540 returns the @file{.drv} file(s) leading to the @code{emacs} package
3541 installed in your profile.
3542
3543 Note that there may be zero matching @file{.drv} files, for instance
3544 because these files have been garbage-collected. There can also be more
3545 than one matching @file{.drv} due to fixed-output derivations.
3546 @end table
3547
3548 Lastly, the following options allow you to check the integrity of the
3549 store and to control disk usage.
3550
3551 @table @option
3552
3553 @item --verify[=@var{options}]
3554 @cindex integrity, of the store
3555 @cindex integrity checking
3556 Verify the integrity of the store.
3557
3558 By default, make sure that all the store items marked as valid in the
3559 database of the daemon actually exist in @file{/gnu/store}.
3560
3561 When provided, @var{options} must be a comma-separated list containing one
3562 or more of @code{contents} and @code{repair}.
3563
3564 When passing @option{--verify=contents}, the daemon computes the
3565 content hash of each store item and compares it against its hash in the
3566 database. Hash mismatches are reported as data corruptions. Because it
3567 traverses @emph{all the files in the store}, this command can take a
3568 long time, especially on systems with a slow disk drive.
3569
3570 @cindex repairing the store
3571 @cindex corruption, recovering from
3572 Using @option{--verify=repair} or @option{--verify=contents,repair}
3573 causes the daemon to try to repair corrupt store items by fetching
3574 substitutes for them (@pxref{Substitutes}). Because repairing is not
3575 atomic, and thus potentially dangerous, it is available only to the
3576 system administrator. A lightweight alternative, when you know exactly
3577 which items in the store are corrupt, is @command{guix build --repair}
3578 (@pxref{Invoking guix build}).
3579
3580 @item --optimize
3581 @cindex deduplication
3582 Optimize the store by hard-linking identical files---this is
3583 @dfn{deduplication}.
3584
3585 The daemon performs deduplication after each successful build or archive
3586 import, unless it was started with @code{--disable-deduplication}
3587 (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon, @code{--disable-deduplication}}). Thus,
3588 this option is primarily useful when the daemon was running with
3589 @code{--disable-deduplication}.
3590
3591 @end table
3592
3593 @node Invoking guix pull
3594 @section Invoking @command{guix pull}
3595
3596 @cindex upgrading Guix
3597 @cindex updating Guix
3598 @cindex @command{guix pull}
3599 @cindex pull
3600 Packages are installed or upgraded to the latest version available in
3601 the distribution currently available on your local machine. To update
3602 that distribution, along with the Guix tools, you must run @command{guix
3603 pull}: the command downloads the latest Guix source code and package
3604 descriptions, and deploys it. Source code is downloaded from a
3605 @uref{https://git-scm.com, Git} repository, by default the official
3606 GNU@tie{}Guix repository, though this can be customized.
3607
3608 On completion, @command{guix package} will use packages and package
3609 versions from this just-retrieved copy of Guix. Not only that, but all
3610 the Guix commands and Scheme modules will also be taken from that latest
3611 version. New @command{guix} sub-commands added by the update also
3612 become available.
3613
3614 Any user can update their Guix copy using @command{guix pull}, and the
3615 effect is limited to the user who run @command{guix pull}. For
3616 instance, when user @code{root} runs @command{guix pull}, this has no
3617 effect on the version of Guix that user @code{alice} sees, and vice
3618 versa.
3619
3620 The result of running @command{guix pull} is a @dfn{profile} available
3621 under @file{~/.config/guix/current} containing the latest Guix. Thus,
3622 make sure to add it to the beginning of your search path so that you use
3623 the latest version, and similarly for the Info manual
3624 (@pxref{Documentation}):
3625
3626 @example
3627 export PATH="$HOME/.config/guix/current/bin:$PATH"
3628 export INFOPATH="$HOME/.config/guix/current/share/info:$INFOPATH"
3629 @end example
3630
3631 The @code{--list-generations} or @code{-l} option lists past generations
3632 produced by @command{guix pull}, along with details about their provenance:
3633
3634 @example
3635 $ guix pull -l
3636 Generation 1 Jun 10 2018 00:18:18
3637 guix 65956ad
3638 repository URL: https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git
3639 branch: origin/master
3640 commit: 65956ad3526ba09e1f7a40722c96c6ef7c0936fe
3641
3642 Generation 2 Jun 11 2018 11:02:49
3643 guix e0cc7f6
3644 repository URL: https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git
3645 branch: origin/master
3646 commit: e0cc7f669bec22c37481dd03a7941c7d11a64f1d
3647 2 new packages: keepalived, libnfnetlink
3648 6 packages upgraded: emacs-nix-mode@@2.0.4,
3649 guile2.0-guix@@0.14.0-12.77a1aac, guix@@0.14.0-12.77a1aac,
3650 heimdal@@7.5.0, milkytracker@@1.02.00, nix@@2.0.4
3651
3652 Generation 3 Jun 13 2018 23:31:07 (current)
3653 guix 844cc1c
3654 repository URL: https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git
3655 branch: origin/master
3656 commit: 844cc1c8f394f03b404c5bb3aee086922373490c
3657 28 new packages: emacs-helm-ls-git, emacs-helm-mu, @dots{}
3658 69 packages upgraded: borg@@1.1.6, cheese@@3.28.0, @dots{}
3659 @end example
3660
3661 @xref{Invoking guix describe, @command{guix describe}}, for other ways to
3662 describe the current status of Guix.
3663
3664 This @code{~/.config/guix/current} profile works like any other profile
3665 created by @command{guix package} (@pxref{Invoking guix package}). That
3666 is, you can list generations, roll back to the previous
3667 generation---i.e., the previous Guix---and so on:
3668
3669 @example
3670 $ guix package -p ~/.config/guix/current --roll-back
3671 switched from generation 3 to 2
3672 $ guix package -p ~/.config/guix/current --delete-generations=1
3673 deleting /var/guix/profiles/per-user/charlie/current-guix-1-link
3674 @end example
3675
3676 The @command{guix pull} command is usually invoked with no arguments,
3677 but it supports the following options:
3678
3679 @table @code
3680 @item --url=@var{url}
3681 @itemx --commit=@var{commit}
3682 @itemx --branch=@var{branch}
3683 Download code for the @code{guix} channel from the specified @var{url}, at the
3684 given @var{commit} (a valid Git commit ID represented as a hexadecimal
3685 string), or @var{branch}.
3686
3687 @cindex @file{channels.scm}, configuration file
3688 @cindex configuration file for channels
3689 These options are provided for convenience, but you can also specify your
3690 configuration in the @file{~/.config/guix/channels.scm} file or using the
3691 @option{--channels} option (see below).
3692
3693 @item --channels=@var{file}
3694 @itemx -C @var{file}
3695 Read the list of channels from @var{file} instead of
3696 @file{~/.config/guix/channels.scm}. @var{file} must contain Scheme code that
3697 evaluates to a list of channel objects. @xref{Channels}, for more
3698 information.
3699
3700 @item --news
3701 @itemx -N
3702 Display the list of packages added or upgraded since the previous generation.
3703
3704 This is the same information as displayed upon @command{guix pull} completion,
3705 but without ellipses; it is also similar to the output of @command{guix pull
3706 -l} for the last generation (see below).
3707
3708 @item --list-generations[=@var{pattern}]
3709 @itemx -l [@var{pattern}]
3710 List all the generations of @file{~/.config/guix/current} or, if @var{pattern}
3711 is provided, the subset of generations that match @var{pattern}.
3712 The syntax of @var{pattern} is the same as with @code{guix package
3713 --list-generations} (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
3714
3715 @xref{Invoking guix describe}, for a way to display information about the
3716 current generation only.
3717
3718 @item --profile=@var{profile}
3719 @itemx -p @var{profile}
3720 Use @var{profile} instead of @file{~/.config/guix/current}.
3721
3722 @item --dry-run
3723 @itemx -n
3724 Show which channel commit(s) would be used and what would be built or
3725 substituted but do not actually do it.
3726
3727 @item --system=@var{system}
3728 @itemx -s @var{system}
3729 Attempt to build for @var{system}---e.g., @code{i686-linux}---instead of
3730 the system type of the build host.
3731
3732 @item --verbose
3733 Produce verbose output, writing build logs to the standard error output.
3734
3735 @item --bootstrap
3736 Use the bootstrap Guile to build the latest Guix. This option is only
3737 useful to Guix developers.
3738 @end table
3739
3740 The @dfn{channel} mechanism allows you to instruct @command{guix pull} which
3741 repository and branch to pull from, as well as @emph{additional} repositories
3742 containing package modules that should be deployed. @xref{Channels}, for more
3743 information.
3744
3745 In addition, @command{guix pull} supports all the common build options
3746 (@pxref{Common Build Options}).
3747
3748 @node Channels
3749 @section Channels
3750
3751 @cindex channels
3752 @cindex @file{channels.scm}, configuration file
3753 @cindex configuration file for channels
3754 @cindex @command{guix pull}, configuration file
3755 @cindex configuration of @command{guix pull}
3756 Guix and its package collection are updated by running @command{guix pull}
3757 (@pxref{Invoking guix pull}). By default @command{guix pull} downloads and
3758 deploys Guix itself from the official GNU@tie{}Guix repository. This can be
3759 customized by defining @dfn{channels} in the
3760 @file{~/.config/guix/channels.scm} file. A channel specifies a URL and branch
3761 of a Git repository to be deployed, and @command{guix pull} can be instructed
3762 to pull from one or more channels. In other words, channels can be used to
3763 @emph{customize} and to @emph{extend} Guix, as we will see below.
3764
3765 @subsection Using a Custom Guix Channel
3766
3767 The channel called @code{guix} specifies where Guix itself---its command-line
3768 tools as well as its package collection---should be downloaded. For instance,
3769 suppose you want to update from your own copy of the Guix repository at
3770 @code{example.org}, and specifically the @code{super-hacks} branch, you can
3771 write in @code{~/.config/guix/channels.scm} this specification:
3772
3773 @lisp
3774 ;; Tell 'guix pull' to use my own repo.
3775 (list (channel
3776 (name 'guix)
3777 (url "https://example.org/my-guix.git")
3778 (branch "super-hacks")))
3779 @end lisp
3780
3781 @noindent
3782 From there on, @command{guix pull} will fetch code from the @code{super-hacks}
3783 branch of the repository at @code{example.org}.
3784
3785 @subsection Specifying Additional Channels
3786
3787 @cindex extending the package collection (channels)
3788 @cindex personal packages (channels)
3789 @cindex channels, for personal packages
3790 You can also specify @emph{additional channels} to pull from. Let's say you
3791 have a bunch of custom package variants or personal packages that you think
3792 would make little sense to contribute to the Guix project, but would like to
3793 have these packages transparently available to you at the command line. You
3794 would first write modules containing those package definitions (@pxref{Package
3795 Modules}), maintain them in a Git repository, and then you and anyone else can
3796 use it as an additional channel to get packages from. Neat, no?
3797
3798 @c What follows stems from discussions at
3799 @c <https://debbugs.gnu.org/cgi/bugreport.cgi?bug=22629#134> as well as
3800 @c earlier discussions on guix-devel@gnu.org.
3801 @quotation Warning
3802 Before you, dear user, shout---``woow this is @emph{soooo coool}!''---and
3803 publish your personal channel to the world, we would like to share a few words
3804 of caution:
3805
3806 @itemize
3807 @item
3808 Before publishing a channel, please consider contributing your package
3809 definitions to Guix proper (@pxref{Contributing}). Guix as a project is open
3810 to free software of all sorts, and packages in Guix proper are readily
3811 available to all Guix users and benefit from the project's quality assurance
3812 process.
3813
3814 @item
3815 When you maintain package definitions outside Guix, we, Guix developers,
3816 consider that @emph{the compatibility burden is on you}. Remember that
3817 package modules and package definitions are just Scheme code that uses various
3818 programming interfaces (APIs). We want to remain free to change these APIs to
3819 keep improving Guix, possibly in ways that break your channel. We never
3820 change APIs gratuitously, but we will @emph{not} commit to freezing APIs
3821 either.
3822
3823 @item
3824 Corollary: if you're using an external channel and that channel breaks, please
3825 @emph{report the issue to the channel authors}, not to the Guix project.
3826 @end itemize
3827
3828 You've been warned! Having said this, we believe external channels are a
3829 practical way to exert your freedom to augment Guix' package collection and to
3830 share your improvements, which are basic tenets of
3831 @uref{https://www.gnu.org/philosophy/free-sw.html, free software}. Please
3832 email us at @email{guix-devel@@gnu.org} if you'd like to discuss this.
3833 @end quotation
3834
3835 To use a channel, write @code{~/.config/guix/channels.scm} to instruct
3836 @command{guix pull} to pull from it @emph{in addition} to the default Guix
3837 channel(s):
3838
3839 @vindex %default-channels
3840 @lisp
3841 ;; Add my personal packages to those Guix provides.
3842 (cons (channel
3843 (name 'my-personal-packages)
3844 (url "https://example.org/personal-packages.git"))
3845 %default-channels)
3846 @end lisp
3847
3848 @noindent
3849 Note that the snippet above is (as always!)@: Scheme code; we use @code{cons} to
3850 add a channel the list of channels that the variable @code{%default-channels}
3851 is bound to (@pxref{Pairs, @code{cons} and lists,, guile, GNU Guile Reference
3852 Manual}). With this file in place, @command{guix pull} builds not only Guix
3853 but also the package modules from your own repository. The result in
3854 @file{~/.config/guix/current} is the union of Guix with your own package
3855 modules:
3856
3857 @example
3858 $ guix pull --list-generations
3859 @dots{}
3860 Generation 19 Aug 27 2018 16:20:48
3861 guix d894ab8
3862 repository URL: https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git
3863 branch: master
3864 commit: d894ab8e9bfabcefa6c49d9ba2e834dd5a73a300
3865 my-personal-packages dd3df5e
3866 repository URL: https://example.org/personal-packages.git
3867 branch: master
3868 commit: dd3df5e2c8818760a8fc0bd699e55d3b69fef2bb
3869 11 new packages: my-gimp, my-emacs-with-cool-features, @dots{}
3870 4 packages upgraded: emacs-racket-mode@@0.0.2-2.1b78827, @dots{}
3871 @end example
3872
3873 @noindent
3874 The output of @command{guix pull} above shows that Generation@tie{}19 includes
3875 both Guix and packages from the @code{my-personal-packages} channel. Among
3876 the new and upgraded packages that are listed, some like @code{my-gimp} and
3877 @code{my-emacs-with-cool-features} might come from
3878 @code{my-personal-packages}, while others come from the Guix default channel.
3879
3880 To create a channel, create a Git repository containing your own package
3881 modules and make it available. The repository can contain anything, but a
3882 useful channel will contain Guile modules that export packages. Once you
3883 start using a channel, Guix will behave as if the root directory of that
3884 channel's Git repository has been added to the Guile load path (@pxref{Load
3885 Paths,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}). For example, if your channel
3886 contains a file at @file{my-packages/my-tools.scm} that defines a Guile
3887 module, then the module will be available under the name @code{(my-packages
3888 my-tools)}, and you will be able to use it like any other module
3889 (@pxref{Modules,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}).
3890
3891 @cindex dependencies, channels
3892 @cindex meta-data, channels
3893 @subsection Declaring Channel Dependencies
3894
3895 Channel authors may decide to augment a package collection provided by other
3896 channels. They can declare their channel to be dependent on other channels in
3897 a meta-data file @file{.guix-channel}, which is to be placed in the root of
3898 the channel repository.
3899
3900 The meta-data file should contain a simple S-expression like this:
3901
3902 @lisp
3903 (channel
3904 (version 0)
3905 (dependencies
3906 (channel
3907 (name some-collection)
3908 (url "https://example.org/first-collection.git"))
3909 (channel
3910 (name some-other-collection)
3911 (url "https://example.org/second-collection.git")
3912 (branch "testing"))))
3913 @end lisp
3914
3915 In the above example this channel is declared to depend on two other channels,
3916 which will both be fetched automatically. The modules provided by the channel
3917 will be compiled in an environment where the modules of all these declared
3918 channels are available.
3919
3920 For the sake of reliability and maintainability, you should avoid dependencies
3921 on channels that you don't control, and you should aim to keep the number of
3922 dependencies to a minimum.
3923
3924 @subsection Replicating Guix
3925
3926 @cindex pinning, channels
3927 @cindex replicating Guix
3928 @cindex reproducibility, of Guix
3929 The @command{guix pull --list-generations} output above shows precisely which
3930 commits were used to build this instance of Guix. We can thus replicate it,
3931 say, on another machine, by providing a channel specification in
3932 @file{~/.config/guix/channels.scm} that is ``pinned'' to these commits:
3933
3934 @lisp
3935 ;; Deploy specific commits of my channels of interest.
3936 (list (channel
3937 (name 'guix)
3938 (url "https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git")
3939 (commit "d894ab8e9bfabcefa6c49d9ba2e834dd5a73a300"))
3940 (channel
3941 (name 'my-personal-packages)
3942 (url "https://example.org/personal-packages.git")
3943 (branch "dd3df5e2c8818760a8fc0bd699e55d3b69fef2bb")))
3944 @end lisp
3945
3946 The @command{guix describe --format=channels} command can even generate this
3947 list of channels directly (@pxref{Invoking guix describe}).
3948
3949 At this point the two machines run the @emph{exact same Guix}, with access to
3950 the @emph{exact same packages}. The output of @command{guix build gimp} on
3951 one machine will be exactly the same, bit for bit, as the output of the same
3952 command on the other machine. It also means both machines have access to all
3953 the source code of Guix and, transitively, to all the source code of every
3954 package it defines.
3955
3956 This gives you super powers, allowing you to track the provenance of binary
3957 artifacts with very fine grain, and to reproduce software environments at
3958 will---some sort of ``meta reproducibility'' capabilities, if you will.
3959 @xref{Inferiors}, for another way to take advantage of these super powers.
3960
3961 @node Inferiors
3962 @section Inferiors
3963
3964 @c TODO: Remove this once we're more confident about API stability.
3965 @quotation Note
3966 The functionality described here is a ``technology preview'' as of version
3967 @value{VERSION}. As such, the interface is subject to change.
3968 @end quotation
3969
3970 @cindex inferiors
3971 @cindex composition of Guix revisions
3972 Sometimes you might need to mix packages from the revision of Guix you're
3973 currently running with packages available in a different revision of Guix.
3974 Guix @dfn{inferiors} allow you to achieve that by composing different Guix
3975 revisions in arbitrary ways.
3976
3977 @cindex inferior packages
3978 Technically, an ``inferior'' is essentially a separate Guix process connected
3979 to your main Guix process through a REPL (@pxref{Invoking guix repl}). The
3980 @code{(guix inferior)} module allows you to create inferiors and to
3981 communicate with them. It also provides a high-level interface to browse and
3982 manipulate the packages that an inferior provides---@dfn{inferior packages}.
3983
3984 When combined with channels (@pxref{Channels}), inferiors provide a simple way
3985 to interact with a separate revision of Guix. For example, let's assume you
3986 want to install in your profile the current @code{guile} package, along with
3987 the @code{guile-json} as it existed in an older revision of Guix---perhaps
3988 because the newer @code{guile-json} has an incompatible API and you want to
3989 run your code against the old API@. To do that, you could write a manifest for
3990 use by @code{guix package --manifest} (@pxref{Invoking guix package}); in that
3991 manifest, you would create an inferior for that old Guix revision you care
3992 about, and you would look up the @code{guile-json} package in the inferior:
3993
3994 @lisp
3995 (use-modules (guix inferior) (guix channels)
3996 (srfi srfi-1)) ;for 'first'
3997
3998 (define channels
3999 ;; This is the old revision from which we want to
4000 ;; extract guile-json.
4001 (list (channel
4002 (name 'guix)
4003 (url "https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git")
4004 (commit
4005 "65956ad3526ba09e1f7a40722c96c6ef7c0936fe"))))
4006
4007 (define inferior
4008 ;; An inferior representing the above revision.
4009 (inferior-for-channels channels))
4010
4011 ;; Now create a manifest with the current "guile" package
4012 ;; and the old "guile-json" package.
4013 (packages->manifest
4014 (list (first (lookup-inferior-packages inferior "guile-json"))
4015 (specification->package "guile")))
4016 @end lisp
4017
4018 On its first run, @command{guix package --manifest} might have to build the
4019 channel you specified before it can create the inferior; subsequent runs will
4020 be much faster because the Guix revision will be cached.
4021
4022 The @code{(guix inferior)} module provides the following procedures to open an
4023 inferior:
4024
4025 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} inferior-for-channels @var{channels} @
4026 [#:cache-directory] [#:ttl]
4027 Return an inferior for @var{channels}, a list of channels. Use the cache at
4028 @var{cache-directory}, where entries can be reclaimed after @var{ttl} seconds.
4029 This procedure opens a new connection to the build daemon.
4030
4031 As a side effect, this procedure may build or substitute binaries for
4032 @var{channels}, which can take time.
4033 @end deffn
4034
4035 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} open-inferior @var{directory} @
4036 [#:command "bin/guix"]
4037 Open the inferior Guix in @var{directory}, running
4038 @code{@var{directory}/@var{command} repl} or equivalent. Return @code{#f} if
4039 the inferior could not be launched.
4040 @end deffn
4041
4042 @cindex inferior packages
4043 The procedures listed below allow you to obtain and manipulate inferior
4044 packages.
4045
4046 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} inferior-packages @var{inferior}
4047 Return the list of packages known to @var{inferior}.
4048 @end deffn
4049
4050 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} lookup-inferior-packages @var{inferior} @var{name} @
4051 [@var{version}]
4052 Return the sorted list of inferior packages matching @var{name} in
4053 @var{inferior}, with highest version numbers first. If @var{version} is true,
4054 return only packages with a version number prefixed by @var{version}.
4055 @end deffn
4056
4057 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package? @var{obj}
4058 Return true if @var{obj} is an inferior package.
4059 @end deffn
4060
4061 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-name @var{package}
4062 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-version @var{package}
4063 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-synopsis @var{package}
4064 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-description @var{package}
4065 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-home-page @var{package}
4066 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-location @var{package}
4067 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-inputs @var{package}
4068 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-native-inputs @var{package}
4069 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-propagated-inputs @var{package}
4070 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-transitive-propagated-inputs @var{package}
4071 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-native-search-paths @var{package}
4072 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-transitive-native-search-paths @var{package}
4073 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-search-paths @var{package}
4074 These procedures are the counterpart of package record accessors
4075 (@pxref{package Reference}). Most of them work by querying the inferior
4076 @var{package} comes from, so the inferior must still be live when you call
4077 these procedures.
4078 @end deffn
4079
4080 Inferior packages can be used transparently like any other package or
4081 file-like object in G-expressions (@pxref{G-Expressions}). They are also
4082 transparently handled by the @code{packages->manifest} procedure, which is
4083 commonly use in manifests (@pxref{Invoking guix package, the
4084 @option{--manifest} option of @command{guix package}}). Thus you can insert
4085 an inferior package pretty much anywhere you would insert a regular package:
4086 in manifests, in the @code{packages} field of your @code{operating-system}
4087 declaration, and so on.
4088
4089 @node Invoking guix describe
4090 @section Invoking @command{guix describe}
4091
4092 @cindex reproducibility
4093 @cindex replicating Guix
4094 Often you may want to answer questions like: ``Which revision of Guix am I
4095 using?'' or ``Which channels am I using?'' This is useful information in many
4096 situations: if you want to @emph{replicate} an environment on a different
4097 machine or user account, if you want to report a bug or to determine what
4098 change in the channels you are using caused it, or if you want to record your
4099 system state for reproducibility purposes. The @command{guix describe}
4100 command answers these questions.
4101
4102 When run from a @command{guix pull}ed @command{guix}, @command{guix describe}
4103 displays the channel(s) that it was built from, including their repository URL
4104 and commit IDs (@pxref{Channels}):
4105
4106 @example
4107 $ guix describe
4108 Generation 10 Sep 03 2018 17:32:44 (current)
4109 guix e0fa68c
4110 repository URL: https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git
4111 branch: master
4112 commit: e0fa68c7718fffd33d81af415279d6ddb518f727
4113 @end example
4114
4115 If you're familiar with the Git version control system, this is similar in
4116 spirit to @command{git describe}; the output is also similar to that of
4117 @command{guix pull --list-generations}, but limited to the current generation
4118 (@pxref{Invoking guix pull, the @option{--list-generations} option}). Because
4119 the Git commit ID shown above unambiguously refers to a snapshot of Guix, this
4120 information is all it takes to describe the revision of Guix you're using, and
4121 also to replicate it.
4122
4123 To make it easier to replicate Guix, @command{guix describe} can also be asked
4124 to return a list of channels instead of the human-readable description above:
4125
4126 @example
4127 $ guix describe -f channels
4128 (list (channel
4129 (name 'guix)
4130 (url "https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git")
4131 (commit
4132 "e0fa68c7718fffd33d81af415279d6ddb518f727")))
4133 @end example
4134
4135 @noindent
4136 You can save this to a file and feed it to @command{guix pull -C} on some
4137 other machine or at a later point in time, which will instantiate @emph{this
4138 exact Guix revision} (@pxref{Invoking guix pull, the @option{-C} option}).
4139 From there on, since you're able to deploy the same revision of Guix, you can
4140 just as well @emph{replicate a complete software environment}. We humbly
4141 think that this is @emph{awesome}, and we hope you'll like it too!
4142
4143 The details of the options supported by @command{guix describe} are as
4144 follows:
4145
4146 @table @code
4147 @item --format=@var{format}
4148 @itemx -f @var{format}
4149 Produce output in the specified @var{format}, one of:
4150
4151 @table @code
4152 @item human
4153 produce human-readable output;
4154 @item channels
4155 produce a list of channel specifications that can be passed to @command{guix
4156 pull -C} or installed as @file{~/.config/guix/channels.scm} (@pxref{Invoking
4157 guix pull});
4158 @item json
4159 @cindex JSON
4160 produce a list of channel specifications in JSON format;
4161 @item recutils
4162 produce a list of channel specifications in Recutils format.
4163 @end table
4164
4165 @item --profile=@var{profile}
4166 @itemx -p @var{profile}
4167 Display information about @var{profile}.
4168 @end table
4169
4170 @node Invoking guix archive
4171 @section Invoking @command{guix archive}
4172
4173 @cindex @command{guix archive}
4174 @cindex archive
4175 The @command{guix archive} command allows users to @dfn{export} files
4176 from the store into a single archive, and to later @dfn{import} them on
4177 a machine that runs Guix.
4178 In particular, it allows store files to be transferred from one machine
4179 to the store on another machine.
4180
4181 @quotation Note
4182 If you're looking for a way to produce archives in a format suitable for
4183 tools other than Guix, @pxref{Invoking guix pack}.
4184 @end quotation
4185
4186 @cindex exporting store items
4187 To export store files as an archive to standard output, run:
4188
4189 @example
4190 guix archive --export @var{options} @var{specifications}...
4191 @end example
4192
4193 @var{specifications} may be either store file names or package
4194 specifications, as for @command{guix package} (@pxref{Invoking guix
4195 package}). For instance, the following command creates an archive
4196 containing the @code{gui} output of the @code{git} package and the main
4197 output of @code{emacs}:
4198
4199 @example
4200 guix archive --export git:gui /gnu/store/...-emacs-24.3 > great.nar
4201 @end example
4202
4203 If the specified packages are not built yet, @command{guix archive}
4204 automatically builds them. The build process may be controlled with the
4205 common build options (@pxref{Common Build Options}).
4206
4207 To transfer the @code{emacs} package to a machine connected over SSH,
4208 one would run:
4209
4210 @example
4211 guix archive --export -r emacs | ssh the-machine guix archive --import
4212 @end example
4213
4214 @noindent
4215 Similarly, a complete user profile may be transferred from one machine
4216 to another like this:
4217
4218 @example
4219 guix archive --export -r $(readlink -f ~/.guix-profile) | \
4220 ssh the-machine guix archive --import
4221 @end example
4222
4223 @noindent
4224 However, note that, in both examples, all of @code{emacs} and the
4225 profile as well as all of their dependencies are transferred (due to
4226 @code{-r}), regardless of what is already available in the store on the
4227 target machine. The @code{--missing} option can help figure out which
4228 items are missing from the target store. The @command{guix copy}
4229 command simplifies and optimizes this whole process, so this is probably
4230 what you should use in this case (@pxref{Invoking guix copy}).
4231
4232 @cindex nar, archive format
4233 @cindex normalized archive (nar)
4234 Archives are stored in the ``normalized archive'' or ``nar'' format, which is
4235 comparable in spirit to `tar', but with differences
4236 that make it more appropriate for our purposes. First, rather than
4237 recording all Unix metadata for each file, the nar format only mentions
4238 the file type (regular, directory, or symbolic link); Unix permissions
4239 and owner/group are dismissed. Second, the order in which directory
4240 entries are stored always follows the order of file names according to
4241 the C locale collation order. This makes archive production fully
4242 deterministic.
4243
4244 When exporting, the daemon digitally signs the contents of the archive,
4245 and that digital signature is appended. When importing, the daemon
4246 verifies the signature and rejects the import in case of an invalid
4247 signature or if the signing key is not authorized.
4248 @c FIXME: Add xref to daemon doc about signatures.
4249
4250 The main options are:
4251
4252 @table @code
4253 @item --export
4254 Export the specified store files or packages (see below.) Write the
4255 resulting archive to the standard output.
4256
4257 Dependencies are @emph{not} included in the output, unless
4258 @code{--recursive} is passed.
4259
4260 @item -r
4261 @itemx --recursive
4262 When combined with @code{--export}, this instructs @command{guix
4263 archive} to include dependencies of the given items in the archive.
4264 Thus, the resulting archive is self-contained: it contains the closure
4265 of the exported store items.
4266
4267 @item --import
4268 Read an archive from the standard input, and import the files listed
4269 therein into the store. Abort if the archive has an invalid digital
4270 signature, or if it is signed by a public key not among the authorized
4271 keys (see @code{--authorize} below.)
4272
4273 @item --missing
4274 Read a list of store file names from the standard input, one per line,
4275 and write on the standard output the subset of these files missing from
4276 the store.
4277
4278 @item --generate-key[=@var{parameters}]
4279 @cindex signing, archives
4280 Generate a new key pair for the daemon. This is a prerequisite before
4281 archives can be exported with @code{--export}. Note that this operation
4282 usually takes time, because it needs to gather enough entropy to
4283 generate the key pair.
4284
4285 The generated key pair is typically stored under @file{/etc/guix}, in
4286 @file{signing-key.pub} (public key) and @file{signing-key.sec} (private
4287 key, which must be kept secret.) When @var{parameters} is omitted,
4288 an ECDSA key using the Ed25519 curve is generated, or, for Libgcrypt
4289 versions before 1.6.0, it is a 4096-bit RSA key.
4290 Alternatively, @var{parameters} can specify
4291 @code{genkey} parameters suitable for Libgcrypt (@pxref{General
4292 public-key related Functions, @code{gcry_pk_genkey},, gcrypt, The
4293 Libgcrypt Reference Manual}).
4294
4295 @item --authorize
4296 @cindex authorizing, archives
4297 Authorize imports signed by the public key passed on standard input.
4298 The public key must be in ``s-expression advanced format''---i.e., the
4299 same format as the @file{signing-key.pub} file.
4300
4301 The list of authorized keys is kept in the human-editable file
4302 @file{/etc/guix/acl}. The file contains
4303 @url{https://people.csail.mit.edu/rivest/Sexp.txt, ``advanced-format
4304 s-expressions''} and is structured as an access-control list in the
4305 @url{https://theworld.com/~cme/spki.txt, Simple Public-Key Infrastructure
4306 (SPKI)}.
4307
4308 @item --extract=@var{directory}
4309 @itemx -x @var{directory}
4310 Read a single-item archive as served by substitute servers
4311 (@pxref{Substitutes}) and extract it to @var{directory}. This is a
4312 low-level operation needed in only very narrow use cases; see below.
4313
4314 For example, the following command extracts the substitute for Emacs
4315 served by @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} to @file{/tmp/emacs}:
4316
4317 @example
4318 $ wget -O - \
4319 https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}/nar/@dots{}-emacs-24.5 \
4320 | bunzip2 | guix archive -x /tmp/emacs
4321 @end example
4322
4323 Single-item archives are different from multiple-item archives produced
4324 by @command{guix archive --export}; they contain a single store item,
4325 and they do @emph{not} embed a signature. Thus this operation does
4326 @emph{no} signature verification and its output should be considered
4327 unsafe.
4328
4329 The primary purpose of this operation is to facilitate inspection of
4330 archive contents coming from possibly untrusted substitute servers.
4331
4332 @end table
4333
4334
4335 @c *********************************************************************
4336 @node Development
4337 @chapter Development
4338
4339 @cindex software development
4340 If you are a software developer, Guix provides tools that you should find
4341 helpful---independently of the language you're developing in. This is what
4342 this chapter is about.
4343
4344 The @command{guix environment} command provides a convenient way to set up
4345 @dfn{development environments} containing all the dependencies and tools
4346 necessary to work on the software package of your choice. The @command{guix
4347 pack} command allows you to create @dfn{application bundles} that can be
4348 easily distributed to users who do not run Guix.
4349
4350 @menu
4351 * Invoking guix environment:: Setting up development environments.
4352 * Invoking guix pack:: Creating software bundles.
4353 @end menu
4354
4355 @node Invoking guix environment
4356 @section Invoking @command{guix environment}
4357
4358 @cindex reproducible build environments
4359 @cindex development environments
4360 @cindex @command{guix environment}
4361 @cindex environment, package build environment
4362 The purpose of @command{guix environment} is to assist hackers in
4363 creating reproducible development environments without polluting their
4364 package profile. The @command{guix environment} tool takes one or more
4365 packages, builds all of their inputs, and creates a shell
4366 environment to use them.
4367
4368 The general syntax is:
4369
4370 @example
4371 guix environment @var{options} @var{package}@dots{}
4372 @end example
4373
4374 The following example spawns a new shell set up for the development of
4375 GNU@tie{}Guile:
4376
4377 @example
4378 guix environment guile
4379 @end example
4380
4381 If the needed dependencies are not built yet, @command{guix environment}
4382 automatically builds them. The environment of the new shell is an augmented
4383 version of the environment that @command{guix environment} was run in.
4384 It contains the necessary search paths for building the given package
4385 added to the existing environment variables. To create a ``pure''
4386 environment, in which the original environment variables have been unset,
4387 use the @code{--pure} option@footnote{Users sometimes wrongfully augment
4388 environment variables such as @code{PATH} in their @file{~/.bashrc}
4389 file. As a consequence, when @code{guix environment} launches it, Bash
4390 may read @file{~/.bashrc}, thereby introducing ``impurities'' in these
4391 environment variables. It is an error to define such environment
4392 variables in @file{.bashrc}; instead, they should be defined in
4393 @file{.bash_profile}, which is sourced only by log-in shells.
4394 @xref{Bash Startup Files,,, bash, The GNU Bash Reference Manual}, for
4395 details on Bash start-up files.}.
4396
4397 @vindex GUIX_ENVIRONMENT
4398 @command{guix environment} defines the @code{GUIX_ENVIRONMENT}
4399 variable in the shell it spawns; its value is the file name of the
4400 profile of this environment. This allows users to, say, define a
4401 specific prompt for development environments in their @file{.bashrc}
4402 (@pxref{Bash Startup Files,,, bash, The GNU Bash Reference Manual}):
4403
4404 @example
4405 if [ -n "$GUIX_ENVIRONMENT" ]
4406 then
4407 export PS1="\u@@\h \w [dev]\$ "
4408 fi
4409 @end example
4410
4411 @noindent
4412 ...@: or to browse the profile:
4413
4414 @example
4415 $ ls "$GUIX_ENVIRONMENT/bin"
4416 @end example
4417
4418 Additionally, more than one package may be specified, in which case the
4419 union of the inputs for the given packages are used. For example, the
4420 command below spawns a shell where all of the dependencies of both Guile
4421 and Emacs are available:
4422
4423 @example
4424 guix environment guile emacs
4425 @end example
4426
4427 Sometimes an interactive shell session is not desired. An arbitrary
4428 command may be invoked by placing the @code{--} token to separate the
4429 command from the rest of the arguments:
4430
4431 @example
4432 guix environment guile -- make -j4
4433 @end example
4434
4435 In other situations, it is more convenient to specify the list of
4436 packages needed in the environment. For example, the following command
4437 runs @command{python} from an environment containing Python@tie{}2.7 and
4438 NumPy:
4439
4440 @example
4441 guix environment --ad-hoc python2-numpy python-2.7 -- python
4442 @end example
4443
4444 Furthermore, one might want the dependencies of a package and also some
4445 additional packages that are not build-time or runtime dependencies, but
4446 are useful when developing nonetheless. Because of this, the
4447 @code{--ad-hoc} flag is positional. Packages appearing before
4448 @code{--ad-hoc} are interpreted as packages whose dependencies will be
4449 added to the environment. Packages appearing after are interpreted as
4450 packages that will be added to the environment directly. For example,
4451 the following command creates a Guix development environment that
4452 additionally includes Git and strace:
4453
4454 @example
4455 guix environment guix --ad-hoc git strace
4456 @end example
4457
4458 Sometimes it is desirable to isolate the environment as much as
4459 possible, for maximal purity and reproducibility. In particular, when
4460 using Guix on a host distro that is not Guix System, it is desirable to
4461 prevent access to @file{/usr/bin} and other system-wide resources from
4462 the development environment. For example, the following command spawns
4463 a Guile REPL in a ``container'' where only the store and the current
4464 working directory are mounted:
4465
4466 @example
4467 guix environment --ad-hoc --container guile -- guile
4468 @end example
4469
4470 @quotation Note
4471 The @code{--container} option requires Linux-libre 3.19 or newer.
4472 @end quotation
4473
4474 The available options are summarized below.
4475
4476 @table @code
4477 @item --root=@var{file}
4478 @itemx -r @var{file}
4479 @cindex persistent environment
4480 @cindex garbage collector root, for environments
4481 Make @var{file} a symlink to the profile for this environment, and
4482 register it as a garbage collector root.
4483
4484 This is useful if you want to protect your environment from garbage
4485 collection, to make it ``persistent''.
4486
4487 When this option is omitted, the environment is protected from garbage
4488 collection only for the duration of the @command{guix environment}
4489 session. This means that next time you recreate the same environment,
4490 you could have to rebuild or re-download packages. @xref{Invoking guix
4491 gc}, for more on GC roots.
4492
4493 @item --expression=@var{expr}
4494 @itemx -e @var{expr}
4495 Create an environment for the package or list of packages that
4496 @var{expr} evaluates to.
4497
4498 For example, running:
4499
4500 @example
4501 guix environment -e '(@@ (gnu packages maths) petsc-openmpi)'
4502 @end example
4503
4504 starts a shell with the environment for this specific variant of the
4505 PETSc package.
4506
4507 Running:
4508
4509 @example
4510 guix environment --ad-hoc -e '(@@ (gnu) %base-packages)'
4511 @end example
4512
4513 starts a shell with all the base system packages available.
4514
4515 The above commands only use the default output of the given packages.
4516 To select other outputs, two element tuples can be specified:
4517
4518 @example
4519 guix environment --ad-hoc -e '(list (@@ (gnu packages bash) bash) "include")'
4520 @end example
4521
4522 @item --load=@var{file}
4523 @itemx -l @var{file}
4524 Create an environment for the package or list of packages that the code
4525 within @var{file} evaluates to.
4526
4527 As an example, @var{file} might contain a definition like this
4528 (@pxref{Defining Packages}):
4529
4530 @example
4531 @verbatiminclude environment-gdb.scm
4532 @end example
4533
4534 @item --manifest=@var{file}
4535 @itemx -m @var{file}
4536 Create an environment for the packages contained in the manifest object
4537 returned by the Scheme code in @var{file}.
4538
4539 This is similar to the same-named option in @command{guix package}
4540 (@pxref{profile-manifest, @option{--manifest}}) and uses the same
4541 manifest files.
4542
4543 @item --ad-hoc
4544 Include all specified packages in the resulting environment, as if an
4545 @i{ad hoc} package were defined with them as inputs. This option is
4546 useful for quickly creating an environment without having to write a
4547 package expression to contain the desired inputs.
4548
4549 For instance, the command:
4550
4551 @example
4552 guix environment --ad-hoc guile guile-sdl -- guile
4553 @end example
4554
4555 runs @command{guile} in an environment where Guile and Guile-SDL are
4556 available.
4557
4558 Note that this example implicitly asks for the default output of
4559 @code{guile} and @code{guile-sdl}, but it is possible to ask for a
4560 specific output---e.g., @code{glib:bin} asks for the @code{bin} output
4561 of @code{glib} (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}).
4562
4563 This option may be composed with the default behavior of @command{guix
4564 environment}. Packages appearing before @code{--ad-hoc} are interpreted
4565 as packages whose dependencies will be added to the environment, the
4566 default behavior. Packages appearing after are interpreted as packages
4567 that will be added to the environment directly.
4568
4569 @item --pure
4570 Unset existing environment variables when building the new environment, except
4571 those specified with @option{--preserve} (see below.) This has the effect of
4572 creating an environment in which search paths only contain package inputs.
4573
4574 @item --preserve=@var{regexp}
4575 @itemx -E @var{regexp}
4576 When used alongside @option{--pure}, preserve the environment variables
4577 matching @var{regexp}---in other words, put them on a ``white list'' of
4578 environment variables that must be preserved. This option can be repeated
4579 several times.
4580
4581 @example
4582 guix environment --pure --preserve=^SLURM --ad-hoc openmpi @dots{} \
4583 -- mpirun @dots{}
4584 @end example
4585
4586 This example runs @command{mpirun} in a context where the only environment
4587 variables defined are @code{PATH}, environment variables whose name starts
4588 with @code{SLURM}, as well as the usual ``precious'' variables (@code{HOME},
4589 @code{USER}, etc.)
4590
4591 @item --search-paths
4592 Display the environment variable definitions that make up the
4593 environment.
4594
4595 @item --system=@var{system}
4596 @itemx -s @var{system}
4597 Attempt to build for @var{system}---e.g., @code{i686-linux}.
4598
4599 @item --container
4600 @itemx -C
4601 @cindex container
4602 Run @var{command} within an isolated container. The current working
4603 directory outside the container is mapped inside the container.
4604 Additionally, unless overridden with @code{--user}, a dummy home
4605 directory is created that matches the current user's home directory, and
4606 @file{/etc/passwd} is configured accordingly.
4607
4608 The spawned process runs as the current user outside the container. Inside
4609 the container, it has the same UID and GID as the current user, unless
4610 @option{--user} is passed (see below.)
4611
4612 @item --network
4613 @itemx -N
4614 For containers, share the network namespace with the host system.
4615 Containers created without this flag only have access to the loopback
4616 device.
4617
4618 @item --link-profile
4619 @itemx -P
4620 For containers, link the environment profile to
4621 @file{~/.guix-profile} within the container. This is equivalent to
4622 running the command @command{ln -s $GUIX_ENVIRONMENT ~/.guix-profile}
4623 within the container. Linking will fail and abort the environment if
4624 the directory already exists, which will certainly be the case if
4625 @command{guix environment} was invoked in the user's home directory.
4626
4627 Certain packages are configured to look in
4628 @code{~/.guix-profile} for configuration files and data;@footnote{For
4629 example, the @code{fontconfig} package inspects
4630 @file{~/.guix-profile/share/fonts} for additional fonts.}
4631 @code{--link-profile} allows these programs to behave as expected within
4632 the environment.
4633
4634 @item --user=@var{user}
4635 @itemx -u @var{user}
4636 For containers, use the username @var{user} in place of the current
4637 user. The generated @file{/etc/passwd} entry within the container will
4638 contain the name @var{user}, the home directory will be
4639 @file{/home/@var{user}}, and no user GECOS data will be copied. Furthermore,
4640 the UID and GID inside the container are 1000. @var{user}
4641 need not exist on the system.
4642
4643 Additionally, any shared or exposed path (see @code{--share} and
4644 @code{--expose} respectively) whose target is within the current user's
4645 home directory will be remapped relative to @file{/home/USER}; this
4646 includes the automatic mapping of the current working directory.
4647
4648 @example
4649 # will expose paths as /home/foo/wd, /home/foo/test, and /home/foo/target
4650 cd $HOME/wd
4651 guix environment --container --user=foo \
4652 --expose=$HOME/test \
4653 --expose=/tmp/target=$HOME/target
4654 @end example
4655
4656 While this will limit the leaking of user identity through home paths
4657 and each of the user fields, this is only one useful component of a
4658 broader privacy/anonymity solution---not one in and of itself.
4659
4660 @item --no-cwd
4661 For containers, the default behavior is to share the current working
4662 directory with the isolated container and immediately change to that
4663 directory within the container. If this is undesirable, @code{--no-cwd}
4664 will cause the current working directory to @emph{not} be automatically
4665 shared and will change to the user's home directory within the container
4666 instead. See also @code{--user}.
4667
4668 @item --expose=@var{source}[=@var{target}]
4669 For containers, expose the file system @var{source} from the host system
4670 as the read-only file system @var{target} within the container. If
4671 @var{target} is not specified, @var{source} is used as the target mount
4672 point in the container.
4673
4674 The example below spawns a Guile REPL in a container in which the user's
4675 home directory is accessible read-only via the @file{/exchange}
4676 directory:
4677
4678 @example
4679 guix environment --container --expose=$HOME=/exchange --ad-hoc guile -- guile
4680 @end example
4681
4682 @item --share=@var{source}[=@var{target}]
4683 For containers, share the file system @var{source} from the host system
4684 as the writable file system @var{target} within the container. If
4685 @var{target} is not specified, @var{source} is used as the target mount
4686 point in the container.
4687
4688 The example below spawns a Guile REPL in a container in which the user's
4689 home directory is accessible for both reading and writing via the
4690 @file{/exchange} directory:
4691
4692 @example
4693 guix environment --container --share=$HOME=/exchange --ad-hoc guile -- guile
4694 @end example
4695 @end table
4696
4697 @command{guix environment}
4698 also supports all of the common build options that @command{guix
4699 build} supports (@pxref{Common Build Options}) as well as package
4700 transformation options (@pxref{Package Transformation Options}).
4701
4702 @node Invoking guix pack
4703 @section Invoking @command{guix pack}
4704
4705 Occasionally you want to pass software to people who are not (yet!)
4706 lucky enough to be using Guix. You'd tell them to run @command{guix
4707 package -i @var{something}}, but that's not possible in this case. This
4708 is where @command{guix pack} comes in.
4709
4710 @quotation Note
4711 If you are looking for ways to exchange binaries among machines that
4712 already run Guix, @pxref{Invoking guix copy}, @ref{Invoking guix
4713 publish}, and @ref{Invoking guix archive}.
4714 @end quotation
4715
4716 @cindex pack
4717 @cindex bundle
4718 @cindex application bundle
4719 @cindex software bundle
4720 The @command{guix pack} command creates a shrink-wrapped @dfn{pack} or
4721 @dfn{software bundle}: it creates a tarball or some other archive
4722 containing the binaries of the software you're interested in, and all
4723 its dependencies. The resulting archive can be used on any machine that
4724 does not have Guix, and people can run the exact same binaries as those
4725 you have with Guix. The pack itself is created in a bit-reproducible
4726 fashion, so anyone can verify that it really contains the build results
4727 that you pretend to be shipping.
4728
4729 For example, to create a bundle containing Guile, Emacs, Geiser, and all
4730 their dependencies, you can run:
4731
4732 @example
4733 $ guix pack guile emacs geiser
4734 @dots{}
4735 /gnu/store/@dots{}-pack.tar.gz
4736 @end example
4737
4738 The result here is a tarball containing a @file{/gnu/store} directory
4739 with all the relevant packages. The resulting tarball contains a
4740 @dfn{profile} with the three packages of interest; the profile is the
4741 same as would be created by @command{guix package -i}. It is this
4742 mechanism that is used to create Guix's own standalone binary tarball
4743 (@pxref{Binary Installation}).
4744
4745 Users of this pack would have to run
4746 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-profile/bin/guile} to run Guile, which you may
4747 find inconvenient. To work around it, you can create, say, a
4748 @file{/opt/gnu/bin} symlink to the profile:
4749
4750 @example
4751 guix pack -S /opt/gnu/bin=bin guile emacs geiser
4752 @end example
4753
4754 @noindent
4755 That way, users can happily type @file{/opt/gnu/bin/guile} and enjoy.
4756
4757 @cindex relocatable binaries, with @command{guix pack}
4758 What if the recipient of your pack does not have root privileges on
4759 their machine, and thus cannot unpack it in the root file system? In
4760 that case, you will want to use the @code{--relocatable} option (see
4761 below). This option produces @dfn{relocatable binaries}, meaning they
4762 they can be placed anywhere in the file system hierarchy: in the example
4763 above, users can unpack your tarball in their home directory and
4764 directly run @file{./opt/gnu/bin/guile}.
4765
4766 @cindex Docker, build an image with guix pack
4767 Alternatively, you can produce a pack in the Docker image format using
4768 the following command:
4769
4770 @example
4771 guix pack -f docker guile emacs geiser
4772 @end example
4773
4774 @noindent
4775 The result is a tarball that can be passed to the @command{docker load}
4776 command. See the
4777 @uref{https://docs.docker.com/engine/reference/commandline/load/, Docker
4778 documentation} for more information.
4779
4780 @cindex Singularity, build an image with guix pack
4781 @cindex SquashFS, build an image with guix pack
4782 Yet another option is to produce a SquashFS image with the following
4783 command:
4784
4785 @example
4786 guix pack -f squashfs guile emacs geiser
4787 @end example
4788
4789 @noindent
4790 The result is a SquashFS file system image that can either be mounted or
4791 directly be used as a file system container image with the
4792 @uref{https://singularity.lbl.gov, Singularity container execution
4793 environment}, using commands like @command{singularity shell} or
4794 @command{singularity exec}.
4795
4796 Several command-line options allow you to customize your pack:
4797
4798 @table @code
4799 @item --format=@var{format}
4800 @itemx -f @var{format}
4801 Produce a pack in the given @var{format}.
4802
4803 The available formats are:
4804
4805 @table @code
4806 @item tarball
4807 This is the default format. It produces a tarball containing all the
4808 specified binaries and symlinks.
4809
4810 @item docker
4811 This produces a tarball that follows the
4812 @uref{https://github.com/docker/docker/blob/master/image/spec/v1.2.md,
4813 Docker Image Specification}.
4814
4815 @item squashfs
4816 This produces a SquashFS image containing all the specified binaries and
4817 symlinks, as well as empty mount points for virtual file systems like
4818 procfs.
4819 @end table
4820
4821 @cindex relocatable binaries
4822 @item --relocatable
4823 @itemx -R
4824 Produce @dfn{relocatable binaries}---i.e., binaries that can be placed
4825 anywhere in the file system hierarchy and run from there.
4826
4827 When this option is passed once, the resulting binaries require support for
4828 @dfn{user namespaces} in the kernel Linux; when passed
4829 @emph{twice}@footnote{Here's a trick to memorize it: @code{-RR}, which adds
4830 PRoot support, can be thought of as the abbreviation of ``Really
4831 Relocatable''. Neat, isn't it?}, relocatable binaries fall to back to PRoot
4832 if user namespaces are unavailable, and essentially work anywhere---see below
4833 for the implications.
4834
4835 For example, if you create a pack containing Bash with:
4836
4837 @example
4838 guix pack -RR -S /mybin=bin bash
4839 @end example
4840
4841 @noindent
4842 ...@: you can copy that pack to a machine that lacks Guix, and from your
4843 home directory as a normal user, run:
4844
4845 @example
4846 tar xf pack.tar.gz
4847 ./mybin/sh
4848 @end example
4849
4850 @noindent
4851 In that shell, if you type @code{ls /gnu/store}, you'll notice that
4852 @file{/gnu/store} shows up and contains all the dependencies of
4853 @code{bash}, even though the machine actually lacks @file{/gnu/store}
4854 altogether! That is probably the simplest way to deploy Guix-built
4855 software on a non-Guix machine.
4856
4857 @quotation Note
4858 By default, relocatable binaries rely on the @dfn{user namespace} feature of
4859 the kernel Linux, which allows unprivileged users to mount or change root.
4860 Old versions of Linux did not support it, and some GNU/Linux distributions
4861 turn it off.
4862
4863 To produce relocatable binaries that work even in the absence of user
4864 namespaces, pass @option{--relocatable} or @option{-R} @emph{twice}. In that
4865 case, binaries will try user namespace support and fall back to PRoot if user
4866 namespaces are not supported.
4867
4868 The @uref{https://proot-me.github.io/, PRoot} program provides the necessary
4869 support for file system virtualization. It achieves that by using the
4870 @code{ptrace} system call on the running program. This approach has the
4871 advantage to work without requiring special kernel support, but it incurs
4872 run-time overhead every time a system call is made.
4873 @end quotation
4874
4875 @cindex entry point, for Docker images
4876 @item --entry-point=@var{command}
4877 Use @var{command} as the @dfn{entry point} of the resulting pack, if the pack
4878 format supports it---currently @code{docker} and @code{squashfs} (Singularity)
4879 support it. @var{command} must be relative to the profile contained in the
4880 pack.
4881
4882 The entry point specifies the command that tools like @code{docker run} or
4883 @code{singularity run} automatically start by default. For example, you can
4884 do:
4885
4886 @example
4887 guix pack -f docker --entry-point=bin/guile guile
4888 @end example
4889
4890 The resulting pack can easily be loaded and @code{docker run} with no extra
4891 arguments will spawn @code{bin/guile}:
4892
4893 @example
4894 docker load -i pack.tar.gz
4895 docker run @var{image-id}
4896 @end example
4897
4898 @item --expression=@var{expr}
4899 @itemx -e @var{expr}
4900 Consider the package @var{expr} evaluates to.
4901
4902 This has the same purpose as the same-named option in @command{guix
4903 build} (@pxref{Additional Build Options, @code{--expression} in
4904 @command{guix build}}).
4905
4906 @item --manifest=@var{file}
4907 @itemx -m @var{file}
4908 Use the packages contained in the manifest object returned by the Scheme
4909 code in @var{file}.
4910
4911 This has a similar purpose as the same-named option in @command{guix
4912 package} (@pxref{profile-manifest, @option{--manifest}}) and uses the
4913 same manifest files. It allows you to define a collection of packages
4914 once and use it both for creating profiles and for creating archives
4915 for use on machines that do not have Guix installed. Note that you can
4916 specify @emph{either} a manifest file @emph{or} a list of packages,
4917 but not both.
4918
4919 @item --system=@var{system}
4920 @itemx -s @var{system}
4921 Attempt to build for @var{system}---e.g., @code{i686-linux}---instead of
4922 the system type of the build host.
4923
4924 @item --target=@var{triplet}
4925 @cindex cross-compilation
4926 Cross-build for @var{triplet}, which must be a valid GNU triplet, such
4927 as @code{"mips64el-linux-gnu"} (@pxref{Specifying target triplets, GNU
4928 configuration triplets,, autoconf, Autoconf}).
4929
4930 @item --compression=@var{tool}
4931 @itemx -C @var{tool}
4932 Compress the resulting tarball using @var{tool}---one of @code{gzip},
4933 @code{bzip2}, @code{xz}, @code{lzip}, or @code{none} for no compression.
4934
4935 @item --symlink=@var{spec}
4936 @itemx -S @var{spec}
4937 Add the symlinks specified by @var{spec} to the pack. This option can
4938 appear several times.
4939
4940 @var{spec} has the form @code{@var{source}=@var{target}}, where
4941 @var{source} is the symlink that will be created and @var{target} is the
4942 symlink target.
4943
4944 For instance, @code{-S /opt/gnu/bin=bin} creates a @file{/opt/gnu/bin}
4945 symlink pointing to the @file{bin} sub-directory of the profile.
4946
4947 @item --save-provenance
4948 Save provenance information for the packages passed on the command line.
4949 Provenance information includes the URL and commit of the channels in use
4950 (@pxref{Channels}).
4951
4952 Provenance information is saved in the
4953 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-profile/manifest} file in the pack, along with the
4954 usual package metadata---the name and version of each package, their
4955 propagated inputs, and so on. It is useful information to the recipient of
4956 the pack, who then knows how the pack was (supposedly) obtained.
4957
4958 This option is not enabled by default because, like timestamps, provenance
4959 information contributes nothing to the build process. In other words, there
4960 is an infinity of channel URLs and commit IDs that can lead to the same pack.
4961 Recording such ``silent'' metadata in the output thus potentially breaks the
4962 source-to-binary bitwise reproducibility property.
4963
4964 @item --root=@var{file}
4965 @itemx -r @var{file}
4966 @cindex garbage collector root, for packs
4967 Make @var{file} a symlink to the resulting pack, and register it as a garbage
4968 collector root.
4969
4970 @item --localstatedir
4971 @itemx --profile-name=@var{name}
4972 Include the ``local state directory'', @file{/var/guix}, in the resulting
4973 pack, and notably the @file{/var/guix/profiles/per-user/root/@var{name}}
4974 profile---by default @var{name} is @code{guix-profile}, which corresponds to
4975 @file{~root/.guix-profile}.
4976
4977 @file{/var/guix} contains the store database (@pxref{The Store}) as well
4978 as garbage-collector roots (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}). Providing it in
4979 the pack means that the store is ``complete'' and manageable by Guix;
4980 not providing it pack means that the store is ``dead'': items cannot be
4981 added to it or removed from it after extraction of the pack.
4982
4983 One use case for this is the Guix self-contained binary tarball
4984 (@pxref{Binary Installation}).
4985
4986 @item --bootstrap
4987 Use the bootstrap binaries to build the pack. This option is only
4988 useful to Guix developers.
4989 @end table
4990
4991 In addition, @command{guix pack} supports all the common build options
4992 (@pxref{Common Build Options}) and all the package transformation
4993 options (@pxref{Package Transformation Options}).
4994
4995
4996 @c *********************************************************************
4997 @node Programming Interface
4998 @chapter Programming Interface
4999
5000 GNU Guix provides several Scheme programming interfaces (APIs) to
5001 define, build, and query packages. The first interface allows users to
5002 write high-level package definitions. These definitions refer to
5003 familiar packaging concepts, such as the name and version of a package,
5004 its build system, and its dependencies. These definitions can then be
5005 turned into concrete build actions.
5006
5007 Build actions are performed by the Guix daemon, on behalf of users. In a
5008 standard setup, the daemon has write access to the store---the
5009 @file{/gnu/store} directory---whereas users do not. The recommended
5010 setup also has the daemon perform builds in chroots, under a specific
5011 build users, to minimize interference with the rest of the system.
5012
5013 @cindex derivation
5014 Lower-level APIs are available to interact with the daemon and the
5015 store. To instruct the daemon to perform a build action, users actually
5016 provide it with a @dfn{derivation}. A derivation is a low-level
5017 representation of the build actions to be taken, and the environment in
5018 which they should occur---derivations are to package definitions what
5019 assembly is to C programs. The term ``derivation'' comes from the fact
5020 that build results @emph{derive} from them.
5021
5022 This chapter describes all these APIs in turn, starting from high-level
5023 package definitions.
5024
5025 @menu
5026 * Package Modules:: Packages from the programmer's viewpoint.
5027 * Defining Packages:: Defining new packages.
5028 * Build Systems:: Specifying how packages are built.
5029 * The Store:: Manipulating the package store.
5030 * Derivations:: Low-level interface to package derivations.
5031 * The Store Monad:: Purely functional interface to the store.
5032 * G-Expressions:: Manipulating build expressions.
5033 * Invoking guix repl:: Fiddling with Guix interactively.
5034 @end menu
5035
5036 @node Package Modules
5037 @section Package Modules
5038
5039 From a programming viewpoint, the package definitions of the
5040 GNU distribution are provided by Guile modules in the @code{(gnu packages
5041 @dots{})} name space@footnote{Note that packages under the @code{(gnu
5042 packages @dots{})} module name space are not necessarily ``GNU
5043 packages''. This module naming scheme follows the usual Guile module
5044 naming convention: @code{gnu} means that these modules are distributed
5045 as part of the GNU system, and @code{packages} identifies modules that
5046 define packages.} (@pxref{Modules, Guile modules,, guile, GNU Guile
5047 Reference Manual}). For instance, the @code{(gnu packages emacs)}
5048 module exports a variable named @code{emacs}, which is bound to a
5049 @code{<package>} object (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
5050
5051 The @code{(gnu packages @dots{})} module name space is
5052 automatically scanned for packages by the command-line tools. For
5053 instance, when running @code{guix install emacs}, all the @code{(gnu
5054 packages @dots{})} modules are scanned until one that exports a package
5055 object whose name is @code{emacs} is found. This package search
5056 facility is implemented in the @code{(gnu packages)} module.
5057
5058 @cindex customization, of packages
5059 @cindex package module search path
5060 Users can store package definitions in modules with different
5061 names---e.g., @code{(my-packages emacs)}@footnote{Note that the file
5062 name and module name must match. For instance, the @code{(my-packages
5063 emacs)} module must be stored in a @file{my-packages/emacs.scm} file
5064 relative to the load path specified with @option{--load-path} or
5065 @code{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH}. @xref{Modules and the File System,,,
5066 guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}, for details.}. There are two ways to make
5067 these package definitions visible to the user interfaces:
5068
5069 @enumerate
5070 @item
5071 By adding the directory containing your package modules to the search path
5072 with the @code{-L} flag of @command{guix package} and other commands
5073 (@pxref{Common Build Options}), or by setting the @code{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH}
5074 environment variable described below.
5075
5076 @item
5077 By defining a @dfn{channel} and configuring @command{guix pull} so that it
5078 pulls from it. A channel is essentially a Git repository containing package
5079 modules. @xref{Channels}, for more information on how to define and use
5080 channels.
5081 @end enumerate
5082
5083 @code{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH} works similarly to other search path variables:
5084
5085 @defvr {Environment Variable} GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH
5086 This is a colon-separated list of directories to search for additional
5087 package modules. Directories listed in this variable take precedence
5088 over the own modules of the distribution.
5089 @end defvr
5090
5091 The distribution is fully @dfn{bootstrapped} and @dfn{self-contained}:
5092 each package is built based solely on other packages in the
5093 distribution. The root of this dependency graph is a small set of
5094 @dfn{bootstrap binaries}, provided by the @code{(gnu packages
5095 bootstrap)} module. For more information on bootstrapping,
5096 @pxref{Bootstrapping}.
5097
5098 @node Defining Packages
5099 @section Defining Packages
5100
5101 The high-level interface to package definitions is implemented in the
5102 @code{(guix packages)} and @code{(guix build-system)} modules. As an
5103 example, the package definition, or @dfn{recipe}, for the GNU Hello
5104 package looks like this:
5105
5106 @example
5107 (define-module (gnu packages hello)
5108 #:use-module (guix packages)
5109 #:use-module (guix download)
5110 #:use-module (guix build-system gnu)
5111 #:use-module (guix licenses)
5112 #:use-module (gnu packages gawk))
5113
5114 (define-public hello
5115 (package
5116 (name "hello")
5117 (version "2.10")
5118 (source (origin
5119 (method url-fetch)
5120 (uri (string-append "mirror://gnu/hello/hello-" version
5121 ".tar.gz"))
5122 (sha256
5123 (base32
5124 "0ssi1wpaf7plaswqqjwigppsg5fyh99vdlb9kzl7c9lng89ndq1i"))))
5125 (build-system gnu-build-system)
5126 (arguments '(#:configure-flags '("--enable-silent-rules")))
5127 (inputs `(("gawk" ,gawk)))
5128 (synopsis "Hello, GNU world: An example GNU package")
5129 (description "Guess what GNU Hello prints!")
5130 (home-page "https://www.gnu.org/software/hello/")
5131 (license gpl3+)))
5132 @end example
5133
5134 @noindent
5135 Without being a Scheme expert, the reader may have guessed the meaning
5136 of the various fields here. This expression binds the variable
5137 @code{hello} to a @code{<package>} object, which is essentially a record
5138 (@pxref{SRFI-9, Scheme records,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}).
5139 This package object can be inspected using procedures found in the
5140 @code{(guix packages)} module; for instance, @code{(package-name hello)}
5141 returns---surprise!---@code{"hello"}.
5142
5143 With luck, you may be able to import part or all of the definition of
5144 the package you are interested in from another repository, using the
5145 @code{guix import} command (@pxref{Invoking guix import}).
5146
5147 In the example above, @var{hello} is defined in a module of its own,
5148 @code{(gnu packages hello)}. Technically, this is not strictly
5149 necessary, but it is convenient to do so: all the packages defined in
5150 modules under @code{(gnu packages @dots{})} are automatically known to
5151 the command-line tools (@pxref{Package Modules}).
5152
5153 There are a few points worth noting in the above package definition:
5154
5155 @itemize
5156 @item
5157 The @code{source} field of the package is an @code{<origin>} object
5158 (@pxref{origin Reference}, for the complete reference).
5159 Here, the @code{url-fetch} method from @code{(guix download)} is used,
5160 meaning that the source is a file to be downloaded over FTP or HTTP.
5161
5162 The @code{mirror://gnu} prefix instructs @code{url-fetch} to use one of
5163 the GNU mirrors defined in @code{(guix download)}.
5164
5165 The @code{sha256} field specifies the expected SHA256 hash of the file
5166 being downloaded. It is mandatory, and allows Guix to check the
5167 integrity of the file. The @code{(base32 @dots{})} form introduces the
5168 base32 representation of the hash. You can obtain this information with
5169 @code{guix download} (@pxref{Invoking guix download}) and @code{guix
5170 hash} (@pxref{Invoking guix hash}).
5171
5172 @cindex patches
5173 When needed, the @code{origin} form can also have a @code{patches} field
5174 listing patches to be applied, and a @code{snippet} field giving a
5175 Scheme expression to modify the source code.
5176
5177 @item
5178 @cindex GNU Build System
5179 The @code{build-system} field specifies the procedure to build the
5180 package (@pxref{Build Systems}). Here, @var{gnu-build-system}
5181 represents the familiar GNU Build System, where packages may be
5182 configured, built, and installed with the usual @code{./configure &&
5183 make && make check && make install} command sequence.
5184
5185 @item
5186 The @code{arguments} field specifies options for the build system
5187 (@pxref{Build Systems}). Here it is interpreted by
5188 @var{gnu-build-system} as a request run @file{configure} with the
5189 @code{--enable-silent-rules} flag.
5190
5191 @cindex quote
5192 @cindex quoting
5193 @findex '
5194 @findex quote
5195 What about these quote (@code{'}) characters? They are Scheme syntax to
5196 introduce a literal list; @code{'} is synonymous with @code{quote}.
5197 @xref{Expression Syntax, quoting,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual},
5198 for details. Here the value of the @code{arguments} field is a list of
5199 arguments passed to the build system down the road, as with @code{apply}
5200 (@pxref{Fly Evaluation, @code{apply},, guile, GNU Guile Reference
5201 Manual}).
5202
5203 The hash-colon (@code{#:}) sequence defines a Scheme @dfn{keyword}
5204 (@pxref{Keywords,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}), and
5205 @code{#:configure-flags} is a keyword used to pass a keyword argument
5206 to the build system (@pxref{Coding With Keywords,,, guile, GNU Guile
5207 Reference Manual}).
5208
5209 @item
5210 The @code{inputs} field specifies inputs to the build process---i.e.,
5211 build-time or run-time dependencies of the package. Here, we define an
5212 input called @code{"gawk"} whose value is that of the @var{gawk}
5213 variable; @var{gawk} is itself bound to a @code{<package>} object.
5214
5215 @cindex backquote (quasiquote)
5216 @findex `
5217 @findex quasiquote
5218 @cindex comma (unquote)
5219 @findex ,
5220 @findex unquote
5221 @findex ,@@
5222 @findex unquote-splicing
5223 Again, @code{`} (a backquote, synonymous with @code{quasiquote}) allows
5224 us to introduce a literal list in the @code{inputs} field, while
5225 @code{,} (a comma, synonymous with @code{unquote}) allows us to insert a
5226 value in that list (@pxref{Expression Syntax, unquote,, guile, GNU Guile
5227 Reference Manual}).
5228
5229 Note that GCC, Coreutils, Bash, and other essential tools do not need to
5230 be specified as inputs here. Instead, @var{gnu-build-system} takes care
5231 of ensuring that they are present (@pxref{Build Systems}).
5232
5233 However, any other dependencies need to be specified in the
5234 @code{inputs} field. Any dependency not specified here will simply be
5235 unavailable to the build process, possibly leading to a build failure.
5236 @end itemize
5237
5238 @xref{package Reference}, for a full description of possible fields.
5239
5240 Once a package definition is in place, the
5241 package may actually be built using the @code{guix build} command-line
5242 tool (@pxref{Invoking guix build}), troubleshooting any build failures
5243 you encounter (@pxref{Debugging Build Failures}). You can easily jump back to the
5244 package definition using the @command{guix edit} command
5245 (@pxref{Invoking guix edit}).
5246 @xref{Packaging Guidelines}, for
5247 more information on how to test package definitions, and
5248 @ref{Invoking guix lint}, for information on how to check a definition
5249 for style conformance.
5250 @vindex GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH
5251 Lastly, @pxref{Channels}, for information
5252 on how to extend the distribution by adding your own package definitions
5253 in a ``channel''.
5254
5255 Finally, updating the package definition to a new upstream version
5256 can be partly automated by the @command{guix refresh} command
5257 (@pxref{Invoking guix refresh}).
5258
5259 Behind the scenes, a derivation corresponding to the @code{<package>}
5260 object is first computed by the @code{package-derivation} procedure.
5261 That derivation is stored in a @code{.drv} file under @file{/gnu/store}.
5262 The build actions it prescribes may then be realized by using the
5263 @code{build-derivations} procedure (@pxref{The Store}).
5264
5265 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} package-derivation @var{store} @var{package} [@var{system}]
5266 Return the @code{<derivation>} object of @var{package} for @var{system}
5267 (@pxref{Derivations}).
5268
5269 @var{package} must be a valid @code{<package>} object, and @var{system}
5270 must be a string denoting the target system type---e.g.,
5271 @code{"x86_64-linux"} for an x86_64 Linux-based GNU system. @var{store}
5272 must be a connection to the daemon, which operates on the store
5273 (@pxref{The Store}).
5274 @end deffn
5275
5276 @noindent
5277 @cindex cross-compilation
5278 Similarly, it is possible to compute a derivation that cross-builds a
5279 package for some other system:
5280
5281 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} package-cross-derivation @var{store} @
5282 @var{package} @var{target} [@var{system}]
5283 Return the @code{<derivation>} object of @var{package} cross-built from
5284 @var{system} to @var{target}.
5285
5286 @var{target} must be a valid GNU triplet denoting the target hardware
5287 and operating system, such as @code{"mips64el-linux-gnu"}
5288 (@pxref{Specifying Target Triplets,,, autoconf, Autoconf}).
5289 @end deffn
5290
5291 @cindex package transformations
5292 @cindex input rewriting
5293 @cindex dependency tree rewriting
5294 Packages can be manipulated in arbitrary ways. An example of a useful
5295 transformation is @dfn{input rewriting}, whereby the dependency tree of
5296 a package is rewritten by replacing specific inputs by others:
5297
5298 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} package-input-rewriting @var{replacements} @
5299 [@var{rewrite-name}]
5300 Return a procedure that, when passed a package, replaces its direct and
5301 indirect dependencies (but not its implicit inputs) according to
5302 @var{replacements}. @var{replacements} is a list of package pairs; the
5303 first element of each pair is the package to replace, and the second one
5304 is the replacement.
5305
5306 Optionally, @var{rewrite-name} is a one-argument procedure that takes
5307 the name of a package and returns its new name after rewrite.
5308 @end deffn
5309
5310 @noindent
5311 Consider this example:
5312
5313 @example
5314 (define libressl-instead-of-openssl
5315 ;; This is a procedure to replace OPENSSL by LIBRESSL,
5316 ;; recursively.
5317 (package-input-rewriting `((,openssl . ,libressl))))
5318
5319 (define git-with-libressl
5320 (libressl-instead-of-openssl git))
5321 @end example
5322
5323 @noindent
5324 Here we first define a rewriting procedure that replaces @var{openssl}
5325 with @var{libressl}. Then we use it to define a @dfn{variant} of the
5326 @var{git} package that uses @var{libressl} instead of @var{openssl}.
5327 This is exactly what the @option{--with-input} command-line option does
5328 (@pxref{Package Transformation Options, @option{--with-input}}).
5329
5330 The following variant of @code{package-input-rewriting} can match packages to
5331 be replaced by name rather than by identity.
5332
5333 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} package-input-rewriting/spec @var{replacements}
5334 Return a procedure that, given a package, applies the given @var{replacements} to
5335 all the package graph (excluding implicit inputs). @var{replacements} is a list of
5336 spec/procedures pair; each spec is a package specification such as @code{"gcc"} or
5337 @code{"guile@@2"}, and each procedure takes a matching package and returns a
5338 replacement for that package.
5339 @end deffn
5340
5341 The example above could be rewritten this way:
5342
5343 @example
5344 (define libressl-instead-of-openssl
5345 ;; Replace all the packages called "openssl" with LibreSSL.
5346 (package-input-rewriting/spec `(("openssl" . ,(const libressl)))))
5347 @end example
5348
5349 The key difference here is that, this time, packages are matched by spec and
5350 not by identity. In other words, any package in the graph that is called
5351 @code{openssl} will be replaced.
5352
5353 A more generic procedure to rewrite a package dependency graph is
5354 @code{package-mapping}: it supports arbitrary changes to nodes in the
5355 graph.
5356
5357 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} package-mapping @var{proc} [@var{cut?}]
5358 Return a procedure that, given a package, applies @var{proc} to all the packages
5359 depended on and returns the resulting package. The procedure stops recursion
5360 when @var{cut?} returns true for a given package.
5361 @end deffn
5362
5363 @menu
5364 * package Reference:: The package data type.
5365 * origin Reference:: The origin data type.
5366 @end menu
5367
5368
5369 @node package Reference
5370 @subsection @code{package} Reference
5371
5372 This section summarizes all the options available in @code{package}
5373 declarations (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
5374
5375 @deftp {Data Type} package
5376 This is the data type representing a package recipe.
5377
5378 @table @asis
5379 @item @code{name}
5380 The name of the package, as a string.
5381
5382 @item @code{version}
5383 The version of the package, as a string.
5384
5385 @item @code{source}
5386 An object telling how the source code for the package should be
5387 acquired. Most of the time, this is an @code{origin} object, which
5388 denotes a file fetched from the Internet (@pxref{origin Reference}). It
5389 can also be any other ``file-like'' object such as a @code{local-file},
5390 which denotes a file from the local file system (@pxref{G-Expressions,
5391 @code{local-file}}).
5392
5393 @item @code{build-system}
5394 The build system that should be used to build the package (@pxref{Build
5395 Systems}).
5396
5397 @item @code{arguments} (default: @code{'()})
5398 The arguments that should be passed to the build system. This is a
5399 list, typically containing sequential keyword-value pairs.
5400
5401 @item @code{inputs} (default: @code{'()})
5402 @itemx @code{native-inputs} (default: @code{'()})
5403 @itemx @code{propagated-inputs} (default: @code{'()})
5404 @cindex inputs, of packages
5405 These fields list dependencies of the package. Each one is a list of
5406 tuples, where each tuple has a label for the input (a string) as its
5407 first element, a package, origin, or derivation as its second element,
5408 and optionally the name of the output thereof that should be used, which
5409 defaults to @code{"out"} (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}, for
5410 more on package outputs). For example, the list below specifies three
5411 inputs:
5412
5413 @example
5414 `(("libffi" ,libffi)
5415 ("libunistring" ,libunistring)
5416 ("glib:bin" ,glib "bin")) ;the "bin" output of Glib
5417 @end example
5418
5419 @cindex cross compilation, package dependencies
5420 The distinction between @code{native-inputs} and @code{inputs} is
5421 necessary when considering cross-compilation. When cross-compiling,
5422 dependencies listed in @code{inputs} are built for the @emph{target}
5423 architecture; conversely, dependencies listed in @code{native-inputs}
5424 are built for the architecture of the @emph{build} machine.
5425
5426 @code{native-inputs} is typically used to list tools needed at
5427 build time, but not at run time, such as Autoconf, Automake, pkg-config,
5428 Gettext, or Bison. @command{guix lint} can report likely mistakes in
5429 this area (@pxref{Invoking guix lint}).
5430
5431 @anchor{package-propagated-inputs}
5432 Lastly, @code{propagated-inputs} is similar to @code{inputs}, but the
5433 specified packages will be automatically installed alongside the package
5434 they belong to (@pxref{package-cmd-propagated-inputs, @command{guix
5435 package}}, for information on how @command{guix package} deals with
5436 propagated inputs.)
5437
5438 For example this is necessary when a C/C++ library needs headers of
5439 another library to compile, or when a pkg-config file refers to another
5440 one @i{via} its @code{Requires} field.
5441
5442 Another example where @code{propagated-inputs} is useful is for languages
5443 that lack a facility to record the run-time search path akin to the
5444 @code{RUNPATH} of ELF files; this includes Guile, Python, Perl, and
5445 more. To ensure that libraries written in those languages can find
5446 library code they depend on at run time, run-time dependencies must be
5447 listed in @code{propagated-inputs} rather than @code{inputs}.
5448
5449 @item @code{outputs} (default: @code{'("out")})
5450 The list of output names of the package. @xref{Packages with Multiple
5451 Outputs}, for typical uses of additional outputs.
5452
5453 @item @code{native-search-paths} (default: @code{'()})
5454 @itemx @code{search-paths} (default: @code{'()})
5455 A list of @code{search-path-specification} objects describing
5456 search-path environment variables honored by the package.
5457
5458 @item @code{replacement} (default: @code{#f})
5459 This must be either @code{#f} or a package object that will be used as a
5460 @dfn{replacement} for this package. @xref{Security Updates, grafts},
5461 for details.
5462
5463 @item @code{synopsis}
5464 A one-line description of the package.
5465
5466 @item @code{description}
5467 A more elaborate description of the package.
5468
5469 @item @code{license}
5470 @cindex license, of packages
5471 The license of the package; a value from @code{(guix licenses)},
5472 or a list of such values.
5473
5474 @item @code{home-page}
5475 The URL to the home-page of the package, as a string.
5476
5477 @item @code{supported-systems} (default: @var{%supported-systems})
5478 The list of systems supported by the package, as strings of the form
5479 @code{architecture-kernel}, for example @code{"x86_64-linux"}.
5480
5481 @item @code{maintainers} (default: @code{'()})
5482 The list of maintainers of the package, as @code{maintainer} objects.
5483
5484 @item @code{location} (default: source location of the @code{package} form)
5485 The source location of the package. It is useful to override this when
5486 inheriting from another package, in which case this field is not
5487 automatically corrected.
5488 @end table
5489 @end deftp
5490
5491 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} this-package
5492 When used in the @emph{lexical scope} of a package field definition, this
5493 identifier resolves to the package being defined.
5494
5495 The example below shows how to add a package as a native input of itself when
5496 cross-compiling:
5497
5498 @example
5499 (package
5500 (name "guile")
5501 ;; ...
5502
5503 ;; When cross-compiled, Guile, for example, depends on
5504 ;; a native version of itself. Add it here.
5505 (native-inputs (if (%current-target-system)
5506 `(("self" ,this-package))
5507 '())))
5508 @end example
5509
5510 It is an error to refer to @code{this-package} outside a package definition.
5511 @end deffn
5512
5513 @node origin Reference
5514 @subsection @code{origin} Reference
5515
5516 This section summarizes all the options available in @code{origin}
5517 declarations (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
5518
5519 @deftp {Data Type} origin
5520 This is the data type representing a source code origin.
5521
5522 @table @asis
5523 @item @code{uri}
5524 An object containing the URI of the source. The object type depends on
5525 the @code{method} (see below). For example, when using the
5526 @var{url-fetch} method of @code{(guix download)}, the valid @code{uri}
5527 values are: a URL represented as a string, or a list thereof.
5528
5529 @item @code{method}
5530 A procedure that handles the URI.
5531
5532 Examples include:
5533
5534 @table @asis
5535 @item @var{url-fetch} from @code{(guix download)}
5536 download a file from the HTTP, HTTPS, or FTP URL specified in the
5537 @code{uri} field;
5538
5539 @vindex git-fetch
5540 @item @var{git-fetch} from @code{(guix git-download)}
5541 clone the Git version control repository, and check out the revision
5542 specified in the @code{uri} field as a @code{git-reference} object; a
5543 @code{git-reference} looks like this:
5544
5545 @example
5546 (git-reference
5547 (url "git://git.debian.org/git/pkg-shadow/shadow")
5548 (commit "v4.1.5.1"))
5549 @end example
5550 @end table
5551
5552 @item @code{sha256}
5553 A bytevector containing the SHA-256 hash of the source. Typically the
5554 @code{base32} form is used here to generate the bytevector from a
5555 base-32 string.
5556
5557 You can obtain this information using @code{guix download}
5558 (@pxref{Invoking guix download}) or @code{guix hash} (@pxref{Invoking
5559 guix hash}).
5560
5561 @item @code{file-name} (default: @code{#f})
5562 The file name under which the source code should be saved. When this is
5563 @code{#f}, a sensible default value will be used in most cases. In case
5564 the source is fetched from a URL, the file name from the URL will be
5565 used. For version control checkouts, it is recommended to provide the
5566 file name explicitly because the default is not very descriptive.
5567
5568 @item @code{patches} (default: @code{'()})
5569 A list of file names, origins, or file-like objects (@pxref{G-Expressions,
5570 file-like objects}) pointing to patches to be applied to the source.
5571
5572 This list of patches must be unconditional. In particular, it cannot
5573 depend on the value of @code{%current-system} or
5574 @code{%current-target-system}.
5575
5576 @item @code{snippet} (default: @code{#f})
5577 A G-expression (@pxref{G-Expressions}) or S-expression that will be run
5578 in the source directory. This is a convenient way to modify the source,
5579 sometimes more convenient than a patch.
5580
5581 @item @code{patch-flags} (default: @code{'("-p1")})
5582 A list of command-line flags that should be passed to the @code{patch}
5583 command.
5584
5585 @item @code{patch-inputs} (default: @code{#f})
5586 Input packages or derivations to the patching process. When this is
5587 @code{#f}, the usual set of inputs necessary for patching are provided,
5588 such as GNU@tie{}Patch.
5589
5590 @item @code{modules} (default: @code{'()})
5591 A list of Guile modules that should be loaded during the patching
5592 process and while running the code in the @code{snippet} field.
5593
5594 @item @code{patch-guile} (default: @code{#f})
5595 The Guile package that should be used in the patching process. When
5596 this is @code{#f}, a sensible default is used.
5597 @end table
5598 @end deftp
5599
5600
5601 @node Build Systems
5602 @section Build Systems
5603
5604 @cindex build system
5605 Each package definition specifies a @dfn{build system} and arguments for
5606 that build system (@pxref{Defining Packages}). This @code{build-system}
5607 field represents the build procedure of the package, as well as implicit
5608 dependencies of that build procedure.
5609
5610 Build systems are @code{<build-system>} objects. The interface to
5611 create and manipulate them is provided by the @code{(guix build-system)}
5612 module, and actual build systems are exported by specific modules.
5613
5614 @cindex bag (low-level package representation)
5615 Under the hood, build systems first compile package objects to
5616 @dfn{bags}. A @dfn{bag} is like a package, but with less
5617 ornamentation---in other words, a bag is a lower-level representation of
5618 a package, which includes all the inputs of that package, including some
5619 that were implicitly added by the build system. This intermediate
5620 representation is then compiled to a derivation (@pxref{Derivations}).
5621
5622 Build systems accept an optional list of @dfn{arguments}. In package
5623 definitions, these are passed @i{via} the @code{arguments} field
5624 (@pxref{Defining Packages}). They are typically keyword arguments
5625 (@pxref{Optional Arguments, keyword arguments in Guile,, guile, GNU
5626 Guile Reference Manual}). The value of these arguments is usually
5627 evaluated in the @dfn{build stratum}---i.e., by a Guile process launched
5628 by the daemon (@pxref{Derivations}).
5629
5630 The main build system is @var{gnu-build-system}, which implements the
5631 standard build procedure for GNU and many other packages. It
5632 is provided by the @code{(guix build-system gnu)} module.
5633
5634 @defvr {Scheme Variable} gnu-build-system
5635 @var{gnu-build-system} represents the GNU Build System, and variants
5636 thereof (@pxref{Configuration, configuration and makefile conventions,,
5637 standards, GNU Coding Standards}).
5638
5639 @cindex build phases
5640 In a nutshell, packages using it are configured, built, and installed with
5641 the usual @code{./configure && make && make check && make install}
5642 command sequence. In practice, a few additional steps are often needed.
5643 All these steps are split up in separate @dfn{phases},
5644 notably@footnote{Please see the @code{(guix build gnu-build-system)}
5645 modules for more details about the build phases.}:
5646
5647 @table @code
5648 @item unpack
5649 Unpack the source tarball, and change the current directory to the
5650 extracted source tree. If the source is actually a directory, copy it
5651 to the build tree, and enter that directory.
5652
5653 @item patch-source-shebangs
5654 Patch shebangs encountered in source files so they refer to the right
5655 store file names. For instance, this changes @code{#!/bin/sh} to
5656 @code{#!/gnu/store/@dots{}-bash-4.3/bin/sh}.
5657
5658 @item configure
5659 Run the @file{configure} script with a number of default options, such
5660 as @code{--prefix=/gnu/store/@dots{}}, as well as the options specified
5661 by the @code{#:configure-flags} argument.
5662
5663 @item build
5664 Run @code{make} with the list of flags specified with
5665 @code{#:make-flags}. If the @code{#:parallel-build?} argument is true
5666 (the default), build with @code{make -j}.
5667
5668 @item check
5669 Run @code{make check}, or some other target specified with
5670 @code{#:test-target}, unless @code{#:tests? #f} is passed. If the
5671 @code{#:parallel-tests?} argument is true (the default), run @code{make
5672 check -j}.
5673
5674 @item install
5675 Run @code{make install} with the flags listed in @code{#:make-flags}.
5676
5677 @item patch-shebangs
5678 Patch shebangs on the installed executable files.
5679
5680 @item strip
5681 Strip debugging symbols from ELF files (unless @code{#:strip-binaries?}
5682 is false), copying them to the @code{debug} output when available
5683 (@pxref{Installing Debugging Files}).
5684 @end table
5685
5686 @vindex %standard-phases
5687 The build-side module @code{(guix build gnu-build-system)} defines
5688 @var{%standard-phases} as the default list of build phases.
5689 @var{%standard-phases} is a list of symbol/procedure pairs, where the
5690 procedure implements the actual phase.
5691
5692 The list of phases used for a particular package can be changed with the
5693 @code{#:phases} parameter. For instance, passing:
5694
5695 @example
5696 #:phases (modify-phases %standard-phases (delete 'configure))
5697 @end example
5698
5699 means that all the phases described above will be used, except the
5700 @code{configure} phase.
5701
5702 In addition, this build system ensures that the ``standard'' environment
5703 for GNU packages is available. This includes tools such as GCC, libc,
5704 Coreutils, Bash, Make, Diffutils, grep, and sed (see the @code{(guix
5705 build-system gnu)} module for a complete list). We call these the
5706 @dfn{implicit inputs} of a package, because package definitions do not
5707 have to mention them.
5708 @end defvr
5709
5710 Other @code{<build-system>} objects are defined to support other
5711 conventions and tools used by free software packages. They inherit most
5712 of @var{gnu-build-system}, and differ mainly in the set of inputs
5713 implicitly added to the build process, and in the list of phases
5714 executed. Some of these build systems are listed below.
5715
5716 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ant-build-system
5717 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system ant)}. It
5718 implements the build procedure for Java packages that can be built with
5719 @url{https://ant.apache.org/, Ant build tool}.
5720
5721 It adds both @code{ant} and the @dfn{Java Development Kit} (JDK) as
5722 provided by the @code{icedtea} package to the set of inputs. Different
5723 packages can be specified with the @code{#:ant} and @code{#:jdk}
5724 parameters, respectively.
5725
5726 When the original package does not provide a suitable Ant build file,
5727 the parameter @code{#:jar-name} can be used to generate a minimal Ant
5728 build file @file{build.xml} with tasks to build the specified jar
5729 archive. In this case the parameter @code{#:source-dir} can be used to
5730 specify the source sub-directory, defaulting to ``src''.
5731
5732 The @code{#:main-class} parameter can be used with the minimal ant
5733 buildfile to specify the main class of the resulting jar. This makes the
5734 jar file executable. The @code{#:test-include} parameter can be used to
5735 specify the list of junit tests to run. It defaults to
5736 @code{(list "**/*Test.java")}. The @code{#:test-exclude} can be used to
5737 disable some tests. It defaults to @code{(list "**/Abstract*.java")},
5738 because abstract classes cannot be run as tests.
5739
5740 The parameter @code{#:build-target} can be used to specify the Ant task
5741 that should be run during the @code{build} phase. By default the
5742 ``jar'' task will be run.
5743
5744 @end defvr
5745
5746 @defvr {Scheme Variable} android-ndk-build-system
5747 @cindex Android distribution
5748 @cindex Android NDK build system
5749 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system android-ndk)}. It
5750 implements a build procedure for Android NDK (native development kit)
5751 packages using a Guix-specific build process.
5752
5753 The build system assumes that packages install their public interface
5754 (header) files to the subdirectory "include" of the "out" output and
5755 their libraries to the subdirectory "lib" of the "out" output.
5756
5757 It's also assumed that the union of all the dependencies of a package
5758 has no conflicting files.
5759
5760 For the time being, cross-compilation is not supported - so right now
5761 the libraries and header files are assumed to be host tools.
5762
5763 @end defvr
5764
5765 @defvr {Scheme Variable} asdf-build-system/source
5766 @defvrx {Scheme Variable} asdf-build-system/sbcl
5767 @defvrx {Scheme Variable} asdf-build-system/ecl
5768
5769 These variables, exported by @code{(guix build-system asdf)}, implement
5770 build procedures for Common Lisp packages using
5771 @url{https://common-lisp.net/project/asdf/, ``ASDF''}. ASDF is a system
5772 definition facility for Common Lisp programs and libraries.
5773
5774 The @code{asdf-build-system/source} system installs the packages in
5775 source form, and can be loaded using any common lisp implementation, via
5776 ASDF. The others, such as @code{asdf-build-system/sbcl}, install binary
5777 systems in the format which a particular implementation understands.
5778 These build systems can also be used to produce executable programs, or
5779 lisp images which contain a set of packages pre-loaded.
5780
5781 The build system uses naming conventions. For binary packages, the
5782 package name should be prefixed with the lisp implementation, such as
5783 @code{sbcl-} for @code{asdf-build-system/sbcl}.
5784
5785 Additionally, the corresponding source package should be labeled using
5786 the same convention as python packages (see @ref{Python Modules}), using
5787 the @code{cl-} prefix.
5788
5789 For binary packages, each system should be defined as a Guix package.
5790 If one package @code{origin} contains several systems, package variants
5791 can be created in order to build all the systems. Source packages,
5792 which use @code{asdf-build-system/source}, may contain several systems.
5793
5794 In order to create executable programs and images, the build-side
5795 procedures @code{build-program} and @code{build-image} can be used.
5796 They should be called in a build phase after the @code{create-symlinks}
5797 phase, so that the system which was just built can be used within the
5798 resulting image. @code{build-program} requires a list of Common Lisp
5799 expressions to be passed as the @code{#:entry-program} argument.
5800
5801 If the system is not defined within its own @code{.asd} file of the same
5802 name, then the @code{#:asd-file} parameter should be used to specify
5803 which file the system is defined in. Furthermore, if the package
5804 defines a system for its tests in a separate file, it will be loaded
5805 before the tests are run if it is specified by the
5806 @code{#:test-asd-file} parameter. If it is not set, the files
5807 @code{<system>-tests.asd}, @code{<system>-test.asd}, @code{tests.asd},
5808 and @code{test.asd} will be tried if they exist.
5809
5810 If for some reason the package must be named in a different way than the
5811 naming conventions suggest, the @code{#:asd-system-name} parameter can
5812 be used to specify the name of the system.
5813
5814 @end defvr
5815
5816 @defvr {Scheme Variable} cargo-build-system
5817 @cindex Rust programming language
5818 @cindex Cargo (Rust build system)
5819 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system cargo)}. It
5820 supports builds of packages using Cargo, the build tool of the
5821 @uref{https://www.rust-lang.org, Rust programming language}.
5822
5823 It adds @code{rustc} and @code{cargo} to the set of inputs.
5824 A different Rust package can be specified with the @code{#:rust} parameter.
5825
5826 Regular cargo dependencies should be added to the package definition via the
5827 @code{#:cargo-inputs} parameter as a list of name and spec pairs, where the
5828 spec can be a package or a source definition. Note that the spec must
5829 evaluate to a path to a gzipped tarball which includes a @code{Cargo.toml}
5830 file at its root, or it will be ignored. Similarly, cargo dev-dependencies
5831 should be added to the package definition via the
5832 @code{#:cargo-development-inputs} parameter.
5833
5834 In its @code{configure} phase, this build system will make any source inputs
5835 specified in the @code{#:cargo-inputs} and @code{#:cargo-development-inputs}
5836 parameters available to cargo. The @code{install} phase installs any crate
5837 the binaries if they are defined by the crate.
5838 @end defvr
5839
5840 @cindex Clojure (programming language)
5841 @cindex simple Clojure build system
5842 @defvr {Scheme Variable} clojure-build-system
5843 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system clojure)}. It implements
5844 a simple build procedure for @uref{https://clojure.org/, Clojure} packages
5845 using plain old @code{compile} in Clojure. Cross-compilation is not supported
5846 yet.
5847
5848 It adds @code{clojure}, @code{icedtea} and @code{zip} to the set of inputs.
5849 Different packages can be specified with the @code{#:clojure}, @code{#:jdk} and
5850 @code{#:zip} parameters, respectively.
5851
5852 A list of source directories, test directories and jar names can be specified
5853 with the @code{#:source-dirs}, @code{#:test-dirs} and @code{#:jar-names}
5854 parameters, respectively. Compile directory and main class can be specified
5855 with the @code{#:compile-dir} and @code{#:main-class} parameters, respectively.
5856 Other parameters are documented below.
5857
5858 This build system is an extension of @var{ant-build-system}, but with the
5859 following phases changed:
5860
5861 @table @code
5862
5863 @item build
5864 This phase calls @code{compile} in Clojure to compile source files and runs
5865 @command{jar} to create jars from both source files and compiled files
5866 according to the include list and exclude list specified in
5867 @code{#:aot-include} and @code{#:aot-exclude}, respectively. The exclude list
5868 has priority over the include list. These lists consist of symbols
5869 representing Clojure libraries or the special keyword @code{#:all} representing
5870 all Clojure libraries found under the source directories. The parameter
5871 @code{#:omit-source?} decides if source should be included into the jars.
5872
5873 @item check
5874 This phase runs tests according to the include list and exclude list specified
5875 in @code{#:test-include} and @code{#:test-exclude}, respectively. Their
5876 meanings are analogous to that of @code{#:aot-include} and
5877 @code{#:aot-exclude}, except that the special keyword @code{#:all} now
5878 stands for all Clojure libraries found under the test directories. The
5879 parameter @code{#:tests?} decides if tests should be run.
5880
5881 @item install
5882 This phase installs all jars built previously.
5883 @end table
5884
5885 Apart from the above, this build system also contains an additional phase:
5886
5887 @table @code
5888
5889 @item install-doc
5890 This phase installs all top-level files with base name matching
5891 @var{%doc-regex}. A different regex can be specified with the
5892 @code{#:doc-regex} parameter. All files (recursively) inside the documentation
5893 directories specified in @code{#:doc-dirs} are installed as well.
5894 @end table
5895 @end defvr
5896
5897 @defvr {Scheme Variable} cmake-build-system
5898 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system cmake)}. It
5899 implements the build procedure for packages using the
5900 @url{https://www.cmake.org, CMake build tool}.
5901
5902 It automatically adds the @code{cmake} package to the set of inputs.
5903 Which package is used can be specified with the @code{#:cmake}
5904 parameter.
5905
5906 The @code{#:configure-flags} parameter is taken as a list of flags
5907 passed to the @command{cmake} command. The @code{#:build-type}
5908 parameter specifies in abstract terms the flags passed to the compiler;
5909 it defaults to @code{"RelWithDebInfo"} (short for ``release mode with
5910 debugging information''), which roughly means that code is compiled with
5911 @code{-O2 -g}, as is the case for Autoconf-based packages by default.
5912 @end defvr
5913
5914 @defvr {Scheme Variable} dune-build-system
5915 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system dune)}. It
5916 supports builds of packages using @uref{https://dune.build/, Dune}, a build
5917 tool for the OCaml programming language. It is implemented as an extension
5918 of the @code{ocaml-build-system} which is described below. As such, the
5919 @code{#:ocaml} and @code{#:findlib} parameters can be passed to this build
5920 system.
5921
5922 It automatically adds the @code{dune} package to the set of inputs.
5923 Which package is used can be specified with the @code{#:dune}
5924 parameter.
5925
5926 There is no @code{configure} phase because dune packages typically don't
5927 need to be configured. The @code{#:build-flags} parameter is taken as a
5928 list of flags passed to the @code{dune} command during the build.
5929
5930 The @code{#:jbuild?} parameter can be passed to use the @code{jbuild}
5931 command instead of the more recent @code{dune} command while building
5932 a package. Its default value is @code{#f}.
5933
5934 The @code{#:package} parameter can be passed to specify a package name, which
5935 is useful when a package contains multiple packages and you want to build
5936 only one of them. This is equivalent to passing the @code{-p} argument to
5937 @code{dune}.
5938 @end defvr
5939
5940 @defvr {Scheme Variable} go-build-system
5941 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system go)}. It
5942 implements a build procedure for Go packages using the standard
5943 @url{https://golang.org/cmd/go/#hdr-Compile_packages_and_dependencies,
5944 Go build mechanisms}.
5945
5946 The user is expected to provide a value for the key @code{#:import-path}
5947 and, in some cases, @code{#:unpack-path}. The
5948 @url{https://golang.org/doc/code.html#ImportPaths, import path}
5949 corresponds to the file system path expected by the package's build
5950 scripts and any referring packages, and provides a unique way to
5951 refer to a Go package. It is typically based on a combination of the
5952 package source code's remote URI and file system hierarchy structure. In
5953 some cases, you will need to unpack the package's source code to a
5954 different directory structure than the one indicated by the import path,
5955 and @code{#:unpack-path} should be used in such cases.
5956
5957 Packages that provide Go libraries should install their source code into
5958 the built output. The key @code{#:install-source?}, which defaults to
5959 @code{#t}, controls whether or not the source code is installed. It can
5960 be set to @code{#f} for packages that only provide executable files.
5961 @end defvr
5962
5963 @defvr {Scheme Variable} glib-or-gtk-build-system
5964 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system glib-or-gtk)}. It
5965 is intended for use with packages making use of GLib or GTK+.
5966
5967 This build system adds the following two phases to the ones defined by
5968 @var{gnu-build-system}:
5969
5970 @table @code
5971 @item glib-or-gtk-wrap
5972 The phase @code{glib-or-gtk-wrap} ensures that programs in
5973 @file{bin/} are able to find GLib ``schemas'' and
5974 @uref{https://developer.gnome.org/gtk3/stable/gtk-running.html, GTK+
5975 modules}. This is achieved by wrapping the programs in launch scripts
5976 that appropriately set the @code{XDG_DATA_DIRS} and @code{GTK_PATH}
5977 environment variables.
5978
5979 It is possible to exclude specific package outputs from that wrapping
5980 process by listing their names in the
5981 @code{#:glib-or-gtk-wrap-excluded-outputs} parameter. This is useful
5982 when an output is known not to contain any GLib or GTK+ binaries, and
5983 where wrapping would gratuitously add a dependency of that output on
5984 GLib and GTK+.
5985
5986 @item glib-or-gtk-compile-schemas
5987 The phase @code{glib-or-gtk-compile-schemas} makes sure that all
5988 @uref{https://developer.gnome.org/gio/stable/glib-compile-schemas.html,
5989 GSettings schemas} of GLib are compiled. Compilation is performed by the
5990 @command{glib-compile-schemas} program. It is provided by the package
5991 @code{glib:bin} which is automatically imported by the build system.
5992 The @code{glib} package providing @command{glib-compile-schemas} can be
5993 specified with the @code{#:glib} parameter.
5994 @end table
5995
5996 Both phases are executed after the @code{install} phase.
5997 @end defvr
5998
5999 @defvr {Scheme Variable} guile-build-system
6000 This build system is for Guile packages that consist exclusively of Scheme
6001 code and that are so lean that they don't even have a makefile, let alone a
6002 @file{configure} script. It compiles Scheme code using @command{guild
6003 compile} (@pxref{Compilation,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}) and
6004 installs the @file{.scm} and @file{.go} files in the right place. It also
6005 installs documentation.
6006
6007 This build system supports cross-compilation by using the @code{--target}
6008 option of @command{guild compile}.
6009
6010 Packages built with @code{guile-build-system} must provide a Guile package in
6011 their @code{native-inputs} field.
6012 @end defvr
6013
6014 @defvr {Scheme Variable} minify-build-system
6015 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system minify)}. It
6016 implements a minification procedure for simple JavaScript packages.
6017
6018 It adds @code{uglify-js} to the set of inputs and uses it to compress
6019 all JavaScript files in the @file{src} directory. A different minifier
6020 package can be specified with the @code{#:uglify-js} parameter, but it
6021 is expected that the package writes the minified code to the standard
6022 output.
6023
6024 When the input JavaScript files are not all located in the @file{src}
6025 directory, the parameter @code{#:javascript-files} can be used to
6026 specify a list of file names to feed to the minifier.
6027 @end defvr
6028
6029 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ocaml-build-system
6030 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system ocaml)}. It implements
6031 a build procedure for @uref{https://ocaml.org, OCaml} packages, which consists
6032 of choosing the correct set of commands to run for each package. OCaml
6033 packages can expect many different commands to be run. This build system will
6034 try some of them.
6035
6036 When the package has a @file{setup.ml} file present at the top-level, it will
6037 run @code{ocaml setup.ml -configure}, @code{ocaml setup.ml -build} and
6038 @code{ocaml setup.ml -install}. The build system will assume that this file
6039 was generated by @uref{http://oasis.forge.ocamlcore.org/, OASIS} and will take
6040 care of setting the prefix and enabling tests if they are not disabled. You
6041 can pass configure and build flags with the @code{#:configure-flags} and
6042 @code{#:build-flags}. The @code{#:test-flags} key can be passed to change the
6043 set of flags used to enable tests. The @code{#:use-make?} key can be used to
6044 bypass this system in the build and install phases.
6045
6046 When the package has a @file{configure} file, it is assumed that it is a
6047 hand-made configure script that requires a different argument format than
6048 in the @code{gnu-build-system}. You can add more flags with the
6049 @code{#:configure-flags} key.
6050
6051 When the package has a @file{Makefile} file (or @code{#:use-make?} is
6052 @code{#t}), it will be used and more flags can be passed to the build and
6053 install phases with the @code{#:make-flags} key.
6054
6055 Finally, some packages do not have these files and use a somewhat standard
6056 location for its build system. In that case, the build system will run
6057 @code{ocaml pkg/pkg.ml} or @code{ocaml pkg/build.ml} and take care of
6058 providing the path to the required findlib module. Additional flags can
6059 be passed via the @code{#:build-flags} key. Install is taken care of by
6060 @command{opam-installer}. In this case, the @code{opam} package must
6061 be added to the @code{native-inputs} field of the package definition.
6062
6063 Note that most OCaml packages assume they will be installed in the same
6064 directory as OCaml, which is not what we want in guix. In particular, they
6065 will install @file{.so} files in their module's directory, which is usually
6066 fine because it is in the OCaml compiler directory. In guix though, these
6067 libraries cannot be found and we use @code{CAML_LD_LIBRARY_PATH}. This
6068 variable points to @file{lib/ocaml/site-lib/stubslibs} and this is where
6069 @file{.so} libraries should be installed.
6070 @end defvr
6071
6072 @defvr {Scheme Variable} python-build-system
6073 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system python)}. It
6074 implements the more or less standard build procedure used by Python
6075 packages, which consists in running @code{python setup.py build} and
6076 then @code{python setup.py install --prefix=/gnu/store/@dots{}}.
6077
6078 For packages that install stand-alone Python programs under @code{bin/},
6079 it takes care of wrapping these programs so that their @code{PYTHONPATH}
6080 environment variable points to all the Python libraries they depend on.
6081
6082 Which Python package is used to perform the build can be specified with
6083 the @code{#:python} parameter. This is a useful way to force a package
6084 to be built for a specific version of the Python interpreter, which
6085 might be necessary if the package is only compatible with a single
6086 interpreter version.
6087
6088 By default guix calls @code{setup.py} under control of
6089 @code{setuptools}, much like @command{pip} does. Some packages are not
6090 compatible with setuptools (and pip), thus you can disable this by
6091 setting the @code{#:use-setuptools} parameter to @code{#f}.
6092 @end defvr
6093
6094 @defvr {Scheme Variable} perl-build-system
6095 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system perl)}. It
6096 implements the standard build procedure for Perl packages, which either
6097 consists in running @code{perl Build.PL --prefix=/gnu/store/@dots{}},
6098 followed by @code{Build} and @code{Build install}; or in running
6099 @code{perl Makefile.PL PREFIX=/gnu/store/@dots{}}, followed by
6100 @code{make} and @code{make install}, depending on which of
6101 @code{Build.PL} or @code{Makefile.PL} is present in the package
6102 distribution. Preference is given to the former if both @code{Build.PL}
6103 and @code{Makefile.PL} exist in the package distribution. This
6104 preference can be reversed by specifying @code{#t} for the
6105 @code{#:make-maker?} parameter.
6106
6107 The initial @code{perl Makefile.PL} or @code{perl Build.PL} invocation
6108 passes flags specified by the @code{#:make-maker-flags} or
6109 @code{#:module-build-flags} parameter, respectively.
6110
6111 Which Perl package is used can be specified with @code{#:perl}.
6112 @end defvr
6113
6114 @defvr {Scheme Variable} r-build-system
6115 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system r)}. It
6116 implements the build procedure used by @uref{https://r-project.org, R}
6117 packages, which essentially is little more than running @code{R CMD
6118 INSTALL --library=/gnu/store/@dots{}} in an environment where
6119 @code{R_LIBS_SITE} contains the paths to all R package inputs. Tests
6120 are run after installation using the R function
6121 @code{tools::testInstalledPackage}.
6122 @end defvr
6123
6124 @defvr {Scheme Variable} rakudo-build-system
6125 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system rakudo)}. It
6126 implements the build procedure used by @uref{https://rakudo.org/,
6127 Rakudo} for @uref{https://perl6.org/, Perl6} packages. It installs the
6128 package to @code{/gnu/store/@dots{}/NAME-VERSION/share/perl6} and
6129 installs the binaries, library files and the resources, as well as wrap
6130 the files under the @code{bin/} directory. Tests can be skipped by
6131 passing @code{#f} to the @code{tests?} parameter.
6132
6133 Which rakudo package is used can be specified with @code{rakudo}.
6134 Which perl6-tap-harness package used for the tests can be specified with
6135 @code{#:prove6} or removed by passing @code{#f} to the
6136 @code{with-prove6?} parameter.
6137 Which perl6-zef package used for tests and installing can be specified
6138 with @code{#:zef} or removed by passing @code{#f} to the
6139 @code{with-zef?} parameter.
6140 @end defvr
6141
6142 @defvr {Scheme Variable} texlive-build-system
6143 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system texlive)}. It is
6144 used to build TeX packages in batch mode with a specified engine. The
6145 build system sets the @code{TEXINPUTS} variable to find all TeX source
6146 files in the inputs.
6147
6148 By default it runs @code{luatex} on all files ending on @code{ins}. A
6149 different engine and format can be specified with the
6150 @code{#:tex-format} argument. Different build targets can be specified
6151 with the @code{#:build-targets} argument, which expects a list of file
6152 names. The build system adds only @code{texlive-bin} and
6153 @code{texlive-latex-base} (both from @code{(gnu packages tex}) to the
6154 inputs. Both can be overridden with the arguments @code{#:texlive-bin}
6155 and @code{#:texlive-latex-base}, respectively.
6156
6157 The @code{#:tex-directory} parameter tells the build system where to
6158 install the built files under the texmf tree.
6159 @end defvr
6160
6161 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ruby-build-system
6162 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system ruby)}. It
6163 implements the RubyGems build procedure used by Ruby packages, which
6164 involves running @code{gem build} followed by @code{gem install}.
6165
6166 The @code{source} field of a package that uses this build system
6167 typically references a gem archive, since this is the format that Ruby
6168 developers use when releasing their software. The build system unpacks
6169 the gem archive, potentially patches the source, runs the test suite,
6170 repackages the gem, and installs it. Additionally, directories and
6171 tarballs may be referenced to allow building unreleased gems from Git or
6172 a traditional source release tarball.
6173
6174 Which Ruby package is used can be specified with the @code{#:ruby}
6175 parameter. A list of additional flags to be passed to the @command{gem}
6176 command can be specified with the @code{#:gem-flags} parameter.
6177 @end defvr
6178
6179 @defvr {Scheme Variable} waf-build-system
6180 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system waf)}. It
6181 implements a build procedure around the @code{waf} script. The common
6182 phases---@code{configure}, @code{build}, and @code{install}---are
6183 implemented by passing their names as arguments to the @code{waf}
6184 script.
6185
6186 The @code{waf} script is executed by the Python interpreter. Which
6187 Python package is used to run the script can be specified with the
6188 @code{#:python} parameter.
6189 @end defvr
6190
6191 @defvr {Scheme Variable} scons-build-system
6192 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system scons)}. It
6193 implements the build procedure used by the SCons software construction
6194 tool. This build system runs @code{scons} to build the package,
6195 @code{scons test} to run tests, and then @code{scons install} to install
6196 the package.
6197
6198 Additional flags to be passed to @code{scons} can be specified with the
6199 @code{#:scons-flags} parameter. The version of Python used to run SCons
6200 can be specified by selecting the appropriate SCons package with the
6201 @code{#:scons} parameter.
6202 @end defvr
6203
6204 @defvr {Scheme Variable} haskell-build-system
6205 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system haskell)}. It
6206 implements the Cabal build procedure used by Haskell packages, which
6207 involves running @code{runhaskell Setup.hs configure
6208 --prefix=/gnu/store/@dots{}} and @code{runhaskell Setup.hs build}.
6209 Instead of installing the package by running @code{runhaskell Setup.hs
6210 install}, to avoid trying to register libraries in the read-only
6211 compiler store directory, the build system uses @code{runhaskell
6212 Setup.hs copy}, followed by @code{runhaskell Setup.hs register}. In
6213 addition, the build system generates the package documentation by
6214 running @code{runhaskell Setup.hs haddock}, unless @code{#:haddock? #f}
6215 is passed. Optional Haddock parameters can be passed with the help of
6216 the @code{#:haddock-flags} parameter. If the file @code{Setup.hs} is
6217 not found, the build system looks for @code{Setup.lhs} instead.
6218
6219 Which Haskell compiler is used can be specified with the @code{#:haskell}
6220 parameter which defaults to @code{ghc}.
6221 @end defvr
6222
6223 @defvr {Scheme Variable} dub-build-system
6224 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system dub)}. It
6225 implements the Dub build procedure used by D packages, which
6226 involves running @code{dub build} and @code{dub run}.
6227 Installation is done by copying the files manually.
6228
6229 Which D compiler is used can be specified with the @code{#:ldc}
6230 parameter which defaults to @code{ldc}.
6231 @end defvr
6232
6233 @defvr {Scheme Variable} emacs-build-system
6234 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system emacs)}. It
6235 implements an installation procedure similar to the packaging system
6236 of Emacs itself (@pxref{Packages,,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}).
6237
6238 It first creates the @code{@var{package}-autoloads.el} file, then it
6239 byte compiles all Emacs Lisp files. Differently from the Emacs
6240 packaging system, the Info documentation files are moved to the standard
6241 documentation directory and the @file{dir} file is deleted. Each
6242 package is installed in its own directory under
6243 @file{share/emacs/site-lisp/guix.d}.
6244 @end defvr
6245
6246 @defvr {Scheme Variable} font-build-system
6247 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system font)}. It
6248 implements an installation procedure for font packages where upstream
6249 provides pre-compiled TrueType, OpenType, etc.@: font files that merely
6250 need to be copied into place. It copies font files to standard
6251 locations in the output directory.
6252 @end defvr
6253
6254 @defvr {Scheme Variable} meson-build-system
6255 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system meson)}. It
6256 implements the build procedure for packages that use
6257 @url{https://mesonbuild.com, Meson} as their build system.
6258
6259 It adds both Meson and @uref{https://ninja-build.org/, Ninja} to the set
6260 of inputs, and they can be changed with the parameters @code{#:meson}
6261 and @code{#:ninja} if needed. The default Meson is
6262 @code{meson-for-build}, which is special because it doesn't clear the
6263 @code{RUNPATH} of binaries and libraries when they are installed.
6264
6265 This build system is an extension of @var{gnu-build-system}, but with the
6266 following phases changed to some specific for Meson:
6267
6268 @table @code
6269
6270 @item configure
6271 The phase runs @code{meson} with the flags specified in
6272 @code{#:configure-flags}. The flag @code{--build-type} is always set to
6273 @code{plain} unless something else is specified in @code{#:build-type}.
6274
6275 @item build
6276 The phase runs @code{ninja} to build the package in parallel by default, but
6277 this can be changed with @code{#:parallel-build?}.
6278
6279 @item check
6280 The phase runs @code{ninja} with the target specified in @code{#:test-target},
6281 which is @code{"test"} by default.
6282
6283 @item install
6284 The phase runs @code{ninja install} and can not be changed.
6285 @end table
6286
6287 Apart from that, the build system also adds the following phases:
6288
6289 @table @code
6290
6291 @item fix-runpath
6292 This phase ensures that all binaries can find the libraries they need.
6293 It searches for required libraries in subdirectories of the package being
6294 built, and adds those to @code{RUNPATH} where needed. It also removes
6295 references to libraries left over from the build phase by
6296 @code{meson-for-build}, such as test dependencies, that aren't actually
6297 required for the program to run.
6298
6299 @item glib-or-gtk-wrap
6300 This phase is the phase provided by @code{glib-or-gtk-build-system}, and it
6301 is not enabled by default. It can be enabled with @code{#:glib-or-gtk?}.
6302
6303 @item glib-or-gtk-compile-schemas
6304 This phase is the phase provided by @code{glib-or-gtk-build-system}, and it
6305 is not enabled by default. It can be enabled with @code{#:glib-or-gtk?}.
6306 @end table
6307 @end defvr
6308
6309 @defvr {Scheme Variable} linux-module-build-system
6310 @var{linux-module-build-system} allows building Linux kernel modules.
6311
6312 @cindex build phases
6313 This build system is an extension of @var{gnu-build-system}, but with the
6314 following phases changed:
6315
6316 @table @code
6317
6318 @item configure
6319 This phase configures the environment so that the Linux kernel's Makefile
6320 can be used to build the external kernel module.
6321
6322 @item build
6323 This phase uses the Linux kernel's Makefile in order to build the external
6324 kernel module.
6325
6326 @item install
6327 This phase uses the Linux kernel's Makefile in order to install the external
6328 kernel module.
6329 @end table
6330
6331 It is possible and useful to specify the Linux kernel to use for building
6332 the module (in the "arguments" form of a package using the
6333 linux-module-build-system, use the key #:linux to specify it).
6334 @end defvr
6335
6336 Lastly, for packages that do not need anything as sophisticated, a
6337 ``trivial'' build system is provided. It is trivial in the sense that
6338 it provides basically no support: it does not pull any implicit inputs,
6339 and does not have a notion of build phases.
6340
6341 @defvr {Scheme Variable} trivial-build-system
6342 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system trivial)}.
6343
6344 This build system requires a @code{#:builder} argument. This argument
6345 must be a Scheme expression that builds the package output(s)---as
6346 with @code{build-expression->derivation} (@pxref{Derivations,
6347 @code{build-expression->derivation}}).
6348 @end defvr
6349
6350 @node The Store
6351 @section The Store
6352
6353 @cindex store
6354 @cindex store items
6355 @cindex store paths
6356
6357 Conceptually, the @dfn{store} is the place where derivations that have
6358 been built successfully are stored---by default, @file{/gnu/store}.
6359 Sub-directories in the store are referred to as @dfn{store items} or
6360 sometimes @dfn{store paths}. The store has an associated database that
6361 contains information such as the store paths referred to by each store
6362 path, and the list of @emph{valid} store items---results of successful
6363 builds. This database resides in @file{@var{localstatedir}/guix/db},
6364 where @var{localstatedir} is the state directory specified @i{via}
6365 @option{--localstatedir} at configure time, usually @file{/var}.
6366
6367 The store is @emph{always} accessed by the daemon on behalf of its clients
6368 (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon}). To manipulate the store, clients
6369 connect to the daemon over a Unix-domain socket, send requests to it,
6370 and read the result---these are remote procedure calls, or RPCs.
6371
6372 @quotation Note
6373 Users must @emph{never} modify files under @file{/gnu/store} directly.
6374 This would lead to inconsistencies and break the immutability
6375 assumptions of Guix's functional model (@pxref{Introduction}).
6376
6377 @xref{Invoking guix gc, @command{guix gc --verify}}, for information on
6378 how to check the integrity of the store and attempt recovery from
6379 accidental modifications.
6380 @end quotation
6381
6382 The @code{(guix store)} module provides procedures to connect to the
6383 daemon, and to perform RPCs. These are described below. By default,
6384 @code{open-connection}, and thus all the @command{guix} commands,
6385 connect to the local daemon or to the URI specified by the
6386 @code{GUIX_DAEMON_SOCKET} environment variable.
6387
6388 @defvr {Environment Variable} GUIX_DAEMON_SOCKET
6389 When set, the value of this variable should be a file name or a URI
6390 designating the daemon endpoint. When it is a file name, it denotes a
6391 Unix-domain socket to connect to. In addition to file names, the
6392 supported URI schemes are:
6393
6394 @table @code
6395 @item file
6396 @itemx unix
6397 These are for Unix-domain sockets.
6398 @code{file:///var/guix/daemon-socket/socket} is equivalent to
6399 @file{/var/guix/daemon-socket/socket}.
6400
6401 @item guix
6402 @cindex daemon, remote access
6403 @cindex remote access to the daemon
6404 @cindex daemon, cluster setup
6405 @cindex clusters, daemon setup
6406 These URIs denote connections over TCP/IP, without encryption nor
6407 authentication of the remote host. The URI must specify the host name
6408 and optionally a port number (by default port 44146 is used):
6409
6410 @example
6411 guix://master.guix.example.org:1234
6412 @end example
6413
6414 This setup is suitable on local networks, such as clusters, where only
6415 trusted nodes may connect to the build daemon at
6416 @code{master.guix.example.org}.
6417
6418 The @code{--listen} option of @command{guix-daemon} can be used to
6419 instruct it to listen for TCP connections (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon,
6420 @code{--listen}}).
6421
6422 @item ssh
6423 @cindex SSH access to build daemons
6424 These URIs allow you to connect to a remote daemon over
6425 SSH@footnote{This feature requires Guile-SSH (@pxref{Requirements}).}.
6426 A typical URL might look like this:
6427
6428 @example
6429 ssh://charlie@@guix.example.org:22
6430 @end example
6431
6432 As for @command{guix copy}, the usual OpenSSH client configuration files
6433 are honored (@pxref{Invoking guix copy}).
6434 @end table
6435
6436 Additional URI schemes may be supported in the future.
6437
6438 @c XXX: Remove this note when the protocol incurs fewer round trips
6439 @c and when (guix derivations) no longer relies on file system access.
6440 @quotation Note
6441 The ability to connect to remote build daemons is considered
6442 experimental as of @value{VERSION}. Please get in touch with us to
6443 share any problems or suggestions you may have (@pxref{Contributing}).
6444 @end quotation
6445 @end defvr
6446
6447 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} open-connection [@var{uri}] [#:reserve-space? #t]
6448 Connect to the daemon over the Unix-domain socket at @var{uri} (a string). When
6449 @var{reserve-space?} is true, instruct it to reserve a little bit of
6450 extra space on the file system so that the garbage collector can still
6451 operate should the disk become full. Return a server object.
6452
6453 @var{file} defaults to @code{%default-socket-path}, which is the normal
6454 location given the options that were passed to @command{configure}.
6455 @end deffn
6456
6457 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} close-connection @var{server}
6458 Close the connection to @var{server}.
6459 @end deffn
6460
6461 @defvr {Scheme Variable} current-build-output-port
6462 This variable is bound to a SRFI-39 parameter, which refers to the port
6463 where build and error logs sent by the daemon should be written.
6464 @end defvr
6465
6466 Procedures that make RPCs all take a server object as their first
6467 argument.
6468
6469 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} valid-path? @var{server} @var{path}
6470 @cindex invalid store items
6471 Return @code{#t} when @var{path} designates a valid store item and
6472 @code{#f} otherwise (an invalid item may exist on disk but still be
6473 invalid, for instance because it is the result of an aborted or failed
6474 build.)
6475
6476 A @code{&store-protocol-error} condition is raised if @var{path} is not
6477 prefixed by the store directory (@file{/gnu/store}).
6478 @end deffn
6479
6480 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} add-text-to-store @var{server} @var{name} @var{text} [@var{references}]
6481 Add @var{text} under file @var{name} in the store, and return its store
6482 path. @var{references} is the list of store paths referred to by the
6483 resulting store path.
6484 @end deffn
6485
6486 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} build-derivations @var{store} @var{derivations} @
6487 [@var{mode}]
6488 Build @var{derivations}, a list of @code{<derivation>} objects, @file{.drv}
6489 file names, or derivation/output pairs, using the specified
6490 @var{mode}---@code{(build-mode normal)} by default.
6491 @end deffn
6492
6493 Note that the @code{(guix monads)} module provides a monad as well as
6494 monadic versions of the above procedures, with the goal of making it
6495 more convenient to work with code that accesses the store (@pxref{The
6496 Store Monad}).
6497
6498 @c FIXME
6499 @i{This section is currently incomplete.}
6500
6501 @node Derivations
6502 @section Derivations
6503
6504 @cindex derivations
6505 Low-level build actions and the environment in which they are performed
6506 are represented by @dfn{derivations}. A derivation contains the
6507 following pieces of information:
6508
6509 @itemize
6510 @item
6511 The outputs of the derivation---derivations produce at least one file or
6512 directory in the store, but may produce more.
6513
6514 @item
6515 @cindex build-time dependencies
6516 @cindex dependencies, build-time
6517 The inputs of the derivations---i.e., its build-time dependencies---which may
6518 be other derivations or plain files in the store (patches, build scripts,
6519 etc.)
6520
6521 @item
6522 The system type targeted by the derivation---e.g., @code{x86_64-linux}.
6523
6524 @item
6525 The file name of a build script in the store, along with the arguments
6526 to be passed.
6527
6528 @item
6529 A list of environment variables to be defined.
6530
6531 @end itemize
6532
6533 @cindex derivation path
6534 Derivations allow clients of the daemon to communicate build actions to
6535 the store. They exist in two forms: as an in-memory representation,
6536 both on the client- and daemon-side, and as files in the store whose
6537 name end in @code{.drv}---these files are referred to as @dfn{derivation
6538 paths}. Derivations paths can be passed to the @code{build-derivations}
6539 procedure to perform the build actions they prescribe (@pxref{The
6540 Store}).
6541
6542 @cindex fixed-output derivations
6543 Operations such as file downloads and version-control checkouts for
6544 which the expected content hash is known in advance are modeled as
6545 @dfn{fixed-output derivations}. Unlike regular derivations, the outputs
6546 of a fixed-output derivation are independent of its inputs---e.g., a
6547 source code download produces the same result regardless of the download
6548 method and tools being used.
6549
6550 @cindex references
6551 @cindex run-time dependencies
6552 @cindex dependencies, run-time
6553 The outputs of derivations---i.e., the build results---have a set of
6554 @dfn{references}, as reported by the @code{references} RPC or the
6555 @command{guix gc --references} command (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}). References
6556 are the set of run-time dependencies of the build results. References are a
6557 subset of the inputs of the derivation; this subset is automatically computed
6558 by the build daemon by scanning all the files in the outputs.
6559
6560 The @code{(guix derivations)} module provides a representation of
6561 derivations as Scheme objects, along with procedures to create and
6562 otherwise manipulate derivations. The lowest-level primitive to create
6563 a derivation is the @code{derivation} procedure:
6564
6565 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} derivation @var{store} @var{name} @var{builder} @
6566 @var{args} [#:outputs '("out")] [#:hash #f] [#:hash-algo #f] @
6567 [#:recursive? #f] [#:inputs '()] [#:env-vars '()] @
6568 [#:system (%current-system)] [#:references-graphs #f] @
6569 [#:allowed-references #f] [#:disallowed-references #f] @
6570 [#:leaked-env-vars #f] [#:local-build? #f] @
6571 [#:substitutable? #t] [#:properties '()]
6572 Build a derivation with the given arguments, and return the resulting
6573 @code{<derivation>} object.
6574
6575 When @var{hash} and @var{hash-algo} are given, a
6576 @dfn{fixed-output derivation} is created---i.e., one whose result is
6577 known in advance, such as a file download. If, in addition,
6578 @var{recursive?} is true, then that fixed output may be an executable
6579 file or a directory and @var{hash} must be the hash of an archive
6580 containing this output.
6581
6582 When @var{references-graphs} is true, it must be a list of file
6583 name/store path pairs. In that case, the reference graph of each store
6584 path is exported in the build environment in the corresponding file, in
6585 a simple text format.
6586
6587 When @var{allowed-references} is true, it must be a list of store items
6588 or outputs that the derivation's output may refer to. Likewise,
6589 @var{disallowed-references}, if true, must be a list of things the
6590 outputs may @emph{not} refer to.
6591
6592 When @var{leaked-env-vars} is true, it must be a list of strings
6593 denoting environment variables that are allowed to ``leak'' from the
6594 daemon's environment to the build environment. This is only applicable
6595 to fixed-output derivations---i.e., when @var{hash} is true. The main
6596 use is to allow variables such as @code{http_proxy} to be passed to
6597 derivations that download files.
6598
6599 When @var{local-build?} is true, declare that the derivation is not a
6600 good candidate for offloading and should rather be built locally
6601 (@pxref{Daemon Offload Setup}). This is the case for small derivations
6602 where the costs of data transfers would outweigh the benefits.
6603
6604 When @var{substitutable?} is false, declare that substitutes of the
6605 derivation's output should not be used (@pxref{Substitutes}). This is
6606 useful, for instance, when building packages that capture details of the
6607 host CPU instruction set.
6608
6609 @var{properties} must be an association list describing ``properties'' of the
6610 derivation. It is kept as-is, uninterpreted, in the derivation.
6611 @end deffn
6612
6613 @noindent
6614 Here's an example with a shell script as its builder, assuming
6615 @var{store} is an open connection to the daemon, and @var{bash} points
6616 to a Bash executable in the store:
6617
6618 @lisp
6619 (use-modules (guix utils)
6620 (guix store)
6621 (guix derivations))
6622
6623 (let ((builder ; add the Bash script to the store
6624 (add-text-to-store store "my-builder.sh"
6625 "echo hello world > $out\n" '())))
6626 (derivation store "foo"
6627 bash `("-e" ,builder)
6628 #:inputs `((,bash) (,builder))
6629 #:env-vars '(("HOME" . "/homeless"))))
6630 @result{} #<derivation /gnu/store/@dots{}-foo.drv => /gnu/store/@dots{}-foo>
6631 @end lisp
6632
6633 As can be guessed, this primitive is cumbersome to use directly. A
6634 better approach is to write build scripts in Scheme, of course! The
6635 best course of action for that is to write the build code as a
6636 ``G-expression'', and to pass it to @code{gexp->derivation}. For more
6637 information, @pxref{G-Expressions}.
6638
6639 Once upon a time, @code{gexp->derivation} did not exist and constructing
6640 derivations with build code written in Scheme was achieved with
6641 @code{build-expression->derivation}, documented below. This procedure
6642 is now deprecated in favor of the much nicer @code{gexp->derivation}.
6643
6644 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} build-expression->derivation @var{store} @
6645 @var{name} @var{exp} @
6646 [#:system (%current-system)] [#:inputs '()] @
6647 [#:outputs '("out")] [#:hash #f] [#:hash-algo #f] @
6648 [#:recursive? #f] [#:env-vars '()] [#:modules '()] @
6649 [#:references-graphs #f] [#:allowed-references #f] @
6650 [#:disallowed-references #f] @
6651 [#:local-build? #f] [#:substitutable? #t] [#:guile-for-build #f]
6652 Return a derivation that executes Scheme expression @var{exp} as a
6653 builder for derivation @var{name}. @var{inputs} must be a list of
6654 @code{(name drv-path sub-drv)} tuples; when @var{sub-drv} is omitted,
6655 @code{"out"} is assumed. @var{modules} is a list of names of Guile
6656 modules from the current search path to be copied in the store,
6657 compiled, and made available in the load path during the execution of
6658 @var{exp}---e.g., @code{((guix build utils) (guix build
6659 gnu-build-system))}.
6660
6661 @var{exp} is evaluated in an environment where @code{%outputs} is bound
6662 to a list of output/path pairs, and where @code{%build-inputs} is bound
6663 to a list of string/output-path pairs made from @var{inputs}.
6664 Optionally, @var{env-vars} is a list of string pairs specifying the name
6665 and value of environment variables visible to the builder. The builder
6666 terminates by passing the result of @var{exp} to @code{exit}; thus, when
6667 @var{exp} returns @code{#f}, the build is considered to have failed.
6668
6669 @var{exp} is built using @var{guile-for-build} (a derivation). When
6670 @var{guile-for-build} is omitted or is @code{#f}, the value of the
6671 @code{%guile-for-build} fluid is used instead.
6672
6673 See the @code{derivation} procedure for the meaning of
6674 @var{references-graphs}, @var{allowed-references},
6675 @var{disallowed-references}, @var{local-build?}, and
6676 @var{substitutable?}.
6677 @end deffn
6678
6679 @noindent
6680 Here's an example of a single-output derivation that creates a directory
6681 containing one file:
6682
6683 @lisp
6684 (let ((builder '(let ((out (assoc-ref %outputs "out")))
6685 (mkdir out) ; create /gnu/store/@dots{}-goo
6686 (call-with-output-file (string-append out "/test")
6687 (lambda (p)
6688 (display '(hello guix) p))))))
6689 (build-expression->derivation store "goo" builder))
6690
6691 @result{} #<derivation /gnu/store/@dots{}-goo.drv => @dots{}>
6692 @end lisp
6693
6694
6695 @node The Store Monad
6696 @section The Store Monad
6697
6698 @cindex monad
6699
6700 The procedures that operate on the store described in the previous
6701 sections all take an open connection to the build daemon as their first
6702 argument. Although the underlying model is functional, they either have
6703 side effects or depend on the current state of the store.
6704
6705 The former is inconvenient: the connection to the build daemon has to be
6706 carried around in all those functions, making it impossible to compose
6707 functions that do not take that parameter with functions that do. The
6708 latter can be problematic: since store operations have side effects
6709 and/or depend on external state, they have to be properly sequenced.
6710
6711 @cindex monadic values
6712 @cindex monadic functions
6713 This is where the @code{(guix monads)} module comes in. This module
6714 provides a framework for working with @dfn{monads}, and a particularly
6715 useful monad for our uses, the @dfn{store monad}. Monads are a
6716 construct that allows two things: associating ``context'' with values
6717 (in our case, the context is the store), and building sequences of
6718 computations (here computations include accesses to the store). Values
6719 in a monad---values that carry this additional context---are called
6720 @dfn{monadic values}; procedures that return such values are called
6721 @dfn{monadic procedures}.
6722
6723 Consider this ``normal'' procedure:
6724
6725 @example
6726 (define (sh-symlink store)
6727 ;; Return a derivation that symlinks the 'bash' executable.
6728 (let* ((drv (package-derivation store bash))
6729 (out (derivation->output-path drv))
6730 (sh (string-append out "/bin/bash")))
6731 (build-expression->derivation store "sh"
6732 `(symlink ,sh %output))))
6733 @end example
6734
6735 Using @code{(guix monads)} and @code{(guix gexp)}, it may be rewritten
6736 as a monadic function:
6737
6738 @example
6739 (define (sh-symlink)
6740 ;; Same, but return a monadic value.
6741 (mlet %store-monad ((drv (package->derivation bash)))
6742 (gexp->derivation "sh"
6743 #~(symlink (string-append #$drv "/bin/bash")
6744 #$output))))
6745 @end example
6746
6747 There are several things to note in the second version: the @code{store}
6748 parameter is now implicit and is ``threaded'' in the calls to the
6749 @code{package->derivation} and @code{gexp->derivation} monadic
6750 procedures, and the monadic value returned by @code{package->derivation}
6751 is @dfn{bound} using @code{mlet} instead of plain @code{let}.
6752
6753 As it turns out, the call to @code{package->derivation} can even be
6754 omitted since it will take place implicitly, as we will see later
6755 (@pxref{G-Expressions}):
6756
6757 @example
6758 (define (sh-symlink)
6759 (gexp->derivation "sh"
6760 #~(symlink (string-append #$bash "/bin/bash")
6761 #$output)))
6762 @end example
6763
6764 @c See
6765 @c <https://syntaxexclamation.wordpress.com/2014/06/26/escaping-continuations/>
6766 @c for the funny quote.
6767 Calling the monadic @code{sh-symlink} has no effect. As someone once
6768 said, ``you exit a monad like you exit a building on fire: by running''.
6769 So, to exit the monad and get the desired effect, one must use
6770 @code{run-with-store}:
6771
6772 @example
6773 (run-with-store (open-connection) (sh-symlink))
6774 @result{} /gnu/store/...-sh-symlink
6775 @end example
6776
6777 Note that the @code{(guix monad-repl)} module extends the Guile REPL with
6778 new ``meta-commands'' to make it easier to deal with monadic procedures:
6779 @code{run-in-store}, and @code{enter-store-monad}. The former is used
6780 to ``run'' a single monadic value through the store:
6781
6782 @example
6783 scheme@@(guile-user)> ,run-in-store (package->derivation hello)
6784 $1 = #<derivation /gnu/store/@dots{}-hello-2.9.drv => @dots{}>
6785 @end example
6786
6787 The latter enters a recursive REPL, where all the return values are
6788 automatically run through the store:
6789
6790 @example
6791 scheme@@(guile-user)> ,enter-store-monad
6792 store-monad@@(guile-user) [1]> (package->derivation hello)
6793 $2 = #<derivation /gnu/store/@dots{}-hello-2.9.drv => @dots{}>
6794 store-monad@@(guile-user) [1]> (text-file "foo" "Hello!")
6795 $3 = "/gnu/store/@dots{}-foo"
6796 store-monad@@(guile-user) [1]> ,q
6797 scheme@@(guile-user)>
6798 @end example
6799
6800 @noindent
6801 Note that non-monadic values cannot be returned in the
6802 @code{store-monad} REPL.
6803
6804 The main syntactic forms to deal with monads in general are provided by
6805 the @code{(guix monads)} module and are described below.
6806
6807 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} with-monad @var{monad} @var{body} ...
6808 Evaluate any @code{>>=} or @code{return} forms in @var{body} as being
6809 in @var{monad}.
6810 @end deffn
6811
6812 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} return @var{val}
6813 Return a monadic value that encapsulates @var{val}.
6814 @end deffn
6815
6816 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} >>= @var{mval} @var{mproc} ...
6817 @dfn{Bind} monadic value @var{mval}, passing its ``contents'' to monadic
6818 procedures @var{mproc}@dots{}@footnote{This operation is commonly
6819 referred to as ``bind'', but that name denotes an unrelated procedure in
6820 Guile. Thus we use this somewhat cryptic symbol inherited from the
6821 Haskell language.}. There can be one @var{mproc} or several of them, as
6822 in this example:
6823
6824 @example
6825 (run-with-state
6826 (with-monad %state-monad
6827 (>>= (return 1)
6828 (lambda (x) (return (+ 1 x)))
6829 (lambda (x) (return (* 2 x)))))
6830 'some-state)
6831
6832 @result{} 4
6833 @result{} some-state
6834 @end example
6835 @end deffn
6836
6837 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} mlet @var{monad} ((@var{var} @var{mval}) ...) @
6838 @var{body} ...
6839 @deffnx {Scheme Syntax} mlet* @var{monad} ((@var{var} @var{mval}) ...) @
6840 @var{body} ...
6841 Bind the variables @var{var} to the monadic values @var{mval} in
6842 @var{body}, which is a sequence of expressions. As with the bind
6843 operator, this can be thought of as ``unpacking'' the raw, non-monadic
6844 value ``contained'' in @var{mval} and making @var{var} refer to that
6845 raw, non-monadic value within the scope of the @var{body}. The form
6846 (@var{var} -> @var{val}) binds @var{var} to the ``normal'' value
6847 @var{val}, as per @code{let}. The binding operations occur in sequence
6848 from left to right. The last expression of @var{body} must be a monadic
6849 expression, and its result will become the result of the @code{mlet} or
6850 @code{mlet*} when run in the @var{monad}.
6851
6852 @code{mlet*} is to @code{mlet} what @code{let*} is to @code{let}
6853 (@pxref{Local Bindings,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}).
6854 @end deffn
6855
6856 @deffn {Scheme System} mbegin @var{monad} @var{mexp} ...
6857 Bind @var{mexp} and the following monadic expressions in sequence,
6858 returning the result of the last expression. Every expression in the
6859 sequence must be a monadic expression.
6860
6861 This is akin to @code{mlet}, except that the return values of the
6862 monadic expressions are ignored. In that sense, it is analogous to
6863 @code{begin}, but applied to monadic expressions.
6864 @end deffn
6865
6866 @deffn {Scheme System} mwhen @var{condition} @var{mexp0} @var{mexp*} ...
6867 When @var{condition} is true, evaluate the sequence of monadic
6868 expressions @var{mexp0}..@var{mexp*} as in an @code{mbegin}. When
6869 @var{condition} is false, return @code{*unspecified*} in the current
6870 monad. Every expression in the sequence must be a monadic expression.
6871 @end deffn
6872
6873 @deffn {Scheme System} munless @var{condition} @var{mexp0} @var{mexp*} ...
6874 When @var{condition} is false, evaluate the sequence of monadic
6875 expressions @var{mexp0}..@var{mexp*} as in an @code{mbegin}. When
6876 @var{condition} is true, return @code{*unspecified*} in the current
6877 monad. Every expression in the sequence must be a monadic expression.
6878 @end deffn
6879
6880 @cindex state monad
6881 The @code{(guix monads)} module provides the @dfn{state monad}, which
6882 allows an additional value---the state---to be @emph{threaded} through
6883 monadic procedure calls.
6884
6885 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %state-monad
6886 The state monad. Procedures in the state monad can access and change
6887 the state that is threaded.
6888
6889 Consider the example below. The @code{square} procedure returns a value
6890 in the state monad. It returns the square of its argument, but also
6891 increments the current state value:
6892
6893 @example
6894 (define (square x)
6895 (mlet %state-monad ((count (current-state)))
6896 (mbegin %state-monad
6897 (set-current-state (+ 1 count))
6898 (return (* x x)))))
6899
6900 (run-with-state (sequence %state-monad (map square (iota 3))) 0)
6901 @result{} (0 1 4)
6902 @result{} 3
6903 @end example
6904
6905 When ``run'' through @var{%state-monad}, we obtain that additional state
6906 value, which is the number of @code{square} calls.
6907 @end defvr
6908
6909 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} current-state
6910 Return the current state as a monadic value.
6911 @end deffn
6912
6913 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} set-current-state @var{value}
6914 Set the current state to @var{value} and return the previous state as a
6915 monadic value.
6916 @end deffn
6917
6918 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} state-push @var{value}
6919 Push @var{value} to the current state, which is assumed to be a list,
6920 and return the previous state as a monadic value.
6921 @end deffn
6922
6923 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} state-pop
6924 Pop a value from the current state and return it as a monadic value.
6925 The state is assumed to be a list.
6926 @end deffn
6927
6928 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} run-with-state @var{mval} [@var{state}]
6929 Run monadic value @var{mval} starting with @var{state} as the initial
6930 state. Return two values: the resulting value, and the resulting state.
6931 @end deffn
6932
6933 The main interface to the store monad, provided by the @code{(guix
6934 store)} module, is as follows.
6935
6936 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %store-monad
6937 The store monad---an alias for @var{%state-monad}.
6938
6939 Values in the store monad encapsulate accesses to the store. When its
6940 effect is needed, a value of the store monad must be ``evaluated'' by
6941 passing it to the @code{run-with-store} procedure (see below.)
6942 @end defvr
6943
6944 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} run-with-store @var{store} @var{mval} [#:guile-for-build] [#:system (%current-system)]
6945 Run @var{mval}, a monadic value in the store monad, in @var{store}, an
6946 open store connection.
6947 @end deffn
6948
6949 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} text-file @var{name} @var{text} [@var{references}]
6950 Return as a monadic value the absolute file name in the store of the file
6951 containing @var{text}, a string. @var{references} is a list of store items that the
6952 resulting text file refers to; it defaults to the empty list.
6953 @end deffn
6954
6955 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} binary-file @var{name} @var{data} [@var{references}]
6956 Return as a monadic value the absolute file name in the store of the file
6957 containing @var{data}, a bytevector. @var{references} is a list of store
6958 items that the resulting binary file refers to; it defaults to the empty list.
6959 @end deffn
6960
6961 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} interned-file @var{file} [@var{name}] @
6962 [#:recursive? #t] [#:select? (const #t)]
6963 Return the name of @var{file} once interned in the store. Use
6964 @var{name} as its store name, or the basename of @var{file} if
6965 @var{name} is omitted.
6966
6967 When @var{recursive?} is true, the contents of @var{file} are added
6968 recursively; if @var{file} designates a flat file and @var{recursive?}
6969 is true, its contents are added, and its permission bits are kept.
6970
6971 When @var{recursive?} is true, call @code{(@var{select?} @var{file}
6972 @var{stat})} for each directory entry, where @var{file} is the entry's
6973 absolute file name and @var{stat} is the result of @code{lstat}; exclude
6974 entries for which @var{select?} does not return true.
6975
6976 The example below adds a file to the store, under two different names:
6977
6978 @example
6979 (run-with-store (open-connection)
6980 (mlet %store-monad ((a (interned-file "README"))
6981 (b (interned-file "README" "LEGU-MIN")))
6982 (return (list a b))))
6983
6984 @result{} ("/gnu/store/rwm@dots{}-README" "/gnu/store/44i@dots{}-LEGU-MIN")
6985 @end example
6986
6987 @end deffn
6988
6989 The @code{(guix packages)} module exports the following package-related
6990 monadic procedures:
6991
6992 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} package-file @var{package} [@var{file}] @
6993 [#:system (%current-system)] [#:target #f] @
6994 [#:output "out"]
6995 Return as a monadic
6996 value in the absolute file name of @var{file} within the @var{output}
6997 directory of @var{package}. When @var{file} is omitted, return the name
6998 of the @var{output} directory of @var{package}. When @var{target} is
6999 true, use it as a cross-compilation target triplet.
7000 @end deffn
7001
7002 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} package->derivation @var{package} [@var{system}]
7003 @deffnx {Monadic Procedure} package->cross-derivation @var{package} @
7004 @var{target} [@var{system}]
7005 Monadic version of @code{package-derivation} and
7006 @code{package-cross-derivation} (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
7007 @end deffn
7008
7009
7010 @node G-Expressions
7011 @section G-Expressions
7012
7013 @cindex G-expression
7014 @cindex build code quoting
7015 So we have ``derivations'', which represent a sequence of build actions
7016 to be performed to produce an item in the store (@pxref{Derivations}).
7017 These build actions are performed when asking the daemon to actually
7018 build the derivations; they are run by the daemon in a container
7019 (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon}).
7020
7021 @cindex strata of code
7022 It should come as no surprise that we like to write these build actions
7023 in Scheme. When we do that, we end up with two @dfn{strata} of Scheme
7024 code@footnote{The term @dfn{stratum} in this context was coined by
7025 Manuel Serrano et al.@: in the context of their work on Hop. Oleg
7026 Kiselyov, who has written insightful
7027 @url{http://okmij.org/ftp/meta-programming/#meta-scheme, essays and code
7028 on this topic}, refers to this kind of code generation as
7029 @dfn{staging}.}: the ``host code''---code that defines packages, talks
7030 to the daemon, etc.---and the ``build code''---code that actually
7031 performs build actions, such as making directories, invoking
7032 @command{make}, etc.
7033
7034 To describe a derivation and its build actions, one typically needs to
7035 embed build code inside host code. It boils down to manipulating build
7036 code as data, and the homoiconicity of Scheme---code has a direct
7037 representation as data---comes in handy for that. But we need more than
7038 the normal @code{quasiquote} mechanism in Scheme to construct build
7039 expressions.
7040
7041 The @code{(guix gexp)} module implements @dfn{G-expressions}, a form of
7042 S-expressions adapted to build expressions. G-expressions, or
7043 @dfn{gexps}, consist essentially of three syntactic forms: @code{gexp},
7044 @code{ungexp}, and @code{ungexp-splicing} (or simply: @code{#~},
7045 @code{#$}, and @code{#$@@}), which are comparable to
7046 @code{quasiquote}, @code{unquote}, and @code{unquote-splicing},
7047 respectively (@pxref{Expression Syntax, @code{quasiquote},, guile,
7048 GNU Guile Reference Manual}). However, there are major differences:
7049
7050 @itemize
7051 @item
7052 Gexps are meant to be written to a file and run or manipulated by other
7053 processes.
7054
7055 @item
7056 When a high-level object such as a package or derivation is unquoted
7057 inside a gexp, the result is as if its output file name had been
7058 introduced.
7059
7060 @item
7061 Gexps carry information about the packages or derivations they refer to,
7062 and these dependencies are automatically added as inputs to the build
7063 processes that use them.
7064 @end itemize
7065
7066 @cindex lowering, of high-level objects in gexps
7067 This mechanism is not limited to package and derivation
7068 objects: @dfn{compilers} able to ``lower'' other high-level objects to
7069 derivations or files in the store can be defined,
7070 such that these objects can also be inserted
7071 into gexps. For example, a useful type of high-level objects that can be
7072 inserted in a gexp is ``file-like objects'', which make it easy to
7073 add files to the store and to refer to them in
7074 derivations and such (see @code{local-file} and @code{plain-file}
7075 below.)
7076
7077 To illustrate the idea, here is an example of a gexp:
7078
7079 @example
7080 (define build-exp
7081 #~(begin
7082 (mkdir #$output)
7083 (chdir #$output)
7084 (symlink (string-append #$coreutils "/bin/ls")
7085 "list-files")))
7086 @end example
7087
7088 This gexp can be passed to @code{gexp->derivation}; we obtain a
7089 derivation that builds a directory containing exactly one symlink to
7090 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.22/bin/ls}:
7091
7092 @example
7093 (gexp->derivation "the-thing" build-exp)
7094 @end example
7095
7096 As one would expect, the @code{"/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.22"} string is
7097 substituted to the reference to the @var{coreutils} package in the
7098 actual build code, and @var{coreutils} is automatically made an input to
7099 the derivation. Likewise, @code{#$output} (equivalent to @code{(ungexp
7100 output)}) is replaced by a string containing the directory name of the
7101 output of the derivation.
7102
7103 @cindex cross compilation
7104 In a cross-compilation context, it is useful to distinguish between
7105 references to the @emph{native} build of a package---that can run on the
7106 host---versus references to cross builds of a package. To that end, the
7107 @code{#+} plays the same role as @code{#$}, but is a reference to a
7108 native package build:
7109
7110 @example
7111 (gexp->derivation "vi"
7112 #~(begin
7113 (mkdir #$output)
7114 (system* (string-append #+coreutils "/bin/ln")
7115 "-s"
7116 (string-append #$emacs "/bin/emacs")
7117 (string-append #$output "/bin/vi")))
7118 #:target "mips64el-linux-gnu")
7119 @end example
7120
7121 @noindent
7122 In the example above, the native build of @var{coreutils} is used, so
7123 that @command{ln} can actually run on the host; but then the
7124 cross-compiled build of @var{emacs} is referenced.
7125
7126 @cindex imported modules, for gexps
7127 @findex with-imported-modules
7128 Another gexp feature is @dfn{imported modules}: sometimes you want to be
7129 able to use certain Guile modules from the ``host environment'' in the
7130 gexp, so those modules should be imported in the ``build environment''.
7131 The @code{with-imported-modules} form allows you to express that:
7132
7133 @example
7134 (let ((build (with-imported-modules '((guix build utils))
7135 #~(begin
7136 (use-modules (guix build utils))
7137 (mkdir-p (string-append #$output "/bin"))))))
7138 (gexp->derivation "empty-dir"
7139 #~(begin
7140 #$build
7141 (display "success!\n")
7142 #t)))
7143 @end example
7144
7145 @noindent
7146 In this example, the @code{(guix build utils)} module is automatically
7147 pulled into the isolated build environment of our gexp, such that
7148 @code{(use-modules (guix build utils))} works as expected.
7149
7150 @cindex module closure
7151 @findex source-module-closure
7152 Usually you want the @emph{closure} of the module to be imported---i.e.,
7153 the module itself and all the modules it depends on---rather than just
7154 the module; failing to do that, attempts to use the module will fail
7155 because of missing dependent modules. The @code{source-module-closure}
7156 procedure computes the closure of a module by looking at its source file
7157 headers, which comes in handy in this case:
7158
7159 @example
7160 (use-modules (guix modules)) ;for 'source-module-closure'
7161
7162 (with-imported-modules (source-module-closure
7163 '((guix build utils)
7164 (gnu build vm)))
7165 (gexp->derivation "something-with-vms"
7166 #~(begin
7167 (use-modules (guix build utils)
7168 (gnu build vm))
7169 @dots{})))
7170 @end example
7171
7172 @cindex extensions, for gexps
7173 @findex with-extensions
7174 In the same vein, sometimes you want to import not just pure-Scheme
7175 modules, but also ``extensions'' such as Guile bindings to C libraries
7176 or other ``full-blown'' packages. Say you need the @code{guile-json}
7177 package available on the build side, here's how you would do it:
7178
7179 @example
7180 (use-modules (gnu packages guile)) ;for 'guile-json'
7181
7182 (with-extensions (list guile-json)
7183 (gexp->derivation "something-with-json"
7184 #~(begin
7185 (use-modules (json))
7186 @dots{})))
7187 @end example
7188
7189 The syntactic form to construct gexps is summarized below.
7190
7191 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} #~@var{exp}
7192 @deffnx {Scheme Syntax} (gexp @var{exp})
7193 Return a G-expression containing @var{exp}. @var{exp} may contain one
7194 or more of the following forms:
7195
7196 @table @code
7197 @item #$@var{obj}
7198 @itemx (ungexp @var{obj})
7199 Introduce a reference to @var{obj}. @var{obj} may have one of the
7200 supported types, for example a package or a
7201 derivation, in which case the @code{ungexp} form is replaced by its
7202 output file name---e.g., @code{"/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.22}.
7203
7204 If @var{obj} is a list, it is traversed and references to supported
7205 objects are substituted similarly.
7206
7207 If @var{obj} is another gexp, its contents are inserted and its
7208 dependencies are added to those of the containing gexp.
7209
7210 If @var{obj} is another kind of object, it is inserted as is.
7211
7212 @item #$@var{obj}:@var{output}
7213 @itemx (ungexp @var{obj} @var{output})
7214 This is like the form above, but referring explicitly to the
7215 @var{output} of @var{obj}---this is useful when @var{obj} produces
7216 multiple outputs (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}).
7217
7218 @item #+@var{obj}
7219 @itemx #+@var{obj}:output
7220 @itemx (ungexp-native @var{obj})
7221 @itemx (ungexp-native @var{obj} @var{output})
7222 Same as @code{ungexp}, but produces a reference to the @emph{native}
7223 build of @var{obj} when used in a cross compilation context.
7224
7225 @item #$output[:@var{output}]
7226 @itemx (ungexp output [@var{output}])
7227 Insert a reference to derivation output @var{output}, or to the main
7228 output when @var{output} is omitted.
7229
7230 This only makes sense for gexps passed to @code{gexp->derivation}.
7231
7232 @item #$@@@var{lst}
7233 @itemx (ungexp-splicing @var{lst})
7234 Like the above, but splices the contents of @var{lst} inside the
7235 containing list.
7236
7237 @item #+@@@var{lst}
7238 @itemx (ungexp-native-splicing @var{lst})
7239 Like the above, but refers to native builds of the objects listed in
7240 @var{lst}.
7241
7242 @end table
7243
7244 G-expressions created by @code{gexp} or @code{#~} are run-time objects
7245 of the @code{gexp?} type (see below.)
7246 @end deffn
7247
7248 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} with-imported-modules @var{modules} @var{body}@dots{}
7249 Mark the gexps defined in @var{body}@dots{} as requiring @var{modules}
7250 in their execution environment.
7251
7252 Each item in @var{modules} can be the name of a module, such as
7253 @code{(guix build utils)}, or it can be a module name, followed by an
7254 arrow, followed by a file-like object:
7255
7256 @example
7257 `((guix build utils)
7258 (guix gcrypt)
7259 ((guix config) => ,(scheme-file "config.scm"
7260 #~(define-module @dots{}))))
7261 @end example
7262
7263 @noindent
7264 In the example above, the first two modules are taken from the search
7265 path, and the last one is created from the given file-like object.
7266
7267 This form has @emph{lexical} scope: it has an effect on the gexps
7268 directly defined in @var{body}@dots{}, but not on those defined, say, in
7269 procedures called from @var{body}@dots{}.
7270 @end deffn
7271
7272 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} with-extensions @var{extensions} @var{body}@dots{}
7273 Mark the gexps defined in @var{body}@dots{} as requiring
7274 @var{extensions} in their build and execution environment.
7275 @var{extensions} is typically a list of package objects such as those
7276 defined in the @code{(gnu packages guile)} module.
7277
7278 Concretely, the packages listed in @var{extensions} are added to the
7279 load path while compiling imported modules in @var{body}@dots{}; they
7280 are also added to the load path of the gexp returned by
7281 @var{body}@dots{}.
7282 @end deffn
7283
7284 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} gexp? @var{obj}
7285 Return @code{#t} if @var{obj} is a G-expression.
7286 @end deffn
7287
7288 G-expressions are meant to be written to disk, either as code building
7289 some derivation, or as plain files in the store. The monadic procedures
7290 below allow you to do that (@pxref{The Store Monad}, for more
7291 information about monads.)
7292
7293 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} gexp->derivation @var{name} @var{exp} @
7294 [#:system (%current-system)] [#:target #f] [#:graft? #t] @
7295 [#:hash #f] [#:hash-algo #f] @
7296 [#:recursive? #f] [#:env-vars '()] [#:modules '()] @
7297 [#:module-path @var{%load-path}] @
7298 [#:effective-version "2.2"] @
7299 [#:references-graphs #f] [#:allowed-references #f] @
7300 [#:disallowed-references #f] @
7301 [#:leaked-env-vars #f] @
7302 [#:script-name (string-append @var{name} "-builder")] @
7303 [#:deprecation-warnings #f] @
7304 [#:local-build? #f] [#:substitutable? #t] @
7305 [#:properties '()] [#:guile-for-build #f]
7306 Return a derivation @var{name} that runs @var{exp} (a gexp) with
7307 @var{guile-for-build} (a derivation) on @var{system}; @var{exp} is
7308 stored in a file called @var{script-name}. When @var{target} is true,
7309 it is used as the cross-compilation target triplet for packages referred
7310 to by @var{exp}.
7311
7312 @var{modules} is deprecated in favor of @code{with-imported-modules}.
7313 Its meaning is to
7314 make @var{modules} available in the evaluation context of @var{exp};
7315 @var{modules} is a list of names of Guile modules searched in
7316 @var{module-path} to be copied in the store, compiled, and made available in
7317 the load path during the execution of @var{exp}---e.g., @code{((guix
7318 build utils) (guix build gnu-build-system))}.
7319
7320 @var{effective-version} determines the string to use when adding extensions of
7321 @var{exp} (see @code{with-extensions}) to the search path---e.g., @code{"2.2"}.
7322
7323 @var{graft?} determines whether packages referred to by @var{exp} should be grafted when
7324 applicable.
7325
7326 When @var{references-graphs} is true, it must be a list of tuples of one of the
7327 following forms:
7328
7329 @example
7330 (@var{file-name} @var{package})
7331 (@var{file-name} @var{package} @var{output})
7332 (@var{file-name} @var{derivation})
7333 (@var{file-name} @var{derivation} @var{output})
7334 (@var{file-name} @var{store-item})
7335 @end example
7336
7337 The right-hand-side of each element of @var{references-graphs} is automatically made
7338 an input of the build process of @var{exp}. In the build environment, each
7339 @var{file-name} contains the reference graph of the corresponding item, in a simple
7340 text format.
7341
7342 @var{allowed-references} must be either @code{#f} or a list of output names and packages.
7343 In the latter case, the list denotes store items that the result is allowed to
7344 refer to. Any reference to another store item will lead to a build error.
7345 Similarly for @var{disallowed-references}, which can list items that must not be
7346 referenced by the outputs.
7347
7348 @var{deprecation-warnings} determines whether to show deprecation warnings while
7349 compiling modules. It can be @code{#f}, @code{#t}, or @code{'detailed}.
7350
7351 The other arguments are as for @code{derivation} (@pxref{Derivations}).
7352 @end deffn
7353
7354 @cindex file-like objects
7355 The @code{local-file}, @code{plain-file}, @code{computed-file},
7356 @code{program-file}, and @code{scheme-file} procedures below return
7357 @dfn{file-like objects}. That is, when unquoted in a G-expression,
7358 these objects lead to a file in the store. Consider this G-expression:
7359
7360 @example
7361 #~(system* #$(file-append glibc "/sbin/nscd") "-f"
7362 #$(local-file "/tmp/my-nscd.conf"))
7363 @end example
7364
7365 The effect here is to ``intern'' @file{/tmp/my-nscd.conf} by copying it
7366 to the store. Once expanded, for instance @i{via}
7367 @code{gexp->derivation}, the G-expression refers to that copy under
7368 @file{/gnu/store}; thus, modifying or removing the file in @file{/tmp}
7369 does not have any effect on what the G-expression does.
7370 @code{plain-file} can be used similarly; it differs in that the file
7371 content is directly passed as a string.
7372
7373 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} local-file @var{file} [@var{name}] @
7374 [#:recursive? #f] [#:select? (const #t)]
7375 Return an object representing local file @var{file} to add to the store; this
7376 object can be used in a gexp. If @var{file} is a relative file name, it is looked
7377 up relative to the source file where this form appears. @var{file} will be added to
7378 the store under @var{name}--by default the base name of @var{file}.
7379
7380 When @var{recursive?} is true, the contents of @var{file} are added recursively; if @var{file}
7381 designates a flat file and @var{recursive?} is true, its contents are added, and its
7382 permission bits are kept.
7383
7384 When @var{recursive?} is true, call @code{(@var{select?} @var{file}
7385 @var{stat})} for each directory entry, where @var{file} is the entry's
7386 absolute file name and @var{stat} is the result of @code{lstat}; exclude
7387 entries for which @var{select?} does not return true.
7388
7389 This is the declarative counterpart of the @code{interned-file} monadic
7390 procedure (@pxref{The Store Monad, @code{interned-file}}).
7391 @end deffn
7392
7393 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} plain-file @var{name} @var{content}
7394 Return an object representing a text file called @var{name} with the given
7395 @var{content} (a string or a bytevector) to be added to the store.
7396
7397 This is the declarative counterpart of @code{text-file}.
7398 @end deffn
7399
7400 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} computed-file @var{name} @var{gexp} @
7401 [#:options '(#:local-build? #t)]
7402 Return an object representing the store item @var{name}, a file or
7403 directory computed by @var{gexp}. @var{options}
7404 is a list of additional arguments to pass to @code{gexp->derivation}.
7405
7406 This is the declarative counterpart of @code{gexp->derivation}.
7407 @end deffn
7408
7409 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} gexp->script @var{name} @var{exp} @
7410 [#:guile (default-guile)] [#:module-path %load-path]
7411 Return an executable script @var{name} that runs @var{exp} using
7412 @var{guile}, with @var{exp}'s imported modules in its search path.
7413 Look up @var{exp}'s modules in @var{module-path}.
7414
7415 The example below builds a script that simply invokes the @command{ls}
7416 command:
7417
7418 @example
7419 (use-modules (guix gexp) (gnu packages base))
7420
7421 (gexp->script "list-files"
7422 #~(execl #$(file-append coreutils "/bin/ls")
7423 "ls"))
7424 @end example
7425
7426 When ``running'' it through the store (@pxref{The Store Monad,
7427 @code{run-with-store}}), we obtain a derivation that produces an
7428 executable file @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-list-files} along these lines:
7429
7430 @example
7431 #!/gnu/store/@dots{}-guile-2.0.11/bin/guile -ds
7432 !#
7433 (execl "/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.22"/bin/ls" "ls")
7434 @end example
7435 @end deffn
7436
7437 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} program-file @var{name} @var{exp} @
7438 [#:guile #f] [#:module-path %load-path]
7439 Return an object representing the executable store item @var{name} that
7440 runs @var{gexp}. @var{guile} is the Guile package used to execute that
7441 script. Imported modules of @var{gexp} are looked up in @var{module-path}.
7442
7443 This is the declarative counterpart of @code{gexp->script}.
7444 @end deffn
7445
7446 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} gexp->file @var{name} @var{exp} @
7447 [#:set-load-path? #t] [#:module-path %load-path] @
7448 [#:splice? #f] @
7449 [#:guile (default-guile)]
7450 Return a derivation that builds a file @var{name} containing @var{exp}.
7451 When @var{splice?} is true, @var{exp} is considered to be a list of
7452 expressions that will be spliced in the resulting file.
7453
7454 When @var{set-load-path?} is true, emit code in the resulting file to
7455 set @code{%load-path} and @code{%load-compiled-path} to honor
7456 @var{exp}'s imported modules. Look up @var{exp}'s modules in
7457 @var{module-path}.
7458
7459 The resulting file holds references to all the dependencies of @var{exp}
7460 or a subset thereof.
7461 @end deffn
7462
7463 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} scheme-file @var{name} @var{exp} [#:splice? #f]
7464 Return an object representing the Scheme file @var{name} that contains
7465 @var{exp}.
7466
7467 This is the declarative counterpart of @code{gexp->file}.
7468 @end deffn
7469
7470 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} text-file* @var{name} @var{text} @dots{}
7471 Return as a monadic value a derivation that builds a text file
7472 containing all of @var{text}. @var{text} may list, in addition to
7473 strings, objects of any type that can be used in a gexp: packages,
7474 derivations, local file objects, etc. The resulting store file holds
7475 references to all these.
7476
7477 This variant should be preferred over @code{text-file} anytime the file
7478 to create will reference items from the store. This is typically the
7479 case when building a configuration file that embeds store file names,
7480 like this:
7481
7482 @example
7483 (define (profile.sh)
7484 ;; Return the name of a shell script in the store that
7485 ;; initializes the 'PATH' environment variable.
7486 (text-file* "profile.sh"
7487 "export PATH=" coreutils "/bin:"
7488 grep "/bin:" sed "/bin\n"))
7489 @end example
7490
7491 In this example, the resulting @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-profile.sh} file
7492 will reference @var{coreutils}, @var{grep}, and @var{sed}, thereby
7493 preventing them from being garbage-collected during its lifetime.
7494 @end deffn
7495
7496 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} mixed-text-file @var{name} @var{text} @dots{}
7497 Return an object representing store file @var{name} containing
7498 @var{text}. @var{text} is a sequence of strings and file-like objects,
7499 as in:
7500
7501 @example
7502 (mixed-text-file "profile"
7503 "export PATH=" coreutils "/bin:" grep "/bin")
7504 @end example
7505
7506 This is the declarative counterpart of @code{text-file*}.
7507 @end deffn
7508
7509 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} file-union @var{name} @var{files}
7510 Return a @code{<computed-file>} that builds a directory containing all of @var{files}.
7511 Each item in @var{files} must be a two-element list where the first element is the
7512 file name to use in the new directory, and the second element is a gexp
7513 denoting the target file. Here's an example:
7514
7515 @example
7516 (file-union "etc"
7517 `(("hosts" ,(plain-file "hosts"
7518 "127.0.0.1 localhost"))
7519 ("bashrc" ,(plain-file "bashrc"
7520 "alias ls='ls --color=auto'"))))
7521 @end example
7522
7523 This yields an @code{etc} directory containing these two files.
7524 @end deffn
7525
7526 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} directory-union @var{name} @var{things}
7527 Return a directory that is the union of @var{things}, where @var{things} is a list of
7528 file-like objects denoting directories. For example:
7529
7530 @example
7531 (directory-union "guile+emacs" (list guile emacs))
7532 @end example
7533
7534 yields a directory that is the union of the @code{guile} and @code{emacs} packages.
7535 @end deffn
7536
7537 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} file-append @var{obj} @var{suffix} @dots{}
7538 Return a file-like object that expands to the concatenation of @var{obj}
7539 and @var{suffix}, where @var{obj} is a lowerable object and each
7540 @var{suffix} is a string.
7541
7542 As an example, consider this gexp:
7543
7544 @example
7545 (gexp->script "run-uname"
7546 #~(system* #$(file-append coreutils
7547 "/bin/uname")))
7548 @end example
7549
7550 The same effect could be achieved with:
7551
7552 @example
7553 (gexp->script "run-uname"
7554 #~(system* (string-append #$coreutils
7555 "/bin/uname")))
7556 @end example
7557
7558 There is one difference though: in the @code{file-append} case, the
7559 resulting script contains the absolute file name as a string, whereas in
7560 the second case, the resulting script contains a @code{(string-append
7561 @dots{})} expression to construct the file name @emph{at run time}.
7562 @end deffn
7563
7564
7565 Of course, in addition to gexps embedded in ``host'' code, there are
7566 also modules containing build tools. To make it clear that they are
7567 meant to be used in the build stratum, these modules are kept in the
7568 @code{(guix build @dots{})} name space.
7569
7570 @cindex lowering, of high-level objects in gexps
7571 Internally, high-level objects are @dfn{lowered}, using their compiler,
7572 to either derivations or store items. For instance, lowering a package
7573 yields a derivation, and lowering a @code{plain-file} yields a store
7574 item. This is achieved using the @code{lower-object} monadic procedure.
7575
7576 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} lower-object @var{obj} [@var{system}] @
7577 [#:target #f]
7578 Return as a value in @var{%store-monad} the derivation or store item
7579 corresponding to @var{obj} for @var{system}, cross-compiling for
7580 @var{target} if @var{target} is true. @var{obj} must be an object that
7581 has an associated gexp compiler, such as a @code{<package>}.
7582 @end deffn
7583
7584 @node Invoking guix repl
7585 @section Invoking @command{guix repl}
7586
7587 @cindex REPL, read-eval-print loop
7588 The @command{guix repl} command spawns a Guile @dfn{read-eval-print loop}
7589 (REPL) for interactive programming (@pxref{Using Guile Interactively,,, guile,
7590 GNU Guile Reference Manual}). Compared to just launching the @command{guile}
7591 command, @command{guix repl} guarantees that all the Guix modules and all its
7592 dependencies are available in the search path. You can use it this way:
7593
7594 @example
7595 $ guix repl
7596 scheme@@(guile-user)> ,use (gnu packages base)
7597 scheme@@(guile-user)> coreutils
7598 $1 = #<package coreutils@@8.29 gnu/packages/base.scm:327 3e28300>
7599 @end example
7600
7601 @cindex inferiors
7602 In addition, @command{guix repl} implements a simple machine-readable REPL
7603 protocol for use by @code{(guix inferior)}, a facility to interact with
7604 @dfn{inferiors}, separate processes running a potentially different revision
7605 of Guix.
7606
7607 The available options are as follows:
7608
7609 @table @code
7610 @item --type=@var{type}
7611 @itemx -t @var{type}
7612 Start a REPL of the given @var{TYPE}, which can be one of the following:
7613
7614 @table @code
7615 @item guile
7616 This is default, and it spawns a standard full-featured Guile REPL.
7617 @item machine
7618 Spawn a REPL that uses the machine-readable protocol. This is the protocol
7619 that the @code{(guix inferior)} module speaks.
7620 @end table
7621
7622 @item --listen=@var{endpoint}
7623 By default, @command{guix repl} reads from standard input and writes to
7624 standard output. When this option is passed, it will instead listen for
7625 connections on @var{endpoint}. Here are examples of valid options:
7626
7627 @table @code
7628 @item --listen=tcp:37146
7629 Accept connections on localhost on port 37146.
7630
7631 @item --listen=unix:/tmp/socket
7632 Accept connections on the Unix-domain socket @file{/tmp/socket}.
7633 @end table
7634 @end table
7635
7636 @c *********************************************************************
7637 @node Utilities
7638 @chapter Utilities
7639
7640 This section describes Guix command-line utilities. Some of them are
7641 primarily targeted at developers and users who write new package
7642 definitions, while others are more generally useful. They complement
7643 the Scheme programming interface of Guix in a convenient way.
7644
7645 @menu
7646 * Invoking guix build:: Building packages from the command line.
7647 * Invoking guix edit:: Editing package definitions.
7648 * Invoking guix download:: Downloading a file and printing its hash.
7649 * Invoking guix hash:: Computing the cryptographic hash of a file.
7650 * Invoking guix import:: Importing package definitions.
7651 * Invoking guix refresh:: Updating package definitions.
7652 * Invoking guix lint:: Finding errors in package definitions.
7653 * Invoking guix size:: Profiling disk usage.
7654 * Invoking guix graph:: Visualizing the graph of packages.
7655 * Invoking guix publish:: Sharing substitutes.
7656 * Invoking guix challenge:: Challenging substitute servers.
7657 * Invoking guix copy:: Copying to and from a remote store.
7658 * Invoking guix container:: Process isolation.
7659 * Invoking guix weather:: Assessing substitute availability.
7660 * Invoking guix processes:: Listing client processes.
7661 @end menu
7662
7663 @node Invoking guix build
7664 @section Invoking @command{guix build}
7665
7666 @cindex package building
7667 @cindex @command{guix build}
7668 The @command{guix build} command builds packages or derivations and
7669 their dependencies, and prints the resulting store paths. Note that it
7670 does not modify the user's profile---this is the job of the
7671 @command{guix package} command (@pxref{Invoking guix package}). Thus,
7672 it is mainly useful for distribution developers.
7673
7674 The general syntax is:
7675
7676 @example
7677 guix build @var{options} @var{package-or-derivation}@dots{}
7678 @end example
7679
7680 As an example, the following command builds the latest versions of Emacs
7681 and of Guile, displays their build logs, and finally displays the
7682 resulting directories:
7683
7684 @example
7685 guix build emacs guile
7686 @end example
7687
7688 Similarly, the following command builds all the available packages:
7689
7690 @example
7691 guix build --quiet --keep-going \
7692 `guix package -A | cut -f1,2 --output-delimiter=@@`
7693 @end example
7694
7695 @var{package-or-derivation} may be either the name of a package found in
7696 the software distribution such as @code{coreutils} or
7697 @code{coreutils@@8.20}, or a derivation such as
7698 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.19.drv}. In the former case, a
7699 package with the corresponding name (and optionally version) is searched
7700 for among the GNU distribution modules (@pxref{Package Modules}).
7701
7702 Alternatively, the @code{--expression} option may be used to specify a
7703 Scheme expression that evaluates to a package; this is useful when
7704 disambiguating among several same-named packages or package variants is
7705 needed.
7706
7707 There may be zero or more @var{options}. The available options are
7708 described in the subsections below.
7709
7710 @menu
7711 * Common Build Options:: Build options for most commands.
7712 * Package Transformation Options:: Creating variants of packages.
7713 * Additional Build Options:: Options specific to 'guix build'.
7714 * Debugging Build Failures:: Real life packaging experience.
7715 @end menu
7716
7717 @node Common Build Options
7718 @subsection Common Build Options
7719
7720 A number of options that control the build process are common to
7721 @command{guix build} and other commands that can spawn builds, such as
7722 @command{guix package} or @command{guix archive}. These are the
7723 following:
7724
7725 @table @code
7726
7727 @item --load-path=@var{directory}
7728 @itemx -L @var{directory}
7729 Add @var{directory} to the front of the package module search path
7730 (@pxref{Package Modules}).
7731
7732 This allows users to define their own packages and make them visible to
7733 the command-line tools.
7734
7735 @item --keep-failed
7736 @itemx -K
7737 Keep the build tree of failed builds. Thus, if a build fails, its build
7738 tree is kept under @file{/tmp}, in a directory whose name is shown at
7739 the end of the build log. This is useful when debugging build issues.
7740 @xref{Debugging Build Failures}, for tips and tricks on how to debug
7741 build issues.
7742
7743 This option has no effect when connecting to a remote daemon with a
7744 @code{guix://} URI (@pxref{The Store, the @code{GUIX_DAEMON_SOCKET}
7745 variable}).
7746
7747 @item --keep-going
7748 @itemx -k
7749 Keep going when some of the derivations fail to build; return only once
7750 all the builds have either completed or failed.
7751
7752 The default behavior is to stop as soon as one of the specified
7753 derivations has failed.
7754
7755 @item --dry-run
7756 @itemx -n
7757 Do not build the derivations.
7758
7759 @anchor{fallback-option}
7760 @item --fallback
7761 When substituting a pre-built binary fails, fall back to building
7762 packages locally (@pxref{Substitution Failure}).
7763
7764 @item --substitute-urls=@var{urls}
7765 @anchor{client-substitute-urls}
7766 Consider @var{urls} the whitespace-separated list of substitute source
7767 URLs, overriding the default list of URLs of @command{guix-daemon}
7768 (@pxref{daemon-substitute-urls,, @command{guix-daemon} URLs}).
7769
7770 This means that substitutes may be downloaded from @var{urls}, provided
7771 they are signed by a key authorized by the system administrator
7772 (@pxref{Substitutes}).
7773
7774 When @var{urls} is the empty string, substitutes are effectively
7775 disabled.
7776
7777 @item --no-substitutes
7778 Do not use substitutes for build products. That is, always build things
7779 locally instead of allowing downloads of pre-built binaries
7780 (@pxref{Substitutes}).
7781
7782 @item --no-grafts
7783 Do not ``graft'' packages. In practice, this means that package updates
7784 available as grafts are not applied. @xref{Security Updates}, for more
7785 information on grafts.
7786
7787 @item --rounds=@var{n}
7788 Build each derivation @var{n} times in a row, and raise an error if
7789 consecutive build results are not bit-for-bit identical.
7790
7791 This is a useful way to detect non-deterministic builds processes.
7792 Non-deterministic build processes are a problem because they make it
7793 practically impossible for users to @emph{verify} whether third-party
7794 binaries are genuine. @xref{Invoking guix challenge}, for more.
7795
7796 Note that, currently, the differing build results are not kept around,
7797 so you will have to manually investigate in case of an error---e.g., by
7798 stashing one of the build results with @code{guix archive --export}
7799 (@pxref{Invoking guix archive}), then rebuilding, and finally comparing
7800 the two results.
7801
7802 @item --no-build-hook
7803 Do not attempt to offload builds @i{via} the ``build hook'' of the daemon
7804 (@pxref{Daemon Offload Setup}). That is, always build things locally
7805 instead of offloading builds to remote machines.
7806
7807 @item --max-silent-time=@var{seconds}
7808 When the build or substitution process remains silent for more than
7809 @var{seconds}, terminate it and report a build failure.
7810
7811 By default, the daemon's setting is honored (@pxref{Invoking
7812 guix-daemon, @code{--max-silent-time}}).
7813
7814 @item --timeout=@var{seconds}
7815 Likewise, when the build or substitution process lasts for more than
7816 @var{seconds}, terminate it and report a build failure.
7817
7818 By default, the daemon's setting is honored (@pxref{Invoking
7819 guix-daemon, @code{--timeout}}).
7820
7821 @c Note: This option is actually not part of %standard-build-options but
7822 @c most programs honor it.
7823 @cindex verbosity, of the command-line tools
7824 @cindex build logs, verbosity
7825 @item -v @var{level}
7826 @itemx --verbosity=@var{level}
7827 Use the given verbosity @var{level}, an integer. Choosing 0 means that no
7828 output is produced, 1 is for quiet output, and 2 shows all the build log
7829 output on standard error.
7830
7831 @item --cores=@var{n}
7832 @itemx -c @var{n}
7833 Allow the use of up to @var{n} CPU cores for the build. The special
7834 value @code{0} means to use as many CPU cores as available.
7835
7836 @item --max-jobs=@var{n}
7837 @itemx -M @var{n}
7838 Allow at most @var{n} build jobs in parallel. @xref{Invoking
7839 guix-daemon, @code{--max-jobs}}, for details about this option and the
7840 equivalent @command{guix-daemon} option.
7841
7842 @item --debug=@var{level}
7843 Produce debugging output coming from the build daemon. @var{level} must be an
7844 integer between 0 and 5; higher means more verbose output. Setting a level of
7845 4 or more may be helpful when debugging setup issues with the build daemon.
7846
7847 @end table
7848
7849 Behind the scenes, @command{guix build} is essentially an interface to
7850 the @code{package-derivation} procedure of the @code{(guix packages)}
7851 module, and to the @code{build-derivations} procedure of the @code{(guix
7852 derivations)} module.
7853
7854 In addition to options explicitly passed on the command line,
7855 @command{guix build} and other @command{guix} commands that support
7856 building honor the @code{GUIX_BUILD_OPTIONS} environment variable.
7857
7858 @defvr {Environment Variable} GUIX_BUILD_OPTIONS
7859 Users can define this variable to a list of command line options that
7860 will automatically be used by @command{guix build} and other
7861 @command{guix} commands that can perform builds, as in the example
7862 below:
7863
7864 @example
7865 $ export GUIX_BUILD_OPTIONS="--no-substitutes -c 2 -L /foo/bar"
7866 @end example
7867
7868 These options are parsed independently, and the result is appended to
7869 the parsed command-line options.
7870 @end defvr
7871
7872
7873 @node Package Transformation Options
7874 @subsection Package Transformation Options
7875
7876 @cindex package variants
7877 Another set of command-line options supported by @command{guix build}
7878 and also @command{guix package} are @dfn{package transformation
7879 options}. These are options that make it possible to define @dfn{package
7880 variants}---for instance, packages built from different source code.
7881 This is a convenient way to create customized packages on the fly
7882 without having to type in the definitions of package variants
7883 (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
7884
7885 @table @code
7886
7887 @item --with-source=@var{source}
7888 @itemx --with-source=@var{package}=@var{source}
7889 @itemx --with-source=@var{package}@@@var{version}=@var{source}
7890 Use @var{source} as the source of @var{package}, and @var{version} as
7891 its version number.
7892 @var{source} must be a file name or a URL, as for @command{guix
7893 download} (@pxref{Invoking guix download}).
7894
7895 When @var{package} is omitted,
7896 it is taken to be the package name specified on the
7897 command line that matches the base of @var{source}---e.g.,
7898 if @var{source} is @code{/src/guile-2.0.10.tar.gz}, the corresponding
7899 package is @code{guile}.
7900
7901 Likewise, when @var{version} is omitted, the version string is inferred from
7902 @var{source}; in the previous example, it is @code{2.0.10}.
7903
7904 This option allows users to try out versions of packages other than the
7905 one provided by the distribution. The example below downloads
7906 @file{ed-1.7.tar.gz} from a GNU mirror and uses that as the source for
7907 the @code{ed} package:
7908
7909 @example
7910 guix build ed --with-source=mirror://gnu/ed/ed-1.7.tar.gz
7911 @end example
7912
7913 As a developer, @code{--with-source} makes it easy to test release
7914 candidates:
7915
7916 @example
7917 guix build guile --with-source=../guile-2.0.9.219-e1bb7.tar.xz
7918 @end example
7919
7920 @dots{} or to build from a checkout in a pristine environment:
7921
7922 @example
7923 $ git clone git://git.sv.gnu.org/guix.git
7924 $ guix build guix --with-source=guix@@1.0=./guix
7925 @end example
7926
7927 @item --with-input=@var{package}=@var{replacement}
7928 Replace dependency on @var{package} by a dependency on
7929 @var{replacement}. @var{package} must be a package name, and
7930 @var{replacement} must be a package specification such as @code{guile}
7931 or @code{guile@@1.8}.
7932
7933 For instance, the following command builds Guix, but replaces its
7934 dependency on the current stable version of Guile with a dependency on
7935 the legacy version of Guile, @code{guile@@2.0}:
7936
7937 @example
7938 guix build --with-input=guile=guile@@2.0 guix
7939 @end example
7940
7941 This is a recursive, deep replacement. So in this example, both
7942 @code{guix} and its dependency @code{guile-json} (which also depends on
7943 @code{guile}) get rebuilt against @code{guile@@2.0}.
7944
7945 This is implemented using the @code{package-input-rewriting} Scheme
7946 procedure (@pxref{Defining Packages, @code{package-input-rewriting}}).
7947
7948 @item --with-graft=@var{package}=@var{replacement}
7949 This is similar to @code{--with-input} but with an important difference:
7950 instead of rebuilding the whole dependency chain, @var{replacement} is
7951 built and then @dfn{grafted} onto the binaries that were initially
7952 referring to @var{package}. @xref{Security Updates}, for more
7953 information on grafts.
7954
7955 For example, the command below grafts version 3.5.4 of GnuTLS onto Wget
7956 and all its dependencies, replacing references to the version of GnuTLS
7957 they currently refer to:
7958
7959 @example
7960 guix build --with-graft=gnutls=gnutls@@3.5.4 wget
7961 @end example
7962
7963 This has the advantage of being much faster than rebuilding everything.
7964 But there is a caveat: it works if and only if @var{package} and
7965 @var{replacement} are strictly compatible---for example, if they provide
7966 a library, the application binary interface (ABI) of those libraries
7967 must be compatible. If @var{replacement} is somehow incompatible with
7968 @var{package}, then the resulting package may be unusable. Use with
7969 care!
7970
7971 @item --with-git-url=@var{package}=@var{url}
7972 @cindex Git, using the latest commit
7973 @cindex latest commit, building
7974 Build @var{package} from the latest commit of the @code{master} branch of the
7975 Git repository at @var{url}. Git sub-modules of the repository are fetched,
7976 recursively.
7977
7978 For example, the following command builds the NumPy Python library against the
7979 latest commit of the master branch of Python itself:
7980
7981 @example
7982 guix build python-numpy \
7983 --with-git-url=python=https://github.com/python/cpython
7984 @end example
7985
7986 This option can also be combined with @code{--with-branch} or
7987 @code{--with-commit} (see below).
7988
7989 @cindex continuous integration
7990 Obviously, since it uses the latest commit of the given branch, the result of
7991 such a command varies over time. Nevertheless it is a convenient way to
7992 rebuild entire software stacks against the latest commit of one or more
7993 packages. This is particularly useful in the context of continuous
7994 integration (CI).
7995
7996 Checkouts are kept in a cache under @file{~/.cache/guix/checkouts} to speed up
7997 consecutive accesses to the same repository. You may want to clean it up once
7998 in a while to save disk space.
7999
8000 @item --with-branch=@var{package}=@var{branch}
8001 Build @var{package} from the latest commit of @var{branch}. If the
8002 @code{source} field of @var{package} is an origin with the @code{git-fetch}
8003 method (@pxref{origin Reference}) or a @code{git-checkout} object, the
8004 repository URL is taken from that @code{source}. Otherwise you have to use
8005 @code{--with-git-url} to specify the URL of the Git repository.
8006
8007 For instance, the following command builds @code{guile-sqlite3} from the
8008 latest commit of its @code{master} branch, and then builds @code{guix} (which
8009 depends on it) and @code{cuirass} (which depends on @code{guix}) against this
8010 specific @code{guile-sqlite3} build:
8011
8012 @example
8013 guix build --with-branch=guile-sqlite3=master cuirass
8014 @end example
8015
8016 @item --with-commit=@var{package}=@var{commit}
8017 This is similar to @code{--with-branch}, except that it builds from
8018 @var{commit} rather than the tip of a branch. @var{commit} must be a valid
8019 Git commit SHA1 identifier.
8020 @end table
8021
8022 @node Additional Build Options
8023 @subsection Additional Build Options
8024
8025 The command-line options presented below are specific to @command{guix
8026 build}.
8027
8028 @table @code
8029
8030 @item --quiet
8031 @itemx -q
8032 Build quietly, without displaying the build log; this is equivalent to
8033 @code{--verbosity=0}. Upon completion, the build log is kept in @file{/var}
8034 (or similar) and can always be retrieved using the @option{--log-file} option.
8035
8036 @item --file=@var{file}
8037 @itemx -f @var{file}
8038 Build the package, derivation, or other file-like object that the code within
8039 @var{file} evaluates to (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}).
8040
8041 As an example, @var{file} might contain a package definition like this
8042 (@pxref{Defining Packages}):
8043
8044 @example
8045 @verbatiminclude package-hello.scm
8046 @end example
8047
8048 @item --expression=@var{expr}
8049 @itemx -e @var{expr}
8050 Build the package or derivation @var{expr} evaluates to.
8051
8052 For example, @var{expr} may be @code{(@@ (gnu packages guile)
8053 guile-1.8)}, which unambiguously designates this specific variant of
8054 version 1.8 of Guile.
8055
8056 Alternatively, @var{expr} may be a G-expression, in which case it is used
8057 as a build program passed to @code{gexp->derivation}
8058 (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
8059
8060 Lastly, @var{expr} may refer to a zero-argument monadic procedure
8061 (@pxref{The Store Monad}). The procedure must return a derivation as a
8062 monadic value, which is then passed through @code{run-with-store}.
8063
8064 @item --source
8065 @itemx -S
8066 Build the source derivations of the packages, rather than the packages
8067 themselves.
8068
8069 For instance, @code{guix build -S gcc} returns something like
8070 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-gcc-4.7.2.tar.bz2}, which is the GCC
8071 source tarball.
8072
8073 The returned source tarball is the result of applying any patches and
8074 code snippets specified in the package @code{origin} (@pxref{Defining
8075 Packages}).
8076
8077 @item --sources
8078 Fetch and return the source of @var{package-or-derivation} and all their
8079 dependencies, recursively. This is a handy way to obtain a local copy
8080 of all the source code needed to build @var{packages}, allowing you to
8081 eventually build them even without network access. It is an extension
8082 of the @code{--source} option and can accept one of the following
8083 optional argument values:
8084
8085 @table @code
8086 @item package
8087 This value causes the @code{--sources} option to behave in the same way
8088 as the @code{--source} option.
8089
8090 @item all
8091 Build the source derivations of all packages, including any source that
8092 might be listed as @code{inputs}. This is the default value.
8093
8094 @example
8095 $ guix build --sources tzdata
8096 The following derivations will be built:
8097 /gnu/store/@dots{}-tzdata2015b.tar.gz.drv
8098 /gnu/store/@dots{}-tzcode2015b.tar.gz.drv
8099 @end example
8100
8101 @item transitive
8102 Build the source derivations of all packages, as well of all transitive
8103 inputs to the packages. This can be used e.g.@: to
8104 prefetch package source for later offline building.
8105
8106 @example
8107 $ guix build --sources=transitive tzdata
8108 The following derivations will be built:
8109 /gnu/store/@dots{}-tzcode2015b.tar.gz.drv
8110 /gnu/store/@dots{}-findutils-4.4.2.tar.xz.drv
8111 /gnu/store/@dots{}-grep-2.21.tar.xz.drv
8112 /gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.23.tar.xz.drv
8113 /gnu/store/@dots{}-make-4.1.tar.xz.drv
8114 /gnu/store/@dots{}-bash-4.3.tar.xz.drv
8115 @dots{}
8116 @end example
8117
8118 @end table
8119
8120 @item --system=@var{system}
8121 @itemx -s @var{system}
8122 Attempt to build for @var{system}---e.g., @code{i686-linux}---instead of
8123 the system type of the build host. The @command{guix build} command allows
8124 you to repeat this option several times, in which case it builds for all the
8125 specified systems; other commands ignore extraneous @option{-s} options.
8126
8127 @quotation Note
8128 The @code{--system} flag is for @emph{native} compilation and must not
8129 be confused with cross-compilation. See @code{--target} below for
8130 information on cross-compilation.
8131 @end quotation
8132
8133 An example use of this is on Linux-based systems, which can emulate
8134 different personalities. For instance, passing
8135 @code{--system=i686-linux} on an @code{x86_64-linux} system or
8136 @code{--system=armhf-linux} on an @code{aarch64-linux} system allows you
8137 to build packages in a complete 32-bit environment.
8138
8139 @quotation Note
8140 Building for an @code{armhf-linux} system is unconditionally enabled on
8141 @code{aarch64-linux} machines, although certain aarch64 chipsets do not
8142 allow for this functionality, notably the ThunderX.
8143 @end quotation
8144
8145 Similarly, when transparent emulation with QEMU and @code{binfmt_misc}
8146 is enabled (@pxref{Virtualization Services,
8147 @code{qemu-binfmt-service-type}}), you can build for any system for
8148 which a QEMU @code{binfmt_misc} handler is installed.
8149
8150 Builds for a system other than that of the machine you are using can
8151 also be offloaded to a remote machine of the right architecture.
8152 @xref{Daemon Offload Setup}, for more information on offloading.
8153
8154 @item --target=@var{triplet}
8155 @cindex cross-compilation
8156 Cross-build for @var{triplet}, which must be a valid GNU triplet, such
8157 as @code{"mips64el-linux-gnu"} (@pxref{Specifying Target Triplets, GNU
8158 configuration triplets,, autoconf, Autoconf}).
8159
8160 @anchor{build-check}
8161 @item --check
8162 @cindex determinism, checking
8163 @cindex reproducibility, checking
8164 Rebuild @var{package-or-derivation}, which are already available in the
8165 store, and raise an error if the build results are not bit-for-bit
8166 identical.
8167
8168 This mechanism allows you to check whether previously installed
8169 substitutes are genuine (@pxref{Substitutes}), or whether the build result
8170 of a package is deterministic. @xref{Invoking guix challenge}, for more
8171 background information and tools.
8172
8173 When used in conjunction with @option{--keep-failed}, the differing
8174 output is kept in the store, under @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-check}.
8175 This makes it easy to look for differences between the two results.
8176
8177 @item --repair
8178 @cindex repairing store items
8179 @cindex corruption, recovering from
8180 Attempt to repair the specified store items, if they are corrupt, by
8181 re-downloading or rebuilding them.
8182
8183 This operation is not atomic and thus restricted to @code{root}.
8184
8185 @item --derivations
8186 @itemx -d
8187 Return the derivation paths, not the output paths, of the given
8188 packages.
8189
8190 @item --root=@var{file}
8191 @itemx -r @var{file}
8192 @cindex GC roots, adding
8193 @cindex garbage collector roots, adding
8194 Make @var{file} a symlink to the result, and register it as a garbage
8195 collector root.
8196
8197 Consequently, the results of this @command{guix build} invocation are
8198 protected from garbage collection until @var{file} is removed. When
8199 that option is omitted, build results are eligible for garbage
8200 collection as soon as the build completes. @xref{Invoking guix gc}, for
8201 more on GC roots.
8202
8203 @item --log-file
8204 @cindex build logs, access
8205 Return the build log file names or URLs for the given
8206 @var{package-or-derivation}, or raise an error if build logs are
8207 missing.
8208
8209 This works regardless of how packages or derivations are specified. For
8210 instance, the following invocations are equivalent:
8211
8212 @example
8213 guix build --log-file `guix build -d guile`
8214 guix build --log-file `guix build guile`
8215 guix build --log-file guile
8216 guix build --log-file -e '(@@ (gnu packages guile) guile-2.0)'
8217 @end example
8218
8219 If a log is unavailable locally, and unless @code{--no-substitutes} is
8220 passed, the command looks for a corresponding log on one of the
8221 substitute servers (as specified with @code{--substitute-urls}.)
8222
8223 So for instance, imagine you want to see the build log of GDB on MIPS,
8224 but you are actually on an @code{x86_64} machine:
8225
8226 @example
8227 $ guix build --log-file gdb -s mips64el-linux
8228 https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}/log/@dots{}-gdb-7.10
8229 @end example
8230
8231 You can freely access a huge library of build logs!
8232 @end table
8233
8234 @node Debugging Build Failures
8235 @subsection Debugging Build Failures
8236
8237 @cindex build failures, debugging
8238 When defining a new package (@pxref{Defining Packages}), you will
8239 probably find yourself spending some time debugging and tweaking the
8240 build until it succeeds. To do that, you need to operate the build
8241 commands yourself in an environment as close as possible to the one the
8242 build daemon uses.
8243
8244 To that end, the first thing to do is to use the @option{--keep-failed}
8245 or @option{-K} option of @command{guix build}, which will keep the
8246 failed build tree in @file{/tmp} or whatever directory you specified as
8247 @code{TMPDIR} (@pxref{Invoking guix build, @code{--keep-failed}}).
8248
8249 From there on, you can @command{cd} to the failed build tree and source
8250 the @file{environment-variables} file, which contains all the
8251 environment variable definitions that were in place when the build
8252 failed. So let's say you're debugging a build failure in package
8253 @code{foo}; a typical session would look like this:
8254
8255 @example
8256 $ guix build foo -K
8257 @dots{} @i{build fails}
8258 $ cd /tmp/guix-build-foo.drv-0
8259 $ source ./environment-variables
8260 $ cd foo-1.2
8261 @end example
8262
8263 Now, you can invoke commands as if you were the daemon (almost) and
8264 troubleshoot your build process.
8265
8266 Sometimes it happens that, for example, a package's tests pass when you
8267 run them manually but they fail when the daemon runs them. This can
8268 happen because the daemon runs builds in containers where, unlike in our
8269 environment above, network access is missing, @file{/bin/sh} does not
8270 exist, etc. (@pxref{Build Environment Setup}).
8271
8272 In such cases, you may need to run inspect the build process from within
8273 a container similar to the one the build daemon creates:
8274
8275 @example
8276 $ guix build -K foo
8277 @dots{}
8278 $ cd /tmp/guix-build-foo.drv-0
8279 $ guix environment --no-grafts -C foo --ad-hoc strace gdb
8280 [env]# source ./environment-variables
8281 [env]# cd foo-1.2
8282 @end example
8283
8284 Here, @command{guix environment -C} creates a container and spawns a new
8285 shell in it (@pxref{Invoking guix environment}). The @command{--ad-hoc
8286 strace gdb} part adds the @command{strace} and @command{gdb} commands to
8287 the container, which would may find handy while debugging. The
8288 @option{--no-grafts} option makes sure we get the exact same
8289 environment, with ungrafted packages (@pxref{Security Updates}, for more
8290 info on grafts).
8291
8292 To get closer to a container like that used by the build daemon, we can
8293 remove @file{/bin/sh}:
8294
8295 @example
8296 [env]# rm /bin/sh
8297 @end example
8298
8299 (Don't worry, this is harmless: this is all happening in the throw-away
8300 container created by @command{guix environment}.)
8301
8302 The @command{strace} command is probably not in the search path, but we
8303 can run:
8304
8305 @example
8306 [env]# $GUIX_ENVIRONMENT/bin/strace -f -o log make check
8307 @end example
8308
8309 In this way, not only you will have reproduced the environment variables
8310 the daemon uses, you will also be running the build process in a container
8311 similar to the one the daemon uses.
8312
8313
8314 @node Invoking guix edit
8315 @section Invoking @command{guix edit}
8316
8317 @cindex @command{guix edit}
8318 @cindex package definition, editing
8319 So many packages, so many source files! The @command{guix edit} command
8320 facilitates the life of users and packagers by pointing their editor at
8321 the source file containing the definition of the specified packages.
8322 For instance:
8323
8324 @example
8325 guix edit gcc@@4.9 vim
8326 @end example
8327
8328 @noindent
8329 launches the program specified in the @code{VISUAL} or in the
8330 @code{EDITOR} environment variable to view the recipe of GCC@tie{}4.9.3
8331 and that of Vim.
8332
8333 If you are using a Guix Git checkout (@pxref{Building from Git}), or
8334 have created your own packages on @code{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH}
8335 (@pxref{Package Modules}), you will be able to edit the package
8336 recipes. In other cases, you will be able to examine the read-only recipes
8337 for packages currently in the store.
8338
8339
8340 @node Invoking guix download
8341 @section Invoking @command{guix download}
8342
8343 @cindex @command{guix download}
8344 @cindex downloading package sources
8345 When writing a package definition, developers typically need to download
8346 a source tarball, compute its SHA256 hash, and write that
8347 hash in the package definition (@pxref{Defining Packages}). The
8348 @command{guix download} tool helps with this task: it downloads a file
8349 from the given URI, adds it to the store, and prints both its file name
8350 in the store and its SHA256 hash.
8351
8352 The fact that the downloaded file is added to the store saves bandwidth:
8353 when the developer eventually tries to build the newly defined package
8354 with @command{guix build}, the source tarball will not have to be
8355 downloaded again because it is already in the store. It is also a
8356 convenient way to temporarily stash files, which may be deleted
8357 eventually (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}).
8358
8359 The @command{guix download} command supports the same URIs as used in
8360 package definitions. In particular, it supports @code{mirror://} URIs.
8361 @code{https} URIs (HTTP over TLS) are supported @emph{provided} the
8362 Guile bindings for GnuTLS are available in the user's environment; when
8363 they are not available, an error is raised. @xref{Guile Preparations,
8364 how to install the GnuTLS bindings for Guile,, gnutls-guile,
8365 GnuTLS-Guile}, for more information.
8366
8367 @command{guix download} verifies HTTPS server certificates by loading
8368 the certificates of X.509 authorities from the directory pointed to by
8369 the @code{SSL_CERT_DIR} environment variable (@pxref{X.509
8370 Certificates}), unless @option{--no-check-certificate} is used.
8371
8372 The following options are available:
8373
8374 @table @code
8375 @item --format=@var{fmt}
8376 @itemx -f @var{fmt}
8377 Write the hash in the format specified by @var{fmt}. For more
8378 information on the valid values for @var{fmt}, @pxref{Invoking guix hash}.
8379
8380 @item --no-check-certificate
8381 Do not validate the X.509 certificates of HTTPS servers.
8382
8383 When using this option, you have @emph{absolutely no guarantee} that you
8384 are communicating with the authentic server responsible for the given
8385 URL, which makes you vulnerable to ``man-in-the-middle'' attacks.
8386
8387 @item --output=@var{file}
8388 @itemx -o @var{file}
8389 Save the downloaded file to @var{file} instead of adding it to the
8390 store.
8391 @end table
8392
8393 @node Invoking guix hash
8394 @section Invoking @command{guix hash}
8395
8396 @cindex @command{guix hash}
8397 The @command{guix hash} command computes the SHA256 hash of a file.
8398 It is primarily a convenience tool for anyone contributing to the
8399 distribution: it computes the cryptographic hash of a file, which can be
8400 used in the definition of a package (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
8401
8402 The general syntax is:
8403
8404 @example
8405 guix hash @var{option} @var{file}
8406 @end example
8407
8408 When @var{file} is @code{-} (a hyphen), @command{guix hash} computes the
8409 hash of data read from standard input. @command{guix hash} has the
8410 following options:
8411
8412 @table @code
8413
8414 @item --format=@var{fmt}
8415 @itemx -f @var{fmt}
8416 Write the hash in the format specified by @var{fmt}.
8417
8418 Supported formats: @code{nix-base32}, @code{base32}, @code{base16}
8419 (@code{hex} and @code{hexadecimal} can be used as well).
8420
8421 If the @option{--format} option is not specified, @command{guix hash}
8422 will output the hash in @code{nix-base32}. This representation is used
8423 in the definitions of packages.
8424
8425 @item --recursive
8426 @itemx -r
8427 Compute the hash on @var{file} recursively.
8428
8429 In this case, the hash is computed on an archive containing @var{file},
8430 including its children if it is a directory. Some of the metadata of
8431 @var{file} is part of the archive; for instance, when @var{file} is a
8432 regular file, the hash is different depending on whether @var{file} is
8433 executable or not. Metadata such as time stamps has no impact on the
8434 hash (@pxref{Invoking guix archive}).
8435 @c FIXME: Replace xref above with xref to an ``Archive'' section when
8436 @c it exists.
8437
8438 @item --exclude-vcs
8439 @itemx -x
8440 When combined with @option{--recursive}, exclude version control system
8441 directories (@file{.bzr}, @file{.git}, @file{.hg}, etc.)
8442
8443 @vindex git-fetch
8444 As an example, here is how you would compute the hash of a Git checkout,
8445 which is useful when using the @code{git-fetch} method (@pxref{origin
8446 Reference}):
8447
8448 @example
8449 $ git clone http://example.org/foo.git
8450 $ cd foo
8451 $ guix hash -rx .
8452 @end example
8453 @end table
8454
8455 @node Invoking guix import
8456 @section Invoking @command{guix import}
8457
8458 @cindex importing packages
8459 @cindex package import
8460 @cindex package conversion
8461 @cindex Invoking @command{guix import}
8462 The @command{guix import} command is useful for people who would like to
8463 add a package to the distribution with as little work as
8464 possible---a legitimate demand. The command knows of a few
8465 repositories from which it can ``import'' package metadata. The result
8466 is a package definition, or a template thereof, in the format we know
8467 (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
8468
8469 The general syntax is:
8470
8471 @example
8472 guix import @var{importer} @var{options}@dots{}
8473 @end example
8474
8475 @var{importer} specifies the source from which to import package
8476 metadata, and @var{options} specifies a package identifier and other
8477 options specific to @var{importer}. Currently, the available
8478 ``importers'' are:
8479
8480 @table @code
8481 @item gnu
8482 Import metadata for the given GNU package. This provides a template
8483 for the latest version of that GNU package, including the hash of its
8484 source tarball, and its canonical synopsis and description.
8485
8486 Additional information such as the package dependencies and its
8487 license needs to be figured out manually.
8488
8489 For example, the following command returns a package definition for
8490 GNU@tie{}Hello:
8491
8492 @example
8493 guix import gnu hello
8494 @end example
8495
8496 Specific command-line options are:
8497
8498 @table @code
8499 @item --key-download=@var{policy}
8500 As for @code{guix refresh}, specify the policy to handle missing OpenPGP
8501 keys when verifying the package signature. @xref{Invoking guix
8502 refresh, @code{--key-download}}.
8503 @end table
8504
8505 @item pypi
8506 @cindex pypi
8507 Import metadata from the @uref{https://pypi.python.org/, Python Package
8508 Index}. Information is taken from the JSON-formatted description
8509 available at @code{pypi.python.org} and usually includes all the relevant
8510 information, including package dependencies. For maximum efficiency, it
8511 is recommended to install the @command{unzip} utility, so that the
8512 importer can unzip Python wheels and gather data from them.
8513
8514 The command below imports metadata for the @code{itsdangerous} Python
8515 package:
8516
8517 @example
8518 guix import pypi itsdangerous
8519 @end example
8520
8521 @table @code
8522 @item --recursive
8523 @itemx -r
8524 Traverse the dependency graph of the given upstream package recursively
8525 and generate package expressions for all those packages that are not yet
8526 in Guix.
8527 @end table
8528
8529 @item gem
8530 @cindex gem
8531 Import metadata from @uref{https://rubygems.org/, RubyGems}. Information
8532 is taken from the JSON-formatted description available at
8533 @code{rubygems.org} and includes most relevant information, including
8534 runtime dependencies. There are some caveats, however. The metadata
8535 doesn't distinguish between synopses and descriptions, so the same string
8536 is used for both fields. Additionally, the details of non-Ruby
8537 dependencies required to build native extensions is unavailable and left
8538 as an exercise to the packager.
8539
8540 The command below imports metadata for the @code{rails} Ruby package:
8541
8542 @example
8543 guix import gem rails
8544 @end example
8545
8546 @table @code
8547 @item --recursive
8548 @itemx -r
8549 Traverse the dependency graph of the given upstream package recursively
8550 and generate package expressions for all those packages that are not yet
8551 in Guix.
8552 @end table
8553
8554 @item cpan
8555 @cindex CPAN
8556 Import metadata from @uref{https://www.metacpan.org/, MetaCPAN}.
8557 Information is taken from the JSON-formatted metadata provided through
8558 @uref{https://fastapi.metacpan.org/, MetaCPAN's API} and includes most
8559 relevant information, such as module dependencies. License information
8560 should be checked closely. If Perl is available in the store, then the
8561 @code{corelist} utility will be used to filter core modules out of the
8562 list of dependencies.
8563
8564 The command command below imports metadata for the @code{Acme::Boolean}
8565 Perl module:
8566
8567 @example
8568 guix import cpan Acme::Boolean
8569 @end example
8570
8571 @item cran
8572 @cindex CRAN
8573 @cindex Bioconductor
8574 Import metadata from @uref{https://cran.r-project.org/, CRAN}, the
8575 central repository for the @uref{https://r-project.org, GNU@tie{}R
8576 statistical and graphical environment}.
8577
8578 Information is extracted from the @code{DESCRIPTION} file of the package.
8579
8580 The command command below imports metadata for the @code{Cairo}
8581 R package:
8582
8583 @example
8584 guix import cran Cairo
8585 @end example
8586
8587 When @code{--recursive} is added, the importer will traverse the
8588 dependency graph of the given upstream package recursively and generate
8589 package expressions for all those packages that are not yet in Guix.
8590
8591 When @code{--archive=bioconductor} is added, metadata is imported from
8592 @uref{https://www.bioconductor.org/, Bioconductor}, a repository of R
8593 packages for for the analysis and comprehension of high-throughput
8594 genomic data in bioinformatics.
8595
8596 Information is extracted from the @code{DESCRIPTION} file of a package
8597 published on the web interface of the Bioconductor SVN repository.
8598
8599 The command below imports metadata for the @code{GenomicRanges}
8600 R package:
8601
8602 @example
8603 guix import cran --archive=bioconductor GenomicRanges
8604 @end example
8605
8606 @item texlive
8607 @cindex TeX Live
8608 @cindex CTAN
8609 Import metadata from @uref{https://www.ctan.org/, CTAN}, the
8610 comprehensive TeX archive network for TeX packages that are part of the
8611 @uref{https://www.tug.org/texlive/, TeX Live distribution}.
8612
8613 Information about the package is obtained through the XML API provided
8614 by CTAN, while the source code is downloaded from the SVN repository of
8615 the Tex Live project. This is done because the CTAN does not keep
8616 versioned archives.
8617
8618 The command command below imports metadata for the @code{fontspec}
8619 TeX package:
8620
8621 @example
8622 guix import texlive fontspec
8623 @end example
8624
8625 When @code{--archive=DIRECTORY} is added, the source code is downloaded
8626 not from the @file{latex} sub-directory of the @file{texmf-dist/source}
8627 tree in the TeX Live SVN repository, but from the specified sibling
8628 directory under the same root.
8629
8630 The command below imports metadata for the @code{ifxetex} package from
8631 CTAN while fetching the sources from the directory
8632 @file{texmf/source/generic}:
8633
8634 @example
8635 guix import texlive --archive=generic ifxetex
8636 @end example
8637
8638 @item json
8639 @cindex JSON, import
8640 Import package metadata from a local JSON file. Consider the following
8641 example package definition in JSON format:
8642
8643 @example
8644 @{
8645 "name": "hello",
8646 "version": "2.10",
8647 "source": "mirror://gnu/hello/hello-2.10.tar.gz",
8648 "build-system": "gnu",
8649 "home-page": "https://www.gnu.org/software/hello/",
8650 "synopsis": "Hello, GNU world: An example GNU package",
8651 "description": "GNU Hello prints a greeting.",
8652 "license": "GPL-3.0+",
8653 "native-inputs": ["gcc@@6"]
8654 @}
8655 @end example
8656
8657 The field names are the same as for the @code{<package>} record
8658 (@xref{Defining Packages}). References to other packages are provided
8659 as JSON lists of quoted package specification strings such as
8660 @code{guile} or @code{guile@@2.0}.
8661
8662 The importer also supports a more explicit source definition using the
8663 common fields for @code{<origin>} records:
8664
8665 @example
8666 @{
8667 @dots{}
8668 "source": @{
8669 "method": "url-fetch",
8670 "uri": "mirror://gnu/hello/hello-2.10.tar.gz",
8671 "sha256": @{
8672 "base32": "0ssi1wpaf7plaswqqjwigppsg5fyh99vdlb9kzl7c9lng89ndq1i"
8673 @}
8674 @}
8675 @dots{}
8676 @}
8677 @end example
8678
8679 The command below reads metadata from the JSON file @code{hello.json}
8680 and outputs a package expression:
8681
8682 @example
8683 guix import json hello.json
8684 @end example
8685
8686 @item nix
8687 Import metadata from a local copy of the source of the
8688 @uref{https://nixos.org/nixpkgs/, Nixpkgs distribution}@footnote{This
8689 relies on the @command{nix-instantiate} command of
8690 @uref{https://nixos.org/nix/, Nix}.}. Package definitions in Nixpkgs are
8691 typically written in a mixture of Nix-language and Bash code. This
8692 command only imports the high-level package structure that is written in
8693 the Nix language. It normally includes all the basic fields of a
8694 package definition.
8695
8696 When importing a GNU package, the synopsis and descriptions are replaced
8697 by their canonical upstream variant.
8698
8699 Usually, you will first need to do:
8700
8701 @example
8702 export NIX_REMOTE=daemon
8703 @end example
8704
8705 @noindent
8706 so that @command{nix-instantiate} does not try to open the Nix database.
8707
8708 As an example, the command below imports the package definition of
8709 LibreOffice (more precisely, it imports the definition of the package
8710 bound to the @code{libreoffice} top-level attribute):
8711
8712 @example
8713 guix import nix ~/path/to/nixpkgs libreoffice
8714 @end example
8715
8716 @item hackage
8717 @cindex hackage
8718 Import metadata from the Haskell community's central package archive
8719 @uref{https://hackage.haskell.org/, Hackage}. Information is taken from
8720 Cabal files and includes all the relevant information, including package
8721 dependencies.
8722
8723 Specific command-line options are:
8724
8725 @table @code
8726 @item --stdin
8727 @itemx -s
8728 Read a Cabal file from standard input.
8729 @item --no-test-dependencies
8730 @itemx -t
8731 Do not include dependencies required only by the test suites.
8732 @item --cabal-environment=@var{alist}
8733 @itemx -e @var{alist}
8734 @var{alist} is a Scheme alist defining the environment in which the
8735 Cabal conditionals are evaluated. The accepted keys are: @code{os},
8736 @code{arch}, @code{impl} and a string representing the name of a flag.
8737 The value associated with a flag has to be either the symbol
8738 @code{true} or @code{false}. The value associated with other keys
8739 has to conform to the Cabal file format definition. The default value
8740 associated with the keys @code{os}, @code{arch} and @code{impl} is
8741 @samp{linux}, @samp{x86_64} and @samp{ghc}, respectively.
8742 @item --recursive
8743 @itemx -r
8744 Traverse the dependency graph of the given upstream package recursively
8745 and generate package expressions for all those packages that are not yet
8746 in Guix.
8747 @end table
8748
8749 The command below imports metadata for the latest version of the
8750 @code{HTTP} Haskell package without including test dependencies and
8751 specifying the value of the flag @samp{network-uri} as @code{false}:
8752
8753 @example
8754 guix import hackage -t -e "'((\"network-uri\" . false))" HTTP
8755 @end example
8756
8757 A specific package version may optionally be specified by following the
8758 package name by an at-sign and a version number as in the following example:
8759
8760 @example
8761 guix import hackage mtl@@2.1.3.1
8762 @end example
8763
8764 @item stackage
8765 @cindex stackage
8766 The @code{stackage} importer is a wrapper around the @code{hackage} one.
8767 It takes a package name, looks up the package version included in a
8768 long-term support (LTS) @uref{https://www.stackage.org, Stackage}
8769 release and uses the @code{hackage} importer to retrieve its metadata.
8770 Note that it is up to you to select an LTS release compatible with the
8771 GHC compiler used by Guix.
8772
8773 Specific command-line options are:
8774
8775 @table @code
8776 @item --no-test-dependencies
8777 @itemx -t
8778 Do not include dependencies required only by the test suites.
8779 @item --lts-version=@var{version}
8780 @itemx -l @var{version}
8781 @var{version} is the desired LTS release version. If omitted the latest
8782 release is used.
8783 @item --recursive
8784 @itemx -r
8785 Traverse the dependency graph of the given upstream package recursively
8786 and generate package expressions for all those packages that are not yet
8787 in Guix.
8788 @end table
8789
8790 The command below imports metadata for the @code{HTTP} Haskell package
8791 included in the LTS Stackage release version 7.18:
8792
8793 @example
8794 guix import stackage --lts-version=7.18 HTTP
8795 @end example
8796
8797 @item elpa
8798 @cindex elpa
8799 Import metadata from an Emacs Lisp Package Archive (ELPA) package
8800 repository (@pxref{Packages,,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}).
8801
8802 Specific command-line options are:
8803
8804 @table @code
8805 @item --archive=@var{repo}
8806 @itemx -a @var{repo}
8807 @var{repo} identifies the archive repository from which to retrieve the
8808 information. Currently the supported repositories and their identifiers
8809 are:
8810 @itemize -
8811 @item
8812 @uref{https://elpa.gnu.org/packages, GNU}, selected by the @code{gnu}
8813 identifier. This is the default.
8814
8815 Packages from @code{elpa.gnu.org} are signed with one of the keys
8816 contained in the GnuPG keyring at
8817 @file{share/emacs/25.1/etc/package-keyring.gpg} (or similar) in the
8818 @code{emacs} package (@pxref{Package Installation, ELPA package
8819 signatures,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}).
8820
8821 @item
8822 @uref{https://stable.melpa.org/packages, MELPA-Stable}, selected by the
8823 @code{melpa-stable} identifier.
8824
8825 @item
8826 @uref{https://melpa.org/packages, MELPA}, selected by the @code{melpa}
8827 identifier.
8828 @end itemize
8829
8830 @item --recursive
8831 @itemx -r
8832 Traverse the dependency graph of the given upstream package recursively
8833 and generate package expressions for all those packages that are not yet
8834 in Guix.
8835 @end table
8836
8837 @item crate
8838 @cindex crate
8839 Import metadata from the crates.io Rust package repository
8840 @uref{https://crates.io, crates.io}.
8841
8842 @item opam
8843 @cindex OPAM
8844 @cindex OCaml
8845 Import metadata from the @uref{https://opam.ocaml.org/, OPAM} package
8846 repository used by the OCaml community.
8847 @end table
8848
8849 The structure of the @command{guix import} code is modular. It would be
8850 useful to have more importers for other package formats, and your help
8851 is welcome here (@pxref{Contributing}).
8852
8853 @node Invoking guix refresh
8854 @section Invoking @command{guix refresh}
8855
8856 @cindex @command {guix refresh}
8857 The primary audience of the @command{guix refresh} command is developers
8858 of the GNU software distribution. By default, it reports any packages
8859 provided by the distribution that are outdated compared to the latest
8860 upstream version, like this:
8861
8862 @example
8863 $ guix refresh
8864 gnu/packages/gettext.scm:29:13: gettext would be upgraded from 0.18.1.1 to 0.18.2.1
8865 gnu/packages/glib.scm:77:12: glib would be upgraded from 2.34.3 to 2.37.0
8866 @end example
8867
8868 Alternately, one can specify packages to consider, in which case a
8869 warning is emitted for packages that lack an updater:
8870
8871 @example
8872 $ guix refresh coreutils guile guile-ssh
8873 gnu/packages/ssh.scm:205:2: warning: no updater for guile-ssh
8874 gnu/packages/guile.scm:136:12: guile would be upgraded from 2.0.12 to 2.0.13
8875 @end example
8876
8877 @command{guix refresh} browses the upstream repository of each package and determines
8878 the highest version number of the releases therein. The command
8879 knows how to update specific types of packages: GNU packages, ELPA
8880 packages, etc.---see the documentation for @option{--type} below. There
8881 are many packages, though, for which it lacks a method to determine
8882 whether a new upstream release is available. However, the mechanism is
8883 extensible, so feel free to get in touch with us to add a new method!
8884
8885 @table @code
8886
8887 @item --recursive
8888 Consider the packages specified, and all the packages upon which they depend.
8889
8890 @example
8891 $ guix refresh --recursive coreutils
8892 gnu/packages/acl.scm:35:2: warning: no updater for acl
8893 gnu/packages/m4.scm:30:12: info: 1.4.18 is already the latest version of m4
8894 gnu/packages/xml.scm:68:2: warning: no updater for expat
8895 gnu/packages/multiprecision.scm:40:12: info: 6.1.2 is already the latest version of gmp
8896 @dots{}
8897 @end example
8898
8899 @end table
8900
8901 Sometimes the upstream name differs from the package name used in Guix,
8902 and @command{guix refresh} needs a little help. Most updaters honor the
8903 @code{upstream-name} property in package definitions, which can be used
8904 to that effect:
8905
8906 @example
8907 (define-public network-manager
8908 (package
8909 (name "network-manager")
8910 ;; @dots{}
8911 (properties '((upstream-name . "NetworkManager")))))
8912 @end example
8913
8914 When passed @code{--update}, it modifies distribution source files to
8915 update the version numbers and source tarball hashes of those package
8916 recipes (@pxref{Defining Packages}). This is achieved by downloading
8917 each package's latest source tarball and its associated OpenPGP
8918 signature, authenticating the downloaded tarball against its signature
8919 using @command{gpg}, and finally computing its hash. When the public
8920 key used to sign the tarball is missing from the user's keyring, an
8921 attempt is made to automatically retrieve it from a public key server;
8922 when this is successful, the key is added to the user's keyring; otherwise,
8923 @command{guix refresh} reports an error.
8924
8925 The following options are supported:
8926
8927 @table @code
8928
8929 @item --expression=@var{expr}
8930 @itemx -e @var{expr}
8931 Consider the package @var{expr} evaluates to.
8932
8933 This is useful to precisely refer to a package, as in this example:
8934
8935 @example
8936 guix refresh -l -e '(@@@@ (gnu packages commencement) glibc-final)'
8937 @end example
8938
8939 This command lists the dependents of the ``final'' libc (essentially all
8940 the packages.)
8941
8942 @item --update
8943 @itemx -u
8944 Update distribution source files (package recipes) in place. This is
8945 usually run from a checkout of the Guix source tree (@pxref{Running
8946 Guix Before It Is Installed}):
8947
8948 @example
8949 $ ./pre-inst-env guix refresh -s non-core -u
8950 @end example
8951
8952 @xref{Defining Packages}, for more information on package definitions.
8953
8954 @item --select=[@var{subset}]
8955 @itemx -s @var{subset}
8956 Select all the packages in @var{subset}, one of @code{core} or
8957 @code{non-core}.
8958
8959 The @code{core} subset refers to all the packages at the core of the
8960 distribution---i.e., packages that are used to build ``everything
8961 else''. This includes GCC, libc, Binutils, Bash, etc. Usually,
8962 changing one of these packages in the distribution entails a rebuild of
8963 all the others. Thus, such updates are an inconvenience to users in
8964 terms of build time or bandwidth used to achieve the upgrade.
8965
8966 The @code{non-core} subset refers to the remaining packages. It is
8967 typically useful in cases where an update of the core packages would be
8968 inconvenient.
8969
8970 @item --manifest=@var{file}
8971 @itemx -m @var{file}
8972 Select all the packages from the manifest in @var{file}. This is useful to
8973 check if any packages of the user manifest can be updated.
8974
8975 @item --type=@var{updater}
8976 @itemx -t @var{updater}
8977 Select only packages handled by @var{updater} (may be a comma-separated
8978 list of updaters). Currently, @var{updater} may be one of:
8979
8980 @table @code
8981 @item gnu
8982 the updater for GNU packages;
8983 @item gnome
8984 the updater for GNOME packages;
8985 @item kde
8986 the updater for KDE packages;
8987 @item xorg
8988 the updater for X.org packages;
8989 @item kernel.org
8990 the updater for packages hosted on kernel.org;
8991 @item elpa
8992 the updater for @uref{https://elpa.gnu.org/, ELPA} packages;
8993 @item cran
8994 the updater for @uref{https://cran.r-project.org/, CRAN} packages;
8995 @item bioconductor
8996 the updater for @uref{https://www.bioconductor.org/, Bioconductor} R packages;
8997 @item cpan
8998 the updater for @uref{https://www.cpan.org/, CPAN} packages;
8999 @item pypi
9000 the updater for @uref{https://pypi.python.org, PyPI} packages.
9001 @item gem
9002 the updater for @uref{https://rubygems.org, RubyGems} packages.
9003 @item github
9004 the updater for @uref{https://github.com, GitHub} packages.
9005 @item hackage
9006 the updater for @uref{https://hackage.haskell.org, Hackage} packages.
9007 @item stackage
9008 the updater for @uref{https://www.stackage.org, Stackage} packages.
9009 @item crate
9010 the updater for @uref{https://crates.io, Crates} packages.
9011 @item launchpad
9012 the updater for @uref{https://launchpad.net, Launchpad} packages.
9013 @end table
9014
9015 For instance, the following command only checks for updates of Emacs
9016 packages hosted at @code{elpa.gnu.org} and for updates of CRAN packages:
9017
9018 @example
9019 $ guix refresh --type=elpa,cran
9020 gnu/packages/statistics.scm:819:13: r-testthat would be upgraded from 0.10.0 to 0.11.0
9021 gnu/packages/emacs.scm:856:13: emacs-auctex would be upgraded from 11.88.6 to 11.88.9
9022 @end example
9023
9024 @end table
9025
9026 In addition, @command{guix refresh} can be passed one or more package
9027 names, as in this example:
9028
9029 @example
9030 $ ./pre-inst-env guix refresh -u emacs idutils gcc@@4.8
9031 @end example
9032
9033 @noindent
9034 The command above specifically updates the @code{emacs} and
9035 @code{idutils} packages. The @code{--select} option would have no
9036 effect in this case.
9037
9038 When considering whether to upgrade a package, it is sometimes
9039 convenient to know which packages would be affected by the upgrade and
9040 should be checked for compatibility. For this the following option may
9041 be used when passing @command{guix refresh} one or more package names:
9042
9043 @table @code
9044
9045 @item --list-updaters
9046 @itemx -L
9047 List available updaters and exit (see @option{--type} above.)
9048
9049 For each updater, display the fraction of packages it covers; at the
9050 end, display the fraction of packages covered by all these updaters.
9051
9052 @item --list-dependent
9053 @itemx -l
9054 List top-level dependent packages that would need to be rebuilt as a
9055 result of upgrading one or more packages.
9056
9057 @xref{Invoking guix graph, the @code{reverse-package} type of
9058 @command{guix graph}}, for information on how to visualize the list of
9059 dependents of a package.
9060
9061 @end table
9062
9063 Be aware that the @code{--list-dependent} option only
9064 @emph{approximates} the rebuilds that would be required as a result of
9065 an upgrade. More rebuilds might be required under some circumstances.
9066
9067 @example
9068 $ guix refresh --list-dependent flex
9069 Building the following 120 packages would ensure 213 dependent packages are rebuilt:
9070 hop@@2.4.0 geiser@@0.4 notmuch@@0.18 mu@@0.9.9.5 cflow@@1.4 idutils@@4.6 @dots{}
9071 @end example
9072
9073 The command above lists a set of packages that could be built to check
9074 for compatibility with an upgraded @code{flex} package.
9075
9076 @table @code
9077
9078 @item --list-transitive
9079 List all the packages which one or more packages depend upon.
9080
9081 @example
9082 $ guix refresh --list-transitive flex
9083 flex@@2.6.4 depends on the following 25 packages: perl@@5.28.0 help2man@@1.47.6
9084 bison@@3.0.5 indent@@2.2.10 tar@@1.30 gzip@@1.9 bzip2@@1.0.6 xz@@5.2.4 file@@5.33 @dots{}
9085 @end example
9086
9087 @end table
9088
9089 The command above lists a set of packages which, when changed, would cause
9090 @code{flex} to be rebuilt.
9091
9092 The following options can be used to customize GnuPG operation:
9093
9094 @table @code
9095
9096 @item --gpg=@var{command}
9097 Use @var{command} as the GnuPG 2.x command. @var{command} is searched
9098 for in @code{$PATH}.
9099
9100 @item --keyring=@var{file}
9101 Use @var{file} as the keyring for upstream keys. @var{file} must be in the
9102 @dfn{keybox format}. Keybox files usually have a name ending in @file{.kbx}
9103 and the GNU@tie{}Privacy Guard (GPG) can manipulate these files
9104 (@pxref{kbxutil, @command{kbxutil},, gnupg, Using the GNU Privacy Guard}, for
9105 information on a tool to manipulate keybox files).
9106
9107 When this option is omitted, @command{guix refresh} uses
9108 @file{~/.config/guix/upstream/trustedkeys.kbx} as the keyring for upstream
9109 signing keys. OpenPGP signatures are checked against keys from this keyring;
9110 missing keys are downloaded to this keyring as well (see
9111 @option{--key-download} below.)
9112
9113 You can export keys from your default GPG keyring into a keybox file using
9114 commands like this one:
9115
9116 @example
9117 gpg --export rms@@gnu.org | kbxutil --import-openpgp >> mykeyring.kbx
9118 @end example
9119
9120 Likewise, you can fetch keys to a specific keybox file like this:
9121
9122 @example
9123 gpg --no-default-keyring --keyring mykeyring.kbx \
9124 --recv-keys @value{OPENPGP-SIGNING-KEY-ID}
9125 @end example
9126
9127 @ref{GPG Configuration Options, @option{--keyring},, gnupg, Using the GNU
9128 Privacy Guard}, for more information on GPG's @option{--keyring} option.
9129
9130 @item --key-download=@var{policy}
9131 Handle missing OpenPGP keys according to @var{policy}, which may be one
9132 of:
9133
9134 @table @code
9135 @item always
9136 Always download missing OpenPGP keys from the key server, and add them
9137 to the user's GnuPG keyring.
9138
9139 @item never
9140 Never try to download missing OpenPGP keys. Instead just bail out.
9141
9142 @item interactive
9143 When a package signed with an unknown OpenPGP key is encountered, ask
9144 the user whether to download it or not. This is the default behavior.
9145 @end table
9146
9147 @item --key-server=@var{host}
9148 Use @var{host} as the OpenPGP key server when importing a public key.
9149
9150 @end table
9151
9152 The @code{github} updater uses the
9153 @uref{https://developer.github.com/v3/, GitHub API} to query for new
9154 releases. When used repeatedly e.g.@: when refreshing all packages,
9155 GitHub will eventually refuse to answer any further API requests. By
9156 default 60 API requests per hour are allowed, and a full refresh on all
9157 GitHub packages in Guix requires more than this. Authentication with
9158 GitHub through the use of an API token alleviates these limits. To use
9159 an API token, set the environment variable @code{GUIX_GITHUB_TOKEN} to a
9160 token procured from @uref{https://github.com/settings/tokens} or
9161 otherwise.
9162
9163
9164 @node Invoking guix lint
9165 @section Invoking @command{guix lint}
9166
9167 @cindex @command{guix lint}
9168 @cindex package, checking for errors
9169 The @command{guix lint} command is meant to help package developers avoid
9170 common errors and use a consistent style. It runs a number of checks on
9171 a given set of packages in order to find common mistakes in their
9172 definitions. Available @dfn{checkers} include (see
9173 @code{--list-checkers} for a complete list):
9174
9175 @table @code
9176 @item synopsis
9177 @itemx description
9178 Validate certain typographical and stylistic rules about package
9179 descriptions and synopses.
9180
9181 @item inputs-should-be-native
9182 Identify inputs that should most likely be native inputs.
9183
9184 @item source
9185 @itemx home-page
9186 @itemx mirror-url
9187 @itemx github-url
9188 @itemx source-file-name
9189 Probe @code{home-page} and @code{source} URLs and report those that are
9190 invalid. Suggest a @code{mirror://} URL when applicable. If the
9191 @code{source} URL redirects to a GitHub URL, recommend usage of the GitHub
9192 URL. Check that the source file name is meaningful, e.g.@: is not just a
9193 version number or ``git-checkout'', without a declared @code{file-name}
9194 (@pxref{origin Reference}).
9195
9196 @item source-unstable-tarball
9197 Parse the @code{source} URL to determine if a tarball from GitHub is
9198 autogenerated or if it is a release tarball. Unfortunately GitHub's
9199 autogenerated tarballs are sometimes regenerated.
9200
9201 @item cve
9202 @cindex security vulnerabilities
9203 @cindex CVE, Common Vulnerabilities and Exposures
9204 Report known vulnerabilities found in the Common Vulnerabilities and
9205 Exposures (CVE) databases of the current and past year
9206 @uref{https://nvd.nist.gov/download.cfm#CVE_FEED, published by the US
9207 NIST}.
9208
9209 To view information about a particular vulnerability, visit pages such as:
9210
9211 @itemize
9212 @item
9213 @indicateurl{https://web.nvd.nist.gov/view/vuln/detail?vulnId=CVE-YYYY-ABCD}
9214 @item
9215 @indicateurl{https://cve.mitre.org/cgi-bin/cvename.cgi?name=CVE-YYYY-ABCD}
9216 @end itemize
9217
9218 @noindent
9219 where @code{CVE-YYYY-ABCD} is the CVE identifier---e.g.,
9220 @code{CVE-2015-7554}.
9221
9222 Package developers can specify in package recipes the
9223 @uref{https://nvd.nist.gov/cpe.cfm,Common Platform Enumeration (CPE)}
9224 name and version of the package when they differ from the name or version
9225 that Guix uses, as in this example:
9226
9227 @example
9228 (package
9229 (name "grub")
9230 ;; @dots{}
9231 ;; CPE calls this package "grub2".
9232 (properties '((cpe-name . "grub2")
9233 (cpe-version . "2.3")))
9234 @end example
9235
9236 @c See <https://www.openwall.com/lists/oss-security/2017/03/15/3>.
9237 Some entries in the CVE database do not specify which version of a
9238 package they apply to, and would thus ``stick around'' forever. Package
9239 developers who found CVE alerts and verified they can be ignored can
9240 declare them as in this example:
9241
9242 @example
9243 (package
9244 (name "t1lib")
9245 ;; @dots{}
9246 ;; These CVEs no longer apply and can be safely ignored.
9247 (properties `((lint-hidden-cve . ("CVE-2011-0433"
9248 "CVE-2011-1553"
9249 "CVE-2011-1554"
9250 "CVE-2011-5244")))))
9251 @end example
9252
9253 @item formatting
9254 Warn about obvious source code formatting issues: trailing white space,
9255 use of tabulations, etc.
9256 @end table
9257
9258 The general syntax is:
9259
9260 @example
9261 guix lint @var{options} @var{package}@dots{}
9262 @end example
9263
9264 If no package is given on the command line, then all packages are checked.
9265 The @var{options} may be zero or more of the following:
9266
9267 @table @code
9268 @item --list-checkers
9269 @itemx -l
9270 List and describe all the available checkers that will be run on packages
9271 and exit.
9272
9273 @item --checkers
9274 @itemx -c
9275 Only enable the checkers specified in a comma-separated list using the
9276 names returned by @code{--list-checkers}.
9277
9278 @end table
9279
9280 @node Invoking guix size
9281 @section Invoking @command{guix size}
9282
9283 @cindex size
9284 @cindex package size
9285 @cindex closure
9286 @cindex @command{guix size}
9287 The @command{guix size} command helps package developers profile the
9288 disk usage of packages. It is easy to overlook the impact of an
9289 additional dependency added to a package, or the impact of using a
9290 single output for a package that could easily be split (@pxref{Packages
9291 with Multiple Outputs}). Such are the typical issues that
9292 @command{guix size} can highlight.
9293
9294 The command can be passed one or more package specifications
9295 such as @code{gcc@@4.8}
9296 or @code{guile:debug}, or a file name in the store. Consider this
9297 example:
9298
9299 @example
9300 $ guix size coreutils
9301 store item total self
9302 /gnu/store/@dots{}-gcc-5.5.0-lib 60.4 30.1 38.1%
9303 /gnu/store/@dots{}-glibc-2.27 30.3 28.8 36.6%
9304 /gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.28 78.9 15.0 19.0%
9305 /gnu/store/@dots{}-gmp-6.1.2 63.1 2.7 3.4%
9306 /gnu/store/@dots{}-bash-static-4.4.12 1.5 1.5 1.9%
9307 /gnu/store/@dots{}-acl-2.2.52 61.1 0.4 0.5%
9308 /gnu/store/@dots{}-attr-2.4.47 60.6 0.2 0.3%
9309 /gnu/store/@dots{}-libcap-2.25 60.5 0.2 0.2%
9310 total: 78.9 MiB
9311 @end example
9312
9313 @cindex closure
9314 The store items listed here constitute the @dfn{transitive closure} of
9315 Coreutils---i.e., Coreutils and all its dependencies, recursively---as
9316 would be returned by:
9317
9318 @example
9319 $ guix gc -R /gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.23
9320 @end example
9321
9322 Here the output shows three columns next to store items. The first column,
9323 labeled ``total'', shows the size in mebibytes (MiB) of the closure of
9324 the store item---that is, its own size plus the size of all its
9325 dependencies. The next column, labeled ``self'', shows the size of the
9326 item itself. The last column shows the ratio of the size of the item
9327 itself to the space occupied by all the items listed here.
9328
9329 In this example, we see that the closure of Coreutils weighs in at
9330 79@tie{}MiB, most of which is taken by libc and GCC's run-time support
9331 libraries. (That libc and GCC's libraries represent a large fraction of
9332 the closure is not a problem @i{per se} because they are always available
9333 on the system anyway.)
9334
9335 When the package(s) passed to @command{guix size} are available in the
9336 store@footnote{More precisely, @command{guix size} looks for the
9337 @emph{ungrafted} variant of the given package(s), as returned by
9338 @code{guix build @var{package} --no-grafts}. @xref{Security Updates},
9339 for information on grafts.}, @command{guix size} queries the daemon to determine its
9340 dependencies, and measures its size in the store, similar to @command{du
9341 -ms --apparent-size} (@pxref{du invocation,,, coreutils, GNU
9342 Coreutils}).
9343
9344 When the given packages are @emph{not} in the store, @command{guix size}
9345 reports information based on the available substitutes
9346 (@pxref{Substitutes}). This makes it possible it to profile disk usage of
9347 store items that are not even on disk, only available remotely.
9348
9349 You can also specify several package names:
9350
9351 @example
9352 $ guix size coreutils grep sed bash
9353 store item total self
9354 /gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.24 77.8 13.8 13.4%
9355 /gnu/store/@dots{}-grep-2.22 73.1 0.8 0.8%
9356 /gnu/store/@dots{}-bash-4.3.42 72.3 4.7 4.6%
9357 /gnu/store/@dots{}-readline-6.3 67.6 1.2 1.2%
9358 @dots{}
9359 total: 102.3 MiB
9360 @end example
9361
9362 @noindent
9363 In this example we see that the combination of the four packages takes
9364 102.3@tie{}MiB in total, which is much less than the sum of each closure
9365 since they have a lot of dependencies in common.
9366
9367 The available options are:
9368
9369 @table @option
9370
9371 @item --substitute-urls=@var{urls}
9372 Use substitute information from @var{urls}.
9373 @xref{client-substitute-urls, the same option for @code{guix build}}.
9374
9375 @item --sort=@var{key}
9376 Sort lines according to @var{key}, one of the following options:
9377
9378 @table @code
9379 @item self
9380 the size of each item (the default);
9381 @item closure
9382 the total size of the item's closure.
9383 @end table
9384
9385 @item --map-file=@var{file}
9386 Write a graphical map of disk usage in PNG format to @var{file}.
9387
9388 For the example above, the map looks like this:
9389
9390 @image{images/coreutils-size-map,5in,, map of Coreutils disk usage
9391 produced by @command{guix size}}
9392
9393 This option requires that
9394 @uref{https://wingolog.org/software/guile-charting/, Guile-Charting} be
9395 installed and visible in Guile's module search path. When that is not
9396 the case, @command{guix size} fails as it tries to load it.
9397
9398 @item --system=@var{system}
9399 @itemx -s @var{system}
9400 Consider packages for @var{system}---e.g., @code{x86_64-linux}.
9401
9402 @end table
9403
9404 @node Invoking guix graph
9405 @section Invoking @command{guix graph}
9406
9407 @cindex DAG
9408 @cindex @command{guix graph}
9409 @cindex package dependencies
9410 Packages and their dependencies form a @dfn{graph}, specifically a
9411 directed acyclic graph (DAG). It can quickly become difficult to have a
9412 mental model of the package DAG, so the @command{guix graph} command
9413 provides a visual representation of the DAG. By default,
9414 @command{guix graph} emits a DAG representation in the input format of
9415 @uref{https://www.graphviz.org/, Graphviz}, so its output can be passed
9416 directly to the @command{dot} command of Graphviz. It can also emit an
9417 HTML page with embedded JavaScript code to display a ``chord diagram''
9418 in a Web browser, using the @uref{https://d3js.org/, d3.js} library, or
9419 emit Cypher queries to construct a graph in a graph database supporting
9420 the @uref{https://www.opencypher.org/, openCypher} query language.
9421 The general syntax is:
9422
9423 @example
9424 guix graph @var{options} @var{package}@dots{}
9425 @end example
9426
9427 For example, the following command generates a PDF file representing the
9428 package DAG for the GNU@tie{}Core Utilities, showing its build-time
9429 dependencies:
9430
9431 @example
9432 guix graph coreutils | dot -Tpdf > dag.pdf
9433 @end example
9434
9435 The output looks like this:
9436
9437 @image{images/coreutils-graph,2in,,Dependency graph of the GNU Coreutils}
9438
9439 Nice little graph, no?
9440
9441 But there is more than one graph! The one above is concise: it is the
9442 graph of package objects, omitting implicit inputs such as GCC, libc,
9443 grep, etc. It is often useful to have such a concise graph, but
9444 sometimes one may want to see more details. @command{guix graph} supports
9445 several types of graphs, allowing you to choose the level of detail:
9446
9447 @table @code
9448 @item package
9449 This is the default type used in the example above. It shows the DAG of
9450 package objects, excluding implicit dependencies. It is concise, but
9451 filters out many details.
9452
9453 @item reverse-package
9454 This shows the @emph{reverse} DAG of packages. For example:
9455
9456 @example
9457 guix graph --type=reverse-package ocaml
9458 @end example
9459
9460 ...@: yields the graph of packages that @emph{explicitly} depend on OCaml (if
9461 you are also interested in cases where OCaml is an implicit dependency, see
9462 @code{reverse-bag} below.)
9463
9464 Note that for core packages this can yield huge graphs. If all you want
9465 is to know the number of packages that depend on a given package, use
9466 @command{guix refresh --list-dependent} (@pxref{Invoking guix refresh,
9467 @option{--list-dependent}}).
9468
9469 @item bag-emerged
9470 This is the package DAG, @emph{including} implicit inputs.
9471
9472 For instance, the following command:
9473
9474 @example
9475 guix graph --type=bag-emerged coreutils | dot -Tpdf > dag.pdf
9476 @end example
9477
9478 ...@: yields this bigger graph:
9479
9480 @image{images/coreutils-bag-graph,,5in,Detailed dependency graph of the GNU Coreutils}
9481
9482 At the bottom of the graph, we see all the implicit inputs of
9483 @var{gnu-build-system} (@pxref{Build Systems, @code{gnu-build-system}}).
9484
9485 Now, note that the dependencies of these implicit inputs---that is, the
9486 @dfn{bootstrap dependencies} (@pxref{Bootstrapping})---are not shown
9487 here, for conciseness.
9488
9489 @item bag
9490 Similar to @code{bag-emerged}, but this time including all the bootstrap
9491 dependencies.
9492
9493 @item bag-with-origins
9494 Similar to @code{bag}, but also showing origins and their dependencies.
9495
9496 @item reverse-bag
9497 This shows the @emph{reverse} DAG of packages. Unlike @code{reverse-package},
9498 it also takes implicit dependencies into account. For example:
9499
9500 @example
9501 guix graph -t reverse-bag dune
9502 @end example
9503
9504 @noindent
9505 ...@: yields the graph of all packages that depend on Dune, directly or
9506 indirectly. Since Dune is an @emph{implicit} dependency of many packages
9507 @i{via} @code{dune-build-system}, this shows a large number of packages,
9508 whereas @code{reverse-package} would show very few if any.
9509
9510 @item derivation
9511 This is the most detailed representation: It shows the DAG of
9512 derivations (@pxref{Derivations}) and plain store items. Compared to
9513 the above representation, many additional nodes are visible, including
9514 build scripts, patches, Guile modules, etc.
9515
9516 For this type of graph, it is also possible to pass a @file{.drv} file
9517 name instead of a package name, as in:
9518
9519 @example
9520 guix graph -t derivation `guix system build -d my-config.scm`
9521 @end example
9522
9523 @item module
9524 This is the graph of @dfn{package modules} (@pxref{Package Modules}).
9525 For example, the following command shows the graph for the package
9526 module that defines the @code{guile} package:
9527
9528 @example
9529 guix graph -t module guile | dot -Tpdf > module-graph.pdf
9530 @end example
9531 @end table
9532
9533 All the types above correspond to @emph{build-time dependencies}. The
9534 following graph type represents the @emph{run-time dependencies}:
9535
9536 @table @code
9537 @item references
9538 This is the graph of @dfn{references} of a package output, as returned
9539 by @command{guix gc --references} (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}).
9540
9541 If the given package output is not available in the store, @command{guix
9542 graph} attempts to obtain dependency information from substitutes.
9543
9544 Here you can also pass a store file name instead of a package name. For
9545 example, the command below produces the reference graph of your profile
9546 (which can be big!):
9547
9548 @example
9549 guix graph -t references `readlink -f ~/.guix-profile`
9550 @end example
9551
9552 @item referrers
9553 This is the graph of the @dfn{referrers} of a store item, as returned by
9554 @command{guix gc --referrers} (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}).
9555
9556 This relies exclusively on local information from your store. For
9557 instance, let us suppose that the current Inkscape is available in 10
9558 profiles on your machine; @command{guix graph -t referrers inkscape}
9559 will show a graph rooted at Inkscape and with those 10 profiles linked
9560 to it.
9561
9562 It can help determine what is preventing a store item from being garbage
9563 collected.
9564
9565 @end table
9566
9567 The available options are the following:
9568
9569 @table @option
9570 @item --type=@var{type}
9571 @itemx -t @var{type}
9572 Produce a graph output of @var{type}, where @var{type} must be one of
9573 the values listed above.
9574
9575 @item --list-types
9576 List the supported graph types.
9577
9578 @item --backend=@var{backend}
9579 @itemx -b @var{backend}
9580 Produce a graph using the selected @var{backend}.
9581
9582 @item --list-backends
9583 List the supported graph backends.
9584
9585 Currently, the available backends are Graphviz and d3.js.
9586
9587 @item --expression=@var{expr}
9588 @itemx -e @var{expr}
9589 Consider the package @var{expr} evaluates to.
9590
9591 This is useful to precisely refer to a package, as in this example:
9592
9593 @example
9594 guix graph -e '(@@@@ (gnu packages commencement) gnu-make-final)'
9595 @end example
9596
9597 @item --system=@var{system}
9598 @itemx -s @var{system}
9599 Display the graph for @var{system}---e.g., @code{i686-linux}.
9600
9601 The package dependency graph is largely architecture-independent, but there
9602 are some architecture-dependent bits that this option allows you to visualize.
9603 @end table
9604
9605
9606
9607 @node Invoking guix publish
9608 @section Invoking @command{guix publish}
9609
9610 @cindex @command{guix publish}
9611 The purpose of @command{guix publish} is to enable users to easily share
9612 their store with others, who can then use it as a substitute server
9613 (@pxref{Substitutes}).
9614
9615 When @command{guix publish} runs, it spawns an HTTP server which allows
9616 anyone with network access to obtain substitutes from it. This means
9617 that any machine running Guix can also act as if it were a build farm,
9618 since the HTTP interface is compatible with Cuirass, the software behind
9619 the @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} build farm.
9620
9621 For security, each substitute is signed, allowing recipients to check
9622 their authenticity and integrity (@pxref{Substitutes}). Because
9623 @command{guix publish} uses the signing key of the system, which is only
9624 readable by the system administrator, it must be started as root; the
9625 @code{--user} option makes it drop root privileges early on.
9626
9627 The signing key pair must be generated before @command{guix publish} is
9628 launched, using @command{guix archive --generate-key} (@pxref{Invoking
9629 guix archive}).
9630
9631 The general syntax is:
9632
9633 @example
9634 guix publish @var{options}@dots{}
9635 @end example
9636
9637 Running @command{guix publish} without any additional arguments will
9638 spawn an HTTP server on port 8080:
9639
9640 @example
9641 guix publish
9642 @end example
9643
9644 Once a publishing server has been authorized (@pxref{Invoking guix
9645 archive}), the daemon may download substitutes from it:
9646
9647 @example
9648 guix-daemon --substitute-urls=http://example.org:8080
9649 @end example
9650
9651 By default, @command{guix publish} compresses archives on the fly as it
9652 serves them. This ``on-the-fly'' mode is convenient in that it requires
9653 no setup and is immediately available. However, when serving lots of
9654 clients, we recommend using the @option{--cache} option, which enables
9655 caching of the archives before they are sent to clients---see below for
9656 details. The @command{guix weather} command provides a handy way to
9657 check what a server provides (@pxref{Invoking guix weather}).
9658
9659 As a bonus, @command{guix publish} also serves as a content-addressed
9660 mirror for source files referenced in @code{origin} records
9661 (@pxref{origin Reference}). For instance, assuming @command{guix
9662 publish} is running on @code{example.org}, the following URL returns the
9663 raw @file{hello-2.10.tar.gz} file with the given SHA256 hash
9664 (represented in @code{nix-base32} format, @pxref{Invoking guix hash}):
9665
9666 @example
9667 http://example.org/file/hello-2.10.tar.gz/sha256/0ssi1@dots{}ndq1i
9668 @end example
9669
9670 Obviously, these URLs only work for files that are in the store; in
9671 other cases, they return 404 (``Not Found'').
9672
9673 @cindex build logs, publication
9674 Build logs are available from @code{/log} URLs like:
9675
9676 @example
9677 http://example.org/log/gwspk@dots{}-guile-2.2.3
9678 @end example
9679
9680 @noindent
9681 When @command{guix-daemon} is configured to save compressed build logs,
9682 as is the case by default (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon}), @code{/log}
9683 URLs return the compressed log as-is, with an appropriate
9684 @code{Content-Type} and/or @code{Content-Encoding} header. We recommend
9685 running @command{guix-daemon} with @code{--log-compression=gzip} since
9686 Web browsers can automatically decompress it, which is not the case with
9687 bzip2 compression.
9688
9689 The following options are available:
9690
9691 @table @code
9692 @item --port=@var{port}
9693 @itemx -p @var{port}
9694 Listen for HTTP requests on @var{port}.
9695
9696 @item --listen=@var{host}
9697 Listen on the network interface for @var{host}. The default is to
9698 accept connections from any interface.
9699
9700 @item --user=@var{user}
9701 @itemx -u @var{user}
9702 Change privileges to @var{user} as soon as possible---i.e., once the
9703 server socket is open and the signing key has been read.
9704
9705 @item --compression[=@var{method}[:@var{level}]]
9706 @itemx -C [@var{method}[:@var{level}]]
9707 Compress data using the given @var{method} and @var{level}. @var{method} is
9708 one of @code{lzip} and @code{gzip}; when @var{method} is omitted, @code{gzip}
9709 is used.
9710
9711 When @var{level} is zero, disable compression. The range 1 to 9 corresponds
9712 to different compression levels: 1 is the fastest, and 9 is the best
9713 (CPU-intensive). The default is 3.
9714
9715 Usually, @code{lzip} compresses noticeably better than @code{gzip} for a small
9716 increase in CPU usage; see
9717 @uref{https://nongnu.org/lzip/lzip_benchmark.html,benchmarks on the lzip Web
9718 page}.
9719
9720 Unless @option{--cache} is used, compression occurs on the fly and
9721 the compressed streams are not
9722 cached. Thus, to reduce load on the machine that runs @command{guix
9723 publish}, it may be a good idea to choose a low compression level, to
9724 run @command{guix publish} behind a caching proxy, or to use
9725 @option{--cache}. Using @option{--cache} has the advantage that it
9726 allows @command{guix publish} to add @code{Content-Length} HTTP header
9727 to its responses.
9728
9729 This option can be repeated, in which case every substitute gets compressed
9730 using all the selected methods, and all of them are advertised. This is
9731 useful when users may not support all the compression methods: they can select
9732 the one they support.
9733
9734 @item --cache=@var{directory}
9735 @itemx -c @var{directory}
9736 Cache archives and meta-data (@code{.narinfo} URLs) to @var{directory}
9737 and only serve archives that are in cache.
9738
9739 When this option is omitted, archives and meta-data are created
9740 on-the-fly. This can reduce the available bandwidth, especially when
9741 compression is enabled, since this may become CPU-bound. Another
9742 drawback of the default mode is that the length of archives is not known
9743 in advance, so @command{guix publish} does not add a
9744 @code{Content-Length} HTTP header to its responses, which in turn
9745 prevents clients from knowing the amount of data being downloaded.
9746
9747 Conversely, when @option{--cache} is used, the first request for a store
9748 item (@i{via} a @code{.narinfo} URL) returns 404 and triggers a
9749 background process to @dfn{bake} the archive---computing its
9750 @code{.narinfo} and compressing the archive, if needed. Once the
9751 archive is cached in @var{directory}, subsequent requests succeed and
9752 are served directly from the cache, which guarantees that clients get
9753 the best possible bandwidth.
9754
9755 The ``baking'' process is performed by worker threads. By default, one
9756 thread per CPU core is created, but this can be customized. See
9757 @option{--workers} below.
9758
9759 When @option{--ttl} is used, cached entries are automatically deleted
9760 when they have expired.
9761
9762 @item --workers=@var{N}
9763 When @option{--cache} is used, request the allocation of @var{N} worker
9764 threads to ``bake'' archives.
9765
9766 @item --ttl=@var{ttl}
9767 Produce @code{Cache-Control} HTTP headers that advertise a time-to-live
9768 (TTL) of @var{ttl}. @var{ttl} must denote a duration: @code{5d} means 5
9769 days, @code{1m} means 1 month, and so on.
9770
9771 This allows the user's Guix to keep substitute information in cache for
9772 @var{ttl}. However, note that @code{guix publish} does not itself
9773 guarantee that the store items it provides will indeed remain available
9774 for as long as @var{ttl}.
9775
9776 Additionally, when @option{--cache} is used, cached entries that have
9777 not been accessed for @var{ttl} and that no longer have a corresponding
9778 item in the store, may be deleted.
9779
9780 @item --nar-path=@var{path}
9781 Use @var{path} as the prefix for the URLs of ``nar'' files
9782 (@pxref{Invoking guix archive, normalized archives}).
9783
9784 By default, nars are served at a URL such as
9785 @code{/nar/gzip/@dots{}-coreutils-8.25}. This option allows you to
9786 change the @code{/nar} part to @var{path}.
9787
9788 @item --public-key=@var{file}
9789 @itemx --private-key=@var{file}
9790 Use the specific @var{file}s as the public/private key pair used to sign
9791 the store items being published.
9792
9793 The files must correspond to the same key pair (the private key is used
9794 for signing and the public key is merely advertised in the signature
9795 metadata). They must contain keys in the canonical s-expression format
9796 as produced by @command{guix archive --generate-key} (@pxref{Invoking
9797 guix archive}). By default, @file{/etc/guix/signing-key.pub} and
9798 @file{/etc/guix/signing-key.sec} are used.
9799
9800 @item --repl[=@var{port}]
9801 @itemx -r [@var{port}]
9802 Spawn a Guile REPL server (@pxref{REPL Servers,,, guile, GNU Guile
9803 Reference Manual}) on @var{port} (37146 by default). This is used
9804 primarily for debugging a running @command{guix publish} server.
9805 @end table
9806
9807 Enabling @command{guix publish} on Guix System is a one-liner: just
9808 instantiate a @code{guix-publish-service-type} service in the @code{services} field
9809 of the @code{operating-system} declaration (@pxref{guix-publish-service-type,
9810 @code{guix-publish-service-type}}).
9811
9812 If you are instead running Guix on a ``foreign distro'', follow these
9813 instructions:”
9814
9815 @itemize
9816 @item
9817 If your host distro uses the systemd init system:
9818
9819 @example
9820 # ln -s ~root/.guix-profile/lib/systemd/system/guix-publish.service \
9821 /etc/systemd/system/
9822 # systemctl start guix-publish && systemctl enable guix-publish
9823 @end example
9824
9825 @item
9826 If your host distro uses the Upstart init system:
9827
9828 @example
9829 # ln -s ~root/.guix-profile/lib/upstart/system/guix-publish.conf /etc/init/
9830 # start guix-publish
9831 @end example
9832
9833 @item
9834 Otherwise, proceed similarly with your distro's init system.
9835 @end itemize
9836
9837 @node Invoking guix challenge
9838 @section Invoking @command{guix challenge}
9839
9840 @cindex reproducible builds
9841 @cindex verifiable builds
9842 @cindex @command{guix challenge}
9843 @cindex challenge
9844 Do the binaries provided by this server really correspond to the source
9845 code it claims to build? Is a package build process deterministic?
9846 These are the questions the @command{guix challenge} command attempts to
9847 answer.
9848
9849 The former is obviously an important question: Before using a substitute
9850 server (@pxref{Substitutes}), one had better @emph{verify} that it
9851 provides the right binaries, and thus @emph{challenge} it. The latter
9852 is what enables the former: If package builds are deterministic, then
9853 independent builds of the package should yield the exact same result,
9854 bit for bit; if a server provides a binary different from the one
9855 obtained locally, it may be either corrupt or malicious.
9856
9857 We know that the hash that shows up in @file{/gnu/store} file names is
9858 the hash of all the inputs of the process that built the file or
9859 directory---compilers, libraries, build scripts,
9860 etc. (@pxref{Introduction}). Assuming deterministic build processes,
9861 one store file name should map to exactly one build output.
9862 @command{guix challenge} checks whether there is, indeed, a single
9863 mapping by comparing the build outputs of several independent builds of
9864 any given store item.
9865
9866 The command output looks like this:
9867
9868 @smallexample
9869 $ guix challenge --substitute-urls="https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER} https://guix.example.org"
9870 updating list of substitutes from 'https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}'... 100.0%
9871 updating list of substitutes from 'https://guix.example.org'... 100.0%
9872 /gnu/store/@dots{}-openssl-1.0.2d contents differ:
9873 local hash: 0725l22r5jnzazaacncwsvp9kgf42266ayyp814v7djxs7nk963q
9874 https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}/nar/@dots{}-openssl-1.0.2d: 0725l22r5jnzazaacncwsvp9kgf42266ayyp814v7djxs7nk963q
9875 https://guix.example.org/nar/@dots{}-openssl-1.0.2d: 1zy4fmaaqcnjrzzajkdn3f5gmjk754b43qkq47llbyak9z0qjyim
9876 /gnu/store/@dots{}-git-2.5.0 contents differ:
9877 local hash: 00p3bmryhjxrhpn2gxs2fy0a15lnip05l97205pgbk5ra395hyha
9878 https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}/nar/@dots{}-git-2.5.0: 069nb85bv4d4a6slrwjdy8v1cn4cwspm3kdbmyb81d6zckj3nq9f
9879 https://guix.example.org/nar/@dots{}-git-2.5.0: 0mdqa9w1p6cmli6976v4wi0sw9r4p5prkj7lzfd1877wk11c9c73
9880 /gnu/store/@dots{}-pius-2.1.1 contents differ:
9881 local hash: 0k4v3m9z1zp8xzzizb7d8kjj72f9172xv078sq4wl73vnq9ig3ax
9882 https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}/nar/@dots{}-pius-2.1.1: 0k4v3m9z1zp8xzzizb7d8kjj72f9172xv078sq4wl73vnq9ig3ax
9883 https://guix.example.org/nar/@dots{}-pius-2.1.1: 1cy25x1a4fzq5rk0pmvc8xhwyffnqz95h2bpvqsz2mpvlbccy0gs
9884
9885 @dots{}
9886
9887 6,406 store items were analyzed:
9888 - 4,749 (74.1%) were identical
9889 - 525 (8.2%) differed
9890 - 1,132 (17.7%) were inconclusive
9891 @end smallexample
9892
9893 @noindent
9894 In this example, @command{guix challenge} first scans the store to
9895 determine the set of locally-built derivations---as opposed to store
9896 items that were downloaded from a substitute server---and then queries
9897 all the substitute servers. It then reports those store items for which
9898 the servers obtained a result different from the local build.
9899
9900 @cindex non-determinism, in package builds
9901 As an example, @code{guix.example.org} always gets a different answer.
9902 Conversely, @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} agrees with local builds, except in the
9903 case of Git. This might indicate that the build process of Git is
9904 non-deterministic, meaning that its output varies as a function of
9905 various things that Guix does not fully control, in spite of building
9906 packages in isolated environments (@pxref{Features}). Most common
9907 sources of non-determinism include the addition of timestamps in build
9908 results, the inclusion of random numbers, and directory listings sorted
9909 by inode number. See @uref{https://reproducible-builds.org/docs/}, for
9910 more information.
9911
9912 To find out what is wrong with this Git binary, we can do something along
9913 these lines (@pxref{Invoking guix archive}):
9914
9915 @example
9916 $ wget -q -O - https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}/nar/@dots{}-git-2.5.0 \
9917 | guix archive -x /tmp/git
9918 $ diff -ur --no-dereference /gnu/store/@dots{}-git.2.5.0 /tmp/git
9919 @end example
9920
9921 This command shows the difference between the files resulting from the
9922 local build, and the files resulting from the build on
9923 @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} (@pxref{Overview, Comparing and Merging Files,,
9924 diffutils, Comparing and Merging Files}). The @command{diff} command
9925 works great for text files. When binary files differ, a better option
9926 is @uref{https://diffoscope.org/, Diffoscope}, a tool that helps
9927 visualize differences for all kinds of files.
9928
9929 Once you have done that work, you can tell whether the differences are due
9930 to a non-deterministic build process or to a malicious server. We try
9931 hard to remove sources of non-determinism in packages to make it easier
9932 to verify substitutes, but of course, this is a process that
9933 involves not just Guix, but a large part of the free software community.
9934 In the meantime, @command{guix challenge} is one tool to help address
9935 the problem.
9936
9937 If you are writing packages for Guix, you are encouraged to check
9938 whether @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} and other substitute servers obtain the
9939 same build result as you did with:
9940
9941 @example
9942 $ guix challenge @var{package}
9943 @end example
9944
9945 @noindent
9946 where @var{package} is a package specification such as
9947 @code{guile@@2.0} or @code{glibc:debug}.
9948
9949 The general syntax is:
9950
9951 @example
9952 guix challenge @var{options} [@var{packages}@dots{}]
9953 @end example
9954
9955 When a difference is found between the hash of a locally-built item and
9956 that of a server-provided substitute, or among substitutes provided by
9957 different servers, the command displays it as in the example above and
9958 its exit code is 2 (other non-zero exit codes denote other kinds of
9959 errors.)
9960
9961 The one option that matters is:
9962
9963 @table @code
9964
9965 @item --substitute-urls=@var{urls}
9966 Consider @var{urls} the whitespace-separated list of substitute source
9967 URLs to compare to.
9968
9969 @item --verbose
9970 @itemx -v
9971 Show details about matches (identical contents) in addition to
9972 information about mismatches.
9973
9974 @end table
9975
9976 @node Invoking guix copy
9977 @section Invoking @command{guix copy}
9978
9979 @cindex copy, of store items, over SSH
9980 @cindex SSH, copy of store items
9981 @cindex sharing store items across machines
9982 @cindex transferring store items across machines
9983 The @command{guix copy} command copies items from the store of one
9984 machine to that of another machine over a secure shell (SSH)
9985 connection@footnote{This command is available only when Guile-SSH was
9986 found. @xref{Requirements}, for details.}. For example, the following
9987 command copies the @code{coreutils} package, the user's profile, and all
9988 their dependencies over to @var{host}, logged in as @var{user}:
9989
9990 @example
9991 guix copy --to=@var{user}@@@var{host} \
9992 coreutils `readlink -f ~/.guix-profile`
9993 @end example
9994
9995 If some of the items to be copied are already present on @var{host},
9996 they are not actually sent.
9997
9998 The command below retrieves @code{libreoffice} and @code{gimp} from
9999 @var{host}, assuming they are available there:
10000
10001 @example
10002 guix copy --from=@var{host} libreoffice gimp
10003 @end example
10004
10005 The SSH connection is established using the Guile-SSH client, which is
10006 compatible with OpenSSH: it honors @file{~/.ssh/known_hosts} and
10007 @file{~/.ssh/config}, and uses the SSH agent for authentication.
10008
10009 The key used to sign items that are sent must be accepted by the remote
10010 machine. Likewise, the key used by the remote machine to sign items you
10011 are retrieving must be in @file{/etc/guix/acl} so it is accepted by your
10012 own daemon. @xref{Invoking guix archive}, for more information about
10013 store item authentication.
10014
10015 The general syntax is:
10016
10017 @example
10018 guix copy [--to=@var{spec}|--from=@var{spec}] @var{items}@dots{}
10019 @end example
10020
10021 You must always specify one of the following options:
10022
10023 @table @code
10024 @item --to=@var{spec}
10025 @itemx --from=@var{spec}
10026 Specify the host to send to or receive from. @var{spec} must be an SSH
10027 spec such as @code{example.org}, @code{charlie@@example.org}, or
10028 @code{charlie@@example.org:2222}.
10029 @end table
10030
10031 The @var{items} can be either package names, such as @code{gimp}, or
10032 store items, such as @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-idutils-4.6}.
10033
10034 When specifying the name of a package to send, it is first built if
10035 needed, unless @option{--dry-run} was specified. Common build options
10036 are supported (@pxref{Common Build Options}).
10037
10038
10039 @node Invoking guix container
10040 @section Invoking @command{guix container}
10041 @cindex container
10042 @cindex @command{guix container}
10043 @quotation Note
10044 As of version @value{VERSION}, this tool is experimental. The interface
10045 is subject to radical change in the future.
10046 @end quotation
10047
10048 The purpose of @command{guix container} is to manipulate processes
10049 running within an isolated environment, commonly known as a
10050 ``container'', typically created by the @command{guix environment}
10051 (@pxref{Invoking guix environment}) and @command{guix system container}
10052 (@pxref{Invoking guix system}) commands.
10053
10054 The general syntax is:
10055
10056 @example
10057 guix container @var{action} @var{options}@dots{}
10058 @end example
10059
10060 @var{action} specifies the operation to perform with a container, and
10061 @var{options} specifies the context-specific arguments for the action.
10062
10063 The following actions are available:
10064
10065 @table @code
10066 @item exec
10067 Execute a command within the context of a running container.
10068
10069 The syntax is:
10070
10071 @example
10072 guix container exec @var{pid} @var{program} @var{arguments}@dots{}
10073 @end example
10074
10075 @var{pid} specifies the process ID of the running container.
10076 @var{program} specifies an executable file name within the root file
10077 system of the container. @var{arguments} are the additional options that
10078 will be passed to @var{program}.
10079
10080 The following command launches an interactive login shell inside a
10081 Guix system container, started by @command{guix system container}, and whose
10082 process ID is 9001:
10083
10084 @example
10085 guix container exec 9001 /run/current-system/profile/bin/bash --login
10086 @end example
10087
10088 Note that the @var{pid} cannot be the parent process of a container. It
10089 must be PID 1 of the container or one of its child processes.
10090
10091 @end table
10092
10093 @node Invoking guix weather
10094 @section Invoking @command{guix weather}
10095
10096 Occasionally you're grumpy because substitutes are lacking and you end
10097 up building packages by yourself (@pxref{Substitutes}). The
10098 @command{guix weather} command reports on substitute availability on the
10099 specified servers so you can have an idea of whether you'll be grumpy
10100 today. It can sometimes be useful info as a user, but it is primarily
10101 useful to people running @command{guix publish} (@pxref{Invoking guix
10102 publish}).
10103
10104 @cindex statistics, for substitutes
10105 @cindex availability of substitutes
10106 @cindex substitute availability
10107 @cindex weather, substitute availability
10108 Here's a sample run:
10109
10110 @example
10111 $ guix weather --substitute-urls=https://guix.example.org
10112 computing 5,872 package derivations for x86_64-linux...
10113 looking for 6,128 store items on https://guix.example.org..
10114 updating list of substitutes from 'https://guix.example.org'... 100.0%
10115 https://guix.example.org
10116 43.4% substitutes available (2,658 out of 6,128)
10117 7,032.5 MiB of nars (compressed)
10118 19,824.2 MiB on disk (uncompressed)
10119 0.030 seconds per request (182.9 seconds in total)
10120 33.5 requests per second
10121
10122 9.8% (342 out of 3,470) of the missing items are queued
10123 867 queued builds
10124 x86_64-linux: 518 (59.7%)
10125 i686-linux: 221 (25.5%)
10126 aarch64-linux: 128 (14.8%)
10127 build rate: 23.41 builds per hour
10128 x86_64-linux: 11.16 builds per hour
10129 i686-linux: 6.03 builds per hour
10130 aarch64-linux: 6.41 builds per hour
10131 @end example
10132
10133 @cindex continuous integration, statistics
10134 As you can see, it reports the fraction of all the packages for which
10135 substitutes are available on the server---regardless of whether
10136 substitutes are enabled, and regardless of whether this server's signing
10137 key is authorized. It also reports the size of the compressed archives
10138 (``nars'') provided by the server, the size the corresponding store
10139 items occupy in the store (assuming deduplication is turned off), and
10140 the server's throughput. The second part gives continuous integration
10141 (CI) statistics, if the server supports it. In addition, using the
10142 @option{--coverage} option, @command{guix weather} can list ``important''
10143 package substitutes missing on the server (see below).
10144
10145 To achieve that, @command{guix weather} queries over HTTP(S) meta-data
10146 (@dfn{narinfos}) for all the relevant store items. Like @command{guix
10147 challenge}, it ignores signatures on those substitutes, which is
10148 innocuous since the command only gathers statistics and cannot install
10149 those substitutes.
10150
10151 The general syntax is:
10152
10153 @example
10154 guix weather @var{options}@dots{} [@var{packages}@dots{}]
10155 @end example
10156
10157 When @var{packages} is omitted, @command{guix weather} checks the availability
10158 of substitutes for @emph{all} the packages, or for those specified with
10159 @option{--manifest}; otherwise it only considers the specified packages. It
10160 is also possible to query specific system types with @option{--system}. The
10161 available options are listed below.
10162
10163 @table @code
10164 @item --substitute-urls=@var{urls}
10165 @var{urls} is the space-separated list of substitute server URLs to
10166 query. When this option is omitted, the default set of substitute
10167 servers is queried.
10168
10169 @item --system=@var{system}
10170 @itemx -s @var{system}
10171 Query substitutes for @var{system}---e.g., @code{aarch64-linux}. This
10172 option can be repeated, in which case @command{guix weather} will query
10173 substitutes for several system types.
10174
10175 @item --manifest=@var{file}
10176 Instead of querying substitutes for all the packages, only ask for those
10177 specified in @var{file}. @var{file} must contain a @dfn{manifest}, as
10178 with the @code{-m} option of @command{guix package} (@pxref{Invoking
10179 guix package}).
10180
10181 @item --coverage[=@var{count}]
10182 @itemx -c [@var{count}]
10183 Report on substitute coverage for packages: list packages with at least
10184 @var{count} dependents (zero by default) for which substitutes are
10185 unavailable. Dependent packages themselves are not listed: if @var{b} depends
10186 on @var{a} and @var{a} has no substitutes, only @var{a} is listed, even though
10187 @var{b} usually lacks substitutes as well. The result looks like this:
10188
10189 @example
10190 $ guix weather --substitute-urls=@value{SUBSTITUTE-URL} -c 10
10191 computing 8,983 package derivations for x86_64-linux...
10192 looking for 9,343 store items on @value{SUBSTITUTE-URL}...
10193 updating substitutes from '@value{SUBSTITUTE-URL}'... 100.0%
10194 @value{SUBSTITUTE-URL}
10195 64.7% substitutes available (6,047 out of 9,343)
10196 @dots{}
10197 2502 packages are missing from '@value{SUBSTITUTE-URL}' for 'x86_64-linux', among which:
10198 58 kcoreaddons@@5.49.0 /gnu/store/@dots{}-kcoreaddons-5.49.0
10199 46 qgpgme@@1.11.1 /gnu/store/@dots{}-qgpgme-1.11.1
10200 37 perl-http-cookiejar@@0.008 /gnu/store/@dots{}-perl-http-cookiejar-0.008
10201 @dots{}
10202 @end example
10203
10204 What this example shows is that @code{kcoreaddons} and presumably the 58
10205 packages that depend on it have no substitutes at @code{ci.guix.info};
10206 likewise for @code{qgpgme} and the 46 packages that depend on it.
10207
10208 If you are a Guix developer, or if you are taking care of this build farm,
10209 you'll probably want to have a closer look at these packages: they may simply
10210 fail to build.
10211 @end table
10212
10213 @node Invoking guix processes
10214 @section Invoking @command{guix processes}
10215
10216 The @command{guix processes} command can be useful to developers and system
10217 administrators, especially on multi-user machines and on build farms: it lists
10218 the current sessions (connections to the daemon), as well as information about
10219 the processes involved@footnote{Remote sessions, when @command{guix-daemon} is
10220 started with @option{--listen} specifying a TCP endpoint, are @emph{not}
10221 listed.}. Here's an example of the information it returns:
10222
10223 @example
10224 $ sudo guix processes
10225 SessionPID: 19002
10226 ClientPID: 19090
10227 ClientCommand: guix environment --ad-hoc python
10228
10229 SessionPID: 19402
10230 ClientPID: 19367
10231 ClientCommand: guix publish -u guix-publish -p 3000 -C 9 @dots{}
10232
10233 SessionPID: 19444
10234 ClientPID: 19419
10235 ClientCommand: cuirass --cache-directory /var/cache/cuirass @dots{}
10236 LockHeld: /gnu/store/@dots{}-perl-ipc-cmd-0.96.lock
10237 LockHeld: /gnu/store/@dots{}-python-six-bootstrap-1.11.0.lock
10238 LockHeld: /gnu/store/@dots{}-libjpeg-turbo-2.0.0.lock
10239 ChildProcess: 20495: guix offload x86_64-linux 7200 1 28800
10240 ChildProcess: 27733: guix offload x86_64-linux 7200 1 28800
10241 ChildProcess: 27793: guix offload x86_64-linux 7200 1 28800
10242 @end example
10243
10244 In this example we see that @command{guix-daemon} has three clients:
10245 @command{guix environment}, @command{guix publish}, and the Cuirass continuous
10246 integration tool; their process identifier (PID) is given by the
10247 @code{ClientPID} field. The @code{SessionPID} field gives the PID of the
10248 @command{guix-daemon} sub-process of this particular session.
10249
10250 The @code{LockHeld} fields show which store items are currently locked by this
10251 session, which corresponds to store items being built or substituted (the
10252 @code{LockHeld} field is not displayed when @command{guix processes} is not
10253 running as root.) Last, by looking at the @code{ChildProcess} field, we
10254 understand that these three builds are being offloaded (@pxref{Daemon Offload
10255 Setup}).
10256
10257 The output is in Recutils format so we can use the handy @command{recsel}
10258 command to select sessions of interest (@pxref{Selection Expressions,,,
10259 recutils, GNU recutils manual}). As an example, the command shows the command
10260 line and PID of the client that triggered the build of a Perl package:
10261
10262 @example
10263 $ sudo guix processes | \
10264 recsel -p ClientPID,ClientCommand -e 'LockHeld ~ "perl"'
10265 ClientPID: 19419
10266 ClientCommand: cuirass --cache-directory /var/cache/cuirass @dots{}
10267 @end example
10268
10269
10270 @node System Configuration
10271 @chapter System Configuration
10272
10273 @cindex system configuration
10274 Guix System supports a consistent whole-system configuration
10275 mechanism. By that we mean that all aspects of the global system
10276 configuration---such as the available system services, timezone and
10277 locale settings, user accounts---are declared in a single place. Such
10278 a @dfn{system configuration} can be @dfn{instantiated}---i.e., effected.
10279
10280 One of the advantages of putting all the system configuration under the
10281 control of Guix is that it supports transactional system upgrades, and
10282 makes it possible to roll back to a previous system instantiation,
10283 should something go wrong with the new one (@pxref{Features}). Another
10284 advantage is that it makes it easy to replicate the exact same configuration
10285 across different machines, or at different points in time, without
10286 having to resort to additional administration tools layered on top of
10287 the own tools of the system.
10288 @c Yes, we're talking of Puppet, Chef, & co. here. ↑
10289
10290 This section describes this mechanism. First we focus on the system
10291 administrator's viewpoint---explaining how the system is configured and
10292 instantiated. Then we show how this mechanism can be extended, for
10293 instance to support new system services.
10294
10295 @menu
10296 * Using the Configuration System:: Customizing your GNU system.
10297 * operating-system Reference:: Detail of operating-system declarations.
10298 * File Systems:: Configuring file system mounts.
10299 * Mapped Devices:: Block device extra processing.
10300 * User Accounts:: Specifying user accounts.
10301 * Keyboard Layout:: How the system interprets key strokes.
10302 * Locales:: Language and cultural convention settings.
10303 * Services:: Specifying system services.
10304 * Setuid Programs:: Programs running with root privileges.
10305 * X.509 Certificates:: Authenticating HTTPS servers.
10306 * Name Service Switch:: Configuring libc's name service switch.
10307 * Initial RAM Disk:: Linux-Libre bootstrapping.
10308 * Bootloader Configuration:: Configuring the boot loader.
10309 * Invoking guix system:: Instantiating a system configuration.
10310 * Invoking guix deploy:: Deploying a system configuration to a remote host.
10311 * Running Guix in a VM:: How to run Guix System in a virtual machine.
10312 * Defining Services:: Adding new service definitions.
10313 @end menu
10314
10315 @node Using the Configuration System
10316 @section Using the Configuration System
10317
10318 The operating system is configured by providing an
10319 @code{operating-system} declaration in a file that can then be passed to
10320 the @command{guix system} command (@pxref{Invoking guix system}). A
10321 simple setup, with the default system services, the default Linux-Libre
10322 kernel, initial RAM disk, and boot loader looks like this:
10323
10324 @findex operating-system
10325 @lisp
10326 @include os-config-bare-bones.texi
10327 @end lisp
10328
10329 This example should be self-describing. Some of the fields defined
10330 above, such as @code{host-name} and @code{bootloader}, are mandatory.
10331 Others, such as @code{packages} and @code{services}, can be omitted, in
10332 which case they get a default value.
10333
10334 Below we discuss the effect of some of the most important fields
10335 (@pxref{operating-system Reference}, for details about all the available
10336 fields), and how to @dfn{instantiate} the operating system using
10337 @command{guix system}.
10338
10339 @unnumberedsubsec Bootloader
10340
10341 @cindex legacy boot, on Intel machines
10342 @cindex BIOS boot, on Intel machines
10343 @cindex UEFI boot
10344 @cindex EFI boot
10345 The @code{bootloader} field describes the method that will be used to boot
10346 your system. Machines based on Intel processors can boot in ``legacy'' BIOS
10347 mode, as in the example above. However, more recent machines rely instead on
10348 the @dfn{Unified Extensible Firmware Interface} (UEFI) to boot. In that case,
10349 the @code{bootloader} field should contain something along these lines:
10350
10351 @example
10352 (bootloader-configuration
10353 (bootloader grub-efi-bootloader)
10354 (target "/boot/efi"))
10355 @end example
10356
10357 @xref{Bootloader Configuration}, for more information on the available
10358 configuration options.
10359
10360 @unnumberedsubsec Globally-Visible Packages
10361
10362 @vindex %base-packages
10363 The @code{packages} field lists packages that will be globally visible
10364 on the system, for all user accounts---i.e., in every user's @code{PATH}
10365 environment variable---in addition to the per-user profiles
10366 (@pxref{Invoking guix package}). The @code{%base-packages} variable
10367 provides all the tools one would expect for basic user and administrator
10368 tasks---including the GNU Core Utilities, the GNU Networking Utilities,
10369 the GNU Zile lightweight text editor, @command{find}, @command{grep},
10370 etc. The example above adds GNU@tie{}Screen to those,
10371 taken from the @code{(gnu packages screen)}
10372 module (@pxref{Package Modules}). The
10373 @code{(list package output)} syntax can be used to add a specific output
10374 of a package:
10375
10376 @lisp
10377 (use-modules (gnu packages))
10378 (use-modules (gnu packages dns))
10379
10380 (operating-system
10381 ;; ...
10382 (packages (cons (list bind "utils")
10383 %base-packages)))
10384 @end lisp
10385
10386 @findex specification->package
10387 Referring to packages by variable name, like @code{bind} above, has
10388 the advantage of being unambiguous; it also allows typos and such to be
10389 diagnosed right away as ``unbound variables''. The downside is that one
10390 needs to know which module defines which package, and to augment the
10391 @code{use-package-modules} line accordingly. To avoid that, one can use
10392 the @code{specification->package} procedure of the @code{(gnu packages)}
10393 module, which returns the best package for a given name or name and
10394 version:
10395
10396 @lisp
10397 (use-modules (gnu packages))
10398
10399 (operating-system
10400 ;; ...
10401 (packages (append (map specification->package
10402 '("tcpdump" "htop" "gnupg@@2.0"))
10403 %base-packages)))
10404 @end lisp
10405
10406 @unnumberedsubsec System Services
10407
10408 @cindex services
10409 @vindex %base-services
10410 The @code{services} field lists @dfn{system services} to be made
10411 available when the system starts (@pxref{Services}).
10412 The @code{operating-system} declaration above specifies that, in
10413 addition to the basic services, we want the OpenSSH secure shell
10414 daemon listening on port 2222 (@pxref{Networking Services,
10415 @code{openssh-service-type}}). Under the hood,
10416 @code{openssh-service-type} arranges so that @command{sshd} is started with the
10417 right command-line options, possibly with supporting configuration files
10418 generated as needed (@pxref{Defining Services}).
10419
10420 @cindex customization, of services
10421 @findex modify-services
10422 Occasionally, instead of using the base services as is, you will want to
10423 customize them. To do this, use @code{modify-services} (@pxref{Service
10424 Reference, @code{modify-services}}) to modify the list.
10425
10426 For example, suppose you want to modify @code{guix-daemon} and Mingetty
10427 (the console log-in) in the @code{%base-services} list (@pxref{Base
10428 Services, @code{%base-services}}). To do that, you can write the
10429 following in your operating system declaration:
10430
10431 @lisp
10432 (define %my-services
10433 ;; My very own list of services.
10434 (modify-services %base-services
10435 (guix-service-type config =>
10436 (guix-configuration
10437 (inherit config)
10438 (use-substitutes? #f)
10439 (extra-options '("--gc-keep-derivations"))))
10440 (mingetty-service-type config =>
10441 (mingetty-configuration
10442 (inherit config)))))
10443
10444 (operating-system
10445 ;; @dots{}
10446 (services %my-services))
10447 @end lisp
10448
10449 This changes the configuration---i.e., the service parameters---of the
10450 @code{guix-service-type} instance, and that of all the
10451 @code{mingetty-service-type} instances in the @code{%base-services} list.
10452 Observe how this is accomplished: first, we arrange for the original
10453 configuration to be bound to the identifier @code{config} in the
10454 @var{body}, and then we write the @var{body} so that it evaluates to the
10455 desired configuration. In particular, notice how we use @code{inherit}
10456 to create a new configuration which has the same values as the old
10457 configuration, but with a few modifications.
10458
10459 @cindex encrypted disk
10460 The configuration for a typical ``desktop'' usage, with an encrypted
10461 root partition, the X11 display
10462 server, GNOME and Xfce (users can choose which of these desktop
10463 environments to use at the log-in screen by pressing @kbd{F1}), network
10464 management, power management, and more, would look like this:
10465
10466 @lisp
10467 @include os-config-desktop.texi
10468 @end lisp
10469
10470 A graphical system with a choice of lightweight window managers
10471 instead of full-blown desktop environments would look like this:
10472
10473 @lisp
10474 @include os-config-lightweight-desktop.texi
10475 @end lisp
10476
10477 This example refers to the @file{/boot/efi} file system by its UUID,
10478 @code{1234-ABCD}. Replace this UUID with the right UUID on your system,
10479 as returned by the @command{blkid} command.
10480
10481 @xref{Desktop Services}, for the exact list of services provided by
10482 @code{%desktop-services}. @xref{X.509 Certificates}, for background
10483 information about the @code{nss-certs} package that is used here.
10484
10485 Again, @code{%desktop-services} is just a list of service objects. If
10486 you want to remove services from there, you can do so using the
10487 procedures for list filtering (@pxref{SRFI-1 Filtering and
10488 Partitioning,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}). For instance, the
10489 following expression returns a list that contains all the services in
10490 @code{%desktop-services} minus the Avahi service:
10491
10492 @example
10493 (remove (lambda (service)
10494 (eq? (service-kind service) avahi-service-type))
10495 %desktop-services)
10496 @end example
10497
10498 @unnumberedsubsec Instantiating the System
10499
10500 Assuming the @code{operating-system} declaration
10501 is stored in the @file{my-system-config.scm}
10502 file, the @command{guix system reconfigure my-system-config.scm} command
10503 instantiates that configuration, and makes it the default GRUB boot
10504 entry (@pxref{Invoking guix system}).
10505
10506 The normal way to change the system configuration is by updating this
10507 file and re-running @command{guix system reconfigure}. One should never
10508 have to touch files in @file{/etc} or to run commands that modify the
10509 system state such as @command{useradd} or @command{grub-install}. In
10510 fact, you must avoid that since that would not only void your warranty
10511 but also prevent you from rolling back to previous versions of your
10512 system, should you ever need to.
10513
10514 @cindex roll-back, of the operating system
10515 Speaking of roll-back, each time you run @command{guix system
10516 reconfigure}, a new @dfn{generation} of the system is created---without
10517 modifying or deleting previous generations. Old system generations get
10518 an entry in the bootloader boot menu, allowing you to boot them in case
10519 something went wrong with the latest generation. Reassuring, no? The
10520 @command{guix system list-generations} command lists the system
10521 generations available on disk. It is also possible to roll back the
10522 system via the commands @command{guix system roll-back} and
10523 @command{guix system switch-generation}.
10524
10525 Although the @command{guix system reconfigure} command will not modify
10526 previous generations, you must take care when the current generation is not
10527 the latest (e.g., after invoking @command{guix system roll-back}), since
10528 the operation might overwrite a later generation (@pxref{Invoking guix
10529 system}).
10530
10531 @unnumberedsubsec The Programming Interface
10532
10533 At the Scheme level, the bulk of an @code{operating-system} declaration
10534 is instantiated with the following monadic procedure (@pxref{The Store
10535 Monad}):
10536
10537 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} operating-system-derivation os
10538 Return a derivation that builds @var{os}, an @code{operating-system}
10539 object (@pxref{Derivations}).
10540
10541 The output of the derivation is a single directory that refers to all
10542 the packages, configuration files, and other supporting files needed to
10543 instantiate @var{os}.
10544 @end deffn
10545
10546 This procedure is provided by the @code{(gnu system)} module. Along
10547 with @code{(gnu services)} (@pxref{Services}), this module contains the
10548 guts of Guix System. Make sure to visit it!
10549
10550
10551 @node operating-system Reference
10552 @section @code{operating-system} Reference
10553
10554 This section summarizes all the options available in
10555 @code{operating-system} declarations (@pxref{Using the Configuration
10556 System}).
10557
10558 @deftp {Data Type} operating-system
10559 This is the data type representing an operating system configuration.
10560 By that, we mean all the global system configuration, not per-user
10561 configuration (@pxref{Using the Configuration System}).
10562
10563 @table @asis
10564 @item @code{kernel} (default: @var{linux-libre})
10565 The package object of the operating system kernel to use@footnote{Currently
10566 only the Linux-libre kernel is supported. In the future, it will be
10567 possible to use the GNU@tie{}Hurd.}.
10568
10569 @item @code{kernel-arguments} (default: @code{'("quiet")})
10570 List of strings or gexps representing additional arguments to pass on
10571 the command-line of the kernel---e.g., @code{("console=ttyS0")}.
10572
10573 @item @code{bootloader}
10574 The system bootloader configuration object. @xref{Bootloader Configuration}.
10575
10576 @item @code{label}
10577 This is the label (a string) as it appears in the bootloader's menu entry.
10578 The default label includes the kernel name and version.
10579
10580 @item @code{keyboard-layout} (default: @code{#f})
10581 This field specifies the keyboard layout to use in the console. It can be
10582 either @code{#f}, in which case the default keyboard layout is used (usually
10583 US English), or a @code{<keyboard-layout>} record.
10584
10585 This keyboard layout is in effect as soon as the kernel has booted. For
10586 instance, it is the keyboard layout in effect when you type a passphrase if
10587 your root file system is on a @code{luks-device-mapping} mapped device
10588 (@pxref{Mapped Devices}).
10589
10590 @quotation Note
10591 This does @emph{not} specify the keyboard layout used by the bootloader, nor
10592 that used by the graphical display server. @xref{Bootloader Configuration},
10593 for information on how to specify the bootloader's keyboard layout. @xref{X
10594 Window}, for information on how to specify the keyboard layout used by the X
10595 Window System.
10596 @end quotation
10597
10598 @item @code{initrd-modules} (default: @code{%base-initrd-modules})
10599 @cindex initrd
10600 @cindex initial RAM disk
10601 The list of Linux kernel modules that need to be available in the
10602 initial RAM disk. @xref{Initial RAM Disk}.
10603
10604 @item @code{initrd} (default: @code{base-initrd})
10605 A procedure that returns an initial RAM disk for the Linux
10606 kernel. This field is provided to support low-level customization and
10607 should rarely be needed for casual use. @xref{Initial RAM Disk}.
10608
10609 @item @code{firmware} (default: @code{%base-firmware})
10610 @cindex firmware
10611 List of firmware packages loadable by the operating system kernel.
10612
10613 The default includes firmware needed for Atheros- and Broadcom-based
10614 WiFi devices (Linux-libre modules @code{ath9k} and @code{b43-open},
10615 respectively). @xref{Hardware Considerations}, for more info on
10616 supported hardware.
10617
10618 @item @code{host-name}
10619 The host name.
10620
10621 @item @code{hosts-file}
10622 @cindex hosts file
10623 A file-like object (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}) for use as
10624 @file{/etc/hosts} (@pxref{Host Names,,, libc, The GNU C Library
10625 Reference Manual}). The default is a file with entries for
10626 @code{localhost} and @var{host-name}.
10627
10628 @item @code{mapped-devices} (default: @code{'()})
10629 A list of mapped devices. @xref{Mapped Devices}.
10630
10631 @item @code{file-systems}
10632 A list of file systems. @xref{File Systems}.
10633
10634 @item @code{swap-devices} (default: @code{'()})
10635 @cindex swap devices
10636 A list of strings identifying devices or files to be used for ``swap
10637 space'' (@pxref{Memory Concepts,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference
10638 Manual}). For example, @code{'("/dev/sda3")} or @code{'("/swapfile")}.
10639 It is possible to specify a swap file in a file system on a mapped
10640 device, provided that the necessary device mapping and file system are
10641 also specified. @xref{Mapped Devices} and @ref{File Systems}.
10642
10643 @item @code{users} (default: @code{%base-user-accounts})
10644 @itemx @code{groups} (default: @code{%base-groups})
10645 List of user accounts and groups. @xref{User Accounts}.
10646
10647 If the @code{users} list lacks a user account with UID@tie{}0, a
10648 ``root'' account with UID@tie{}0 is automatically added.
10649
10650 @item @code{skeletons} (default: @code{(default-skeletons)})
10651 A list target file name/file-like object tuples (@pxref{G-Expressions,
10652 file-like objects}). These are the skeleton files that will be added to
10653 the home directory of newly-created user accounts.
10654
10655 For instance, a valid value may look like this:
10656
10657 @example
10658 `((".bashrc" ,(plain-file "bashrc" "echo Hello\n"))
10659 (".guile" ,(plain-file "guile"
10660 "(use-modules (ice-9 readline))
10661 (activate-readline)")))
10662 @end example
10663
10664 @item @code{issue} (default: @code{%default-issue})
10665 A string denoting the contents of the @file{/etc/issue} file, which is
10666 displayed when users log in on a text console.
10667
10668 @item @code{packages} (default: @code{%base-packages})
10669 The set of packages installed in the global profile, which is accessible
10670 at @file{/run/current-system/profile}.
10671
10672 The default set includes core utilities and it is good practice to
10673 install non-core utilities in user profiles (@pxref{Invoking guix
10674 package}).
10675
10676 @item @code{timezone}
10677 A timezone identifying string---e.g., @code{"Europe/Paris"}.
10678
10679 You can run the @command{tzselect} command to find out which timezone
10680 string corresponds to your region. Choosing an invalid timezone name
10681 causes @command{guix system} to fail.
10682
10683 @item @code{locale} (default: @code{"en_US.utf8"})
10684 The name of the default locale (@pxref{Locale Names,,, libc, The GNU C
10685 Library Reference Manual}). @xref{Locales}, for more information.
10686
10687 @item @code{locale-definitions} (default: @code{%default-locale-definitions})
10688 The list of locale definitions to be compiled and that may be used at
10689 run time. @xref{Locales}.
10690
10691 @item @code{locale-libcs} (default: @code{(list @var{glibc})})
10692 The list of GNU@tie{}libc packages whose locale data and tools are used
10693 to build the locale definitions. @xref{Locales}, for compatibility
10694 considerations that justify this option.
10695
10696 @item @code{name-service-switch} (default: @code{%default-nss})
10697 Configuration of the libc name service switch (NSS)---a
10698 @code{<name-service-switch>} object. @xref{Name Service Switch}, for
10699 details.
10700
10701 @item @code{services} (default: @code{%base-services})
10702 A list of service objects denoting system services. @xref{Services}.
10703
10704 @cindex essential services
10705 @item @code{essential-services} (default: ...)
10706 The list of ``essential services''---i.e., things like instances of
10707 @code{system-service-type} and @code{host-name-service-type} (@pxref{Service
10708 Reference}), which are derived from the operating system definition itself.
10709 As a user you should @emph{never} need to touch this field.
10710
10711 @item @code{pam-services} (default: @code{(base-pam-services)})
10712 @cindex PAM
10713 @cindex pluggable authentication modules
10714 Linux @dfn{pluggable authentication module} (PAM) services.
10715 @c FIXME: Add xref to PAM services section.
10716
10717 @item @code{setuid-programs} (default: @var{%setuid-programs})
10718 List of string-valued G-expressions denoting setuid programs.
10719 @xref{Setuid Programs}.
10720
10721 @item @code{sudoers-file} (default: @var{%sudoers-specification})
10722 @cindex sudoers file
10723 The contents of the @file{/etc/sudoers} file as a file-like object
10724 (@pxref{G-Expressions, @code{local-file} and @code{plain-file}}).
10725
10726 This file specifies which users can use the @command{sudo} command, what
10727 they are allowed to do, and what privileges they may gain. The default
10728 is that only @code{root} and members of the @code{wheel} group may use
10729 @code{sudo}.
10730
10731 @end table
10732
10733 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} this-operating-system
10734 When used in the @emph{lexical scope} of an operating system field definition,
10735 this identifier resolves to the operating system being defined.
10736
10737 The example below shows how to refer to the operating system being defined in
10738 the definition of the @code{label} field:
10739
10740 @example
10741 (use-modules (gnu) (guix))
10742
10743 (operating-system
10744 ;; ...
10745 (label (package-full-name
10746 (operating-system-kernel this-operating-system))))
10747 @end example
10748
10749 It is an error to refer to @code{this-operating-system} outside an operating
10750 system definition.
10751 @end deffn
10752
10753 @end deftp
10754
10755 @node File Systems
10756 @section File Systems
10757
10758 The list of file systems to be mounted is specified in the
10759 @code{file-systems} field of the operating system declaration
10760 (@pxref{Using the Configuration System}). Each file system is declared
10761 using the @code{file-system} form, like this:
10762
10763 @example
10764 (file-system
10765 (mount-point "/home")
10766 (device "/dev/sda3")
10767 (type "ext4"))
10768 @end example
10769
10770 As usual, some of the fields are mandatory---those shown in the example
10771 above---while others can be omitted. These are described below.
10772
10773 @deftp {Data Type} file-system
10774 Objects of this type represent file systems to be mounted. They
10775 contain the following members:
10776
10777 @table @asis
10778 @item @code{type}
10779 This is a string specifying the type of the file system---e.g.,
10780 @code{"ext4"}.
10781
10782 @item @code{mount-point}
10783 This designates the place where the file system is to be mounted.
10784
10785 @item @code{device}
10786 This names the ``source'' of the file system. It can be one of three
10787 things: a file system label, a file system UUID, or the name of a
10788 @file{/dev} node. Labels and UUIDs offer a way to refer to file
10789 systems without having to hard-code their actual device
10790 name@footnote{Note that, while it is tempting to use
10791 @file{/dev/disk/by-uuid} and similar device names to achieve the same
10792 result, this is not recommended: These special device nodes are created
10793 by the udev daemon and may be unavailable at the time the device is
10794 mounted.}.
10795
10796 @findex file-system-label
10797 File system labels are created using the @code{file-system-label}
10798 procedure, UUIDs are created using @code{uuid}, and @file{/dev} node are
10799 plain strings. Here's an example of a file system referred to by its
10800 label, as shown by the @command{e2label} command:
10801
10802 @example
10803 (file-system
10804 (mount-point "/home")
10805 (type "ext4")
10806 (device (file-system-label "my-home")))
10807 @end example
10808
10809 @findex uuid
10810 UUIDs are converted from their string representation (as shown by the
10811 @command{tune2fs -l} command) using the @code{uuid} form@footnote{The
10812 @code{uuid} form expects 16-byte UUIDs as defined in
10813 @uref{https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4122, RFC@tie{}4122}. This is the
10814 form of UUID used by the ext2 family of file systems and others, but it
10815 is different from ``UUIDs'' found in FAT file systems, for instance.},
10816 like this:
10817
10818 @example
10819 (file-system
10820 (mount-point "/home")
10821 (type "ext4")
10822 (device (uuid "4dab5feb-d176-45de-b287-9b0a6e4c01cb")))
10823 @end example
10824
10825 When the source of a file system is a mapped device (@pxref{Mapped
10826 Devices}), its @code{device} field @emph{must} refer to the mapped
10827 device name---e.g., @file{"/dev/mapper/root-partition"}.
10828 This is required so that
10829 the system knows that mounting the file system depends on having the
10830 corresponding device mapping established.
10831
10832 @item @code{flags} (default: @code{'()})
10833 This is a list of symbols denoting mount flags. Recognized flags
10834 include @code{read-only}, @code{bind-mount}, @code{no-dev} (disallow
10835 access to special files), @code{no-suid} (ignore setuid and setgid
10836 bits), @code{no-atime} (do not update file access times), and @code{no-exec}
10837 (disallow program execution). @xref{Mount-Unmount-Remount,,, libc, The GNU C
10838 Library Reference Manual}, for more information on these flags.
10839
10840 @item @code{options} (default: @code{#f})
10841 This is either @code{#f}, or a string denoting mount options passed to the
10842 file system driver. @xref{Mount-Unmount-Remount,,, libc, The GNU C Library
10843 Reference Manual}, for details and run @command{man 8 mount} for options for
10844 various file systems.
10845
10846 @item @code{mount?} (default: @code{#t})
10847 This value indicates whether to automatically mount the file system when
10848 the system is brought up. When set to @code{#f}, the file system gets
10849 an entry in @file{/etc/fstab} (read by the @command{mount} command) but
10850 is not automatically mounted.
10851
10852 @item @code{needed-for-boot?} (default: @code{#f})
10853 This Boolean value indicates whether the file system is needed when
10854 booting. If that is true, then the file system is mounted when the
10855 initial RAM disk (initrd) is loaded. This is always the case, for
10856 instance, for the root file system.
10857
10858 @item @code{check?} (default: @code{#t})
10859 This Boolean indicates whether the file system needs to be checked for
10860 errors before being mounted.
10861
10862 @item @code{create-mount-point?} (default: @code{#f})
10863 When true, the mount point is created if it does not exist yet.
10864
10865 @item @code{dependencies} (default: @code{'()})
10866 This is a list of @code{<file-system>} or @code{<mapped-device>} objects
10867 representing file systems that must be mounted or mapped devices that
10868 must be opened before (and unmounted or closed after) this one.
10869
10870 As an example, consider a hierarchy of mounts: @file{/sys/fs/cgroup} is
10871 a dependency of @file{/sys/fs/cgroup/cpu} and
10872 @file{/sys/fs/cgroup/memory}.
10873
10874 Another example is a file system that depends on a mapped device, for
10875 example for an encrypted partition (@pxref{Mapped Devices}).
10876 @end table
10877 @end deftp
10878
10879 The @code{(gnu system file-systems)} exports the following useful
10880 variables.
10881
10882 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %base-file-systems
10883 These are essential file systems that are required on normal systems,
10884 such as @var{%pseudo-terminal-file-system} and @var{%immutable-store} (see
10885 below.) Operating system declarations should always contain at least
10886 these.
10887 @end defvr
10888
10889 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %pseudo-terminal-file-system
10890 This is the file system to be mounted as @file{/dev/pts}. It supports
10891 @dfn{pseudo-terminals} created @i{via} @code{openpty} and similar
10892 functions (@pxref{Pseudo-Terminals,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference
10893 Manual}). Pseudo-terminals are used by terminal emulators such as
10894 @command{xterm}.
10895 @end defvr
10896
10897 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %shared-memory-file-system
10898 This file system is mounted as @file{/dev/shm} and is used to support
10899 memory sharing across processes (@pxref{Memory-mapped I/O,
10900 @code{shm_open},, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
10901 @end defvr
10902
10903 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %immutable-store
10904 This file system performs a read-only ``bind mount'' of
10905 @file{/gnu/store}, making it read-only for all the users including
10906 @code{root}. This prevents against accidental modification by software
10907 running as @code{root} or by system administrators.
10908
10909 The daemon itself is still able to write to the store: it remounts it
10910 read-write in its own ``name space.''
10911 @end defvr
10912
10913 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %binary-format-file-system
10914 The @code{binfmt_misc} file system, which allows handling of arbitrary
10915 executable file types to be delegated to user space. This requires the
10916 @code{binfmt.ko} kernel module to be loaded.
10917 @end defvr
10918
10919 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %fuse-control-file-system
10920 The @code{fusectl} file system, which allows unprivileged users to mount
10921 and unmount user-space FUSE file systems. This requires the
10922 @code{fuse.ko} kernel module to be loaded.
10923 @end defvr
10924
10925 @node Mapped Devices
10926 @section Mapped Devices
10927
10928 @cindex device mapping
10929 @cindex mapped devices
10930 The Linux kernel has a notion of @dfn{device mapping}: a block device,
10931 such as a hard disk partition, can be @dfn{mapped} into another device,
10932 usually in @code{/dev/mapper/},
10933 with additional processing over the data that flows through
10934 it@footnote{Note that the GNU@tie{}Hurd makes no difference between the
10935 concept of a ``mapped device'' and that of a file system: both boil down
10936 to @emph{translating} input/output operations made on a file to
10937 operations on its backing store. Thus, the Hurd implements mapped
10938 devices, like file systems, using the generic @dfn{translator} mechanism
10939 (@pxref{Translators,,, hurd, The GNU Hurd Reference Manual}).}. A
10940 typical example is encryption device mapping: all writes to the mapped
10941 device are encrypted, and all reads are deciphered, transparently.
10942 Guix extends this notion by considering any device or set of devices that
10943 are @dfn{transformed} in some way to create a new device; for instance,
10944 RAID devices are obtained by @dfn{assembling} several other devices, such
10945 as hard disks or partitions, into a new one that behaves as one partition.
10946 Other examples, not yet implemented, are LVM logical volumes.
10947
10948 Mapped devices are declared using the @code{mapped-device} form,
10949 defined as follows; for examples, see below.
10950
10951 @deftp {Data Type} mapped-device
10952 Objects of this type represent device mappings that will be made when
10953 the system boots up.
10954
10955 @table @code
10956 @item source
10957 This is either a string specifying the name of the block device to be mapped,
10958 such as @code{"/dev/sda3"}, or a list of such strings when several devices
10959 need to be assembled for creating a new one.
10960
10961 @item target
10962 This string specifies the name of the resulting mapped device. For
10963 kernel mappers such as encrypted devices of type @code{luks-device-mapping},
10964 specifying @code{"my-partition"} leads to the creation of
10965 the @code{"/dev/mapper/my-partition"} device.
10966 For RAID devices of type @code{raid-device-mapping}, the full device name
10967 such as @code{"/dev/md0"} needs to be given.
10968
10969 @item type
10970 This must be a @code{mapped-device-kind} object, which specifies how
10971 @var{source} is mapped to @var{target}.
10972 @end table
10973 @end deftp
10974
10975 @defvr {Scheme Variable} luks-device-mapping
10976 This defines LUKS block device encryption using the @command{cryptsetup}
10977 command from the package with the same name. It relies on the
10978 @code{dm-crypt} Linux kernel module.
10979 @end defvr
10980
10981 @defvr {Scheme Variable} raid-device-mapping
10982 This defines a RAID device, which is assembled using the @code{mdadm}
10983 command from the package with the same name. It requires a Linux kernel
10984 module for the appropriate RAID level to be loaded, such as @code{raid456}
10985 for RAID-4, RAID-5 or RAID-6, or @code{raid10} for RAID-10.
10986 @end defvr
10987
10988 @cindex disk encryption
10989 @cindex LUKS
10990 The following example specifies a mapping from @file{/dev/sda3} to
10991 @file{/dev/mapper/home} using LUKS---the
10992 @url{https://gitlab.com/cryptsetup/cryptsetup,Linux Unified Key Setup}, a
10993 standard mechanism for disk encryption.
10994 The @file{/dev/mapper/home}
10995 device can then be used as the @code{device} of a @code{file-system}
10996 declaration (@pxref{File Systems}).
10997
10998 @example
10999 (mapped-device
11000 (source "/dev/sda3")
11001 (target "home")
11002 (type luks-device-mapping))
11003 @end example
11004
11005 Alternatively, to become independent of device numbering, one may obtain
11006 the LUKS UUID (@dfn{unique identifier}) of the source device by a
11007 command like:
11008
11009 @example
11010 cryptsetup luksUUID /dev/sda3
11011 @end example
11012
11013 and use it as follows:
11014
11015 @example
11016 (mapped-device
11017 (source (uuid "cb67fc72-0d54-4c88-9d4b-b225f30b0f44"))
11018 (target "home")
11019 (type luks-device-mapping))
11020 @end example
11021
11022 @cindex swap encryption
11023 It is also desirable to encrypt swap space, since swap space may contain
11024 sensitive data. One way to accomplish that is to use a swap file in a
11025 file system on a device mapped via LUKS encryption. In this way, the
11026 swap file is encrypted because the entire device is encrypted.
11027 @xref{Preparing for Installation,,Disk Partitioning}, for an example.
11028
11029 A RAID device formed of the partitions @file{/dev/sda1} and @file{/dev/sdb1}
11030 may be declared as follows:
11031
11032 @example
11033 (mapped-device
11034 (source (list "/dev/sda1" "/dev/sdb1"))
11035 (target "/dev/md0")
11036 (type raid-device-mapping))
11037 @end example
11038
11039 The @file{/dev/md0} device can then be used as the @code{device} of a
11040 @code{file-system} declaration (@pxref{File Systems}).
11041 Note that the RAID level need not be given; it is chosen during the
11042 initial creation and formatting of the RAID device and is determined
11043 automatically later.
11044
11045
11046 @node User Accounts
11047 @section User Accounts
11048
11049 @cindex users
11050 @cindex accounts
11051 @cindex user accounts
11052 User accounts and groups are entirely managed through the
11053 @code{operating-system} declaration. They are specified with the
11054 @code{user-account} and @code{user-group} forms:
11055
11056 @example
11057 (user-account
11058 (name "alice")
11059 (group "users")
11060 (supplementary-groups '("wheel" ;allow use of sudo, etc.
11061 "audio" ;sound card
11062 "video" ;video devices such as webcams
11063 "cdrom")) ;the good ol' CD-ROM
11064 (comment "Bob's sister")
11065 (home-directory "/home/alice"))
11066 @end example
11067
11068 When booting or upon completion of @command{guix system reconfigure},
11069 the system ensures that only the user accounts and groups specified in
11070 the @code{operating-system} declaration exist, and with the specified
11071 properties. Thus, account or group creations or modifications made by
11072 directly invoking commands such as @command{useradd} are lost upon
11073 reconfiguration or reboot. This ensures that the system remains exactly
11074 as declared.
11075
11076 @deftp {Data Type} user-account
11077 Objects of this type represent user accounts. The following members may
11078 be specified:
11079
11080 @table @asis
11081 @item @code{name}
11082 The name of the user account.
11083
11084 @item @code{group}
11085 @cindex groups
11086 This is the name (a string) or identifier (a number) of the user group
11087 this account belongs to.
11088
11089 @item @code{supplementary-groups} (default: @code{'()})
11090 Optionally, this can be defined as a list of group names that this
11091 account belongs to.
11092
11093 @item @code{uid} (default: @code{#f})
11094 This is the user ID for this account (a number), or @code{#f}. In the
11095 latter case, a number is automatically chosen by the system when the
11096 account is created.
11097
11098 @item @code{comment} (default: @code{""})
11099 A comment about the account, such as the account owner's full name.
11100
11101 @item @code{home-directory}
11102 This is the name of the home directory for the account.
11103
11104 @item @code{create-home-directory?} (default: @code{#t})
11105 Indicates whether the home directory of this account should be created
11106 if it does not exist yet.
11107
11108 @item @code{shell} (default: Bash)
11109 This is a G-expression denoting the file name of a program to be used as
11110 the shell (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
11111
11112 @item @code{system?} (default: @code{#f})
11113 This Boolean value indicates whether the account is a ``system''
11114 account. System accounts are sometimes treated specially; for instance,
11115 graphical login managers do not list them.
11116
11117 @anchor{user-account-password}
11118 @cindex password, for user accounts
11119 @item @code{password} (default: @code{#f})
11120 You would normally leave this field to @code{#f}, initialize user
11121 passwords as @code{root} with the @command{passwd} command, and then let
11122 users change it with @command{passwd}. Passwords set with
11123 @command{passwd} are of course preserved across reboot and
11124 reconfiguration.
11125
11126 If you @emph{do} want to set an initial password for an account, then
11127 this field must contain the encrypted password, as a string. You can use the
11128 @code{crypt} procedure for this purpose:
11129
11130 @example
11131 (user-account
11132 (name "charlie")
11133 (group "users")
11134
11135 ;; Specify a SHA-512-hashed initial password.
11136 (password (crypt "InitialPassword!" "$6$abc")))
11137 @end example
11138
11139 @quotation Note
11140 The hash of this initial password will be available in a file in
11141 @file{/gnu/store}, readable by all the users, so this method must be used with
11142 care.
11143 @end quotation
11144
11145 @xref{Passphrase Storage,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}, for
11146 more information on password encryption, and @ref{Encryption,,, guile, GNU
11147 Guile Reference Manual}, for information on Guile's @code{crypt} procedure.
11148
11149 @end table
11150 @end deftp
11151
11152 @cindex groups
11153 User group declarations are even simpler:
11154
11155 @example
11156 (user-group (name "students"))
11157 @end example
11158
11159 @deftp {Data Type} user-group
11160 This type is for, well, user groups. There are just a few fields:
11161
11162 @table @asis
11163 @item @code{name}
11164 The name of the group.
11165
11166 @item @code{id} (default: @code{#f})
11167 The group identifier (a number). If @code{#f}, a new number is
11168 automatically allocated when the group is created.
11169
11170 @item @code{system?} (default: @code{#f})
11171 This Boolean value indicates whether the group is a ``system'' group.
11172 System groups have low numerical IDs.
11173
11174 @item @code{password} (default: @code{#f})
11175 What, user groups can have a password? Well, apparently yes. Unless
11176 @code{#f}, this field specifies the password of the group.
11177
11178 @end table
11179 @end deftp
11180
11181 For convenience, a variable lists all the basic user groups one may
11182 expect:
11183
11184 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %base-groups
11185 This is the list of basic user groups that users and/or packages expect
11186 to be present on the system. This includes groups such as ``root'',
11187 ``wheel'', and ``users'', as well as groups used to control access to
11188 specific devices such as ``audio'', ``disk'', and ``cdrom''.
11189 @end defvr
11190
11191 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %base-user-accounts
11192 This is the list of basic system accounts that programs may expect to
11193 find on a GNU/Linux system, such as the ``nobody'' account.
11194
11195 Note that the ``root'' account is not included here. It is a
11196 special-case and is automatically added whether or not it is specified.
11197 @end defvr
11198
11199 @node Keyboard Layout
11200 @section Keyboard Layout
11201
11202 @cindex keyboard layout
11203 @cindex keymap
11204 To specify what each key of your keyboard does, you need to tell the operating
11205 system what @dfn{keyboard layout} you want to use. The default, when nothing
11206 is specified, is the US English QWERTY layout for 105-key PC keyboards.
11207 However, German speakers will usually prefer the German QWERTZ layout, French
11208 speakers will want the AZERTY layout, and so on; hackers might prefer Dvorak
11209 or bépo, and they might even want to further customize the effect of some of
11210 the keys. This section explains how to get that done.
11211
11212 @cindex keyboard layout, definition
11213 There are three components that will want to know about your keyboard layout:
11214
11215 @itemize
11216 @item
11217 The @emph{bootloader} may want to know what keyboard layout you want to use
11218 (@pxref{Bootloader Configuration, @code{keyboard-layout}}). This is useful if
11219 you want, for instance, to make sure that you can type the passphrase of your
11220 encrypted root partition using the right layout.
11221
11222 @item
11223 The @emph{operating system kernel}, Linux, will need that so that the console
11224 is properly configured (@pxref{operating-system Reference,
11225 @code{keyboard-layout}}).
11226
11227 @item
11228 The @emph{graphical display server}, usually Xorg, also has its own idea of
11229 the keyboard layout (@pxref{X Window, @code{keyboard-layout}}).
11230 @end itemize
11231
11232 Guix allows you to configure all three separately but, fortunately, it allows
11233 you to share the same keyboard layout for all three components.
11234
11235 @cindex XKB, keyboard layouts
11236 Keyboard layouts are represented by records created by the
11237 @code{keyboard-layout} procedure of @code{(gnu system keyboard)}. Following
11238 the X Keyboard extension (XKB), each layout has four attributes: a name (often
11239 a language code such as ``fi'' for Finnish or ``jp'' for Japanese), an
11240 optional variant name, an optional keyboard model name, and a possibly empty
11241 list of additional options. In most cases the layout name is all you care
11242 about. Here are a few example:
11243
11244 @example
11245 ;; The German QWERTZ layout. Here we assume a standard
11246 ;; "pc105" keyboard model.
11247 (keyboard-layout "de")
11248
11249 ;; The bépo variant of the French layout.
11250 (keyboard-layout "fr" "bepo")
11251
11252 ;; The Catalan layout.
11253 (keyboard-layout "es" "cat")
11254
11255 ;; The Latin American Spanish layout. In addition, the
11256 ;; "Caps Lock" key is used as an additional "Ctrl" key,
11257 ;; and the "Menu" key is used as a "Compose" key to enter
11258 ;; accented letters.
11259 (keyboard-layout "latam"
11260 #:options '("ctrl:nocaps" "compose:menu"))
11261
11262 ;; The Russian layout for a ThinkPad keyboard.
11263 (keyboard-layout "ru" #:model "thinkpad")
11264
11265 ;; The "US international" layout, which is the US layout plus
11266 ;; dead keys to enter accented characters. This is for an
11267 ;; Apple MacBook keyboard.
11268 (keyboard-layout "us" "intl" #:model "macbook78")
11269 @end example
11270
11271 See the @file{share/X11/xkb} directory of the @code{xkeyboard-config} package
11272 for a complete list of supported layouts, variants, and models.
11273
11274 @cindex keyboard layout, configuration
11275 Let's say you want your system to use the Turkish keyboard layout throughout
11276 your system---bootloader, console, and Xorg. Here's what your system
11277 configuration would look like:
11278
11279 @findex set-xorg-configuration
11280 @lisp
11281 ;; Using the Turkish layout for the bootloader, the console,
11282 ;; and for Xorg.
11283
11284 (operating-system
11285 ;; ...
11286 (keyboard-layout (keyboard-layout "tr")) ;for the console
11287 (bootloader (bootloader-configuration
11288 (bootloader grub-efi-bootloader)
11289 (target "/boot/efi")
11290 (keyboard-layout keyboard-layout))) ;for GRUB
11291 (services (cons (set-xorg-configuration
11292 (xorg-configuration ;for Xorg
11293 (keyboard-layout keyboard-layout)))
11294 %desktop-services)))
11295 @end lisp
11296
11297 In the example above, for GRUB and for Xorg, we just refer to the
11298 @code{keyboard-layout} field defined above, but we could just as well refer to
11299 a different layout. The @code{set-xorg-configuration} procedure communicates
11300 the desired Xorg configuration to the graphical log-in manager, by default
11301 GDM.
11302
11303 We've discussed how to specify the @emph{default} keyboard layout of your
11304 system when it starts, but you can also adjust it at run time:
11305
11306 @itemize
11307 @item
11308 If you're using GNOME, its settings panel has a ``Region & Language'' entry
11309 where you can select one or more keyboard layouts.
11310
11311 @item
11312 Under Xorg, the @command{setxkbmap} command (from the same-named package)
11313 allows you to change the current layout. For example, this is how you would
11314 change the layout to US Dvorak:
11315
11316 @example
11317 setxkbmap us dvorak
11318 @end example
11319
11320 @item
11321 The @code{loadkeys} command changes the keyboard layout in effect in the Linux
11322 console. However, note that @code{loadkeys} does @emph{not} use the XKB
11323 keyboard layout categorization described above. The command below loads the
11324 French bépo layout:
11325
11326 @example
11327 loadkeys fr-bepo
11328 @end example
11329 @end itemize
11330
11331 @node Locales
11332 @section Locales
11333
11334 @cindex locale
11335 A @dfn{locale} defines cultural conventions for a particular language
11336 and region of the world (@pxref{Locales,,, libc, The GNU C Library
11337 Reference Manual}). Each locale has a name that typically has the form
11338 @code{@var{language}_@var{territory}.@var{codeset}}---e.g.,
11339 @code{fr_LU.utf8} designates the locale for the French language, with
11340 cultural conventions from Luxembourg, and using the UTF-8 encoding.
11341
11342 @cindex locale definition
11343 Usually, you will want to specify the default locale for the machine
11344 using the @code{locale} field of the @code{operating-system} declaration
11345 (@pxref{operating-system Reference, @code{locale}}).
11346
11347 The selected locale is automatically added to the @dfn{locale
11348 definitions} known to the system if needed, with its codeset inferred
11349 from its name---e.g., @code{bo_CN.utf8} will be assumed to use the
11350 @code{UTF-8} codeset. Additional locale definitions can be specified in
11351 the @code{locale-definitions} slot of @code{operating-system}---this is
11352 useful, for instance, if the codeset could not be inferred from the
11353 locale name. The default set of locale definitions includes some widely
11354 used locales, but not all the available locales, in order to save space.
11355
11356 For instance, to add the North Frisian locale for Germany, the value of
11357 that field may be:
11358
11359 @example
11360 (cons (locale-definition
11361 (name "fy_DE.utf8") (source "fy_DE"))
11362 %default-locale-definitions)
11363 @end example
11364
11365 Likewise, to save space, one might want @code{locale-definitions} to
11366 list only the locales that are actually used, as in:
11367
11368 @example
11369 (list (locale-definition
11370 (name "ja_JP.eucjp") (source "ja_JP")
11371 (charset "EUC-JP")))
11372 @end example
11373
11374 @vindex LOCPATH
11375 The compiled locale definitions are available at
11376 @file{/run/current-system/locale/X.Y}, where @code{X.Y} is the libc
11377 version, which is the default location where the GNU@tie{}libc provided
11378 by Guix looks for locale data. This can be overridden using the
11379 @code{LOCPATH} environment variable (@pxref{locales-and-locpath,
11380 @code{LOCPATH} and locale packages}).
11381
11382 The @code{locale-definition} form is provided by the @code{(gnu system
11383 locale)} module. Details are given below.
11384
11385 @deftp {Data Type} locale-definition
11386 This is the data type of a locale definition.
11387
11388 @table @asis
11389
11390 @item @code{name}
11391 The name of the locale. @xref{Locale Names,,, libc, The GNU C Library
11392 Reference Manual}, for more information on locale names.
11393
11394 @item @code{source}
11395 The name of the source for that locale. This is typically the
11396 @code{@var{language}_@var{territory}} part of the locale name.
11397
11398 @item @code{charset} (default: @code{"UTF-8"})
11399 The ``character set'' or ``code set'' for that locale,
11400 @uref{https://www.iana.org/assignments/character-sets, as defined by
11401 IANA}.
11402
11403 @end table
11404 @end deftp
11405
11406 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-locale-definitions
11407 A list of commonly used UTF-8 locales, used as the default
11408 value of the @code{locale-definitions} field of @code{operating-system}
11409 declarations.
11410
11411 @cindex locale name
11412 @cindex normalized codeset in locale names
11413 These locale definitions use the @dfn{normalized codeset} for the part
11414 that follows the dot in the name (@pxref{Using gettextized software,
11415 normalized codeset,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}). So for
11416 instance it has @code{uk_UA.utf8} but @emph{not}, say,
11417 @code{uk_UA.UTF-8}.
11418 @end defvr
11419
11420 @subsection Locale Data Compatibility Considerations
11421
11422 @cindex incompatibility, of locale data
11423 @code{operating-system} declarations provide a @code{locale-libcs} field
11424 to specify the GNU@tie{}libc packages that are used to compile locale
11425 declarations (@pxref{operating-system Reference}). ``Why would I
11426 care?'', you may ask. Well, it turns out that the binary format of
11427 locale data is occasionally incompatible from one libc version to
11428 another.
11429
11430 @c See <https://sourceware.org/ml/libc-alpha/2015-09/msg00575.html>
11431 @c and <https://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/guix-devel/2015-08/msg00737.html>.
11432 For instance, a program linked against libc version 2.21 is unable to
11433 read locale data produced with libc 2.22; worse, that program
11434 @emph{aborts} instead of simply ignoring the incompatible locale
11435 data@footnote{Versions 2.23 and later of GNU@tie{}libc will simply skip
11436 the incompatible locale data, which is already an improvement.}.
11437 Similarly, a program linked against libc 2.22 can read most, but not
11438 all, of the locale data from libc 2.21 (specifically, @code{LC_COLLATE}
11439 data is incompatible); thus calls to @code{setlocale} may fail, but
11440 programs will not abort.
11441
11442 The ``problem'' with Guix is that users have a lot of freedom: They can
11443 choose whether and when to upgrade software in their profiles, and might
11444 be using a libc version different from the one the system administrator
11445 used to build the system-wide locale data.
11446
11447 Fortunately, unprivileged users can also install their own locale data
11448 and define @var{GUIX_LOCPATH} accordingly (@pxref{locales-and-locpath,
11449 @code{GUIX_LOCPATH} and locale packages}).
11450
11451 Still, it is best if the system-wide locale data at
11452 @file{/run/current-system/locale} is built for all the libc versions
11453 actually in use on the system, so that all the programs can access
11454 it---this is especially crucial on a multi-user system. To do that, the
11455 administrator can specify several libc packages in the
11456 @code{locale-libcs} field of @code{operating-system}:
11457
11458 @example
11459 (use-package-modules base)
11460
11461 (operating-system
11462 ;; @dots{}
11463 (locale-libcs (list glibc-2.21 (canonical-package glibc))))
11464 @end example
11465
11466 This example would lead to a system containing locale definitions for
11467 both libc 2.21 and the current version of libc in
11468 @file{/run/current-system/locale}.
11469
11470
11471 @node Services
11472 @section Services
11473
11474 @cindex system services
11475 An important part of preparing an @code{operating-system} declaration is
11476 listing @dfn{system services} and their configuration (@pxref{Using the
11477 Configuration System}). System services are typically daemons launched
11478 when the system boots, or other actions needed at that time---e.g.,
11479 configuring network access.
11480
11481 Guix has a broad definition of ``service'' (@pxref{Service
11482 Composition}), but many services are managed by the GNU@tie{}Shepherd
11483 (@pxref{Shepherd Services}). On a running system, the @command{herd}
11484 command allows you to list the available services, show their status,
11485 start and stop them, or do other specific operations (@pxref{Jump
11486 Start,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}). For example:
11487
11488 @example
11489 # herd status
11490 @end example
11491
11492 The above command, run as @code{root}, lists the currently defined
11493 services. The @command{herd doc} command shows a synopsis of the given
11494 service and its associated actions:
11495
11496 @example
11497 # herd doc nscd
11498 Run libc's name service cache daemon (nscd).
11499
11500 # herd doc nscd action invalidate
11501 invalidate: Invalidate the given cache--e.g., 'hosts' for host name lookups.
11502 @end example
11503
11504 The @command{start}, @command{stop}, and @command{restart} sub-commands
11505 have the effect you would expect. For instance, the commands below stop
11506 the nscd service and restart the Xorg display server:
11507
11508 @example
11509 # herd stop nscd
11510 Service nscd has been stopped.
11511 # herd restart xorg-server
11512 Service xorg-server has been stopped.
11513 Service xorg-server has been started.
11514 @end example
11515
11516 The following sections document the available services, starting with
11517 the core services, that may be used in an @code{operating-system}
11518 declaration.
11519
11520 @menu
11521 * Base Services:: Essential system services.
11522 * Scheduled Job Execution:: The mcron service.
11523 * Log Rotation:: The rottlog service.
11524 * Networking Services:: Network setup, SSH daemon, etc.
11525 * X Window:: Graphical display.
11526 * Printing Services:: Local and remote printer support.
11527 * Desktop Services:: D-Bus and desktop services.
11528 * Sound Services:: ALSA and Pulseaudio services.
11529 * Database Services:: SQL databases, key-value stores, etc.
11530 * Mail Services:: IMAP, POP3, SMTP, and all that.
11531 * Messaging Services:: Messaging services.
11532 * Telephony Services:: Telephony services.
11533 * Monitoring Services:: Monitoring services.
11534 * Kerberos Services:: Kerberos services.
11535 * LDAP Services:: LDAP services.
11536 * Web Services:: Web servers.
11537 * Certificate Services:: TLS certificates via Let's Encrypt.
11538 * DNS Services:: DNS daemons.
11539 * VPN Services:: VPN daemons.
11540 * Network File System:: NFS related services.
11541 * Continuous Integration:: The Cuirass service.
11542 * Power Management Services:: Extending battery life.
11543 * Audio Services:: The MPD.
11544 * Virtualization Services:: Virtualization services.
11545 * Version Control Services:: Providing remote access to Git repositories.
11546 * Game Services:: Game servers.
11547 * Miscellaneous Services:: Other services.
11548 @end menu
11549
11550 @node Base Services
11551 @subsection Base Services
11552
11553 The @code{(gnu services base)} module provides definitions for the basic
11554 services that one expects from the system. The services exported by
11555 this module are listed below.
11556
11557 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %base-services
11558 This variable contains a list of basic services (@pxref{Service Types
11559 and Services}, for more information on service objects) one would
11560 expect from the system: a login service (mingetty) on each tty, syslogd,
11561 the libc name service cache daemon (nscd), the udev device manager, and
11562 more.
11563
11564 This is the default value of the @code{services} field of
11565 @code{operating-system} declarations. Usually, when customizing a
11566 system, you will want to append services to @code{%base-services}, like
11567 this:
11568
11569 @example
11570 (append (list (service avahi-service-type)
11571 (service openssh-service-type))
11572 %base-services)
11573 @end example
11574 @end defvr
11575
11576 @defvr {Scheme Variable} special-files-service-type
11577 This is the service that sets up ``special files'' such as
11578 @file{/bin/sh}; an instance of it is part of @code{%base-services}.
11579
11580 The value associated with @code{special-files-service-type} services
11581 must be a list of tuples where the first element is the ``special file''
11582 and the second element is its target. By default it is:
11583
11584 @cindex @file{/bin/sh}
11585 @cindex @file{sh}, in @file{/bin}
11586 @example
11587 `(("/bin/sh" ,(file-append @var{bash} "/bin/sh")))
11588 @end example
11589
11590 @cindex @file{/usr/bin/env}
11591 @cindex @file{env}, in @file{/usr/bin}
11592 If you want to add, say, @code{/usr/bin/env} to your system, you can
11593 change it to:
11594
11595 @example
11596 `(("/bin/sh" ,(file-append @var{bash} "/bin/sh"))
11597 ("/usr/bin/env" ,(file-append @var{coreutils} "/bin/env")))
11598 @end example
11599
11600 Since this is part of @code{%base-services}, you can use
11601 @code{modify-services} to customize the set of special files
11602 (@pxref{Service Reference, @code{modify-services}}). But the simple way
11603 to add a special file is @i{via} the @code{extra-special-file} procedure
11604 (see below.)
11605 @end defvr
11606
11607 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} extra-special-file @var{file} @var{target}
11608 Use @var{target} as the ``special file'' @var{file}.
11609
11610 For example, adding the following lines to the @code{services} field of
11611 your operating system declaration leads to a @file{/usr/bin/env}
11612 symlink:
11613
11614 @example
11615 (extra-special-file "/usr/bin/env"
11616 (file-append coreutils "/bin/env"))
11617 @end example
11618 @end deffn
11619
11620 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} host-name-service @var{name}
11621 Return a service that sets the host name to @var{name}.
11622 @end deffn
11623
11624 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} login-service @var{config}
11625 Return a service to run login according to @var{config}, a
11626 @code{<login-configuration>} object, which specifies the message of the day,
11627 among other things.
11628 @end deffn
11629
11630 @deftp {Data Type} login-configuration
11631 This is the data type representing the configuration of login.
11632
11633 @table @asis
11634
11635 @item @code{motd}
11636 @cindex message of the day
11637 A file-like object containing the ``message of the day''.
11638
11639 @item @code{allow-empty-passwords?} (default: @code{#t})
11640 Allow empty passwords by default so that first-time users can log in when
11641 the 'root' account has just been created.
11642
11643 @end table
11644 @end deftp
11645
11646 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} mingetty-service @var{config}
11647 Return a service to run mingetty according to @var{config}, a
11648 @code{<mingetty-configuration>} object, which specifies the tty to run, among
11649 other things.
11650 @end deffn
11651
11652 @deftp {Data Type} mingetty-configuration
11653 This is the data type representing the configuration of Mingetty, which
11654 provides the default implementation of virtual console log-in.
11655
11656 @table @asis
11657
11658 @item @code{tty}
11659 The name of the console this Mingetty runs on---e.g., @code{"tty1"}.
11660
11661 @item @code{auto-login} (default: @code{#f})
11662 When true, this field must be a string denoting the user name under
11663 which the system automatically logs in. When it is @code{#f}, a
11664 user name and password must be entered to log in.
11665
11666 @item @code{login-program} (default: @code{#f})
11667 This must be either @code{#f}, in which case the default log-in program
11668 is used (@command{login} from the Shadow tool suite), or a gexp denoting
11669 the name of the log-in program.
11670
11671 @item @code{login-pause?} (default: @code{#f})
11672 When set to @code{#t} in conjunction with @var{auto-login}, the user
11673 will have to press a key before the log-in shell is launched.
11674
11675 @item @code{mingetty} (default: @var{mingetty})
11676 The Mingetty package to use.
11677
11678 @end table
11679 @end deftp
11680
11681 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} agetty-service @var{config}
11682 Return a service to run agetty according to @var{config}, an
11683 @code{<agetty-configuration>} object, which specifies the tty to run,
11684 among other things.
11685 @end deffn
11686
11687 @deftp {Data Type} agetty-configuration
11688 This is the data type representing the configuration of agetty, which
11689 implements virtual and serial console log-in. See the @code{agetty(8)}
11690 man page for more information.
11691
11692 @table @asis
11693
11694 @item @code{tty}
11695 The name of the console this agetty runs on, as a string---e.g.,
11696 @code{"ttyS0"}. This argument is optional, it will default to
11697 a reasonable default serial port used by the kernel Linux.
11698
11699 For this, if there is a value for an option @code{agetty.tty} in the kernel
11700 command line, agetty will extract the device name of the serial port
11701 from it and use that.
11702
11703 If not and if there is a value for an option @code{console} with a tty in
11704 the Linux command line, agetty will extract the device name of the
11705 serial port from it and use that.
11706
11707 In both cases, agetty will leave the other serial device settings
11708 (baud rate etc.)@: alone---in the hope that Linux pinned them to the
11709 correct values.
11710
11711 @item @code{baud-rate} (default: @code{#f})
11712 A string containing a comma-separated list of one or more baud rates, in
11713 descending order.
11714
11715 @item @code{term} (default: @code{#f})
11716 A string containing the value used for the @code{TERM} environment
11717 variable.
11718
11719 @item @code{eight-bits?} (default: @code{#f})
11720 When @code{#t}, the tty is assumed to be 8-bit clean, and parity detection is
11721 disabled.
11722
11723 @item @code{auto-login} (default: @code{#f})
11724 When passed a login name, as a string, the specified user will be logged
11725 in automatically without prompting for their login name or password.
11726
11727 @item @code{no-reset?} (default: @code{#f})
11728 When @code{#t}, don't reset terminal cflags (control modes).
11729
11730 @item @code{host} (default: @code{#f})
11731 This accepts a string containing the "login_host", which will be written
11732 into the @file{/var/run/utmpx} file.
11733
11734 @item @code{remote?} (default: @code{#f})
11735 When set to @code{#t} in conjunction with @var{host}, this will add an
11736 @code{-r} fakehost option to the command line of the login program
11737 specified in @var{login-program}.
11738
11739 @item @code{flow-control?} (default: @code{#f})
11740 When set to @code{#t}, enable hardware (RTS/CTS) flow control.
11741
11742 @item @code{no-issue?} (default: @code{#f})
11743 When set to @code{#t}, the contents of the @file{/etc/issue} file will
11744 not be displayed before presenting the login prompt.
11745
11746 @item @code{init-string} (default: @code{#f})
11747 This accepts a string that will be sent to the tty or modem before
11748 sending anything else. It can be used to initialize a modem.
11749
11750 @item @code{no-clear?} (default: @code{#f})
11751 When set to @code{#t}, agetty will not clear the screen before showing
11752 the login prompt.
11753
11754 @item @code{login-program} (default: (file-append shadow "/bin/login"))
11755 This must be either a gexp denoting the name of a log-in program, or
11756 unset, in which case the default value is the @command{login} from the
11757 Shadow tool suite.
11758
11759 @item @code{local-line} (default: @code{#f})
11760 Control the CLOCAL line flag. This accepts one of three symbols as
11761 arguments, @code{'auto}, @code{'always}, or @code{'never}. If @code{#f},
11762 the default value chosen by agetty is @code{'auto}.
11763
11764 @item @code{extract-baud?} (default: @code{#f})
11765 When set to @code{#t}, instruct agetty to try to extract the baud rate
11766 from the status messages produced by certain types of modems.
11767
11768 @item @code{skip-login?} (default: @code{#f})
11769 When set to @code{#t}, do not prompt the user for a login name. This
11770 can be used with @var{login-program} field to use non-standard login
11771 systems.
11772
11773 @item @code{no-newline?} (default: @code{#f})
11774 When set to @code{#t}, do not print a newline before printing the
11775 @file{/etc/issue} file.
11776
11777 @c Is this dangerous only when used with login-program, or always?
11778 @item @code{login-options} (default: @code{#f})
11779 This option accepts a string containing options that are passed to the
11780 login program. When used with the @var{login-program}, be aware that a
11781 malicious user could try to enter a login name containing embedded
11782 options that could be parsed by the login program.
11783
11784 @item @code{login-pause} (default: @code{#f})
11785 When set to @code{#t}, wait for any key before showing the login prompt.
11786 This can be used in conjunction with @var{auto-login} to save memory by
11787 lazily spawning shells.
11788
11789 @item @code{chroot} (default: @code{#f})
11790 Change root to the specified directory. This option accepts a directory
11791 path as a string.
11792
11793 @item @code{hangup?} (default: @code{#f})
11794 Use the Linux system call @code{vhangup} to do a virtual hangup of the
11795 specified terminal.
11796
11797 @item @code{keep-baud?} (default: @code{#f})
11798 When set to @code{#t}, try to keep the existing baud rate. The baud
11799 rates from @var{baud-rate} are used when agetty receives a @key{BREAK}
11800 character.
11801
11802 @item @code{timeout} (default: @code{#f})
11803 When set to an integer value, terminate if no user name could be read
11804 within @var{timeout} seconds.
11805
11806 @item @code{detect-case?} (default: @code{#f})
11807 When set to @code{#t}, turn on support for detecting an uppercase-only
11808 terminal. This setting will detect a login name containing only
11809 uppercase letters as indicating an uppercase-only terminal and turn on
11810 some upper-to-lower case conversions. Note that this will not support
11811 Unicode characters.
11812
11813 @item @code{wait-cr?} (default: @code{#f})
11814 When set to @code{#t}, wait for the user or modem to send a
11815 carriage-return or linefeed character before displaying
11816 @file{/etc/issue} or login prompt. This is typically used with the
11817 @var{init-string} option.
11818
11819 @item @code{no-hints?} (default: @code{#f})
11820 When set to @code{#t}, do not print hints about Num, Caps, and Scroll
11821 locks.
11822
11823 @item @code{no-hostname?} (default: @code{#f})
11824 By default, the hostname is printed. When this option is set to
11825 @code{#t}, no hostname will be shown at all.
11826
11827 @item @code{long-hostname?} (default: @code{#f})
11828 By default, the hostname is only printed until the first dot. When this
11829 option is set to @code{#t}, the fully qualified hostname by
11830 @code{gethostname} or @code{getaddrinfo} is shown.
11831
11832 @item @code{erase-characters} (default: @code{#f})
11833 This option accepts a string of additional characters that should be
11834 interpreted as backspace when the user types their login name.
11835
11836 @item @code{kill-characters} (default: @code{#f})
11837 This option accepts a string that should be interpreted to mean "ignore
11838 all previous characters" (also called a "kill" character) when the user
11839 types their login name.
11840
11841 @item @code{chdir} (default: @code{#f})
11842 This option accepts, as a string, a directory path that will be changed
11843 to before login.
11844
11845 @item @code{delay} (default: @code{#f})
11846 This options accepts, as an integer, the number of seconds to sleep
11847 before opening the tty and displaying the login prompt.
11848
11849 @item @code{nice} (default: @code{#f})
11850 This option accepts, as an integer, the nice value with which to run the
11851 @command{login} program.
11852
11853 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @code{'()})
11854 This option provides an "escape hatch" for the user to provide arbitrary
11855 command-line arguments to @command{agetty} as a list of strings.
11856
11857 @end table
11858 @end deftp
11859
11860 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} kmscon-service-type @var{config}
11861 Return a service to run @uref{https://www.freedesktop.org/wiki/Software/kmscon,kmscon}
11862 according to @var{config}, a @code{<kmscon-configuration>} object, which
11863 specifies the tty to run, among other things.
11864 @end deffn
11865
11866 @deftp {Data Type} kmscon-configuration
11867 This is the data type representing the configuration of Kmscon, which
11868 implements virtual console log-in.
11869
11870 @table @asis
11871
11872 @item @code{virtual-terminal}
11873 The name of the console this Kmscon runs on---e.g., @code{"tty1"}.
11874
11875 @item @code{login-program} (default: @code{#~(string-append #$shadow "/bin/login")})
11876 A gexp denoting the name of the log-in program. The default log-in program is
11877 @command{login} from the Shadow tool suite.
11878
11879 @item @code{login-arguments} (default: @code{'("-p")})
11880 A list of arguments to pass to @command{login}.
11881
11882 @item @code{auto-login} (default: @code{#f})
11883 When passed a login name, as a string, the specified user will be logged
11884 in automatically without prompting for their login name or password.
11885
11886 @item @code{hardware-acceleration?} (default: #f)
11887 Whether to use hardware acceleration.
11888
11889 @item @code{kmscon} (default: @var{kmscon})
11890 The Kmscon package to use.
11891
11892 @end table
11893 @end deftp
11894
11895 @cindex name service cache daemon
11896 @cindex nscd
11897 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} nscd-service [@var{config}] [#:glibc glibc] @
11898 [#:name-services '()]
11899 Return a service that runs the libc name service cache daemon (nscd) with the
11900 given @var{config}---an @code{<nscd-configuration>} object. @xref{Name
11901 Service Switch}, for an example.
11902
11903 For convenience, the Shepherd service for nscd provides the following actions:
11904
11905 @table @code
11906 @item invalidate
11907 @cindex cache invalidation, nscd
11908 @cindex nscd, cache invalidation
11909 This invalidate the given cache. For instance, running:
11910
11911 @example
11912 herd invalidate nscd hosts
11913 @end example
11914
11915 @noindent
11916 invalidates the host name lookup cache of nscd.
11917
11918 @item statistics
11919 Running @command{herd statistics nscd} displays information about nscd usage
11920 and caches.
11921 @end table
11922
11923 @end deffn
11924
11925 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %nscd-default-configuration
11926 This is the default @code{<nscd-configuration>} value (see below) used
11927 by @code{nscd-service}. It uses the caches defined by
11928 @var{%nscd-default-caches}; see below.
11929 @end defvr
11930
11931 @deftp {Data Type} nscd-configuration
11932 This is the data type representing the name service cache daemon (nscd)
11933 configuration.
11934
11935 @table @asis
11936
11937 @item @code{name-services} (default: @code{'()})
11938 List of packages denoting @dfn{name services} that must be visible to
11939 the nscd---e.g., @code{(list @var{nss-mdns})}.
11940
11941 @item @code{glibc} (default: @var{glibc})
11942 Package object denoting the GNU C Library providing the @command{nscd}
11943 command.
11944
11945 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{"/var/log/nscd.log"})
11946 Name of the nscd log file. This is where debugging output goes when
11947 @code{debug-level} is strictly positive.
11948
11949 @item @code{debug-level} (default: @code{0})
11950 Integer denoting the debugging levels. Higher numbers mean that more
11951 debugging output is logged.
11952
11953 @item @code{caches} (default: @var{%nscd-default-caches})
11954 List of @code{<nscd-cache>} objects denoting things to be cached; see
11955 below.
11956
11957 @end table
11958 @end deftp
11959
11960 @deftp {Data Type} nscd-cache
11961 Data type representing a cache database of nscd and its parameters.
11962
11963 @table @asis
11964
11965 @item @code{database}
11966 This is a symbol representing the name of the database to be cached.
11967 Valid values are @code{passwd}, @code{group}, @code{hosts}, and
11968 @code{services}, which designate the corresponding NSS database
11969 (@pxref{NSS Basics,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
11970
11971 @item @code{positive-time-to-live}
11972 @itemx @code{negative-time-to-live} (default: @code{20})
11973 A number representing the number of seconds during which a positive or
11974 negative lookup result remains in cache.
11975
11976 @item @code{check-files?} (default: @code{#t})
11977 Whether to check for updates of the files corresponding to
11978 @var{database}.
11979
11980 For instance, when @var{database} is @code{hosts}, setting this flag
11981 instructs nscd to check for updates in @file{/etc/hosts} and to take
11982 them into account.
11983
11984 @item @code{persistent?} (default: @code{#t})
11985 Whether the cache should be stored persistently on disk.
11986
11987 @item @code{shared?} (default: @code{#t})
11988 Whether the cache should be shared among users.
11989
11990 @item @code{max-database-size} (default: 32@tie{}MiB)
11991 Maximum size in bytes of the database cache.
11992
11993 @c XXX: 'suggested-size' and 'auto-propagate?' seem to be expert
11994 @c settings, so leave them out.
11995
11996 @end table
11997 @end deftp
11998
11999 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %nscd-default-caches
12000 List of @code{<nscd-cache>} objects used by default by
12001 @code{nscd-configuration} (see above).
12002
12003 It enables persistent and aggressive caching of service and host name
12004 lookups. The latter provides better host name lookup performance,
12005 resilience in the face of unreliable name servers, and also better
12006 privacy---often the result of host name lookups is in local cache, so
12007 external name servers do not even need to be queried.
12008 @end defvr
12009
12010 @anchor{syslog-configuration-type}
12011 @cindex syslog
12012 @cindex logging
12013 @deftp {Data Type} syslog-configuration
12014 This data type represents the configuration of the syslog daemon.
12015
12016 @table @asis
12017 @item @code{syslogd} (default: @code{#~(string-append #$inetutils "/libexec/syslogd")})
12018 The syslog daemon to use.
12019
12020 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{%default-syslog.conf})
12021 The syslog configuration file to use.
12022
12023 @end table
12024 @end deftp
12025
12026 @anchor{syslog-service}
12027 @cindex syslog
12028 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} syslog-service @var{config}
12029 Return a service that runs a syslog daemon according to @var{config}.
12030
12031 @xref{syslogd invocation,,, inetutils, GNU Inetutils}, for more
12032 information on the configuration file syntax.
12033 @end deffn
12034
12035 @defvr {Scheme Variable} guix-service-type
12036 This is the type of the service that runs the build daemon,
12037 @command{guix-daemon} (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon}). Its value must be a
12038 @code{guix-configuration} record as described below.
12039 @end defvr
12040
12041 @anchor{guix-configuration-type}
12042 @deftp {Data Type} guix-configuration
12043 This data type represents the configuration of the Guix build daemon.
12044 @xref{Invoking guix-daemon}, for more information.
12045
12046 @table @asis
12047 @item @code{guix} (default: @var{guix})
12048 The Guix package to use.
12049
12050 @item @code{build-group} (default: @code{"guixbuild"})
12051 Name of the group for build user accounts.
12052
12053 @item @code{build-accounts} (default: @code{10})
12054 Number of build user accounts to create.
12055
12056 @item @code{authorize-key?} (default: @code{#t})
12057 @cindex substitutes, authorization thereof
12058 Whether to authorize the substitute keys listed in
12059 @code{authorized-keys}---by default that of @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}}
12060 (@pxref{Substitutes}).
12061
12062 @vindex %default-authorized-guix-keys
12063 @item @code{authorized-keys} (default: @code{%default-authorized-guix-keys})
12064 The list of authorized key files for archive imports, as a list of
12065 string-valued gexps (@pxref{Invoking guix archive}). By default, it
12066 contains that of @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} (@pxref{Substitutes}).
12067
12068 @item @code{use-substitutes?} (default: @code{#t})
12069 Whether to use substitutes.
12070
12071 @item @code{substitute-urls} (default: @code{%default-substitute-urls})
12072 The list of URLs where to look for substitutes by default.
12073
12074 @item @code{max-silent-time} (default: @code{0})
12075 @itemx @code{timeout} (default: @code{0})
12076 The number of seconds of silence and the number of seconds of activity,
12077 respectively, after which a build process times out. A value of zero
12078 disables the timeout.
12079
12080 @item @code{log-compression} (default: @code{'bzip2})
12081 The type of compression used for build logs---one of @code{gzip},
12082 @code{bzip2}, or @code{none}.
12083
12084 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @code{'()})
12085 List of extra command-line options for @command{guix-daemon}.
12086
12087 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{"/var/log/guix-daemon.log"})
12088 File where @command{guix-daemon}'s standard output and standard error
12089 are written.
12090
12091 @item @code{http-proxy} (default: @code{#f})
12092 The HTTP proxy used for downloading fixed-output derivations and
12093 substitutes.
12094
12095 @item @code{tmpdir} (default: @code{#f})
12096 A directory path where the @command{guix-daemon} will perform builds.
12097
12098 @end table
12099 @end deftp
12100
12101 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} udev-service [#:udev @var{eudev} #:rules @code{'()}]
12102 Run @var{udev}, which populates the @file{/dev} directory dynamically.
12103 udev rules can be provided as a list of files through the @var{rules}
12104 variable. The procedures @code{udev-rule} and @code{file->udev-rule} from
12105 @code{(gnu services base)} simplify the creation of such rule files.
12106 @end deffn
12107
12108 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} udev-rule [@var{file-name} @var{contents}]
12109 Return a udev-rule file named @var{file-name} containing the rules
12110 defined by the @var{contents} literal.
12111
12112 In the following example, a rule for a USB device is defined to be
12113 stored in the file @file{90-usb-thing.rules}. The rule runs a script
12114 upon detecting a USB device with a given product identifier.
12115
12116 @example
12117 (define %example-udev-rule
12118 (udev-rule
12119 "90-usb-thing.rules"
12120 (string-append "ACTION==\"add\", SUBSYSTEM==\"usb\", "
12121 "ATTR@{product@}==\"Example\", "
12122 "RUN+=\"/path/to/script\"")))
12123 @end example
12124
12125 The @command{herd rules udev} command, as root, returns the name of the
12126 directory containing all the active udev rules.
12127 @end deffn
12128
12129 Here we show how the default @var{udev-service} can be extended with it.
12130
12131 @example
12132 (operating-system
12133 ;; @dots{}
12134 (services
12135 (modify-services %desktop-services
12136 (udev-service-type config =>
12137 (udev-configuration (inherit config)
12138 (rules (append (udev-configuration-rules config)
12139 (list %example-udev-rule))))))))
12140 @end example
12141
12142 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} file->udev-rule [@var{file-name} @var{file}]
12143 Return a udev file named @var{file-name} containing the rules defined
12144 within @var{file}, a file-like object.
12145
12146 The following example showcases how we can use an existing rule file.
12147
12148 @example
12149 (use-modules (guix download) ;for url-fetch
12150 (guix packages) ;for origin
12151 ;; @dots{})
12152
12153 (define %android-udev-rules
12154 (file->udev-rule
12155 "51-android-udev.rules"
12156 (let ((version "20170910"))
12157 (origin
12158 (method url-fetch)
12159 (uri (string-append "https://raw.githubusercontent.com/M0Rf30/"
12160 "android-udev-rules/" version "/51-android.rules"))
12161 (sha256
12162 (base32 "0lmmagpyb6xsq6zcr2w1cyx9qmjqmajkvrdbhjx32gqf1d9is003"))))))
12163 @end example
12164 @end deffn
12165
12166 Additionally, Guix package definitions can be included in @var{rules} in
12167 order to extend the udev rules with the definitions found under their
12168 @file{lib/udev/rules.d} sub-directory. In lieu of the previous
12169 @var{file->udev-rule} example, we could have used the
12170 @var{android-udev-rules} package which exists in Guix in the @code{(gnu
12171 packages android)} module.
12172
12173 The following example shows how to use the @var{android-udev-rules}
12174 package so that the Android tool @command{adb} can detect devices
12175 without root privileges. It also details how to create the
12176 @code{adbusers} group, which is required for the proper functioning of
12177 the rules defined within the @var{android-udev-rules} package. To
12178 create such a group, we must define it both as part of the
12179 @var{supplementary-groups} of our @var{user-account} declaration, as
12180 well as in the @var{groups} field of the @var{operating-system} record.
12181
12182 @example
12183 (use-modules (gnu packages android) ;for android-udev-rules
12184 (gnu system shadow) ;for user-group
12185 ;; @dots{})
12186
12187 (operating-system
12188 ;; @dots{}
12189 (users (cons (user-acount
12190 ;; @dots{}
12191 (supplementary-groups
12192 '("adbusers" ;for adb
12193 "wheel" "netdev" "audio" "video"))
12194 ;; @dots{})))
12195
12196 (groups (cons (user-group (system? #t) (name "adbusers"))
12197 %base-groups))
12198
12199 ;; @dots{}
12200
12201 (services
12202 (modify-services %desktop-services
12203 (udev-service-type
12204 config =>
12205 (udev-configuration (inherit config)
12206 (rules (cons android-udev-rules
12207 (udev-configuration-rules config))))))))
12208 @end example
12209
12210 @defvr {Scheme Variable} urandom-seed-service-type
12211 Save some entropy in @var{%random-seed-file} to seed @file{/dev/urandom}
12212 when rebooting. It also tries to seed @file{/dev/urandom} from
12213 @file{/dev/hwrng} while booting, if @file{/dev/hwrng} exists and is
12214 readable.
12215 @end defvr
12216
12217 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %random-seed-file
12218 This is the name of the file where some random bytes are saved by
12219 @var{urandom-seed-service} to seed @file{/dev/urandom} when rebooting.
12220 It defaults to @file{/var/lib/random-seed}.
12221 @end defvr
12222
12223 @cindex mouse
12224 @cindex gpm
12225 @defvr {Scheme Variable} gpm-service-type
12226 This is the type of the service that runs GPM, the @dfn{general-purpose
12227 mouse daemon}, which provides mouse support to the Linux console. GPM
12228 allows users to use the mouse in the console, notably to select, copy,
12229 and paste text.
12230
12231 The value for services of this type must be a @code{gpm-configuration}
12232 (see below). This service is not part of @code{%base-services}.
12233 @end defvr
12234
12235 @deftp {Data Type} gpm-configuration
12236 Data type representing the configuration of GPM.
12237
12238 @table @asis
12239 @item @code{options} (default: @code{%default-gpm-options})
12240 Command-line options passed to @command{gpm}. The default set of
12241 options instruct @command{gpm} to listen to mouse events on
12242 @file{/dev/input/mice}. @xref{Command Line,,, gpm, gpm manual}, for
12243 more information.
12244
12245 @item @code{gpm} (default: @code{gpm})
12246 The GPM package to use.
12247
12248 @end table
12249 @end deftp
12250
12251 @anchor{guix-publish-service-type}
12252 @deffn {Scheme Variable} guix-publish-service-type
12253 This is the service type for @command{guix publish} (@pxref{Invoking
12254 guix publish}). Its value must be a @code{guix-publish-configuration}
12255 object, as described below.
12256
12257 This assumes that @file{/etc/guix} already contains a signing key pair as
12258 created by @command{guix archive --generate-key} (@pxref{Invoking guix
12259 archive}). If that is not the case, the service will fail to start.
12260 @end deffn
12261
12262 @deftp {Data Type} guix-publish-configuration
12263 Data type representing the configuration of the @code{guix publish}
12264 service.
12265
12266 @table @asis
12267 @item @code{guix} (default: @code{guix})
12268 The Guix package to use.
12269
12270 @item @code{port} (default: @code{80})
12271 The TCP port to listen for connections.
12272
12273 @item @code{host} (default: @code{"localhost"})
12274 The host (and thus, network interface) to listen to. Use
12275 @code{"0.0.0.0"} to listen on all the network interfaces.
12276
12277 @item @code{compression} (default: @code{'(("gzip" 3))})
12278 This is a list of compression method/level tuple used when compressing
12279 substitutes. For example, to compress all substitutes with @emph{both} lzip
12280 at level 7 and gzip at level 9, write:
12281
12282 @example
12283 '(("lzip" 7) ("gzip" 9))
12284 @end example
12285
12286 Level 9 achieves the best compression ratio at the expense of increased CPU
12287 usage, whereas level 1 achieves fast compression.
12288
12289 An empty list disables compression altogether.
12290
12291 @item @code{nar-path} (default: @code{"nar"})
12292 The URL path at which ``nars'' can be fetched. @xref{Invoking guix
12293 publish, @code{--nar-path}}, for details.
12294
12295 @item @code{cache} (default: @code{#f})
12296 When it is @code{#f}, disable caching and instead generate archives on
12297 demand. Otherwise, this should be the name of a directory---e.g.,
12298 @code{"/var/cache/guix/publish"}---where @command{guix publish} caches
12299 archives and meta-data ready to be sent. @xref{Invoking guix publish,
12300 @option{--cache}}, for more information on the tradeoffs involved.
12301
12302 @item @code{workers} (default: @code{#f})
12303 When it is an integer, this is the number of worker threads used for
12304 caching; when @code{#f}, the number of processors is used.
12305 @xref{Invoking guix publish, @option{--workers}}, for more information.
12306
12307 @item @code{ttl} (default: @code{#f})
12308 When it is an integer, this denotes the @dfn{time-to-live} in seconds
12309 of the published archives. @xref{Invoking guix publish, @option{--ttl}},
12310 for more information.
12311 @end table
12312 @end deftp
12313
12314 @anchor{rngd-service}
12315 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} rngd-service [#:rng-tools @var{rng-tools}] @
12316 [#:device "/dev/hwrng"]
12317 Return a service that runs the @command{rngd} program from @var{rng-tools}
12318 to add @var{device} to the kernel's entropy pool. The service will fail if
12319 @var{device} does not exist.
12320 @end deffn
12321
12322 @anchor{pam-limits-service}
12323 @cindex session limits
12324 @cindex ulimit
12325 @cindex priority
12326 @cindex realtime
12327 @cindex jackd
12328 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} pam-limits-service [#:limits @code{'()}]
12329
12330 Return a service that installs a configuration file for the
12331 @uref{http://linux-pam.org/Linux-PAM-html/sag-pam_limits.html,
12332 @code{pam_limits} module}. The procedure optionally takes a list of
12333 @code{pam-limits-entry} values, which can be used to specify
12334 @code{ulimit} limits and nice priority limits to user sessions.
12335
12336 The following limits definition sets two hard and soft limits for all
12337 login sessions of users in the @code{realtime} group:
12338
12339 @example
12340 (pam-limits-service
12341 (list
12342 (pam-limits-entry "@@realtime" 'both 'rtprio 99)
12343 (pam-limits-entry "@@realtime" 'both 'memlock 'unlimited)))
12344 @end example
12345
12346 The first entry increases the maximum realtime priority for
12347 non-privileged processes; the second entry lifts any restriction of the
12348 maximum address space that can be locked in memory. These settings are
12349 commonly used for real-time audio systems.
12350 @end deffn
12351
12352 @node Scheduled Job Execution
12353 @subsection Scheduled Job Execution
12354
12355 @cindex cron
12356 @cindex mcron
12357 @cindex scheduling jobs
12358 The @code{(gnu services mcron)} module provides an interface to
12359 GNU@tie{}mcron, a daemon to run jobs at scheduled times (@pxref{Top,,,
12360 mcron, GNU@tie{}mcron}). GNU@tie{}mcron is similar to the traditional
12361 Unix @command{cron} daemon; the main difference is that it is
12362 implemented in Guile Scheme, which provides a lot of flexibility when
12363 specifying the scheduling of jobs and their actions.
12364
12365 The example below defines an operating system that runs the
12366 @command{updatedb} (@pxref{Invoking updatedb,,, find, Finding Files})
12367 and the @command{guix gc} commands (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}) daily, as
12368 well as the @command{mkid} command on behalf of an unprivileged user
12369 (@pxref{mkid invocation,,, idutils, ID Database Utilities}). It uses
12370 gexps to introduce job definitions that are passed to mcron
12371 (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
12372
12373 @lisp
12374 (use-modules (guix) (gnu) (gnu services mcron))
12375 (use-package-modules base idutils)
12376
12377 (define updatedb-job
12378 ;; Run 'updatedb' at 3AM every day. Here we write the
12379 ;; job's action as a Scheme procedure.
12380 #~(job '(next-hour '(3))
12381 (lambda ()
12382 (execl (string-append #$findutils "/bin/updatedb")
12383 "updatedb"
12384 "--prunepaths=/tmp /var/tmp /gnu/store"))))
12385
12386 (define garbage-collector-job
12387 ;; Collect garbage 5 minutes after midnight every day.
12388 ;; The job's action is a shell command.
12389 #~(job "5 0 * * *" ;Vixie cron syntax
12390 "guix gc -F 1G"))
12391
12392 (define idutils-job
12393 ;; Update the index database as user "charlie" at 12:15PM
12394 ;; and 19:15PM. This runs from the user's home directory.
12395 #~(job '(next-minute-from (next-hour '(12 19)) '(15))
12396 (string-append #$idutils "/bin/mkid src")
12397 #:user "charlie"))
12398
12399 (operating-system
12400 ;; @dots{}
12401 (services (cons (service mcron-service-type
12402 (mcron-configuration
12403 (jobs (list garbage-collector-job
12404 updatedb-job
12405 idutils-job))))
12406 %base-services)))
12407 @end lisp
12408
12409 @xref{Guile Syntax, mcron job specifications,, mcron, GNU@tie{}mcron},
12410 for more information on mcron job specifications. Below is the
12411 reference of the mcron service.
12412
12413 On a running system, you can use the @code{schedule} action of the service to
12414 visualize the mcron jobs that will be executed next:
12415
12416 @example
12417 # herd schedule mcron
12418 @end example
12419
12420 @noindent
12421 The example above lists the next five tasks that will be executed, but you can
12422 also specify the number of tasks to display:
12423
12424 @example
12425 # herd schedule mcron 10
12426 @end example
12427
12428 @defvr {Scheme Variable} mcron-service-type
12429 This is the type of the @code{mcron} service, whose value is an
12430 @code{mcron-configuration} object.
12431
12432 This service type can be the target of a service extension that provides
12433 it additional job specifications (@pxref{Service Composition}). In
12434 other words, it is possible to define services that provide additional
12435 mcron jobs to run.
12436 @end defvr
12437
12438 @deftp {Data Type} mcron-configuration
12439 Data type representing the configuration of mcron.
12440
12441 @table @asis
12442 @item @code{mcron} (default: @var{mcron})
12443 The mcron package to use.
12444
12445 @item @code{jobs}
12446 This is a list of gexps (@pxref{G-Expressions}), where each gexp
12447 corresponds to an mcron job specification (@pxref{Syntax, mcron job
12448 specifications,, mcron, GNU@tie{}mcron}).
12449 @end table
12450 @end deftp
12451
12452
12453 @node Log Rotation
12454 @subsection Log Rotation
12455
12456 @cindex rottlog
12457 @cindex log rotation
12458 @cindex logging
12459 Log files such as those found in @file{/var/log} tend to grow endlessly,
12460 so it's a good idea to @dfn{rotate} them once in a while---i.e., archive
12461 their contents in separate files, possibly compressed. The @code{(gnu
12462 services admin)} module provides an interface to GNU@tie{}Rot[t]log, a
12463 log rotation tool (@pxref{Top,,, rottlog, GNU Rot[t]log Manual}).
12464
12465 The example below defines an operating system that provides log rotation
12466 with the default settings, for commonly encountered log files.
12467
12468 @lisp
12469 (use-modules (guix) (gnu))
12470 (use-service-modules admin mcron)
12471 (use-package-modules base idutils)
12472
12473 (operating-system
12474 ;; @dots{}
12475 (services (cons (service rottlog-service-type)
12476 %base-services)))
12477 @end lisp
12478
12479 @defvr {Scheme Variable} rottlog-service-type
12480 This is the type of the Rottlog service, whose value is a
12481 @code{rottlog-configuration} object.
12482
12483 Other services can extend this one with new @code{log-rotation} objects
12484 (see below), thereby augmenting the set of files to be rotated.
12485
12486 This service type can define mcron jobs (@pxref{Scheduled Job
12487 Execution}) to run the rottlog service.
12488 @end defvr
12489
12490 @deftp {Data Type} rottlog-configuration
12491 Data type representing the configuration of rottlog.
12492
12493 @table @asis
12494 @item @code{rottlog} (default: @code{rottlog})
12495 The Rottlog package to use.
12496
12497 @item @code{rc-file} (default: @code{(file-append rottlog "/etc/rc")})
12498 The Rottlog configuration file to use (@pxref{Mandatory RC Variables,,,
12499 rottlog, GNU Rot[t]log Manual}).
12500
12501 @item @code{rotations} (default: @code{%default-rotations})
12502 A list of @code{log-rotation} objects as defined below.
12503
12504 @item @code{jobs}
12505 This is a list of gexps where each gexp corresponds to an mcron job
12506 specification (@pxref{Scheduled Job Execution}).
12507 @end table
12508 @end deftp
12509
12510 @deftp {Data Type} log-rotation
12511 Data type representing the rotation of a group of log files.
12512
12513 Taking an example from the Rottlog manual (@pxref{Period Related File
12514 Examples,,, rottlog, GNU Rot[t]log Manual}), a log rotation might be
12515 defined like this:
12516
12517 @example
12518 (log-rotation
12519 (frequency 'daily)
12520 (files '("/var/log/apache/*"))
12521 (options '("storedir apache-archives"
12522 "rotate 6"
12523 "notifempty"
12524 "nocompress")))
12525 @end example
12526
12527 The list of fields is as follows:
12528
12529 @table @asis
12530 @item @code{frequency} (default: @code{'weekly})
12531 The log rotation frequency, a symbol.
12532
12533 @item @code{files}
12534 The list of files or file glob patterns to rotate.
12535
12536 @item @code{options} (default: @code{'()})
12537 The list of rottlog options for this rotation (@pxref{Configuration
12538 parameters,,, rottlog, GNU Rot[t]lg Manual}).
12539
12540 @item @code{post-rotate} (default: @code{#f})
12541 Either @code{#f} or a gexp to execute once the rotation has completed.
12542 @end table
12543 @end deftp
12544
12545 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-rotations
12546 Specifies weekly rotation of @var{%rotated-files} and
12547 a couple of other files.
12548 @end defvr
12549
12550 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %rotated-files
12551 The list of syslog-controlled files to be rotated. By default it is:
12552 @code{'("/var/log/messages" "/var/log/secure")}.
12553 @end defvr
12554
12555 @node Networking Services
12556 @subsection Networking Services
12557
12558 The @code{(gnu services networking)} module provides services to configure
12559 the network interface.
12560
12561 @cindex DHCP, networking service
12562 @defvr {Scheme Variable} dhcp-client-service-type
12563 This is the type of services that run @var{dhcp}, a Dynamic Host Configuration
12564 Protocol (DHCP) client, on all the non-loopback network interfaces. Its value
12565 is the DHCP client package to use, @code{isc-dhcp} by default.
12566 @end defvr
12567
12568 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} dhcpd-service-type
12569 This type defines a service that runs a DHCP daemon. To create a
12570 service of this type, you must supply a @code{<dhcpd-configuration>}.
12571 For example:
12572
12573 @example
12574 (service dhcpd-service-type
12575 (dhcpd-configuration
12576 (config-file (local-file "my-dhcpd.conf"))
12577 (interfaces '("enp0s25"))))
12578 @end example
12579 @end deffn
12580
12581 @deftp {Data Type} dhcpd-configuration
12582 @table @asis
12583 @item @code{package} (default: @code{isc-dhcp})
12584 The package that provides the DHCP daemon. This package is expected to
12585 provide the daemon at @file{sbin/dhcpd} relative to its output
12586 directory. The default package is the
12587 @uref{https://www.isc.org/products/DHCP, ISC's DHCP server}.
12588 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{#f})
12589 The configuration file to use. This is required. It will be passed to
12590 @code{dhcpd} via its @code{-cf} option. This may be any ``file-like''
12591 object (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}). See @code{man
12592 dhcpd.conf} for details on the configuration file syntax.
12593 @item @code{version} (default: @code{"4"})
12594 The DHCP version to use. The ISC DHCP server supports the values ``4'',
12595 ``6'', and ``4o6''. These correspond to the @code{dhcpd} program
12596 options @code{-4}, @code{-6}, and @code{-4o6}. See @code{man dhcpd} for
12597 details.
12598 @item @code{run-directory} (default: @code{"/run/dhcpd"})
12599 The run directory to use. At service activation time, this directory
12600 will be created if it does not exist.
12601 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{"/run/dhcpd/dhcpd.pid"})
12602 The PID file to use. This corresponds to the @code{-pf} option of
12603 @code{dhcpd}. See @code{man dhcpd} for details.
12604 @item @code{interfaces} (default: @code{'()})
12605 The names of the network interfaces on which dhcpd should listen for
12606 broadcasts. If this list is not empty, then its elements (which must be
12607 strings) will be appended to the @code{dhcpd} invocation when starting
12608 the daemon. It may not be necessary to explicitly specify any
12609 interfaces here; see @code{man dhcpd} for details.
12610 @end table
12611 @end deftp
12612
12613 @defvr {Scheme Variable} static-networking-service-type
12614 This is the type for statically-configured network interfaces.
12615 @c TODO Document <static-networking> data structures.
12616 @end defvr
12617
12618 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} static-networking-service @var{interface} @var{ip} @
12619 [#:netmask #f] [#:gateway #f] [#:name-servers @code{'()}] @
12620 [#:requirement @code{'(udev)}]
12621 Return a service that starts @var{interface} with address @var{ip}. If
12622 @var{netmask} is true, use it as the network mask. If @var{gateway} is true,
12623 it must be a string specifying the default network gateway. @var{requirement}
12624 can be used to declare a dependency on another service before configuring the
12625 interface.
12626
12627 This procedure can be called several times, one for each network
12628 interface of interest. Behind the scenes what it does is extend
12629 @code{static-networking-service-type} with additional network interfaces
12630 to handle.
12631
12632 For example:
12633
12634 @example
12635 (static-networking-service "eno1" "192.168.1.82"
12636 #:gateway "192.168.1.2"
12637 #:name-servers '("192.168.1.2"))
12638 @end example
12639 @end deffn
12640
12641 @cindex wicd
12642 @cindex wireless
12643 @cindex WiFi
12644 @cindex network management
12645 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} wicd-service [#:wicd @var{wicd}]
12646 Return a service that runs @url{https://launchpad.net/wicd,Wicd}, a network
12647 management daemon that aims to simplify wired and wireless networking.
12648
12649 This service adds the @var{wicd} package to the global profile, providing
12650 several commands to interact with the daemon and configure networking:
12651 @command{wicd-client}, a graphical user interface, and the @command{wicd-cli}
12652 and @command{wicd-curses} user interfaces.
12653 @end deffn
12654
12655 @cindex ModemManager
12656
12657 @defvr {Scheme Variable} modem-manager-service-type
12658 This is the service type for the
12659 @uref{https://wiki.gnome.org/Projects/ModemManager, ModemManager}
12660 service. The value for this service type is a
12661 @code{modem-manager-configuration} record.
12662
12663 This service is part of @code{%desktop-services} (@pxref{Desktop
12664 Services}).
12665 @end defvr
12666
12667 @deftp {Data Type} modem-manager-configuration
12668 Data type representing the configuration of ModemManager.
12669
12670 @table @asis
12671 @item @code{modem-manager} (default: @code{modem-manager})
12672 The ModemManager package to use.
12673
12674 @end table
12675 @end deftp
12676
12677 @cindex USB_ModeSwitch
12678 @cindex Modeswitching
12679
12680 @defvr {Scheme Variable} usb-modeswitch-service-type
12681 This is the service type for the
12682 @uref{http://www.draisberghof.de/usb_modeswitch/, USB_ModeSwitch} service. The
12683 value for this service type is a @code{usb-modeswitch-configuration} record.
12684
12685 When plugged in, some USB modems (and other USB devices) initially present
12686 themselves as a read-only storage medium and not as a modem. They need to be
12687 @dfn{modeswitched} before they are usable. The USB_ModeSwitch service type
12688 installs udev rules to automatically modeswitch these devices when they are
12689 plugged in.
12690
12691 This service is part of @code{%desktop-services} (@pxref{Desktop
12692 Services}).
12693 @end defvr
12694
12695 @deftp {Data Type} usb-modeswitch-configuration
12696 Data type representing the configuration of USB_ModeSwitch.
12697
12698 @table @asis
12699 @item @code{usb-modeswitch} (default: @code{usb-modeswitch})
12700 The USB_ModeSwitch package providing the binaries for modeswitching.
12701
12702 @item @code{usb-modeswitch-data} (default: @code{usb-modeswitch-data})
12703 The package providing the device data and udev rules file used by
12704 USB_ModeSwitch.
12705
12706 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{#~(string-append #$usb-modeswitch:dispatcher "/etc/usb_modeswitch.conf")})
12707 Which config file to use for the USB_ModeSwitch dispatcher. By default the
12708 config file shipped with USB_ModeSwitch is used which disables logging to
12709 @file{/var/log} among other default settings. If set to @code{#f}, no config
12710 file is used.
12711
12712 @end table
12713 @end deftp
12714
12715 @cindex NetworkManager
12716
12717 @defvr {Scheme Variable} network-manager-service-type
12718 This is the service type for the
12719 @uref{https://wiki.gnome.org/Projects/NetworkManager, NetworkManager}
12720 service. The value for this service type is a
12721 @code{network-manager-configuration} record.
12722
12723 This service is part of @code{%desktop-services} (@pxref{Desktop
12724 Services}).
12725 @end defvr
12726
12727 @deftp {Data Type} network-manager-configuration
12728 Data type representing the configuration of NetworkManager.
12729
12730 @table @asis
12731 @item @code{network-manager} (default: @code{network-manager})
12732 The NetworkManager package to use.
12733
12734 @item @code{dns} (default: @code{"default"})
12735 Processing mode for DNS, which affects how NetworkManager uses the
12736 @code{resolv.conf} configuration file.
12737
12738 @table @samp
12739 @item default
12740 NetworkManager will update @code{resolv.conf} to reflect the nameservers
12741 provided by currently active connections.
12742
12743 @item dnsmasq
12744 NetworkManager will run @code{dnsmasq} as a local caching nameserver, using a
12745 @dfn{conditional forwarding} configuration if you are connected to a VPN, and
12746 then update @code{resolv.conf} to point to the local nameserver.
12747
12748 With this setting, you can share your network connection. For example when
12749 you want to share your network connection to another laptop @i{via} an
12750 Ethernet cable, you can open @command{nm-connection-editor} and configure the
12751 Wired connection's method for IPv4 and IPv6 to be ``Shared to other computers''
12752 and reestablish the connection (or reboot).
12753
12754 You can also set up a @dfn{host-to-guest connection} to QEMU VMs
12755 (@pxref{Installing Guix in a VM}). With a host-to-guest connection, you can
12756 e.g.@: access a Web server running on the VM (@pxref{Web Services}) from a Web
12757 browser on your host system, or connect to the VM @i{via} SSH
12758 (@pxref{Networking Services, @code{openssh-service-type}}). To set up a
12759 host-to-guest connection, run this command once:
12760
12761 @example
12762 nmcli connection add type tun \
12763 connection.interface-name tap0 \
12764 tun.mode tap tun.owner $(id -u) \
12765 ipv4.method shared \
12766 ipv4.addresses 172.28.112.1/24
12767 @end example
12768
12769 Then each time you launch your QEMU VM (@pxref{Running Guix in a VM}), pass
12770 @option{-nic tap,ifname=tap0,script=no,downscript=no} to
12771 @command{qemu-system-...}.
12772
12773 @item none
12774 NetworkManager will not modify @code{resolv.conf}.
12775 @end table
12776
12777 @item @code{vpn-plugins} (default: @code{'()})
12778 This is the list of available plugins for virtual private networks
12779 (VPNs). An example of this is the @code{network-manager-openvpn}
12780 package, which allows NetworkManager to manage VPNs @i{via} OpenVPN.
12781
12782 @end table
12783 @end deftp
12784
12785 @cindex Connman
12786 @deffn {Scheme Variable} connman-service-type
12787 This is the service type to run @url{https://01.org/connman,Connman},
12788 a network connection manager.
12789
12790 Its value must be an
12791 @code{connman-configuration} record as in this example:
12792
12793 @example
12794 (service connman-service-type
12795 (connman-configuration
12796 (disable-vpn? #t)))
12797 @end example
12798
12799 See below for details about @code{connman-configuration}.
12800 @end deffn
12801
12802 @deftp {Data Type} connman-configuration
12803 Data Type representing the configuration of connman.
12804
12805 @table @asis
12806 @item @code{connman} (default: @var{connman})
12807 The connman package to use.
12808
12809 @item @code{disable-vpn?} (default: @code{#f})
12810 When true, disable connman's vpn plugin.
12811 @end table
12812 @end deftp
12813
12814 @cindex WPA Supplicant
12815 @defvr {Scheme Variable} wpa-supplicant-service-type
12816 This is the service type to run @url{https://w1.fi/wpa_supplicant/,WPA
12817 supplicant}, an authentication daemon required to authenticate against
12818 encrypted WiFi or ethernet networks.
12819 @end defvr
12820
12821 @deftp {Data Type} wpa-supplicant-configuration
12822 Data type representing the configuration of WPA Supplicant.
12823
12824 It takes the following parameters:
12825
12826 @table @asis
12827 @item @code{wpa-supplicant} (default: @code{wpa-supplicant})
12828 The WPA Supplicant package to use.
12829
12830 @item @code{dbus?} (default: @code{#t})
12831 Whether to listen for requests on D-Bus.
12832
12833 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/wpa_supplicant.pid"})
12834 Where to store the PID file.
12835
12836 @item @code{interface} (default: @code{#f})
12837 If this is set, it must specify the name of a network interface that
12838 WPA supplicant will control.
12839
12840 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{#f})
12841 Optional configuration file to use.
12842
12843 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @code{'()})
12844 List of additional command-line arguments to pass to the daemon.
12845 @end table
12846 @end deftp
12847
12848 @cindex iptables
12849 @defvr {Scheme Variable} iptables-service-type
12850 This is the service type to set up an iptables configuration. iptables is a
12851 packet filtering framework supported by the Linux kernel. This service
12852 supports configuring iptables for both IPv4 and IPv6. A simple example
12853 configuration rejecting all incoming connections except those to the ssh port
12854 22 is shown below.
12855
12856 @lisp
12857 (service iptables-service-type
12858 (iptables-configuration
12859 (ipv4-rules (plain-file "iptables.rules" "*filter
12860 :INPUT ACCEPT
12861 :FORWARD ACCEPT
12862 :OUTPUT ACCEPT
12863 -A INPUT -p tcp --dport 22 -j ACCEPT
12864 -A INPUT -j REJECT --reject-with icmp-port-unreachable
12865 COMMIT
12866 "))
12867 (ipv6-rules (plain-file "ip6tables.rules" "*filter
12868 :INPUT ACCEPT
12869 :FORWARD ACCEPT
12870 :OUTPUT ACCEPT
12871 -A INPUT -p tcp --dport 22 -j ACCEPT
12872 -A INPUT -j REJECT --reject-with icmp6-port-unreachable
12873 COMMIT
12874 "))))
12875 @end lisp
12876 @end defvr
12877
12878 @deftp {Data Type} iptables-configuration
12879 The data type representing the configuration of iptables.
12880
12881 @table @asis
12882 @item @code{iptables} (default: @code{iptables})
12883 The iptables package that provides @code{iptables-restore} and
12884 @code{ip6tables-restore}.
12885 @item @code{ipv4-rules} (default: @code{%iptables-accept-all-rules})
12886 The iptables rules to use. It will be passed to @code{iptables-restore}.
12887 This may be any ``file-like'' object (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like
12888 objects}).
12889 @item @code{ipv6-rules} (default: @code{%iptables-accept-all-rules})
12890 The ip6tables rules to use. It will be passed to @code{ip6tables-restore}.
12891 This may be any ``file-like'' object (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like
12892 objects}).
12893 @end table
12894 @end deftp
12895
12896 @cindex NTP (Network Time Protocol), service
12897 @cindex real time clock
12898 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ntp-service-type
12899 This is the type of the service running the @uref{http://www.ntp.org,
12900 Network Time Protocol (NTP)} daemon, @command{ntpd}. The daemon will keep the
12901 system clock synchronized with that of the specified NTP servers.
12902
12903 The value of this service is an @code{ntpd-configuration} object, as described
12904 below.
12905 @end defvr
12906
12907 @deftp {Data Type} ntp-configuration
12908 This is the data type for the NTP service configuration.
12909
12910 @table @asis
12911 @item @code{servers} (default: @code{%ntp-servers})
12912 This is the list of servers (host names) with which @command{ntpd} will be
12913 synchronized.
12914
12915 @item @code{allow-large-adjustment?} (default: @code{#f})
12916 This determines whether @command{ntpd} is allowed to make an initial
12917 adjustment of more than 1,000 seconds.
12918
12919 @item @code{ntp} (default: @code{ntp})
12920 The NTP package to use.
12921 @end table
12922 @end deftp
12923
12924 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %ntp-servers
12925 List of host names used as the default NTP servers. These are servers of the
12926 @uref{https://www.ntppool.org/en/, NTP Pool Project}.
12927 @end defvr
12928
12929 @cindex OpenNTPD
12930 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} openntpd-service-type
12931 Run the @command{ntpd}, the Network Time Protocol (NTP) daemon, as implemented
12932 by @uref{http://www.openntpd.org, OpenNTPD}. The daemon will keep the system
12933 clock synchronized with that of the given servers.
12934
12935 @example
12936 (service
12937 openntpd-service-type
12938 (openntpd-configuration
12939 (listen-on '("127.0.0.1" "::1"))
12940 (sensor '("udcf0 correction 70000"))
12941 (constraint-from '("www.gnu.org"))
12942 (constraints-from '("https://www.google.com/"))
12943 (allow-large-adjustment? #t)))
12944
12945 @end example
12946 @end deffn
12947
12948 @deftp {Data Type} openntpd-configuration
12949 @table @asis
12950 @item @code{openntpd} (default: @code{(file-append openntpd "/sbin/ntpd")})
12951 The openntpd executable to use.
12952 @item @code{listen-on} (default: @code{'("127.0.0.1" "::1")})
12953 A list of local IP addresses or hostnames the ntpd daemon should listen on.
12954 @item @code{query-from} (default: @code{'()})
12955 A list of local IP address the ntpd daemon should use for outgoing queries.
12956 @item @code{sensor} (default: @code{'()})
12957 Specify a list of timedelta sensor devices ntpd should use. @code{ntpd}
12958 will listen to each sensor that actually exists and ignore non-existent ones.
12959 See @uref{https://man.openbsd.org/ntpd.conf, upstream documentation} for more
12960 information.
12961 @item @code{server} (default: @var{%ntp-servers})
12962 Specify a list of IP addresses or hostnames of NTP servers to synchronize to.
12963 @item @code{servers} (default: @code{'()})
12964 Specify a list of IP addresses or hostnames of NTP pools to synchronize to.
12965 @item @code{constraint-from} (default: @code{'()})
12966 @code{ntpd} can be configured to query the ‘Date’ from trusted HTTPS servers via TLS.
12967 This time information is not used for precision but acts as an authenticated
12968 constraint, thereby reducing the impact of unauthenticated NTP
12969 man-in-the-middle attacks.
12970 Specify a list of URLs, IP addresses or hostnames of HTTPS servers to provide
12971 a constraint.
12972 @item @code{constraints-from} (default: @code{'()})
12973 As with constraint from, specify a list of URLs, IP addresses or hostnames of
12974 HTTPS servers to provide a constraint. Should the hostname resolve to multiple
12975 IP addresses, @code{ntpd} will calculate a median constraint from all of them.
12976 @item @code{allow-large-adjustment?} (default: @code{#f})
12977 Determines if @code{ntpd} is allowed to make an initial adjustment of more
12978 than 180 seconds.
12979 @end table
12980 @end deftp
12981
12982 @cindex inetd
12983 @deffn {Scheme variable} inetd-service-type
12984 This service runs the @command{inetd} (@pxref{inetd invocation,,,
12985 inetutils, GNU Inetutils}) daemon. @command{inetd} listens for
12986 connections on internet sockets, and lazily starts the specified server
12987 program when a connection is made on one of these sockets.
12988
12989 The value of this service is an @code{inetd-configuration} object. The
12990 following example configures the @command{inetd} daemon to provide the
12991 built-in @command{echo} service, as well as an smtp service which
12992 forwards smtp traffic over ssh to a server @code{smtp-server} behind a
12993 gateway @code{hostname}:
12994
12995 @example
12996 (service
12997 inetd-service-type
12998 (inetd-configuration
12999 (entries (list
13000 (inetd-entry
13001 (name "echo")
13002 (socket-type 'stream)
13003 (protocol "tcp")
13004 (wait? #f)
13005 (user "root"))
13006 (inetd-entry
13007 (node "127.0.0.1")
13008 (name "smtp")
13009 (socket-type 'stream)
13010 (protocol "tcp")
13011 (wait? #f)
13012 (user "root")
13013 (program (file-append openssh "/bin/ssh"))
13014 (arguments
13015 '("ssh" "-qT" "-i" "/path/to/ssh_key"
13016 "-W" "smtp-server:25" "user@@hostname")))))
13017 @end example
13018
13019 See below for more details about @code{inetd-configuration}.
13020 @end deffn
13021
13022 @deftp {Data Type} inetd-configuration
13023 Data type representing the configuration of @command{inetd}.
13024
13025 @table @asis
13026 @item @code{program} (default: @code{(file-append inetutils "/libexec/inetd")})
13027 The @command{inetd} executable to use.
13028
13029 @item @code{entries} (default: @code{'()})
13030 A list of @command{inetd} service entries. Each entry should be created
13031 by the @code{inetd-entry} constructor.
13032 @end table
13033 @end deftp
13034
13035 @deftp {Data Type} inetd-entry
13036 Data type representing an entry in the @command{inetd} configuration.
13037 Each entry corresponds to a socket where @command{inetd} will listen for
13038 requests.
13039
13040 @table @asis
13041 @item @code{node} (default: @code{#f})
13042 Optional string, a comma-separated list of local addresses
13043 @command{inetd} should use when listening for this service.
13044 @xref{Configuration file,,, inetutils, GNU Inetutils} for a complete
13045 description of all options.
13046 @item @code{name}
13047 A string, the name must correspond to an entry in @code{/etc/services}.
13048 @item @code{socket-type}
13049 One of @code{'stream}, @code{'dgram}, @code{'raw}, @code{'rdm} or
13050 @code{'seqpacket}.
13051 @item @code{protocol}
13052 A string, must correspond to an entry in @code{/etc/protocols}.
13053 @item @code{wait?} (default: @code{#t})
13054 Whether @command{inetd} should wait for the server to exit before
13055 listening to new service requests.
13056 @item @code{user}
13057 A string containing the user (and, optionally, group) name of the user
13058 as whom the server should run. The group name can be specified in a
13059 suffix, separated by a colon or period, i.e.@: @code{"user"},
13060 @code{"user:group"} or @code{"user.group"}.
13061 @item @code{program} (default: @code{"internal"})
13062 The server program which will serve the requests, or @code{"internal"}
13063 if @command{inetd} should use a built-in service.
13064 @item @code{arguments} (default: @code{'()})
13065 A list strings or file-like objects, which are the server program's
13066 arguments, starting with the zeroth argument, i.e.@: the name of the
13067 program itself. For @command{inetd}'s internal services, this entry
13068 must be @code{'()} or @code{'("internal")}.
13069 @end table
13070
13071 @xref{Configuration file,,, inetutils, GNU Inetutils} for a more
13072 detailed discussion of each configuration field.
13073 @end deftp
13074
13075 @cindex Tor
13076 @defvr {Scheme Variable} tor-service-type
13077 This is the type for a service that runs the @uref{https://torproject.org,
13078 Tor} anonymous networking daemon. The service is configured using a
13079 @code{<tor-configuration>} record. By default, the Tor daemon runs as the
13080 @code{tor} unprivileged user, which is a member of the @code{tor} group.
13081
13082 @end defvr
13083
13084 @deftp {Data Type} tor-configuration
13085 @table @asis
13086 @item @code{tor} (default: @code{tor})
13087 The package that provides the Tor daemon. This package is expected to provide
13088 the daemon at @file{bin/tor} relative to its output directory. The default
13089 package is the @uref{https://www.torproject.org, Tor Project's}
13090 implementation.
13091
13092 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{(plain-file "empty" "")})
13093 The configuration file to use. It will be appended to a default configuration
13094 file, and the final configuration file will be passed to @code{tor} via its
13095 @code{-f} option. This may be any ``file-like'' object (@pxref{G-Expressions,
13096 file-like objects}). See @code{man tor} for details on the configuration file
13097 syntax.
13098
13099 @item @code{hidden-services} (default: @code{'()})
13100 The list of @code{<hidden-service>} records to use. For any hidden service
13101 you include in this list, appropriate configuration to enable the hidden
13102 service will be automatically added to the default configuration file. You
13103 may conveniently create @code{<hidden-service>} records using the
13104 @code{tor-hidden-service} procedure described below.
13105
13106 @item @code{socks-socket-type} (default: @code{'tcp})
13107 The default socket type that Tor should use for its SOCKS socket. This must
13108 be either @code{'tcp} or @code{'unix}. If it is @code{'tcp}, then by default
13109 Tor will listen on TCP port 9050 on the loopback interface (i.e., localhost).
13110 If it is @code{'unix}, then Tor will listen on the UNIX domain socket
13111 @file{/var/run/tor/socks-sock}, which will be made writable by members of the
13112 @code{tor} group.
13113
13114 If you want to customize the SOCKS socket in more detail, leave
13115 @code{socks-socket-type} at its default value of @code{'tcp} and use
13116 @code{config-file} to override the default by providing your own
13117 @code{SocksPort} option.
13118 @end table
13119 @end deftp
13120
13121 @cindex hidden service
13122 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} tor-hidden-service @var{name} @var{mapping}
13123 Define a new Tor @dfn{hidden service} called @var{name} and implementing
13124 @var{mapping}. @var{mapping} is a list of port/host tuples, such as:
13125
13126 @example
13127 '((22 "127.0.0.1:22")
13128 (80 "127.0.0.1:8080"))
13129 @end example
13130
13131 In this example, port 22 of the hidden service is mapped to local port 22, and
13132 port 80 is mapped to local port 8080.
13133
13134 This creates a @file{/var/lib/tor/hidden-services/@var{name}} directory, where
13135 the @file{hostname} file contains the @code{.onion} host name for the hidden
13136 service.
13137
13138 See @uref{https://www.torproject.org/docs/tor-hidden-service.html.en, the Tor
13139 project's documentation} for more information.
13140 @end deffn
13141
13142 The @code{(gnu services rsync)} module provides the following services:
13143
13144 You might want an rsync daemon if you have files that you want available
13145 so anyone (or just yourself) can download existing files or upload new
13146 files.
13147
13148 @deffn {Scheme Variable} rsync-service-type
13149 This is the service type for the @uref{https://rsync.samba.org, rsync} daemon,
13150 The value for this service type is a
13151 @command{rsync-configuration} record as in this example:
13152
13153 @example
13154 (service rsync-service-type)
13155 @end example
13156
13157 See below for details about @code{rsync-configuration}.
13158 @end deffn
13159
13160 @deftp {Data Type} rsync-configuration
13161 Data type representing the configuration for @code{rsync-service}.
13162
13163 @table @asis
13164 @item @code{package} (default: @var{rsync})
13165 @code{rsync} package to use.
13166
13167 @item @code{port-number} (default: @code{873})
13168 TCP port on which @command{rsync} listens for incoming connections. If port
13169 is less than @code{1024} @command{rsync} needs to be started as the
13170 @code{root} user and group.
13171
13172 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/rsyncd/rsyncd.pid"})
13173 Name of the file where @command{rsync} writes its PID.
13174
13175 @item @code{lock-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/rsyncd/rsyncd.lock"})
13176 Name of the file where @command{rsync} writes its lock file.
13177
13178 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{"/var/log/rsyncd.log"})
13179 Name of the file where @command{rsync} writes its log file.
13180
13181 @item @code{use-chroot?} (default: @var{#t})
13182 Whether to use chroot for @command{rsync} shared directory.
13183
13184 @item @code{share-path} (default: @file{/srv/rsync})
13185 Location of the @command{rsync} shared directory.
13186
13187 @item @code{share-comment} (default: @code{"Rsync share"})
13188 Comment of the @command{rsync} shared directory.
13189
13190 @item @code{read-only?} (default: @var{#f})
13191 Read-write permissions to shared directory.
13192
13193 @item @code{timeout} (default: @code{300})
13194 I/O timeout in seconds.
13195
13196 @item @code{user} (default: @var{"root"})
13197 Owner of the @code{rsync} process.
13198
13199 @item @code{group} (default: @var{"root"})
13200 Group of the @code{rsync} process.
13201
13202 @item @code{uid} (default: @var{"rsyncd"})
13203 User name or user ID that file transfers to and from that module should take
13204 place as when the daemon was run as @code{root}.
13205
13206 @item @code{gid} (default: @var{"rsyncd"})
13207 Group name or group ID that will be used when accessing the module.
13208
13209 @end table
13210 @end deftp
13211
13212 Furthermore, @code{(gnu services ssh)} provides the following services.
13213 @cindex SSH
13214 @cindex SSH server
13215
13216 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} lsh-service [#:host-key "/etc/lsh/host-key"] @
13217 [#:daemonic? #t] [#:interfaces '()] [#:port-number 22] @
13218 [#:allow-empty-passwords? #f] [#:root-login? #f] @
13219 [#:syslog-output? #t] [#:x11-forwarding? #t] @
13220 [#:tcp/ip-forwarding? #t] [#:password-authentication? #t] @
13221 [#:public-key-authentication? #t] [#:initialize? #t]
13222 Run the @command{lshd} program from @var{lsh} to listen on port @var{port-number}.
13223 @var{host-key} must designate a file containing the host key, and readable
13224 only by root.
13225
13226 When @var{daemonic?} is true, @command{lshd} will detach from the
13227 controlling terminal and log its output to syslogd, unless one sets
13228 @var{syslog-output?} to false. Obviously, it also makes lsh-service
13229 depend on existence of syslogd service. When @var{pid-file?} is true,
13230 @command{lshd} writes its PID to the file called @var{pid-file}.
13231
13232 When @var{initialize?} is true, automatically create the seed and host key
13233 upon service activation if they do not exist yet. This may take long and
13234 require interaction.
13235
13236 When @var{initialize?} is false, it is up to the user to initialize the
13237 randomness generator (@pxref{lsh-make-seed,,, lsh, LSH Manual}), and to create
13238 a key pair with the private key stored in file @var{host-key} (@pxref{lshd
13239 basics,,, lsh, LSH Manual}).
13240
13241 When @var{interfaces} is empty, lshd listens for connections on all the
13242 network interfaces; otherwise, @var{interfaces} must be a list of host names
13243 or addresses.
13244
13245 @var{allow-empty-passwords?} specifies whether to accept log-ins with empty
13246 passwords, and @var{root-login?} specifies whether to accept log-ins as
13247 root.
13248
13249 The other options should be self-descriptive.
13250 @end deffn
13251
13252 @cindex SSH
13253 @cindex SSH server
13254 @deffn {Scheme Variable} openssh-service-type
13255 This is the type for the @uref{http://www.openssh.org, OpenSSH} secure
13256 shell daemon, @command{sshd}. Its value must be an
13257 @code{openssh-configuration} record as in this example:
13258
13259 @example
13260 (service openssh-service-type
13261 (openssh-configuration
13262 (x11-forwarding? #t)
13263 (permit-root-login 'without-password)
13264 (authorized-keys
13265 `(("alice" ,(local-file "alice.pub"))
13266 ("bob" ,(local-file "bob.pub"))))))
13267 @end example
13268
13269 See below for details about @code{openssh-configuration}.
13270
13271 This service can be extended with extra authorized keys, as in this
13272 example:
13273
13274 @example
13275 (service-extension openssh-service-type
13276 (const `(("charlie"
13277 ,(local-file "charlie.pub")))))
13278 @end example
13279 @end deffn
13280
13281 @deftp {Data Type} openssh-configuration
13282 This is the configuration record for OpenSSH's @command{sshd}.
13283
13284 @table @asis
13285 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/sshd.pid"})
13286 Name of the file where @command{sshd} writes its PID.
13287
13288 @item @code{port-number} (default: @code{22})
13289 TCP port on which @command{sshd} listens for incoming connections.
13290
13291 @item @code{permit-root-login} (default: @code{#f})
13292 This field determines whether and when to allow logins as root. If
13293 @code{#f}, root logins are disallowed; if @code{#t}, they are allowed.
13294 If it's the symbol @code{'without-password}, then root logins are
13295 permitted but not with password-based authentication.
13296
13297 @item @code{allow-empty-passwords?} (default: @code{#f})
13298 When true, users with empty passwords may log in. When false, they may
13299 not.
13300
13301 @item @code{password-authentication?} (default: @code{#t})
13302 When true, users may log in with their password. When false, they have
13303 other authentication methods.
13304
13305 @item @code{public-key-authentication?} (default: @code{#t})
13306 When true, users may log in using public key authentication. When
13307 false, users have to use other authentication method.
13308
13309 Authorized public keys are stored in @file{~/.ssh/authorized_keys}.
13310 This is used only by protocol version 2.
13311
13312 @item @code{x11-forwarding?} (default: @code{#f})
13313 When true, forwarding of X11 graphical client connections is
13314 enabled---in other words, @command{ssh} options @option{-X} and
13315 @option{-Y} will work.
13316
13317 @item @code{allow-agent-forwarding?} (default: @code{#t})
13318 Whether to allow agent forwarding.
13319
13320 @item @code{allow-tcp-forwarding?} (default: @code{#t})
13321 Whether to allow TCP forwarding.
13322
13323 @item @code{gateway-ports?} (default: @code{#f})
13324 Whether to allow gateway ports.
13325
13326 @item @code{challenge-response-authentication?} (default: @code{#f})
13327 Specifies whether challenge response authentication is allowed (e.g.@: via
13328 PAM).
13329
13330 @item @code{use-pam?} (default: @code{#t})
13331 Enables the Pluggable Authentication Module interface. If set to
13332 @code{#t}, this will enable PAM authentication using
13333 @code{challenge-response-authentication?} and
13334 @code{password-authentication?}, in addition to PAM account and session
13335 module processing for all authentication types.
13336
13337 Because PAM challenge response authentication usually serves an
13338 equivalent role to password authentication, you should disable either
13339 @code{challenge-response-authentication?} or
13340 @code{password-authentication?}.
13341
13342 @item @code{print-last-log?} (default: @code{#t})
13343 Specifies whether @command{sshd} should print the date and time of the
13344 last user login when a user logs in interactively.
13345
13346 @item @code{subsystems} (default: @code{'(("sftp" "internal-sftp"))})
13347 Configures external subsystems (e.g.@: file transfer daemon).
13348
13349 This is a list of two-element lists, each of which containing the
13350 subsystem name and a command (with optional arguments) to execute upon
13351 subsystem request.
13352
13353 The command @command{internal-sftp} implements an in-process SFTP
13354 server. Alternately, one can specify the @command{sftp-server} command:
13355 @example
13356 (service openssh-service-type
13357 (openssh-configuration
13358 (subsystems
13359 `(("sftp" ,(file-append openssh "/libexec/sftp-server"))))))
13360 @end example
13361
13362 @item @code{accepted-environment} (default: @code{'()})
13363 List of strings describing which environment variables may be exported.
13364
13365 Each string gets on its own line. See the @code{AcceptEnv} option in
13366 @code{man sshd_config}.
13367
13368 This example allows ssh-clients to export the @code{COLORTERM} variable.
13369 It is set by terminal emulators, which support colors. You can use it in
13370 your shell's ressource file to enable colors for the prompt and commands
13371 if this variable is set.
13372
13373 @example
13374 (service openssh-service-type
13375 (openssh-configuration
13376 (accepted-environment '("COLORTERM"))))
13377 @end example
13378
13379 @item @code{authorized-keys} (default: @code{'()})
13380 @cindex authorized keys, SSH
13381 @cindex SSH authorized keys
13382 This is the list of authorized keys. Each element of the list is a user
13383 name followed by one or more file-like objects that represent SSH public
13384 keys. For example:
13385
13386 @example
13387 (openssh-configuration
13388 (authorized-keys
13389 `(("rekado" ,(local-file "rekado.pub"))
13390 ("chris" ,(local-file "chris.pub"))
13391 ("root" ,(local-file "rekado.pub") ,(local-file "chris.pub")))))
13392 @end example
13393
13394 @noindent
13395 registers the specified public keys for user accounts @code{rekado},
13396 @code{chris}, and @code{root}.
13397
13398 Additional authorized keys can be specified @i{via}
13399 @code{service-extension}.
13400
13401 Note that this does @emph{not} interfere with the use of
13402 @file{~/.ssh/authorized_keys}.
13403
13404 @item @code{log-level} (default: @code{'info})
13405 This is a symbol specifying the logging level: @code{quiet}, @code{fatal},
13406 @code{error}, @code{info}, @code{verbose}, @code{debug}, etc. See the man
13407 page for @file{sshd_config} for the full list of level names.
13408
13409 @item @code{extra-content} (default: @code{""})
13410 This field can be used to append arbitrary text to the configuration file. It
13411 is especially useful for elaborate configurations that cannot be expressed
13412 otherwise. This configuration, for example, would generally disable root
13413 logins, but permit them from one specific IP address:
13414
13415 @example
13416 (openssh-configuration
13417 (extra-content "\
13418 Match Address 192.168.0.1
13419 PermitRootLogin yes"))
13420 @end example
13421
13422 @end table
13423 @end deftp
13424
13425 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} dropbear-service [@var{config}]
13426 Run the @uref{https://matt.ucc.asn.au/dropbear/dropbear.html,Dropbear SSH
13427 daemon} with the given @var{config}, a @code{<dropbear-configuration>}
13428 object.
13429
13430 For example, to specify a Dropbear service listening on port 1234, add
13431 this call to the operating system's @code{services} field:
13432
13433 @example
13434 (dropbear-service (dropbear-configuration
13435 (port-number 1234)))
13436 @end example
13437 @end deffn
13438
13439 @deftp {Data Type} dropbear-configuration
13440 This data type represents the configuration of a Dropbear SSH daemon.
13441
13442 @table @asis
13443 @item @code{dropbear} (default: @var{dropbear})
13444 The Dropbear package to use.
13445
13446 @item @code{port-number} (default: 22)
13447 The TCP port where the daemon waits for incoming connections.
13448
13449 @item @code{syslog-output?} (default: @code{#t})
13450 Whether to enable syslog output.
13451
13452 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/dropbear.pid"})
13453 File name of the daemon's PID file.
13454
13455 @item @code{root-login?} (default: @code{#f})
13456 Whether to allow @code{root} logins.
13457
13458 @item @code{allow-empty-passwords?} (default: @code{#f})
13459 Whether to allow empty passwords.
13460
13461 @item @code{password-authentication?} (default: @code{#t})
13462 Whether to enable password-based authentication.
13463 @end table
13464 @end deftp
13465
13466 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %facebook-host-aliases
13467 This variable contains a string for use in @file{/etc/hosts}
13468 (@pxref{Host Names,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}). Each
13469 line contains a entry that maps a known server name of the Facebook
13470 on-line service---e.g., @code{www.facebook.com}---to the local
13471 host---@code{127.0.0.1} or its IPv6 equivalent, @code{::1}.
13472
13473 This variable is typically used in the @code{hosts-file} field of an
13474 @code{operating-system} declaration (@pxref{operating-system Reference,
13475 @file{/etc/hosts}}):
13476
13477 @example
13478 (use-modules (gnu) (guix))
13479
13480 (operating-system
13481 (host-name "mymachine")
13482 ;; ...
13483 (hosts-file
13484 ;; Create a /etc/hosts file with aliases for "localhost"
13485 ;; and "mymachine", as well as for Facebook servers.
13486 (plain-file "hosts"
13487 (string-append (local-host-aliases host-name)
13488 %facebook-host-aliases))))
13489 @end example
13490
13491 This mechanism can prevent programs running locally, such as Web
13492 browsers, from accessing Facebook.
13493 @end defvr
13494
13495 The @code{(gnu services avahi)} provides the following definition.
13496
13497 @defvr {Scheme Variable} avahi-service-type
13498 This is the service that runs @command{avahi-daemon}, a system-wide
13499 mDNS/DNS-SD responder that allows for service discovery and
13500 ``zero-configuration'' host name lookups (see @uref{https://avahi.org/}).
13501 Its value must be a @code{zero-configuration} record---see below.
13502
13503 This service extends the name service cache daemon (nscd) so that it can
13504 resolve @code{.local} host names using
13505 @uref{http://0pointer.de/lennart/projects/nss-mdns/, nss-mdns}. @xref{Name
13506 Service Switch}, for information on host name resolution.
13507
13508 Additionally, add the @var{avahi} package to the system profile so that
13509 commands such as @command{avahi-browse} are directly usable.
13510 @end defvr
13511
13512 @deftp {Data Type} avahi-configuration
13513 Data type representation the configuration for Avahi.
13514
13515 @table @asis
13516
13517 @item @code{host-name} (default: @code{#f})
13518 If different from @code{#f}, use that as the host name to
13519 publish for this machine; otherwise, use the machine's actual host name.
13520
13521 @item @code{publish?} (default: @code{#t})
13522 When true, allow host names and services to be published (broadcast) over the
13523 network.
13524
13525 @item @code{publish-workstation?} (default: @code{#t})
13526 When true, @command{avahi-daemon} publishes the machine's host name and IP
13527 address via mDNS on the local network. To view the host names published on
13528 your local network, you can run:
13529
13530 @example
13531 avahi-browse _workstation._tcp
13532 @end example
13533
13534 @item @code{wide-area?} (default: @code{#f})
13535 When true, DNS-SD over unicast DNS is enabled.
13536
13537 @item @code{ipv4?} (default: @code{#t})
13538 @itemx @code{ipv6?} (default: @code{#t})
13539 These fields determine whether to use IPv4/IPv6 sockets.
13540
13541 @item @code{domains-to-browse} (default: @code{'()})
13542 This is a list of domains to browse.
13543 @end table
13544 @end deftp
13545
13546 @deffn {Scheme Variable} openvswitch-service-type
13547 This is the type of the @uref{https://www.openvswitch.org, Open vSwitch}
13548 service, whose value should be an @code{openvswitch-configuration}
13549 object.
13550 @end deffn
13551
13552 @deftp {Data Type} openvswitch-configuration
13553 Data type representing the configuration of Open vSwitch, a multilayer
13554 virtual switch which is designed to enable massive network automation
13555 through programmatic extension.
13556
13557 @table @asis
13558 @item @code{package} (default: @var{openvswitch})
13559 Package object of the Open vSwitch.
13560
13561 @end table
13562 @end deftp
13563
13564 @node X Window
13565 @subsection X Window
13566
13567 @cindex X11
13568 @cindex X Window System
13569 @cindex login manager
13570 Support for the X Window graphical display system---specifically
13571 Xorg---is provided by the @code{(gnu services xorg)} module. Note that
13572 there is no @code{xorg-service} procedure. Instead, the X server is
13573 started by the @dfn{login manager}, by default the GNOME Display Manager (GDM).
13574
13575 @cindex GDM
13576 @cindex GNOME, login manager
13577 GDM of course allows users to log in into window managers and desktop
13578 environments other than GNOME; for those using GNOME, GDM is required for
13579 features such as automatic screen locking.
13580
13581 @cindex window manager
13582 To use X11, you must install at least one @dfn{window manager}---for
13583 example the @code{windowmaker} or @code{openbox} packages---preferably
13584 by adding it to the @code{packages} field of your operating system
13585 definition (@pxref{operating-system Reference, system-wide packages}).
13586
13587 @defvr {Scheme Variable} gdm-service-type
13588 This is the type for the @uref{https://wiki.gnome.org/Projects/GDM/, GNOME
13589 Desktop Manager} (GDM), a program that manages graphical display servers and
13590 handles graphical user logins. Its value must be a @code{gdm-configuration}
13591 (see below.)
13592
13593 @cindex session types (X11)
13594 @cindex X11 session types
13595 GDM looks for @dfn{session types} described by the @file{.desktop} files in
13596 @file{/run/current-system/profile/share/xsessions} and allows users to choose
13597 a session from the log-in screen. Packages such as @code{gnome}, @code{xfce},
13598 and @code{i3} provide @file{.desktop} files; adding them to the system-wide
13599 set of packages automatically makes them available at the log-in screen.
13600
13601 In addition, @file{~/.xsession} files are honored. When available,
13602 @file{~/.xsession} must be an executable that starts a window manager
13603 and/or other X clients.
13604 @end defvr
13605
13606 @deftp {Data Type} gdm-configuration
13607 @table @asis
13608 @item @code{auto-login?} (default: @code{#f})
13609 @itemx @code{default-user} (default: @code{#f})
13610 When @code{auto-login?} is false, GDM presents a log-in screen.
13611
13612 When @code{auto-login?} is true, GDM logs in directly as
13613 @code{default-user}.
13614
13615 @item @code{gnome-shell-assets} (default: ...)
13616 List of GNOME Shell assets needed by GDM: icon theme, fonts, etc.
13617
13618 @item @code{xorg-configuration} (default: @code{(xorg-configuration)})
13619 Configuration of the Xorg graphical server.
13620
13621 @item @code{xsession} (default: @code{(xinitrc)})
13622 Script to run before starting a X session.
13623
13624 @item @code{dbus-daemon} (default: @code{dbus-daemon-wrapper})
13625 File name of the @code{dbus-daemon} executable.
13626
13627 @item @code{gdm} (default: @code{gdm})
13628 The GDM package to use.
13629 @end table
13630 @end deftp
13631
13632 @defvr {Scheme Variable} slim-service-type
13633 This is the type for the SLiM graphical login manager for X11.
13634
13635 Like GDM, SLiM looks for session types described by @file{.desktop} files and
13636 allows users to choose a session from the log-in screen using @kbd{F1}. It
13637 also honors @file{~/.xsession} files.
13638
13639 Unlike GDM, SLiM does not spawn the user session on a different VT after
13640 logging in, which means that you can only start one graphical session. If you
13641 want to be able to run multiple graphical sessions at the same time you have
13642 to add multiple SLiM services to your system services. The following example
13643 shows how to replace the default GDM service with two SLiM services on tty7
13644 and tty8.
13645
13646 @lisp
13647 (use-modules (gnu services)
13648 (gnu services desktop)
13649 (gnu services xorg)
13650 (srfi srfi-1)) ;for 'remove'
13651
13652 (operating-system
13653 ;; ...
13654 (services (cons* (service slim-service-type (slim-configuration
13655 (display ":0")
13656 (vt "vt7")))
13657 (service slim-service-type (slim-configuration
13658 (display ":1")
13659 (vt "vt8")))
13660 (remove (lambda (service)
13661 (eq? (service-kind service) gdm-service-type))
13662 %desktop-services))))
13663 @end lisp
13664
13665 @end defvr
13666
13667 @deftp {Data Type} slim-configuration
13668 Data type representing the configuration of @code{slim-service-type}.
13669
13670 @table @asis
13671 @item @code{allow-empty-passwords?} (default: @code{#t})
13672 Whether to allow logins with empty passwords.
13673
13674 @item @code{auto-login?} (default: @code{#f})
13675 @itemx @code{default-user} (default: @code{""})
13676 When @code{auto-login?} is false, SLiM presents a log-in screen.
13677
13678 When @code{auto-login?} is true, SLiM logs in directly as
13679 @code{default-user}.
13680
13681 @item @code{theme} (default: @code{%default-slim-theme})
13682 @itemx @code{theme-name} (default: @code{%default-slim-theme-name})
13683 The graphical theme to use and its name.
13684
13685 @item @code{auto-login-session} (default: @code{#f})
13686 If true, this must be the name of the executable to start as the default
13687 session---e.g., @code{(file-append windowmaker "/bin/windowmaker")}.
13688
13689 If false, a session described by one of the available @file{.desktop}
13690 files in @code{/run/current-system/profile} and @code{~/.guix-profile}
13691 will be used.
13692
13693 @quotation Note
13694 You must install at least one window manager in the system profile or in
13695 your user profile. Failing to do that, if @code{auto-login-session} is
13696 false, you will be unable to log in.
13697 @end quotation
13698
13699 @item @code{xorg-configuration} (default @code{(xorg-configuration)})
13700 Configuration of the Xorg graphical server.
13701
13702 @item @code{display} (default @code{":0"})
13703 The display on which to start the Xorg graphical server.
13704
13705 @item @code{vt} (default @code{"vt7"})
13706 The VT on which to start the Xorg graphical server.
13707
13708 @item @code{xauth} (default: @code{xauth})
13709 The XAuth package to use.
13710
13711 @item @code{shepherd} (default: @code{shepherd})
13712 The Shepherd package used when invoking @command{halt} and
13713 @command{reboot}.
13714
13715 @item @code{sessreg} (default: @code{sessreg})
13716 The sessreg package used in order to register the session.
13717
13718 @item @code{slim} (default: @code{slim})
13719 The SLiM package to use.
13720 @end table
13721 @end deftp
13722
13723 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-theme
13724 @defvrx {Scheme Variable} %default-theme-name
13725 The default SLiM theme and its name.
13726 @end defvr
13727
13728
13729 @deftp {Data Type} sddm-configuration
13730 This is the data type representing the sddm service configuration.
13731
13732 @table @asis
13733 @item @code{display-server} (default: "x11")
13734 Select display server to use for the greeter. Valid values are "x11"
13735 or "wayland".
13736
13737 @item @code{numlock} (default: "on")
13738 Valid values are "on", "off" or "none".
13739
13740 @item @code{halt-command} (default @code{#~(string-apppend #$shepherd "/sbin/halt")})
13741 Command to run when halting.
13742
13743 @item @code{reboot-command} (default @code{#~(string-append #$shepherd "/sbin/reboot")})
13744 Command to run when rebooting.
13745
13746 @item @code{theme} (default "maldives")
13747 Theme to use. Default themes provided by SDDM are "elarun" or "maldives".
13748
13749 @item @code{themes-directory} (default "/run/current-system/profile/share/sddm/themes")
13750 Directory to look for themes.
13751
13752 @item @code{faces-directory} (default "/run/current-system/profile/share/sddm/faces")
13753 Directory to look for faces.
13754
13755 @item @code{default-path} (default "/run/current-system/profile/bin")
13756 Default PATH to use.
13757
13758 @item @code{minimum-uid} (default: 1000)
13759 Minimum UID displayed in SDDM and allowed for log-in.
13760
13761 @item @code{maximum-uid} (default: 2000)
13762 Maximum UID to display in SDDM.
13763
13764 @item @code{remember-last-user?} (default #t)
13765 Remember last user.
13766
13767 @item @code{remember-last-session?} (default #t)
13768 Remember last session.
13769
13770 @item @code{hide-users} (default "")
13771 Usernames to hide from SDDM greeter.
13772
13773 @item @code{hide-shells} (default @code{#~(string-append #$shadow "/sbin/nologin")})
13774 Users with shells listed will be hidden from the SDDM greeter.
13775
13776 @item @code{session-command} (default @code{#~(string-append #$sddm "/share/sddm/scripts/wayland-session")})
13777 Script to run before starting a wayland session.
13778
13779 @item @code{sessions-directory} (default "/run/current-system/profile/share/wayland-sessions")
13780 Directory to look for desktop files starting wayland sessions.
13781
13782 @item @code{xorg-configuration} (default @code{(xorg-configuration)})
13783 Configuration of the Xorg graphical server.
13784
13785 @item @code{xauth-path} (default @code{#~(string-append #$xauth "/bin/xauth")})
13786 Path to xauth.
13787
13788 @item @code{xephyr-path} (default @code{#~(string-append #$xorg-server "/bin/Xephyr")})
13789 Path to Xephyr.
13790
13791 @item @code{xdisplay-start} (default @code{#~(string-append #$sddm "/share/sddm/scripts/Xsetup")})
13792 Script to run after starting xorg-server.
13793
13794 @item @code{xdisplay-stop} (default @code{#~(string-append #$sddm "/share/sddm/scripts/Xstop")})
13795 Script to run before stopping xorg-server.
13796
13797 @item @code{xsession-command} (default: @code{xinitrc})
13798 Script to run before starting a X session.
13799
13800 @item @code{xsessions-directory} (default: "/run/current-system/profile/share/xsessions")
13801 Directory to look for desktop files starting X sessions.
13802
13803 @item @code{minimum-vt} (default: 7)
13804 Minimum VT to use.
13805
13806 @item @code{auto-login-user} (default "")
13807 User to use for auto-login.
13808
13809 @item @code{auto-login-session} (default "")
13810 Desktop file to use for auto-login.
13811
13812 @item @code{relogin?} (default #f)
13813 Relogin after logout.
13814
13815 @end table
13816 @end deftp
13817
13818 @cindex login manager
13819 @cindex X11 login
13820 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} sddm-service config
13821 Return a service that spawns the SDDM graphical login manager for config of
13822 type @code{<sddm-configuration>}.
13823
13824 @example
13825 (sddm-service (sddm-configuration
13826 (auto-login-user "Alice")
13827 (auto-login-session "xfce.desktop")))
13828 @end example
13829 @end deffn
13830
13831 @cindex Xorg, configuration
13832 @deftp {Data Type} xorg-configuration
13833 This data type represents the configuration of the Xorg graphical display
13834 server. Note that there is not Xorg service; instead, the X server is started
13835 by a ``display manager'' such as GDM, SDDM, and SLiM. Thus, the configuration
13836 of these display managers aggregates an @code{xorg-configuration} record.
13837
13838 @table @asis
13839 @item @code{modules} (default: @code{%default-xorg-modules})
13840 This is a list of @dfn{module packages} loaded by the Xorg
13841 server---e.g., @code{xf86-video-vesa}, @code{xf86-input-keyboard}, and so on.
13842
13843 @item @code{fonts} (default: @code{%default-xorg-fonts})
13844 This is a list of font directories to add to the server's @dfn{font path}.
13845
13846 @item @code{drivers} (default: @code{'()})
13847 This must be either the empty list, in which case Xorg chooses a graphics
13848 driver automatically, or a list of driver names that will be tried in this
13849 order---e.g., @code{("modesetting" "vesa")}.
13850
13851 @item @code{resolutions} (default: @code{'()})
13852 When @code{resolutions} is the empty list, Xorg chooses an appropriate screen
13853 resolution. Otherwise, it must be a list of resolutions---e.g., @code{((1024
13854 768) (640 480))}.
13855
13856 @cindex keyboard layout, for Xorg
13857 @cindex keymap, for Xorg
13858 @item @code{keyboard-layout} (default: @code{#f})
13859 If this is @code{#f}, Xorg uses the default keyboard layout---usually US
13860 English (``qwerty'') for a 105-key PC keyboard.
13861
13862 Otherwise this must be a @code{keyboard-layout} object specifying the keyboard
13863 layout in use when Xorg is running. @xref{Keyboard Layout}, for more
13864 information on how to specify the keyboard layout.
13865
13866 @item @code{extra-config} (default: @code{'()})
13867 This is a list of strings or objects appended to the configuration file. It
13868 is used to pass extra text to be added verbatim to the configuration file.
13869
13870 @item @code{server} (default: @code{xorg-server})
13871 This is the package providing the Xorg server.
13872
13873 @item @code{server-arguments} (default: @code{%default-xorg-server-arguments})
13874 This is the list of command-line arguments to pass to the X server. The
13875 default is @code{-nolisten tcp}.
13876 @end table
13877 @end deftp
13878
13879 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} set-xorg-configuration @var{config} @
13880 [@var{login-manager-service-type}]
13881 Tell the log-in manager (of type @var{login-manager-service-type}) to use
13882 @var{config}, an @code{<xorg-configuration>} record.
13883
13884 Since the Xorg configuration is embedded in the log-in manager's
13885 configuration---e.g., @code{gdm-configuration}---this procedure provides a
13886 shorthand to set the Xorg configuration.
13887 @end deffn
13888
13889 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} xorg-start-command [@var{config}]
13890 Return a @code{startx} script in which the modules, fonts, etc. specified
13891 in @var{config}, are available. The result should be used in place of
13892 @code{startx}.
13893
13894 Usually the X server is started by a login manager.
13895 @end deffn
13896
13897
13898 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} screen-locker-service @var{package} [@var{program}]
13899 Add @var{package}, a package for a screen locker or screen saver whose
13900 command is @var{program}, to the set of setuid programs and add a PAM entry
13901 for it. For example:
13902
13903 @lisp
13904 (screen-locker-service xlockmore "xlock")
13905 @end lisp
13906
13907 makes the good ol' XlockMore usable.
13908 @end deffn
13909
13910
13911 @node Printing Services
13912 @subsection Printing Services
13913
13914 @cindex printer support with CUPS
13915 The @code{(gnu services cups)} module provides a Guix service definition
13916 for the CUPS printing service. To add printer support to a Guix
13917 system, add a @code{cups-service} to the operating system definition:
13918
13919 @deffn {Scheme Variable} cups-service-type
13920 The service type for the CUPS print server. Its value should be a valid
13921 CUPS configuration (see below). To use the default settings, simply
13922 write:
13923 @example
13924 (service cups-service-type)
13925 @end example
13926 @end deffn
13927
13928 The CUPS configuration controls the basic things about your CUPS
13929 installation: what interfaces it listens on, what to do if a print job
13930 fails, how much logging to do, and so on. To actually add a printer,
13931 you have to visit the @url{http://localhost:631} URL, or use a tool such
13932 as GNOME's printer configuration services. By default, configuring a
13933 CUPS service will generate a self-signed certificate if needed, for
13934 secure connections to the print server.
13935
13936 Suppose you want to enable the Web interface of CUPS and also add
13937 support for Epson printers @i{via} the @code{escpr} package and for HP
13938 printers @i{via} the @code{hplip-minimal} package. You can do that directly,
13939 like this (you need to use the @code{(gnu packages cups)} module):
13940
13941 @example
13942 (service cups-service-type
13943 (cups-configuration
13944 (web-interface? #t)
13945 (extensions
13946 (list cups-filters escpr hplip-minimal))))
13947 @end example
13948
13949 Note: If you wish to use the Qt5 based GUI which comes with the hplip
13950 package then it is suggested that you install the @code{hplip} package,
13951 either in your OS configuration file or as your user.
13952
13953 The available configuration parameters follow. Each parameter
13954 definition is preceded by its type; for example, @samp{string-list foo}
13955 indicates that the @code{foo} parameter should be specified as a list of
13956 strings. There is also a way to specify the configuration as a string,
13957 if you have an old @code{cupsd.conf} file that you want to port over
13958 from some other system; see the end for more details.
13959
13960 @c The following documentation was initially generated by
13961 @c (generate-documentation) in (gnu services cups). Manually maintained
13962 @c documentation is better, so we shouldn't hesitate to edit below as
13963 @c needed. However if the change you want to make to this documentation
13964 @c can be done in an automated way, it's probably easier to change
13965 @c (generate-documentation) than to make it below and have to deal with
13966 @c the churn as CUPS updates.
13967
13968
13969 Available @code{cups-configuration} fields are:
13970
13971 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} package cups
13972 The CUPS package.
13973 @end deftypevr
13974
13975 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} package-list extensions
13976 Drivers and other extensions to the CUPS package.
13977 @end deftypevr
13978
13979 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} files-configuration files-configuration
13980 Configuration of where to write logs, what directories to use for print
13981 spools, and related privileged configuration parameters.
13982
13983 Available @code{files-configuration} fields are:
13984
13985 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} log-location access-log
13986 Defines the access log filename. Specifying a blank filename disables
13987 access log generation. The value @code{stderr} causes log entries to be
13988 sent to the standard error file when the scheduler is running in the
13989 foreground, or to the system log daemon when run in the background. The
13990 value @code{syslog} causes log entries to be sent to the system log
13991 daemon. The server name may be included in filenames using the string
13992 @code{%s}, as in @code{/var/log/cups/%s-access_log}.
13993
13994 Defaults to @samp{"/var/log/cups/access_log"}.
13995 @end deftypevr
13996
13997 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} file-name cache-dir
13998 Where CUPS should cache data.
13999
14000 Defaults to @samp{"/var/cache/cups"}.
14001 @end deftypevr
14002
14003 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string config-file-perm
14004 Specifies the permissions for all configuration files that the scheduler
14005 writes.
14006
14007 Note that the permissions for the printers.conf file are currently
14008 masked to only allow access from the scheduler user (typically root).
14009 This is done because printer device URIs sometimes contain sensitive
14010 authentication information that should not be generally known on the
14011 system. There is no way to disable this security feature.
14012
14013 Defaults to @samp{"0640"}.
14014 @end deftypevr
14015
14016 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} log-location error-log
14017 Defines the error log filename. Specifying a blank filename disables
14018 error log generation. The value @code{stderr} causes log entries to be
14019 sent to the standard error file when the scheduler is running in the
14020 foreground, or to the system log daemon when run in the background. The
14021 value @code{syslog} causes log entries to be sent to the system log
14022 daemon. The server name may be included in filenames using the string
14023 @code{%s}, as in @code{/var/log/cups/%s-error_log}.
14024
14025 Defaults to @samp{"/var/log/cups/error_log"}.
14026 @end deftypevr
14027
14028 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string fatal-errors
14029 Specifies which errors are fatal, causing the scheduler to exit. The
14030 kind strings are:
14031
14032 @table @code
14033 @item none
14034 No errors are fatal.
14035
14036 @item all
14037 All of the errors below are fatal.
14038
14039 @item browse
14040 Browsing initialization errors are fatal, for example failed connections
14041 to the DNS-SD daemon.
14042
14043 @item config
14044 Configuration file syntax errors are fatal.
14045
14046 @item listen
14047 Listen or Port errors are fatal, except for IPv6 failures on the
14048 loopback or @code{any} addresses.
14049
14050 @item log
14051 Log file creation or write errors are fatal.
14052
14053 @item permissions
14054 Bad startup file permissions are fatal, for example shared TLS
14055 certificate and key files with world-read permissions.
14056 @end table
14057
14058 Defaults to @samp{"all -browse"}.
14059 @end deftypevr
14060
14061 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} boolean file-device?
14062 Specifies whether the file pseudo-device can be used for new printer
14063 queues. The URI @uref{file:///dev/null} is always allowed.
14064
14065 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
14066 @end deftypevr
14067
14068 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string group
14069 Specifies the group name or ID that will be used when executing external
14070 programs.
14071
14072 Defaults to @samp{"lp"}.
14073 @end deftypevr
14074
14075 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string log-file-perm
14076 Specifies the permissions for all log files that the scheduler writes.
14077
14078 Defaults to @samp{"0644"}.
14079 @end deftypevr
14080
14081 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} log-location page-log
14082 Defines the page log filename. Specifying a blank filename disables
14083 page log generation. The value @code{stderr} causes log entries to be
14084 sent to the standard error file when the scheduler is running in the
14085 foreground, or to the system log daemon when run in the background. The
14086 value @code{syslog} causes log entries to be sent to the system log
14087 daemon. The server name may be included in filenames using the string
14088 @code{%s}, as in @code{/var/log/cups/%s-page_log}.
14089
14090 Defaults to @samp{"/var/log/cups/page_log"}.
14091 @end deftypevr
14092
14093 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string remote-root
14094 Specifies the username that is associated with unauthenticated accesses
14095 by clients claiming to be the root user. The default is @code{remroot}.
14096
14097 Defaults to @samp{"remroot"}.
14098 @end deftypevr
14099
14100 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} file-name request-root
14101 Specifies the directory that contains print jobs and other HTTP request
14102 data.
14103
14104 Defaults to @samp{"/var/spool/cups"}.
14105 @end deftypevr
14106
14107 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} sandboxing sandboxing
14108 Specifies the level of security sandboxing that is applied to print
14109 filters, backends, and other child processes of the scheduler; either
14110 @code{relaxed} or @code{strict}. This directive is currently only
14111 used/supported on macOS.
14112
14113 Defaults to @samp{strict}.
14114 @end deftypevr
14115
14116 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} file-name server-keychain
14117 Specifies the location of TLS certificates and private keys. CUPS will
14118 look for public and private keys in this directory: a @code{.crt} files
14119 for PEM-encoded certificates and corresponding @code{.key} files for
14120 PEM-encoded private keys.
14121
14122 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/cups/ssl"}.
14123 @end deftypevr
14124
14125 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} file-name server-root
14126 Specifies the directory containing the server configuration files.
14127
14128 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/cups"}.
14129 @end deftypevr
14130
14131 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} boolean sync-on-close?
14132 Specifies whether the scheduler calls fsync(2) after writing
14133 configuration or state files.
14134
14135 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
14136 @end deftypevr
14137
14138 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list system-group
14139 Specifies the group(s) to use for @code{@@SYSTEM} group authentication.
14140 @end deftypevr
14141
14142 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} file-name temp-dir
14143 Specifies the directory where temporary files are stored.
14144
14145 Defaults to @samp{"/var/spool/cups/tmp"}.
14146 @end deftypevr
14147
14148 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string user
14149 Specifies the user name or ID that is used when running external
14150 programs.
14151
14152 Defaults to @samp{"lp"}.
14153 @end deftypevr
14154 @end deftypevr
14155
14156 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} access-log-level access-log-level
14157 Specifies the logging level for the AccessLog file. The @code{config}
14158 level logs when printers and classes are added, deleted, or modified and
14159 when configuration files are accessed or updated. The @code{actions}
14160 level logs when print jobs are submitted, held, released, modified, or
14161 canceled, and any of the conditions for @code{config}. The @code{all}
14162 level logs all requests.
14163
14164 Defaults to @samp{actions}.
14165 @end deftypevr
14166
14167 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean auto-purge-jobs?
14168 Specifies whether to purge job history data automatically when it is no
14169 longer required for quotas.
14170
14171 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
14172 @end deftypevr
14173
14174 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} browse-local-protocols browse-local-protocols
14175 Specifies which protocols to use for local printer sharing.
14176
14177 Defaults to @samp{dnssd}.
14178 @end deftypevr
14179
14180 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean browse-web-if?
14181 Specifies whether the CUPS web interface is advertised.
14182
14183 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
14184 @end deftypevr
14185
14186 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean browsing?
14187 Specifies whether shared printers are advertised.
14188
14189 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
14190 @end deftypevr
14191
14192 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string classification
14193 Specifies the security classification of the server. Any valid banner
14194 name can be used, including "classified", "confidential", "secret",
14195 "topsecret", and "unclassified", or the banner can be omitted to disable
14196 secure printing functions.
14197
14198 Defaults to @samp{""}.
14199 @end deftypevr
14200
14201 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean classify-override?
14202 Specifies whether users may override the classification (cover page) of
14203 individual print jobs using the @code{job-sheets} option.
14204
14205 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
14206 @end deftypevr
14207
14208 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} default-auth-type default-auth-type
14209 Specifies the default type of authentication to use.
14210
14211 Defaults to @samp{Basic}.
14212 @end deftypevr
14213
14214 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} default-encryption default-encryption
14215 Specifies whether encryption will be used for authenticated requests.
14216
14217 Defaults to @samp{Required}.
14218 @end deftypevr
14219
14220 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string default-language
14221 Specifies the default language to use for text and web content.
14222
14223 Defaults to @samp{"en"}.
14224 @end deftypevr
14225
14226 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string default-paper-size
14227 Specifies the default paper size for new print queues. @samp{"Auto"}
14228 uses a locale-specific default, while @samp{"None"} specifies there is
14229 no default paper size. Specific size names are typically
14230 @samp{"Letter"} or @samp{"A4"}.
14231
14232 Defaults to @samp{"Auto"}.
14233 @end deftypevr
14234
14235 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string default-policy
14236 Specifies the default access policy to use.
14237
14238 Defaults to @samp{"default"}.
14239 @end deftypevr
14240
14241 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean default-shared?
14242 Specifies whether local printers are shared by default.
14243
14244 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
14245 @end deftypevr
14246
14247 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer dirty-clean-interval
14248 Specifies the delay for updating of configuration and state files, in
14249 seconds. A value of 0 causes the update to happen as soon as possible,
14250 typically within a few milliseconds.
14251
14252 Defaults to @samp{30}.
14253 @end deftypevr
14254
14255 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} error-policy error-policy
14256 Specifies what to do when an error occurs. Possible values are
14257 @code{abort-job}, which will discard the failed print job;
14258 @code{retry-job}, which will retry the job at a later time;
14259 @code{retry-this-job}, which retries the failed job immediately; and
14260 @code{stop-printer}, which stops the printer.
14261
14262 Defaults to @samp{stop-printer}.
14263 @end deftypevr
14264
14265 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer filter-limit
14266 Specifies the maximum cost of filters that are run concurrently, which
14267 can be used to minimize disk, memory, and CPU resource problems. A
14268 limit of 0 disables filter limiting. An average print to a
14269 non-PostScript printer needs a filter limit of about 200. A PostScript
14270 printer needs about half that (100). Setting the limit below these
14271 thresholds will effectively limit the scheduler to printing a single job
14272 at any time.
14273
14274 Defaults to @samp{0}.
14275 @end deftypevr
14276
14277 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer filter-nice
14278 Specifies the scheduling priority of filters that are run to print a
14279 job. The nice value ranges from 0, the highest priority, to 19, the
14280 lowest priority.
14281
14282 Defaults to @samp{0}.
14283 @end deftypevr
14284
14285 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} host-name-lookups host-name-lookups
14286 Specifies whether to do reverse lookups on connecting clients. The
14287 @code{double} setting causes @code{cupsd} to verify that the hostname
14288 resolved from the address matches one of the addresses returned for that
14289 hostname. Double lookups also prevent clients with unregistered
14290 addresses from connecting to your server. Only set this option to
14291 @code{#t} or @code{double} if absolutely required.
14292
14293 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
14294 @end deftypevr
14295
14296 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer job-kill-delay
14297 Specifies the number of seconds to wait before killing the filters and
14298 backend associated with a canceled or held job.
14299
14300 Defaults to @samp{30}.
14301 @end deftypevr
14302
14303 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer job-retry-interval
14304 Specifies the interval between retries of jobs in seconds. This is
14305 typically used for fax queues but can also be used with normal print
14306 queues whose error policy is @code{retry-job} or
14307 @code{retry-current-job}.
14308
14309 Defaults to @samp{30}.
14310 @end deftypevr
14311
14312 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer job-retry-limit
14313 Specifies the number of retries that are done for jobs. This is
14314 typically used for fax queues but can also be used with normal print
14315 queues whose error policy is @code{retry-job} or
14316 @code{retry-current-job}.
14317
14318 Defaults to @samp{5}.
14319 @end deftypevr
14320
14321 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean keep-alive?
14322 Specifies whether to support HTTP keep-alive connections.
14323
14324 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
14325 @end deftypevr
14326
14327 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer keep-alive-timeout
14328 Specifies how long an idle client connection remains open, in seconds.
14329
14330 Defaults to @samp{30}.
14331 @end deftypevr
14332
14333 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer limit-request-body
14334 Specifies the maximum size of print files, IPP requests, and HTML form
14335 data. A limit of 0 disables the limit check.
14336
14337 Defaults to @samp{0}.
14338 @end deftypevr
14339
14340 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} multiline-string-list listen
14341 Listens on the specified interfaces for connections. Valid values are
14342 of the form @var{address}:@var{port}, where @var{address} is either an
14343 IPv6 address enclosed in brackets, an IPv4 address, or @code{*} to
14344 indicate all addresses. Values can also be file names of local UNIX
14345 domain sockets. The Listen directive is similar to the Port directive
14346 but allows you to restrict access to specific interfaces or networks.
14347 @end deftypevr
14348
14349 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer listen-back-log
14350 Specifies the number of pending connections that will be allowed. This
14351 normally only affects very busy servers that have reached the MaxClients
14352 limit, but can also be triggered by large numbers of simultaneous
14353 connections. When the limit is reached, the operating system will
14354 refuse additional connections until the scheduler can accept the pending
14355 ones.
14356
14357 Defaults to @samp{128}.
14358 @end deftypevr
14359
14360 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} location-access-control-list location-access-controls
14361 Specifies a set of additional access controls.
14362
14363 Available @code{location-access-controls} fields are:
14364
14365 @deftypevr {@code{location-access-controls} parameter} file-name path
14366 Specifies the URI path to which the access control applies.
14367 @end deftypevr
14368
14369 @deftypevr {@code{location-access-controls} parameter} access-control-list access-controls
14370 Access controls for all access to this path, in the same format as the
14371 @code{access-controls} of @code{operation-access-control}.
14372
14373 Defaults to @samp{()}.
14374 @end deftypevr
14375
14376 @deftypevr {@code{location-access-controls} parameter} method-access-control-list method-access-controls
14377 Access controls for method-specific access to this path.
14378
14379 Defaults to @samp{()}.
14380
14381 Available @code{method-access-controls} fields are:
14382
14383 @deftypevr {@code{method-access-controls} parameter} boolean reverse?
14384 If @code{#t}, apply access controls to all methods except the listed
14385 methods. Otherwise apply to only the listed methods.
14386
14387 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
14388 @end deftypevr
14389
14390 @deftypevr {@code{method-access-controls} parameter} method-list methods
14391 Methods to which this access control applies.
14392
14393 Defaults to @samp{()}.
14394 @end deftypevr
14395
14396 @deftypevr {@code{method-access-controls} parameter} access-control-list access-controls
14397 Access control directives, as a list of strings. Each string should be
14398 one directive, such as "Order allow,deny".
14399
14400 Defaults to @samp{()}.
14401 @end deftypevr
14402 @end deftypevr
14403 @end deftypevr
14404
14405 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer log-debug-history
14406 Specifies the number of debugging messages that are retained for logging
14407 if an error occurs in a print job. Debug messages are logged regardless
14408 of the LogLevel setting.
14409
14410 Defaults to @samp{100}.
14411 @end deftypevr
14412
14413 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} log-level log-level
14414 Specifies the level of logging for the ErrorLog file. The value
14415 @code{none} stops all logging while @code{debug2} logs everything.
14416
14417 Defaults to @samp{info}.
14418 @end deftypevr
14419
14420 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} log-time-format log-time-format
14421 Specifies the format of the date and time in the log files. The value
14422 @code{standard} logs whole seconds while @code{usecs} logs microseconds.
14423
14424 Defaults to @samp{standard}.
14425 @end deftypevr
14426
14427 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-clients
14428 Specifies the maximum number of simultaneous clients that are allowed by
14429 the scheduler.
14430
14431 Defaults to @samp{100}.
14432 @end deftypevr
14433
14434 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-clients-per-host
14435 Specifies the maximum number of simultaneous clients that are allowed
14436 from a single address.
14437
14438 Defaults to @samp{100}.
14439 @end deftypevr
14440
14441 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-copies
14442 Specifies the maximum number of copies that a user can print of each
14443 job.
14444
14445 Defaults to @samp{9999}.
14446 @end deftypevr
14447
14448 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-hold-time
14449 Specifies the maximum time a job may remain in the @code{indefinite}
14450 hold state before it is canceled. A value of 0 disables cancellation of
14451 held jobs.
14452
14453 Defaults to @samp{0}.
14454 @end deftypevr
14455
14456 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-jobs
14457 Specifies the maximum number of simultaneous jobs that are allowed. Set
14458 to 0 to allow an unlimited number of jobs.
14459
14460 Defaults to @samp{500}.
14461 @end deftypevr
14462
14463 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-jobs-per-printer
14464 Specifies the maximum number of simultaneous jobs that are allowed per
14465 printer. A value of 0 allows up to MaxJobs jobs per printer.
14466
14467 Defaults to @samp{0}.
14468 @end deftypevr
14469
14470 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-jobs-per-user
14471 Specifies the maximum number of simultaneous jobs that are allowed per
14472 user. A value of 0 allows up to MaxJobs jobs per user.
14473
14474 Defaults to @samp{0}.
14475 @end deftypevr
14476
14477 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-job-time
14478 Specifies the maximum time a job may take to print before it is
14479 canceled, in seconds. Set to 0 to disable cancellation of "stuck" jobs.
14480
14481 Defaults to @samp{10800}.
14482 @end deftypevr
14483
14484 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-log-size
14485 Specifies the maximum size of the log files before they are rotated, in
14486 bytes. The value 0 disables log rotation.
14487
14488 Defaults to @samp{1048576}.
14489 @end deftypevr
14490
14491 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer multiple-operation-timeout
14492 Specifies the maximum amount of time to allow between files in a
14493 multiple file print job, in seconds.
14494
14495 Defaults to @samp{300}.
14496 @end deftypevr
14497
14498 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string page-log-format
14499 Specifies the format of PageLog lines. Sequences beginning with percent
14500 (@samp{%}) characters are replaced with the corresponding information,
14501 while all other characters are copied literally. The following percent
14502 sequences are recognized:
14503
14504 @table @samp
14505 @item %%
14506 insert a single percent character
14507
14508 @item %@{name@}
14509 insert the value of the specified IPP attribute
14510
14511 @item %C
14512 insert the number of copies for the current page
14513
14514 @item %P
14515 insert the current page number
14516
14517 @item %T
14518 insert the current date and time in common log format
14519
14520 @item %j
14521 insert the job ID
14522
14523 @item %p
14524 insert the printer name
14525
14526 @item %u
14527 insert the username
14528 @end table
14529
14530 A value of the empty string disables page logging. The string @code{%p
14531 %u %j %T %P %C %@{job-billing@} %@{job-originating-host-name@}
14532 %@{job-name@} %@{media@} %@{sides@}} creates a page log with the
14533 standard items.
14534
14535 Defaults to @samp{""}.
14536 @end deftypevr
14537
14538 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} environment-variables environment-variables
14539 Passes the specified environment variable(s) to child processes; a list
14540 of strings.
14541
14542 Defaults to @samp{()}.
14543 @end deftypevr
14544
14545 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} policy-configuration-list policies
14546 Specifies named access control policies.
14547
14548 Available @code{policy-configuration} fields are:
14549
14550 @deftypevr {@code{policy-configuration} parameter} string name
14551 Name of the policy.
14552 @end deftypevr
14553
14554 @deftypevr {@code{policy-configuration} parameter} string job-private-access
14555 Specifies an access list for a job's private values. @code{@@ACL} maps
14556 to the printer's requesting-user-name-allowed or
14557 requesting-user-name-denied values. @code{@@OWNER} maps to the job's
14558 owner. @code{@@SYSTEM} maps to the groups listed for the
14559 @code{system-group} field of the @code{files-config} configuration,
14560 which is reified into the @code{cups-files.conf(5)} file. Other
14561 possible elements of the access list include specific user names, and
14562 @code{@@@var{group}} to indicate members of a specific group. The
14563 access list may also be simply @code{all} or @code{default}.
14564
14565 Defaults to @samp{"@@OWNER @@SYSTEM"}.
14566 @end deftypevr
14567
14568 @deftypevr {@code{policy-configuration} parameter} string job-private-values
14569 Specifies the list of job values to make private, or @code{all},
14570 @code{default}, or @code{none}.
14571
14572 Defaults to @samp{"job-name job-originating-host-name
14573 job-originating-user-name phone"}.
14574 @end deftypevr
14575
14576 @deftypevr {@code{policy-configuration} parameter} string subscription-private-access
14577 Specifies an access list for a subscription's private values.
14578 @code{@@ACL} maps to the printer's requesting-user-name-allowed or
14579 requesting-user-name-denied values. @code{@@OWNER} maps to the job's
14580 owner. @code{@@SYSTEM} maps to the groups listed for the
14581 @code{system-group} field of the @code{files-config} configuration,
14582 which is reified into the @code{cups-files.conf(5)} file. Other
14583 possible elements of the access list include specific user names, and
14584 @code{@@@var{group}} to indicate members of a specific group. The
14585 access list may also be simply @code{all} or @code{default}.
14586
14587 Defaults to @samp{"@@OWNER @@SYSTEM"}.
14588 @end deftypevr
14589
14590 @deftypevr {@code{policy-configuration} parameter} string subscription-private-values
14591 Specifies the list of job values to make private, or @code{all},
14592 @code{default}, or @code{none}.
14593
14594 Defaults to @samp{"notify-events notify-pull-method notify-recipient-uri
14595 notify-subscriber-user-name notify-user-data"}.
14596 @end deftypevr
14597
14598 @deftypevr {@code{policy-configuration} parameter} operation-access-control-list access-controls
14599 Access control by IPP operation.
14600
14601 Defaults to @samp{()}.
14602 @end deftypevr
14603 @end deftypevr
14604
14605 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean-or-non-negative-integer preserve-job-files
14606 Specifies whether job files (documents) are preserved after a job is
14607 printed. If a numeric value is specified, job files are preserved for
14608 the indicated number of seconds after printing. Otherwise a boolean
14609 value applies indefinitely.
14610
14611 Defaults to @samp{86400}.
14612 @end deftypevr
14613
14614 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean-or-non-negative-integer preserve-job-history
14615 Specifies whether the job history is preserved after a job is printed.
14616 If a numeric value is specified, the job history is preserved for the
14617 indicated number of seconds after printing. If @code{#t}, the job
14618 history is preserved until the MaxJobs limit is reached.
14619
14620 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
14621 @end deftypevr
14622
14623 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer reload-timeout
14624 Specifies the amount of time to wait for job completion before
14625 restarting the scheduler.
14626
14627 Defaults to @samp{30}.
14628 @end deftypevr
14629
14630 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string rip-cache
14631 Specifies the maximum amount of memory to use when converting documents
14632 into bitmaps for a printer.
14633
14634 Defaults to @samp{"128m"}.
14635 @end deftypevr
14636
14637 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string server-admin
14638 Specifies the email address of the server administrator.
14639
14640 Defaults to @samp{"root@@localhost.localdomain"}.
14641 @end deftypevr
14642
14643 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} host-name-list-or-* server-alias
14644 The ServerAlias directive is used for HTTP Host header validation when
14645 clients connect to the scheduler from external interfaces. Using the
14646 special name @code{*} can expose your system to known browser-based DNS
14647 rebinding attacks, even when accessing sites through a firewall. If the
14648 auto-discovery of alternate names does not work, we recommend listing
14649 each alternate name with a ServerAlias directive instead of using
14650 @code{*}.
14651
14652 Defaults to @samp{*}.
14653 @end deftypevr
14654
14655 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string server-name
14656 Specifies the fully-qualified host name of the server.
14657
14658 Defaults to @samp{"localhost"}.
14659 @end deftypevr
14660
14661 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} server-tokens server-tokens
14662 Specifies what information is included in the Server header of HTTP
14663 responses. @code{None} disables the Server header. @code{ProductOnly}
14664 reports @code{CUPS}. @code{Major} reports @code{CUPS 2}. @code{Minor}
14665 reports @code{CUPS 2.0}. @code{Minimal} reports @code{CUPS 2.0.0}.
14666 @code{OS} reports @code{CUPS 2.0.0 (@var{uname})} where @var{uname} is
14667 the output of the @code{uname} command. @code{Full} reports @code{CUPS
14668 2.0.0 (@var{uname}) IPP/2.0}.
14669
14670 Defaults to @samp{Minimal}.
14671 @end deftypevr
14672
14673 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string set-env
14674 Set the specified environment variable to be passed to child processes.
14675
14676 Defaults to @samp{"variable value"}.
14677 @end deftypevr
14678
14679 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} multiline-string-list ssl-listen
14680 Listens on the specified interfaces for encrypted connections. Valid
14681 values are of the form @var{address}:@var{port}, where @var{address} is
14682 either an IPv6 address enclosed in brackets, an IPv4 address, or
14683 @code{*} to indicate all addresses.
14684
14685 Defaults to @samp{()}.
14686 @end deftypevr
14687
14688 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} ssl-options ssl-options
14689 Sets encryption options. By default, CUPS only supports encryption
14690 using TLS v1.0 or higher using known secure cipher suites. The
14691 @code{AllowRC4} option enables the 128-bit RC4 cipher suites, which are
14692 required for some older clients that do not implement newer ones. The
14693 @code{AllowSSL3} option enables SSL v3.0, which is required for some
14694 older clients that do not support TLS v1.0.
14695
14696 Defaults to @samp{()}.
14697 @end deftypevr
14698
14699 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean strict-conformance?
14700 Specifies whether the scheduler requires clients to strictly adhere to
14701 the IPP specifications.
14702
14703 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
14704 @end deftypevr
14705
14706 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer timeout
14707 Specifies the HTTP request timeout, in seconds.
14708
14709 Defaults to @samp{300}.
14710
14711 @end deftypevr
14712
14713 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean web-interface?
14714 Specifies whether the web interface is enabled.
14715
14716 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
14717 @end deftypevr
14718
14719 At this point you're probably thinking ``oh dear, Guix manual, I like
14720 you but you can stop already with the configuration options''. Indeed.
14721 However, one more point: it could be that you have an existing
14722 @code{cupsd.conf} that you want to use. In that case, you can pass an
14723 @code{opaque-cups-configuration} as the configuration of a
14724 @code{cups-service-type}.
14725
14726 Available @code{opaque-cups-configuration} fields are:
14727
14728 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-cups-configuration} parameter} package cups
14729 The CUPS package.
14730 @end deftypevr
14731
14732 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-cups-configuration} parameter} string cupsd.conf
14733 The contents of the @code{cupsd.conf}, as a string.
14734 @end deftypevr
14735
14736 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-cups-configuration} parameter} string cups-files.conf
14737 The contents of the @code{cups-files.conf} file, as a string.
14738 @end deftypevr
14739
14740 For example, if your @code{cupsd.conf} and @code{cups-files.conf} are in
14741 strings of the same name, you could instantiate a CUPS service like
14742 this:
14743
14744 @example
14745 (service cups-service-type
14746 (opaque-cups-configuration
14747 (cupsd.conf cupsd.conf)
14748 (cups-files.conf cups-files.conf)))
14749 @end example
14750
14751
14752 @node Desktop Services
14753 @subsection Desktop Services
14754
14755 The @code{(gnu services desktop)} module provides services that are
14756 usually useful in the context of a ``desktop'' setup---that is, on a
14757 machine running a graphical display server, possibly with graphical user
14758 interfaces, etc. It also defines services that provide specific desktop
14759 environments like GNOME, Xfce or MATE.
14760
14761 To simplify things, the module defines a variable containing the set of
14762 services that users typically expect on a machine with a graphical
14763 environment and networking:
14764
14765 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %desktop-services
14766 This is a list of services that builds upon @code{%base-services} and
14767 adds or adjusts services for a typical ``desktop'' setup.
14768
14769 In particular, it adds a graphical login manager (@pxref{X Window,
14770 @code{gdm-service-type}}), screen lockers, a network management tool
14771 (@pxref{Networking Services, @code{network-manager-service-type}}) with modem
14772 support (@pxref{Networking Services, @code{modem-manager-service-type}}),
14773 energy and color management services, the @code{elogind} login and seat
14774 manager, the Polkit privilege service, the GeoClue location service, the
14775 AccountsService daemon that allows authorized users change system passwords,
14776 an NTP client (@pxref{Networking Services}), the Avahi daemon, and has the
14777 name service switch service configured to be able to use @code{nss-mdns}
14778 (@pxref{Name Service Switch, mDNS}).
14779 @end defvr
14780
14781 The @code{%desktop-services} variable can be used as the @code{services}
14782 field of an @code{operating-system} declaration (@pxref{operating-system
14783 Reference, @code{services}}).
14784
14785 Additionally, the @code{gnome-desktop-service-type},
14786 @code{xfce-desktop-service}, @code{mate-desktop-service-type} and
14787 @code{enlightenment-desktop-service-type} procedures can add GNOME, Xfce, MATE
14788 and/or Enlightenment to a system. To ``add GNOME'' means that system-level
14789 services like the backlight adjustment helpers and the power management
14790 utilities are added to the system, extending @code{polkit} and @code{dbus}
14791 appropriately, allowing GNOME to operate with elevated privileges on a
14792 limited number of special-purpose system interfaces. Additionally,
14793 adding a service made by @code{gnome-desktop-service-type} adds the GNOME
14794 metapackage to the system profile. Likewise, adding the Xfce service
14795 not only adds the @code{xfce} metapackage to the system profile, but it
14796 also gives the Thunar file manager the ability to open a ``root-mode''
14797 file management window, if the user authenticates using the
14798 administrator's password via the standard polkit graphical interface.
14799 To ``add MATE'' means that @code{polkit} and @code{dbus} are extended
14800 appropriately, allowing MATE to operate with elevated privileges on a
14801 limited number of special-purpose system interfaces. Additionally,
14802 adding a service of type @code{mate-desktop-service-type} adds the MATE
14803 metapackage to the system profile. ``Adding Enlightenment'' means that
14804 @code{dbus} is extended appropriately, and several of Enlightenment's binaries
14805 are set as setuid, allowing Enlightenment's screen locker and other
14806 functionality to work as expetected.
14807
14808 The desktop environments in Guix use the Xorg display server by
14809 default. If you'd like to use the newer display server protocol
14810 called Wayland, you need to use the @code{sddm-service} instead of
14811 GDM as the graphical login manager. You should then
14812 select the ``GNOME (Wayland)'' session in SDDM. Alternatively you can
14813 also try starting GNOME on Wayland manually from a TTY with the
14814 command ``XDG_SESSION_TYPE=wayland exec dbus-run-session
14815 gnome-session``. Currently only GNOME has support for Wayland.
14816
14817 @defvr {Scheme Variable} gnome-desktop-service-type
14818 This is the type of the service that adds the @uref{https://www.gnome.org,
14819 GNOME} desktop environment. Its value is a @code{gnome-desktop-configuration}
14820 object (see below.)
14821
14822 This service adds the @code{gnome} package to the system profile, and extends
14823 polkit with the actions from @code{gnome-settings-daemon}.
14824 @end defvr
14825
14826 @deftp {Data Type} gnome-desktop-configuration
14827 Configuration record for the GNOME desktop environment.
14828
14829 @table @asis
14830 @item @code{gnome} (default: @code{gnome})
14831 The GNOME package to use.
14832 @end table
14833 @end deftp
14834
14835 @defvr {Scheme Variable} xfce-desktop-service-type
14836 This is the type of a service to run the @uref{Xfce, https://xfce.org/}
14837 desktop environment. Its value is an @code{xfce-desktop-configuration} object
14838 (see below.)
14839
14840 This service adds the @code{xfce} package to the system profile, and
14841 extends polkit with the ability for @code{thunar} to manipulate the file
14842 system as root from within a user session, after the user has authenticated
14843 with the administrator's password.
14844 @end defvr
14845
14846 @deftp {Data Type} xfce-desktop-configuration
14847 Configuration record for the Xfce desktop environment.
14848
14849 @table @asis
14850 @item @code{xfce} (default: @code{xfce})
14851 The Xfce package to use.
14852 @end table
14853 @end deftp
14854
14855 @deffn {Scheme Variable} mate-desktop-service-type
14856 This is the type of the service that runs the @uref{https://mate-desktop.org/,
14857 MATE desktop environment}. Its value is a @code{mate-desktop-configuration}
14858 object (see below.)
14859
14860 This service adds the @code{mate} package to the system
14861 profile, and extends polkit with the actions from
14862 @code{mate-settings-daemon}.
14863 @end deffn
14864
14865 @deftp {Data Type} mate-desktop-configuration
14866 Configuration record for the MATE desktop environment.
14867
14868 @table @asis
14869 @item @code{mate} (default: @code{mate})
14870 The MATE package to use.
14871 @end table
14872 @end deftp
14873
14874 @deffn {Scheme Variable} enlightenment-desktop-service-type
14875 Return a service that adds the @code{enlightenment} package to the system
14876 profile, and extends dbus with actions from @code{efl}.
14877 @end deffn
14878
14879 @deftp {Data Type} enlightenment-desktop-service-configuration
14880 @table @asis
14881 @item @code{enlightenment} (default: @code{enlightenment})
14882 The enlightenment package to use.
14883 @end table
14884 @end deftp
14885
14886 Because the GNOME, Xfce and MATE desktop services pull in so many packages,
14887 the default @code{%desktop-services} variable doesn't include any of
14888 them by default. To add GNOME, Xfce or MATE, just @code{cons} them onto
14889 @code{%desktop-services} in the @code{services} field of your
14890 @code{operating-system}:
14891
14892 @example
14893 (use-modules (gnu))
14894 (use-service-modules desktop)
14895 (operating-system
14896 ...
14897 ;; cons* adds items to the list given as its last argument.
14898 (services (cons* (service gnome-desktop-service-type)
14899 (service xfce-desktop-service)
14900 %desktop-services))
14901 ...)
14902 @end example
14903
14904 These desktop environments will then be available as options in the
14905 graphical login window.
14906
14907 The actual service definitions included in @code{%desktop-services} and
14908 provided by @code{(gnu services dbus)} and @code{(gnu services desktop)}
14909 are described below.
14910
14911 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} dbus-service [#:dbus @var{dbus}] [#:services '()]
14912 Return a service that runs the ``system bus'', using @var{dbus}, with
14913 support for @var{services}.
14914
14915 @uref{https://dbus.freedesktop.org/, D-Bus} is an inter-process communication
14916 facility. Its system bus is used to allow system services to communicate
14917 and to be notified of system-wide events.
14918
14919 @var{services} must be a list of packages that provide an
14920 @file{etc/dbus-1/system.d} directory containing additional D-Bus configuration
14921 and policy files. For example, to allow avahi-daemon to use the system bus,
14922 @var{services} must be equal to @code{(list avahi)}.
14923 @end deffn
14924
14925 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} elogind-service [#:config @var{config}]
14926 Return a service that runs the @code{elogind} login and
14927 seat management daemon. @uref{https://github.com/elogind/elogind,
14928 Elogind} exposes a D-Bus interface that can be used to know which users
14929 are logged in, know what kind of sessions they have open, suspend the
14930 system, inhibit system suspend, reboot the system, and other tasks.
14931
14932 Elogind handles most system-level power events for a computer, for
14933 example suspending the system when a lid is closed, or shutting it down
14934 when the power button is pressed.
14935
14936 The @var{config} keyword argument specifies the configuration for
14937 elogind, and should be the result of an @code{(elogind-configuration
14938 (@var{parameter} @var{value})...)} invocation. Available parameters and
14939 their default values are:
14940
14941 @table @code
14942 @item kill-user-processes?
14943 @code{#f}
14944 @item kill-only-users
14945 @code{()}
14946 @item kill-exclude-users
14947 @code{("root")}
14948 @item inhibit-delay-max-seconds
14949 @code{5}
14950 @item handle-power-key
14951 @code{poweroff}
14952 @item handle-suspend-key
14953 @code{suspend}
14954 @item handle-hibernate-key
14955 @code{hibernate}
14956 @item handle-lid-switch
14957 @code{suspend}
14958 @item handle-lid-switch-docked
14959 @code{ignore}
14960 @item power-key-ignore-inhibited?
14961 @code{#f}
14962 @item suspend-key-ignore-inhibited?
14963 @code{#f}
14964 @item hibernate-key-ignore-inhibited?
14965 @code{#f}
14966 @item lid-switch-ignore-inhibited?
14967 @code{#t}
14968 @item holdoff-timeout-seconds
14969 @code{30}
14970 @item idle-action
14971 @code{ignore}
14972 @item idle-action-seconds
14973 @code{(* 30 60)}
14974 @item runtime-directory-size-percent
14975 @code{10}
14976 @item runtime-directory-size
14977 @code{#f}
14978 @item remove-ipc?
14979 @code{#t}
14980 @item suspend-state
14981 @code{("mem" "standby" "freeze")}
14982 @item suspend-mode
14983 @code{()}
14984 @item hibernate-state
14985 @code{("disk")}
14986 @item hibernate-mode
14987 @code{("platform" "shutdown")}
14988 @item hybrid-sleep-state
14989 @code{("disk")}
14990 @item hybrid-sleep-mode
14991 @code{("suspend" "platform" "shutdown")}
14992 @end table
14993 @end deffn
14994
14995 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} accountsservice-service @
14996 [#:accountsservice @var{accountsservice}]
14997 Return a service that runs AccountsService, a system service that can
14998 list available accounts, change their passwords, and so on.
14999 AccountsService integrates with PolicyKit to enable unprivileged users
15000 to acquire the capability to modify their system configuration.
15001 @uref{https://www.freedesktop.org/wiki/Software/AccountsService/, the
15002 accountsservice web site} for more information.
15003
15004 The @var{accountsservice} keyword argument is the @code{accountsservice}
15005 package to expose as a service.
15006 @end deffn
15007
15008 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} polkit-service @
15009 [#:polkit @var{polkit}]
15010 Return a service that runs the
15011 @uref{https://www.freedesktop.org/wiki/Software/polkit/, Polkit privilege
15012 management service}, which allows system administrators to grant access to
15013 privileged operations in a structured way. By querying the Polkit service, a
15014 privileged system component can know when it should grant additional
15015 capabilities to ordinary users. For example, an ordinary user can be granted
15016 the capability to suspend the system if the user is logged in locally.
15017 @end deffn
15018
15019 @defvr {Scheme Variable} upower-service-type
15020 Service that runs @uref{https://upower.freedesktop.org/, @command{upowerd}}, a
15021 system-wide monitor for power consumption and battery levels, with the given
15022 configuration settings.
15023
15024 It implements the @code{org.freedesktop.UPower} D-Bus interface, and is
15025 notably used by GNOME.
15026 @end defvr
15027
15028 @deftp {Data Type} upower-configuration
15029 Data type representation the configuration for UPower.
15030
15031 @table @asis
15032
15033 @item @code{upower} (default: @var{upower})
15034 Package to use for @code{upower}.
15035
15036 @item @code{watts-up-pro?} (default: @code{#f})
15037 Enable the Watts Up Pro device.
15038
15039 @item @code{poll-batteries?} (default: @code{#t})
15040 Enable polling the kernel for battery level changes.
15041
15042 @item @code{ignore-lid?} (default: @code{#f})
15043 Ignore the lid state, this can be useful if it's incorrect on a device.
15044
15045 @item @code{use-percentage-for-policy?} (default: @code{#f})
15046 Whether battery percentage based policy should be used. The default is to use
15047 the time left, change to @code{#t} to use the percentage.
15048
15049 @item @code{percentage-low} (default: @code{10})
15050 When @code{use-percentage-for-policy?} is @code{#t}, this sets the percentage
15051 at which the battery is considered low.
15052
15053 @item @code{percentage-critical} (default: @code{3})
15054 When @code{use-percentage-for-policy?} is @code{#t}, this sets the percentage
15055 at which the battery is considered critical.
15056
15057 @item @code{percentage-action} (default: @code{2})
15058 When @code{use-percentage-for-policy?} is @code{#t}, this sets the percentage
15059 at which action will be taken.
15060
15061 @item @code{time-low} (default: @code{1200})
15062 When @code{use-time-for-policy?} is @code{#f}, this sets the time remaining in
15063 seconds at which the battery is considered low.
15064
15065 @item @code{time-critical} (default: @code{300})
15066 When @code{use-time-for-policy?} is @code{#f}, this sets the time remaining in
15067 seconds at which the battery is considered critical.
15068
15069 @item @code{time-action} (default: @code{120})
15070 When @code{use-time-for-policy?} is @code{#f}, this sets the time remaining in
15071 seconds at which action will be taken.
15072
15073 @item @code{critical-power-action} (default: @code{'hybrid-sleep})
15074 The action taken when @code{percentage-action} or @code{time-action} is
15075 reached (depending on the configuration of @code{use-percentage-for-policy?}).
15076
15077 Possible values are:
15078
15079 @itemize @bullet
15080 @item
15081 @code{'power-off}
15082
15083 @item
15084 @code{'hibernate}
15085
15086 @item
15087 @code{'hybrid-sleep}.
15088 @end itemize
15089
15090 @end table
15091 @end deftp
15092
15093 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} udisks-service [#:udisks @var{udisks}]
15094 Return a service for @uref{https://udisks.freedesktop.org/docs/latest/,
15095 UDisks}, a @dfn{disk management} daemon that provides user interfaces with
15096 notifications and ways to mount/unmount disks. Programs that talk to UDisks
15097 include the @command{udisksctl} command, part of UDisks, and GNOME Disks.
15098 @end deffn
15099
15100 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} colord-service [#:colord @var{colord}]
15101 Return a service that runs @command{colord}, a system service with a D-Bus
15102 interface to manage the color profiles of input and output devices such as
15103 screens and scanners. It is notably used by the GNOME Color Manager graphical
15104 tool. See @uref{https://www.freedesktop.org/software/colord/, the colord web
15105 site} for more information.
15106 @end deffn
15107
15108 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} geoclue-application name [#:allowed? #t] [#:system? #f] [#:users '()]
15109 Return a configuration allowing an application to access GeoClue
15110 location data. @var{name} is the Desktop ID of the application, without
15111 the @code{.desktop} part. If @var{allowed?} is true, the application
15112 will have access to location information by default. The boolean
15113 @var{system?} value indicates whether an application is a system component
15114 or not. Finally @var{users} is a list of UIDs of all users for which
15115 this application is allowed location info access. An empty users list
15116 means that all users are allowed.
15117 @end deffn
15118
15119 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %standard-geoclue-applications
15120 The standard list of well-known GeoClue application configurations,
15121 granting authority to the GNOME date-and-time utility to ask for the
15122 current location in order to set the time zone, and allowing the
15123 IceCat and Epiphany web browsers to request location information.
15124 IceCat and Epiphany both query the user before allowing a web page to
15125 know the user's location.
15126 @end defvr
15127
15128 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} geoclue-service [#:colord @var{colord}] @
15129 [#:whitelist '()] @
15130 [#:wifi-geolocation-url "https://location.services.mozilla.com/v1/geolocate?key=geoclue"] @
15131 [#:submit-data? #f]
15132 [#:wifi-submission-url "https://location.services.mozilla.com/v1/submit?key=geoclue"] @
15133 [#:submission-nick "geoclue"] @
15134 [#:applications %standard-geoclue-applications]
15135 Return a service that runs the GeoClue location service. This service
15136 provides a D-Bus interface to allow applications to request access to a
15137 user's physical location, and optionally to add information to online
15138 location databases. See
15139 @uref{https://wiki.freedesktop.org/www/Software/GeoClue/, the GeoClue
15140 web site} for more information.
15141 @end deffn
15142
15143 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} bluetooth-service [#:bluez @var{bluez}] @
15144 [@w{#:auto-enable? #f}]
15145 Return a service that runs the @command{bluetoothd} daemon, which
15146 manages all the Bluetooth devices and provides a number of D-Bus
15147 interfaces. When AUTO-ENABLE? is true, the bluetooth controller is
15148 powered automatically at boot, which can be useful when using a
15149 bluetooth keyboard or mouse.
15150
15151 Users need to be in the @code{lp} group to access the D-Bus service.
15152 @end deffn
15153
15154 @node Sound Services
15155 @subsection Sound Services
15156
15157 @cindex sound support
15158 @cindex ALSA
15159 @cindex PulseAudio, sound support
15160
15161 The @code{(gnu services sound)} module provides a service to configure the
15162 Advanced Linux Sound Architecture (ALSA) system, which makes PulseAudio the
15163 preferred ALSA output driver.
15164
15165 @deffn {Scheme Variable} alsa-service-type
15166 This is the type for the @uref{https://alsa-project.org/, Advanced Linux Sound
15167 Architecture} (ALSA) system, which generates the @file{/etc/asound.conf}
15168 configuration file. The value for this type is a @command{alsa-configuration}
15169 record as in this example:
15170
15171 @example
15172 (service alsa-service-type)
15173 @end example
15174
15175 See below for details about @code{alsa-configuration}.
15176 @end deffn
15177
15178 @deftp {Data Type} alsa-configuration
15179 Data type representing the configuration for @code{alsa-service}.
15180
15181 @table @asis
15182 @item @code{alsa-plugins} (default: @var{alsa-plugins})
15183 @code{alsa-plugins} package to use.
15184
15185 @item @code{pulseaudio?} (default: @var{#t})
15186 Whether ALSA applications should transparently be made to use the
15187 @uref{http://www.pulseaudio.org/, PulseAudio} sound server.
15188
15189 Using PulseAudio allows you to run several sound-producing applications
15190 at the same time and to individual control them @i{via}
15191 @command{pavucontrol}, among other things.
15192
15193 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @var{""})
15194 String to append to the @file{/etc/asound.conf} file.
15195
15196 @end table
15197 @end deftp
15198
15199 Individual users who want to override the system configuration of ALSA can do
15200 it with the @file{~/.asoundrc} file:
15201
15202 @example
15203 # In guix, we have to specify the absolute path for plugins.
15204 pcm_type.jack @{
15205 lib "/home/alice/.guix-profile/lib/alsa-lib/libasound_module_pcm_jack.so"
15206 @}
15207
15208 # Routing ALSA to jack:
15209 # <http://jackaudio.org/faq/routing_alsa.html>.
15210 pcm.rawjack @{
15211 type jack
15212 playback_ports @{
15213 0 system:playback_1
15214 1 system:playback_2
15215 @}
15216
15217 capture_ports @{
15218 0 system:capture_1
15219 1 system:capture_2
15220 @}
15221 @}
15222
15223 pcm.!default @{
15224 type plug
15225 slave @{
15226 pcm "rawjack"
15227 @}
15228 @}
15229 @end example
15230
15231 See @uref{https://www.alsa-project.org/main/index.php/Asoundrc} for the
15232 details.
15233
15234
15235 @node Database Services
15236 @subsection Database Services
15237
15238 @cindex database
15239 @cindex SQL
15240 The @code{(gnu services databases)} module provides the following services.
15241
15242 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} postgresql-service [#:postgresql postgresql] @
15243 [#:config-file] [#:data-directory ``/var/lib/postgresql/data''] @
15244 [#:port 5432] [#:locale ``en_US.utf8''] [#:extension-packages '()]
15245 Return a service that runs @var{postgresql}, the PostgreSQL database
15246 server.
15247
15248 The PostgreSQL daemon loads its runtime configuration from @var{config-file},
15249 creates a database cluster with @var{locale} as the default
15250 locale, stored in @var{data-directory}. It then listens on @var{port}.
15251
15252 @cindex postgresql extension-packages
15253 Additional extensions are loaded from packages listed in
15254 @var{extension-packages}. Extensions are available at runtime. For instance,
15255 to create a geographic database using the @code{postgis} extension, a user can
15256 configure the postgresql-service as in this example:
15257
15258 @cindex postgis
15259 @example
15260 (use-package-modules databases geo)
15261
15262 (operating-system
15263 ...
15264 ;; postgresql is required to run `psql' but postgis is not required for
15265 ;; proper operation.
15266 (packages (cons* postgresql %base-packages))
15267 (services
15268 (cons*
15269 (postgresql-service #:extension-packages (list postgis))
15270 %base-services)))
15271 @end example
15272
15273 Then the extension becomes visible and you can initialise an empty geographic
15274 database in this way:
15275
15276 @example
15277 psql -U postgres
15278 > create database postgistest;
15279 > \connect postgistest;
15280 > create extension postgis;
15281 > create extension postgis_topology;
15282 @end example
15283
15284 There is no need to add this field for contrib extensions such as hstore or
15285 dblink as they are already loadable by postgresql. This field is only
15286 required to add extensions provided by other packages.
15287 @end deffn
15288
15289 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} mysql-service [#:config (mysql-configuration)]
15290 Return a service that runs @command{mysqld}, the MySQL or MariaDB
15291 database server.
15292
15293 The optional @var{config} argument specifies the configuration for
15294 @command{mysqld}, which should be a @code{<mysql-configuration>} object.
15295 @end deffn
15296
15297 @deftp {Data Type} mysql-configuration
15298 Data type representing the configuration of @var{mysql-service}.
15299
15300 @table @asis
15301 @item @code{mysql} (default: @var{mariadb})
15302 Package object of the MySQL database server, can be either @var{mariadb}
15303 or @var{mysql}.
15304
15305 For MySQL, a temporary root password will be displayed at activation time.
15306 For MariaDB, the root password is empty.
15307
15308 @item @code{port} (default: @code{3306})
15309 TCP port on which the database server listens for incoming connections.
15310 @end table
15311 @end deftp
15312
15313 @defvr {Scheme Variable} memcached-service-type
15314 This is the service type for the @uref{https://memcached.org/,
15315 Memcached} service, which provides a distributed in memory cache. The
15316 value for the service type is a @code{memcached-configuration} object.
15317 @end defvr
15318
15319 @example
15320 (service memcached-service-type)
15321 @end example
15322
15323 @deftp {Data Type} memcached-configuration
15324 Data type representing the configuration of memcached.
15325
15326 @table @asis
15327 @item @code{memcached} (default: @code{memcached})
15328 The Memcached package to use.
15329
15330 @item @code{interfaces} (default: @code{'("0.0.0.0")})
15331 Network interfaces on which to listen.
15332
15333 @item @code{tcp-port} (default: @code{11211})
15334 Port on which to accept connections on,
15335
15336 @item @code{udp-port} (default: @code{11211})
15337 Port on which to accept UDP connections on, a value of 0 will disable
15338 listening on a UDP socket.
15339
15340 @item @code{additional-options} (default: @code{'()})
15341 Additional command line options to pass to @code{memcached}.
15342 @end table
15343 @end deftp
15344
15345 @defvr {Scheme Variable} mongodb-service-type
15346 This is the service type for @uref{https://www.mongodb.com/, MongoDB}.
15347 The value for the service type is a @code{mongodb-configuration} object.
15348 @end defvr
15349
15350 @example
15351 (service mongodb-service-type)
15352 @end example
15353
15354 @deftp {Data Type} mongodb-configuration
15355 Data type representing the configuration of mongodb.
15356
15357 @table @asis
15358 @item @code{mongodb} (default: @code{mongodb})
15359 The MongoDB package to use.
15360
15361 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{%default-mongodb-configuration-file})
15362 The configuration file for MongoDB.
15363
15364 @item @code{data-directory} (default: @code{"/var/lib/mongodb"})
15365 This value is used to create the directory, so that it exists and is
15366 owned by the mongodb user. It should match the data-directory which
15367 MongoDB is configured to use through the configuration file.
15368 @end table
15369 @end deftp
15370
15371 @defvr {Scheme Variable} redis-service-type
15372 This is the service type for the @uref{https://redis.io/, Redis}
15373 key/value store, whose value is a @code{redis-configuration} object.
15374 @end defvr
15375
15376 @deftp {Data Type} redis-configuration
15377 Data type representing the configuration of redis.
15378
15379 @table @asis
15380 @item @code{redis} (default: @code{redis})
15381 The Redis package to use.
15382
15383 @item @code{bind} (default: @code{"127.0.0.1"})
15384 Network interface on which to listen.
15385
15386 @item @code{port} (default: @code{6379})
15387 Port on which to accept connections on, a value of 0 will disable
15388 listening on a TCP socket.
15389
15390 @item @code{working-directory} (default: @code{"/var/lib/redis"})
15391 Directory in which to store the database and related files.
15392 @end table
15393 @end deftp
15394
15395 @node Mail Services
15396 @subsection Mail Services
15397
15398 @cindex mail
15399 @cindex email
15400 The @code{(gnu services mail)} module provides Guix service definitions
15401 for email services: IMAP, POP3, and LMTP servers, as well as mail
15402 transport agents (MTAs). Lots of acronyms! These services are detailed
15403 in the subsections below.
15404
15405 @subsubheading Dovecot Service
15406
15407 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} dovecot-service [#:config (dovecot-configuration)]
15408 Return a service that runs the Dovecot IMAP/POP3/LMTP mail server.
15409 @end deffn
15410
15411 By default, Dovecot does not need much configuration; the default
15412 configuration object created by @code{(dovecot-configuration)} will
15413 suffice if your mail is delivered to @code{~/Maildir}. A self-signed
15414 certificate will be generated for TLS-protected connections, though
15415 Dovecot will also listen on cleartext ports by default. There are a
15416 number of options, though, which mail administrators might need to change,
15417 and as is the case with other services, Guix allows the system
15418 administrator to specify these parameters via a uniform Scheme interface.
15419
15420 For example, to specify that mail is located at @code{maildir~/.mail},
15421 one would instantiate the Dovecot service like this:
15422
15423 @example
15424 (dovecot-service #:config
15425 (dovecot-configuration
15426 (mail-location "maildir:~/.mail")))
15427 @end example
15428
15429 The available configuration parameters follow. Each parameter
15430 definition is preceded by its type; for example, @samp{string-list foo}
15431 indicates that the @code{foo} parameter should be specified as a list of
15432 strings. There is also a way to specify the configuration as a string,
15433 if you have an old @code{dovecot.conf} file that you want to port over
15434 from some other system; see the end for more details.
15435
15436 @c The following documentation was initially generated by
15437 @c (generate-documentation) in (gnu services mail). Manually maintained
15438 @c documentation is better, so we shouldn't hesitate to edit below as
15439 @c needed. However if the change you want to make to this documentation
15440 @c can be done in an automated way, it's probably easier to change
15441 @c (generate-documentation) than to make it below and have to deal with
15442 @c the churn as dovecot updates.
15443
15444 Available @code{dovecot-configuration} fields are:
15445
15446 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} package dovecot
15447 The dovecot package.
15448 @end deftypevr
15449
15450 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} comma-separated-string-list listen
15451 A list of IPs or hosts where to listen for connections. @samp{*}
15452 listens on all IPv4 interfaces, @samp{::} listens on all IPv6
15453 interfaces. If you want to specify non-default ports or anything more
15454 complex, customize the address and port fields of the
15455 @samp{inet-listener} of the specific services you are interested in.
15456 @end deftypevr
15457
15458 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} protocol-configuration-list protocols
15459 List of protocols we want to serve. Available protocols include
15460 @samp{imap}, @samp{pop3}, and @samp{lmtp}.
15461
15462 Available @code{protocol-configuration} fields are:
15463
15464 @deftypevr {@code{protocol-configuration} parameter} string name
15465 The name of the protocol.
15466 @end deftypevr
15467
15468 @deftypevr {@code{protocol-configuration} parameter} string auth-socket-path
15469 UNIX socket path to the master authentication server to find users.
15470 This is used by imap (for shared users) and lda.
15471 It defaults to @samp{"/var/run/dovecot/auth-userdb"}.
15472 @end deftypevr
15473
15474 @deftypevr {@code{protocol-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list mail-plugins
15475 Space separated list of plugins to load.
15476 @end deftypevr
15477
15478 @deftypevr {@code{protocol-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mail-max-userip-connections
15479 Maximum number of IMAP connections allowed for a user from each IP
15480 address. NOTE: The username is compared case-sensitively.
15481 Defaults to @samp{10}.
15482 @end deftypevr
15483
15484 @end deftypevr
15485
15486 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} service-configuration-list services
15487 List of services to enable. Available services include @samp{imap},
15488 @samp{imap-login}, @samp{pop3}, @samp{pop3-login}, @samp{auth}, and
15489 @samp{lmtp}.
15490
15491 Available @code{service-configuration} fields are:
15492
15493 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} string kind
15494 The service kind. Valid values include @code{director},
15495 @code{imap-login}, @code{pop3-login}, @code{lmtp}, @code{imap},
15496 @code{pop3}, @code{auth}, @code{auth-worker}, @code{dict},
15497 @code{tcpwrap}, @code{quota-warning}, or anything else.
15498 @end deftypevr
15499
15500 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} listener-configuration-list listeners
15501 Listeners for the service. A listener is either a
15502 @code{unix-listener-configuration}, a @code{fifo-listener-configuration}, or
15503 an @code{inet-listener-configuration}.
15504 Defaults to @samp{()}.
15505
15506 Available @code{unix-listener-configuration} fields are:
15507
15508 @deftypevr {@code{unix-listener-configuration} parameter} string path
15509 Path to the file, relative to @code{base-dir} field. This is also used as
15510 the section name.
15511 @end deftypevr
15512
15513 @deftypevr {@code{unix-listener-configuration} parameter} string mode
15514 The access mode for the socket.
15515 Defaults to @samp{"0600"}.
15516 @end deftypevr
15517
15518 @deftypevr {@code{unix-listener-configuration} parameter} string user
15519 The user to own the socket.
15520 Defaults to @samp{""}.
15521 @end deftypevr
15522
15523 @deftypevr {@code{unix-listener-configuration} parameter} string group
15524 The group to own the socket.
15525 Defaults to @samp{""}.
15526 @end deftypevr
15527
15528
15529 Available @code{fifo-listener-configuration} fields are:
15530
15531 @deftypevr {@code{fifo-listener-configuration} parameter} string path
15532 Path to the file, relative to @code{base-dir} field. This is also used as
15533 the section name.
15534 @end deftypevr
15535
15536 @deftypevr {@code{fifo-listener-configuration} parameter} string mode
15537 The access mode for the socket.
15538 Defaults to @samp{"0600"}.
15539 @end deftypevr
15540
15541 @deftypevr {@code{fifo-listener-configuration} parameter} string user
15542 The user to own the socket.
15543 Defaults to @samp{""}.
15544 @end deftypevr
15545
15546 @deftypevr {@code{fifo-listener-configuration} parameter} string group
15547 The group to own the socket.
15548 Defaults to @samp{""}.
15549 @end deftypevr
15550
15551
15552 Available @code{inet-listener-configuration} fields are:
15553
15554 @deftypevr {@code{inet-listener-configuration} parameter} string protocol
15555 The protocol to listen for.
15556 @end deftypevr
15557
15558 @deftypevr {@code{inet-listener-configuration} parameter} string address
15559 The address on which to listen, or empty for all addresses.
15560 Defaults to @samp{""}.
15561 @end deftypevr
15562
15563 @deftypevr {@code{inet-listener-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer port
15564 The port on which to listen.
15565 @end deftypevr
15566
15567 @deftypevr {@code{inet-listener-configuration} parameter} boolean ssl?
15568 Whether to use SSL for this service; @samp{yes}, @samp{no}, or
15569 @samp{required}.
15570 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
15571 @end deftypevr
15572
15573 @end deftypevr
15574
15575 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer client-limit
15576 Maximum number of simultaneous client connections per process. Once
15577 this number of connections is received, the next incoming connection
15578 will prompt Dovecot to spawn another process. If set to 0,
15579 @code{default-client-limit} is used instead.
15580
15581 Defaults to @samp{0}.
15582
15583 @end deftypevr
15584
15585 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer service-count
15586 Number of connections to handle before starting a new process.
15587 Typically the only useful values are 0 (unlimited) or 1. 1 is more
15588 secure, but 0 is faster. <doc/wiki/LoginProcess.txt>.
15589 Defaults to @samp{1}.
15590
15591 @end deftypevr
15592
15593 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer process-limit
15594 Maximum number of processes that can exist for this service. If set to
15595 0, @code{default-process-limit} is used instead.
15596
15597 Defaults to @samp{0}.
15598
15599 @end deftypevr
15600
15601 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer process-min-avail
15602 Number of processes to always keep waiting for more connections.
15603 Defaults to @samp{0}.
15604 @end deftypevr
15605
15606 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer vsz-limit
15607 If you set @samp{service-count 0}, you probably need to grow
15608 this.
15609 Defaults to @samp{256000000}.
15610 @end deftypevr
15611
15612 @end deftypevr
15613
15614 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} dict-configuration dict
15615 Dict configuration, as created by the @code{dict-configuration}
15616 constructor.
15617
15618 Available @code{dict-configuration} fields are:
15619
15620 @deftypevr {@code{dict-configuration} parameter} free-form-fields entries
15621 A list of key-value pairs that this dict should hold.
15622 Defaults to @samp{()}.
15623 @end deftypevr
15624
15625 @end deftypevr
15626
15627 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} passdb-configuration-list passdbs
15628 A list of passdb configurations, each one created by the
15629 @code{passdb-configuration} constructor.
15630
15631 Available @code{passdb-configuration} fields are:
15632
15633 @deftypevr {@code{passdb-configuration} parameter} string driver
15634 The driver that the passdb should use. Valid values include
15635 @samp{pam}, @samp{passwd}, @samp{shadow}, @samp{bsdauth}, and
15636 @samp{static}.
15637 Defaults to @samp{"pam"}.
15638 @end deftypevr
15639
15640 @deftypevr {@code{passdb-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list args
15641 Space separated list of arguments to the passdb driver.
15642 Defaults to @samp{""}.
15643 @end deftypevr
15644
15645 @end deftypevr
15646
15647 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} userdb-configuration-list userdbs
15648 List of userdb configurations, each one created by the
15649 @code{userdb-configuration} constructor.
15650
15651 Available @code{userdb-configuration} fields are:
15652
15653 @deftypevr {@code{userdb-configuration} parameter} string driver
15654 The driver that the userdb should use. Valid values include
15655 @samp{passwd} and @samp{static}.
15656 Defaults to @samp{"passwd"}.
15657 @end deftypevr
15658
15659 @deftypevr {@code{userdb-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list args
15660 Space separated list of arguments to the userdb driver.
15661 Defaults to @samp{""}.
15662 @end deftypevr
15663
15664 @deftypevr {@code{userdb-configuration} parameter} free-form-args override-fields
15665 Override fields from passwd.
15666 Defaults to @samp{()}.
15667 @end deftypevr
15668
15669 @end deftypevr
15670
15671 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} plugin-configuration plugin-configuration
15672 Plug-in configuration, created by the @code{plugin-configuration}
15673 constructor.
15674 @end deftypevr
15675
15676 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} list-of-namespace-configuration namespaces
15677 List of namespaces. Each item in the list is created by the
15678 @code{namespace-configuration} constructor.
15679
15680 Available @code{namespace-configuration} fields are:
15681
15682 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string name
15683 Name for this namespace.
15684 @end deftypevr
15685
15686 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string type
15687 Namespace type: @samp{private}, @samp{shared} or @samp{public}.
15688 Defaults to @samp{"private"}.
15689 @end deftypevr
15690
15691 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string separator
15692 Hierarchy separator to use. You should use the same separator for
15693 all namespaces or some clients get confused. @samp{/} is usually a good
15694 one. The default however depends on the underlying mail storage
15695 format.
15696 Defaults to @samp{""}.
15697 @end deftypevr
15698
15699 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string prefix
15700 Prefix required to access this namespace. This needs to be
15701 different for all namespaces. For example @samp{Public/}.
15702 Defaults to @samp{""}.
15703 @end deftypevr
15704
15705 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string location
15706 Physical location of the mailbox. This is in the same format as
15707 mail_location, which is also the default for it.
15708 Defaults to @samp{""}.
15709 @end deftypevr
15710
15711 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} boolean inbox?
15712 There can be only one INBOX, and this setting defines which
15713 namespace has it.
15714 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
15715 @end deftypevr
15716
15717 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} boolean hidden?
15718 If namespace is hidden, it's not advertised to clients via NAMESPACE
15719 extension. You'll most likely also want to set @samp{list? #f}. This is mostly
15720 useful when converting from another server with different namespaces
15721 which you want to deprecate but still keep working. For example you can
15722 create hidden namespaces with prefixes @samp{~/mail/}, @samp{~%u/mail/}
15723 and @samp{mail/}.
15724 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
15725 @end deftypevr
15726
15727 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} boolean list?
15728 Show the mailboxes under this namespace with the LIST command. This
15729 makes the namespace visible for clients that do not support the NAMESPACE
15730 extension. The special @code{children} value lists child mailboxes, but
15731 hides the namespace prefix.
15732 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
15733 @end deftypevr
15734
15735 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} boolean subscriptions?
15736 Namespace handles its own subscriptions. If set to @code{#f}, the
15737 parent namespace handles them. The empty prefix should always have this
15738 as @code{#t}).
15739 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
15740 @end deftypevr
15741
15742 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} mailbox-configuration-list mailboxes
15743 List of predefined mailboxes in this namespace.
15744 Defaults to @samp{()}.
15745
15746 Available @code{mailbox-configuration} fields are:
15747
15748 @deftypevr {@code{mailbox-configuration} parameter} string name
15749 Name for this mailbox.
15750 @end deftypevr
15751
15752 @deftypevr {@code{mailbox-configuration} parameter} string auto
15753 @samp{create} will automatically create this mailbox.
15754 @samp{subscribe} will both create and subscribe to the mailbox.
15755 Defaults to @samp{"no"}.
15756 @end deftypevr
15757
15758 @deftypevr {@code{mailbox-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list special-use
15759 List of IMAP @code{SPECIAL-USE} attributes as specified by RFC 6154.
15760 Valid values are @code{\All}, @code{\Archive}, @code{\Drafts},
15761 @code{\Flagged}, @code{\Junk}, @code{\Sent}, and @code{\Trash}.
15762 Defaults to @samp{()}.
15763 @end deftypevr
15764
15765 @end deftypevr
15766
15767 @end deftypevr
15768
15769 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name base-dir
15770 Base directory where to store runtime data.
15771 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/dovecot/"}.
15772 @end deftypevr
15773
15774 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string login-greeting
15775 Greeting message for clients.
15776 Defaults to @samp{"Dovecot ready."}.
15777 @end deftypevr
15778
15779 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list login-trusted-networks
15780 List of trusted network ranges. Connections from these IPs are
15781 allowed to override their IP addresses and ports (for logging and for
15782 authentication checks). @samp{disable-plaintext-auth} is also ignored
15783 for these networks. Typically you would specify your IMAP proxy servers
15784 here.
15785 Defaults to @samp{()}.
15786 @end deftypevr
15787
15788 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list login-access-sockets
15789 List of login access check sockets (e.g.@: tcpwrap).
15790 Defaults to @samp{()}.
15791 @end deftypevr
15792
15793 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean verbose-proctitle?
15794 Show more verbose process titles (in ps). Currently shows user name
15795 and IP address. Useful for seeing who is actually using the IMAP
15796 processes (e.g.@: shared mailboxes or if the same uid is used for multiple
15797 accounts).
15798 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
15799 @end deftypevr
15800
15801 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean shutdown-clients?
15802 Should all processes be killed when Dovecot master process shuts down.
15803 Setting this to @code{#f} means that Dovecot can be upgraded without
15804 forcing existing client connections to close (although that could also
15805 be a problem if the upgrade is e.g.@: due to a security fix).
15806 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
15807 @end deftypevr
15808
15809 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer doveadm-worker-count
15810 If non-zero, run mail commands via this many connections to doveadm
15811 server, instead of running them directly in the same process.
15812 Defaults to @samp{0}.
15813 @end deftypevr
15814
15815 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string doveadm-socket-path
15816 UNIX socket or host:port used for connecting to doveadm server.
15817 Defaults to @samp{"doveadm-server"}.
15818 @end deftypevr
15819
15820 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list import-environment
15821 List of environment variables that are preserved on Dovecot startup
15822 and passed down to all of its child processes. You can also give
15823 key=value pairs to always set specific settings.
15824 @end deftypevr
15825
15826 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean disable-plaintext-auth?
15827 Disable LOGIN command and all other plaintext authentications unless
15828 SSL/TLS is used (LOGINDISABLED capability). Note that if the remote IP
15829 matches the local IP (i.e.@: you're connecting from the same computer),
15830 the connection is considered secure and plaintext authentication is
15831 allowed. See also ssl=required setting.
15832 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
15833 @end deftypevr
15834
15835 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer auth-cache-size
15836 Authentication cache size (e.g.@: @samp{#e10e6}). 0 means it's disabled.
15837 Note that bsdauth, PAM and vpopmail require @samp{cache-key} to be set
15838 for caching to be used.
15839 Defaults to @samp{0}.
15840 @end deftypevr
15841
15842 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-cache-ttl
15843 Time to live for cached data. After TTL expires the cached record
15844 is no longer used, *except* if the main database lookup returns internal
15845 failure. We also try to handle password changes automatically: If
15846 user's previous authentication was successful, but this one wasn't, the
15847 cache isn't used. For now this works only with plaintext
15848 authentication.
15849 Defaults to @samp{"1 hour"}.
15850 @end deftypevr
15851
15852 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-cache-negative-ttl
15853 TTL for negative hits (user not found, password mismatch).
15854 0 disables caching them completely.
15855 Defaults to @samp{"1 hour"}.
15856 @end deftypevr
15857
15858 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list auth-realms
15859 List of realms for SASL authentication mechanisms that need them.
15860 You can leave it empty if you don't want to support multiple realms.
15861 Many clients simply use the first one listed here, so keep the default
15862 realm first.
15863 Defaults to @samp{()}.
15864 @end deftypevr
15865
15866 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-default-realm
15867 Default realm/domain to use if none was specified. This is used for
15868 both SASL realms and appending @@domain to username in plaintext
15869 logins.
15870 Defaults to @samp{""}.
15871 @end deftypevr
15872
15873 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-username-chars
15874 List of allowed characters in username. If the user-given username
15875 contains a character not listed in here, the login automatically fails.
15876 This is just an extra check to make sure user can't exploit any
15877 potential quote escaping vulnerabilities with SQL/LDAP databases. If
15878 you want to allow all characters, set this value to empty.
15879 Defaults to @samp{"abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ01234567890.-_@@"}.
15880 @end deftypevr
15881
15882 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-username-translation
15883 Username character translations before it's looked up from
15884 databases. The value contains series of from -> to characters. For
15885 example @samp{#@@/@@} means that @samp{#} and @samp{/} characters are
15886 translated to @samp{@@}.
15887 Defaults to @samp{""}.
15888 @end deftypevr
15889
15890 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-username-format
15891 Username formatting before it's looked up from databases. You can
15892 use the standard variables here, e.g.@: %Lu would lowercase the username,
15893 %n would drop away the domain if it was given, or @samp{%n-AT-%d} would
15894 change the @samp{@@} into @samp{-AT-}. This translation is done after
15895 @samp{auth-username-translation} changes.
15896 Defaults to @samp{"%Lu"}.
15897 @end deftypevr
15898
15899 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-master-user-separator
15900 If you want to allow master users to log in by specifying the master
15901 username within the normal username string (i.e.@: not using SASL
15902 mechanism's support for it), you can specify the separator character
15903 here. The format is then <username><separator><master username>.
15904 UW-IMAP uses @samp{*} as the separator, so that could be a good
15905 choice.
15906 Defaults to @samp{""}.
15907 @end deftypevr
15908
15909 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-anonymous-username
15910 Username to use for users logging in with ANONYMOUS SASL
15911 mechanism.
15912 Defaults to @samp{"anonymous"}.
15913 @end deftypevr
15914
15915 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer auth-worker-max-count
15916 Maximum number of dovecot-auth worker processes. They're used to
15917 execute blocking passdb and userdb queries (e.g.@: MySQL and PAM).
15918 They're automatically created and destroyed as needed.
15919 Defaults to @samp{30}.
15920 @end deftypevr
15921
15922 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-gssapi-hostname
15923 Host name to use in GSSAPI principal names. The default is to use
15924 the name returned by gethostname(). Use @samp{$ALL} (with quotes) to
15925 allow all keytab entries.
15926 Defaults to @samp{""}.
15927 @end deftypevr
15928
15929 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-krb5-keytab
15930 Kerberos keytab to use for the GSSAPI mechanism. Will use the
15931 system default (usually @file{/etc/krb5.keytab}) if not specified. You may
15932 need to change the auth service to run as root to be able to read this
15933 file.
15934 Defaults to @samp{""}.
15935 @end deftypevr
15936
15937 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-use-winbind?
15938 Do NTLM and GSS-SPNEGO authentication using Samba's winbind daemon
15939 and @samp{ntlm-auth} helper.
15940 <doc/wiki/Authentication/Mechanisms/Winbind.txt>.
15941 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
15942 @end deftypevr
15943
15944 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name auth-winbind-helper-path
15945 Path for Samba's @samp{ntlm-auth} helper binary.
15946 Defaults to @samp{"/usr/bin/ntlm_auth"}.
15947 @end deftypevr
15948
15949 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-failure-delay
15950 Time to delay before replying to failed authentications.
15951 Defaults to @samp{"2 secs"}.
15952 @end deftypevr
15953
15954 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-ssl-require-client-cert?
15955 Require a valid SSL client certificate or the authentication
15956 fails.
15957 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
15958 @end deftypevr
15959
15960 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-ssl-username-from-cert?
15961 Take the username from client's SSL certificate, using
15962 @code{X509_NAME_get_text_by_NID()} which returns the subject's DN's
15963 CommonName.
15964 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
15965 @end deftypevr
15966
15967 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list auth-mechanisms
15968 List of wanted authentication mechanisms. Supported mechanisms are:
15969 @samp{plain}, @samp{login}, @samp{digest-md5}, @samp{cram-md5},
15970 @samp{ntlm}, @samp{rpa}, @samp{apop}, @samp{anonymous}, @samp{gssapi},
15971 @samp{otp}, @samp{skey}, and @samp{gss-spnego}. NOTE: See also
15972 @samp{disable-plaintext-auth} setting.
15973 @end deftypevr
15974
15975 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list director-servers
15976 List of IPs or hostnames to all director servers, including ourself.
15977 Ports can be specified as ip:port. The default port is the same as what
15978 director service's @samp{inet-listener} is using.
15979 Defaults to @samp{()}.
15980 @end deftypevr
15981
15982 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list director-mail-servers
15983 List of IPs or hostnames to all backend mail servers. Ranges are
15984 allowed too, like 10.0.0.10-10.0.0.30.
15985 Defaults to @samp{()}.
15986 @end deftypevr
15987
15988 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string director-user-expire
15989 How long to redirect users to a specific server after it no longer
15990 has any connections.
15991 Defaults to @samp{"15 min"}.
15992 @end deftypevr
15993
15994 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string director-username-hash
15995 How the username is translated before being hashed. Useful values
15996 include %Ln if user can log in with or without @@domain, %Ld if mailboxes
15997 are shared within domain.
15998 Defaults to @samp{"%Lu"}.
15999 @end deftypevr
16000
16001 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string log-path
16002 Log file to use for error messages. @samp{syslog} logs to syslog,
16003 @samp{/dev/stderr} logs to stderr.
16004 Defaults to @samp{"syslog"}.
16005 @end deftypevr
16006
16007 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string info-log-path
16008 Log file to use for informational messages. Defaults to
16009 @samp{log-path}.
16010 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16011 @end deftypevr
16012
16013 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string debug-log-path
16014 Log file to use for debug messages. Defaults to
16015 @samp{info-log-path}.
16016 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16017 @end deftypevr
16018
16019 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string syslog-facility
16020 Syslog facility to use if you're logging to syslog. Usually if you
16021 don't want to use @samp{mail}, you'll use local0..local7. Also other
16022 standard facilities are supported.
16023 Defaults to @samp{"mail"}.
16024 @end deftypevr
16025
16026 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-verbose?
16027 Log unsuccessful authentication attempts and the reasons why they
16028 failed.
16029 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16030 @end deftypevr
16031
16032 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-verbose-passwords
16033 In case of password mismatches, log the attempted password. Valid
16034 values are no, plain and sha1. sha1 can be useful for detecting brute
16035 force password attempts vs. user simply trying the same password over
16036 and over again. You can also truncate the value to n chars by appending
16037 ":n" (e.g.@: sha1:6).
16038 Defaults to @samp{"no"}.
16039 @end deftypevr
16040
16041 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-debug?
16042 Even more verbose logging for debugging purposes. Shows for example
16043 SQL queries.
16044 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16045 @end deftypevr
16046
16047 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-debug-passwords?
16048 In case of password mismatches, log the passwords and used scheme so
16049 the problem can be debugged. Enabling this also enables
16050 @samp{auth-debug}.
16051 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16052 @end deftypevr
16053
16054 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-debug?
16055 Enable mail process debugging. This can help you figure out why
16056 Dovecot isn't finding your mails.
16057 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16058 @end deftypevr
16059
16060 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean verbose-ssl?
16061 Show protocol level SSL errors.
16062 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16063 @end deftypevr
16064
16065 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string log-timestamp
16066 Prefix for each line written to log file. % codes are in
16067 strftime(3) format.
16068 Defaults to @samp{"\"%b %d %H:%M:%S \""}.
16069 @end deftypevr
16070
16071 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list login-log-format-elements
16072 List of elements we want to log. The elements which have a
16073 non-empty variable value are joined together to form a comma-separated
16074 string.
16075 @end deftypevr
16076
16077 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string login-log-format
16078 Login log format. %s contains @samp{login-log-format-elements}
16079 string, %$ contains the data we want to log.
16080 Defaults to @samp{"%$: %s"}.
16081 @end deftypevr
16082
16083 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-log-prefix
16084 Log prefix for mail processes. See doc/wiki/Variables.txt for list
16085 of possible variables you can use.
16086 Defaults to @samp{"\"%s(%u)<%@{pid@}><%@{session@}>: \""}.
16087 @end deftypevr
16088
16089 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string deliver-log-format
16090 Format to use for logging mail deliveries. You can use variables:
16091 @table @code
16092 @item %$
16093 Delivery status message (e.g.@: @samp{saved to INBOX})
16094 @item %m
16095 Message-ID
16096 @item %s
16097 Subject
16098 @item %f
16099 From address
16100 @item %p
16101 Physical size
16102 @item %w
16103 Virtual size.
16104 @end table
16105 Defaults to @samp{"msgid=%m: %$"}.
16106 @end deftypevr
16107
16108 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-location
16109 Location for users' mailboxes. The default is empty, which means
16110 that Dovecot tries to find the mailboxes automatically. This won't work
16111 if the user doesn't yet have any mail, so you should explicitly tell
16112 Dovecot the full location.
16113
16114 If you're using mbox, giving a path to the INBOX
16115 file (e.g.@: /var/mail/%u) isn't enough. You'll also need to tell Dovecot
16116 where the other mailboxes are kept. This is called the "root mail
16117 directory", and it must be the first path given in the
16118 @samp{mail-location} setting.
16119
16120 There are a few special variables you can use, eg.:
16121
16122 @table @samp
16123 @item %u
16124 username
16125 @item %n
16126 user part in user@@domain, same as %u if there's no domain
16127 @item %d
16128 domain part in user@@domain, empty if there's no domain
16129 @item %h
16130 home director
16131 @end table
16132
16133 See doc/wiki/Variables.txt for full list. Some examples:
16134 @table @samp
16135 @item maildir:~/Maildir
16136 @item mbox:~/mail:INBOX=/var/mail/%u
16137 @item mbox:/var/mail/%d/%1n/%n:INDEX=/var/indexes/%d/%1n/%
16138 @end table
16139 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16140 @end deftypevr
16141
16142 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-uid
16143 System user and group used to access mails. If you use multiple,
16144 userdb can override these by returning uid or gid fields. You can use
16145 either numbers or names. <doc/wiki/UserIds.txt>.
16146 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16147 @end deftypevr
16148
16149 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-gid
16150
16151 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16152 @end deftypevr
16153
16154 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-privileged-group
16155 Group to enable temporarily for privileged operations. Currently
16156 this is used only with INBOX when either its initial creation or
16157 dotlocking fails. Typically this is set to "mail" to give access to
16158 /var/mail.
16159 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16160 @end deftypevr
16161
16162 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-access-groups
16163 Grant access to these supplementary groups for mail processes.
16164 Typically these are used to set up access to shared mailboxes. Note
16165 that it may be dangerous to set these if users can create
16166 symlinks (e.g.@: if "mail" group is set here, ln -s /var/mail ~/mail/var
16167 could allow a user to delete others' mailboxes, or ln -s
16168 /secret/shared/box ~/mail/mybox would allow reading it).
16169 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16170 @end deftypevr
16171
16172 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-full-filesystem-access?
16173 Allow full file system access to clients. There's no access checks
16174 other than what the operating system does for the active UID/GID. It
16175 works with both maildir and mboxes, allowing you to prefix mailboxes
16176 names with e.g.@: /path/ or ~user/.
16177 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16178 @end deftypevr
16179
16180 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mmap-disable?
16181 Don't use mmap() at all. This is required if you store indexes to
16182 shared file systems (NFS or clustered file system).
16183 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16184 @end deftypevr
16185
16186 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean dotlock-use-excl?
16187 Rely on @samp{O_EXCL} to work when creating dotlock files. NFS
16188 supports @samp{O_EXCL} since version 3, so this should be safe to use
16189 nowadays by default.
16190 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
16191 @end deftypevr
16192
16193 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-fsync
16194 When to use fsync() or fdatasync() calls:
16195 @table @code
16196 @item optimized
16197 Whenever necessary to avoid losing important data
16198 @item always
16199 Useful with e.g.@: NFS when write()s are delayed
16200 @item never
16201 Never use it (best performance, but crashes can lose data).
16202 @end table
16203 Defaults to @samp{"optimized"}.
16204 @end deftypevr
16205
16206 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-nfs-storage?
16207 Mail storage exists in NFS. Set this to yes to make Dovecot flush
16208 NFS caches whenever needed. If you're using only a single mail server
16209 this isn't needed.
16210 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16211 @end deftypevr
16212
16213 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-nfs-index?
16214 Mail index files also exist in NFS. Setting this to yes requires
16215 @samp{mmap-disable? #t} and @samp{fsync-disable? #f}.
16216 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16217 @end deftypevr
16218
16219 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string lock-method
16220 Locking method for index files. Alternatives are fcntl, flock and
16221 dotlock. Dotlocking uses some tricks which may create more disk I/O
16222 than other locking methods. NFS users: flock doesn't work, remember to
16223 change @samp{mmap-disable}.
16224 Defaults to @samp{"fcntl"}.
16225 @end deftypevr
16226
16227 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name mail-temp-dir
16228 Directory in which LDA/LMTP temporarily stores incoming mails >128
16229 kB.
16230 Defaults to @samp{"/tmp"}.
16231 @end deftypevr
16232
16233 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer first-valid-uid
16234 Valid UID range for users. This is mostly to make sure that users can't
16235 log in as daemons or other system users. Note that denying root logins is
16236 hardcoded to dovecot binary and can't be done even if @samp{first-valid-uid}
16237 is set to 0.
16238 Defaults to @samp{500}.
16239 @end deftypevr
16240
16241 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer last-valid-uid
16242
16243 Defaults to @samp{0}.
16244 @end deftypevr
16245
16246 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer first-valid-gid
16247 Valid GID range for users. Users having non-valid GID as primary group ID
16248 aren't allowed to log in. If user belongs to supplementary groups with
16249 non-valid GIDs, those groups are not set.
16250 Defaults to @samp{1}.
16251 @end deftypevr
16252
16253 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer last-valid-gid
16254
16255 Defaults to @samp{0}.
16256 @end deftypevr
16257
16258 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mail-max-keyword-length
16259 Maximum allowed length for mail keyword name. It's only forced when
16260 trying to create new keywords.
16261 Defaults to @samp{50}.
16262 @end deftypevr
16263
16264 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} colon-separated-file-name-list valid-chroot-dirs
16265 List of directories under which chrooting is allowed for mail
16266 processes (i.e.@: /var/mail will allow chrooting to /var/mail/foo/bar
16267 too). This setting doesn't affect @samp{login-chroot}
16268 @samp{mail-chroot} or auth chroot settings. If this setting is empty,
16269 "/./" in home dirs are ignored. WARNING: Never add directories here
16270 which local users can modify, that may lead to root exploit. Usually
16271 this should be done only if you don't allow shell access for users.
16272 <doc/wiki/Chrooting.txt>.
16273 Defaults to @samp{()}.
16274 @end deftypevr
16275
16276 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-chroot
16277 Default chroot directory for mail processes. This can be overridden
16278 for specific users in user database by giving /./ in user's home
16279 directory (e.g.@: /home/./user chroots into /home). Note that usually
16280 there is no real need to do chrooting, Dovecot doesn't allow users to
16281 access files outside their mail directory anyway. If your home
16282 directories are prefixed with the chroot directory, append "/."@: to
16283 @samp{mail-chroot}. <doc/wiki/Chrooting.txt>.
16284 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16285 @end deftypevr
16286
16287 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name auth-socket-path
16288 UNIX socket path to master authentication server to find users.
16289 This is used by imap (for shared users) and lda.
16290 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/dovecot/auth-userdb"}.
16291 @end deftypevr
16292
16293 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name mail-plugin-dir
16294 Directory where to look up mail plugins.
16295 Defaults to @samp{"/usr/lib/dovecot"}.
16296 @end deftypevr
16297
16298 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list mail-plugins
16299 List of plugins to load for all services. Plugins specific to IMAP,
16300 LDA, etc.@: are added to this list in their own .conf files.
16301 Defaults to @samp{()}.
16302 @end deftypevr
16303
16304 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mail-cache-min-mail-count
16305 The minimum number of mails in a mailbox before updates are done to
16306 cache file. This allows optimizing Dovecot's behavior to do less disk
16307 writes at the cost of more disk reads.
16308 Defaults to @samp{0}.
16309 @end deftypevr
16310
16311 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mailbox-idle-check-interval
16312 When IDLE command is running, mailbox is checked once in a while to
16313 see if there are any new mails or other changes. This setting defines
16314 the minimum time to wait between those checks. Dovecot can also use
16315 dnotify, inotify and kqueue to find out immediately when changes
16316 occur.
16317 Defaults to @samp{"30 secs"}.
16318 @end deftypevr
16319
16320 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-save-crlf?
16321 Save mails with CR+LF instead of plain LF. This makes sending those
16322 mails take less CPU, especially with sendfile() syscall with Linux and
16323 FreeBSD. But it also creates a bit more disk I/O which may just make it
16324 slower. Also note that if other software reads the mboxes/maildirs,
16325 they may handle the extra CRs wrong and cause problems.
16326 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16327 @end deftypevr
16328
16329 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean maildir-stat-dirs?
16330 By default LIST command returns all entries in maildir beginning
16331 with a dot. Enabling this option makes Dovecot return only entries
16332 which are directories. This is done by stat()ing each entry, so it
16333 causes more disk I/O.
16334 (For systems setting struct @samp{dirent->d_type} this check is free
16335 and it's done always regardless of this setting).
16336 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16337 @end deftypevr
16338
16339 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean maildir-copy-with-hardlinks?
16340 When copying a message, do it with hard links whenever possible.
16341 This makes the performance much better, and it's unlikely to have any
16342 side effects.
16343 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
16344 @end deftypevr
16345
16346 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean maildir-very-dirty-syncs?
16347 Assume Dovecot is the only MUA accessing Maildir: Scan cur/
16348 directory only when its mtime changes unexpectedly or when we can't find
16349 the mail otherwise.
16350 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16351 @end deftypevr
16352
16353 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list mbox-read-locks
16354 Which locking methods to use for locking mbox. There are four
16355 available:
16356
16357 @table @code
16358 @item dotlock
16359 Create <mailbox>.lock file. This is the oldest and most NFS-safe
16360 solution. If you want to use /var/mail/ like directory, the users will
16361 need write access to that directory.
16362 @item dotlock-try
16363 Same as dotlock, but if it fails because of permissions or because there
16364 isn't enough disk space, just skip it.
16365 @item fcntl
16366 Use this if possible. Works with NFS too if lockd is used.
16367 @item flock
16368 May not exist in all systems. Doesn't work with NFS.
16369 @item lockf
16370 May not exist in all systems. Doesn't work with NFS.
16371 @end table
16372
16373 You can use multiple locking methods; if you do the order they're declared
16374 in is important to avoid deadlocks if other MTAs/MUAs are using multiple
16375 locking methods as well. Some operating systems don't allow using some of
16376 them simultaneously.
16377 @end deftypevr
16378
16379 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list mbox-write-locks
16380
16381 @end deftypevr
16382
16383 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mbox-lock-timeout
16384 Maximum time to wait for lock (all of them) before aborting.
16385 Defaults to @samp{"5 mins"}.
16386 @end deftypevr
16387
16388 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mbox-dotlock-change-timeout
16389 If dotlock exists but the mailbox isn't modified in any way,
16390 override the lock file after this much time.
16391 Defaults to @samp{"2 mins"}.
16392 @end deftypevr
16393
16394 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mbox-dirty-syncs?
16395 When mbox changes unexpectedly we have to fully read it to find out
16396 what changed. If the mbox is large this can take a long time. Since
16397 the change is usually just a newly appended mail, it'd be faster to
16398 simply read the new mails. If this setting is enabled, Dovecot does
16399 this but still safely fallbacks to re-reading the whole mbox file
16400 whenever something in mbox isn't how it's expected to be. The only real
16401 downside to this setting is that if some other MUA changes message
16402 flags, Dovecot doesn't notice it immediately. Note that a full sync is
16403 done with SELECT, EXAMINE, EXPUNGE and CHECK commands.
16404 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
16405 @end deftypevr
16406
16407 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mbox-very-dirty-syncs?
16408 Like @samp{mbox-dirty-syncs}, but don't do full syncs even with SELECT,
16409 EXAMINE, EXPUNGE or CHECK commands. If this is set,
16410 @samp{mbox-dirty-syncs} is ignored.
16411 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16412 @end deftypevr
16413
16414 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mbox-lazy-writes?
16415 Delay writing mbox headers until doing a full write sync (EXPUNGE
16416 and CHECK commands and when closing the mailbox). This is especially
16417 useful for POP3 where clients often delete all mails. The downside is
16418 that our changes aren't immediately visible to other MUAs.
16419 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
16420 @end deftypevr
16421
16422 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mbox-min-index-size
16423 If mbox size is smaller than this (e.g.@: 100k), don't write index
16424 files. If an index file already exists it's still read, just not
16425 updated.
16426 Defaults to @samp{0}.
16427 @end deftypevr
16428
16429 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mdbox-rotate-size
16430 Maximum dbox file size until it's rotated.
16431 Defaults to @samp{10000000}.
16432 @end deftypevr
16433
16434 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mdbox-rotate-interval
16435 Maximum dbox file age until it's rotated. Typically in days. Day
16436 begins from midnight, so 1d = today, 2d = yesterday, etc. 0 = check
16437 disabled.
16438 Defaults to @samp{"1d"}.
16439 @end deftypevr
16440
16441 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mdbox-preallocate-space?
16442 When creating new mdbox files, immediately preallocate their size to
16443 @samp{mdbox-rotate-size}. This setting currently works only in Linux
16444 with some file systems (ext4, xfs).
16445 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16446 @end deftypevr
16447
16448 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-attachment-dir
16449 sdbox and mdbox support saving mail attachments to external files,
16450 which also allows single instance storage for them. Other backends
16451 don't support this for now.
16452
16453 WARNING: This feature hasn't been tested much yet. Use at your own risk.
16454
16455 Directory root where to store mail attachments. Disabled, if empty.
16456 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16457 @end deftypevr
16458
16459 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mail-attachment-min-size
16460 Attachments smaller than this aren't saved externally. It's also
16461 possible to write a plugin to disable saving specific attachments
16462 externally.
16463 Defaults to @samp{128000}.
16464 @end deftypevr
16465
16466 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-attachment-fs
16467 File system backend to use for saving attachments:
16468 @table @code
16469 @item posix
16470 No SiS done by Dovecot (but this might help FS's own deduplication)
16471 @item sis posix
16472 SiS with immediate byte-by-byte comparison during saving
16473 @item sis-queue posix
16474 SiS with delayed comparison and deduplication.
16475 @end table
16476 Defaults to @samp{"sis posix"}.
16477 @end deftypevr
16478
16479 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-attachment-hash
16480 Hash format to use in attachment filenames. You can add any text and
16481 variables: @code{%@{md4@}}, @code{%@{md5@}}, @code{%@{sha1@}},
16482 @code{%@{sha256@}}, @code{%@{sha512@}}, @code{%@{size@}}. Variables can be
16483 truncated, e.g.@: @code{%@{sha256:80@}} returns only first 80 bits.
16484 Defaults to @samp{"%@{sha1@}"}.
16485 @end deftypevr
16486
16487 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer default-process-limit
16488
16489 Defaults to @samp{100}.
16490 @end deftypevr
16491
16492 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer default-client-limit
16493
16494 Defaults to @samp{1000}.
16495 @end deftypevr
16496
16497 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer default-vsz-limit
16498 Default VSZ (virtual memory size) limit for service processes.
16499 This is mainly intended to catch and kill processes that leak memory
16500 before they eat up everything.
16501 Defaults to @samp{256000000}.
16502 @end deftypevr
16503
16504 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string default-login-user
16505 Login user is internally used by login processes. This is the most
16506 untrusted user in Dovecot system. It shouldn't have access to anything
16507 at all.
16508 Defaults to @samp{"dovenull"}.
16509 @end deftypevr
16510
16511 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string default-internal-user
16512 Internal user is used by unprivileged processes. It should be
16513 separate from login user, so that login processes can't disturb other
16514 processes.
16515 Defaults to @samp{"dovecot"}.
16516 @end deftypevr
16517
16518 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl?
16519 SSL/TLS support: yes, no, required. <doc/wiki/SSL.txt>.
16520 Defaults to @samp{"required"}.
16521 @end deftypevr
16522
16523 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-cert
16524 PEM encoded X.509 SSL/TLS certificate (public key).
16525 Defaults to @samp{"</etc/dovecot/default.pem"}.
16526 @end deftypevr
16527
16528 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-key
16529 PEM encoded SSL/TLS private key. The key is opened before
16530 dropping root privileges, so keep the key file unreadable by anyone but
16531 root.
16532 Defaults to @samp{"</etc/dovecot/private/default.pem"}.
16533 @end deftypevr
16534
16535 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-key-password
16536 If key file is password protected, give the password here.
16537 Alternatively give it when starting dovecot with -p parameter. Since
16538 this file is often world-readable, you may want to place this setting
16539 instead to a different.
16540 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16541 @end deftypevr
16542
16543 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-ca
16544 PEM encoded trusted certificate authority. Set this only if you
16545 intend to use @samp{ssl-verify-client-cert? #t}. The file should
16546 contain the CA certificate(s) followed by the matching
16547 CRL(s). (e.g.@: @samp{ssl-ca </etc/ssl/certs/ca.pem}).
16548 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16549 @end deftypevr
16550
16551 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean ssl-require-crl?
16552 Require that CRL check succeeds for client certificates.
16553 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
16554 @end deftypevr
16555
16556 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean ssl-verify-client-cert?
16557 Request client to send a certificate. If you also want to require
16558 it, set @samp{auth-ssl-require-client-cert? #t} in auth section.
16559 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16560 @end deftypevr
16561
16562 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-cert-username-field
16563 Which field from certificate to use for username. commonName and
16564 x500UniqueIdentifier are the usual choices. You'll also need to set
16565 @samp{auth-ssl-username-from-cert? #t}.
16566 Defaults to @samp{"commonName"}.
16567 @end deftypevr
16568
16569 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-min-protocol
16570 Minimum SSL protocol version to accept.
16571 Defaults to @samp{"TLSv1"}.
16572 @end deftypevr
16573
16574 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-cipher-list
16575 SSL ciphers to use.
16576 Defaults to @samp{"ALL:!kRSA:!SRP:!kDHd:!DSS:!aNULL:!eNULL:!EXPORT:!DES:!3DES:!MD5:!PSK:!RC4:!ADH:!LOW@@STRENGTH"}.
16577 @end deftypevr
16578
16579 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-crypto-device
16580 SSL crypto device to use, for valid values run "openssl engine".
16581 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16582 @end deftypevr
16583
16584 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string postmaster-address
16585 Address to use when sending rejection mails.
16586 %d expands to recipient domain.
16587 Defaults to @samp{"postmaster@@%d"}.
16588 @end deftypevr
16589
16590 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string hostname
16591 Hostname to use in various parts of sent mails (e.g.@: in Message-Id)
16592 and in LMTP replies. Default is the system's real hostname@@domain.
16593 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16594 @end deftypevr
16595
16596 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean quota-full-tempfail?
16597 If user is over quota, return with temporary failure instead of
16598 bouncing the mail.
16599 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16600 @end deftypevr
16601
16602 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name sendmail-path
16603 Binary to use for sending mails.
16604 Defaults to @samp{"/usr/sbin/sendmail"}.
16605 @end deftypevr
16606
16607 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string submission-host
16608 If non-empty, send mails via this SMTP host[:port] instead of
16609 sendmail.
16610 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16611 @end deftypevr
16612
16613 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string rejection-subject
16614 Subject: header to use for rejection mails. You can use the same
16615 variables as for @samp{rejection-reason} below.
16616 Defaults to @samp{"Rejected: %s"}.
16617 @end deftypevr
16618
16619 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string rejection-reason
16620 Human readable error message for rejection mails. You can use
16621 variables:
16622
16623 @table @code
16624 @item %n
16625 CRLF
16626 @item %r
16627 reason
16628 @item %s
16629 original subject
16630 @item %t
16631 recipient
16632 @end table
16633 Defaults to @samp{"Your message to <%t> was automatically rejected:%n%r"}.
16634 @end deftypevr
16635
16636 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string recipient-delimiter
16637 Delimiter character between local-part and detail in email
16638 address.
16639 Defaults to @samp{"+"}.
16640 @end deftypevr
16641
16642 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string lda-original-recipient-header
16643 Header where the original recipient address (SMTP's RCPT TO:
16644 address) is taken from if not available elsewhere. With dovecot-lda -a
16645 parameter overrides this. A commonly used header for this is
16646 X-Original-To.
16647 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16648 @end deftypevr
16649
16650 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean lda-mailbox-autocreate?
16651 Should saving a mail to a nonexistent mailbox automatically create
16652 it?.
16653 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16654 @end deftypevr
16655
16656 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean lda-mailbox-autosubscribe?
16657 Should automatically created mailboxes be also automatically
16658 subscribed?.
16659 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16660 @end deftypevr
16661
16662 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer imap-max-line-length
16663 Maximum IMAP command line length. Some clients generate very long
16664 command lines with huge mailboxes, so you may need to raise this if you
16665 get "Too long argument" or "IMAP command line too large" errors
16666 often.
16667 Defaults to @samp{64000}.
16668 @end deftypevr
16669
16670 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-logout-format
16671 IMAP logout format string:
16672 @table @code
16673 @item %i
16674 total number of bytes read from client
16675 @item %o
16676 total number of bytes sent to client.
16677 @end table
16678 See @file{doc/wiki/Variables.txt} for a list of all the variables you can use.
16679 Defaults to @samp{"in=%i out=%o deleted=%@{deleted@} expunged=%@{expunged@} trashed=%@{trashed@} hdr_count=%@{fetch_hdr_count@} hdr_bytes=%@{fetch_hdr_bytes@} body_count=%@{fetch_body_count@} body_bytes=%@{fetch_body_bytes@}"}.
16680 @end deftypevr
16681
16682 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-capability
16683 Override the IMAP CAPABILITY response. If the value begins with '+',
16684 add the given capabilities on top of the defaults (e.g.@: +XFOO XBAR).
16685 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16686 @end deftypevr
16687
16688 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-idle-notify-interval
16689 How long to wait between "OK Still here" notifications when client
16690 is IDLEing.
16691 Defaults to @samp{"2 mins"}.
16692 @end deftypevr
16693
16694 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-id-send
16695 ID field names and values to send to clients. Using * as the value
16696 makes Dovecot use the default value. The following fields have default
16697 values currently: name, version, os, os-version, support-url,
16698 support-email.
16699 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16700 @end deftypevr
16701
16702 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-id-log
16703 ID fields sent by client to log. * means everything.
16704 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16705 @end deftypevr
16706
16707 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list imap-client-workarounds
16708 Workarounds for various client bugs:
16709
16710 @table @code
16711 @item delay-newmail
16712 Send EXISTS/RECENT new mail notifications only when replying to NOOP and
16713 CHECK commands. Some clients ignore them otherwise, for example OSX
16714 Mail (<v2.1). Outlook Express breaks more badly though, without this it
16715 may show user "Message no longer in server" errors. Note that OE6
16716 still breaks even with this workaround if synchronization is set to
16717 "Headers Only".
16718
16719 @item tb-extra-mailbox-sep
16720 Thunderbird gets somehow confused with LAYOUT=fs (mbox and dbox) and
16721 adds extra @samp{/} suffixes to mailbox names. This option causes Dovecot to
16722 ignore the extra @samp{/} instead of treating it as invalid mailbox name.
16723
16724 @item tb-lsub-flags
16725 Show \Noselect flags for LSUB replies with LAYOUT=fs (e.g.@: mbox).
16726 This makes Thunderbird realize they aren't selectable and show them
16727 greyed out, instead of only later giving "not selectable" popup error.
16728 @end table
16729 Defaults to @samp{()}.
16730 @end deftypevr
16731
16732 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-urlauth-host
16733 Host allowed in URLAUTH URLs sent by client. "*" allows all.
16734 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16735 @end deftypevr
16736
16737
16738 Whew! Lots of configuration options. The nice thing about it though is
16739 that Guix has a complete interface to Dovecot's configuration
16740 language. This allows not only a nice way to declare configurations,
16741 but also offers reflective capabilities as well: users can write code to
16742 inspect and transform configurations from within Scheme.
16743
16744 However, it could be that you just want to get a @code{dovecot.conf} up
16745 and running. In that case, you can pass an
16746 @code{opaque-dovecot-configuration} as the @code{#:config} parameter to
16747 @code{dovecot-service}. As its name indicates, an opaque configuration
16748 does not have easy reflective capabilities.
16749
16750 Available @code{opaque-dovecot-configuration} fields are:
16751
16752 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-dovecot-configuration} parameter} package dovecot
16753 The dovecot package.
16754 @end deftypevr
16755
16756 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-dovecot-configuration} parameter} string string
16757 The contents of the @code{dovecot.conf}, as a string.
16758 @end deftypevr
16759
16760 For example, if your @code{dovecot.conf} is just the empty string, you
16761 could instantiate a dovecot service like this:
16762
16763 @example
16764 (dovecot-service #:config
16765 (opaque-dovecot-configuration
16766 (string "")))
16767 @end example
16768
16769 @subsubheading OpenSMTPD Service
16770
16771 @deffn {Scheme Variable} opensmtpd-service-type
16772 This is the type of the @uref{https://www.opensmtpd.org, OpenSMTPD}
16773 service, whose value should be an @code{opensmtpd-configuration} object
16774 as in this example:
16775
16776 @example
16777 (service opensmtpd-service-type
16778 (opensmtpd-configuration
16779 (config-file (local-file "./my-smtpd.conf"))))
16780 @end example
16781 @end deffn
16782
16783 @deftp {Data Type} opensmtpd-configuration
16784 Data type representing the configuration of opensmtpd.
16785
16786 @table @asis
16787 @item @code{package} (default: @var{opensmtpd})
16788 Package object of the OpenSMTPD SMTP server.
16789
16790 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{%default-opensmtpd-file})
16791 File-like object of the OpenSMTPD configuration file to use. By default
16792 it listens on the loopback network interface, and allows for mail from
16793 users and daemons on the local machine, as well as permitting email to
16794 remote servers. Run @command{man smtpd.conf} for more information.
16795
16796 @end table
16797 @end deftp
16798
16799 @subsubheading Exim Service
16800
16801 @cindex mail transfer agent (MTA)
16802 @cindex MTA (mail transfer agent)
16803 @cindex SMTP
16804
16805 @deffn {Scheme Variable} exim-service-type
16806 This is the type of the @uref{https://exim.org, Exim} mail transfer
16807 agent (MTA), whose value should be an @code{exim-configuration} object
16808 as in this example:
16809
16810 @example
16811 (service exim-service-type
16812 (exim-configuration
16813 (config-file (local-file "./my-exim.conf"))))
16814 @end example
16815 @end deffn
16816
16817 In order to use an @code{exim-service-type} service you must also have a
16818 @code{mail-aliases-service-type} service present in your
16819 @code{operating-system} (even if it has no aliases).
16820
16821 @deftp {Data Type} exim-configuration
16822 Data type representing the configuration of exim.
16823
16824 @table @asis
16825 @item @code{package} (default: @var{exim})
16826 Package object of the Exim server.
16827
16828 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{#f})
16829 File-like object of the Exim configuration file to use. If its value is
16830 @code{#f} then use the default configuration file from the package
16831 provided in @code{package}. The resulting configuration file is loaded
16832 after setting the @code{exim_user} and @code{exim_group} configuration
16833 variables.
16834
16835 @end table
16836 @end deftp
16837
16838 @subsubheading Getmail service
16839
16840 @cindex IMAP
16841 @cindex POP
16842
16843 @deffn {Scheme Variable} getmail-service-type
16844 This is the type of the @uref{http://pyropus.ca/software/getmail/, Getmail}
16845 mail retriever, whose value should be an @code{getmail-configuration}.
16846 @end deffn
16847
16848 Available @code{getmail-configuration} fields are:
16849
16850 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration} parameter} symbol name
16851 A symbol to identify the getmail service.
16852
16853 Defaults to @samp{"unset"}.
16854
16855 @end deftypevr
16856
16857 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration} parameter} package package
16858 The getmail package to use.
16859
16860 @end deftypevr
16861
16862 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration} parameter} string user
16863 The user to run getmail as.
16864
16865 Defaults to @samp{"getmail"}.
16866
16867 @end deftypevr
16868
16869 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration} parameter} string group
16870 The group to run getmail as.
16871
16872 Defaults to @samp{"getmail"}.
16873
16874 @end deftypevr
16875
16876 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration} parameter} string directory
16877 The getmail directory to use.
16878
16879 Defaults to @samp{"/var/lib/getmail/default"}.
16880
16881 @end deftypevr
16882
16883 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration} parameter} getmail-configuration-file rcfile
16884 The getmail configuration file to use.
16885
16886 Available @code{getmail-configuration-file} fields are:
16887
16888 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration-file} parameter} getmail-retriever-configuration retriever
16889 What mail account to retrieve mail from, and how to access that account.
16890
16891 Available @code{getmail-retriever-configuration} fields are:
16892
16893 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} string type
16894 The type of mail retriever to use. Valid values include @samp{passwd}
16895 and @samp{static}.
16896
16897 Defaults to @samp{"SimpleIMAPSSLRetriever"}.
16898
16899 @end deftypevr
16900
16901 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} string server
16902 Space separated list of arguments to the userdb driver.
16903
16904 Defaults to @samp{unset}.
16905
16906 @end deftypevr
16907
16908 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} string username
16909 Space separated list of arguments to the userdb driver.
16910
16911 Defaults to @samp{unset}.
16912
16913 @end deftypevr
16914
16915 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer port
16916 Space separated list of arguments to the userdb driver.
16917
16918 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16919
16920 @end deftypevr
16921
16922 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} string password
16923 Override fields from passwd.
16924
16925 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16926
16927 @end deftypevr
16928
16929 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} list password-command
16930 Override fields from passwd.
16931
16932 Defaults to @samp{()}.
16933
16934 @end deftypevr
16935
16936 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} string keyfile
16937 PEM-formatted key file to use for the TLS negotiation
16938
16939 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16940
16941 @end deftypevr
16942
16943 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} string certfile
16944 PEM-formatted certificate file to use for the TLS negotiation
16945
16946 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16947
16948 @end deftypevr
16949
16950 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} string ca-certs
16951 CA certificates to use
16952
16953 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16954
16955 @end deftypevr
16956
16957 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} parameter-alist extra-parameters
16958 Extra retriever parameters
16959
16960 Defaults to @samp{()}.
16961
16962 @end deftypevr
16963
16964 @end deftypevr
16965
16966 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration-file} parameter} getmail-destination-configuration destination
16967 What to do with retrieved messages.
16968
16969 Available @code{getmail-destination-configuration} fields are:
16970
16971 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-destination-configuration} parameter} string type
16972 The type of mail destination. Valid values include @samp{Maildir},
16973 @samp{Mboxrd} and @samp{MDA_external}.
16974
16975 Defaults to @samp{unset}.
16976
16977 @end deftypevr
16978
16979 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-destination-configuration} parameter} string-or-filelike path
16980 The path option for the mail destination. The behaviour depends on the
16981 chosen type.
16982
16983 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16984
16985 @end deftypevr
16986
16987 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-destination-configuration} parameter} parameter-alist extra-parameters
16988 Extra destination parameters
16989
16990 Defaults to @samp{()}.
16991
16992 @end deftypevr
16993
16994 @end deftypevr
16995
16996 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration-file} parameter} getmail-options-configuration options
16997 Configure getmail.
16998
16999 Available @code{getmail-options-configuration} fields are:
17000
17001 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer verbose
17002 If set to @samp{0}, getmail will only print warnings and errors. A
17003 value of @samp{1} means that messages will be printed about retrieving
17004 and deleting messages. If set to @samp{2}, getmail will print messages
17005 about each of it's actions.
17006
17007 Defaults to @samp{1}.
17008
17009 @end deftypevr
17010
17011 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} boolean read-all
17012 If true, getmail will retrieve all available messages. Otherwise it
17013 will only retrieve messages it hasn't seen previously.
17014
17015 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
17016
17017 @end deftypevr
17018
17019 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} boolean delete
17020 If set to true, messages will be deleted from the server after
17021 retrieving and successfully delivering them. Otherwise, messages will
17022 be left on the server.
17023
17024 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
17025
17026 @end deftypevr
17027
17028 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer delete-after
17029 Getmail will delete messages this number of days after seeing them, if
17030 they have not been delivered. This means messages will be left on the
17031 server this number of days after delivering them. A value of @samp{0}
17032 disabled this feature.
17033
17034 Defaults to @samp{0}.
17035
17036 @end deftypevr
17037
17038 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer delete-bigger-than
17039 Delete messages larger than this of bytes after retrieving them, even if
17040 the delete and delete-after options are disabled. A value of @samp{0}
17041 disables this feature.
17042
17043 Defaults to @samp{0}.
17044
17045 @end deftypevr
17046
17047 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-bytes-per-session
17048 Retrieve messages totalling up to this number of bytes before closing
17049 the session with the server. A value of @samp{0} disables this feature.
17050
17051 Defaults to @samp{0}.
17052
17053 @end deftypevr
17054
17055 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-message-size
17056 Don't retrieve messages larger than this number of bytes. A value of
17057 @samp{0} disables this feature.
17058
17059 Defaults to @samp{0}.
17060
17061 @end deftypevr
17062
17063 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} boolean delivered-to
17064 If true, getmail will add a Delivered-To header to messages.
17065
17066 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
17067
17068 @end deftypevr
17069
17070 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} boolean received
17071 If set, getmail adds a Received header to the messages.
17072
17073 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
17074
17075 @end deftypevr
17076
17077 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} string message-log
17078 Getmail will record a log of its actions to the named file. A value of
17079 @samp{""} disables this feature.
17080
17081 Defaults to @samp{""}.
17082
17083 @end deftypevr
17084
17085 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} boolean message-log-syslog
17086 If true, getmail will record a log of its actions using the system
17087 logger.
17088
17089 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
17090
17091 @end deftypevr
17092
17093 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} boolean message-log-verbose
17094 If true, getmail will log information about messages not retrieved and
17095 the reason for not retrieving them, as well as starting and ending
17096 information lines.
17097
17098 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
17099
17100 @end deftypevr
17101
17102 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} parameter-alist extra-parameters
17103 Extra options to include.
17104
17105 Defaults to @samp{()}.
17106
17107 @end deftypevr
17108
17109 @end deftypevr
17110
17111 @end deftypevr
17112
17113 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration} parameter} list idle
17114 A list of mailboxes that getmail should wait on the server for new mail
17115 notifications. This depends on the server supporting the IDLE
17116 extension.
17117
17118 Defaults to @samp{()}.
17119
17120 @end deftypevr
17121
17122 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration} parameter} list environment-variables
17123 Environment variables to set for getmail.
17124
17125 Defaults to @samp{()}.
17126
17127 @end deftypevr
17128
17129 @subsubheading Mail Aliases Service
17130
17131 @cindex email aliases
17132 @cindex aliases, for email addresses
17133
17134 @deffn {Scheme Variable} mail-aliases-service-type
17135 This is the type of the service which provides @code{/etc/aliases},
17136 specifying how to deliver mail to users on this system.
17137
17138 @example
17139 (service mail-aliases-service-type
17140 '(("postmaster" "bob")
17141 ("bob" "bob@@example.com" "bob@@example2.com")))
17142 @end example
17143 @end deffn
17144
17145 The configuration for a @code{mail-aliases-service-type} service is an
17146 association list denoting how to deliver mail that comes to this
17147 system. Each entry is of the form @code{(alias addresses ...)}, with
17148 @code{alias} specifying the local alias and @code{addresses} specifying
17149 where to deliver this user's mail.
17150
17151 The aliases aren't required to exist as users on the local system. In
17152 the above example, there doesn't need to be a @code{postmaster} entry in
17153 the @code{operating-system}'s @code{user-accounts} in order to deliver
17154 the @code{postmaster} mail to @code{bob} (which subsequently would
17155 deliver mail to @code{bob@@example.com} and @code{bob@@example2.com}).
17156
17157 @subsubheading GNU Mailutils IMAP4 Daemon
17158 @cindex GNU Mailutils IMAP4 Daemon
17159
17160 @deffn {Scheme Variable} imap4d-service-type
17161 This is the type of the GNU Mailutils IMAP4 Daemon (@pxref{imap4d,,,
17162 mailutils, GNU Mailutils Manual}), whose value should be an
17163 @code{imap4d-configuration} object as in this example:
17164
17165 @example
17166 (service imap4d-service-type
17167 (imap4d-configuration
17168 (config-file (local-file "imap4d.conf"))))
17169 @end example
17170 @end deffn
17171
17172 @deftp {Data Type} imap4d-configuration
17173 Data type representing the configuration of @command{imap4d}.
17174
17175 @table @asis
17176 @item @code{package} (default: @code{mailutils})
17177 The package that provides @command{imap4d}.
17178
17179 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{%default-imap4d-config-file})
17180 File-like object of the configuration file to use, by default it will listen
17181 on TCP port 143 of @code{localhost}. @xref{Conf-imap4d,,, mailutils, GNU
17182 Mailutils Manual}, for details.
17183
17184 @end table
17185 @end deftp
17186
17187 @node Messaging Services
17188 @subsection Messaging Services
17189
17190 @cindex messaging
17191 @cindex jabber
17192 @cindex XMPP
17193 The @code{(gnu services messaging)} module provides Guix service
17194 definitions for messaging services: currently only Prosody is supported.
17195
17196 @subsubheading Prosody Service
17197
17198 @deffn {Scheme Variable} prosody-service-type
17199 This is the type for the @uref{https://prosody.im, Prosody XMPP
17200 communication server}. Its value must be a @code{prosody-configuration}
17201 record as in this example:
17202
17203 @example
17204 (service prosody-service-type
17205 (prosody-configuration
17206 (modules-enabled (cons "groups" "mam" %default-modules-enabled))
17207 (int-components
17208 (list
17209 (int-component-configuration
17210 (hostname "conference.example.net")
17211 (plugin "muc")
17212 (mod-muc (mod-muc-configuration)))))
17213 (virtualhosts
17214 (list
17215 (virtualhost-configuration
17216 (domain "example.net"))))))
17217 @end example
17218
17219 See below for details about @code{prosody-configuration}.
17220
17221 @end deffn
17222
17223 By default, Prosody does not need much configuration. Only one
17224 @code{virtualhosts} field is needed: it specifies the domain you wish
17225 Prosody to serve.
17226
17227 You can perform various sanity checks on the generated configuration
17228 with the @code{prosodyctl check} command.
17229
17230 Prosodyctl will also help you to import certificates from the
17231 @code{letsencrypt} directory so that the @code{prosody} user can access
17232 them. See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/letsencrypt}.
17233
17234 @example
17235 prosodyctl --root cert import /etc/letsencrypt/live
17236 @end example
17237
17238 The available configuration parameters follow. Each parameter
17239 definition is preceded by its type; for example, @samp{string-list foo}
17240 indicates that the @code{foo} parameter should be specified as a list of
17241 strings. Types starting with @code{maybe-} denote parameters that won't
17242 show up in @code{prosody.cfg.lua} when their value is @code{'disabled}.
17243
17244 There is also a way to specify the configuration as a string, if you
17245 have an old @code{prosody.cfg.lua} file that you want to port over from
17246 some other system; see the end for more details.
17247
17248 The @code{file-object} type designates either a file-like object
17249 (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}) or a file name.
17250
17251 @c The following documentation was initially generated by
17252 @c (generate-documentation) in (gnu services messaging). Manually maintained
17253 @c documentation is better, so we shouldn't hesitate to edit below as
17254 @c needed. However if the change you want to make to this documentation
17255 @c can be done in an automated way, it's probably easier to change
17256 @c (generate-documentation) than to make it below and have to deal with
17257 @c the churn as Prosody updates.
17258
17259 Available @code{prosody-configuration} fields are:
17260
17261 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} package prosody
17262 The Prosody package.
17263 @end deftypevr
17264
17265 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} file-name data-path
17266 Location of the Prosody data storage directory. See
17267 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/configure}.
17268 Defaults to @samp{"/var/lib/prosody"}.
17269 @end deftypevr
17270
17271 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} file-object-list plugin-paths
17272 Additional plugin directories. They are searched in all the specified
17273 paths in order. See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/plugins_directory}.
17274 Defaults to @samp{()}.
17275 @end deftypevr
17276
17277 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} file-name certificates
17278 Every virtual host and component needs a certificate so that clients and
17279 servers can securely verify its identity. Prosody will automatically load
17280 certificates/keys from the directory specified here.
17281 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/prosody/certs"}.
17282 @end deftypevr
17283
17284 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} string-list admins
17285 This is a list of accounts that are admins for the server. Note that you
17286 must create the accounts separately. See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/admins} and
17287 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/creating_accounts}.
17288 Example: @code{(admins '("user1@@example.com" "user2@@example.net"))}
17289 Defaults to @samp{()}.
17290 @end deftypevr
17291
17292 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} boolean use-libevent?
17293 Enable use of libevent for better performance under high load. See
17294 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/libevent}.
17295 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
17296 @end deftypevr
17297
17298 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} module-list modules-enabled
17299 This is the list of modules Prosody will load on startup. It looks for
17300 @code{mod_modulename.lua} in the plugins folder, so make sure that exists too.
17301 Documentation on modules can be found at:
17302 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules}.
17303 Defaults to @samp{("roster" "saslauth" "tls" "dialback" "disco" "carbons" "private" "blocklist" "vcard" "version" "uptime" "time" "ping" "pep" "register" "admin_adhoc")}.
17304 @end deftypevr
17305
17306 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} string-list modules-disabled
17307 @samp{"offline"}, @samp{"c2s"} and @samp{"s2s"} are auto-loaded, but
17308 should you want to disable them then add them to this list.
17309 Defaults to @samp{()}.
17310 @end deftypevr
17311
17312 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} file-object groups-file
17313 Path to a text file where the shared groups are defined. If this path is
17314 empty then @samp{mod_groups} does nothing. See
17315 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules/mod_groups}.
17316 Defaults to @samp{"/var/lib/prosody/sharedgroups.txt"}.
17317 @end deftypevr
17318
17319 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} boolean allow-registration?
17320 Disable account creation by default, for security. See
17321 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/creating_accounts}.
17322 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
17323 @end deftypevr
17324
17325 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} maybe-ssl-configuration ssl
17326 These are the SSL/TLS-related settings. Most of them are disabled so to
17327 use Prosody's defaults. If you do not completely understand these options, do
17328 not add them to your config, it is easy to lower the security of your server
17329 using them. See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/advanced_ssl_config}.
17330
17331 Available @code{ssl-configuration} fields are:
17332
17333 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-string protocol
17334 This determines what handshake to use.
17335 @end deftypevr
17336
17337 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-file-name key
17338 Path to your private key file.
17339 @end deftypevr
17340
17341 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-file-name certificate
17342 Path to your certificate file.
17343 @end deftypevr
17344
17345 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} file-object capath
17346 Path to directory containing root certificates that you wish Prosody to
17347 trust when verifying the certificates of remote servers.
17348 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/ssl/certs"}.
17349 @end deftypevr
17350
17351 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-file-object cafile
17352 Path to a file containing root certificates that you wish Prosody to trust.
17353 Similar to @code{capath} but with all certificates concatenated together.
17354 @end deftypevr
17355
17356 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-string-list verify
17357 A list of verification options (these mostly map to OpenSSL's
17358 @code{set_verify()} flags).
17359 @end deftypevr
17360
17361 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-string-list options
17362 A list of general options relating to SSL/TLS. These map to OpenSSL's
17363 @code{set_options()}. For a full list of options available in LuaSec, see the
17364 LuaSec source.
17365 @end deftypevr
17366
17367 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer depth
17368 How long a chain of certificate authorities to check when looking for a
17369 trusted root certificate.
17370 @end deftypevr
17371
17372 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-string ciphers
17373 An OpenSSL cipher string. This selects what ciphers Prosody will offer to
17374 clients, and in what order.
17375 @end deftypevr
17376
17377 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-file-name dhparam
17378 A path to a file containing parameters for Diffie-Hellman key exchange. You
17379 can create such a file with:
17380 @code{openssl dhparam -out /etc/prosody/certs/dh-2048.pem 2048}
17381 @end deftypevr
17382
17383 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-string curve
17384 Curve for Elliptic curve Diffie-Hellman. Prosody's default is
17385 @samp{"secp384r1"}.
17386 @end deftypevr
17387
17388 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-string-list verifyext
17389 A list of "extra" verification options.
17390 @end deftypevr
17391
17392 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-string password
17393 Password for encrypted private keys.
17394 @end deftypevr
17395
17396 @end deftypevr
17397
17398 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} boolean c2s-require-encryption?
17399 Whether to force all client-to-server connections to be encrypted or not.
17400 See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules/mod_tls}.
17401 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
17402 @end deftypevr
17403
17404 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} string-list disable-sasl-mechanisms
17405 Set of mechanisms that will never be offered. See
17406 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules/mod_saslauth}.
17407 Defaults to @samp{("DIGEST-MD5")}.
17408 @end deftypevr
17409
17410 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} boolean s2s-require-encryption?
17411 Whether to force all server-to-server connections to be encrypted or not.
17412 See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules/mod_tls}.
17413 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
17414 @end deftypevr
17415
17416 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} boolean s2s-secure-auth?
17417 Whether to require encryption and certificate authentication. This
17418 provides ideal security, but requires servers you communicate with to support
17419 encryption AND present valid, trusted certificates. See
17420 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/s2s#security}.
17421 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
17422 @end deftypevr
17423
17424 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} string-list s2s-insecure-domains
17425 Many servers don't support encryption or have invalid or self-signed
17426 certificates. You can list domains here that will not be required to
17427 authenticate using certificates. They will be authenticated using DNS. See
17428 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/s2s#security}.
17429 Defaults to @samp{()}.
17430 @end deftypevr
17431
17432 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} string-list s2s-secure-domains
17433 Even if you leave @code{s2s-secure-auth?} disabled, you can still require
17434 valid certificates for some domains by specifying a list here. See
17435 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/s2s#security}.
17436 Defaults to @samp{()}.
17437 @end deftypevr
17438
17439 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} string authentication
17440 Select the authentication backend to use. The default provider stores
17441 passwords in plaintext and uses Prosody's configured data storage to store the
17442 authentication data. If you do not trust your server please see
17443 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules/mod_auth_internal_hashed} for information
17444 about using the hashed backend. See also
17445 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/authentication}
17446 Defaults to @samp{"internal_plain"}.
17447 @end deftypevr
17448
17449 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} maybe-string log
17450 Set logging options. Advanced logging configuration is not yet supported
17451 by the Prosody service. See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/logging}.
17452 Defaults to @samp{"*syslog"}.
17453 @end deftypevr
17454
17455 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} file-name pidfile
17456 File to write pid in. See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules/mod_posix}.
17457 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/prosody/prosody.pid"}.
17458 @end deftypevr
17459
17460 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer http-max-content-size
17461 Maximum allowed size of the HTTP body (in bytes).
17462 @end deftypevr
17463
17464 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} maybe-string http-external-url
17465 Some modules expose their own URL in various ways. This URL is built
17466 from the protocol, host and port used. If Prosody sits behind a proxy, the
17467 public URL will be @code{http-external-url} instead. See
17468 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/http#external_url}.
17469 @end deftypevr
17470
17471 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} virtualhost-configuration-list virtualhosts
17472 A host in Prosody is a domain on which user accounts can be created. For
17473 example if you want your users to have addresses like
17474 @samp{"john.smith@@example.com"} then you need to add a host
17475 @samp{"example.com"}. All options in this list will apply only to this host.
17476
17477 Note: the name "virtual" host is used in configuration to avoid confusion with
17478 the actual physical host that Prosody is installed on. A single Prosody
17479 instance can serve many domains, each one defined as a VirtualHost entry in
17480 Prosody's configuration. Conversely a server that hosts a single domain would
17481 have just one VirtualHost entry.
17482
17483 See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/configure#virtual_host_settings}.
17484
17485 Available @code{virtualhost-configuration} fields are:
17486
17487 all these @code{prosody-configuration} fields: @code{admins}, @code{use-libevent?}, @code{modules-enabled}, @code{modules-disabled}, @code{groups-file}, @code{allow-registration?}, @code{ssl}, @code{c2s-require-encryption?}, @code{disable-sasl-mechanisms}, @code{s2s-require-encryption?}, @code{s2s-secure-auth?}, @code{s2s-insecure-domains}, @code{s2s-secure-domains}, @code{authentication}, @code{log}, @code{http-max-content-size}, @code{http-external-url}, @code{raw-content}, plus:
17488 @deftypevr {@code{virtualhost-configuration} parameter} string domain
17489 Domain you wish Prosody to serve.
17490 @end deftypevr
17491
17492 @end deftypevr
17493
17494 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} int-component-configuration-list int-components
17495 Components are extra services on a server which are available to clients,
17496 usually on a subdomain of the main server (such as
17497 @samp{"mycomponent.example.com"}). Example components might be chatroom
17498 servers, user directories, or gateways to other protocols.
17499
17500 Internal components are implemented with Prosody-specific plugins. To add an
17501 internal component, you simply fill the hostname field, and the plugin you wish
17502 to use for the component.
17503
17504 See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/components}.
17505 Defaults to @samp{()}.
17506
17507 Available @code{int-component-configuration} fields are:
17508
17509 all these @code{prosody-configuration} fields: @code{admins}, @code{use-libevent?}, @code{modules-enabled}, @code{modules-disabled}, @code{groups-file}, @code{allow-registration?}, @code{ssl}, @code{c2s-require-encryption?}, @code{disable-sasl-mechanisms}, @code{s2s-require-encryption?}, @code{s2s-secure-auth?}, @code{s2s-insecure-domains}, @code{s2s-secure-domains}, @code{authentication}, @code{log}, @code{http-max-content-size}, @code{http-external-url}, @code{raw-content}, plus:
17510 @deftypevr {@code{int-component-configuration} parameter} string hostname
17511 Hostname of the component.
17512 @end deftypevr
17513
17514 @deftypevr {@code{int-component-configuration} parameter} string plugin
17515 Plugin you wish to use for the component.
17516 @end deftypevr
17517
17518 @deftypevr {@code{int-component-configuration} parameter} maybe-mod-muc-configuration mod-muc
17519 Multi-user chat (MUC) is Prosody's module for allowing you to create
17520 hosted chatrooms/conferences for XMPP users.
17521
17522 General information on setting up and using multi-user chatrooms can be found
17523 in the "Chatrooms" documentation (@url{https://prosody.im/doc/chatrooms}),
17524 which you should read if you are new to XMPP chatrooms.
17525
17526 See also @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules/mod_muc}.
17527
17528 Available @code{mod-muc-configuration} fields are:
17529
17530 @deftypevr {@code{mod-muc-configuration} parameter} string name
17531 The name to return in service discovery responses.
17532 Defaults to @samp{"Prosody Chatrooms"}.
17533 @end deftypevr
17534
17535 @deftypevr {@code{mod-muc-configuration} parameter} string-or-boolean restrict-room-creation
17536 If @samp{#t}, this will only allow admins to create new chatrooms.
17537 Otherwise anyone can create a room. The value @samp{"local"} restricts room
17538 creation to users on the service's parent domain. E.g.@: @samp{user@@example.com}
17539 can create rooms on @samp{rooms.example.com}. The value @samp{"admin"}
17540 restricts to service administrators only.
17541 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
17542 @end deftypevr
17543
17544 @deftypevr {@code{mod-muc-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-history-messages
17545 Maximum number of history messages that will be sent to the member that has
17546 just joined the room.
17547 Defaults to @samp{20}.
17548 @end deftypevr
17549
17550 @end deftypevr
17551
17552 @end deftypevr
17553
17554 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} ext-component-configuration-list ext-components
17555 External components use XEP-0114, which most standalone components
17556 support. To add an external component, you simply fill the hostname field. See
17557 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/components}.
17558 Defaults to @samp{()}.
17559
17560 Available @code{ext-component-configuration} fields are:
17561
17562 all these @code{prosody-configuration} fields: @code{admins}, @code{use-libevent?}, @code{modules-enabled}, @code{modules-disabled}, @code{groups-file}, @code{allow-registration?}, @code{ssl}, @code{c2s-require-encryption?}, @code{disable-sasl-mechanisms}, @code{s2s-require-encryption?}, @code{s2s-secure-auth?}, @code{s2s-insecure-domains}, @code{s2s-secure-domains}, @code{authentication}, @code{log}, @code{http-max-content-size}, @code{http-external-url}, @code{raw-content}, plus:
17563 @deftypevr {@code{ext-component-configuration} parameter} string component-secret
17564 Password which the component will use to log in.
17565 @end deftypevr
17566
17567 @deftypevr {@code{ext-component-configuration} parameter} string hostname
17568 Hostname of the component.
17569 @end deftypevr
17570
17571 @end deftypevr
17572
17573 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer-list component-ports
17574 Port(s) Prosody listens on for component connections.
17575 Defaults to @samp{(5347)}.
17576 @end deftypevr
17577
17578 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} string component-interface
17579 Interface Prosody listens on for component connections.
17580 Defaults to @samp{"127.0.0.1"}.
17581 @end deftypevr
17582
17583 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} maybe-raw-content raw-content
17584 Raw content that will be added to the configuration file.
17585 @end deftypevr
17586
17587 It could be that you just want to get a @code{prosody.cfg.lua}
17588 up and running. In that case, you can pass an
17589 @code{opaque-prosody-configuration} record as the value of
17590 @code{prosody-service-type}. As its name indicates, an opaque configuration
17591 does not have easy reflective capabilities.
17592 Available @code{opaque-prosody-configuration} fields are:
17593
17594 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-prosody-configuration} parameter} package prosody
17595 The prosody package.
17596 @end deftypevr
17597
17598 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-prosody-configuration} parameter} string prosody.cfg.lua
17599 The contents of the @code{prosody.cfg.lua} to use.
17600 @end deftypevr
17601
17602 For example, if your @code{prosody.cfg.lua} is just the empty
17603 string, you could instantiate a prosody service like this:
17604
17605 @example
17606 (service prosody-service-type
17607 (opaque-prosody-configuration
17608 (prosody.cfg.lua "")))
17609 @end example
17610
17611 @c end of Prosody auto-generated documentation
17612
17613 @subsubheading BitlBee Service
17614
17615 @cindex IRC (Internet Relay Chat)
17616 @cindex IRC gateway
17617 @url{https://bitlbee.org,BitlBee} is a gateway that provides an IRC
17618 interface to a variety of messaging protocols such as XMPP.
17619
17620 @defvr {Scheme Variable} bitlbee-service-type
17621 This is the service type for the @url{https://bitlbee.org,BitlBee} IRC
17622 gateway daemon. Its value is a @code{bitlbee-configuration} (see
17623 below).
17624
17625 To have BitlBee listen on port 6667 on localhost, add this line to your
17626 services:
17627
17628 @example
17629 (service bitlbee-service-type)
17630 @end example
17631 @end defvr
17632
17633 @deftp {Data Type} bitlbee-configuration
17634 This is the configuration for BitlBee, with the following fields:
17635
17636 @table @asis
17637 @item @code{interface} (default: @code{"127.0.0.1"})
17638 @itemx @code{port} (default: @code{6667})
17639 Listen on the network interface corresponding to the IP address
17640 specified in @var{interface}, on @var{port}.
17641
17642 When @var{interface} is @code{127.0.0.1}, only local clients can
17643 connect; when it is @code{0.0.0.0}, connections can come from any
17644 networking interface.
17645
17646 @item @code{package} (default: @code{bitlbee})
17647 The BitlBee package to use.
17648
17649 @item @code{plugins} (default: @code{'()})
17650 List of plugin packages to use---e.g., @code{bitlbee-discord}.
17651
17652 @item @code{extra-settings} (default: @code{""})
17653 Configuration snippet added as-is to the BitlBee configuration file.
17654 @end table
17655 @end deftp
17656
17657 @subsubheading Quassel Service
17658
17659 @cindex IRC (Internet Relay Chat)
17660 @url{https://quassel-irc.org/,Quassel} is a distributed IRC client,
17661 meaning that one or more clients can attach to and detach from the
17662 central core.
17663
17664 @defvr {Scheme Variable} quassel-service-type
17665 This is the service type for the @url{https://quassel-irc.org/,Quassel}
17666 IRC backend daemon. Its value is a @code{quassel-configuration}
17667 (see below).
17668 @end defvr
17669
17670 @deftp {Data Type} quassel-configuration
17671 This is the configuration for Quassel, with the following fields:
17672
17673 @table @asis
17674 @item @code{quassel} (default: @code{quassel})
17675 The Quassel package to use.
17676
17677 @item @code{interface} (default: @code{"::,0.0.0.0"})
17678 @item @code{port} (default: @code{4242})
17679 Listen on the network interface(s) corresponding to the IPv4 or IPv6
17680 interfaces specified in the comma delimited @var{interface}, on
17681 @var{port}.
17682
17683 @item @code{loglevel} (default: @code{"Info"})
17684 The level of logging desired. Accepted values are Debug, Info, Warning
17685 and Error.
17686 @end table
17687 @end deftp
17688
17689 @node Telephony Services
17690 @subsection Telephony Services
17691
17692 @cindex Murmur (VoIP server)
17693 @cindex VoIP server
17694 This section describes how to set up and run a Murmur server. Murmur is
17695 the server of the @uref{https://mumble.info, Mumble} voice-over-IP
17696 (VoIP) suite.
17697
17698 @deftp {Data Type} murmur-configuration
17699 The service type for the Murmur server. An example configuration can
17700 look like this:
17701
17702 @example
17703 (service murmur-service-type
17704 (murmur-configuration
17705 (welcome-text
17706 "Welcome to this Mumble server running on Guix!")
17707 (cert-required? #t) ;disallow text password logins
17708 (ssl-cert "/etc/letsencrypt/live/mumble.example.com/fullchain.pem")
17709 (ssl-key "/etc/letsencrypt/live/mumble.example.com/privkey.pem")))
17710 @end example
17711
17712 After reconfiguring your system, you can manually set the murmur @code{SuperUser}
17713 password with the command that is printed during the activation phase.
17714
17715 It is recommended to register a normal Mumble user account
17716 and grant it admin or moderator rights.
17717 You can use the @code{mumble} client to
17718 login as new normal user, register yourself, and log out.
17719 For the next step login with the name @code{SuperUser} use
17720 the @code{SuperUser} password that you set previously,
17721 and grant your newly registered mumble user administrator or moderator
17722 rights and create some channels.
17723
17724 Available @code{murmur-configuration} fields are:
17725
17726 @table @asis
17727 @item @code{package} (default: @code{mumble})
17728 Package that contains @code{bin/murmurd}.
17729
17730 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"murmur"})
17731 User who will run the Murmur server.
17732
17733 @item @code{group} (default: @code{"murmur"})
17734 Group of the user who will run the murmur server.
17735
17736 @item @code{port} (default: @code{64738})
17737 Port on which the server will listen.
17738
17739 @item @code{welcome-text} (default: @code{""})
17740 Welcome text sent to clients when they connect.
17741
17742 @item @code{server-password} (default: @code{""})
17743 Password the clients have to enter in order to connect.
17744
17745 @item @code{max-users} (default: @code{100})
17746 Maximum of users that can be connected to the server at once.
17747
17748 @item @code{max-user-bandwidth} (default: @code{#f})
17749 Maximum voice traffic a user can send per second.
17750
17751 @item @code{database-file} (default: @code{"/var/lib/murmur/db.sqlite"})
17752 File name of the sqlite database.
17753 The service's user will become the owner of the directory.
17754
17755 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{"/var/log/murmur/murmur.log"})
17756 File name of the log file.
17757 The service's user will become the owner of the directory.
17758
17759 @item @code{autoban-attempts} (default: @code{10})
17760 Maximum number of logins a user can make in @code{autoban-timeframe}
17761 without getting auto banned for @code{autoban-time}.
17762
17763 @item @code{autoban-timeframe} (default: @code{120})
17764 Timeframe for autoban in seconds.
17765
17766 @item @code{autoban-time} (default: @code{300})
17767 Amount of time in seconds for which a client gets banned
17768 when violating the autoban limits.
17769
17770 @item @code{opus-threshold} (default: @code{100})
17771 Percentage of clients that need to support opus
17772 before switching over to opus audio codec.
17773
17774 @item @code{channel-nesting-limit} (default: @code{10})
17775 How deep channels can be nested at maximum.
17776
17777 @item @code{channelname-regex} (default: @code{#f})
17778 A string in form of a Qt regular expression that channel names must conform to.
17779
17780 @item @code{username-regex} (default: @code{#f})
17781 A string in form of a Qt regular expression that user names must conform to.
17782
17783 @item @code{text-message-length} (default: @code{5000})
17784 Maximum size in bytes that a user can send in one text chat message.
17785
17786 @item @code{image-message-length} (default: @code{(* 128 1024)})
17787 Maximum size in bytes that a user can send in one image message.
17788
17789 @item @code{cert-required?} (default: @code{#f})
17790 If it is set to @code{#t} clients that use weak password authentication
17791 will not be accepted. Users must have completed the certificate wizard to join.
17792
17793 @item @code{remember-channel?} (default: @code{#f})
17794 Should murmur remember the last channel each user was in when they disconnected
17795 and put them into the remembered channel when they rejoin.
17796
17797 @item @code{allow-html?} (default: @code{#f})
17798 Should html be allowed in text messages, user comments, and channel descriptions.
17799
17800 @item @code{allow-ping?} (default: @code{#f})
17801 Setting to true exposes the current user count, the maximum user count, and
17802 the server's maximum bandwidth per client to unauthenticated users. In the
17803 Mumble client, this information is shown in the Connect dialog.
17804
17805 Disabling this setting will prevent public listing of the server.
17806
17807 @item @code{bonjour?} (default: @code{#f})
17808 Should the server advertise itself in the local network through the bonjour protocol.
17809
17810 @item @code{send-version?} (default: @code{#f})
17811 Should the murmur server version be exposed in ping requests.
17812
17813 @item @code{log-days} (default: @code{31})
17814 Murmur also stores logs in the database, which are accessible via RPC.
17815 The default is 31 days of months, but you can set this setting to 0 to keep logs forever,
17816 or -1 to disable logging to the database.
17817
17818 @item @code{obfuscate-ips?} (default: @code{#t})
17819 Should logged ips be obfuscated to protect the privacy of users.
17820
17821 @item @code{ssl-cert} (default: @code{#f})
17822 File name of the SSL/TLS certificate used for encrypted connections.
17823
17824 @example
17825 (ssl-cert "/etc/letsencrypt/live/example.com/fullchain.pem")
17826 @end example
17827 @item @code{ssl-key} (default: @code{#f})
17828 Filepath to the ssl private key used for encrypted connections.
17829 @example
17830 (ssl-key "/etc/letsencrypt/live/example.com/privkey.pem")
17831 @end example
17832
17833 @item @code{ssl-dh-params} (default: @code{#f})
17834 File name of a PEM-encoded file with Diffie-Hellman parameters
17835 for the SSL/TLS encryption. Alternatively you set it to
17836 @code{"@@ffdhe2048"}, @code{"@@ffdhe3072"}, @code{"@@ffdhe4096"}, @code{"@@ffdhe6144"}
17837 or @code{"@@ffdhe8192"} to use bundled parameters from RFC 7919.
17838
17839 @item @code{ssl-ciphers} (default: @code{#f})
17840 The @code{ssl-ciphers} option chooses the cipher suites to make available for use
17841 in SSL/TLS.
17842
17843 This option is specified using
17844 @uref{https://www.openssl.org/docs/apps/ciphers.html#CIPHER-LIST-FORMAT,
17845 OpenSSL cipher list notation}.
17846
17847 It is recommended that you try your cipher string using 'openssl ciphers <string>'
17848 before setting it here, to get a feel for which cipher suites you will get.
17849 After setting this option, it is recommend that you inspect your Murmur log
17850 to ensure that Murmur is using the cipher suites that you expected it to.
17851
17852 Note: Changing this option may impact the backwards compatibility of your
17853 Murmur server, and can remove the ability for older Mumble clients to be able
17854 to connect to it.
17855
17856 @item @code{public-registration} (default: @code{#f})
17857 Must be a @code{<murmur-public-registration-configuration>} record or @code{#f}.
17858
17859 You can optionally register your server in the public server list that the
17860 @code{mumble} client shows on startup.
17861 You cannot register your server if you have set a @code{server-password},
17862 or set @code{allow-ping} to @code{#f}.
17863
17864 It might take a few hours until it shows up in the public list.
17865
17866 @item @code{file} (default: @code{#f})
17867 Optional alternative override for this configuration.
17868 @end table
17869 @end deftp
17870
17871 @deftp {Data Type} murmur-public-registration-configuration
17872 Configuration for public registration of a murmur service.
17873
17874 @table @asis
17875 @item @code{name}
17876 This is a display name for your server. Not to be confused with the hostname.
17877
17878 @item @code{password}
17879 A password to identify your registration.
17880 Subsequent updates will need the same password. Don't lose your password.
17881
17882 @item @code{url}
17883 This should be a @code{http://} or @code{https://} link to your web
17884 site.
17885
17886 @item @code{hostname} (default: @code{#f})
17887 By default your server will be listed by its IP address.
17888 If it is set your server will be linked by this host name instead.
17889 @end table
17890 @end deftp
17891
17892
17893
17894 @node Monitoring Services
17895 @subsection Monitoring Services
17896
17897 @subsubheading Tailon Service
17898
17899 @uref{https://tailon.readthedocs.io/, Tailon} is a web application for
17900 viewing and searching log files.
17901
17902 The following example will configure the service with default values.
17903 By default, Tailon can be accessed on port 8080 (@code{http://localhost:8080}).
17904
17905 @example
17906 (service tailon-service-type)
17907 @end example
17908
17909 The following example customises more of the Tailon configuration,
17910 adding @command{sed} to the list of allowed commands.
17911
17912 @example
17913 (service tailon-service-type
17914 (tailon-configuration
17915 (config-file
17916 (tailon-configuration-file
17917 (allowed-commands '("tail" "grep" "awk" "sed"))))))
17918 @end example
17919
17920
17921 @deftp {Data Type} tailon-configuration
17922 Data type representing the configuration of Tailon.
17923 This type has the following parameters:
17924
17925 @table @asis
17926 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{(tailon-configuration-file)})
17927 The configuration file to use for Tailon. This can be set to a
17928 @dfn{tailon-configuration-file} record value, or any gexp
17929 (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
17930
17931 For example, to instead use a local file, the @code{local-file} function
17932 can be used:
17933
17934 @example
17935 (service tailon-service-type
17936 (tailon-configuration
17937 (config-file (local-file "./my-tailon.conf"))))
17938 @end example
17939
17940 @item @code{package} (default: @code{tailon})
17941 The tailon package to use.
17942
17943 @end table
17944 @end deftp
17945
17946 @deftp {Data Type} tailon-configuration-file
17947 Data type representing the configuration options for Tailon.
17948 This type has the following parameters:
17949
17950 @table @asis
17951 @item @code{files} (default: @code{(list "/var/log")})
17952 List of files to display. The list can include strings for a single file
17953 or directory, or a list, where the first item is the name of a
17954 subsection, and the remaining items are the files or directories in that
17955 subsection.
17956
17957 @item @code{bind} (default: @code{"localhost:8080"})
17958 Address and port to which Tailon should bind on.
17959
17960 @item @code{relative-root} (default: @code{#f})
17961 URL path to use for Tailon, set to @code{#f} to not use a path.
17962
17963 @item @code{allow-transfers?} (default: @code{#t})
17964 Allow downloading the log files in the web interface.
17965
17966 @item @code{follow-names?} (default: @code{#t})
17967 Allow tailing of not-yet existent files.
17968
17969 @item @code{tail-lines} (default: @code{200})
17970 Number of lines to read initially from each file.
17971
17972 @item @code{allowed-commands} (default: @code{(list "tail" "grep" "awk")})
17973 Commands to allow running. By default, @code{sed} is disabled.
17974
17975 @item @code{debug?} (default: @code{#f})
17976 Set @code{debug?} to @code{#t} to show debug messages.
17977
17978 @item @code{wrap-lines} (default: @code{#t})
17979 Initial line wrapping state in the web interface. Set to @code{#t} to
17980 initially wrap lines (the default), or to @code{#f} to initially not
17981 wrap lines.
17982
17983 @item @code{http-auth} (default: @code{#f})
17984 HTTP authentication type to use. Set to @code{#f} to disable
17985 authentication (the default). Supported values are @code{"digest"} or
17986 @code{"basic"}.
17987
17988 @item @code{users} (default: @code{#f})
17989 If HTTP authentication is enabled (see @code{http-auth}), access will be
17990 restricted to the credentials provided here. To configure users, use a
17991 list of pairs, where the first element of the pair is the username, and
17992 the 2nd element of the pair is the password.
17993
17994 @example
17995 (tailon-configuration-file
17996 (http-auth "basic")
17997 (users '(("user1" . "password1")
17998 ("user2" . "password2"))))
17999 @end example
18000
18001 @end table
18002 @end deftp
18003
18004
18005 @subsubheading Darkstat Service
18006 @cindex darkstat
18007 Darkstat is a packet sniffer that captures network traffic, calculates
18008 statistics about usage, and serves reports over HTTP.
18009
18010 @defvar {Scheme Variable} darkstat-service-type
18011 This is the service type for the
18012 @uref{https://unix4lyfe.org/darkstat/, darkstat}
18013 service, its value must be a @code{darkstat-configuration} record as in
18014 this example:
18015
18016 @example
18017 (service darkstat-service-type
18018 (darkstat-configuration
18019 (interface "eno1")))
18020 @end example
18021 @end defvar
18022
18023 @deftp {Data Type} darkstat-configuration
18024 Data type representing the configuration of @command{darkstat}.
18025
18026 @table @asis
18027 @item @code{package} (default: @code{darkstat})
18028 The darkstat package to use.
18029
18030 @item @code{interface}
18031 Capture traffic on the specified network interface.
18032
18033 @item @code{port} (default: @code{"667"})
18034 Bind the web interface to the specified port.
18035
18036 @item @code{bind-address} (default: @code{"127.0.0.1"})
18037 Bind the web interface to the specified address.
18038
18039 @item @code{base} (default: @code{"/"})
18040 Specify the path of the base URL. This can be useful if
18041 @command{darkstat} is accessed via a reverse proxy.
18042
18043 @end table
18044 @end deftp
18045
18046 @subsubheading Prometheus Node Exporter Service
18047
18048 @cindex prometheus-node-exporter
18049 The Prometheus ``node exporter'' makes hardware and operating system statistics
18050 provided by the Linux kernel available for the Prometheus monitoring system.
18051 This service should be deployed on all physical nodes and virtual machines,
18052 where monitoring these statistics is desirable.
18053
18054 @defvar {Scheme variable} prometheus-node-exporter-service-type
18055 This is the service type for the
18056 @uref{https://github.com/prometheus/node_exporter/, prometheus-node-exporter}
18057 service, its value must be a @code{prometheus-node-exporter-configuration}
18058 record as in this example:
18059
18060 @example
18061 (service prometheus-node-exporter-service-type
18062 (prometheus-node-exporter-configuration
18063 (web-listen-address ":9100")))
18064 @end example
18065 @end defvar
18066
18067 @deftp {Data Type} prometheus-node-exporter-configuration
18068 Data type representing the configuration of @command{node_exporter}.
18069
18070 @table @asis
18071 @item @code{package} (default: @code{go-github-com-prometheus-node-exporter})
18072 The prometheus-node-exporter package to use.
18073
18074 @item @code{web-listen-address} (default: @code{":9100"})
18075 Bind the web interface to the specified address.
18076
18077 @end table
18078 @end deftp
18079
18080 @subsubheading Zabbix server
18081 @cindex zabbix zabbix-server
18082 Zabbix provides monitoring metrics, among others network utilization, CPU load
18083 and disk space consumption:
18084
18085 @itemize
18086 @item High performance, high capacity (able to monitor hundreds of thousands of devices).
18087 @item Auto-discovery of servers and network devices and interfaces.
18088 @item Low-level discovery, allows to automatically start monitoring new items, file systems or network interfaces among others.
18089 @item Distributed monitoring with centralized web administration.
18090 @item Native high performance agents.
18091 @item SLA, and ITIL KPI metrics on reporting.
18092 @item High-level (business) view of monitored resources through user-defined visual console screens and dashboards.
18093 @item Remote command execution through Zabbix proxies.
18094 @end itemize
18095
18096 @c %start of fragment
18097
18098 Available @code{zabbix-server-configuration} fields are:
18099
18100 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} package zabbix-server
18101 The zabbix-server package.
18102
18103 @end deftypevr
18104
18105 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string user
18106 User who will run the Zabbix server.
18107
18108 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
18109
18110 @end deftypevr
18111
18112 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} group group
18113 Group who will run the Zabbix server.
18114
18115 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
18116
18117 @end deftypevr
18118
18119 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string db-host
18120 Database host name.
18121
18122 Defaults to @samp{"127.0.0.1"}.
18123
18124 @end deftypevr
18125
18126 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string db-name
18127 Database name.
18128
18129 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
18130
18131 @end deftypevr
18132
18133 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string db-user
18134 Database user.
18135
18136 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
18137
18138 @end deftypevr
18139
18140 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string db-password
18141 Database password. Please, use @code{include-files} with
18142 @code{DBPassword=SECRET} inside a specified file instead.
18143
18144 Defaults to @samp{""}.
18145
18146 @end deftypevr
18147
18148 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} number db-port
18149 Database port.
18150
18151 Defaults to @samp{5432}.
18152
18153 @end deftypevr
18154
18155 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string log-type
18156 Specifies where log messages are written to:
18157
18158 @itemize @bullet
18159 @item
18160 @code{system} - syslog.
18161
18162 @item
18163 @code{file} - file specified with @code{log-file} parameter.
18164
18165 @item
18166 @code{console} - standard output.
18167
18168 @end itemize
18169
18170 Defaults to @samp{""}.
18171
18172 @end deftypevr
18173
18174 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string log-file
18175 Log file name for @code{log-type} @code{file} parameter.
18176
18177 Defaults to @samp{"/var/log/zabbix/server.log"}.
18178
18179 @end deftypevr
18180
18181 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string pid-file
18182 Name of PID file.
18183
18184 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/zabbix/zabbix_server.pid"}.
18185
18186 @end deftypevr
18187
18188 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string ssl-ca-location
18189 The location of certificate authority (CA) files for SSL server
18190 certificate verification.
18191
18192 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/ssl/certs/ca-certificates.crt"}.
18193
18194 @end deftypevr
18195
18196 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string ssl-cert-location
18197 Location of SSL client certificates.
18198
18199 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/ssl/certs"}.
18200
18201 @end deftypevr
18202
18203 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string extra-options
18204 Extra options will be appended to Zabbix server configuration file.
18205
18206 Defaults to @samp{""}.
18207
18208 @end deftypevr
18209
18210 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} include-files include-files
18211 You may include individual files or all files in a directory in the
18212 configuration file.
18213
18214 Defaults to @samp{()}.
18215
18216 @end deftypevr
18217
18218 @c %end of fragment
18219
18220 @subsubheading Zabbix agent
18221 @cindex zabbix zabbix-agent
18222
18223 Zabbix agent gathers information for Zabbix server.
18224
18225 @c %start of fragment
18226
18227 Available @code{zabbix-agent-configuration} fields are:
18228
18229 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} package zabbix-agent
18230 The zabbix-agent package.
18231
18232 @end deftypevr
18233
18234 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} string user
18235 User who will run the Zabbix agent.
18236
18237 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
18238
18239 @end deftypevr
18240
18241 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} group group
18242 Group who will run the Zabbix agent.
18243
18244 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
18245
18246 @end deftypevr
18247
18248 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} string hostname
18249 Unique, case sensitive hostname which is required for active checks and
18250 must match hostname as configured on the server.
18251
18252 Defaults to @samp{"Zabbix server"}.
18253
18254 @end deftypevr
18255
18256 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} string log-type
18257 Specifies where log messages are written to:
18258
18259 @itemize @bullet
18260 @item
18261 @code{system} - syslog.
18262
18263 @item
18264 @code{file} - file specified with @code{log-file} parameter.
18265
18266 @item
18267 @code{console} - standard output.
18268
18269 @end itemize
18270
18271 Defaults to @samp{""}.
18272
18273 @end deftypevr
18274
18275 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} string log-file
18276 Log file name for @code{log-type} @code{file} parameter.
18277
18278 Defaults to @samp{"/var/log/zabbix/agent.log"}.
18279
18280 @end deftypevr
18281
18282 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} string pid-file
18283 Name of PID file.
18284
18285 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/zabbix/zabbix_agent.pid"}.
18286
18287 @end deftypevr
18288
18289 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} list server
18290 List of IP addresses, optionally in CIDR notation, or hostnames of
18291 Zabbix servers and Zabbix proxies. Incoming connections will be
18292 accepted only from the hosts listed here.
18293
18294 Defaults to @samp{("127.0.0.1")}.
18295
18296 @end deftypevr
18297
18298 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} list server-active
18299 List of IP:port (or hostname:port) pairs of Zabbix servers and Zabbix
18300 proxies for active checks. If port is not specified, default port is
18301 used. If this parameter is not specified, active checks are disabled.
18302
18303 Defaults to @samp{("127.0.0.1")}.
18304
18305 @end deftypevr
18306
18307 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} string extra-options
18308 Extra options will be appended to Zabbix server configuration file.
18309
18310 Defaults to @samp{""}.
18311
18312 @end deftypevr
18313
18314 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} include-files include-files
18315 You may include individual files or all files in a directory in the
18316 configuration file.
18317
18318 Defaults to @samp{()}.
18319
18320 @end deftypevr
18321
18322 @c %end of fragment
18323
18324 @subsubheading Zabbix front-end
18325 @cindex zabbix zabbix-front-end
18326
18327 This service provides a WEB interface to Zabbix server.
18328
18329 @c %start of fragment
18330
18331 Available @code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} fields are:
18332
18333 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} nginx-server-configuration-list nginx
18334 NGINX configuration.
18335
18336 @end deftypevr
18337
18338 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} string db-host
18339 Database host name.
18340
18341 Defaults to @samp{"localhost"}.
18342
18343 @end deftypevr
18344
18345 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} number db-port
18346 Database port.
18347
18348 Defaults to @samp{5432}.
18349
18350 @end deftypevr
18351
18352 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} string db-name
18353 Database name.
18354
18355 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
18356
18357 @end deftypevr
18358
18359 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} string db-user
18360 Database user.
18361
18362 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
18363
18364 @end deftypevr
18365
18366 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} string db-password
18367 Database password. Please, use @code{db-secret-file} instead.
18368
18369 Defaults to @samp{""}.
18370
18371 @end deftypevr
18372
18373 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} string db-secret-file
18374 Secret file which will be appended to @file{zabbix.conf.php} file. This
18375 file contains credentials for use by Zabbix front-end. You are expected
18376 to create it manually.
18377
18378 Defaults to @samp{""}.
18379
18380 @end deftypevr
18381
18382 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} string zabbix-host
18383 Zabbix server hostname.
18384
18385 Defaults to @samp{"localhost"}.
18386
18387 @end deftypevr
18388
18389 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} number zabbix-port
18390 Zabbix server port.
18391
18392 Defaults to @samp{10051}.
18393
18394 @end deftypevr
18395
18396
18397 @c %end of fragment
18398
18399 @node Kerberos Services
18400 @subsection Kerberos Services
18401 @cindex Kerberos
18402
18403 The @code{(gnu services kerberos)} module provides services relating to
18404 the authentication protocol @dfn{Kerberos}.
18405
18406 @subsubheading Krb5 Service
18407
18408 Programs using a Kerberos client library normally
18409 expect a configuration file in @file{/etc/krb5.conf}.
18410 This service generates such a file from a definition provided in the
18411 operating system declaration.
18412 It does not cause any daemon to be started.
18413
18414 No ``keytab'' files are provided by this service---you must explicitly create them.
18415 This service is known to work with the MIT client library, @code{mit-krb5}.
18416 Other implementations have not been tested.
18417
18418 @defvr {Scheme Variable} krb5-service-type
18419 A service type for Kerberos 5 clients.
18420 @end defvr
18421
18422 @noindent
18423 Here is an example of its use:
18424 @lisp
18425 (service krb5-service-type
18426 (krb5-configuration
18427 (default-realm "EXAMPLE.COM")
18428 (allow-weak-crypto? #t)
18429 (realms (list
18430 (krb5-realm
18431 (name "EXAMPLE.COM")
18432 (admin-server "groucho.example.com")
18433 (kdc "karl.example.com"))
18434 (krb5-realm
18435 (name "ARGRX.EDU")
18436 (admin-server "kerb-admin.argrx.edu")
18437 (kdc "keys.argrx.edu"))))))
18438 @end lisp
18439
18440 @noindent
18441 This example provides a Kerberos@tie{}5 client configuration which:
18442 @itemize
18443 @item Recognizes two realms, @i{viz:} ``EXAMPLE.COM'' and ``ARGRX.EDU'', both
18444 of which have distinct administration servers and key distribution centers;
18445 @item Will default to the realm ``EXAMPLE.COM'' if the realm is not explicitly
18446 specified by clients;
18447 @item Accepts services which only support encryption types known to be weak.
18448 @end itemize
18449
18450 The @code{krb5-realm} and @code{krb5-configuration} types have many fields.
18451 Only the most commonly used ones are described here.
18452 For a full list, and more detailed explanation of each, see the MIT
18453 @uref{https://web.mit.edu/kerberos/krb5-devel/doc/admin/conf_files/krb5_conf.html,,krb5.conf}
18454 documentation.
18455
18456
18457 @deftp {Data Type} krb5-realm
18458 @cindex realm, kerberos
18459 @table @asis
18460 @item @code{name}
18461 This field is a string identifying the name of the realm.
18462 A common convention is to use the fully qualified DNS name of your organization,
18463 converted to upper case.
18464
18465 @item @code{admin-server}
18466 This field is a string identifying the host where the administration server is
18467 running.
18468
18469 @item @code{kdc}
18470 This field is a string identifying the key distribution center
18471 for the realm.
18472 @end table
18473 @end deftp
18474
18475 @deftp {Data Type} krb5-configuration
18476
18477 @table @asis
18478 @item @code{allow-weak-crypto?} (default: @code{#f})
18479 If this flag is @code{#t} then services which only offer encryption algorithms
18480 known to be weak will be accepted.
18481
18482 @item @code{default-realm} (default: @code{#f})
18483 This field should be a string identifying the default Kerberos
18484 realm for the client.
18485 You should set this field to the name of your Kerberos realm.
18486 If this value is @code{#f}
18487 then a realm must be specified with every Kerberos principal when invoking programs
18488 such as @command{kinit}.
18489
18490 @item @code{realms}
18491 This should be a non-empty list of @code{krb5-realm} objects, which clients may
18492 access.
18493 Normally, one of them will have a @code{name} field matching the @code{default-realm}
18494 field.
18495 @end table
18496 @end deftp
18497
18498
18499 @subsubheading PAM krb5 Service
18500 @cindex pam-krb5
18501
18502 The @code{pam-krb5} service allows for login authentication and password
18503 management via Kerberos.
18504 You will need this service if you want PAM enabled applications to authenticate
18505 users using Kerberos.
18506
18507 @defvr {Scheme Variable} pam-krb5-service-type
18508 A service type for the Kerberos 5 PAM module.
18509 @end defvr
18510
18511 @deftp {Data Type} pam-krb5-configuration
18512 Data type representing the configuration of the Kerberos 5 PAM module.
18513 This type has the following parameters:
18514 @table @asis
18515 @item @code{pam-krb5} (default: @code{pam-krb5})
18516 The pam-krb5 package to use.
18517
18518 @item @code{minimum-uid} (default: @code{1000})
18519 The smallest user ID for which Kerberos authentications should be attempted.
18520 Local accounts with lower values will silently fail to authenticate.
18521 @end table
18522 @end deftp
18523
18524
18525 @node LDAP Services
18526 @subsection LDAP Services
18527 @cindex LDAP
18528 @cindex nslcd, LDAP service
18529
18530 The @code{(gnu services authentication)} module provides the
18531 @code{nslcd-service-type}, which can be used to authenticate against an LDAP
18532 server. In addition to configuring the service itself, you may want to add
18533 @code{ldap} as a name service to the Name Service Switch. @xref{Name Service
18534 Switch} for detailed information.
18535
18536 Here is a simple operating system declaration with a default configuration of
18537 the @code{nslcd-service-type} and a Name Service Switch configuration that
18538 consults the @code{ldap} name service last:
18539
18540 @example
18541 (use-service-modules authentication)
18542 (use-modules (gnu system nss))
18543 ...
18544 (operating-system
18545 ...
18546 (services
18547 (cons*
18548 (service nslcd-service-type)
18549 (service dhcp-client-service-type)
18550 %base-services))
18551 (name-service-switch
18552 (let ((services (list (name-service (name "db"))
18553 (name-service (name "files"))
18554 (name-service (name "ldap")))))
18555 (name-service-switch
18556 (inherit %mdns-host-lookup-nss)
18557 (password services)
18558 (shadow services)
18559 (group services)
18560 (netgroup services)
18561 (gshadow services)))))
18562 @end example
18563
18564 @c %start of generated documentation for nslcd-configuration
18565
18566 Available @code{nslcd-configuration} fields are:
18567
18568 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} package nss-pam-ldapd
18569 The @code{nss-pam-ldapd} package to use.
18570
18571 @end deftypevr
18572
18573 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number threads
18574 The number of threads to start that can handle requests and perform LDAP
18575 queries. Each thread opens a separate connection to the LDAP server.
18576 The default is to start 5 threads.
18577
18578 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18579
18580 @end deftypevr
18581
18582 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} string uid
18583 This specifies the user id with which the daemon should be run.
18584
18585 Defaults to @samp{"nslcd"}.
18586
18587 @end deftypevr
18588
18589 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} string gid
18590 This specifies the group id with which the daemon should be run.
18591
18592 Defaults to @samp{"nslcd"}.
18593
18594 @end deftypevr
18595
18596 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} log-option log
18597 This option controls the way logging is done via a list containing
18598 SCHEME and LEVEL. The SCHEME argument may either be the symbols "none"
18599 or "syslog", or an absolute file name. The LEVEL argument is optional
18600 and specifies the log level. The log level may be one of the following
18601 symbols: "crit", "error", "warning", "notice", "info" or "debug". All
18602 messages with the specified log level or higher are logged.
18603
18604 Defaults to @samp{("/var/log/nslcd" info)}.
18605
18606 @end deftypevr
18607
18608 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} list uri
18609 The list of LDAP server URIs. Normally, only the first server will be
18610 used with the following servers as fall-back.
18611
18612 Defaults to @samp{("ldap://localhost:389/")}.
18613
18614 @end deftypevr
18615
18616 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string ldap-version
18617 The version of the LDAP protocol to use. The default is to use the
18618 maximum version supported by the LDAP library.
18619
18620 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18621
18622 @end deftypevr
18623
18624 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string binddn
18625 Specifies the distinguished name with which to bind to the directory
18626 server for lookups. The default is to bind anonymously.
18627
18628 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18629
18630 @end deftypevr
18631
18632 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string bindpw
18633 Specifies the credentials with which to bind. This option is only
18634 applicable when used with binddn.
18635
18636 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18637
18638 @end deftypevr
18639
18640 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string rootpwmoddn
18641 Specifies the distinguished name to use when the root user tries to
18642 modify a user's password using the PAM module.
18643
18644 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18645
18646 @end deftypevr
18647
18648 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string rootpwmodpw
18649 Specifies the credentials with which to bind if the root user tries to
18650 change a user's password. This option is only applicable when used with
18651 rootpwmoddn
18652
18653 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18654
18655 @end deftypevr
18656
18657 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string sasl-mech
18658 Specifies the SASL mechanism to be used when performing SASL
18659 authentication.
18660
18661 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18662
18663 @end deftypevr
18664
18665 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string sasl-realm
18666 Specifies the SASL realm to be used when performing SASL authentication.
18667
18668 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18669
18670 @end deftypevr
18671
18672 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string sasl-authcid
18673 Specifies the authentication identity to be used when performing SASL
18674 authentication.
18675
18676 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18677
18678 @end deftypevr
18679
18680 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string sasl-authzid
18681 Specifies the authorization identity to be used when performing SASL
18682 authentication.
18683
18684 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18685
18686 @end deftypevr
18687
18688 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean sasl-canonicalize?
18689 Determines whether the LDAP server host name should be canonicalised. If
18690 this is enabled the LDAP library will do a reverse host name lookup. By
18691 default, it is left up to the LDAP library whether this check is
18692 performed or not.
18693
18694 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18695
18696 @end deftypevr
18697
18698 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string krb5-ccname
18699 Set the name for the GSS-API Kerberos credentials cache.
18700
18701 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18702
18703 @end deftypevr
18704
18705 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} string base
18706 The directory search base.
18707
18708 Defaults to @samp{"dc=example,dc=com"}.
18709
18710 @end deftypevr
18711
18712 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} scope-option scope
18713 Specifies the search scope (subtree, onelevel, base or children). The
18714 default scope is subtree; base scope is almost never useful for name
18715 service lookups; children scope is not supported on all servers.
18716
18717 Defaults to @samp{(subtree)}.
18718
18719 @end deftypevr
18720
18721 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-deref-option deref
18722 Specifies the policy for dereferencing aliases. The default policy is
18723 to never dereference aliases.
18724
18725 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18726
18727 @end deftypevr
18728
18729 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean referrals
18730 Specifies whether automatic referral chasing should be enabled. The
18731 default behaviour is to chase referrals.
18732
18733 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18734
18735 @end deftypevr
18736
18737 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} list-of-map-entries maps
18738 This option allows for custom attributes to be looked up instead of the
18739 default RFC 2307 attributes. It is a list of maps, each consisting of
18740 the name of a map, the RFC 2307 attribute to match and the query
18741 expression for the attribute as it is available in the directory.
18742
18743 Defaults to @samp{()}.
18744
18745 @end deftypevr
18746
18747 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} list-of-filter-entries filters
18748 A list of filters consisting of the name of a map to which the filter
18749 applies and an LDAP search filter expression.
18750
18751 Defaults to @samp{()}.
18752
18753 @end deftypevr
18754
18755 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number bind-timelimit
18756 Specifies the time limit in seconds to use when connecting to the
18757 directory server. The default value is 10 seconds.
18758
18759 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18760
18761 @end deftypevr
18762
18763 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number timelimit
18764 Specifies the time limit (in seconds) to wait for a response from the
18765 LDAP server. A value of zero, which is the default, is to wait
18766 indefinitely for searches to be completed.
18767
18768 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18769
18770 @end deftypevr
18771
18772 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number idle-timelimit
18773 Specifies the period if inactivity (in seconds) after which the con‐
18774 nection to the LDAP server will be closed. The default is not to time
18775 out connections.
18776
18777 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18778
18779 @end deftypevr
18780
18781 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number reconnect-sleeptime
18782 Specifies the number of seconds to sleep when connecting to all LDAP
18783 servers fails. By default one second is waited between the first
18784 failure and the first retry.
18785
18786 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18787
18788 @end deftypevr
18789
18790 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number reconnect-retrytime
18791 Specifies the time after which the LDAP server is considered to be
18792 permanently unavailable. Once this time is reached retries will be done
18793 only once per this time period. The default value is 10 seconds.
18794
18795 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18796
18797 @end deftypevr
18798
18799 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-ssl-option ssl
18800 Specifies whether to use SSL/TLS or not (the default is not to). If
18801 'start-tls is specified then StartTLS is used rather than raw LDAP over
18802 SSL.
18803
18804 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18805
18806 @end deftypevr
18807
18808 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-tls-reqcert-option tls-reqcert
18809 Specifies what checks to perform on a server-supplied certificate. The
18810 meaning of the values is described in the ldap.conf(5) manual page.
18811
18812 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18813
18814 @end deftypevr
18815
18816 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string tls-cacertdir
18817 Specifies the directory containing X.509 certificates for peer authen‐
18818 tication. This parameter is ignored when using GnuTLS.
18819
18820 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18821
18822 @end deftypevr
18823
18824 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string tls-cacertfile
18825 Specifies the path to the X.509 certificate for peer authentication.
18826
18827 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18828
18829 @end deftypevr
18830
18831 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string tls-randfile
18832 Specifies the path to an entropy source. This parameter is ignored when
18833 using GnuTLS.
18834
18835 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18836
18837 @end deftypevr
18838
18839 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string tls-ciphers
18840 Specifies the ciphers to use for TLS as a string.
18841
18842 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18843
18844 @end deftypevr
18845
18846 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string tls-cert
18847 Specifies the path to the file containing the local certificate for
18848 client TLS authentication.
18849
18850 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18851
18852 @end deftypevr
18853
18854 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string tls-key
18855 Specifies the path to the file containing the private key for client TLS
18856 authentication.
18857
18858 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18859
18860 @end deftypevr
18861
18862 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number pagesize
18863 Set this to a number greater than 0 to request paged results from the
18864 LDAP server in accordance with RFC2696. The default (0) is to not
18865 request paged results.
18866
18867 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18868
18869 @end deftypevr
18870
18871 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-ignore-users-option nss-initgroups-ignoreusers
18872 This option prevents group membership lookups through LDAP for the
18873 specified users. Alternatively, the value 'all-local may be used. With
18874 that value nslcd builds a full list of non-LDAP users on startup.
18875
18876 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18877
18878 @end deftypevr
18879
18880 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number nss-min-uid
18881 This option ensures that LDAP users with a numeric user id lower than
18882 the specified value are ignored.
18883
18884 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18885
18886 @end deftypevr
18887
18888 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number nss-uid-offset
18889 This option specifies an offset that is added to all LDAP numeric user
18890 ids. This can be used to avoid user id collisions with local users.
18891
18892 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18893
18894 @end deftypevr
18895
18896 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number nss-gid-offset
18897 This option specifies an offset that is added to all LDAP numeric group
18898 ids. This can be used to avoid user id collisions with local groups.
18899
18900 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18901
18902 @end deftypevr
18903
18904 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean nss-nested-groups
18905 If this option is set, the member attribute of a group may point to
18906 another group. Members of nested groups are also returned in the higher
18907 level group and parent groups are returned when finding groups for a
18908 specific user. The default is not to perform extra searches for nested
18909 groups.
18910
18911 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18912
18913 @end deftypevr
18914
18915 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean nss-getgrent-skipmembers
18916 If this option is set, the group member list is not retrieved when
18917 looking up groups. Lookups for finding which groups a user belongs to
18918 will remain functional so the user will likely still get the correct
18919 groups assigned on login.
18920
18921 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18922
18923 @end deftypevr
18924
18925 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean nss-disable-enumeration
18926 If this option is set, functions which cause all user/group entries to
18927 be loaded from the directory will not succeed in doing so. This can
18928 dramatically reduce LDAP server load in situations where there are a
18929 great number of users and/or groups. This option is not recommended for
18930 most configurations.
18931
18932 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18933
18934 @end deftypevr
18935
18936 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string validnames
18937 This option can be used to specify how user and group names are verified
18938 within the system. This pattern is used to check all user and group
18939 names that are requested and returned from LDAP.
18940
18941 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18942
18943 @end deftypevr
18944
18945 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean ignorecase
18946 This specifies whether or not to perform searches using case-insensitive
18947 matching. Enabling this could open up the system to authorization
18948 bypass vulnerabilities and introduce nscd cache poisoning
18949 vulnerabilities which allow denial of service.
18950
18951 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18952
18953 @end deftypevr
18954
18955 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean pam-authc-ppolicy
18956 This option specifies whether password policy controls are requested and
18957 handled from the LDAP server when performing user authentication.
18958
18959 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18960
18961 @end deftypevr
18962
18963 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string pam-authc-search
18964 By default nslcd performs an LDAP search with the user's credentials
18965 after BIND (authentication) to ensure that the BIND operation was
18966 successful. The default search is a simple check to see if the user's
18967 DN exists. A search filter can be specified that will be used instead.
18968 It should return at least one entry.
18969
18970 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18971
18972 @end deftypevr
18973
18974 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string pam-authz-search
18975 This option allows flexible fine tuning of the authorisation check that
18976 should be performed. The search filter specified is executed and if any
18977 entries match, access is granted, otherwise access is denied.
18978
18979 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18980
18981 @end deftypevr
18982
18983 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string pam-password-prohibit-message
18984 If this option is set password modification using pam_ldap will be
18985 denied and the specified message will be presented to the user instead.
18986 The message can be used to direct the user to an alternative means of
18987 changing their password.
18988
18989 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18990
18991 @end deftypevr
18992
18993 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} list pam-services
18994 List of pam service names for which LDAP authentication should suffice.
18995
18996 Defaults to @samp{()}.
18997
18998 @end deftypevr
18999
19000 @c %end of generated documentation for nslcd-configuration
19001
19002
19003 @node Web Services
19004 @subsection Web Services
19005
19006 @cindex web
19007 @cindex www
19008 @cindex HTTP
19009 The @code{(gnu services web)} module provides the Apache HTTP Server,
19010 the nginx web server, and also a fastcgi wrapper daemon.
19011
19012 @subsubheading Apache HTTP Server
19013
19014 @deffn {Scheme Variable} httpd-service-type
19015 Service type for the @uref{https://httpd.apache.org/,Apache HTTP} server
19016 (@dfn{httpd}). The value for this service type is a
19017 @code{httpd-configuration} record.
19018
19019 A simple example configuration is given below.
19020
19021 @example
19022 (service httpd-service-type
19023 (httpd-configuration
19024 (config
19025 (httpd-config-file
19026 (server-name "www.example.com")
19027 (document-root "/srv/http/www.example.com")))))
19028 @end example
19029
19030 Other services can also extend the @code{httpd-service-type} to add to
19031 the configuration.
19032
19033 @example
19034 (simple-service 'my-extra-server httpd-service-type
19035 (list
19036 (httpd-virtualhost
19037 "*:80"
19038 (list (string-append
19039 "ServerName "www.example.com
19040 DocumentRoot \"/srv/http/www.example.com\"")))))
19041 @end example
19042 @end deffn
19043
19044 The details for the @code{httpd-configuration}, @code{httpd-module},
19045 @code{httpd-config-file} and @code{httpd-virtualhost} record types are
19046 given below.
19047
19048 @deffn {Data Type} httpd-configuration
19049 This data type represents the configuration for the httpd service.
19050
19051 @table @asis
19052 @item @code{package} (default: @code{httpd})
19053 The httpd package to use.
19054
19055 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/httpd"})
19056 The pid file used by the shepherd-service.
19057
19058 @item @code{config} (default: @code{(httpd-config-file)})
19059 The configuration file to use with the httpd service. The default value
19060 is a @code{httpd-config-file} record, but this can also be a different
19061 G-expression that generates a file, for example a @code{plain-file}. A
19062 file outside of the store can also be specified through a string.
19063
19064 @end table
19065 @end deffn
19066
19067 @deffn {Data Type} httpd-module
19068 This data type represents a module for the httpd service.
19069
19070 @table @asis
19071 @item @code{name}
19072 The name of the module.
19073
19074 @item @code{file}
19075 The file for the module. This can be relative to the httpd package being
19076 used, the absolute location of a file, or a G-expression for a file
19077 within the store, for example @code{(file-append mod-wsgi
19078 "/modules/mod_wsgi.so")}.
19079
19080 @end table
19081 @end deffn
19082
19083 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-httpd-modules
19084 A default list of @code{httpd-module} objects.
19085 @end defvr
19086
19087 @deffn {Data Type} httpd-config-file
19088 This data type represents a configuration file for the httpd service.
19089
19090 @table @asis
19091 @item @code{modules} (default: @code{%default-httpd-modules})
19092 The modules to load. Additional modules can be added here, or loaded by
19093 additional configuration.
19094
19095 For example, in order to handle requests for PHP files, you can use Apache’s
19096 @code{mod_proxy_fcgi} module along with @code{php-fpm-service-type}:
19097
19098 @example
19099 (service httpd-service-type
19100 (httpd-configuration
19101 (config
19102 (httpd-config-file
19103 (modules (cons*
19104 (httpd-module
19105 (name "proxy_module")
19106 (file "modules/mod_proxy.so"))
19107 (httpd-module
19108 (name "proxy_fcgi_module")
19109 (file "modules/mod_proxy_fcgi.so"))
19110 %default-httpd-modules))
19111 (extra-config (list "\
19112 <FilesMatch \\.php$>
19113 SetHandler \"proxy:unix:/var/run/php-fpm.sock|fcgi://localhost/\"
19114 </FilesMatch>"))))))
19115 (service php-fpm-service-type
19116 (php-fpm-configuration
19117 (socket "/var/run/php-fpm.sock")
19118 (socket-group "httpd")))
19119 @end example
19120
19121 @item @code{server-root} (default: @code{httpd})
19122 The @code{ServerRoot} in the configuration file, defaults to the httpd
19123 package. Directives including @code{Include} and @code{LoadModule} are
19124 taken as relative to the server root.
19125
19126 @item @code{server-name} (default: @code{#f})
19127 The @code{ServerName} in the configuration file, used to specify the
19128 request scheme, hostname and port that the server uses to identify
19129 itself.
19130
19131 This doesn't need to be set in the server config, and can be specifyed
19132 in virtual hosts. The default is @code{#f} to not specify a
19133 @code{ServerName}.
19134
19135 @item @code{document-root} (default: @code{"/srv/http"})
19136 The @code{DocumentRoot} from which files will be served.
19137
19138 @item @code{listen} (default: @code{'("80")})
19139 The list of values for the @code{Listen} directives in the config
19140 file. The value should be a list of strings, when each string can
19141 specify the port number to listen on, and optionally the IP address and
19142 protocol to use.
19143
19144 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/httpd"})
19145 The @code{PidFile} to use. This should match the @code{pid-file} set in
19146 the @code{httpd-configuration} so that the Shepherd service is
19147 configured correctly.
19148
19149 @item @code{error-log} (default: @code{"/var/log/httpd/error_log"})
19150 The @code{ErrorLog} to which the server will log errors.
19151
19152 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"httpd"})
19153 The @code{User} which the server will answer requests as.
19154
19155 @item @code{group} (default: @code{"httpd"})
19156 The @code{Group} which the server will answer requests as.
19157
19158 @item @code{extra-config} (default: @code{(list "TypesConfig etc/httpd/mime.types")})
19159 A flat list of strings and G-expressions which will be added to the end
19160 of the configuration file.
19161
19162 Any values which the service is extended with will be appended to this
19163 list.
19164
19165 @end table
19166 @end deffn
19167
19168 @deffn {Data Type} httpd-virtualhost
19169 This data type represents a virtualhost configuration block for the httpd service.
19170
19171 These should be added to the extra-config for the httpd-service.
19172
19173 @example
19174 (simple-service 'my-extra-server httpd-service-type
19175 (list
19176 (httpd-virtualhost
19177 "*:80"
19178 (list (string-append
19179 "ServerName "www.example.com
19180 DocumentRoot \"/srv/http/www.example.com\"")))))
19181 @end example
19182
19183 @table @asis
19184 @item @code{addresses-and-ports}
19185 The addresses and ports for the @code{VirtualHost} directive.
19186
19187 @item @code{contents}
19188 The contents of the @code{VirtualHost} directive, this should be a list
19189 of strings and G-expressions.
19190
19191 @end table
19192 @end deffn
19193
19194 @subsubheading NGINX
19195
19196 @deffn {Scheme Variable} nginx-service-type
19197 Service type for the @uref{https://nginx.org/,NGinx} web server. The
19198 value for this service type is a @code{<nginx-configuration>} record.
19199
19200 A simple example configuration is given below.
19201
19202 @example
19203 (service nginx-service-type
19204 (nginx-configuration
19205 (server-blocks
19206 (list (nginx-server-configuration
19207 (server-name '("www.example.com"))
19208 (root "/srv/http/www.example.com"))))))
19209 @end example
19210
19211 In addition to adding server blocks to the service configuration
19212 directly, this service can be extended by other services to add server
19213 blocks, as in this example:
19214
19215 @example
19216 (simple-service 'my-extra-server nginx-service-type
19217 (list (nginx-server-configuration
19218 (root "/srv/http/extra-website")
19219 (try-files (list "$uri" "$uri/index.html")))))
19220 @end example
19221 @end deffn
19222
19223 At startup, @command{nginx} has not yet read its configuration file, so
19224 it uses a default file to log error messages. If it fails to load its
19225 configuration file, that is where error messages are logged. After the
19226 configuration file is loaded, the default error log file changes as per
19227 configuration. In our case, startup error messages can be found in
19228 @file{/var/run/nginx/logs/error.log}, and after configuration in
19229 @file{/var/log/nginx/error.log}. The second location can be changed
19230 with the @var{log-directory} configuration option.
19231
19232 @deffn {Data Type} nginx-configuration
19233 This data type represents the configuration for NGinx. Some
19234 configuration can be done through this and the other provided record
19235 types, or alternatively, a config file can be provided.
19236
19237 @table @asis
19238 @item @code{nginx} (default: @code{nginx})
19239 The nginx package to use.
19240
19241 @item @code{log-directory} (default: @code{"/var/log/nginx"})
19242 The directory to which NGinx will write log files.
19243
19244 @item @code{run-directory} (default: @code{"/var/run/nginx"})
19245 The directory in which NGinx will create a pid file, and write temporary
19246 files.
19247
19248 @item @code{server-blocks} (default: @code{'()})
19249 A list of @dfn{server blocks} to create in the generated configuration
19250 file, the elements should be of type
19251 @code{<nginx-server-configuration>}.
19252
19253 The following example would setup NGinx to serve @code{www.example.com}
19254 from the @code{/srv/http/www.example.com} directory, without using
19255 HTTPS.
19256 @example
19257 (service nginx-service-type
19258 (nginx-configuration
19259 (server-blocks
19260 (list (nginx-server-configuration
19261 (server-name '("www.example.com"))
19262 (root "/srv/http/www.example.com"))))))
19263 @end example
19264
19265 @item @code{upstream-blocks} (default: @code{'()})
19266 A list of @dfn{upstream blocks} to create in the generated configuration
19267 file, the elements should be of type
19268 @code{<nginx-upstream-configuration>}.
19269
19270 Configuring upstreams through the @code{upstream-blocks} can be useful
19271 when combined with @code{locations} in the
19272 @code{<nginx-server-configuration>} records. The following example
19273 creates a server configuration with one location configuration, that
19274 will proxy requests to a upstream configuration, which will handle
19275 requests with two servers.
19276
19277 @example
19278 (service
19279 nginx-service-type
19280 (nginx-configuration
19281 (server-blocks
19282 (list (nginx-server-configuration
19283 (server-name '("www.example.com"))
19284 (root "/srv/http/www.example.com")
19285 (locations
19286 (list
19287 (nginx-location-configuration
19288 (uri "/path1")
19289 (body '("proxy_pass http://server-proxy;"))))))))
19290 (upstream-blocks
19291 (list (nginx-upstream-configuration
19292 (name "server-proxy")
19293 (servers (list "server1.example.com"
19294 "server2.example.com")))))))
19295 @end example
19296
19297 @item @code{file} (default: @code{#f})
19298 If a configuration @var{file} is provided, this will be used, rather than
19299 generating a configuration file from the provided @code{log-directory},
19300 @code{run-directory}, @code{server-blocks} and @code{upstream-blocks}. For
19301 proper operation, these arguments should match what is in @var{file} to ensure
19302 that the directories are created when the service is activated.
19303
19304 This can be useful if you have an existing configuration file, or it's
19305 not possible to do what is required through the other parts of the
19306 nginx-configuration record.
19307
19308 @item @code{server-names-hash-bucket-size} (default: @code{#f})
19309 Bucket size for the server names hash tables, defaults to @code{#f} to
19310 use the size of the processors cache line.
19311
19312 @item @code{server-names-hash-bucket-max-size} (default: @code{#f})
19313 Maximum bucket size for the server names hash tables.
19314
19315 @item @code{extra-content} (default: @code{""})
19316 Extra content for the @code{http} block. Should be string or a string
19317 valued G-expression.
19318
19319 @end table
19320 @end deffn
19321
19322 @deftp {Data Type} nginx-server-configuration
19323 Data type representing the configuration of an nginx server block.
19324 This type has the following parameters:
19325
19326 @table @asis
19327 @item @code{listen} (default: @code{'("80" "443 ssl")})
19328 Each @code{listen} directive sets the address and port for IP, or the
19329 path for a UNIX-domain socket on which the server will accept requests.
19330 Both address and port, or only address or only port can be specified.
19331 An address may also be a hostname, for example:
19332
19333 @example
19334 '("127.0.0.1:8000" "127.0.0.1" "8000" "*:8000" "localhost:8000")
19335 @end example
19336
19337 @item @code{server-name} (default: @code{(list 'default)})
19338 A list of server names this server represents. @code{'default} represents the
19339 default server for connections matching no other server.
19340
19341 @item @code{root} (default: @code{"/srv/http"})
19342 Root of the website nginx will serve.
19343
19344 @item @code{locations} (default: @code{'()})
19345 A list of @dfn{nginx-location-configuration} or
19346 @dfn{nginx-named-location-configuration} records to use within this
19347 server block.
19348
19349 @item @code{index} (default: @code{(list "index.html")})
19350 Index files to look for when clients ask for a directory. If it cannot be found,
19351 Nginx will send the list of files in the directory.
19352
19353 @item @code{try-files} (default: @code{'()})
19354 A list of files whose existence is checked in the specified order.
19355 @code{nginx} will use the first file it finds to process the request.
19356
19357 @item @code{ssl-certificate} (default: @code{#f})
19358 Where to find the certificate for secure connections. Set it to @code{#f} if
19359 you don't have a certificate or you don't want to use HTTPS.
19360
19361 @item @code{ssl-certificate-key} (default: @code{#f})
19362 Where to find the private key for secure connections. Set it to @code{#f} if
19363 you don't have a key or you don't want to use HTTPS.
19364
19365 @item @code{server-tokens?} (default: @code{#f})
19366 Whether the server should add its configuration to response.
19367
19368 @item @code{raw-content} (default: @code{'()})
19369 A list of raw lines added to the server block.
19370
19371 @end table
19372 @end deftp
19373
19374 @deftp {Data Type} nginx-upstream-configuration
19375 Data type representing the configuration of an nginx @code{upstream}
19376 block. This type has the following parameters:
19377
19378 @table @asis
19379 @item @code{name}
19380 Name for this group of servers.
19381
19382 @item @code{servers}
19383 Specify the addresses of the servers in the group. The address can be
19384 specified as a IP address (e.g.@: @samp{127.0.0.1}), domain name
19385 (e.g.@: @samp{backend1.example.com}) or a path to a UNIX socket using the
19386 prefix @samp{unix:}. For addresses using an IP address or domain name,
19387 the default port is 80, and a different port can be specified
19388 explicitly.
19389
19390 @end table
19391 @end deftp
19392
19393 @deftp {Data Type} nginx-location-configuration
19394 Data type representing the configuration of an nginx @code{location}
19395 block. This type has the following parameters:
19396
19397 @table @asis
19398 @item @code{uri}
19399 URI which this location block matches.
19400
19401 @anchor{nginx-location-configuration body}
19402 @item @code{body}
19403 Body of the location block, specified as a list of strings. This can contain
19404 many
19405 configuration directives. For example, to pass requests to a upstream
19406 server group defined using an @code{nginx-upstream-configuration} block,
19407 the following directive would be specified in the body @samp{(list "proxy_pass
19408 http://upstream-name;")}.
19409
19410 @end table
19411 @end deftp
19412
19413 @deftp {Data Type} nginx-named-location-configuration
19414 Data type representing the configuration of an nginx named location
19415 block. Named location blocks are used for request redirection, and not
19416 used for regular request processing. This type has the following
19417 parameters:
19418
19419 @table @asis
19420 @item @code{name}
19421 Name to identify this location block.
19422
19423 @item @code{body}
19424 @xref{nginx-location-configuration body}, as the body for named location
19425 blocks can be used in a similar way to the
19426 @code{nginx-location-configuration body}. One restriction is that the
19427 body of a named location block cannot contain location blocks.
19428
19429 @end table
19430 @end deftp
19431
19432 @subsubheading Varnish Cache
19433 @cindex Varnish
19434 Varnish is a fast cache server that sits in between web applications
19435 and end users. It proxies requests from clients and caches the
19436 accessed URLs such that multiple requests for the same resource only
19437 creates one request to the back-end.
19438
19439 @defvr {Scheme Variable} varnish-service-type
19440 Service type for the Varnish daemon.
19441 @end defvr
19442
19443 @deftp {Data Type} varnish-configuration
19444 Data type representing the @code{varnish} service configuration.
19445 This type has the following parameters:
19446
19447 @table @asis
19448 @item @code{package} (default: @code{varnish})
19449 The Varnish package to use.
19450
19451 @item @code{name} (default: @code{"default"})
19452 A name for this Varnish instance. Varnish will create a directory in
19453 @file{/var/varnish/} with this name and keep temporary files there. If
19454 the name starts with a forward slash, it is interpreted as an absolute
19455 directory name.
19456
19457 Pass the @code{-n} argument to other Varnish programs to connect to the
19458 named instance, e.g.@: @command{varnishncsa -n default}.
19459
19460 @item @code{backend} (default: @code{"localhost:8080"})
19461 The backend to use. This option has no effect if @code{vcl} is set.
19462
19463 @item @code{vcl} (default: #f)
19464 The @dfn{VCL} (Varnish Configuration Language) program to run. If this
19465 is @code{#f}, Varnish will proxy @code{backend} using the default
19466 configuration. Otherwise this must be a file-like object with valid
19467 VCL syntax.
19468
19469 @c Varnish does not support HTTPS, so keep this URL to avoid confusion.
19470 For example, to mirror @url{http://www.gnu.org,www.gnu.org} with VCL you
19471 can do something along these lines:
19472
19473 @example
19474 (define %gnu-mirror
19475 (plain-file
19476 "gnu.vcl"
19477 "vcl 4.1;
19478 backend gnu @{ .host = "www.gnu.org"; @}"))
19479
19480 (operating-system
19481 ...
19482 (services (cons (service varnish-service-type
19483 (varnish-configuration
19484 (listen '(":80"))
19485 (vcl %gnu-mirror)))
19486 %base-services)))
19487 @end example
19488
19489 The configuration of an already running Varnish instance can be inspected
19490 and changed using the @command{varnishadm} program.
19491
19492 Consult the @url{https://varnish-cache.org/docs/,Varnish User Guide} and
19493 @url{https://book.varnish-software.com/4.0/,Varnish Book} for
19494 comprehensive documentation on Varnish and its configuration language.
19495
19496 @item @code{listen} (default: @code{'("localhost:80")})
19497 List of addresses Varnish will listen on.
19498
19499 @item @code{storage} (default: @code{'("malloc,128m")})
19500 List of storage backends that will be available in VCL.
19501
19502 @item @code{parameters} (default: @code{'()})
19503 List of run-time parameters in the form @code{'(("parameter" . "value"))}.
19504
19505 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @code{'()})
19506 Additional arguments to pass to the @command{varnishd} process.
19507
19508 @end table
19509 @end deftp
19510
19511 @subsubheading Patchwork
19512 @cindex Patchwork
19513 Patchwork is a patch tracking system. It can collect patches sent to a
19514 mailing list, and display them in a web interface.
19515
19516 @defvr {Scheme Variable} patchwork-service-type
19517 Service type for Patchwork.
19518 @end defvr
19519
19520 The following example is an example of a minimal service for Patchwork, for
19521 the @code{patchwork.example.com} domain.
19522
19523 @example
19524 (service patchwork-service-type
19525 (patchwork-configuration
19526 (domain "patchwork.example.com")
19527 (settings-module
19528 (patchwork-settings-module
19529 (allowed-hosts (list domain))
19530 (default-from-email "patchwork@@patchwork.example.com")))
19531 (getmail-retriever-config
19532 (getmail-retriever-configuration
19533 (type "SimpleIMAPSSLRetriever")
19534 (server "imap.example.com")
19535 (port 993)
19536 (username "patchwork")
19537 (password-command
19538 (list (file-append coreutils "/bin/cat")
19539 "/etc/getmail-patchwork-imap-password"))
19540 (extra-parameters
19541 '((mailboxes . ("Patches"))))))))
19542
19543 @end example
19544
19545 There are three records for configuring the Patchwork service. The
19546 @code{<patchwork-configuration>} relates to the configuration for Patchwork
19547 within the HTTPD service.
19548
19549 The @code{settings-module} field within the @code{<patchwork-configuration>}
19550 record can be populated with the @code{<patchwork-settings-module>} record,
19551 which describes a settings module that is generated within the Guix store.
19552
19553 For the @code{database-configuration} field within the
19554 @code{<patchwork-settings-module>}, the
19555 @code{<patchwork-database-configuration>} must be used.
19556
19557 @deftp {Data Type} patchwork-configuration
19558 Data type representing the Patchwork service configuration. This type has the
19559 following parameters:
19560
19561 @table @asis
19562 @item @code{patchwork} (default: @code{patchwork})
19563 The Patchwork package to use.
19564
19565 @item @code{domain}
19566 The domain to use for Patchwork, this is used in the HTTPD service virtual
19567 host.
19568
19569 @item @code{settings-module}
19570 The settings module to use for Patchwork. As a Django application, Patchwork
19571 is configured with a Python module containing the settings. This can either be
19572 an instance of the @code{<patchwork-settings-module>} record, any other record
19573 that represents the settings in the store, or a directory outside of the
19574 store.
19575
19576 @item @code{static-path} (default: @code{"/static/"})
19577 The path under which the HTTPD service should serve the static files.
19578
19579 @item @code{getmail-retriever-config}
19580 The getmail-retriever-configuration record value to use with
19581 Patchwork. Getmail will be configured with this value, the messages will be
19582 delivered to Patchwork.
19583
19584 @end table
19585 @end deftp
19586
19587 @deftp {Data Type} patchwork-settings-module
19588 Data type representing a settings module for Patchwork. Some of these
19589 settings relate directly to Patchwork, but others relate to Django, the web
19590 framework used by Patchwork, or the Django Rest Framework library. This type
19591 has the following parameters:
19592
19593 @table @asis
19594 @item @code{database-configuration} (default: @code{(patchwork-database-configuration)})
19595 The database connection settings used for Patchwork. See the
19596 @code{<patchwork-database-configuration>} record type for more information.
19597
19598 @item @code{secret-key-file} (default: @code{"/etc/patchwork/django-secret-key"})
19599 Patchwork, as a Django web application uses a secret key for cryptographically
19600 signing values. This file should contain a unique unpredictable value.
19601
19602 If this file does not exist, it will be created and populated with a random
19603 value by the patchwork-setup shepherd service.
19604
19605 This setting relates to Django.
19606
19607 @item @code{allowed-hosts}
19608 A list of valid hosts for this Patchwork service. This should at least include
19609 the domain specified in the @code{<patchwork-configuration>} record.
19610
19611 This is a Django setting.
19612
19613 @item @code{default-from-email}
19614 The email address from which Patchwork should send email by default.
19615
19616 This is a Patchwork setting.
19617
19618 @item @code{static-url} (default: @code{#f})
19619 The URL to use when serving static assets. It can be part of a URL, or a full
19620 URL, but must end in a @code{/}.
19621
19622 If the default value is used, the @code{static-path} value from the
19623 @code{<patchwork-configuration>} record will be used.
19624
19625 This is a Django setting.
19626
19627 @item @code{admins} (default: @code{'()})
19628 Email addresses to send the details of errors that occur. Each value should
19629 be a list containing two elements, the name and then the email address.
19630
19631 This is a Django setting.
19632
19633 @item @code{debug?} (default: @code{#f})
19634 Whether to run Patchwork in debug mode. If set to @code{#t}, detailed error
19635 messages will be shown.
19636
19637 This is a Django setting.
19638
19639 @item @code{enable-rest-api?} (default: @code{#t})
19640 Whether to enable the Patchwork REST API.
19641
19642 This is a Patchwork setting.
19643
19644 @item @code{enable-xmlrpc?} (default: @code{#t})
19645 Whether to enable the XML RPC API.
19646
19647 This is a Patchwork setting.
19648
19649 @item @code{force-https-links?} (default: @code{#t})
19650 Whether to use HTTPS links on Patchwork pages.
19651
19652 This is a Patchwork setting.
19653
19654 @item @code{extra-settings} (default: @code{""})
19655 Extra code to place at the end of the Patchwork settings module.
19656
19657 @end table
19658 @end deftp
19659
19660 @deftp {Data Type} patchwork-database-configuration
19661 Data type representing the database configuration for Patchwork.
19662
19663 @table @asis
19664 @item @code{engine} (default: @code{"django.db.backends.postgresql_psycopg2"})
19665 The database engine to use.
19666
19667 @item @code{name} (default: @code{"patchwork"})
19668 The name of the database to use.
19669
19670 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"httpd"})
19671 The user to connect to the database as.
19672
19673 @item @code{password} (default: @code{""})
19674 The password to use when connecting to the database.
19675
19676 @item @code{host} (default: @code{""})
19677 The host to make the database connection to.
19678
19679 @item @code{port} (default: @code{""})
19680 The port on which to connect to the database.
19681
19682 @end table
19683 @end deftp
19684
19685 @subsubheading FastCGI
19686 @cindex fastcgi
19687 @cindex fcgiwrap
19688 FastCGI is an interface between the front-end and the back-end of a web
19689 service. It is a somewhat legacy facility; new web services should
19690 generally just talk HTTP between the front-end and the back-end.
19691 However there are a number of back-end services such as PHP or the
19692 optimized HTTP Git repository access that use FastCGI, so we have
19693 support for it in Guix.
19694
19695 To use FastCGI, you configure the front-end web server (e.g., nginx) to
19696 dispatch some subset of its requests to the fastcgi backend, which
19697 listens on a local TCP or UNIX socket. There is an intermediary
19698 @code{fcgiwrap} program that sits between the actual backend process and
19699 the web server. The front-end indicates which backend program to run,
19700 passing that information to the @code{fcgiwrap} process.
19701
19702 @defvr {Scheme Variable} fcgiwrap-service-type
19703 A service type for the @code{fcgiwrap} FastCGI proxy.
19704 @end defvr
19705
19706 @deftp {Data Type} fcgiwrap-configuration
19707 Data type representing the configuration of the @code{fcgiwrap} service.
19708 This type has the following parameters:
19709 @table @asis
19710 @item @code{package} (default: @code{fcgiwrap})
19711 The fcgiwrap package to use.
19712
19713 @item @code{socket} (default: @code{tcp:127.0.0.1:9000})
19714 The socket on which the @code{fcgiwrap} process should listen, as a
19715 string. Valid @var{socket} values include
19716 @code{unix:@var{/path/to/unix/socket}},
19717 @code{tcp:@var{dot.ted.qu.ad}:@var{port}} and
19718 @code{tcp6:[@var{ipv6_addr}]:port}.
19719
19720 @item @code{user} (default: @code{fcgiwrap})
19721 @itemx @code{group} (default: @code{fcgiwrap})
19722 The user and group names, as strings, under which to run the
19723 @code{fcgiwrap} process. The @code{fastcgi} service will ensure that if
19724 the user asks for the specific user or group names @code{fcgiwrap} that
19725 the corresponding user and/or group is present on the system.
19726
19727 It is possible to configure a FastCGI-backed web service to pass HTTP
19728 authentication information from the front-end to the back-end, and to
19729 allow @code{fcgiwrap} to run the back-end process as a corresponding
19730 local user. To enable this capability on the back-end., run
19731 @code{fcgiwrap} as the @code{root} user and group. Note that this
19732 capability also has to be configured on the front-end as well.
19733 @end table
19734 @end deftp
19735
19736 @cindex php-fpm
19737 PHP-FPM (FastCGI Process Manager) is an alternative PHP FastCGI implementation
19738 with some additional features useful for sites of any size.
19739
19740 These features include:
19741 @itemize @bullet
19742 @item Adaptive process spawning
19743 @item Basic statistics (similar to Apache's mod_status)
19744 @item Advanced process management with graceful stop/start
19745 @item Ability to start workers with different uid/gid/chroot/environment
19746 and different php.ini (replaces safe_mode)
19747 @item Stdout & stderr logging
19748 @item Emergency restart in case of accidental opcode cache destruction
19749 @item Accelerated upload support
19750 @item Support for a "slowlog"
19751 @item Enhancements to FastCGI, such as fastcgi_finish_request() -
19752 a special function to finish request & flush all data while continuing to do
19753 something time-consuming (video converting, stats processing, etc.)
19754 @end itemize
19755 ...@: and much more.
19756
19757 @defvr {Scheme Variable} php-fpm-service-type
19758 A Service type for @code{php-fpm}.
19759 @end defvr
19760
19761 @deftp {Data Type} php-fpm-configuration
19762 Data Type for php-fpm service configuration.
19763 @table @asis
19764 @item @code{php} (default: @code{php})
19765 The php package to use.
19766 @item @code{socket} (default: @code{(string-append "/var/run/php" (version-major (package-version php)) "-fpm.sock")})
19767 The address on which to accept FastCGI requests. Valid syntaxes are:
19768 @table @asis
19769 @item @code{"ip.add.re.ss:port"}
19770 Listen on a TCP socket to a specific address on a specific port.
19771 @item @code{"port"}
19772 Listen on a TCP socket to all addresses on a specific port.
19773 @item @code{"/path/to/unix/socket"}
19774 Listen on a unix socket.
19775 @end table
19776
19777 @item @code{user} (default: @code{php-fpm})
19778 User who will own the php worker processes.
19779 @item @code{group} (default: @code{php-fpm})
19780 Group of the worker processes.
19781 @item @code{socket-user} (default: @code{php-fpm})
19782 User who can speak to the php-fpm socket.
19783 @item @code{socket-group} (default: @code{php-fpm})
19784 Group that can speak to the php-fpm socket.
19785 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{(string-append "/var/run/php" (version-major (package-version php)) "-fpm.pid")})
19786 The process id of the php-fpm process is written to this file
19787 once the service has started.
19788 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{(string-append "/var/log/php" (version-major (package-version php)) "-fpm.log")})
19789 Log for the php-fpm master process.
19790 @item @code{process-manager} (default: @code{(php-fpm-dynamic-process-manager-configuration)})
19791 Detailed settings for the php-fpm process manager.
19792 Must be either:
19793 @table @asis
19794 @item @code{<php-fpm-dynamic-process-manager-configuration>}
19795 @item @code{<php-fpm-static-process-manager-configuration>}
19796 @item @code{<php-fpm-on-demand-process-manager-configuration>}
19797 @end table
19798 @item @code{display-errors} (default @code{#f})
19799 Determines whether php errors and warning should be sent to clients
19800 and displayed in their browsers.
19801 This is useful for local php development, but a security risk for public sites,
19802 as error messages can reveal passwords and personal data.
19803 @item @code{timezone} (default @code{#f})
19804 Specifies @code{php_admin_value[date.timezone]} parameter.
19805 @item @code{workers-logfile} (default @code{(string-append "/var/log/php" (version-major (package-version php)) "-fpm.www.log")})
19806 This file will log the @code{stderr} outputs of php worker processes.
19807 Can be set to @code{#f} to disable logging.
19808 @item @code{file} (default @code{#f})
19809 An optional override of the whole configuration.
19810 You can use the @code{mixed-text-file} function or an absolute filepath for it.
19811 @end table
19812 @end deftp
19813
19814 @deftp {Data type} php-fpm-dynamic-process-manager-configuration
19815 Data Type for the @code{dynamic} php-fpm process manager. With the
19816 @code{dynamic} process manager, spare worker processes are kept around
19817 based on it's configured limits.
19818 @table @asis
19819 @item @code{max-children} (default: @code{5})
19820 Maximum of worker processes.
19821 @item @code{start-servers} (default: @code{2})
19822 How many worker processes should be started on start-up.
19823 @item @code{min-spare-servers} (default: @code{1})
19824 How many spare worker processes should be kept around at minimum.
19825 @item @code{max-spare-servers} (default: @code{3})
19826 How many spare worker processes should be kept around at maximum.
19827 @end table
19828 @end deftp
19829
19830 @deftp {Data type} php-fpm-static-process-manager-configuration
19831 Data Type for the @code{static} php-fpm process manager. With the
19832 @code{static} process manager, an unchanging number of worker processes
19833 are created.
19834 @table @asis
19835 @item @code{max-children} (default: @code{5})
19836 Maximum of worker processes.
19837 @end table
19838 @end deftp
19839
19840 @deftp {Data type} php-fpm-on-demand-process-manager-configuration
19841 Data Type for the @code{on-demand} php-fpm process manager. With the
19842 @code{on-demand} process manager, worker processes are only created as
19843 requests arrive.
19844 @table @asis
19845 @item @code{max-children} (default: @code{5})
19846 Maximum of worker processes.
19847 @item @code{process-idle-timeout} (default: @code{10})
19848 The time in seconds after which a process with no requests is killed.
19849 @end table
19850 @end deftp
19851
19852
19853 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} nginx-php-fpm-location @
19854 [#:nginx-package nginx] @
19855 [socket (string-append "/var/run/php" @
19856 (version-major (package-version php)) @
19857 "-fpm.sock")]
19858 A helper function to quickly add php to an @code{nginx-server-configuration}.
19859 @end deffn
19860
19861 A simple services setup for nginx with php can look like this:
19862 @example
19863 (services (cons* (service dhcp-client-service-type)
19864 (service php-fpm-service-type)
19865 (service nginx-service-type
19866 (nginx-server-configuration
19867 (server-name '("example.com"))
19868 (root "/srv/http/")
19869 (locations
19870 (list (nginx-php-location)))
19871 (listen '("80"))
19872 (ssl-certificate #f)
19873 (ssl-certificate-key #f)))
19874 %base-services))
19875 @end example
19876
19877 @cindex cat-avatar-generator
19878 The cat avatar generator is a simple service to demonstrate the use of php-fpm
19879 in @code{Nginx}. It is used to generate cat avatar from a seed, for instance
19880 the hash of a user's email address.
19881
19882 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} cat-avatar-generator-service @
19883 [#:cache-dir "/var/cache/cat-avatar-generator"] @
19884 [#:package cat-avatar-generator] @
19885 [#:configuration (nginx-server-configuration)]
19886 Returns an nginx-server-configuration that inherits @code{configuration}. It
19887 extends the nginx configuration to add a server block that serves @code{package},
19888 a version of cat-avatar-generator. During execution, cat-avatar-generator will
19889 be able to use @code{cache-dir} as its cache directory.
19890 @end deffn
19891
19892 A simple setup for cat-avatar-generator can look like this:
19893 @example
19894 (services (cons* (cat-avatar-generator-service
19895 #:configuration
19896 (nginx-server-configuration
19897 (server-name '("example.com"))))
19898 ...
19899 %base-services))
19900 @end example
19901
19902 @subsubheading Hpcguix-web
19903
19904 @cindex hpcguix-web
19905 The @uref{https://github.com/UMCUGenetics/hpcguix-web/, hpcguix-web}
19906 program is a customizable web interface to browse Guix packages,
19907 initially designed for users of high-performance computing (HPC)
19908 clusters.
19909
19910 @defvr {Scheme Variable} hpcguix-web-service-type
19911 The service type for @code{hpcguix-web}.
19912 @end defvr
19913
19914 @deftp {Data Type} hpcguix-web-configuration
19915 Data type for the hpcguix-web service configuration.
19916
19917 @table @asis
19918 @item @code{specs}
19919 A gexp (@pxref{G-Expressions}) specifying the hpcguix-web service
19920 configuration. The main items available in this spec are:
19921
19922 @table @asis
19923 @item @code{title-prefix} (default: @code{"hpcguix | "})
19924 The page title prefix.
19925
19926 @item @code{guix-command} (default: @code{"guix"})
19927 The @command{guix} command.
19928
19929 @item @code{package-filter-proc} (default: @code{(const #t)})
19930 A procedure specifying how to filter packages that are displayed.
19931
19932 @item @code{package-page-extension-proc} (default: @code{(const '())})
19933 Extension package for @code{hpcguix-web}.
19934
19935 @item @code{menu} (default: @code{'()})
19936 Additional entry in page @code{menu}.
19937
19938 @item @code{channels} (default: @code{%default-channels})
19939 List of channels from which the package list is built (@pxref{Channels}).
19940
19941 @item @code{package-list-expiration} (default: @code{(* 12 3600)})
19942 The expiration time, in seconds, after which the package list is rebuilt from
19943 the latest instances of the given channels.
19944 @end table
19945
19946 See the hpcguix-web repository for a
19947 @uref{https://github.com/UMCUGenetics/hpcguix-web/blob/master/hpcweb-configuration.scm,
19948 complete example}.
19949
19950 @item @code{package} (default: @code{hpcguix-web})
19951 The hpcguix-web package to use.
19952 @end table
19953 @end deftp
19954
19955 A typical hpcguix-web service declaration looks like this:
19956
19957 @example
19958 (service hpcguix-web-service-type
19959 (hpcguix-web-configuration
19960 (specs
19961 #~(define site-config
19962 (hpcweb-configuration
19963 (title-prefix "Guix-HPC - ")
19964 (menu '(("/about" "ABOUT"))))))))
19965 @end example
19966
19967 @quotation Note
19968 The hpcguix-web service periodically updates the package list it publishes by
19969 pulling channels from Git. To that end, it needs to access X.509 certificates
19970 so that it can authenticate Git servers when communicating over HTTPS, and it
19971 assumes that @file{/etc/ssl/certs} contains those certificates.
19972
19973 Thus, make sure to add @code{nss-certs} or another certificate package to the
19974 @code{packages} field of your configuration. @ref{X.509 Certificates}, for
19975 more information on X.509 certificates.
19976 @end quotation
19977
19978 @node Certificate Services
19979 @subsection Certificate Services
19980
19981 @cindex Web
19982 @cindex HTTP, HTTPS
19983 @cindex Let's Encrypt
19984 @cindex TLS certificates
19985 The @code{(gnu services certbot)} module provides a service to
19986 automatically obtain a valid TLS certificate from the Let's Encrypt
19987 certificate authority. These certificates can then be used to serve
19988 content securely over HTTPS or other TLS-based protocols, with the
19989 knowledge that the client will be able to verify the server's
19990 authenticity.
19991
19992 @url{https://letsencrypt.org/, Let's Encrypt} provides the
19993 @code{certbot} tool to automate the certification process. This tool
19994 first securely generates a key on the server. It then makes a request
19995 to the Let's Encrypt certificate authority (CA) to sign the key. The CA
19996 checks that the request originates from the host in question by using a
19997 challenge-response protocol, requiring the server to provide its
19998 response over HTTP. If that protocol completes successfully, the CA
19999 signs the key, resulting in a certificate. That certificate is valid
20000 for a limited period of time, and therefore to continue to provide TLS
20001 services, the server needs to periodically ask the CA to renew its
20002 signature.
20003
20004 The certbot service automates this process: the initial key
20005 generation, the initial certification request to the Let's Encrypt
20006 service, the web server challenge/response integration, writing the
20007 certificate to disk, the automated periodic renewals, and the deployment
20008 tasks associated with the renewal (e.g.@: reloading services, copying keys
20009 with different permissions).
20010
20011 Certbot is run twice a day, at a random minute within the hour. It
20012 won't do anything until your certificates are due for renewal or
20013 revoked, but running it regularly would give your service a chance of
20014 staying online in case a Let's Encrypt-initiated revocation happened for
20015 some reason.
20016
20017 By using this service, you agree to the ACME Subscriber Agreement, which
20018 can be found there:
20019 @url{https://acme-v01.api.letsencrypt.org/directory}.
20020
20021 @defvr {Scheme Variable} certbot-service-type
20022 A service type for the @code{certbot} Let's Encrypt client. Its value
20023 must be a @code{certbot-configuration} record as in this example:
20024
20025 @example
20026 (define %nginx-deploy-hook
20027 (program-file
20028 "nginx-deploy-hook"
20029 #~(let ((pid (call-with-input-file "/var/run/nginx/pid" read)))
20030 (kill pid SIGHUP))))
20031
20032 (service certbot-service-type
20033 (certbot-configuration
20034 (email "foo@@example.net")
20035 (certificates
20036 (list
20037 (certificate-configuration
20038 (domains '("example.net" "www.example.net"))
20039 (deploy-hook %nginx-deploy-hook))
20040 (certificate-configuration
20041 (domains '("bar.example.net")))))))
20042 @end example
20043
20044 See below for details about @code{certbot-configuration}.
20045 @end defvr
20046
20047 @deftp {Data Type} certbot-configuration
20048 Data type representing the configuration of the @code{certbot} service.
20049 This type has the following parameters:
20050
20051 @table @asis
20052 @item @code{package} (default: @code{certbot})
20053 The certbot package to use.
20054
20055 @item @code{webroot} (default: @code{/var/www})
20056 The directory from which to serve the Let's Encrypt challenge/response
20057 files.
20058
20059 @item @code{certificates} (default: @code{()})
20060 A list of @code{certificates-configuration}s for which to generate
20061 certificates and request signatures. Each certificate has a @code{name}
20062 and several @code{domains}.
20063
20064 @item @code{email}
20065 Mandatory email used for registration, recovery contact, and important
20066 account notifications.
20067
20068 @item @code{rsa-key-size} (default: @code{2048})
20069 Size of the RSA key.
20070
20071 @item @code{default-location} (default: @i{see below})
20072 The default @code{nginx-location-configuration}. Because @code{certbot}
20073 needs to be able to serve challenges and responses, it needs to be able
20074 to run a web server. It does so by extending the @code{nginx} web
20075 service with an @code{nginx-server-configuration} listening on the
20076 @var{domains} on port 80, and which has a
20077 @code{nginx-location-configuration} for the @code{/.well-known/} URI
20078 path subspace used by Let's Encrypt. @xref{Web Services}, for more on
20079 these nginx configuration data types.
20080
20081 Requests to other URL paths will be matched by the
20082 @code{default-location}, which if present is added to all
20083 @code{nginx-server-configuration}s.
20084
20085 By default, the @code{default-location} will issue a redirect from
20086 @code{http://@var{domain}/...} to @code{https://@var{domain}/...}, leaving
20087 you to define what to serve on your site via @code{https}.
20088
20089 Pass @code{#f} to not issue a default location.
20090 @end table
20091 @end deftp
20092
20093 @deftp {Data Type} certificate-configuration
20094 Data type representing the configuration of a certificate.
20095 This type has the following parameters:
20096
20097 @table @asis
20098 @item @code{name} (default: @i{see below})
20099 This name is used by Certbot for housekeeping and in file paths; it
20100 doesn't affect the content of the certificate itself. To see
20101 certificate names, run @code{certbot certificates}.
20102
20103 Its default is the first provided domain.
20104
20105 @item @code{domains} (default: @code{()})
20106 The first domain provided will be the subject CN of the certificate, and
20107 all domains will be Subject Alternative Names on the certificate.
20108
20109 @item @code{challenge} (default: @code{#f})
20110 The challenge type that has to be run by certbot. If @code{#f} is specified,
20111 default to the HTTP challenge. If a value is specified, defaults to the
20112 manual plugin (see @code{authentication-hook}, @code{cleanup-hook} and
20113 the documentation at @url{https://certbot.eff.org/docs/using.html#hooks}).
20114
20115 @item @code{authentication-hook} (default: @code{#f})
20116 Command to be run in a shell once for each certificate challenge to be
20117 answered. For this command, the shell variable @code{$CERTBOT_DOMAIN}
20118 will contain the domain being authenticated, @code{$CERTBOT_VALIDATION}
20119 contains the validation string and @code{$CERTBOT_TOKEN} contains the
20120 file name of the resource requested when performing an HTTP-01 challenge.
20121
20122 @item @code{cleanup-hook} (default: @code{#f})
20123 Command to be run in a shell once for each certificate challenge that
20124 have been answered by the @code{auth-hook}. For this command, the shell
20125 variables available in the @code{auth-hook} script are still available, and
20126 additionally @code{$CERTBOT_AUTH_OUTPUT} will contain the standard output
20127 of the @code{auth-hook} script.
20128
20129 @item @code{deploy-hook} (default: @code{#f})
20130 Command to be run in a shell once for each successfully issued
20131 certificate. For this command, the shell variable
20132 @code{$RENEWED_LINEAGE} will point to the config live subdirectory (for
20133 example, @samp{"/etc/letsencrypt/live/example.com"}) containing the new
20134 certificates and keys; the shell variable @code{$RENEWED_DOMAINS} will
20135 contain a space-delimited list of renewed certificate domains (for
20136 example, @samp{"example.com www.example.com"}.
20137
20138 @end table
20139 @end deftp
20140
20141 For each @code{certificate-configuration}, the certificate is saved to
20142 @code{/etc/letsencrypt/live/@var{name}/fullchain.pem} and the key is
20143 saved to @code{/etc/letsencrypt/live/@var{name}/privkey.pem}.
20144 @node DNS Services
20145 @subsection DNS Services
20146 @cindex DNS (domain name system)
20147 @cindex domain name system (DNS)
20148
20149 The @code{(gnu services dns)} module provides services related to the
20150 @dfn{domain name system} (DNS). It provides a server service for hosting
20151 an @emph{authoritative} DNS server for multiple zones, slave or master.
20152 This service uses @uref{https://www.knot-dns.cz/, Knot DNS}. And also a
20153 caching and forwarding DNS server for the LAN, which uses
20154 @uref{http://www.thekelleys.org.uk/dnsmasq/doc.html, dnsmasq}.
20155
20156 @subsubheading Knot Service
20157
20158 An example configuration of an authoritative server for two zones, one master
20159 and one slave, is:
20160
20161 @lisp
20162 (define-zone-entries example.org.zone
20163 ;; Name TTL Class Type Data
20164 ("@@" "" "IN" "A" "127.0.0.1")
20165 ("@@" "" "IN" "NS" "ns")
20166 ("ns" "" "IN" "A" "127.0.0.1"))
20167
20168 (define master-zone
20169 (knot-zone-configuration
20170 (domain "example.org")
20171 (zone (zone-file
20172 (origin "example.org")
20173 (entries example.org.zone)))))
20174
20175 (define slave-zone
20176 (knot-zone-configuration
20177 (domain "plop.org")
20178 (dnssec-policy "default")
20179 (master (list "plop-master"))))
20180
20181 (define plop-master
20182 (knot-remote-configuration
20183 (id "plop-master")
20184 (address (list "208.76.58.171"))))
20185
20186 (operating-system
20187 ;; ...
20188 (services (cons* (service knot-service-type
20189 (knot-configuration
20190 (remotes (list plop-master))
20191 (zones (list master-zone slave-zone))))
20192 ;; ...
20193 %base-services)))
20194 @end lisp
20195
20196 @deffn {Scheme Variable} knot-service-type
20197 This is the type for the Knot DNS server.
20198
20199 Knot DNS is an authoritative DNS server, meaning that it can serve multiple
20200 zones, that is to say domain names you would buy from a registrar. This server
20201 is not a resolver, meaning that it can only resolve names for which it is
20202 authoritative. This server can be configured to serve zones as a master server
20203 or a slave server as a per-zone basis. Slave zones will get their data from
20204 masters, and will serve it as an authoritative server. From the point of view
20205 of a resolver, there is no difference between master and slave.
20206
20207 The following data types are used to configure the Knot DNS server:
20208 @end deffn
20209
20210 @deftp {Data Type} knot-key-configuration
20211 Data type representing a key.
20212 This type has the following parameters:
20213
20214 @table @asis
20215 @item @code{id} (default: @code{""})
20216 An identifier for other configuration fields to refer to this key. IDs must
20217 be unique and must not be empty.
20218
20219 @item @code{algorithm} (default: @code{#f})
20220 The algorithm to use. Choose between @code{#f}, @code{'hmac-md5},
20221 @code{'hmac-sha1}, @code{'hmac-sha224}, @code{'hmac-sha256}, @code{'hmac-sha384}
20222 and @code{'hmac-sha512}.
20223
20224 @item @code{secret} (default: @code{""})
20225 The secret key itself.
20226
20227 @end table
20228 @end deftp
20229
20230 @deftp {Data Type} knot-acl-configuration
20231 Data type representing an Access Control List (ACL) configuration.
20232 This type has the following parameters:
20233
20234 @table @asis
20235 @item @code{id} (default: @code{""})
20236 An identifier for ether configuration fields to refer to this key. IDs must be
20237 unique and must not be empty.
20238
20239 @item @code{address} (default: @code{'()})
20240 An ordered list of IP addresses, network subnets, or network ranges represented
20241 with strings. The query must match one of them. Empty value means that
20242 address match is not required.
20243
20244 @item @code{key} (default: @code{'()})
20245 An ordered list of references to keys represented with strings. The string
20246 must match a key ID defined in a @code{knot-key-configuration}. No key means
20247 that a key is not require to match that ACL.
20248
20249 @item @code{action} (default: @code{'()})
20250 An ordered list of actions that are permitted or forbidden by this ACL. Possible
20251 values are lists of zero or more elements from @code{'transfer}, @code{'notify}
20252 and @code{'update}.
20253
20254 @item @code{deny?} (default: @code{#f})
20255 When true, the ACL defines restrictions. Listed actions are forbidden. When
20256 false, listed actions are allowed.
20257
20258 @end table
20259 @end deftp
20260
20261 @deftp {Data Type} zone-entry
20262 Data type represnting a record entry in a zone file.
20263 This type has the following parameters:
20264
20265 @table @asis
20266 @item @code{name} (default: @code{"@@"})
20267 The name of the record. @code{"@@"} refers to the origin of the zone. Names
20268 are relative to the origin of the zone. For example, in the @code{example.org}
20269 zone, @code{"ns.example.org"} actually refers to @code{ns.example.org.example.org}.
20270 Names ending with a dot are absolute, which means that @code{"ns.example.org."}
20271 refers to @code{ns.example.org}.
20272
20273 @item @code{ttl} (default: @code{""})
20274 The Time-To-Live (TTL) of this record. If not set, the default TTL is used.
20275
20276 @item @code{class} (default: @code{"IN"})
20277 The class of the record. Knot currently supports only @code{"IN"} and
20278 partially @code{"CH"}.
20279
20280 @item @code{type} (default: @code{"A"})
20281 The type of the record. Common types include A (IPv4 address), AAAA (IPv6
20282 address), NS (Name Server) and MX (Mail eXchange). Many other types are
20283 defined.
20284
20285 @item @code{data} (default: @code{""})
20286 The data contained in the record. For instance an IP address associated with
20287 an A record, or a domain name associated with an NS record. Remember that
20288 domain names are relative to the origin unless they end with a dot.
20289
20290 @end table
20291 @end deftp
20292
20293 @deftp {Data Type} zone-file
20294 Data type representing the content of a zone file.
20295 This type has the following parameters:
20296
20297 @table @asis
20298 @item @code{entries} (default: @code{'()})
20299 The list of entries. The SOA record is taken care of, so you don't need to
20300 put it in the list of entries. This list should probably contain an entry
20301 for your primary authoritative DNS server. Other than using a list of entries
20302 directly, you can use @code{define-zone-entries} to define a object containing
20303 the list of entries more easily, that you can later pass to the @code{entries}
20304 field of the @code{zone-file}.
20305
20306 @item @code{origin} (default: @code{""})
20307 The name of your zone. This parameter cannot be empty.
20308
20309 @item @code{ns} (default: @code{"ns"})
20310 The domain of your primary authoritative DNS server. The name is relative to
20311 the origin, unless it ends with a dot. It is mandatory that this primary
20312 DNS server corresponds to an NS record in the zone and that it is associated
20313 to an IP address in the list of entries.
20314
20315 @item @code{mail} (default: @code{"hostmaster"})
20316 An email address people can contact you at, as the owner of the zone. This
20317 is translated as @code{<mail>@@<origin>}.
20318
20319 @item @code{serial} (default: @code{1})
20320 The serial number of the zone. As this is used to keep track of changes by
20321 both slaves and resolvers, it is mandatory that it @emph{never} decreases.
20322 Always increment it when you make a change in your zone.
20323
20324 @item @code{refresh} (default: @code{(* 2 24 3600)})
20325 The frequency at which slaves will do a zone transfer. This value is a number
20326 of seconds. It can be computed by multiplications or with
20327 @code{(string->duration)}.
20328
20329 @item @code{retry} (default: @code{(* 15 60)})
20330 The period after which a slave will retry to contact its master when it fails
20331 to do so a first time.
20332
20333 @item @code{expiry} (default: @code{(* 14 24 3600)})
20334 Default TTL of records. Existing records are considered correct for at most
20335 this amount of time. After this period, resolvers will invalidate their cache
20336 and check again that it still exists.
20337
20338 @item @code{nx} (default: @code{3600})
20339 Default TTL of inexistant records. This delay is usually short because you want
20340 your new domains to reach everyone quickly.
20341
20342 @end table
20343 @end deftp
20344
20345 @deftp {Data Type} knot-remote-configuration
20346 Data type representing a remote configuration.
20347 This type has the following parameters:
20348
20349 @table @asis
20350 @item @code{id} (default: @code{""})
20351 An identifier for other configuration fields to refer to this remote. IDs must
20352 be unique and must not be empty.
20353
20354 @item @code{address} (default: @code{'()})
20355 An ordered list of destination IP addresses. Addresses are tried in sequence.
20356 An optional port can be given with the @@ separator. For instance:
20357 @code{(list "1.2.3.4" "2.3.4.5@@53")}. Default port is 53.
20358
20359 @item @code{via} (default: @code{'()})
20360 An ordered list of source IP addresses. An empty list will have Knot choose
20361 an appropriate source IP. An optional port can be given with the @@ separator.
20362 The default is to choose at random.
20363
20364 @item @code{key} (default: @code{#f})
20365 A reference to a key, that is a string containing the identifier of a key
20366 defined in a @code{knot-key-configuration} field.
20367
20368 @end table
20369 @end deftp
20370
20371 @deftp {Data Type} knot-keystore-configuration
20372 Data type representing a keystore to hold dnssec keys.
20373 This type has the following parameters:
20374
20375 @table @asis
20376 @item @code{id} (default: @code{""})
20377 The id of the keystore. It must not be empty.
20378
20379 @item @code{backend} (default: @code{'pem})
20380 The backend to store the keys in. Can be @code{'pem} or @code{'pkcs11}.
20381
20382 @item @code{config} (default: @code{"/var/lib/knot/keys/keys"})
20383 The configuration string of the backend. An example for the PKCS#11 is:
20384 @code{"pkcs11:token=knot;pin-value=1234 /gnu/store/.../lib/pkcs11/libsofthsm2.so"}.
20385 For the pem backend, the string reprensents a path in the file system.
20386
20387 @end table
20388 @end deftp
20389
20390 @deftp {Data Type} knot-policy-configuration
20391 Data type representing a dnssec policy. Knot DNS is able to automatically
20392 sign your zones. It can either generate and manage your keys automatically or
20393 use keys that you generate.
20394
20395 Dnssec is usually implemented using two keys: a Key Signing Key (KSK) that is
20396 used to sign the second, and a Zone Signing Key (ZSK) that is used to sign the
20397 zone. In order to be trusted, the KSK needs to be present in the parent zone
20398 (usually a top-level domain). If your registrar supports dnssec, you will
20399 have to send them your KSK's hash so they can add a DS record in their zone.
20400 This is not automated and need to be done each time you change your KSK.
20401
20402 The policy also defines the lifetime of keys. Usually, ZSK can be changed
20403 easily and use weaker cryptographic functions (they use lower parameters) in
20404 order to sign records quickly, so they are changed often. The KSK however
20405 requires manual interaction with the registrar, so they are changed less often
20406 and use stronger parameters because they sign only one record.
20407
20408 This type has the following parameters:
20409
20410 @table @asis
20411 @item @code{id} (default: @code{""})
20412 The id of the policy. It must not be empty.
20413
20414 @item @code{keystore} (default: @code{"default"})
20415 A reference to a keystore, that is a string containing the identifier of a
20416 keystore defined in a @code{knot-keystore-configuration} field. The
20417 @code{"default"} identifier means the default keystore (a kasp database that
20418 was setup by this service).
20419
20420 @item @code{manual?} (default: @code{#f})
20421 Whether the key management is manual or automatic.
20422
20423 @item @code{single-type-signing?} (default: @code{#f})
20424 When @code{#t}, use the Single-Type Signing Scheme.
20425
20426 @item @code{algorithm} (default: @code{"ecdsap256sha256"})
20427 An algorithm of signing keys and issued signatures.
20428
20429 @item @code{ksk-size} (default: @code{256})
20430 The length of the KSK. Note that this value is correct for the default
20431 algorithm, but would be unsecure for other algorithms.
20432
20433 @item @code{zsk-size} (default: @code{256})
20434 The length of the ZSK. Note that this value is correct for the default
20435 algorithm, but would be unsecure for other algorithms.
20436
20437 @item @code{dnskey-ttl} (default: @code{'default})
20438 The TTL value for DNSKEY records added into zone apex. The special
20439 @code{'default} value means same as the zone SOA TTL.
20440
20441 @item @code{zsk-lifetime} (default: @code{(* 30 24 3600)})
20442 The period between ZSK publication and the next rollover initiation.
20443
20444 @item @code{propagation-delay} (default: @code{(* 24 3600)})
20445 An extra delay added for each key rollover step. This value should be high
20446 enough to cover propagation of data from the master server to all slaves.
20447
20448 @item @code{rrsig-lifetime} (default: @code{(* 14 24 3600)})
20449 A validity period of newly issued signatures.
20450
20451 @item @code{rrsig-refresh} (default: @code{(* 7 24 3600)})
20452 A period how long before a signature expiration the signature will be refreshed.
20453
20454 @item @code{nsec3?} (default: @code{#f})
20455 When @code{#t}, NSEC3 will be used instead of NSEC.
20456
20457 @item @code{nsec3-iterations} (default: @code{5})
20458 The number of additional times the hashing is performed.
20459
20460 @item @code{nsec3-salt-length} (default: @code{8})
20461 The length of a salt field in octets, which is appended to the original owner
20462 name before hashing.
20463
20464 @item @code{nsec3-salt-lifetime} (default: @code{(* 30 24 3600)})
20465 The validity period of newly issued salt field.
20466
20467 @end table
20468 @end deftp
20469
20470 @deftp {Data Type} knot-zone-configuration
20471 Data type representing a zone served by Knot.
20472 This type has the following parameters:
20473
20474 @table @asis
20475 @item @code{domain} (default: @code{""})
20476 The domain served by this configuration. It must not be empty.
20477
20478 @item @code{file} (default: @code{""})
20479 The file where this zone is saved. This parameter is ignored by master zones.
20480 Empty means default location that depends on the domain name.
20481
20482 @item @code{zone} (default: @code{(zone-file)})
20483 The content of the zone file. This parameter is ignored by slave zones. It
20484 must contain a zone-file record.
20485
20486 @item @code{master} (default: @code{'()})
20487 A list of master remotes. When empty, this zone is a master. When set, this
20488 zone is a slave. This is a list of remotes identifiers.
20489
20490 @item @code{ddns-master} (default: @code{#f})
20491 The main master. When empty, it defaults to the first master in the list of
20492 masters.
20493
20494 @item @code{notify} (default: @code{'()})
20495 A list of slave remote identifiers.
20496
20497 @item @code{acl} (default: @code{'()})
20498 A list of acl identifiers.
20499
20500 @item @code{semantic-checks?} (default: @code{#f})
20501 When set, this adds more semantic checks to the zone.
20502
20503 @item @code{disable-any?} (default: @code{#f})
20504 When set, this forbids queries of the ANY type.
20505
20506 @item @code{zonefile-sync} (default: @code{0})
20507 The delay between a modification in memory and on disk. 0 means immediate
20508 synchronization.
20509
20510 @item @code{zonefile-load} (default: @code{#f})
20511 The way the zone file contents are applied during zone load. Possible values
20512 are:
20513
20514 @itemize
20515 @item @code{#f} for using the default value from Knot,
20516 @item @code{'none} for not using the zone file at all,
20517 @item @code{'difference} for computing the difference between already available
20518 contents and zone contents and applying it to the current zone contents,
20519 @item @code{'difference-no-serial} for the same as @code{'difference}, but
20520 ignoring the SOA serial in the zone file, while the server takes care of it
20521 automatically.
20522 @item @code{'whole} for loading zone contents from the zone file.
20523 @end itemize
20524
20525 @item @code{journal-content} (default: @code{#f})
20526 The way the journal is used to store zone and its changes. Possible values
20527 are @code{'none} to not use it at all, @code{'changes} to store changes and
20528 @code{'all} to store contents. @code{#f} does not set this option, so the
20529 default value from Knot is used.
20530
20531 @item @code{max-journal-usage} (default: @code{#f})
20532 The maximum size for the journal on disk. @code{#f} does not set this option,
20533 so the default value from Knot is used.
20534
20535 @item @code{max-journal-depth} (default: @code{#f})
20536 The maximum size of the history. @code{#f} does not set this option, so the
20537 default value from Knot is used.
20538
20539 @item @code{max-zone-size} (default: @code{#f})
20540 The maximum size of the zone file. This limit is enforced for incoming
20541 transfer and updates. @code{#f} does not set this option, so the default
20542 value from Knot is used.
20543
20544 @item @code{dnssec-policy} (default: @code{#f})
20545 A reference to a @code{knot-policy-configuration} record, or the special
20546 name @code{"default"}. If the value is @code{#f}, there is no dnssec signing
20547 on this zone.
20548
20549 @item @code{serial-policy} (default: @code{'increment})
20550 A policy between @code{'increment} and @code{'unixtime}.
20551
20552 @end table
20553 @end deftp
20554
20555 @deftp {Data Type} knot-configuration
20556 Data type representing the Knot configuration.
20557 This type has the following parameters:
20558
20559 @table @asis
20560 @item @code{knot} (default: @code{knot})
20561 The Knot package.
20562
20563 @item @code{run-directory} (default: @code{"/var/run/knot"})
20564 The run directory. This directory will be used for pid file and sockets.
20565
20566 @item @code{includes} (default: @code{'()})
20567 A list of strings or file-like objects denoting other files that must be
20568 included at the top of the configuration file.
20569
20570 @cindex secrets, Knot service
20571 This can be used to manage secrets out-of-band. For example, secret
20572 keys may be stored in an out-of-band file not managed by Guix, and
20573 thus not visible in @file{/gnu/store}---e.g., you could store secret
20574 key configuration in @file{/etc/knot/secrets.conf} and add this file
20575 to the @code{includes} list.
20576
20577 It can also be used to add configuration not supported by this interface.
20578
20579 @item @code{listen-v4} (default: @code{"0.0.0.0"})
20580 An ip address on which to listen.
20581
20582 @item @code{listen-v6} (default: @code{"::"})
20583 An ip address on which to listen.
20584
20585 @item @code{listen-port} (default: @code{53})
20586 A port on which to listen.
20587
20588 @item @code{keys} (default: @code{'()})
20589 The list of knot-key-configuration used by this configuration.
20590
20591 @item @code{acls} (default: @code{'()})
20592 The list of knot-acl-configuration used by this configuration.
20593
20594 @item @code{remotes} (default: @code{'()})
20595 The list of knot-remote-configuration used by this configuration.
20596
20597 @item @code{zones} (default: @code{'()})
20598 The list of knot-zone-configuration used by this configuration.
20599
20600 @end table
20601 @end deftp
20602
20603 @subsubheading Dnsmasq Service
20604
20605 @deffn {Scheme Variable} dnsmasq-service-type
20606 This is the type of the dnsmasq service, whose value should be an
20607 @code{dnsmasq-configuration} object as in this example:
20608
20609 @example
20610 (service dnsmasq-service-type
20611 (dnsmasq-configuration
20612 (no-resolv? #t)
20613 (servers '("192.168.1.1"))))
20614 @end example
20615 @end deffn
20616
20617 @deftp {Data Type} dnsmasq-configuration
20618 Data type representing the configuration of dnsmasq.
20619
20620 @table @asis
20621 @item @code{package} (default: @var{dnsmasq})
20622 Package object of the dnsmasq server.
20623
20624 @item @code{no-hosts?} (default: @code{#f})
20625 When true, don't read the hostnames in /etc/hosts.
20626
20627 @item @code{port} (default: @code{53})
20628 The port to listen on. Setting this to zero completely disables DNS
20629 responses, leaving only DHCP and/or TFTP functions.
20630
20631 @item @code{local-service?} (default: @code{#t})
20632 Accept DNS queries only from hosts whose address is on a local subnet,
20633 ie a subnet for which an interface exists on the server.
20634
20635 @item @code{listen-addresses} (default: @code{'()})
20636 Listen on the given IP addresses.
20637
20638 @item @code{resolv-file} (default: @code{"/etc/resolv.conf"})
20639 The file to read the IP address of the upstream nameservers from.
20640
20641 @item @code{no-resolv?} (default: @code{#f})
20642 When true, don't read @var{resolv-file}.
20643
20644 @item @code{servers} (default: @code{'()})
20645 Specify IP address of upstream servers directly.
20646
20647 @item @code{cache-size} (default: @code{150})
20648 Set the size of dnsmasq's cache. Setting the cache size to zero
20649 disables caching.
20650
20651 @item @code{negative-cache?} (default: @code{#t})
20652 When false, disable negative caching.
20653
20654 @end table
20655 @end deftp
20656
20657 @subsubheading ddclient Service
20658
20659 @cindex ddclient
20660 The ddclient service described below runs the ddclient daemon, which takes
20661 care of automatically updating DNS entries for service providers such as
20662 @uref{https://dyn.com/dns/, Dyn}.
20663
20664 The following example show instantiates the service with its default
20665 configuration:
20666
20667 @example
20668 (service ddclient-service-type)
20669 @end example
20670
20671 Note that ddclient needs to access credentials that are stored in a
20672 @dfn{secret file}, by default @file{/etc/ddclient/secrets} (see
20673 @code{secret-file} below.) You are expected to create this file manually, in
20674 an ``out-of-band'' fashion (you @emph{could} make this file part of the
20675 service configuration, for instance by using @code{plain-file}, but it will be
20676 world-readable @i{via} @file{/gnu/store}.) See the examples in the
20677 @file{share/ddclient} directory of the @code{ddclient} package.
20678
20679 @c %start of fragment
20680
20681 Available @code{ddclient-configuration} fields are:
20682
20683 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} package ddclient
20684 The ddclient package.
20685
20686 @end deftypevr
20687
20688 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} integer daemon
20689 The period after which ddclient will retry to check IP and domain name.
20690
20691 Defaults to @samp{300}.
20692
20693 @end deftypevr
20694
20695 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} boolean syslog
20696 Use syslog for the output.
20697
20698 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
20699
20700 @end deftypevr
20701
20702 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} string mail
20703 Mail to user.
20704
20705 Defaults to @samp{"root"}.
20706
20707 @end deftypevr
20708
20709 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} string mail-failure
20710 Mail failed update to user.
20711
20712 Defaults to @samp{"root"}.
20713
20714 @end deftypevr
20715
20716 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} string pid
20717 The ddclient PID file.
20718
20719 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/ddclient/ddclient.pid"}.
20720
20721 @end deftypevr
20722
20723 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} boolean ssl
20724 Enable SSL support.
20725
20726 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
20727
20728 @end deftypevr
20729
20730 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} string user
20731 Specifies the user name or ID that is used when running ddclient
20732 program.
20733
20734 Defaults to @samp{"ddclient"}.
20735
20736 @end deftypevr
20737
20738 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} string group
20739 Group of the user who will run the ddclient program.
20740
20741 Defaults to @samp{"ddclient"}.
20742
20743 @end deftypevr
20744
20745 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} string secret-file
20746 Secret file which will be appended to @file{ddclient.conf} file. This
20747 file contains credentials for use by ddclient. You are expected to
20748 create it manually.
20749
20750 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/ddclient/secrets.conf"}.
20751
20752 @end deftypevr
20753
20754 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} list extra-options
20755 Extra options will be appended to @file{ddclient.conf} file.
20756
20757 Defaults to @samp{()}.
20758
20759 @end deftypevr
20760
20761
20762 @c %end of fragment
20763
20764
20765 @node VPN Services
20766 @subsection VPN Services
20767 @cindex VPN (virtual private network)
20768 @cindex virtual private network (VPN)
20769
20770 The @code{(gnu services vpn)} module provides services related to
20771 @dfn{virtual private networks} (VPNs). It provides a @emph{client} service for
20772 your machine to connect to a VPN, and a @emph{server} service for your machine
20773 to host a VPN. Both services use @uref{https://openvpn.net/, OpenVPN}.
20774
20775 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} openvpn-client-service @
20776 [#:config (openvpn-client-configuration)]
20777
20778 Return a service that runs @command{openvpn}, a VPN daemon, as a client.
20779 @end deffn
20780
20781 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} openvpn-server-service @
20782 [#:config (openvpn-server-configuration)]
20783
20784 Return a service that runs @command{openvpn}, a VPN daemon, as a server.
20785
20786 Both can be run simultaneously.
20787 @end deffn
20788
20789 @c %automatically generated documentation
20790
20791 Available @code{openvpn-client-configuration} fields are:
20792
20793 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} package openvpn
20794 The OpenVPN package.
20795
20796 @end deftypevr
20797
20798 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} string pid-file
20799 The OpenVPN pid file.
20800
20801 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/openvpn/openvpn.pid"}.
20802
20803 @end deftypevr
20804
20805 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} proto proto
20806 The protocol (UDP or TCP) used to open a channel between clients and
20807 servers.
20808
20809 Defaults to @samp{udp}.
20810
20811 @end deftypevr
20812
20813 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} dev dev
20814 The device type used to represent the VPN connection.
20815
20816 Defaults to @samp{tun}.
20817
20818 @end deftypevr
20819
20820 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} string ca
20821 The certificate authority to check connections against.
20822
20823 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/ca.crt"}.
20824
20825 @end deftypevr
20826
20827 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} string cert
20828 The certificate of the machine the daemon is running on. It should be
20829 signed by the authority given in @code{ca}.
20830
20831 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/client.crt"}.
20832
20833 @end deftypevr
20834
20835 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} string key
20836 The key of the machine the daemon is running on. It must be the key whose
20837 certificate is @code{cert}.
20838
20839 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/client.key"}.
20840
20841 @end deftypevr
20842
20843 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} boolean comp-lzo?
20844 Whether to use the lzo compression algorithm.
20845
20846 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
20847
20848 @end deftypevr
20849
20850 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} boolean persist-key?
20851 Don't re-read key files across SIGUSR1 or --ping-restart.
20852
20853 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
20854
20855 @end deftypevr
20856
20857 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} boolean persist-tun?
20858 Don't close and reopen TUN/TAP device or run up/down scripts across
20859 SIGUSR1 or --ping-restart restarts.
20860
20861 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
20862
20863 @end deftypevr
20864
20865 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} number verbosity
20866 Verbosity level.
20867
20868 Defaults to @samp{3}.
20869
20870 @end deftypevr
20871
20872 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} tls-auth-client tls-auth
20873 Add an additional layer of HMAC authentication on top of the TLS control
20874 channel to protect against DoS attacks.
20875
20876 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20877
20878 @end deftypevr
20879
20880 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} key-usage verify-key-usage?
20881 Whether to check the server certificate has server usage extension.
20882
20883 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
20884
20885 @end deftypevr
20886
20887 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} bind bind?
20888 Bind to a specific local port number.
20889
20890 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20891
20892 @end deftypevr
20893
20894 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} resolv-retry resolv-retry?
20895 Retry resolving server address.
20896
20897 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
20898
20899 @end deftypevr
20900
20901 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} openvpn-remote-list remote
20902 A list of remote servers to connect to.
20903
20904 Defaults to @samp{()}.
20905
20906 Available @code{openvpn-remote-configuration} fields are:
20907
20908 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-remote-configuration} parameter} string name
20909 Server name.
20910
20911 Defaults to @samp{"my-server"}.
20912
20913 @end deftypevr
20914
20915 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-remote-configuration} parameter} number port
20916 Port number the server listens to.
20917
20918 Defaults to @samp{1194}.
20919
20920 @end deftypevr
20921
20922 @end deftypevr
20923 @c %end of automatic openvpn-client documentation
20924
20925 @c %automatically generated documentation
20926
20927 Available @code{openvpn-server-configuration} fields are:
20928
20929 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} package openvpn
20930 The OpenVPN package.
20931
20932 @end deftypevr
20933
20934 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} string pid-file
20935 The OpenVPN pid file.
20936
20937 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/openvpn/openvpn.pid"}.
20938
20939 @end deftypevr
20940
20941 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} proto proto
20942 The protocol (UDP or TCP) used to open a channel between clients and
20943 servers.
20944
20945 Defaults to @samp{udp}.
20946
20947 @end deftypevr
20948
20949 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} dev dev
20950 The device type used to represent the VPN connection.
20951
20952 Defaults to @samp{tun}.
20953
20954 @end deftypevr
20955
20956 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} string ca
20957 The certificate authority to check connections against.
20958
20959 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/ca.crt"}.
20960
20961 @end deftypevr
20962
20963 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} string cert
20964 The certificate of the machine the daemon is running on. It should be
20965 signed by the authority given in @code{ca}.
20966
20967 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/client.crt"}.
20968
20969 @end deftypevr
20970
20971 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} string key
20972 The key of the machine the daemon is running on. It must be the key whose
20973 certificate is @code{cert}.
20974
20975 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/client.key"}.
20976
20977 @end deftypevr
20978
20979 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} boolean comp-lzo?
20980 Whether to use the lzo compression algorithm.
20981
20982 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
20983
20984 @end deftypevr
20985
20986 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} boolean persist-key?
20987 Don't re-read key files across SIGUSR1 or --ping-restart.
20988
20989 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
20990
20991 @end deftypevr
20992
20993 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} boolean persist-tun?
20994 Don't close and reopen TUN/TAP device or run up/down scripts across
20995 SIGUSR1 or --ping-restart restarts.
20996
20997 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
20998
20999 @end deftypevr
21000
21001 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} number verbosity
21002 Verbosity level.
21003
21004 Defaults to @samp{3}.
21005
21006 @end deftypevr
21007
21008 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} tls-auth-server tls-auth
21009 Add an additional layer of HMAC authentication on top of the TLS control
21010 channel to protect against DoS attacks.
21011
21012 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21013
21014 @end deftypevr
21015
21016 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} number port
21017 Specifies the port number on which the server listens.
21018
21019 Defaults to @samp{1194}.
21020
21021 @end deftypevr
21022
21023 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} ip-mask server
21024 An ip and mask specifying the subnet inside the virtual network.
21025
21026 Defaults to @samp{"10.8.0.0 255.255.255.0"}.
21027
21028 @end deftypevr
21029
21030 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} cidr6 server-ipv6
21031 A CIDR notation specifying the IPv6 subnet inside the virtual network.
21032
21033 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21034
21035 @end deftypevr
21036
21037 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} string dh
21038 The Diffie-Hellman parameters file.
21039
21040 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/dh2048.pem"}.
21041
21042 @end deftypevr
21043
21044 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} string ifconfig-pool-persist
21045 The file that records client IPs.
21046
21047 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/ipp.txt"}.
21048
21049 @end deftypevr
21050
21051 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} gateway redirect-gateway?
21052 When true, the server will act as a gateway for its clients.
21053
21054 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21055
21056 @end deftypevr
21057
21058 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} boolean client-to-client?
21059 When true, clients are allowed to talk to each other inside the VPN.
21060
21061 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21062
21063 @end deftypevr
21064
21065 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} keepalive keepalive
21066 Causes ping-like messages to be sent back and forth over the link so
21067 that each side knows when the other side has gone down. @code{keepalive}
21068 requires a pair. The first element is the period of the ping sending,
21069 and the second element is the timeout before considering the other side
21070 down.
21071
21072 @end deftypevr
21073
21074 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} number max-clients
21075 The maximum number of clients.
21076
21077 Defaults to @samp{100}.
21078
21079 @end deftypevr
21080
21081 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} string status
21082 The status file. This file shows a small report on current connection.
21083 It is truncated and rewritten every minute.
21084
21085 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/openvpn/status"}.
21086
21087 @end deftypevr
21088
21089 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} openvpn-ccd-list client-config-dir
21090 The list of configuration for some clients.
21091
21092 Defaults to @samp{()}.
21093
21094 Available @code{openvpn-ccd-configuration} fields are:
21095
21096 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-ccd-configuration} parameter} string name
21097 Client name.
21098
21099 Defaults to @samp{"client"}.
21100
21101 @end deftypevr
21102
21103 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-ccd-configuration} parameter} ip-mask iroute
21104 Client own network
21105
21106 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21107
21108 @end deftypevr
21109
21110 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-ccd-configuration} parameter} ip-mask ifconfig-push
21111 Client VPN IP.
21112
21113 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21114
21115 @end deftypevr
21116
21117 @end deftypevr
21118
21119
21120 @c %end of automatic openvpn-server documentation
21121
21122
21123 @node Network File System
21124 @subsection Network File System
21125 @cindex NFS
21126
21127 The @code{(gnu services nfs)} module provides the following services,
21128 which are most commonly used in relation to mounting or exporting
21129 directory trees as @dfn{network file systems} (NFS).
21130
21131 @subsubheading RPC Bind Service
21132 @cindex rpcbind
21133
21134 The RPC Bind service provides a facility to map program numbers into
21135 universal addresses.
21136 Many NFS related services use this facility. Hence it is automatically
21137 started when a dependent service starts.
21138
21139 @defvr {Scheme Variable} rpcbind-service-type
21140 A service type for the RPC portmapper daemon.
21141 @end defvr
21142
21143
21144 @deftp {Data Type} rpcbind-configuration
21145 Data type representing the configuration of the RPC Bind Service.
21146 This type has the following parameters:
21147 @table @asis
21148 @item @code{rpcbind} (default: @code{rpcbind})
21149 The rpcbind package to use.
21150
21151 @item @code{warm-start?} (default: @code{#t})
21152 If this parameter is @code{#t}, then the daemon will read a
21153 state file on startup thus reloading state information saved by a previous
21154 instance.
21155 @end table
21156 @end deftp
21157
21158
21159 @subsubheading Pipefs Pseudo File System
21160 @cindex pipefs
21161 @cindex rpc_pipefs
21162
21163 The pipefs file system is used to transfer NFS related data
21164 between the kernel and user space programs.
21165
21166 @defvr {Scheme Variable} pipefs-service-type
21167 A service type for the pipefs pseudo file system.
21168 @end defvr
21169
21170 @deftp {Data Type} pipefs-configuration
21171 Data type representing the configuration of the pipefs pseudo file system service.
21172 This type has the following parameters:
21173 @table @asis
21174 @item @code{mount-point} (default: @code{"/var/lib/nfs/rpc_pipefs"})
21175 The directory to which the file system is to be attached.
21176 @end table
21177 @end deftp
21178
21179
21180 @subsubheading GSS Daemon Service
21181 @cindex GSSD
21182 @cindex GSS
21183 @cindex global security system
21184
21185 The @dfn{global security system} (GSS) daemon provides strong security for RPC
21186 based protocols.
21187 Before exchanging RPC requests an RPC client must establish a security
21188 context. Typically this is done using the Kerberos command @command{kinit}
21189 or automatically at login time using PAM services (@pxref{Kerberos Services}).
21190
21191 @defvr {Scheme Variable} gss-service-type
21192 A service type for the Global Security System (GSS) daemon.
21193 @end defvr
21194
21195 @deftp {Data Type} gss-configuration
21196 Data type representing the configuration of the GSS daemon service.
21197 This type has the following parameters:
21198 @table @asis
21199 @item @code{nfs-utils} (default: @code{nfs-utils})
21200 The package in which the @command{rpc.gssd} command is to be found.
21201
21202 @item @code{pipefs-directory} (default: @code{"/var/lib/nfs/rpc_pipefs"})
21203 The directory where the pipefs file system is mounted.
21204
21205 @end table
21206 @end deftp
21207
21208
21209 @subsubheading IDMAP Daemon Service
21210 @cindex idmapd
21211 @cindex name mapper
21212
21213 The idmap daemon service provides mapping between user IDs and user names.
21214 Typically it is required in order to access file systems mounted via NFSv4.
21215
21216 @defvr {Scheme Variable} idmap-service-type
21217 A service type for the Identity Mapper (IDMAP) daemon.
21218 @end defvr
21219
21220 @deftp {Data Type} idmap-configuration
21221 Data type representing the configuration of the IDMAP daemon service.
21222 This type has the following parameters:
21223 @table @asis
21224 @item @code{nfs-utils} (default: @code{nfs-utils})
21225 The package in which the @command{rpc.idmapd} command is to be found.
21226
21227 @item @code{pipefs-directory} (default: @code{"/var/lib/nfs/rpc_pipefs"})
21228 The directory where the pipefs file system is mounted.
21229
21230 @item @code{domain} (default: @code{#f})
21231 The local NFSv4 domain name.
21232 This must be a string or @code{#f}.
21233 If it is @code{#f} then the daemon will use the host's fully qualified domain name.
21234
21235 @end table
21236 @end deftp
21237
21238 @node Continuous Integration
21239 @subsection Continuous Integration
21240
21241 @cindex continuous integration
21242 @uref{https://git.savannah.gnu.org/cgit/guix/guix-cuirass.git, Cuirass} is a
21243 continuous integration tool for Guix. It can be used both for development and
21244 for providing substitutes to others (@pxref{Substitutes}).
21245
21246 The @code{(gnu services cuirass)} module provides the following service.
21247
21248 @defvr {Scheme Procedure} cuirass-service-type
21249 The type of the Cuirass service. Its value must be a
21250 @code{cuirass-configuration} object, as described below.
21251 @end defvr
21252
21253 To add build jobs, you have to set the @code{specifications} field of the
21254 configuration. Here is an example of a service that polls the Guix repository
21255 and builds the packages from a manifest. Some of the packages are defined in
21256 the @code{"custom-packages"} input, which is the equivalent of
21257 @code{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH}.
21258
21259 @example
21260 (define %cuirass-specs
21261 #~(list
21262 '((#:name . "my-manifest")
21263 (#:load-path-inputs . ("guix"))
21264 (#:package-path-inputs . ("custom-packages"))
21265 (#:proc-input . "guix")
21266 (#:proc-file . "build-aux/cuirass/gnu-system.scm")
21267 (#:proc . cuirass-jobs)
21268 (#:proc-args . ((subset . "manifests")
21269 (systems . ("x86_64-linux"))
21270 (manifests . (("config" . "guix/manifest.scm")))))
21271 (#:inputs . (((#:name . "guix")
21272 (#:url . "git://git.savannah.gnu.org/guix.git")
21273 (#:load-path . ".")
21274 (#:branch . "master")
21275 (#:no-compile? . #t))
21276 ((#:name . "config")
21277 (#:url . "git://git.example.org/config.git")
21278 (#:load-path . ".")
21279 (#:branch . "master")
21280 (#:no-compile? . #t))
21281 ((#:name . "custom-packages")
21282 (#:url . "git://git.example.org/custom-packages.git")
21283 (#:load-path . ".")
21284 (#:branch . "master")
21285 (#:no-compile? . #t)))))))
21286
21287 (service cuirass-service-type
21288 (cuirass-configuration
21289 (specifications %cuirass-specs)))
21290 @end example
21291
21292 While information related to build jobs is located directly in the
21293 specifications, global settings for the @command{cuirass} process are
21294 accessible in other @code{cuirass-configuration} fields.
21295
21296 @deftp {Data Type} cuirass-configuration
21297 Data type representing the configuration of Cuirass.
21298
21299 @table @asis
21300 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{"/var/log/cuirass.log"})
21301 Location of the log file.
21302
21303 @item @code{cache-directory} (default: @code{"/var/cache/cuirass"})
21304 Location of the repository cache.
21305
21306 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"cuirass"})
21307 Owner of the @code{cuirass} process.
21308
21309 @item @code{group} (default: @code{"cuirass"})
21310 Owner's group of the @code{cuirass} process.
21311
21312 @item @code{interval} (default: @code{60})
21313 Number of seconds between the poll of the repositories followed by the
21314 Cuirass jobs.
21315
21316 @item @code{database} (default: @code{"/var/lib/cuirass/cuirass.db"})
21317 Location of sqlite database which contains the build results and previously
21318 added specifications.
21319
21320 @item @code{ttl} (default: @code{(* 30 24 3600)})
21321 Specifies the time-to-live (TTL) in seconds of garbage collector roots that
21322 are registered for build results. This means that build results are protected
21323 from garbage collection for at least @var{ttl} seconds.
21324
21325 @item @code{port} (default: @code{8081})
21326 Port number used by the HTTP server.
21327
21328 @item --listen=@var{host}
21329 Listen on the network interface for @var{host}. The default is to
21330 accept connections from localhost.
21331
21332 @item @code{specifications} (default: @code{#~'()})
21333 A gexp (@pxref{G-Expressions}) that evaluates to a list of specifications,
21334 where a specification is an association list
21335 (@pxref{Associations Lists,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}) whose
21336 keys are keywords (@code{#:keyword-example}) as shown in the example
21337 above.
21338
21339 @item @code{use-substitutes?} (default: @code{#f})
21340 This allows using substitutes to avoid building every dependencies of a job
21341 from source.
21342
21343 @item @code{one-shot?} (default: @code{#f})
21344 Only evaluate specifications and build derivations once.
21345
21346 @item @code{fallback?} (default: @code{#f})
21347 When substituting a pre-built binary fails, fall back to building
21348 packages locally.
21349
21350 @item @code{cuirass} (default: @code{cuirass})
21351 The Cuirass package to use.
21352 @end table
21353 @end deftp
21354
21355 @node Power Management Services
21356 @subsection Power Management Services
21357
21358 @cindex tlp
21359 @cindex power management with TLP
21360 @subsubheading TLP daemon
21361
21362 The @code{(gnu services pm)} module provides a Guix service definition
21363 for the Linux power management tool TLP.
21364
21365 TLP enables various powersaving modes in userspace and kernel.
21366 Contrary to @code{upower-service}, it is not a passive,
21367 monitoring tool, as it will apply custom settings each time a new power
21368 source is detected. More information can be found at
21369 @uref{https://linrunner.de/en/tlp/tlp.html, TLP home page}.
21370
21371 @deffn {Scheme Variable} tlp-service-type
21372 The service type for the TLP tool. Its value should be a valid
21373 TLP configuration (see below). To use the default settings, simply
21374 write:
21375 @example
21376 (service tlp-service-type)
21377 @end example
21378 @end deffn
21379
21380 By default TLP does not need much configuration but most TLP parameters
21381 can be tweaked using @code{tlp-configuration}.
21382
21383 Each parameter definition is preceded by its type; for example,
21384 @samp{boolean foo} indicates that the @code{foo} parameter
21385 should be specified as a boolean. Types starting with
21386 @code{maybe-} denote parameters that won't show up in TLP config file
21387 when their value is @code{'disabled}.
21388
21389 @c The following documentation was initially generated by
21390 @c (generate-tlp-documentation) in (gnu services pm). Manually maintained
21391 @c documentation is better, so we shouldn't hesitate to edit below as
21392 @c needed. However if the change you want to make to this documentation
21393 @c can be done in an automated way, it's probably easier to change
21394 @c (generate-documentation) than to make it below and have to deal with
21395 @c the churn as TLP updates.
21396
21397 Available @code{tlp-configuration} fields are:
21398
21399 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} package tlp
21400 The TLP package.
21401
21402 @end deftypevr
21403
21404 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean tlp-enable?
21405 Set to true if you wish to enable TLP.
21406
21407 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
21408
21409 @end deftypevr
21410
21411 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string tlp-default-mode
21412 Default mode when no power supply can be detected. Alternatives are AC
21413 and BAT.
21414
21415 Defaults to @samp{"AC"}.
21416
21417 @end deftypevr
21418
21419 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer disk-idle-secs-on-ac
21420 Number of seconds Linux kernel has to wait after the disk goes idle,
21421 before syncing on AC.
21422
21423 Defaults to @samp{0}.
21424
21425 @end deftypevr
21426
21427 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer disk-idle-secs-on-bat
21428 Same as @code{disk-idle-ac} but on BAT mode.
21429
21430 Defaults to @samp{2}.
21431
21432 @end deftypevr
21433
21434 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-lost-work-secs-on-ac
21435 Dirty pages flushing periodicity, expressed in seconds.
21436
21437 Defaults to @samp{15}.
21438
21439 @end deftypevr
21440
21441 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-lost-work-secs-on-bat
21442 Same as @code{max-lost-work-secs-on-ac} but on BAT mode.
21443
21444 Defaults to @samp{60}.
21445
21446 @end deftypevr
21447
21448 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-space-separated-string-list cpu-scaling-governor-on-ac
21449 CPU frequency scaling governor on AC mode. With intel_pstate driver,
21450 alternatives are powersave and performance. With acpi-cpufreq driver,
21451 alternatives are ondemand, powersave, performance and conservative.
21452
21453 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
21454
21455 @end deftypevr
21456
21457 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-space-separated-string-list cpu-scaling-governor-on-bat
21458 Same as @code{cpu-scaling-governor-on-ac} but on BAT mode.
21459
21460 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
21461
21462 @end deftypevr
21463
21464 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-scaling-min-freq-on-ac
21465 Set the min available frequency for the scaling governor on AC.
21466
21467 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
21468
21469 @end deftypevr
21470
21471 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-scaling-max-freq-on-ac
21472 Set the max available frequency for the scaling governor on AC.
21473
21474 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
21475
21476 @end deftypevr
21477
21478 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-scaling-min-freq-on-bat
21479 Set the min available frequency for the scaling governor on BAT.
21480
21481 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
21482
21483 @end deftypevr
21484
21485 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-scaling-max-freq-on-bat
21486 Set the max available frequency for the scaling governor on BAT.
21487
21488 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
21489
21490 @end deftypevr
21491
21492 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-min-perf-on-ac
21493 Limit the min P-state to control the power dissipation of the CPU, in AC
21494 mode. Values are stated as a percentage of the available performance.
21495
21496 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
21497
21498 @end deftypevr
21499
21500 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-max-perf-on-ac
21501 Limit the max P-state to control the power dissipation of the CPU, in AC
21502 mode. Values are stated as a percentage of the available performance.
21503
21504 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
21505
21506 @end deftypevr
21507
21508 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-min-perf-on-bat
21509 Same as @code{cpu-min-perf-on-ac} on BAT mode.
21510
21511 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
21512
21513 @end deftypevr
21514
21515 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-max-perf-on-bat
21516 Same as @code{cpu-max-perf-on-ac} on BAT mode.
21517
21518 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
21519
21520 @end deftypevr
21521
21522 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean cpu-boost-on-ac?
21523 Enable CPU turbo boost feature on AC mode.
21524
21525 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
21526
21527 @end deftypevr
21528
21529 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean cpu-boost-on-bat?
21530 Same as @code{cpu-boost-on-ac?} on BAT mode.
21531
21532 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
21533
21534 @end deftypevr
21535
21536 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean sched-powersave-on-ac?
21537 Allow Linux kernel to minimize the number of CPU cores/hyper-threads
21538 used under light load conditions.
21539
21540 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21541
21542 @end deftypevr
21543
21544 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean sched-powersave-on-bat?
21545 Same as @code{sched-powersave-on-ac?} but on BAT mode.
21546
21547 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
21548
21549 @end deftypevr
21550
21551 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean nmi-watchdog?
21552 Enable Linux kernel NMI watchdog.
21553
21554 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21555
21556 @end deftypevr
21557
21558 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-string phc-controls
21559 For Linux kernels with PHC patch applied, change CPU voltages. An
21560 example value would be @samp{"F:V F:V F:V F:V"}.
21561
21562 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
21563
21564 @end deftypevr
21565
21566 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string energy-perf-policy-on-ac
21567 Set CPU performance versus energy saving policy on AC. Alternatives are
21568 performance, normal, powersave.
21569
21570 Defaults to @samp{"performance"}.
21571
21572 @end deftypevr
21573
21574 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string energy-perf-policy-on-bat
21575 Same as @code{energy-perf-policy-ac} but on BAT mode.
21576
21577 Defaults to @samp{"powersave"}.
21578
21579 @end deftypevr
21580
21581 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list disks-devices
21582 Hard disk devices.
21583
21584 @end deftypevr
21585
21586 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list disk-apm-level-on-ac
21587 Hard disk advanced power management level.
21588
21589 @end deftypevr
21590
21591 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list disk-apm-level-on-bat
21592 Same as @code{disk-apm-bat} but on BAT mode.
21593
21594 @end deftypevr
21595
21596 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-space-separated-string-list disk-spindown-timeout-on-ac
21597 Hard disk spin down timeout. One value has to be specified for each
21598 declared hard disk.
21599
21600 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
21601
21602 @end deftypevr
21603
21604 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-space-separated-string-list disk-spindown-timeout-on-bat
21605 Same as @code{disk-spindown-timeout-on-ac} but on BAT mode.
21606
21607 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
21608
21609 @end deftypevr
21610
21611 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-space-separated-string-list disk-iosched
21612 Select IO scheduler for disk devices. One value has to be specified for
21613 each declared hard disk. Example alternatives are cfq, deadline and
21614 noop.
21615
21616 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
21617
21618 @end deftypevr
21619
21620 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string sata-linkpwr-on-ac
21621 SATA aggressive link power management (ALPM) level. Alternatives are
21622 min_power, medium_power, max_performance.
21623
21624 Defaults to @samp{"max_performance"}.
21625
21626 @end deftypevr
21627
21628 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string sata-linkpwr-on-bat
21629 Same as @code{sata-linkpwr-ac} but on BAT mode.
21630
21631 Defaults to @samp{"min_power"}.
21632
21633 @end deftypevr
21634
21635 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-string sata-linkpwr-blacklist
21636 Exclude specified SATA host devices for link power management.
21637
21638 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
21639
21640 @end deftypevr
21641
21642 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-on-off-boolean ahci-runtime-pm-on-ac?
21643 Enable Runtime Power Management for AHCI controller and disks on AC
21644 mode.
21645
21646 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
21647
21648 @end deftypevr
21649
21650 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-on-off-boolean ahci-runtime-pm-on-bat?
21651 Same as @code{ahci-runtime-pm-on-ac} on BAT mode.
21652
21653 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
21654
21655 @end deftypevr
21656
21657 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer ahci-runtime-pm-timeout
21658 Seconds of inactivity before disk is suspended.
21659
21660 Defaults to @samp{15}.
21661
21662 @end deftypevr
21663
21664 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string pcie-aspm-on-ac
21665 PCI Express Active State Power Management level. Alternatives are
21666 default, performance, powersave.
21667
21668 Defaults to @samp{"performance"}.
21669
21670 @end deftypevr
21671
21672 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string pcie-aspm-on-bat
21673 Same as @code{pcie-aspm-ac} but on BAT mode.
21674
21675 Defaults to @samp{"powersave"}.
21676
21677 @end deftypevr
21678
21679 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string radeon-power-profile-on-ac
21680 Radeon graphics clock speed level. Alternatives are low, mid, high,
21681 auto, default.
21682
21683 Defaults to @samp{"high"}.
21684
21685 @end deftypevr
21686
21687 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string radeon-power-profile-on-bat
21688 Same as @code{radeon-power-ac} but on BAT mode.
21689
21690 Defaults to @samp{"low"}.
21691
21692 @end deftypevr
21693
21694 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string radeon-dpm-state-on-ac
21695 Radeon dynamic power management method (DPM). Alternatives are battery,
21696 performance.
21697
21698 Defaults to @samp{"performance"}.
21699
21700 @end deftypevr
21701
21702 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string radeon-dpm-state-on-bat
21703 Same as @code{radeon-dpm-state-ac} but on BAT mode.
21704
21705 Defaults to @samp{"battery"}.
21706
21707 @end deftypevr
21708
21709 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string radeon-dpm-perf-level-on-ac
21710 Radeon DPM performance level. Alternatives are auto, low, high.
21711
21712 Defaults to @samp{"auto"}.
21713
21714 @end deftypevr
21715
21716 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string radeon-dpm-perf-level-on-bat
21717 Same as @code{radeon-dpm-perf-ac} but on BAT mode.
21718
21719 Defaults to @samp{"auto"}.
21720
21721 @end deftypevr
21722
21723 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} on-off-boolean wifi-pwr-on-ac?
21724 Wifi power saving mode.
21725
21726 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21727
21728 @end deftypevr
21729
21730 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} on-off-boolean wifi-pwr-on-bat?
21731 Same as @code{wifi-power-ac?} but on BAT mode.
21732
21733 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
21734
21735 @end deftypevr
21736
21737 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} y-n-boolean wol-disable?
21738 Disable wake on LAN.
21739
21740 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
21741
21742 @end deftypevr
21743
21744 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer sound-power-save-on-ac
21745 Timeout duration in seconds before activating audio power saving on
21746 Intel HDA and AC97 devices. A value of 0 disables power saving.
21747
21748 Defaults to @samp{0}.
21749
21750 @end deftypevr
21751
21752 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer sound-power-save-on-bat
21753 Same as @code{sound-powersave-ac} but on BAT mode.
21754
21755 Defaults to @samp{1}.
21756
21757 @end deftypevr
21758
21759 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} y-n-boolean sound-power-save-controller?
21760 Disable controller in powersaving mode on Intel HDA devices.
21761
21762 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
21763
21764 @end deftypevr
21765
21766 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean bay-poweroff-on-bat?
21767 Enable optical drive in UltraBay/MediaBay on BAT mode. Drive can be
21768 powered on again by releasing (and reinserting) the eject lever or by
21769 pressing the disc eject button on newer models.
21770
21771 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21772
21773 @end deftypevr
21774
21775 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string bay-device
21776 Name of the optical drive device to power off.
21777
21778 Defaults to @samp{"sr0"}.
21779
21780 @end deftypevr
21781
21782 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string runtime-pm-on-ac
21783 Runtime Power Management for PCI(e) bus devices. Alternatives are on
21784 and auto.
21785
21786 Defaults to @samp{"on"}.
21787
21788 @end deftypevr
21789
21790 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string runtime-pm-on-bat
21791 Same as @code{runtime-pm-ac} but on BAT mode.
21792
21793 Defaults to @samp{"auto"}.
21794
21795 @end deftypevr
21796
21797 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean runtime-pm-all?
21798 Runtime Power Management for all PCI(e) bus devices, except blacklisted
21799 ones.
21800
21801 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
21802
21803 @end deftypevr
21804
21805 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-space-separated-string-list runtime-pm-blacklist
21806 Exclude specified PCI(e) device addresses from Runtime Power Management.
21807
21808 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
21809
21810 @end deftypevr
21811
21812 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list runtime-pm-driver-blacklist
21813 Exclude PCI(e) devices assigned to the specified drivers from Runtime
21814 Power Management.
21815
21816 @end deftypevr
21817
21818 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean usb-autosuspend?
21819 Enable USB autosuspend feature.
21820
21821 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
21822
21823 @end deftypevr
21824
21825 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-string usb-blacklist
21826 Exclude specified devices from USB autosuspend.
21827
21828 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
21829
21830 @end deftypevr
21831
21832 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean usb-blacklist-wwan?
21833 Exclude WWAN devices from USB autosuspend.
21834
21835 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
21836
21837 @end deftypevr
21838
21839 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-string usb-whitelist
21840 Include specified devices into USB autosuspend, even if they are already
21841 excluded by the driver or via @code{usb-blacklist-wwan?}.
21842
21843 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
21844
21845 @end deftypevr
21846
21847 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean usb-autosuspend-disable-on-shutdown?
21848 Enable USB autosuspend before shutdown.
21849
21850 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
21851
21852 @end deftypevr
21853
21854 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean restore-device-state-on-startup?
21855 Restore radio device state (bluetooth, wifi, wwan) from previous
21856 shutdown on system startup.
21857
21858 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21859
21860 @end deftypevr
21861
21862 @cindex thermald
21863 @cindex CPU frequency scaling with thermald
21864 @subsubheading Thermald daemon
21865
21866 The @code{(gnu services pm)} module provides an interface to
21867 thermald, a CPU frequency scaling service which helps prevent overheating.
21868
21869 @defvr {Scheme Variable} thermald-service-type
21870 This is the service type for
21871 @uref{https://01.org/linux-thermal-daemon/, thermald}, the Linux
21872 Thermal Daemon, which is responsible for controlling the thermal state
21873 of processors and preventing overheating.
21874 @end defvr
21875
21876 @deftp {Data Type} thermald-configuration
21877 Data type representing the configuration of @code{thermald-service-type}.
21878
21879 @table @asis
21880 @item @code{ignore-cpuid-check?} (default: @code{#f})
21881 Ignore cpuid check for supported CPU models.
21882
21883 @item @code{thermald} (default: @var{thermald})
21884 Package object of thermald.
21885
21886 @end table
21887 @end deftp
21888
21889 @node Audio Services
21890 @subsection Audio Services
21891
21892 The @code{(gnu services audio)} module provides a service to start MPD
21893 (the Music Player Daemon).
21894
21895 @cindex mpd
21896 @subsubheading Music Player Daemon
21897
21898 The Music Player Daemon (MPD) is a service that can play music while
21899 being controlled from the local machine or over the network by a variety
21900 of clients.
21901
21902 The following example shows how one might run @code{mpd} as user
21903 @code{"bob"} on port @code{6666}. It uses pulseaudio for output.
21904
21905 @example
21906 (service mpd-service-type
21907 (mpd-configuration
21908 (user "bob")
21909 (port "6666")))
21910 @end example
21911
21912 @defvr {Scheme Variable} mpd-service-type
21913 The service type for @command{mpd}
21914 @end defvr
21915
21916 @deftp {Data Type} mpd-configuration
21917 Data type representing the configuration of @command{mpd}.
21918
21919 @table @asis
21920 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"mpd"})
21921 The user to run mpd as.
21922
21923 @item @code{music-dir} (default: @code{"~/Music"})
21924 The directory to scan for music files.
21925
21926 @item @code{playlist-dir} (default: @code{"~/.mpd/playlists"})
21927 The directory to store playlists.
21928
21929 @item @code{db-file} (default: @code{"~/.mpd/tag_cache"})
21930 The location of the music database.
21931
21932 @item @code{state-file} (default: @code{"~/.mpd/state"})
21933 The location of the file that stores current MPD's state.
21934
21935 @item @code{sticker-file} (default: @code{"~/.mpd/sticker.sql"})
21936 The location of the sticker database.
21937
21938 @item @code{port} (default: @code{"6600"})
21939 The port to run mpd on.
21940
21941 @item @code{address} (default: @code{"any"})
21942 The address that mpd will bind to. To use a Unix domain socket,
21943 an absolute path can be specified here.
21944
21945 @end table
21946 @end deftp
21947
21948 @node Virtualization Services
21949 @subsection Virtualization services
21950
21951 The @code{(gnu services virtualization)} module provides services for
21952 the libvirt and virtlog daemons, as well as other virtualization-related
21953 services.
21954
21955 @subsubheading Libvirt daemon
21956 @code{libvirtd} is the server side daemon component of the libvirt
21957 virtualization management system. This daemon runs on host servers
21958 and performs required management tasks for virtualized guests.
21959
21960 @deffn {Scheme Variable} libvirt-service-type
21961 This is the type of the @uref{https://libvirt.org, libvirt daemon}.
21962 Its value must be a @code{libvirt-configuration}.
21963
21964 @example
21965 (service libvirt-service-type
21966 (libvirt-configuration
21967 (unix-sock-group "libvirt")
21968 (tls-port "16555")))
21969 @end example
21970 @end deffn
21971
21972 @c Auto-generated with (generate-libvirt-documentation)
21973 Available @code{libvirt-configuration} fields are:
21974
21975 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} package libvirt
21976 Libvirt package.
21977
21978 @end deftypevr
21979
21980 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} boolean listen-tls?
21981 Flag listening for secure TLS connections on the public TCP/IP port.
21982 must set @code{listen} for this to have any effect.
21983
21984 It is necessary to setup a CA and issue server certificates before using
21985 this capability.
21986
21987 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
21988
21989 @end deftypevr
21990
21991 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} boolean listen-tcp?
21992 Listen for unencrypted TCP connections on the public TCP/IP port. must
21993 set @code{listen} for this to have any effect.
21994
21995 Using the TCP socket requires SASL authentication by default. Only SASL
21996 mechanisms which support data encryption are allowed. This is
21997 DIGEST_MD5 and GSSAPI (Kerberos5)
21998
21999 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22000
22001 @end deftypevr
22002
22003 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string tls-port
22004 Port for accepting secure TLS connections This can be a port number, or
22005 service name
22006
22007 Defaults to @samp{"16514"}.
22008
22009 @end deftypevr
22010
22011 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string tcp-port
22012 Port for accepting insecure TCP connections This can be a port number,
22013 or service name
22014
22015 Defaults to @samp{"16509"}.
22016
22017 @end deftypevr
22018
22019 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string listen-addr
22020 IP address or hostname used for client connections.
22021
22022 Defaults to @samp{"0.0.0.0"}.
22023
22024 @end deftypevr
22025
22026 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} boolean mdns-adv?
22027 Flag toggling mDNS advertisement of the libvirt service.
22028
22029 Alternatively can disable for all services on a host by stopping the
22030 Avahi daemon.
22031
22032 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22033
22034 @end deftypevr
22035
22036 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string mdns-name
22037 Default mDNS advertisement name. This must be unique on the immediate
22038 broadcast network.
22039
22040 Defaults to @samp{"Virtualization Host <hostname>"}.
22041
22042 @end deftypevr
22043
22044 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string unix-sock-group
22045 UNIX domain socket group ownership. This can be used to allow a
22046 'trusted' set of users access to management capabilities without
22047 becoming root.
22048
22049 Defaults to @samp{"root"}.
22050
22051 @end deftypevr
22052
22053 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string unix-sock-ro-perms
22054 UNIX socket permissions for the R/O socket. This is used for monitoring
22055 VM status only.
22056
22057 Defaults to @samp{"0777"}.
22058
22059 @end deftypevr
22060
22061 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string unix-sock-rw-perms
22062 UNIX socket permissions for the R/W socket. Default allows only root.
22063 If PolicyKit is enabled on the socket, the default will change to allow
22064 everyone (eg, 0777)
22065
22066 Defaults to @samp{"0770"}.
22067
22068 @end deftypevr
22069
22070 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string unix-sock-admin-perms
22071 UNIX socket permissions for the admin socket. Default allows only owner
22072 (root), do not change it unless you are sure to whom you are exposing
22073 the access to.
22074
22075 Defaults to @samp{"0777"}.
22076
22077 @end deftypevr
22078
22079 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string unix-sock-dir
22080 The directory in which sockets will be found/created.
22081
22082 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/libvirt"}.
22083
22084 @end deftypevr
22085
22086 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string auth-unix-ro
22087 Authentication scheme for UNIX read-only sockets. By default socket
22088 permissions allow anyone to connect
22089
22090 Defaults to @samp{"polkit"}.
22091
22092 @end deftypevr
22093
22094 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string auth-unix-rw
22095 Authentication scheme for UNIX read-write sockets. By default socket
22096 permissions only allow root. If PolicyKit support was compiled into
22097 libvirt, the default will be to use 'polkit' auth.
22098
22099 Defaults to @samp{"polkit"}.
22100
22101 @end deftypevr
22102
22103 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string auth-tcp
22104 Authentication scheme for TCP sockets. If you don't enable SASL, then
22105 all TCP traffic is cleartext. Don't do this outside of a dev/test
22106 scenario.
22107
22108 Defaults to @samp{"sasl"}.
22109
22110 @end deftypevr
22111
22112 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string auth-tls
22113 Authentication scheme for TLS sockets. TLS sockets already have
22114 encryption provided by the TLS layer, and limited authentication is done
22115 by certificates.
22116
22117 It is possible to make use of any SASL authentication mechanism as well,
22118 by using 'sasl' for this option
22119
22120 Defaults to @samp{"none"}.
22121
22122 @end deftypevr
22123
22124 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} optional-list access-drivers
22125 API access control scheme.
22126
22127 By default an authenticated user is allowed access to all APIs. Access
22128 drivers can place restrictions on this.
22129
22130 Defaults to @samp{()}.
22131
22132 @end deftypevr
22133
22134 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string key-file
22135 Server key file path. If set to an empty string, then no private key is
22136 loaded.
22137
22138 Defaults to @samp{""}.
22139
22140 @end deftypevr
22141
22142 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string cert-file
22143 Server key file path. If set to an empty string, then no certificate is
22144 loaded.
22145
22146 Defaults to @samp{""}.
22147
22148 @end deftypevr
22149
22150 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string ca-file
22151 Server key file path. If set to an empty string, then no CA certificate
22152 is loaded.
22153
22154 Defaults to @samp{""}.
22155
22156 @end deftypevr
22157
22158 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string crl-file
22159 Certificate revocation list path. If set to an empty string, then no
22160 CRL is loaded.
22161
22162 Defaults to @samp{""}.
22163
22164 @end deftypevr
22165
22166 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} boolean tls-no-sanity-cert
22167 Disable verification of our own server certificates.
22168
22169 When libvirtd starts it performs some sanity checks against its own
22170 certificates.
22171
22172 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22173
22174 @end deftypevr
22175
22176 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} boolean tls-no-verify-cert
22177 Disable verification of client certificates.
22178
22179 Client certificate verification is the primary authentication mechanism.
22180 Any client which does not present a certificate signed by the CA will be
22181 rejected.
22182
22183 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22184
22185 @end deftypevr
22186
22187 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} optional-list tls-allowed-dn-list
22188 Whitelist of allowed x509 Distinguished Name.
22189
22190 Defaults to @samp{()}.
22191
22192 @end deftypevr
22193
22194 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} optional-list sasl-allowed-usernames
22195 Whitelist of allowed SASL usernames. The format for username depends on
22196 the SASL authentication mechanism.
22197
22198 Defaults to @samp{()}.
22199
22200 @end deftypevr
22201
22202 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string tls-priority
22203 Override the compile time default TLS priority string. The default is
22204 usually "NORMAL" unless overridden at build time. Only set this is it
22205 is desired for libvirt to deviate from the global default settings.
22206
22207 Defaults to @samp{"NORMAL"}.
22208
22209 @end deftypevr
22210
22211 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer max-clients
22212 Maximum number of concurrent client connections to allow over all
22213 sockets combined.
22214
22215 Defaults to @samp{5000}.
22216
22217 @end deftypevr
22218
22219 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer max-queued-clients
22220 Maximum length of queue of connections waiting to be accepted by the
22221 daemon. Note, that some protocols supporting retransmission may obey
22222 this so that a later reattempt at connection succeeds.
22223
22224 Defaults to @samp{1000}.
22225
22226 @end deftypevr
22227
22228 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer max-anonymous-clients
22229 Maximum length of queue of accepted but not yet authenticated clients.
22230 Set this to zero to turn this feature off
22231
22232 Defaults to @samp{20}.
22233
22234 @end deftypevr
22235
22236 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer min-workers
22237 Number of workers to start up initially.
22238
22239 Defaults to @samp{5}.
22240
22241 @end deftypevr
22242
22243 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer max-workers
22244 Maximum number of worker threads.
22245
22246 If the number of active clients exceeds @code{min-workers}, then more
22247 threads are spawned, up to max_workers limit. Typically you'd want
22248 max_workers to equal maximum number of clients allowed.
22249
22250 Defaults to @samp{20}.
22251
22252 @end deftypevr
22253
22254 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer prio-workers
22255 Number of priority workers. If all workers from above pool are stuck,
22256 some calls marked as high priority (notably domainDestroy) can be
22257 executed in this pool.
22258
22259 Defaults to @samp{5}.
22260
22261 @end deftypevr
22262
22263 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer max-requests
22264 Total global limit on concurrent RPC calls.
22265
22266 Defaults to @samp{20}.
22267
22268 @end deftypevr
22269
22270 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer max-client-requests
22271 Limit on concurrent requests from a single client connection. To avoid
22272 one client monopolizing the server this should be a small fraction of
22273 the global max_requests and max_workers parameter.
22274
22275 Defaults to @samp{5}.
22276
22277 @end deftypevr
22278
22279 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer admin-min-workers
22280 Same as @code{min-workers} but for the admin interface.
22281
22282 Defaults to @samp{1}.
22283
22284 @end deftypevr
22285
22286 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer admin-max-workers
22287 Same as @code{max-workers} but for the admin interface.
22288
22289 Defaults to @samp{5}.
22290
22291 @end deftypevr
22292
22293 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer admin-max-clients
22294 Same as @code{max-clients} but for the admin interface.
22295
22296 Defaults to @samp{5}.
22297
22298 @end deftypevr
22299
22300 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer admin-max-queued-clients
22301 Same as @code{max-queued-clients} but for the admin interface.
22302
22303 Defaults to @samp{5}.
22304
22305 @end deftypevr
22306
22307 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer admin-max-client-requests
22308 Same as @code{max-client-requests} but for the admin interface.
22309
22310 Defaults to @samp{5}.
22311
22312 @end deftypevr
22313
22314 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer log-level
22315 Logging level. 4 errors, 3 warnings, 2 information, 1 debug.
22316
22317 Defaults to @samp{3}.
22318
22319 @end deftypevr
22320
22321 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string log-filters
22322 Logging filters.
22323
22324 A filter allows to select a different logging level for a given category
22325 of logs The format for a filter is one of:
22326
22327 @itemize @bullet
22328 @item
22329 x:name
22330
22331 @item
22332 x:+name
22333
22334 @end itemize
22335
22336 where @code{name} is a string which is matched against the category
22337 given in the @code{VIR_LOG_INIT()} at the top of each libvirt source
22338 file, e.g., "remote", "qemu", or "util.json" (the name in the filter can
22339 be a substring of the full category name, in order to match multiple
22340 similar categories), the optional "+" prefix tells libvirt to log stack
22341 trace for each message matching name, and @code{x} is the minimal level
22342 where matching messages should be logged:
22343
22344 @itemize @bullet
22345 @item
22346 1: DEBUG
22347
22348 @item
22349 2: INFO
22350
22351 @item
22352 3: WARNING
22353
22354 @item
22355 4: ERROR
22356
22357 @end itemize
22358
22359 Multiple filters can be defined in a single filters statement, they just
22360 need to be separated by spaces.
22361
22362 Defaults to @samp{"3:remote 4:event"}.
22363
22364 @end deftypevr
22365
22366 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string log-outputs
22367 Logging outputs.
22368
22369 An output is one of the places to save logging information. The format
22370 for an output can be:
22371
22372 @table @code
22373 @item x:stderr
22374 output goes to stderr
22375
22376 @item x:syslog:name
22377 use syslog for the output and use the given name as the ident
22378
22379 @item x:file:file_path
22380 output to a file, with the given filepath
22381
22382 @item x:journald
22383 output to journald logging system
22384
22385 @end table
22386
22387 In all case the x prefix is the minimal level, acting as a filter
22388
22389 @itemize @bullet
22390 @item
22391 1: DEBUG
22392
22393 @item
22394 2: INFO
22395
22396 @item
22397 3: WARNING
22398
22399 @item
22400 4: ERROR
22401
22402 @end itemize
22403
22404 Multiple outputs can be defined, they just need to be separated by
22405 spaces.
22406
22407 Defaults to @samp{"3:stderr"}.
22408
22409 @end deftypevr
22410
22411 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer audit-level
22412 Allows usage of the auditing subsystem to be altered
22413
22414 @itemize @bullet
22415 @item
22416 0: disable all auditing
22417
22418 @item
22419 1: enable auditing, only if enabled on host
22420
22421 @item
22422 2: enable auditing, and exit if disabled on host.
22423
22424 @end itemize
22425
22426 Defaults to @samp{1}.
22427
22428 @end deftypevr
22429
22430 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} boolean audit-logging
22431 Send audit messages via libvirt logging infrastructure.
22432
22433 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22434
22435 @end deftypevr
22436
22437 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} optional-string host-uuid
22438 Host UUID. UUID must not have all digits be the same.
22439
22440 Defaults to @samp{""}.
22441
22442 @end deftypevr
22443
22444 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string host-uuid-source
22445 Source to read host UUID.
22446
22447 @itemize @bullet
22448 @item
22449 @code{smbios}: fetch the UUID from @code{dmidecode -s system-uuid}
22450
22451 @item
22452 @code{machine-id}: fetch the UUID from @code{/etc/machine-id}
22453
22454 @end itemize
22455
22456 If @code{dmidecode} does not provide a valid UUID a temporary UUID will
22457 be generated.
22458
22459 Defaults to @samp{"smbios"}.
22460
22461 @end deftypevr
22462
22463 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer keepalive-interval
22464 A keepalive message is sent to a client after @code{keepalive_interval}
22465 seconds of inactivity to check if the client is still responding. If
22466 set to -1, libvirtd will never send keepalive requests; however clients
22467 can still send them and the daemon will send responses.
22468
22469 Defaults to @samp{5}.
22470
22471 @end deftypevr
22472
22473 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer keepalive-count
22474 Maximum number of keepalive messages that are allowed to be sent to the
22475 client without getting any response before the connection is considered
22476 broken.
22477
22478 In other words, the connection is automatically closed approximately
22479 after @code{keepalive_interval * (keepalive_count + 1)} seconds since
22480 the last message received from the client. When @code{keepalive-count}
22481 is set to 0, connections will be automatically closed after
22482 @code{keepalive-interval} seconds of inactivity without sending any
22483 keepalive messages.
22484
22485 Defaults to @samp{5}.
22486
22487 @end deftypevr
22488
22489 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer admin-keepalive-interval
22490 Same as above but for admin interface.
22491
22492 Defaults to @samp{5}.
22493
22494 @end deftypevr
22495
22496 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer admin-keepalive-count
22497 Same as above but for admin interface.
22498
22499 Defaults to @samp{5}.
22500
22501 @end deftypevr
22502
22503 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer ovs-timeout
22504 Timeout for Open vSwitch calls.
22505
22506 The @code{ovs-vsctl} utility is used for the configuration and its
22507 timeout option is set by default to 5 seconds to avoid potential
22508 infinite waits blocking libvirt.
22509
22510 Defaults to @samp{5}.
22511
22512 @end deftypevr
22513
22514 @c %end of autogenerated docs
22515
22516 @subsubheading Virtlog daemon
22517 The virtlogd service is a server side daemon component of libvirt that is
22518 used to manage logs from virtual machine consoles.
22519
22520 This daemon is not used directly by libvirt client applications, rather it
22521 is called on their behalf by @code{libvirtd}. By maintaining the logs in a
22522 standalone daemon, the main @code{libvirtd} daemon can be restarted without
22523 risk of losing logs. The @code{virtlogd} daemon has the ability to re-exec()
22524 itself upon receiving @code{SIGUSR1}, to allow live upgrades without downtime.
22525
22526 @deffn {Scheme Variable} virtlog-service-type
22527 This is the type of the virtlog daemon.
22528 Its value must be a @code{virtlog-configuration}.
22529
22530 @example
22531 (service virtlog-service-type
22532 (virtlog-configuration
22533 (max-clients 1000)))
22534 @end example
22535 @end deffn
22536
22537 @deftypevr {@code{virtlog-configuration} parameter} integer log-level
22538 Logging level. 4 errors, 3 warnings, 2 information, 1 debug.
22539
22540 Defaults to @samp{3}.
22541
22542 @end deftypevr
22543
22544 @deftypevr {@code{virtlog-configuration} parameter} string log-filters
22545 Logging filters.
22546
22547 A filter allows to select a different logging level for a given category
22548 of logs The format for a filter is one of:
22549
22550 @itemize @bullet
22551 @item
22552 x:name
22553
22554 @item
22555 x:+name
22556
22557 @end itemize
22558
22559 where @code{name} is a string which is matched against the category
22560 given in the @code{VIR_LOG_INIT()} at the top of each libvirt source
22561 file, e.g., "remote", "qemu", or "util.json" (the name in the filter can
22562 be a substring of the full category name, in order to match multiple
22563 similar categories), the optional "+" prefix tells libvirt to log stack
22564 trace for each message matching name, and @code{x} is the minimal level
22565 where matching messages should be logged:
22566
22567 @itemize @bullet
22568 @item
22569 1: DEBUG
22570
22571 @item
22572 2: INFO
22573
22574 @item
22575 3: WARNING
22576
22577 @item
22578 4: ERROR
22579
22580 @end itemize
22581
22582 Multiple filters can be defined in a single filters statement, they just
22583 need to be separated by spaces.
22584
22585 Defaults to @samp{"3:remote 4:event"}.
22586
22587 @end deftypevr
22588
22589 @deftypevr {@code{virtlog-configuration} parameter} string log-outputs
22590 Logging outputs.
22591
22592 An output is one of the places to save logging information The format
22593 for an output can be:
22594
22595 @table @code
22596 @item x:stderr
22597 output goes to stderr
22598
22599 @item x:syslog:name
22600 use syslog for the output and use the given name as the ident
22601
22602 @item x:file:file_path
22603 output to a file, with the given filepath
22604
22605 @item x:journald
22606 output to journald logging system
22607
22608 @end table
22609
22610 In all case the x prefix is the minimal level, acting as a filter
22611
22612 @itemize @bullet
22613 @item
22614 1: DEBUG
22615
22616 @item
22617 2: INFO
22618
22619 @item
22620 3: WARNING
22621
22622 @item
22623 4: ERROR
22624
22625 @end itemize
22626
22627 Multiple outputs can be defined, they just need to be separated by
22628 spaces.
22629
22630 Defaults to @samp{"3:stderr"}.
22631
22632 @end deftypevr
22633
22634 @deftypevr {@code{virtlog-configuration} parameter} integer max-clients
22635 Maximum number of concurrent client connections to allow over all
22636 sockets combined.
22637
22638 Defaults to @samp{1024}.
22639
22640 @end deftypevr
22641
22642 @deftypevr {@code{virtlog-configuration} parameter} integer max-size
22643 Maximum file size before rolling over.
22644
22645 Defaults to @samp{2MB}
22646
22647 @end deftypevr
22648
22649 @deftypevr {@code{virtlog-configuration} parameter} integer max-backups
22650 Maximum number of backup files to keep.
22651
22652 Defaults to @samp{3}
22653
22654 @end deftypevr
22655
22656 @subsubheading Transparent Emulation with QEMU
22657
22658 @cindex emulation
22659 @cindex @code{binfmt_misc}
22660 @code{qemu-binfmt-service-type} provides support for transparent
22661 emulation of program binaries built for different architectures---e.g.,
22662 it allows you to transparently execute an ARMv7 program on an x86_64
22663 machine. It achieves this by combining the @uref{https://www.qemu.org,
22664 QEMU} emulator and the @code{binfmt_misc} feature of the kernel Linux.
22665
22666 @defvr {Scheme Variable} qemu-binfmt-service-type
22667 This is the type of the QEMU/binfmt service for transparent emulation.
22668 Its value must be a @code{qemu-binfmt-configuration} object, which
22669 specifies the QEMU package to use as well as the architecture we want to
22670 emulated:
22671
22672 @example
22673 (service qemu-binfmt-service-type
22674 (qemu-binfmt-configuration
22675 (platforms (lookup-qemu-platforms "arm" "aarch64" "mips64el"))))
22676 @end example
22677
22678 In this example, we enable transparent emulation for the ARM and aarch64
22679 platforms. Running @code{herd stop qemu-binfmt} turns it off, and
22680 running @code{herd start qemu-binfmt} turns it back on (@pxref{Invoking
22681 herd, the @command{herd} command,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}).
22682 @end defvr
22683
22684 @deftp {Data Type} qemu-binfmt-configuration
22685 This is the configuration for the @code{qemu-binfmt} service.
22686
22687 @table @asis
22688 @item @code{platforms} (default: @code{'()})
22689 The list of emulated QEMU platforms. Each item must be a @dfn{platform
22690 object} as returned by @code{lookup-qemu-platforms} (see below).
22691
22692 @item @code{guix-support?} (default: @code{#f})
22693 When it is true, QEMU and all its dependencies are added to the build
22694 environment of @command{guix-daemon} (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon,
22695 @code{--chroot-directory} option}). This allows the @code{binfmt_misc}
22696 handlers to be used within the build environment, which in turn means
22697 that you can transparently build programs for another architecture.
22698
22699 For example, let's suppose you're on an x86_64 machine and you have this
22700 service:
22701
22702 @example
22703 (service qemu-binfmt-service-type
22704 (qemu-binfmt-configuration
22705 (platforms (lookup-qemu-platforms "arm"))
22706 (guix-support? #t)))
22707 @end example
22708
22709 You can run:
22710
22711 @example
22712 guix build -s armhf-linux inkscape
22713 @end example
22714
22715 @noindent
22716 and it will build Inkscape for ARMv7 @emph{as if it were a native
22717 build}, transparently using QEMU to emulate the ARMv7 CPU. Pretty handy
22718 if you'd like to test a package build for an architecture you don't have
22719 access to!
22720
22721 @item @code{qemu} (default: @code{qemu})
22722 The QEMU package to use.
22723 @end table
22724 @end deftp
22725
22726 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} lookup-qemu-platforms @var{platforms}@dots{}
22727 Return the list of QEMU platform objects corresponding to
22728 @var{platforms}@dots{}. @var{platforms} must be a list of strings
22729 corresponding to platform names, such as @code{"arm"}, @code{"sparc"},
22730 @code{"mips64el"}, and so on.
22731 @end deffn
22732
22733 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} qemu-platform? @var{obj}
22734 Return true if @var{obj} is a platform object.
22735 @end deffn
22736
22737 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} qemu-platform-name @var{platform}
22738 Return the name of @var{platform}---a string such as @code{"arm"}.
22739 @end deffn
22740
22741 @node Version Control Services
22742 @subsection Version Control Services
22743
22744 The @code{(gnu services version-control)} module provides a service to
22745 allow remote access to local Git repositories. There are three options:
22746 the @code{git-daemon-service}, which provides access to repositories via
22747 the @code{git://} unsecured TCP-based protocol, extending the
22748 @code{nginx} web server to proxy some requests to
22749 @code{git-http-backend}, or providing a web interface with
22750 @code{cgit-service-type}.
22751
22752 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} git-daemon-service [#:config (git-daemon-configuration)]
22753
22754 Return a service that runs @command{git daemon}, a simple TCP server to
22755 expose repositories over the Git protocol for anonymous access.
22756
22757 The optional @var{config} argument should be a
22758 @code{<git-daemon-configuration>} object, by default it allows read-only
22759 access to exported@footnote{By creating the magic file
22760 "git-daemon-export-ok" in the repository directory.} repositories under
22761 @file{/srv/git}.
22762
22763 @end deffn
22764
22765 @deftp {Data Type} git-daemon-configuration
22766 Data type representing the configuration for @code{git-daemon-service}.
22767
22768 @table @asis
22769 @item @code{package} (default: @var{git})
22770 Package object of the Git distributed version control system.
22771
22772 @item @code{export-all?} (default: @var{#f})
22773 Whether to allow access for all Git repositories, even if they do not
22774 have the @file{git-daemon-export-ok} file.
22775
22776 @item @code{base-path} (default: @file{/srv/git})
22777 Whether to remap all the path requests as relative to the given path.
22778 If you run git daemon with @var{(base-path "/srv/git")} on example.com,
22779 then if you later try to pull @code{git://example.com/hello.git}, git
22780 daemon will interpret the path as @code{/srv/git/hello.git}.
22781
22782 @item @code{user-path} (default: @var{#f})
22783 Whether to allow @code{~user} notation to be used in requests. When
22784 specified with empty string, requests to @code{git://host/~alice/foo} is
22785 taken as a request to access @code{foo} repository in the home directory
22786 of user @code{alice}. If @var{(user-path "path")} is specified, the
22787 same request is taken as a request to access @code{path/foo} repository
22788 in the home directory of user @code{alice}.
22789
22790 @item @code{listen} (default: @var{'()})
22791 Whether to listen on specific IP addresses or hostnames, defaults to
22792 all.
22793
22794 @item @code{port} (default: @var{#f})
22795 Whether to listen on an alternative port, which defaults to 9418.
22796
22797 @item @code{whitelist} (default: @var{'()})
22798 If not empty, only allow access to this list of directories.
22799
22800 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @var{'()})
22801 Extra options will be passed to @code{git daemon}, please run
22802 @command{man git-daemon} for more information.
22803
22804 @end table
22805 @end deftp
22806
22807 The @code{git://} protocol lacks authentication. When you pull from a
22808 repository fetched via @code{git://}, you don't know whether the data you
22809 receive was modified or is even coming from the specified host, and your
22810 connection is subject to eavesdropping. It's better to use an authenticated
22811 and encrypted transport, such as @code{https}. Although Git allows you
22812 to serve repositories using unsophisticated file-based web servers,
22813 there is a faster protocol implemented by the @code{git-http-backend}
22814 program. This program is the back-end of a proper Git web service. It
22815 is designed to sit behind a FastCGI proxy. @xref{Web Services}, for more
22816 on running the necessary @code{fcgiwrap} daemon.
22817
22818 Guix has a separate configuration data type for serving Git repositories
22819 over HTTP.
22820
22821 @deftp {Data Type} git-http-configuration
22822 Data type representing the configuration for @code{git-http-service}.
22823
22824 @table @asis
22825 @item @code{package} (default: @var{git})
22826 Package object of the Git distributed version control system.
22827
22828 @item @code{git-root} (default: @file{/srv/git})
22829 Directory containing the Git repositories to expose to the world.
22830
22831 @item @code{export-all?} (default: @var{#f})
22832 Whether to expose access for all Git repositories in @var{git-root},
22833 even if they do not have the @file{git-daemon-export-ok} file.
22834
22835 @item @code{uri-path} (default: @file{/git/})
22836 Path prefix for Git access. With the default @code{/git/} prefix, this
22837 will map @code{http://@var{server}/git/@var{repo}.git} to
22838 @code{/srv/git/@var{repo}.git}. Requests whose URI paths do not begin
22839 with this prefix are not passed on to this Git instance.
22840
22841 @item @code{fcgiwrap-socket} (default: @code{127.0.0.1:9000})
22842 The socket on which the @code{fcgiwrap} daemon is listening. @xref{Web
22843 Services}.
22844 @end table
22845 @end deftp
22846
22847 There is no @code{git-http-service-type}, currently; instead you can
22848 create an @code{nginx-location-configuration} from a
22849 @code{git-http-configuration} and then add that location to a web
22850 server.
22851
22852 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} git-http-nginx-location-configuration @
22853 [config=(git-http-configuration)]
22854 Compute an @code{nginx-location-configuration} that corresponds to the
22855 given Git http configuration. An example nginx service definition to
22856 serve the default @file{/srv/git} over HTTPS might be:
22857
22858 @example
22859 (service nginx-service-type
22860 (nginx-configuration
22861 (server-blocks
22862 (list
22863 (nginx-server-configuration
22864 (listen '("443 ssl"))
22865 (server-name "git.my-host.org")
22866 (ssl-certificate
22867 "/etc/letsencrypt/live/git.my-host.org/fullchain.pem")
22868 (ssl-certificate-key
22869 "/etc/letsencrypt/live/git.my-host.org/privkey.pem")
22870 (locations
22871 (list
22872 (git-http-nginx-location-configuration
22873 (git-http-configuration (uri-path "/"))))))))))
22874 @end example
22875
22876 This example assumes that you are using Let's Encrypt to get your TLS
22877 certificate. @xref{Certificate Services}. The default @code{certbot}
22878 service will redirect all HTTP traffic on @code{git.my-host.org} to
22879 HTTPS. You will also need to add an @code{fcgiwrap} proxy to your
22880 system services. @xref{Web Services}.
22881 @end deffn
22882
22883 @subsubheading Cgit Service
22884
22885 @cindex Cgit service
22886 @cindex Git, web interface
22887 @uref{https://git.zx2c4.com/cgit/, Cgit} is a web frontend for Git
22888 repositories written in C.
22889
22890 The following example will configure the service with default values.
22891 By default, Cgit can be accessed on port 80 (@code{http://localhost:80}).
22892
22893 @example
22894 (service cgit-service-type)
22895 @end example
22896
22897 The @code{file-object} type designates either a file-like object
22898 (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}) or a string.
22899
22900 @c %start of fragment
22901
22902 Available @code{cgit-configuration} fields are:
22903
22904 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} package package
22905 The CGIT package.
22906
22907 @end deftypevr
22908
22909 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} nginx-server-configuration-list nginx
22910 NGINX configuration.
22911
22912 @end deftypevr
22913
22914 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object about-filter
22915 Specifies a command which will be invoked to format the content of about
22916 pages (both top-level and for each repository).
22917
22918 Defaults to @samp{""}.
22919
22920 @end deftypevr
22921
22922 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string agefile
22923 Specifies a path, relative to each repository path, which can be used to
22924 specify the date and time of the youngest commit in the repository.
22925
22926 Defaults to @samp{""}.
22927
22928 @end deftypevr
22929
22930 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object auth-filter
22931 Specifies a command that will be invoked for authenticating repository
22932 access.
22933
22934 Defaults to @samp{""}.
22935
22936 @end deftypevr
22937
22938 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string branch-sort
22939 Flag which, when set to @samp{age}, enables date ordering in the branch
22940 ref list, and when set @samp{name} enables ordering by branch name.
22941
22942 Defaults to @samp{"name"}.
22943
22944 @end deftypevr
22945
22946 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string cache-root
22947 Path used to store the cgit cache entries.
22948
22949 Defaults to @samp{"/var/cache/cgit"}.
22950
22951 @end deftypevr
22952
22953 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-static-ttl
22954 Number which specifies the time-to-live, in minutes, for the cached
22955 version of repository pages accessed with a fixed SHA1.
22956
22957 Defaults to @samp{-1}.
22958
22959 @end deftypevr
22960
22961 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-dynamic-ttl
22962 Number which specifies the time-to-live, in minutes, for the cached
22963 version of repository pages accessed without a fixed SHA1.
22964
22965 Defaults to @samp{5}.
22966
22967 @end deftypevr
22968
22969 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-repo-ttl
22970 Number which specifies the time-to-live, in minutes, for the cached
22971 version of the repository summary page.
22972
22973 Defaults to @samp{5}.
22974
22975 @end deftypevr
22976
22977 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-root-ttl
22978 Number which specifies the time-to-live, in minutes, for the cached
22979 version of the repository index page.
22980
22981 Defaults to @samp{5}.
22982
22983 @end deftypevr
22984
22985 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-scanrc-ttl
22986 Number which specifies the time-to-live, in minutes, for the result of
22987 scanning a path for Git repositories.
22988
22989 Defaults to @samp{15}.
22990
22991 @end deftypevr
22992
22993 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-about-ttl
22994 Number which specifies the time-to-live, in minutes, for the cached
22995 version of the repository about page.
22996
22997 Defaults to @samp{15}.
22998
22999 @end deftypevr
23000
23001 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-snapshot-ttl
23002 Number which specifies the time-to-live, in minutes, for the cached
23003 version of snapshots.
23004
23005 Defaults to @samp{5}.
23006
23007 @end deftypevr
23008
23009 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-size
23010 The maximum number of entries in the cgit cache. When set to @samp{0},
23011 caching is disabled.
23012
23013 Defaults to @samp{0}.
23014
23015 @end deftypevr
23016
23017 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean case-sensitive-sort?
23018 Sort items in the repo list case sensitively.
23019
23020 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
23021
23022 @end deftypevr
23023
23024 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} list clone-prefix
23025 List of common prefixes which, when combined with a repository URL,
23026 generates valid clone URLs for the repository.
23027
23028 Defaults to @samp{()}.
23029
23030 @end deftypevr
23031
23032 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} list clone-url
23033 List of @code{clone-url} templates.
23034
23035 Defaults to @samp{()}.
23036
23037 @end deftypevr
23038
23039 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object commit-filter
23040 Command which will be invoked to format commit messages.
23041
23042 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23043
23044 @end deftypevr
23045
23046 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string commit-sort
23047 Flag which, when set to @samp{date}, enables strict date ordering in the
23048 commit log, and when set to @samp{topo} enables strict topological
23049 ordering.
23050
23051 Defaults to @samp{"git log"}.
23052
23053 @end deftypevr
23054
23055 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object css
23056 URL which specifies the css document to include in all cgit pages.
23057
23058 Defaults to @samp{"/share/cgit/cgit.css"}.
23059
23060 @end deftypevr
23061
23062 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object email-filter
23063 Specifies a command which will be invoked to format names and email
23064 address of committers, authors, and taggers, as represented in various
23065 places throughout the cgit interface.
23066
23067 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23068
23069 @end deftypevr
23070
23071 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean embedded?
23072 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit generate a HTML
23073 fragment suitable for embedding in other HTML pages.
23074
23075 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
23076
23077 @end deftypevr
23078
23079 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-commit-graph?
23080 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit print an ASCII-art
23081 commit history graph to the left of the commit messages in the
23082 repository log page.
23083
23084 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
23085
23086 @end deftypevr
23087
23088 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-filter-overrides?
23089 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, allows all filter settings to be
23090 overridden in repository-specific cgitrc files.
23091
23092 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
23093
23094 @end deftypevr
23095
23096 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-follow-links?
23097 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, allows users to follow a file in the
23098 log view.
23099
23100 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
23101
23102 @end deftypevr
23103
23104 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-http-clone?
23105 If set to @samp{#t}, cgit will act as an dumb HTTP endpoint for Git
23106 clones.
23107
23108 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
23109
23110 @end deftypevr
23111
23112 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-index-links?
23113 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit generate extra links
23114 "summary", "commit", "tree" for each repo in the repository index.
23115
23116 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
23117
23118 @end deftypevr
23119
23120 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-index-owner?
23121 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit display the owner of
23122 each repo in the repository index.
23123
23124 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
23125
23126 @end deftypevr
23127
23128 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-log-filecount?
23129 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit print the number of
23130 modified files for each commit on the repository log page.
23131
23132 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
23133
23134 @end deftypevr
23135
23136 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-log-linecount?
23137 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit print the number of
23138 added and removed lines for each commit on the repository log page.
23139
23140 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
23141
23142 @end deftypevr
23143
23144 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-remote-branches?
23145 Flag which, when set to @code{#t}, will make cgit display remote
23146 branches in the summary and refs views.
23147
23148 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
23149
23150 @end deftypevr
23151
23152 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-subject-links?
23153 Flag which, when set to @code{1}, will make cgit use the subject of the
23154 parent commit as link text when generating links to parent commits in
23155 commit view.
23156
23157 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
23158
23159 @end deftypevr
23160
23161 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-html-serving?
23162 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit use the subject of the
23163 parent commit as link text when generating links to parent commits in
23164 commit view.
23165
23166 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
23167
23168 @end deftypevr
23169
23170 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-tree-linenumbers?
23171 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit generate linenumber
23172 links for plaintext blobs printed in the tree view.
23173
23174 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
23175
23176 @end deftypevr
23177
23178 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-git-config?
23179 Flag which, when set to @samp{#f}, will allow cgit to use Git config to
23180 set any repo specific settings.
23181
23182 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
23183
23184 @end deftypevr
23185
23186 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object favicon
23187 URL used as link to a shortcut icon for cgit.
23188
23189 Defaults to @samp{"/favicon.ico"}.
23190
23191 @end deftypevr
23192
23193 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string footer
23194 The content of the file specified with this option will be included
23195 verbatim at the bottom of all pages (i.e.@: it replaces the standard
23196 "generated by..."@: message).
23197
23198 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23199
23200 @end deftypevr
23201
23202 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string head-include
23203 The content of the file specified with this option will be included
23204 verbatim in the HTML HEAD section on all pages.
23205
23206 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23207
23208 @end deftypevr
23209
23210 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string header
23211 The content of the file specified with this option will be included
23212 verbatim at the top of all pages.
23213
23214 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23215
23216 @end deftypevr
23217
23218 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object include
23219 Name of a configfile to include before the rest of the current config-
23220 file is parsed.
23221
23222 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23223
23224 @end deftypevr
23225
23226 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string index-header
23227 The content of the file specified with this option will be included
23228 verbatim above the repository index.
23229
23230 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23231
23232 @end deftypevr
23233
23234 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string index-info
23235 The content of the file specified with this option will be included
23236 verbatim below the heading on the repository index page.
23237
23238 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23239
23240 @end deftypevr
23241
23242 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean local-time?
23243 Flag which, if set to @samp{#t}, makes cgit print commit and tag times
23244 in the servers timezone.
23245
23246 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
23247
23248 @end deftypevr
23249
23250 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object logo
23251 URL which specifies the source of an image which will be used as a logo
23252 on all cgit pages.
23253
23254 Defaults to @samp{"/share/cgit/cgit.png"}.
23255
23256 @end deftypevr
23257
23258 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string logo-link
23259 URL loaded when clicking on the cgit logo image.
23260
23261 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23262
23263 @end deftypevr
23264
23265 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object owner-filter
23266 Command which will be invoked to format the Owner column of the main
23267 page.
23268
23269 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23270
23271 @end deftypevr
23272
23273 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer max-atom-items
23274 Number of items to display in atom feeds view.
23275
23276 Defaults to @samp{10}.
23277
23278 @end deftypevr
23279
23280 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer max-commit-count
23281 Number of entries to list per page in "log" view.
23282
23283 Defaults to @samp{50}.
23284
23285 @end deftypevr
23286
23287 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer max-message-length
23288 Number of commit message characters to display in "log" view.
23289
23290 Defaults to @samp{80}.
23291
23292 @end deftypevr
23293
23294 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer max-repo-count
23295 Specifies the number of entries to list per page on the repository index
23296 page.
23297
23298 Defaults to @samp{50}.
23299
23300 @end deftypevr
23301
23302 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer max-repodesc-length
23303 Specifies the maximum number of repo description characters to display
23304 on the repository index page.
23305
23306 Defaults to @samp{80}.
23307
23308 @end deftypevr
23309
23310 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer max-blob-size
23311 Specifies the maximum size of a blob to display HTML for in KBytes.
23312
23313 Defaults to @samp{0}.
23314
23315 @end deftypevr
23316
23317 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string max-stats
23318 Maximum statistics period. Valid values are @samp{week},@samp{month},
23319 @samp{quarter} and @samp{year}.
23320
23321 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23322
23323 @end deftypevr
23324
23325 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} mimetype-alist mimetype
23326 Mimetype for the specified filename extension.
23327
23328 Defaults to @samp{((gif "image/gif") (html "text/html") (jpg
23329 "image/jpeg") (jpeg "image/jpeg") (pdf "application/pdf") (png
23330 "image/png") (svg "image/svg+xml"))}.
23331
23332 @end deftypevr
23333
23334 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object mimetype-file
23335 Specifies the file to use for automatic mimetype lookup.
23336
23337 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23338
23339 @end deftypevr
23340
23341 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string module-link
23342 Text which will be used as the formatstring for a hyperlink when a
23343 submodule is printed in a directory listing.
23344
23345 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23346
23347 @end deftypevr
23348
23349 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean nocache?
23350 If set to the value @samp{#t} caching will be disabled.
23351
23352 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
23353
23354 @end deftypevr
23355
23356 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean noplainemail?
23357 If set to @samp{#t} showing full author email addresses will be
23358 disabled.
23359
23360 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
23361
23362 @end deftypevr
23363
23364 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean noheader?
23365 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit omit the standard
23366 header on all pages.
23367
23368 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
23369
23370 @end deftypevr
23371
23372 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} project-list project-list
23373 A list of subdirectories inside of @code{repository-directory}, relative
23374 to it, that should loaded as Git repositories. An empty list means that
23375 all subdirectories will be loaded.
23376
23377 Defaults to @samp{()}.
23378
23379 @end deftypevr
23380
23381 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object readme
23382 Text which will be used as default value for @code{cgit-repo-readme}.
23383
23384 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23385
23386 @end deftypevr
23387
23388 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean remove-suffix?
23389 If set to @code{#t} and @code{repository-directory} is enabled, if any
23390 repositories are found with a suffix of @code{.git}, this suffix will be
23391 removed for the URL and name.
23392
23393 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
23394
23395 @end deftypevr
23396
23397 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer renamelimit
23398 Maximum number of files to consider when detecting renames.
23399
23400 Defaults to @samp{-1}.
23401
23402 @end deftypevr
23403
23404 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string repository-sort
23405 The way in which repositories in each section are sorted.
23406
23407 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23408
23409 @end deftypevr
23410
23411 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} robots-list robots
23412 Text used as content for the @code{robots} meta-tag.
23413
23414 Defaults to @samp{("noindex" "nofollow")}.
23415
23416 @end deftypevr
23417
23418 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string root-desc
23419 Text printed below the heading on the repository index page.
23420
23421 Defaults to @samp{"a fast webinterface for the git dscm"}.
23422
23423 @end deftypevr
23424
23425 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string root-readme
23426 The content of the file specified with this option will be included
23427 verbatim below thef "about" link on the repository index page.
23428
23429 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23430
23431 @end deftypevr
23432
23433 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string root-title
23434 Text printed as heading on the repository index page.
23435
23436 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23437
23438 @end deftypevr
23439
23440 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean scan-hidden-path
23441 If set to @samp{#t} and repository-directory is enabled,
23442 repository-directory will recurse into directories whose name starts
23443 with a period. Otherwise, repository-directory will stay away from such
23444 directories, considered as "hidden". Note that this does not apply to
23445 the ".git" directory in non-bare repos.
23446
23447 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
23448
23449 @end deftypevr
23450
23451 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} list snapshots
23452 Text which specifies the default set of snapshot formats that cgit
23453 generates links for.
23454
23455 Defaults to @samp{()}.
23456
23457 @end deftypevr
23458
23459 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} repository-directory repository-directory
23460 Name of the directory to scan for repositories (represents
23461 @code{scan-path}).
23462
23463 Defaults to @samp{"/srv/git"}.
23464
23465 @end deftypevr
23466
23467 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string section
23468 The name of the current repository section - all repositories defined
23469 after this option will inherit the current section name.
23470
23471 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23472
23473 @end deftypevr
23474
23475 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string section-sort
23476 Flag which, when set to @samp{1}, will sort the sections on the
23477 repository listing by name.
23478
23479 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23480
23481 @end deftypevr
23482
23483 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer section-from-path
23484 A number which, if defined prior to repository-directory, specifies how
23485 many path elements from each repo path to use as a default section name.
23486
23487 Defaults to @samp{0}.
23488
23489 @end deftypevr
23490
23491 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean side-by-side-diffs?
23492 If set to @samp{#t} shows side-by-side diffs instead of unidiffs per
23493 default.
23494
23495 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
23496
23497 @end deftypevr
23498
23499 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object source-filter
23500 Specifies a command which will be invoked to format plaintext blobs in
23501 the tree view.
23502
23503 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23504
23505 @end deftypevr
23506
23507 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer summary-branches
23508 Specifies the number of branches to display in the repository "summary"
23509 view.
23510
23511 Defaults to @samp{10}.
23512
23513 @end deftypevr
23514
23515 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer summary-log
23516 Specifies the number of log entries to display in the repository
23517 "summary" view.
23518
23519 Defaults to @samp{10}.
23520
23521 @end deftypevr
23522
23523 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer summary-tags
23524 Specifies the number of tags to display in the repository "summary"
23525 view.
23526
23527 Defaults to @samp{10}.
23528
23529 @end deftypevr
23530
23531 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string strict-export
23532 Filename which, if specified, needs to be present within the repository
23533 for cgit to allow access to that repository.
23534
23535 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23536
23537 @end deftypevr
23538
23539 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string virtual-root
23540 URL which, if specified, will be used as root for all cgit links.
23541
23542 Defaults to @samp{"/"}.
23543
23544 @end deftypevr
23545
23546 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} repository-cgit-configuration-list repositories
23547 A list of @dfn{cgit-repo} records to use with config.
23548
23549 Defaults to @samp{()}.
23550
23551 Available @code{repository-cgit-configuration} fields are:
23552
23553 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-list snapshots
23554 A mask of snapshot formats for this repo that cgit generates links for,
23555 restricted by the global @code{snapshots} setting.
23556
23557 Defaults to @samp{()}.
23558
23559 @end deftypevr
23560
23561 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-file-object source-filter
23562 Override the default @code{source-filter}.
23563
23564 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23565
23566 @end deftypevr
23567
23568 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string url
23569 The relative URL used to access the repository.
23570
23571 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23572
23573 @end deftypevr
23574
23575 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-file-object about-filter
23576 Override the default @code{about-filter}.
23577
23578 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23579
23580 @end deftypevr
23581
23582 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string branch-sort
23583 Flag which, when set to @samp{age}, enables date ordering in the branch
23584 ref list, and when set to @samp{name} enables ordering by branch name.
23585
23586 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23587
23588 @end deftypevr
23589
23590 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-list clone-url
23591 A list of URLs which can be used to clone repo.
23592
23593 Defaults to @samp{()}.
23594
23595 @end deftypevr
23596
23597 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-file-object commit-filter
23598 Override the default @code{commit-filter}.
23599
23600 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23601
23602 @end deftypevr
23603
23604 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string commit-sort
23605 Flag which, when set to @samp{date}, enables strict date ordering in the
23606 commit log, and when set to @samp{topo} enables strict topological
23607 ordering.
23608
23609 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23610
23611 @end deftypevr
23612
23613 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string defbranch
23614 The name of the default branch for this repository. If no such branch
23615 exists in the repository, the first branch name (when sorted) is used as
23616 default instead. By default branch pointed to by HEAD, or "master" if
23617 there is no suitable HEAD.
23618
23619 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23620
23621 @end deftypevr
23622
23623 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string desc
23624 The value to show as repository description.
23625
23626 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23627
23628 @end deftypevr
23629
23630 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string homepage
23631 The value to show as repository homepage.
23632
23633 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23634
23635 @end deftypevr
23636
23637 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-file-object email-filter
23638 Override the default @code{email-filter}.
23639
23640 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23641
23642 @end deftypevr
23643
23644 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} maybe-repo-boolean enable-commit-graph?
23645 A flag which can be used to disable the global setting
23646 @code{enable-commit-graph?}.
23647
23648 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23649
23650 @end deftypevr
23651
23652 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} maybe-repo-boolean enable-log-filecount?
23653 A flag which can be used to disable the global setting
23654 @code{enable-log-filecount?}.
23655
23656 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23657
23658 @end deftypevr
23659
23660 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} maybe-repo-boolean enable-log-linecount?
23661 A flag which can be used to disable the global setting
23662 @code{enable-log-linecount?}.
23663
23664 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23665
23666 @end deftypevr
23667
23668 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} maybe-repo-boolean enable-remote-branches?
23669 Flag which, when set to @code{#t}, will make cgit display remote
23670 branches in the summary and refs views.
23671
23672 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23673
23674 @end deftypevr
23675
23676 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} maybe-repo-boolean enable-subject-links?
23677 A flag which can be used to override the global setting
23678 @code{enable-subject-links?}.
23679
23680 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23681
23682 @end deftypevr
23683
23684 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} maybe-repo-boolean enable-html-serving?
23685 A flag which can be used to override the global setting
23686 @code{enable-html-serving?}.
23687
23688 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23689
23690 @end deftypevr
23691
23692 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-boolean hide?
23693 Flag which, when set to @code{#t}, hides the repository from the
23694 repository index.
23695
23696 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
23697
23698 @end deftypevr
23699
23700 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-boolean ignore?
23701 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, ignores the repository.
23702
23703 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
23704
23705 @end deftypevr
23706
23707 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-file-object logo
23708 URL which specifies the source of an image which will be used as a logo
23709 on this repo’s pages.
23710
23711 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23712
23713 @end deftypevr
23714
23715 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string logo-link
23716 URL loaded when clicking on the cgit logo image.
23717
23718 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23719
23720 @end deftypevr
23721
23722 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-file-object owner-filter
23723 Override the default @code{owner-filter}.
23724
23725 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23726
23727 @end deftypevr
23728
23729 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string module-link
23730 Text which will be used as the formatstring for a hyperlink when a
23731 submodule is printed in a directory listing. The arguments for the
23732 formatstring are the path and SHA1 of the submodule commit.
23733
23734 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23735
23736 @end deftypevr
23737
23738 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} module-link-path module-link-path
23739 Text which will be used as the formatstring for a hyperlink when a
23740 submodule with the specified subdirectory path is printed in a directory
23741 listing.
23742
23743 Defaults to @samp{()}.
23744
23745 @end deftypevr
23746
23747 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string max-stats
23748 Override the default maximum statistics period.
23749
23750 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23751
23752 @end deftypevr
23753
23754 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string name
23755 The value to show as repository name.
23756
23757 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23758
23759 @end deftypevr
23760
23761 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string owner
23762 A value used to identify the owner of the repository.
23763
23764 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23765
23766 @end deftypevr
23767
23768 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string path
23769 An absolute path to the repository directory.
23770
23771 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23772
23773 @end deftypevr
23774
23775 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string readme
23776 A path (relative to repo) which specifies a file to include verbatim as
23777 the "About" page for this repo.
23778
23779 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23780
23781 @end deftypevr
23782
23783 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string section
23784 The name of the current repository section - all repositories defined
23785 after this option will inherit the current section name.
23786
23787 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23788
23789 @end deftypevr
23790
23791 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-list extra-options
23792 Extra options will be appended to cgitrc file.
23793
23794 Defaults to @samp{()}.
23795
23796 @end deftypevr
23797
23798 @end deftypevr
23799
23800 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} list extra-options
23801 Extra options will be appended to cgitrc file.
23802
23803 Defaults to @samp{()}.
23804
23805 @end deftypevr
23806
23807
23808 @c %end of fragment
23809
23810 However, it could be that you just want to get a @code{cgitrc} up and
23811 running. In that case, you can pass an @code{opaque-cgit-configuration}
23812 as a record to @code{cgit-service-type}. As its name indicates, an
23813 opaque configuration does not have easy reflective capabilities.
23814
23815 Available @code{opaque-cgit-configuration} fields are:
23816
23817 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-cgit-configuration} parameter} package cgit
23818 The cgit package.
23819 @end deftypevr
23820
23821 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-cgit-configuration} parameter} string string
23822 The contents of the @code{cgitrc}, as a string.
23823 @end deftypevr
23824
23825 For example, if your @code{cgitrc} is just the empty string, you
23826 could instantiate a cgit service like this:
23827
23828 @example
23829 (service cgit-service-type
23830 (opaque-cgit-configuration
23831 (cgitrc "")))
23832 @end example
23833
23834 @subsubheading Gitolite Service
23835
23836 @cindex Gitolite service
23837 @cindex Git, hosting
23838 @uref{https://gitolite.com/gitolite/, Gitolite} is a tool for hosting Git
23839 repositories on a central server.
23840
23841 Gitolite can handle multiple repositories and users, and supports flexible
23842 configuration of the permissions for the users on the repositories.
23843
23844 The following example will configure Gitolite using the default @code{git}
23845 user, and the provided SSH public key.
23846
23847 @example
23848 (service gitolite-service-type
23849 (gitolite-configuration
23850 (admin-pubkey (plain-file
23851 "yourname.pub"
23852 "ssh-rsa AAAA... guix@@example.com"))))
23853 @end example
23854
23855 Gitolite is configured through a special admin repository which you can clone,
23856 for example, if you setup Gitolite on @code{example.com}, you would run the
23857 following command to clone the admin repository.
23858
23859 @example
23860 git clone git@@example.com:gitolite-admin
23861 @end example
23862
23863 When the Gitolite service is activated, the provided @code{admin-pubkey} will
23864 be inserted in to the @file{keydir} directory in the gitolite-admin
23865 repository. If this results in a change in the repository, it will be
23866 committed using the message ``gitolite setup by GNU Guix''.
23867
23868 @deftp {Data Type} gitolite-configuration
23869 Data type representing the configuration for @code{gitolite-service-type}.
23870
23871 @table @asis
23872 @item @code{package} (default: @var{gitolite})
23873 Gitolite package to use.
23874
23875 @item @code{user} (default: @var{git})
23876 User to use for Gitolite. This will be user that you use when accessing
23877 Gitolite over SSH.
23878
23879 @item @code{group} (default: @var{git})
23880 Group to use for Gitolite.
23881
23882 @item @code{home-directory} (default: @var{"/var/lib/gitolite"})
23883 Directory in which to store the Gitolite configuration and repositories.
23884
23885 @item @code{rc-file} (default: @var{(gitolite-rc-file)})
23886 A ``file-like'' object (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}),
23887 representing the configuration for Gitolite.
23888
23889 @item @code{admin-pubkey} (default: @var{#f})
23890 A ``file-like'' object (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}) used to
23891 setup Gitolite. This will be inserted in to the @file{keydir} directory
23892 within the gitolite-admin repository.
23893
23894 To specify the SSH key as a string, use the @code{plain-file} function.
23895
23896 @example
23897 (plain-file "yourname.pub" "ssh-rsa AAAA... guix@@example.com")
23898 @end example
23899
23900 @end table
23901 @end deftp
23902
23903 @deftp {Data Type} gitolite-rc-file
23904 Data type representing the Gitolite RC file.
23905
23906 @table @asis
23907 @item @code{umask} (default: @code{#o0077})
23908 This controls the permissions Gitolite sets on the repositories and their
23909 contents.
23910
23911 A value like @code{#o0027} will give read access to the group used by Gitolite
23912 (by default: @code{git}). This is necessary when using Gitolite with software
23913 like cgit or gitweb.
23914
23915 @item @code{git-config-keys} (default: @code{""})
23916 Gitolite allows you to set git config values using the "config" keyword. This
23917 setting allows control over the config keys to accept.
23918
23919 @item @code{roles} (default: @code{'(("READERS" . 1) ("WRITERS" . ))})
23920 Set the role names allowed to be used by users running the perms command.
23921
23922 @item @code{enable} (default: @code{'("help" "desc" "info" "perms" "writable" "ssh-authkeys" "git-config" "daemon" "gitweb")})
23923 This setting controls the commands and features to enable within Gitolite.
23924
23925 @end table
23926 @end deftp
23927
23928
23929 @node Game Services
23930 @subsection Game Services
23931
23932 @subsubheading The Battle for Wesnoth Service
23933 @cindex wesnothd
23934 @uref{https://wesnoth.org, The Battle for Wesnoth} is a fantasy, turn
23935 based tactical strategy game, with several single player campaigns, and
23936 multiplayer games (both networked and local).
23937
23938 @defvar {Scheme Variable} wesnothd-service-type
23939 Service type for the wesnothd service. Its value must be a
23940 @code{wesnothd-configuration} object. To run wesnothd in the default
23941 configuration, instantiate it as:
23942
23943 @example
23944 (service wesnothd-service-type)
23945 @end example
23946 @end defvar
23947
23948 @deftp {Data Type} wesnothd-configuration
23949 Data type representing the configuration of @command{wesnothd}.
23950
23951 @table @asis
23952 @item @code{package} (default: @code{wesnoth-server})
23953 The wesnoth server package to use.
23954
23955 @item @code{port} (default: @code{15000})
23956 The port to bind the server to.
23957 @end table
23958 @end deftp
23959
23960 @node Miscellaneous Services
23961 @subsection Miscellaneous Services
23962
23963 @cindex fingerprint
23964 @subsubheading Fingerprint Service
23965
23966 The @code{(gnu services authentication)} module provides a DBus service to
23967 read and identify fingerprints via a fingerprint sensor.
23968
23969 @defvr {Scheme Variable} fprintd-service-type
23970 The service type for @command{fprintd}, which provides the fingerprint
23971 reading capability.
23972
23973 @example
23974 (service fprintd-service-type)
23975 @end example
23976 @end defvr
23977
23978 @cindex sysctl
23979 @subsubheading System Control Service
23980
23981 The @code{(gnu services sysctl)} provides a service to configure kernel
23982 parameters at boot.
23983
23984 @defvr {Scheme Variable} sysctl-service-type
23985 The service type for @command{sysctl}, which modifies kernel parameters
23986 under @file{/proc/sys/}. To enable IPv4 forwarding, it can be
23987 instantiated as:
23988
23989 @example
23990 (service sysctl-service-type
23991 (sysctl-configuration
23992 (settings '(("net.ipv4.ip_forward" . "1")))))
23993 @end example
23994 @end defvr
23995
23996 @deftp {Data Type} sysctl-configuration
23997 The data type representing the configuration of @command{sysctl}.
23998
23999 @table @asis
24000 @item @code{sysctl} (default: @code{(file-append procps "/sbin/sysctl"})
24001 The @command{sysctl} executable to use.
24002
24003 @item @code{settings} (default: @code{'()})
24004 An association list specifies kernel parameters and their values.
24005 @end table
24006 @end deftp
24007
24008 @cindex pcscd
24009 @subsubheading PC/SC Smart Card Daemon Service
24010
24011 The @code{(gnu services security-token)} module provides the following service
24012 to run @command{pcscd}, the PC/SC Smart Card Daemon. @command{pcscd} is the
24013 daemon program for pcsc-lite and the MuscleCard framework. It is a resource
24014 manager that coordinates communications with smart card readers, smart cards
24015 and cryptographic tokens that are connected to the system.
24016
24017 @defvr {Scheme Variable} pcscd-service-type
24018 Service type for the @command{pcscd} service. Its value must be a
24019 @code{pcscd-configuration} object. To run pcscd in the default
24020 configuration, instantiate it as:
24021
24022 @example
24023 (service pcscd-service-type)
24024 @end example
24025 @end defvr
24026
24027 @deftp {Data Type} pcscd-configuration
24028 The data type representing the configuration of @command{pcscd}.
24029
24030 @table @asis
24031 @item @code{pcsc-lite} (default: @code{pcsc-lite})
24032 The pcsc-lite package that provides pcscd.
24033 @item @code{usb-drivers} (default: @code{(list ccid)})
24034 List of packages that provide USB drivers to pcscd. Drivers are expected to be
24035 under @file{pcsc/drivers} in the store directory of the package.
24036 @end table
24037 @end deftp
24038
24039 @cindex lirc
24040 @subsubheading Lirc Service
24041
24042 The @code{(gnu services lirc)} module provides the following service.
24043
24044 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} lirc-service [#:lirc lirc] @
24045 [#:device #f] [#:driver #f] [#:config-file #f] @
24046 [#:extra-options '()]
24047 Return a service that runs @url{http://www.lirc.org,LIRC}, a daemon that
24048 decodes infrared signals from remote controls.
24049
24050 Optionally, @var{device}, @var{driver} and @var{config-file}
24051 (configuration file name) may be specified. See @command{lircd} manual
24052 for details.
24053
24054 Finally, @var{extra-options} is a list of additional command-line options
24055 passed to @command{lircd}.
24056 @end deffn
24057
24058 @cindex spice
24059 @subsubheading Spice Service
24060
24061 The @code{(gnu services spice)} module provides the following service.
24062
24063 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} spice-vdagent-service [#:spice-vdagent]
24064 Returns a service that runs @url{https://www.spice-space.org,VDAGENT}, a daemon
24065 that enables sharing the clipboard with a vm and setting the guest display
24066 resolution when the graphical console window resizes.
24067 @end deffn
24068
24069 @cindex inputattach
24070 @subsubheading inputattach Service
24071
24072 @cindex tablet input, for Xorg
24073 @cindex touchscreen input, for Xorg
24074 The @uref{https://linuxwacom.github.io/, inputattach} service allows you to
24075 use input devices such as Wacom tablets, touchscreens, or joysticks with the
24076 Xorg display server.
24077
24078 @deffn {Scheme Variable} inputattach-service-type
24079 Type of a service that runs @command{inputattach} on a device and
24080 dispatches events from it.
24081 @end deffn
24082
24083 @deftp {Data Type} inputattach-configuration
24084 @table @asis
24085 @item @code{device-type} (default: @code{"wacom"})
24086 The type of device to connect to. Run @command{inputattach --help}, from the
24087 @code{inputattach} package, to see the list of supported device types.
24088
24089 @item @code{device} (default: @code{"/dev/ttyS0"})
24090 The device file to connect to the device.
24091
24092 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{#f})
24093 If true, this must be the name of a file to log messages to.
24094 @end table
24095 @end deftp
24096
24097 @subsection Dictionary Services
24098 @cindex dictionary
24099 The @code{(gnu services dict)} module provides the following service:
24100
24101 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} dicod-service [#:config (dicod-configuration)]
24102 Return a service that runs the @command{dicod} daemon, an implementation
24103 of DICT server (@pxref{Dicod,,, dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
24104
24105 The optional @var{config} argument specifies the configuration for
24106 @command{dicod}, which should be a @code{<dicod-configuration>} object, by
24107 default it serves the GNU Collaborative International Dictonary of English.
24108
24109 You can add @command{open localhost} to your @file{~/.dico} file to make
24110 @code{localhost} the default server for @command{dico} client
24111 (@pxref{Initialization File,,, dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
24112 @end deffn
24113
24114 @deftp {Data Type} dicod-configuration
24115 Data type representing the configuration of dicod.
24116
24117 @table @asis
24118 @item @code{dico} (default: @var{dico})
24119 Package object of the GNU Dico dictionary server.
24120
24121 @item @code{interfaces} (default: @var{'("localhost")})
24122 This is the list of IP addresses and ports and possibly socket file
24123 names to listen to (@pxref{Server Settings, @code{listen} directive,,
24124 dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
24125
24126 @item @code{handlers} (default: @var{'()})
24127 List of @code{<dicod-handler>} objects denoting handlers (module instances).
24128
24129 @item @code{databases} (default: @var{(list %dicod-database:gcide)})
24130 List of @code{<dicod-database>} objects denoting dictionaries to be served.
24131 @end table
24132 @end deftp
24133
24134 @deftp {Data Type} dicod-handler
24135 Data type representing a dictionary handler (module instance).
24136
24137 @table @asis
24138 @item @code{name}
24139 Name of the handler (module instance).
24140
24141 @item @code{module} (default: @var{#f})
24142 Name of the dicod module of the handler (instance). If it is @code{#f},
24143 the module has the same name as the handler.
24144 (@pxref{Modules,,, dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
24145
24146 @item @code{options}
24147 List of strings or gexps representing the arguments for the module handler
24148 @end table
24149 @end deftp
24150
24151 @deftp {Data Type} dicod-database
24152 Data type representing a dictionary database.
24153
24154 @table @asis
24155 @item @code{name}
24156 Name of the database, will be used in DICT commands.
24157
24158 @item @code{handler}
24159 Name of the dicod handler (module instance) used by this database
24160 (@pxref{Handlers,,, dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
24161
24162 @item @code{complex?} (default: @var{#f})
24163 Whether the database configuration complex. The complex configuration
24164 will need a corresponding @code{<dicod-handler>} object, otherwise not.
24165
24166 @item @code{options}
24167 List of strings or gexps representing the arguments for the database
24168 (@pxref{Databases,,, dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
24169 @end table
24170 @end deftp
24171
24172 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %dicod-database:gcide
24173 A @code{<dicod-database>} object serving the GNU Collaborative International
24174 Dictionary of English using the @code{gcide} package.
24175 @end defvr
24176
24177 The following is an example @code{dicod-service} configuration.
24178
24179 @example
24180 (dicod-service #:config
24181 (dicod-configuration
24182 (handlers (list (dicod-handler
24183 (name "wordnet")
24184 (module "dictorg")
24185 (options
24186 (list #~(string-append "dbdir=" #$wordnet))))))
24187 (databases (list (dicod-database
24188 (name "wordnet")
24189 (complex? #t)
24190 (handler "wordnet")
24191 (options '("database=wn")))
24192 %dicod-database:gcide))))
24193 @end example
24194
24195 @cindex Docker
24196 @subsubheading Docker Service
24197
24198 The @code{(gnu services docker)} module provides the following services.
24199
24200 @defvr {Scheme Variable} docker-service-type
24201
24202 This is the type of the service that runs @url{https://www.docker.com,Docker},
24203 a daemon that can execute application bundles (sometimes referred to as
24204 ``containers'') in isolated environments.
24205
24206 @end defvr
24207
24208 @deftp {Data Type} docker-configuration
24209 This is the data type representing the configuration of Docker and Containerd.
24210
24211 @table @asis
24212
24213 @item @code{package} (default: @code{docker})
24214 The Docker package to use.
24215
24216 @item @code{containerd} (default: @var{containerd})
24217 The Containerd package to use.
24218
24219 @end table
24220 @end deftp
24221
24222 @cindex Audit
24223 @subsubheading Auditd Service
24224
24225 The @code{(gnu services auditd)} module provides the following service.
24226
24227 @defvr {Scheme Variable} auditd-service-type
24228
24229 This is the type of the service that runs
24230 @url{https://people.redhat.com/sgrubb/audit/,auditd},
24231 a daemon that tracks security-relevant information on your system.
24232
24233 Examples of things that can be tracked:
24234
24235 @enumerate
24236 @item
24237 File accesses
24238 @item
24239 System calls
24240 @item
24241 Invoked commands
24242 @item
24243 Failed login attempts
24244 @item
24245 Firewall filtering
24246 @item
24247 Network access
24248 @end enumerate
24249
24250 @command{auditctl} from the @code{audit} package can be used in order
24251 to add or remove events to be tracked (until the next reboot).
24252 In order to permanently track events, put the command line arguments
24253 of auditctl into @file{/etc/audit/audit.rules}.
24254 @command{aureport} from the @code{audit} package can be used in order
24255 to view a report of all recorded events.
24256 The audit daemon usually logs into the directory @file{/var/log/audit}.
24257
24258 @end defvr
24259
24260 @deftp {Data Type} auditd-configuration
24261 This is the data type representing the configuration of auditd.
24262
24263 @table @asis
24264
24265 @item @code{audit} (default: @code{audit})
24266 The audit package to use.
24267
24268 @end table
24269 @end deftp
24270
24271 @defvr {Scheme Variable} singularity-service-type
24272 This is the type of the service that allows you to run
24273 @url{https://www.sylabs.io/singularity/, Singularity}, a Docker-style tool to
24274 create and run application bundles (aka. ``containers''). The value for this
24275 service is the Singularity package to use.
24276
24277 The service does not install a daemon; instead, it installs helper programs as
24278 setuid-root (@pxref{Setuid Programs}) such that unprivileged users can invoke
24279 @command{singularity run} and similar commands.
24280 @end defvr
24281
24282 @cindex Nix
24283 @subsubheading Nix service
24284
24285 The @code{(gnu services nix)} module provides the following service.
24286
24287 @defvr {Scheme Variable} nix-service-type
24288
24289 This is the type of the service that runs build daemon of the
24290 @url{https://nixos.org/nix/, Nix} package manager. Here is an example showing
24291 how to use it:
24292
24293 @example
24294 (use-modules (gnu))
24295 (use-service-modules nix)
24296 (use-package-modules package-management)
24297
24298 (operating-system
24299 ;; @dots{}
24300 (packages (append (list nix)
24301 %base-packages))
24302
24303 (services (append (list (service nix-service-type))
24304 %base-services)))
24305 @end example
24306
24307 After @command{guix system reconfigure} configure Nix for your user:
24308
24309 @itemize
24310 @item Add a Nix channel and update it. See
24311 @url{https://nixos.org/nix/manual/, Nix Package Manager Guide}.
24312
24313 @item Create a symlink to your profile and activate Nix profile:
24314 @end itemize
24315
24316 @example
24317 $ ln -s "/nix/var/nix/profiles/per-user/$USER/profile" ~/.nix-profile
24318 $ source /run/current-system/profile/etc/profile.d/nix.sh
24319 @end example
24320
24321 @end defvr
24322
24323 @node Setuid Programs
24324 @section Setuid Programs
24325
24326 @cindex setuid programs
24327 Some programs need to run with ``root'' privileges, even when they are
24328 launched by unprivileged users. A notorious example is the
24329 @command{passwd} program, which users can run to change their
24330 password, and which needs to access the @file{/etc/passwd} and
24331 @file{/etc/shadow} files---something normally restricted to root, for
24332 obvious security reasons. To address that, these executables are
24333 @dfn{setuid-root}, meaning that they always run with root privileges
24334 (@pxref{How Change Persona,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual},
24335 for more info about the setuid mechanism.)
24336
24337 The store itself @emph{cannot} contain setuid programs: that would be a
24338 security issue since any user on the system can write derivations that
24339 populate the store (@pxref{The Store}). Thus, a different mechanism is
24340 used: instead of changing the setuid bit directly on files that are in
24341 the store, we let the system administrator @emph{declare} which programs
24342 should be setuid root.
24343
24344 The @code{setuid-programs} field of an @code{operating-system}
24345 declaration contains a list of G-expressions denoting the names of
24346 programs to be setuid-root (@pxref{Using the Configuration System}).
24347 For instance, the @command{passwd} program, which is part of the Shadow
24348 package, can be designated by this G-expression (@pxref{G-Expressions}):
24349
24350 @example
24351 #~(string-append #$shadow "/bin/passwd")
24352 @end example
24353
24354 A default set of setuid programs is defined by the
24355 @code{%setuid-programs} variable of the @code{(gnu system)} module.
24356
24357 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %setuid-programs
24358 A list of G-expressions denoting common programs that are setuid-root.
24359
24360 The list includes commands such as @command{passwd}, @command{ping},
24361 @command{su}, and @command{sudo}.
24362 @end defvr
24363
24364 Under the hood, the actual setuid programs are created in the
24365 @file{/run/setuid-programs} directory at system activation time. The
24366 files in this directory refer to the ``real'' binaries, which are in the
24367 store.
24368
24369 @node X.509 Certificates
24370 @section X.509 Certificates
24371
24372 @cindex HTTPS, certificates
24373 @cindex X.509 certificates
24374 @cindex TLS
24375 Web servers available over HTTPS (that is, HTTP over the transport-layer
24376 security mechanism, TLS) send client programs an @dfn{X.509 certificate}
24377 that the client can then use to @emph{authenticate} the server. To do
24378 that, clients verify that the server's certificate is signed by a
24379 so-called @dfn{certificate authority} (CA). But to verify the CA's
24380 signature, clients must have first acquired the CA's certificate.
24381
24382 Web browsers such as GNU@tie{}IceCat include their own set of CA
24383 certificates, such that they are able to verify CA signatures
24384 out-of-the-box.
24385
24386 However, most other programs that can talk HTTPS---@command{wget},
24387 @command{git}, @command{w3m}, etc.---need to be told where CA
24388 certificates can be found.
24389
24390 @cindex @code{nss-certs}
24391 In Guix, this is done by adding a package that provides certificates
24392 to the @code{packages} field of the @code{operating-system} declaration
24393 (@pxref{operating-system Reference}). Guix includes one such package,
24394 @code{nss-certs}, which is a set of CA certificates provided as part of
24395 Mozilla's Network Security Services.
24396
24397 Note that it is @emph{not} part of @code{%base-packages}, so you need to
24398 explicitly add it. The @file{/etc/ssl/certs} directory, which is where
24399 most applications and libraries look for certificates by default, points
24400 to the certificates installed globally.
24401
24402 Unprivileged users, including users of Guix on a foreign distro,
24403 can also install their own certificate package in
24404 their profile. A number of environment variables need to be defined so
24405 that applications and libraries know where to find them. Namely, the
24406 OpenSSL library honors the @code{SSL_CERT_DIR} and @code{SSL_CERT_FILE}
24407 variables. Some applications add their own environment variables; for
24408 instance, the Git version control system honors the certificate bundle
24409 pointed to by the @code{GIT_SSL_CAINFO} environment variable. Thus, you
24410 would typically run something like:
24411
24412 @example
24413 $ guix install nss-certs
24414 $ export SSL_CERT_DIR="$HOME/.guix-profile/etc/ssl/certs"
24415 $ export SSL_CERT_FILE="$HOME/.guix-profile/etc/ssl/certs/ca-certificates.crt"
24416 $ export GIT_SSL_CAINFO="$SSL_CERT_FILE"
24417 @end example
24418
24419 As another example, R requires the @code{CURL_CA_BUNDLE} environment
24420 variable to point to a certificate bundle, so you would have to run
24421 something like this:
24422
24423 @example
24424 $ guix install nss-certs
24425 $ export CURL_CA_BUNDLE="$HOME/.guix-profile/etc/ssl/certs/ca-certificates.crt"
24426 @end example
24427
24428 For other applications you may want to look up the required environment
24429 variable in the relevant documentation.
24430
24431
24432 @node Name Service Switch
24433 @section Name Service Switch
24434
24435 @cindex name service switch
24436 @cindex NSS
24437 The @code{(gnu system nss)} module provides bindings to the
24438 configuration file of the libc @dfn{name service switch} or @dfn{NSS}
24439 (@pxref{NSS Configuration File,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference
24440 Manual}). In a nutshell, the NSS is a mechanism that allows libc to be
24441 extended with new ``name'' lookup methods for system databases, which
24442 includes host names, service names, user accounts, and more (@pxref{Name
24443 Service Switch, System Databases and Name Service Switch,, libc, The GNU
24444 C Library Reference Manual}).
24445
24446 The NSS configuration specifies, for each system database, which lookup
24447 method is to be used, and how the various methods are chained
24448 together---for instance, under which circumstances NSS should try the
24449 next method in the list. The NSS configuration is given in the
24450 @code{name-service-switch} field of @code{operating-system} declarations
24451 (@pxref{operating-system Reference, @code{name-service-switch}}).
24452
24453 @cindex nss-mdns
24454 @cindex .local, host name lookup
24455 As an example, the declaration below configures the NSS to use the
24456 @uref{http://0pointer.de/lennart/projects/nss-mdns/, @code{nss-mdns}
24457 back-end}, which supports host name lookups over multicast DNS (mDNS)
24458 for host names ending in @code{.local}:
24459
24460 @example
24461 (name-service-switch
24462 (hosts (list %files ;first, check /etc/hosts
24463
24464 ;; If the above did not succeed, try
24465 ;; with 'mdns_minimal'.
24466 (name-service
24467 (name "mdns_minimal")
24468
24469 ;; 'mdns_minimal' is authoritative for
24470 ;; '.local'. When it returns "not found",
24471 ;; no need to try the next methods.
24472 (reaction (lookup-specification
24473 (not-found => return))))
24474
24475 ;; Then fall back to DNS.
24476 (name-service
24477 (name "dns"))
24478
24479 ;; Finally, try with the "full" 'mdns'.
24480 (name-service
24481 (name "mdns")))))
24482 @end example
24483
24484 Do not worry: the @code{%mdns-host-lookup-nss} variable (see below)
24485 contains this configuration, so you will not have to type it if all you
24486 want is to have @code{.local} host lookup working.
24487
24488 Note that, in this case, in addition to setting the
24489 @code{name-service-switch} of the @code{operating-system} declaration,
24490 you also need to use @code{avahi-service-type} (@pxref{Networking Services,
24491 @code{avahi-service-type}}), or @code{%desktop-services}, which includes it
24492 (@pxref{Desktop Services}). Doing this makes @code{nss-mdns} accessible
24493 to the name service cache daemon (@pxref{Base Services,
24494 @code{nscd-service}}).
24495
24496 For convenience, the following variables provide typical NSS
24497 configurations.
24498
24499 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-nss
24500 This is the default name service switch configuration, a
24501 @code{name-service-switch} object.
24502 @end defvr
24503
24504 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %mdns-host-lookup-nss
24505 This is the name service switch configuration with support for host name
24506 lookup over multicast DNS (mDNS) for host names ending in @code{.local}.
24507 @end defvr
24508
24509 The reference for name service switch configuration is given below. It
24510 is a direct mapping of the configuration file format of the C library , so
24511 please refer to the C library manual for more information (@pxref{NSS
24512 Configuration File,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
24513 Compared to the configuration file format of libc NSS, it has the advantage
24514 not only of adding this warm parenthetic feel that we like, but also
24515 static checks: you will know about syntax errors and typos as soon as you
24516 run @command{guix system}.
24517
24518 @deftp {Data Type} name-service-switch
24519
24520 This is the data type representation the configuration of libc's name
24521 service switch (NSS). Each field below represents one of the supported
24522 system databases.
24523
24524 @table @code
24525 @item aliases
24526 @itemx ethers
24527 @itemx group
24528 @itemx gshadow
24529 @itemx hosts
24530 @itemx initgroups
24531 @itemx netgroup
24532 @itemx networks
24533 @itemx password
24534 @itemx public-key
24535 @itemx rpc
24536 @itemx services
24537 @itemx shadow
24538 The system databases handled by the NSS. Each of these fields must be a
24539 list of @code{<name-service>} objects (see below).
24540 @end table
24541 @end deftp
24542
24543 @deftp {Data Type} name-service
24544
24545 This is the data type representing an actual name service and the
24546 associated lookup action.
24547
24548 @table @code
24549 @item name
24550 A string denoting the name service (@pxref{Services in the NSS
24551 configuration,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
24552
24553 Note that name services listed here must be visible to nscd. This is
24554 achieved by passing the @code{#:name-services} argument to
24555 @code{nscd-service} the list of packages providing the needed name
24556 services (@pxref{Base Services, @code{nscd-service}}).
24557
24558 @item reaction
24559 An action specified using the @code{lookup-specification} macro
24560 (@pxref{Actions in the NSS configuration,,, libc, The GNU C Library
24561 Reference Manual}). For example:
24562
24563 @example
24564 (lookup-specification (unavailable => continue)
24565 (success => return))
24566 @end example
24567 @end table
24568 @end deftp
24569
24570 @node Initial RAM Disk
24571 @section Initial RAM Disk
24572
24573 @cindex initrd
24574 @cindex initial RAM disk
24575 For bootstrapping purposes, the Linux-Libre kernel is passed an
24576 @dfn{initial RAM disk}, or @dfn{initrd}. An initrd contains a temporary
24577 root file system as well as an initialization script. The latter is
24578 responsible for mounting the real root file system, and for loading any
24579 kernel modules that may be needed to achieve that.
24580
24581 The @code{initrd-modules} field of an @code{operating-system}
24582 declaration allows you to specify Linux-libre kernel modules that must
24583 be available in the initrd. In particular, this is where you would list
24584 modules needed to actually drive the hard disk where your root partition
24585 is---although the default value of @code{initrd-modules} should cover
24586 most use cases. For example, assuming you need the @code{megaraid_sas}
24587 module in addition to the default modules to be able to access your root
24588 file system, you would write:
24589
24590 @example
24591 (operating-system
24592 ;; @dots{}
24593 (initrd-modules (cons "megaraid_sas" %base-initrd-modules)))
24594 @end example
24595
24596 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %base-initrd-modules
24597 This is the list of kernel modules included in the initrd by default.
24598 @end defvr
24599
24600 Furthermore, if you need lower-level customization, the @code{initrd}
24601 field of an @code{operating-system} declaration allows
24602 you to specify which initrd you would like to use. The @code{(gnu
24603 system linux-initrd)} module provides three ways to build an initrd: the
24604 high-level @code{base-initrd} procedure and the low-level
24605 @code{raw-initrd} and @code{expression->initrd} procedures.
24606
24607 The @code{base-initrd} procedure is intended to cover most common uses.
24608 For example, if you want to add a bunch of kernel modules to be loaded
24609 at boot time, you can define the @code{initrd} field of the operating
24610 system declaration like this:
24611
24612 @example
24613 (initrd (lambda (file-systems . rest)
24614 ;; Create a standard initrd but set up networking
24615 ;; with the parameters QEMU expects by default.
24616 (apply base-initrd file-systems
24617 #:qemu-networking? #t
24618 rest)))
24619 @end example
24620
24621 The @code{base-initrd} procedure also handles common use cases that
24622 involves using the system as a QEMU guest, or as a ``live'' system with
24623 volatile root file system.
24624
24625 The @code{base-initrd} procedure is built from @code{raw-initrd} procedure.
24626 Unlike @code{base-initrd}, @code{raw-initrd} doesn't do anything high-level,
24627 such as trying to guess which kernel modules and packages should be included
24628 to the initrd. An example use of @code{raw-initrd} is when a user has
24629 a custom Linux kernel configuration and default kernel modules included by
24630 @code{base-initrd} are not available.
24631
24632 The initial RAM disk produced by @code{base-initrd} or @code{raw-initrd}
24633 honors several options passed on the Linux kernel command line
24634 (that is, arguments passed @i{via} the @code{linux} command of GRUB, or the
24635 @code{-append} option of QEMU), notably:
24636
24637 @table @code
24638 @item --load=@var{boot}
24639 Tell the initial RAM disk to load @var{boot}, a file containing a Scheme
24640 program, once it has mounted the root file system.
24641
24642 Guix uses this option to yield control to a boot program that runs the
24643 service activation programs and then spawns the GNU@tie{}Shepherd, the
24644 initialization system.
24645
24646 @item --root=@var{root}
24647 Mount @var{root} as the root file system. @var{root} can be a
24648 device name like @code{/dev/sda1}, a file system label, or a file system
24649 UUID.
24650
24651 @item --system=@var{system}
24652 Have @file{/run/booted-system} and @file{/run/current-system} point to
24653 @var{system}.
24654
24655 @item modprobe.blacklist=@var{modules}@dots{}
24656 @cindex module, black-listing
24657 @cindex black list, of kernel modules
24658 Instruct the initial RAM disk as well as the @command{modprobe} command
24659 (from the kmod package) to refuse to load @var{modules}. @var{modules}
24660 must be a comma-separated list of module names---e.g.,
24661 @code{usbkbd,9pnet}.
24662
24663 @item --repl
24664 Start a read-eval-print loop (REPL) from the initial RAM disk before it
24665 tries to load kernel modules and to mount the root file system. Our
24666 marketing team calls it @dfn{boot-to-Guile}. The Schemer in you will
24667 love it. @xref{Using Guile Interactively,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference
24668 Manual}, for more information on Guile's REPL.
24669
24670 @end table
24671
24672 Now that you know all the features that initial RAM disks produced by
24673 @code{base-initrd} and @code{raw-initrd} provide,
24674 here is how to use it and customize it further.
24675
24676 @cindex initrd
24677 @cindex initial RAM disk
24678 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} raw-initrd @var{file-systems} @
24679 [#:linux-modules '()] [#:mapped-devices '()] @
24680 [#:keyboard-layout #f] @
24681 [#:helper-packages '()] [#:qemu-networking? #f] [#:volatile-root? #f]
24682 Return a derivation that builds a raw initrd. @var{file-systems} is
24683 a list of file systems to be mounted by the initrd, possibly in addition to
24684 the root file system specified on the kernel command line via @code{--root}.
24685 @var{linux-modules} is a list of kernel modules to be loaded at boot time.
24686 @var{mapped-devices} is a list of device mappings to realize before
24687 @var{file-systems} are mounted (@pxref{Mapped Devices}).
24688 @var{helper-packages} is a list of packages to be copied in the initrd. It may
24689 include @code{e2fsck/static} or other packages needed by the initrd to check
24690 the root file system.
24691
24692 When true, @var{keyboard-layout} is a @code{<keyboard-layout>} record denoting
24693 the desired console keyboard layout. This is done before @var{mapped-devices}
24694 are set up and before @var{file-systems} are mounted such that, should the
24695 user need to enter a passphrase or use the REPL, this happens using the
24696 intended keyboard layout.
24697
24698 When @var{qemu-networking?} is true, set up networking with the standard QEMU
24699 parameters. When @var{virtio?} is true, load additional modules so that the
24700 initrd can be used as a QEMU guest with para-virtualized I/O drivers.
24701
24702 When @var{volatile-root?} is true, the root file system is writable but any changes
24703 to it are lost.
24704 @end deffn
24705
24706 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} base-initrd @var{file-systems} @
24707 [#:mapped-devices '()] [#:keyboard-layout #f] @
24708 [#:qemu-networking? #f] [#:volatile-root? #f] @
24709 [#:linux-modules '()]
24710 Return as a file-like object a generic initrd, with kernel
24711 modules taken from @var{linux}. @var{file-systems} is a list of file-systems to be
24712 mounted by the initrd, possibly in addition to the root file system specified
24713 on the kernel command line via @code{--root}. @var{mapped-devices} is a list of device
24714 mappings to realize before @var{file-systems} are mounted.
24715
24716 When true, @var{keyboard-layout} is a @code{<keyboard-layout>} record denoting
24717 the desired console keyboard layout. This is done before @var{mapped-devices}
24718 are set up and before @var{file-systems} are mounted such that, should the
24719 user need to enter a passphrase or use the REPL, this happens using the
24720 intended keyboard layout.
24721
24722 @var{qemu-networking?} and @var{volatile-root?} behaves as in @code{raw-initrd}.
24723
24724 The initrd is automatically populated with all the kernel modules necessary
24725 for @var{file-systems} and for the given options. Additional kernel
24726 modules can be listed in @var{linux-modules}. They will be added to the initrd, and
24727 loaded at boot time in the order in which they appear.
24728 @end deffn
24729
24730 Needless to say, the initrds we produce and use embed a
24731 statically-linked Guile, and the initialization program is a Guile
24732 program. That gives a lot of flexibility. The
24733 @code{expression->initrd} procedure builds such an initrd, given the
24734 program to run in that initrd.
24735
24736 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} expression->initrd @var{exp} @
24737 [#:guile %guile-static-stripped] [#:name "guile-initrd"]
24738 Return as a file-like object a Linux initrd (a gzipped cpio archive)
24739 containing @var{guile} and that evaluates @var{exp}, a G-expression,
24740 upon booting. All the derivations referenced by @var{exp} are
24741 automatically copied to the initrd.
24742 @end deffn
24743
24744 @node Bootloader Configuration
24745 @section Bootloader Configuration
24746
24747 @cindex bootloader
24748 @cindex boot loader
24749
24750 The operating system supports multiple bootloaders. The bootloader is
24751 configured using @code{bootloader-configuration} declaration. All the
24752 fields of this structure are bootloader agnostic except for one field,
24753 @code{bootloader} that indicates the bootloader to be configured and
24754 installed.
24755
24756 Some of the bootloaders do not honor every field of
24757 @code{bootloader-configuration}. For instance, the extlinux
24758 bootloader does not support themes and thus ignores the @code{theme}
24759 field.
24760
24761 @deftp {Data Type} bootloader-configuration
24762 The type of a bootloader configuration declaration.
24763
24764 @table @asis
24765
24766 @item @code{bootloader}
24767 @cindex EFI, bootloader
24768 @cindex UEFI, bootloader
24769 @cindex BIOS, bootloader
24770 The bootloader to use, as a @code{bootloader} object. For now
24771 @code{grub-bootloader}, @code{grub-efi-bootloader},
24772 @code{extlinux-bootloader} and @code{u-boot-bootloader} are supported.
24773
24774 @vindex grub-efi-bootloader
24775 @code{grub-efi-bootloader} allows to boot on modern systems using the
24776 @dfn{Unified Extensible Firmware Interface} (UEFI). This is what you should
24777 use if the installation image contains a @file{/sys/firmware/efi} directory
24778 when you boot it on your system.
24779
24780 @vindex grub-bootloader
24781 @code{grub-bootloader} allows you to boot in particular Intel-based machines
24782 in ``legacy'' BIOS mode.
24783
24784 @cindex ARM, bootloaders
24785 @cindex AArch64, bootloaders
24786 Available bootloaders are described in @code{(gnu bootloader @dots{})}
24787 modules. In particular, @code{(gnu bootloader u-boot)} contains definitions
24788 of bootloaders for a wide range of ARM and AArch64 systems, using the
24789 @uref{https://www.denx.de/wiki/U-Boot/, U-Boot bootloader}.
24790
24791 @item @code{target}
24792 This is a string denoting the target onto which to install the
24793 bootloader.
24794
24795 The interpretation depends on the bootloader in question. For
24796 @code{grub-bootloader}, for example, it should be a device name understood by
24797 the bootloader @command{installer} command, such as @code{/dev/sda} or
24798 @code{(hd0)} (@pxref{Invoking grub-install,,, grub, GNU GRUB Manual}). For
24799 @code{grub-efi-bootloader}, it should be the mount point of the EFI file
24800 system, usually @file{/boot/efi}.
24801
24802 @item @code{menu-entries} (default: @code{()})
24803 A possibly empty list of @code{menu-entry} objects (see below), denoting
24804 entries to appear in the bootloader menu, in addition to the current
24805 system entry and the entry pointing to previous system generations.
24806
24807 @item @code{default-entry} (default: @code{0})
24808 The index of the default boot menu entry. Index 0 is for the entry of the
24809 current system.
24810
24811 @item @code{timeout} (default: @code{5})
24812 The number of seconds to wait for keyboard input before booting. Set to
24813 0 to boot immediately, and to -1 to wait indefinitely.
24814
24815 @cindex keyboard layout, for the bootloader
24816 @item @code{keyboard-layout} (default: @code{#f})
24817 If this is @code{#f}, the bootloader's menu (if any) uses the default keyboard
24818 layout, usually US@tie{}English (``qwerty'').
24819
24820 Otherwise, this must be a @code{keyboard-layout} object (@pxref{Keyboard
24821 Layout}).
24822
24823 @quotation Note
24824 This option is currently ignored by bootloaders other than @code{grub} and
24825 @code{grub-efi}.
24826 @end quotation
24827
24828 @item @code{theme} (default: @var{#f})
24829 The bootloader theme object describing the theme to use. If no theme
24830 is provided, some bootloaders might use a default theme, that's true
24831 for GRUB.
24832
24833 @item @code{terminal-outputs} (default: @code{'(gfxterm)})
24834 The output terminals used for the bootloader boot menu, as a list of
24835 symbols. GRUB accepts the values: @code{console}, @code{serial},
24836 @code{serial_@{0-3@}}, @code{gfxterm}, @code{vga_text},
24837 @code{mda_text}, @code{morse}, and @code{pkmodem}. This field
24838 corresponds to the GRUB variable @code{GRUB_TERMINAL_OUTPUT} (@pxref{Simple
24839 configuration,,, grub,GNU GRUB manual}).
24840
24841 @item @code{terminal-inputs} (default: @code{'()})
24842 The input terminals used for the bootloader boot menu, as a list of
24843 symbols. For GRUB, the default is the native platform terminal as
24844 determined at run-time. GRUB accepts the values: @code{console},
24845 @code{serial}, @code{serial_@{0-3@}}, @code{at_keyboard}, and
24846 @code{usb_keyboard}. This field corresponds to the GRUB variable
24847 @code{GRUB_TERMINAL_INPUT} (@pxref{Simple configuration,,, grub,GNU GRUB
24848 manual}).
24849
24850 @item @code{serial-unit} (default: @code{#f})
24851 The serial unit used by the bootloader, as an integer from 0 to 3.
24852 For GRUB, it is chosen at run-time; currently GRUB chooses 0, which
24853 corresponds to COM1 (@pxref{Serial terminal,,, grub,GNU GRUB manual}).
24854
24855 @item @code{serial-speed} (default: @code{#f})
24856 The speed of the serial interface, as an integer. For GRUB, the
24857 default value is chosen at run-time; currently GRUB chooses
24858 9600@tie{}bps (@pxref{Serial terminal,,, grub,GNU GRUB manual}).
24859 @end table
24860
24861 @end deftp
24862
24863 @cindex dual boot
24864 @cindex boot menu
24865 Should you want to list additional boot menu entries @i{via} the
24866 @code{menu-entries} field above, you will need to create them with the
24867 @code{menu-entry} form. For example, imagine you want to be able to
24868 boot another distro (hard to imagine!), you can define a menu entry
24869 along these lines:
24870
24871 @example
24872 (menu-entry
24873 (label "The Other Distro")
24874 (linux "/boot/old/vmlinux-2.6.32")
24875 (linux-arguments '("root=/dev/sda2"))
24876 (initrd "/boot/old/initrd"))
24877 @end example
24878
24879 Details below.
24880
24881 @deftp {Data Type} menu-entry
24882 The type of an entry in the bootloader menu.
24883
24884 @table @asis
24885
24886 @item @code{label}
24887 The label to show in the menu---e.g., @code{"GNU"}.
24888
24889 @item @code{linux}
24890 The Linux kernel image to boot, for example:
24891
24892 @example
24893 (file-append linux-libre "/bzImage")
24894 @end example
24895
24896 For GRUB, it is also possible to specify a device explicitly in the
24897 file path using GRUB's device naming convention (@pxref{Naming
24898 convention,,, grub, GNU GRUB manual}), for example:
24899
24900 @example
24901 "(hd0,msdos1)/boot/vmlinuz"
24902 @end example
24903
24904 If the device is specified explicitly as above, then the @code{device}
24905 field is ignored entirely.
24906
24907 @item @code{linux-arguments} (default: @code{()})
24908 The list of extra Linux kernel command-line arguments---e.g.,
24909 @code{("console=ttyS0")}.
24910
24911 @item @code{initrd}
24912 A G-Expression or string denoting the file name of the initial RAM disk
24913 to use (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
24914 @item @code{device} (default: @code{#f})
24915 The device where the kernel and initrd are to be found---i.e., for GRUB,
24916 @dfn{root} for this menu entry (@pxref{root,,, grub, GNU GRUB manual}).
24917
24918 This may be a file system label (a string), a file system UUID (a
24919 bytevector, @pxref{File Systems}), or @code{#f}, in which case
24920 the bootloader will search the device containing the file specified by
24921 the @code{linux} field (@pxref{search,,, grub, GNU GRUB manual}). It
24922 must @emph{not} be an OS device name such as @file{/dev/sda1}.
24923
24924 @end table
24925 @end deftp
24926
24927 @c FIXME: Write documentation once it's stable.
24928 For now only GRUB has theme support. GRUB themes are created using
24929 the @code{grub-theme} form, which is not documented yet.
24930
24931 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-theme
24932 This is the default GRUB theme used by the operating system if no
24933 @code{theme} field is specified in @code{bootloader-configuration}
24934 record.
24935
24936 It comes with a fancy background image displaying the GNU and Guix
24937 logos.
24938 @end defvr
24939
24940
24941 @node Invoking guix system
24942 @section Invoking @code{guix system}
24943
24944 Once you have written an operating system declaration as seen in the
24945 previous section, it can be @dfn{instantiated} using the @command{guix
24946 system} command. The synopsis is:
24947
24948 @example
24949 guix system @var{options}@dots{} @var{action} @var{file}
24950 @end example
24951
24952 @var{file} must be the name of a file containing an
24953 @code{operating-system} declaration. @var{action} specifies how the
24954 operating system is instantiated. Currently the following values are
24955 supported:
24956
24957 @table @code
24958 @item search
24959 Display available service type definitions that match the given regular
24960 expressions, sorted by relevance:
24961
24962 @example
24963 $ guix system search console font
24964 name: console-fonts
24965 location: gnu/services/base.scm:729:2
24966 extends: shepherd-root
24967 description: Install the given fonts on the specified ttys (fonts are
24968 + per virtual console on GNU/Linux). The value of this service is a list
24969 + of tty/font pairs like:
24970 +
24971 + '(("tty1" . "LatGrkCyr-8x16"))
24972 relevance: 20
24973
24974 name: mingetty
24975 location: gnu/services/base.scm:1048:2
24976 extends: shepherd-root
24977 description: Provide console login using the `mingetty' program.
24978 relevance: 2
24979
24980 name: login
24981 location: gnu/services/base.scm:775:2
24982 extends: pam
24983 description: Provide a console log-in service as specified by its
24984 + configuration value, a `login-configuration' object.
24985 relevance: 2
24986
24987 @dots{}
24988 @end example
24989
24990 As for @command{guix package --search}, the result is written in
24991 @code{recutils} format, which makes it easy to filter the output
24992 (@pxref{Top, GNU recutils databases,, recutils, GNU recutils manual}).
24993
24994 @item reconfigure
24995 Build the operating system described in @var{file}, activate it, and
24996 switch to it@footnote{This action (and the related actions
24997 @code{switch-generation} and @code{roll-back}) are usable only on
24998 systems already running Guix System.}.
24999
25000 This effects all the configuration specified in @var{file}: user
25001 accounts, system services, global package list, setuid programs, etc.
25002 The command starts system services specified in @var{file} that are not
25003 currently running; if a service is currently running this command will
25004 arrange for it to be upgraded the next time it is stopped (e.g.@: by
25005 @code{herd stop X} or @code{herd restart X}).
25006
25007 This command creates a new generation whose number is one greater than
25008 the current generation (as reported by @command{guix system
25009 list-generations}). If that generation already exists, it will be
25010 overwritten. This behavior mirrors that of @command{guix package}
25011 (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
25012
25013 It also adds a bootloader menu entry for the new OS configuration,
25014 ---unless @option{--no-bootloader} is passed. For GRUB, it moves
25015 entries for older configurations to a submenu, allowing you to choose
25016 an older system generation at boot time should you need it.
25017
25018 @quotation Note
25019 @c The paragraph below refers to the problem discussed at
25020 @c <https://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/guix-devel/2014-08/msg00057.html>.
25021 It is highly recommended to run @command{guix pull} once before you run
25022 @command{guix system reconfigure} for the first time (@pxref{Invoking
25023 guix pull}). Failing to do that you would see an older version of Guix
25024 once @command{reconfigure} has completed.
25025 @end quotation
25026
25027 @item switch-generation
25028 @cindex generations
25029 Switch to an existing system generation. This action atomically
25030 switches the system profile to the specified system generation. It
25031 also rearranges the system's existing bootloader menu entries. It
25032 makes the menu entry for the specified system generation the default,
25033 and it moves the entries for the other generatiors to a submenu, if
25034 supported by the bootloader being used. The next time the system
25035 boots, it will use the specified system generation.
25036
25037 The bootloader itself is not being reinstalled when using this
25038 command. Thus, the installed bootloader is used with an updated
25039 configuration file.
25040
25041 The target generation can be specified explicitly by its generation
25042 number. For example, the following invocation would switch to system
25043 generation 7:
25044
25045 @example
25046 guix system switch-generation 7
25047 @end example
25048
25049 The target generation can also be specified relative to the current
25050 generation with the form @code{+N} or @code{-N}, where @code{+3} means
25051 ``3 generations ahead of the current generation,'' and @code{-1} means
25052 ``1 generation prior to the current generation.'' When specifying a
25053 negative value such as @code{-1}, you must precede it with @code{--} to
25054 prevent it from being parsed as an option. For example:
25055
25056 @example
25057 guix system switch-generation -- -1
25058 @end example
25059
25060 Currently, the effect of invoking this action is @emph{only} to switch
25061 the system profile to an existing generation and rearrange the
25062 bootloader menu entries. To actually start using the target system
25063 generation, you must reboot after running this action. In the future,
25064 it will be updated to do the same things as @command{reconfigure},
25065 like activating and deactivating services.
25066
25067 This action will fail if the specified generation does not exist.
25068
25069 @item roll-back
25070 @cindex rolling back
25071 Switch to the preceding system generation. The next time the system
25072 boots, it will use the preceding system generation. This is the inverse
25073 of @command{reconfigure}, and it is exactly the same as invoking
25074 @command{switch-generation} with an argument of @code{-1}.
25075
25076 Currently, as with @command{switch-generation}, you must reboot after
25077 running this action to actually start using the preceding system
25078 generation.
25079
25080 @item delete-generations
25081 @cindex deleting system generations
25082 @cindex saving space
25083 Delete system generations, making them candidates for garbage collection
25084 (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}, for information on how to run the ``garbage
25085 collector'').
25086
25087 This works in the same way as @command{guix package --delete-generations}
25088 (@pxref{Invoking guix package, @code{--delete-generations}}). With no
25089 arguments, all system generations but the current one are deleted:
25090
25091 @example
25092 guix system delete-generations
25093 @end example
25094
25095 You can also select the generations you want to delete. The example below
25096 deletes all the system generations that are more than two month old:
25097
25098 @example
25099 guix system delete-generations 2m
25100 @end example
25101
25102 Running this command automatically reinstalls the bootloader with an updated
25103 list of menu entries---e.g., the ``old generations'' sub-menu in GRUB no
25104 longer lists the generations that have been deleted.
25105
25106 @item build
25107 Build the derivation of the operating system, which includes all the
25108 configuration files and programs needed to boot and run the system.
25109 This action does not actually install anything.
25110
25111 @item init
25112 Populate the given directory with all the files necessary to run the
25113 operating system specified in @var{file}. This is useful for first-time
25114 installations of Guix System. For instance:
25115
25116 @example
25117 guix system init my-os-config.scm /mnt
25118 @end example
25119
25120 copies to @file{/mnt} all the store items required by the configuration
25121 specified in @file{my-os-config.scm}. This includes configuration
25122 files, packages, and so on. It also creates other essential files
25123 needed for the system to operate correctly---e.g., the @file{/etc},
25124 @file{/var}, and @file{/run} directories, and the @file{/bin/sh} file.
25125
25126 This command also installs bootloader on the target specified in
25127 @file{my-os-config}, unless the @option{--no-bootloader} option was
25128 passed.
25129
25130 @item vm
25131 @cindex virtual machine
25132 @cindex VM
25133 @anchor{guix system vm}
25134 Build a virtual machine that contains the operating system declared in
25135 @var{file}, and return a script to run that virtual machine (VM).
25136
25137 @quotation Note
25138 The @code{vm} action and others below
25139 can use KVM support in the Linux-libre kernel. Specifically, if the
25140 machine has hardware virtualization support, the corresponding
25141 KVM kernel module should be loaded, and the @file{/dev/kvm} device node
25142 must exist and be readable and writable by the user and by the
25143 build users of the daemon (@pxref{Build Environment Setup}).
25144 @end quotation
25145
25146 Arguments given to the script are passed to QEMU as in the example
25147 below, which enables networking and requests 1@tie{}GiB of RAM for the
25148 emulated machine:
25149
25150 @example
25151 $ /gnu/store/@dots{}-run-vm.sh -m 1024 -net user
25152 @end example
25153
25154 The VM shares its store with the host system.
25155
25156 Additional file systems can be shared between the host and the VM using
25157 the @code{--share} and @code{--expose} command-line options: the former
25158 specifies a directory to be shared with write access, while the latter
25159 provides read-only access to the shared directory.
25160
25161 The example below creates a VM in which the user's home directory is
25162 accessible read-only, and where the @file{/exchange} directory is a
25163 read-write mapping of @file{$HOME/tmp} on the host:
25164
25165 @example
25166 guix system vm my-config.scm \
25167 --expose=$HOME --share=$HOME/tmp=/exchange
25168 @end example
25169
25170 On GNU/Linux, the default is to boot directly to the kernel; this has
25171 the advantage of requiring only a very tiny root disk image since the
25172 store of the host can then be mounted.
25173
25174 The @code{--full-boot} option forces a complete boot sequence, starting
25175 with the bootloader. This requires more disk space since a root image
25176 containing at least the kernel, initrd, and bootloader data files must
25177 be created. The @code{--image-size} option can be used to specify the
25178 size of the image.
25179
25180 @cindex System images, creation in various formats
25181 @cindex Creating system images in various formats
25182 @item vm-image
25183 @itemx disk-image
25184 @itemx docker-image
25185 Return a virtual machine, disk image, or Docker image of the operating
25186 system declared in @var{file} that stands alone. By default,
25187 @command{guix system} estimates the size of the image needed to store
25188 the system, but you can use the @option{--image-size} option to specify
25189 a value. Docker images are built to contain exactly what they need, so
25190 the @option{--image-size} option is ignored in the case of
25191 @code{docker-image}.
25192
25193 You can specify the root file system type by using the
25194 @option{--file-system-type} option. It defaults to @code{ext4}.
25195
25196 When using @code{vm-image}, the returned image is in qcow2 format, which
25197 the QEMU emulator can efficiently use. @xref{Running Guix in a VM},
25198 for more information on how to run the image in a virtual machine.
25199
25200 When using @code{disk-image}, a raw disk image is produced; it can be
25201 copied as is to a USB stick, for instance. Assuming @code{/dev/sdc} is
25202 the device corresponding to a USB stick, one can copy the image to it
25203 using the following command:
25204
25205 @example
25206 # dd if=$(guix system disk-image my-os.scm) of=/dev/sdc
25207 @end example
25208
25209 When using @code{docker-image}, a Docker image is produced. Guix builds
25210 the image from scratch, not from a pre-existing Docker base image. As a
25211 result, it contains @emph{exactly} what you define in the operating
25212 system configuration file. You can then load the image and launch a
25213 Docker container using commands like the following:
25214
25215 @example
25216 image_id="`docker load < guix-system-docker-image.tar.gz`"
25217 container_id="`docker create $image_id`"
25218 docker start $container_id
25219 @end example
25220
25221 This command starts a new Docker container from the specified image. It
25222 will boot the Guix system in the usual manner, which means it will
25223 start any services you have defined in the operating system
25224 configuration. You can get an interactive shell running in the container
25225 using @command{docker exec}:
25226
25227 @example
25228 docker exec -ti $container_id /run/current-system/profile/bin/bash --login
25229 @end example
25230
25231 Depending on what you run in the Docker container, it
25232 may be necessary to give the container additional permissions. For
25233 example, if you intend to build software using Guix inside of the Docker
25234 container, you may need to pass the @option{--privileged} option to
25235 @code{docker create}.
25236
25237 @item container
25238 Return a script to run the operating system declared in @var{file}
25239 within a container. Containers are a set of lightweight isolation
25240 mechanisms provided by the kernel Linux-libre. Containers are
25241 substantially less resource-demanding than full virtual machines since
25242 the kernel, shared objects, and other resources can be shared with the
25243 host system; this also means they provide thinner isolation.
25244
25245 Currently, the script must be run as root in order to support more than
25246 a single user and group. The container shares its store with the host
25247 system.
25248
25249 As with the @code{vm} action (@pxref{guix system vm}), additional file
25250 systems to be shared between the host and container can be specified
25251 using the @option{--share} and @option{--expose} options:
25252
25253 @example
25254 guix system container my-config.scm \
25255 --expose=$HOME --share=$HOME/tmp=/exchange
25256 @end example
25257
25258 @quotation Note
25259 This option requires Linux-libre 3.19 or newer.
25260 @end quotation
25261
25262 @end table
25263
25264 @var{options} can contain any of the common build options (@pxref{Common
25265 Build Options}). In addition, @var{options} can contain one of the
25266 following:
25267
25268 @table @option
25269 @item --expression=@var{expr}
25270 @itemx -e @var{expr}
25271 Consider the operating-system @var{expr} evaluates to.
25272 This is an alternative to specifying a file which evaluates to an
25273 operating system.
25274 This is used to generate the Guix system installer @pxref{Building the
25275 Installation Image}).
25276
25277 @item --system=@var{system}
25278 @itemx -s @var{system}
25279 Attempt to build for @var{system} instead of the host system type.
25280 This works as per @command{guix build} (@pxref{Invoking guix build}).
25281
25282 @item --derivation
25283 @itemx -d
25284 Return the derivation file name of the given operating system without
25285 building anything.
25286
25287 @item --file-system-type=@var{type}
25288 @itemx -t @var{type}
25289 For the @code{disk-image} action, create a file system of the given
25290 @var{type} on the image.
25291
25292 When this option is omitted, @command{guix system} uses @code{ext4}.
25293
25294 @cindex ISO-9660 format
25295 @cindex CD image format
25296 @cindex DVD image format
25297 @code{--file-system-type=iso9660} produces an ISO-9660 image, suitable
25298 for burning on CDs and DVDs.
25299
25300 @item --image-size=@var{size}
25301 For the @code{vm-image} and @code{disk-image} actions, create an image
25302 of the given @var{size}. @var{size} may be a number of bytes, or it may
25303 include a unit as a suffix (@pxref{Block size, size specifications,,
25304 coreutils, GNU Coreutils}).
25305
25306 When this option is omitted, @command{guix system} computes an estimate
25307 of the image size as a function of the size of the system declared in
25308 @var{file}.
25309
25310 @item --network
25311 @itemx -N
25312 For the @code{container} action, allow containers to access the host network,
25313 that is, do not create a network namespace.
25314
25315 @item --root=@var{file}
25316 @itemx -r @var{file}
25317 Make @var{file} a symlink to the result, and register it as a garbage
25318 collector root.
25319
25320 @item --skip-checks
25321 Skip pre-installation safety checks.
25322
25323 By default, @command{guix system init} and @command{guix system
25324 reconfigure} perform safety checks: they make sure the file systems that
25325 appear in the @code{operating-system} declaration actually exist
25326 (@pxref{File Systems}), and that any Linux kernel modules that may be
25327 needed at boot time are listed in @code{initrd-modules} (@pxref{Initial
25328 RAM Disk}). Passing this option skips these tests altogether.
25329
25330 @cindex on-error
25331 @cindex on-error strategy
25332 @cindex error strategy
25333 @item --on-error=@var{strategy}
25334 Apply @var{strategy} when an error occurs when reading @var{file}.
25335 @var{strategy} may be one of the following:
25336
25337 @table @code
25338 @item nothing-special
25339 Report the error concisely and exit. This is the default strategy.
25340
25341 @item backtrace
25342 Likewise, but also display a backtrace.
25343
25344 @item debug
25345 Report the error and enter Guile's debugger. From there, you can run
25346 commands such as @code{,bt} to get a backtrace, @code{,locals} to
25347 display local variable values, and more generally inspect the state of the
25348 program. @xref{Debug Commands,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}, for
25349 a list of available debugging commands.
25350 @end table
25351 @end table
25352
25353 Once you have built, configured, re-configured, and re-re-configured
25354 your Guix installation, you may find it useful to list the operating
25355 system generations available on disk---and that you can choose from the
25356 bootloader boot menu:
25357
25358 @table @code
25359
25360 @item list-generations
25361 List a summary of each generation of the operating system available on
25362 disk, in a human-readable way. This is similar to the
25363 @option{--list-generations} option of @command{guix package}
25364 (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
25365
25366 Optionally, one can specify a pattern, with the same syntax that is used
25367 in @command{guix package --list-generations}, to restrict the list of
25368 generations displayed. For instance, the following command displays
25369 generations that are up to 10 days old:
25370
25371 @example
25372 $ guix system list-generations 10d
25373 @end example
25374
25375 @end table
25376
25377 The @command{guix system} command has even more to offer! The following
25378 sub-commands allow you to visualize how your system services relate to
25379 each other:
25380
25381 @anchor{system-extension-graph}
25382 @table @code
25383
25384 @item extension-graph
25385 Emit in Dot/Graphviz format to standard output the @dfn{service
25386 extension graph} of the operating system defined in @var{file}
25387 (@pxref{Service Composition}, for more information on service
25388 extensions.)
25389
25390 The command:
25391
25392 @example
25393 $ guix system extension-graph @var{file} | dot -Tpdf > services.pdf
25394 @end example
25395
25396 produces a PDF file showing the extension relations among services.
25397
25398 @anchor{system-shepherd-graph}
25399 @item shepherd-graph
25400 Emit in Dot/Graphviz format to standard output the @dfn{dependency
25401 graph} of shepherd services of the operating system defined in
25402 @var{file}. @xref{Shepherd Services}, for more information and for an
25403 example graph.
25404
25405 @end table
25406
25407 @node Invoking guix deploy
25408 @section Invoking @code{guix deploy}
25409
25410 We've already seen @code{operating-system} declarations used to manage a
25411 machine's configuration locally. Suppose you need to configure multiple
25412 machines, though---perhaps you're managing a service on the web that's
25413 comprised of several servers. @command{guix deploy} enables you to use those
25414 same @code{operating-system} declarations to manage multiple remote hosts at
25415 once as a logical ``deployment''.
25416
25417 @quotation Note
25418 The functionality described in this section is still under development
25419 and is subject to change. Get in touch with us on
25420 @email{guix-devel@@gnu.org}!
25421 @end quotation
25422
25423 @example
25424 guix deploy @var{file}
25425 @end example
25426
25427 Such an invocation will deploy the machines that the code within @var{file}
25428 evaluates to. As an example, @var{file} might contain a definition like this:
25429
25430 @example
25431 ;; This is a Guix deployment of a "bare bones" setup, with
25432 ;; no X11 display server, to a machine with an SSH daemon
25433 ;; listening on localhost:2222. A configuration such as this
25434 ;; may be appropriate for virtual machine with ports
25435 ;; forwarded to the host's loopback interface.
25436
25437 (use-service-modules networking ssh)
25438 (use-package-modules bootloaders)
25439
25440 (define %system
25441 (operating-system
25442 (host-name "gnu-deployed")
25443 (timezone "Etc/UTC")
25444 (bootloader (bootloader-configuration
25445 (bootloader grub-bootloader)
25446 (target "/dev/vda")
25447 (terminal-outputs '(console))))
25448 (file-systems (cons (file-system
25449 (mount-point "/")
25450 (device "/dev/vda1")
25451 (type "ext4"))
25452 %base-file-systems))
25453 (services
25454 (append (list (service dhcp-client-service-type)
25455 (service openssh-service-type
25456 (openssh-configuration
25457 (permit-root-login #t)
25458 (allow-empty-passwords? #t))))
25459 %base-services))))
25460
25461 (list (machine
25462 (system %system)
25463 (environment managed-host-environment-type)
25464 (configuration (machine-ssh-configuration
25465 (host-name "localhost")
25466 (identity "./id_rsa")
25467 (port 2222)))))
25468 @end example
25469
25470 The file should evaluate to a list of @var{machine} objects. This example,
25471 upon being deployed, will create a new generation on the remote system
25472 realizing the @code{operating-system} declaration @var{%system}.
25473 @var{environment} and @var{configuration} specify how the machine should be
25474 provisioned---that is, how the computing resources should be created and
25475 managed. The above example does not create any resources, as a
25476 @code{'managed-host} is a machine that is already running the Guix system and
25477 available over the network. This is a particularly simple case; a more
25478 complex deployment may involve, for example, starting virtual machines through
25479 a Virtual Private Server (VPS) provider. In such a case, a different
25480 @var{environment} type would be used.
25481
25482 @deftp {Data Type} machine
25483 This is the data type representing a single machine in a heterogeneous Guix
25484 deployment.
25485
25486 @table @asis
25487 @item @code{system}
25488 The object of the operating system configuration to deploy.
25489
25490 @item @code{environment}
25491 An @code{environment-type} describing how the machine should be provisioned.
25492 At the moment, the only supported value is
25493 @code{managed-host-environment-type}.
25494
25495 @item @code{configuration} (default: @code{#f})
25496 An object describing the configuration for the machine's @code{environment}.
25497 If the @code{environment} has a default configuration, @code{#f} maybe used.
25498 If @code{#f} is used for an environment with no default configuration,
25499 however, an error will be thrown.
25500 @end table
25501 @end deftp
25502
25503 @deftp {Data Type} machine-ssh-configuration
25504 This is the data type representing the SSH client parameters for a machine
25505 with an @code{environment} of @code{managed-host-environment-type}.
25506
25507 @table @asis
25508 @item @code{host-name}
25509 @item @code{port} (default: @code{22})
25510 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"root"})
25511 @item @code{identity} (default: @code{#f})
25512 If specified, the path to the SSH private key to use to authenticate with the
25513 remote host.
25514 @end table
25515 @end deftp
25516
25517 @node Running Guix in a VM
25518 @section Running Guix in a Virtual Machine
25519
25520 @cindex virtual machine
25521 To run Guix in a virtual machine (VM), one can use the pre-built Guix VM image
25522 distributed at
25523 @url{@value{BASE-URL}/guix-system-vm-image-@value{VERSION}.x86_64-linux.xz}.
25524 This image is a compressed image in QCOW format. You will first need to
25525 decompress with @command{xz -d}, and then you can pass it to an emulator such
25526 as QEMU (see below for details).
25527
25528 This image boots the Xfce graphical environment and it contains some
25529 commonly-used tools. You can install more software in the image by running
25530 @command{guix package} in a terminal (@pxref{Invoking guix package}). You can
25531 also reconfigure the system based on its initial configuration file available
25532 as @file{/etc/config.scm} (@pxref{Using the Configuration System}).
25533
25534 Instead of using this pre-built image, one can also build their own virtual
25535 machine image using @command{guix system vm-image} (@pxref{Invoking guix
25536 system}). The returned image is in qcow2 format, which the
25537 @uref{https://qemu.org/, QEMU emulator} can efficiently use.
25538
25539 @cindex QEMU
25540 If you built your own image, you must copy it out of the store
25541 (@pxref{The Store}) and give yourself permission to write to the copy
25542 before you can use it. When invoking QEMU, you must choose a system
25543 emulator that is suitable for your hardware platform. Here is a minimal
25544 QEMU invocation that will boot the result of @command{guix system
25545 vm-image} on x86_64 hardware:
25546
25547 @example
25548 $ qemu-system-x86_64 \
25549 -net user -net nic,model=virtio \
25550 -enable-kvm -m 512 \
25551 -device virtio-blk,drive=myhd \
25552 -drive if=none,file=/tmp/qemu-image,id=myhd
25553 @end example
25554
25555 Here is what each of these options means:
25556
25557 @table @code
25558 @item qemu-system-x86_64
25559 This specifies the hardware platform to emulate. This should match the
25560 host.
25561
25562 @item -net user
25563 Enable the unprivileged user-mode network stack. The guest OS can
25564 access the host but not vice versa. This is the simplest way to get the
25565 guest OS online.
25566
25567 @item -net nic,model=virtio
25568 You must create a network interface of a given model. If you do not
25569 create a NIC, the boot will fail. Assuming your hardware platform is
25570 x86_64, you can get a list of available NIC models by running
25571 @command{qemu-system-x86_64 -net nic,model=help}.
25572
25573 @item -enable-kvm
25574 If your system has hardware virtualization extensions, enabling the
25575 virtual machine support (KVM) of the Linux kernel will make things run
25576 faster.
25577
25578 @c To run Xfce + 'guix pull', we need at least 1G of RAM.
25579 @item -m 1024
25580 RAM available to the guest OS, in mebibytes. Defaults to 128@tie{}MiB,
25581 which may be insufficient for some operations.
25582
25583 @item -device virtio-blk,drive=myhd
25584 Create a @code{virtio-blk} drive called ``myhd''. @code{virtio-blk} is a
25585 ``paravirtualization'' mechanism for block devices that allows QEMU to achieve
25586 better performance than if it were emulating a complete disk drive. See the
25587 QEMU and KVM documentation for more info.
25588
25589 @item -drive if=none,file=/tmp/qemu-image,id=myhd
25590 Use our QCOW image, the @file{/tmp/qemu-image} file, as the backing store the
25591 the ``myhd'' drive.
25592 @end table
25593
25594 The default @command{run-vm.sh} script that is returned by an invocation of
25595 @command{guix system vm} does not add a @command{-net user} flag by default.
25596 To get network access from within the vm add the @code{(dhcp-client-service)}
25597 to your system definition and start the VM using
25598 @command{`guix system vm config.scm` -net user}. An important caveat of using
25599 @command{-net user} for networking is that @command{ping} will not work, because
25600 it uses the ICMP protocol. You'll have to use a different command to check for
25601 network connectivity, for example @command{guix download}.
25602
25603 @subsection Connecting Through SSH
25604
25605 @cindex SSH
25606 @cindex SSH server
25607 To enable SSH inside a VM you need to add an SSH server like
25608 @code{openssh-service-type} to your VM (@pxref{Networking Services,
25609 @code{openssh-service-type}}). In addition you need to forward the SSH port,
25610 22 by default, to the host. You can do this with
25611
25612 @example
25613 `guix system vm config.scm` -net user,hostfwd=tcp::10022-:22
25614 @end example
25615
25616 To connect to the VM you can run
25617
25618 @example
25619 ssh -o UserKnownHostsFile=/dev/null -o StrictHostKeyChecking=no -p 10022
25620 @end example
25621
25622 The @command{-p} tells @command{ssh} the port you want to connect to.
25623 @command{-o UserKnownHostsFile=/dev/null} prevents @command{ssh} from complaining
25624 every time you modify your @command{config.scm} file and the
25625 @command{-o StrictHostKeyChecking=no} prevents you from having to allow a
25626 connection to an unknown host every time you connect.
25627
25628 @subsection Using @command{virt-viewer} with Spice
25629
25630 As an alternative to the default @command{qemu} graphical client you can
25631 use the @command{remote-viewer} from the @command{virt-viewer} package. To
25632 connect pass the @command{-spice port=5930,disable-ticketing} flag to
25633 @command{qemu}. See previous section for further information on how to do this.
25634
25635 Spice also allows you to do some nice stuff like share your clipboard with your
25636 VM. To enable that you'll also have to pass the following flags to @command{qemu}:
25637
25638 @example
25639 -device virtio-serial-pci,id=virtio-serial0,max_ports=16,bus=pci.0,addr=0x5
25640 -chardev spicevmc,name=vdagent,id=vdagent
25641 -device virtserialport,nr=1,bus=virtio-serial0.0,chardev=vdagent,
25642 name=com.redhat.spice.0
25643 @end example
25644
25645 You'll also need to add the @pxref{Miscellaneous Services, Spice service}.
25646
25647 @node Defining Services
25648 @section Defining Services
25649
25650 The previous sections show the available services and how one can combine
25651 them in an @code{operating-system} declaration. But how do we define
25652 them in the first place? And what is a service anyway?
25653
25654 @menu
25655 * Service Composition:: The model for composing services.
25656 * Service Types and Services:: Types and services.
25657 * Service Reference:: API reference.
25658 * Shepherd Services:: A particular type of service.
25659 @end menu
25660
25661 @node Service Composition
25662 @subsection Service Composition
25663
25664 @cindex services
25665 @cindex daemons
25666 Here we define a @dfn{service} as, broadly, something that extends the
25667 functionality of the operating system. Often a service is a process---a
25668 @dfn{daemon}---started when the system boots: a secure shell server, a
25669 Web server, the Guix build daemon, etc. Sometimes a service is a daemon
25670 whose execution can be triggered by another daemon---e.g., an FTP server
25671 started by @command{inetd} or a D-Bus service activated by
25672 @command{dbus-daemon}. Occasionally, a service does not map to a
25673 daemon. For instance, the ``account'' service collects user accounts
25674 and makes sure they exist when the system runs; the ``udev'' service
25675 collects device management rules and makes them available to the eudev
25676 daemon; the @file{/etc} service populates the @file{/etc} directory
25677 of the system.
25678
25679 @cindex service extensions
25680 Guix system services are connected by @dfn{extensions}. For instance, the
25681 secure shell service @emph{extends} the Shepherd---the
25682 initialization system, running as PID@tie{}1---by giving it the command
25683 lines to start and stop the secure shell daemon (@pxref{Networking
25684 Services, @code{openssh-service-type}}); the UPower service extends the D-Bus
25685 service by passing it its @file{.service} specification, and extends the
25686 udev service by passing it device management rules (@pxref{Desktop
25687 Services, @code{upower-service}}); the Guix daemon service extends the
25688 Shepherd by passing it the command lines to start and stop the daemon,
25689 and extends the account service by passing it a list of required build
25690 user accounts (@pxref{Base Services}).
25691
25692 All in all, services and their ``extends'' relations form a directed
25693 acyclic graph (DAG). If we represent services as boxes and extensions
25694 as arrows, a typical system might provide something like this:
25695
25696 @image{images/service-graph,,5in,Typical service extension graph.}
25697
25698 @cindex system service
25699 At the bottom, we see the @dfn{system service}, which produces the
25700 directory containing everything to run and boot the system, as returned
25701 by the @command{guix system build} command. @xref{Service Reference},
25702 to learn about the other service types shown here.
25703 @xref{system-extension-graph, the @command{guix system extension-graph}
25704 command}, for information on how to generate this representation for a
25705 particular operating system definition.
25706
25707 @cindex service types
25708 Technically, developers can define @dfn{service types} to express these
25709 relations. There can be any number of services of a given type on the
25710 system---for instance, a system running two instances of the GNU secure
25711 shell server (lsh) has two instances of @code{lsh-service-type}, with
25712 different parameters.
25713
25714 The following section describes the programming interface for service
25715 types and services.
25716
25717 @node Service Types and Services
25718 @subsection Service Types and Services
25719
25720 A @dfn{service type} is a node in the DAG described above. Let us start
25721 with a simple example, the service type for the Guix build daemon
25722 (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon}):
25723
25724 @example
25725 (define guix-service-type
25726 (service-type
25727 (name 'guix)
25728 (extensions
25729 (list (service-extension shepherd-root-service-type guix-shepherd-service)
25730 (service-extension account-service-type guix-accounts)
25731 (service-extension activation-service-type guix-activation)))
25732 (default-value (guix-configuration))))
25733 @end example
25734
25735 @noindent
25736 It defines three things:
25737
25738 @enumerate
25739 @item
25740 A name, whose sole purpose is to make inspection and debugging easier.
25741
25742 @item
25743 A list of @dfn{service extensions}, where each extension designates the
25744 target service type and a procedure that, given the parameters of the
25745 service, returns a list of objects to extend the service of that type.
25746
25747 Every service type has at least one service extension. The only
25748 exception is the @dfn{boot service type}, which is the ultimate service.
25749
25750 @item
25751 Optionally, a default value for instances of this type.
25752 @end enumerate
25753
25754 In this example, @code{guix-service-type} extends three services:
25755
25756 @table @code
25757 @item shepherd-root-service-type
25758 The @code{guix-shepherd-service} procedure defines how the Shepherd
25759 service is extended. Namely, it returns a @code{<shepherd-service>}
25760 object that defines how @command{guix-daemon} is started and stopped
25761 (@pxref{Shepherd Services}).
25762
25763 @item account-service-type
25764 This extension for this service is computed by @code{guix-accounts},
25765 which returns a list of @code{user-group} and @code{user-account}
25766 objects representing the build user accounts (@pxref{Invoking
25767 guix-daemon}).
25768
25769 @item activation-service-type
25770 Here @code{guix-activation} is a procedure that returns a gexp, which is
25771 a code snippet to run at ``activation time''---e.g., when the service is
25772 booted.
25773 @end table
25774
25775 A service of this type is instantiated like this:
25776
25777 @example
25778 (service guix-service-type
25779 (guix-configuration
25780 (build-accounts 5)
25781 (use-substitutes? #f)))
25782 @end example
25783
25784 The second argument to the @code{service} form is a value representing
25785 the parameters of this specific service instance.
25786 @xref{guix-configuration-type, @code{guix-configuration}}, for
25787 information about the @code{guix-configuration} data type. When the
25788 value is omitted, the default value specified by
25789 @code{guix-service-type} is used:
25790
25791 @example
25792 (service guix-service-type)
25793 @end example
25794
25795 @code{guix-service-type} is quite simple because it extends other
25796 services but is not extensible itself.
25797
25798 @c @subsubsubsection Extensible Service Types
25799
25800 The service type for an @emph{extensible} service looks like this:
25801
25802 @example
25803 (define udev-service-type
25804 (service-type (name 'udev)
25805 (extensions
25806 (list (service-extension shepherd-root-service-type
25807 udev-shepherd-service)))
25808
25809 (compose concatenate) ;concatenate the list of rules
25810 (extend (lambda (config rules)
25811 (match config
25812 (($ <udev-configuration> udev initial-rules)
25813 (udev-configuration
25814 (udev udev) ;the udev package to use
25815 (rules (append initial-rules rules)))))))))
25816 @end example
25817
25818 This is the service type for the
25819 @uref{https://wiki.gentoo.org/wiki/Project:Eudev, eudev device
25820 management daemon}. Compared to the previous example, in addition to an
25821 extension of @code{shepherd-root-service-type}, we see two new fields:
25822
25823 @table @code
25824 @item compose
25825 This is the procedure to @dfn{compose} the list of extensions to
25826 services of this type.
25827
25828 Services can extend the udev service by passing it lists of rules; we
25829 compose those extensions simply by concatenating them.
25830
25831 @item extend
25832 This procedure defines how the value of the service is @dfn{extended} with
25833 the composition of the extensions.
25834
25835 Udev extensions are composed into a list of rules, but the udev service
25836 value is itself a @code{<udev-configuration>} record. So here, we
25837 extend that record by appending the list of rules it contains to the
25838 list of contributed rules.
25839
25840 @item description
25841 This is a string giving an overview of the service type. The string can
25842 contain Texinfo markup (@pxref{Overview,,, texinfo, GNU Texinfo}). The
25843 @command{guix system search} command searches these strings and displays
25844 them (@pxref{Invoking guix system}).
25845 @end table
25846
25847 There can be only one instance of an extensible service type such as
25848 @code{udev-service-type}. If there were more, the
25849 @code{service-extension} specifications would be ambiguous.
25850
25851 Still here? The next section provides a reference of the programming
25852 interface for services.
25853
25854 @node Service Reference
25855 @subsection Service Reference
25856
25857 We have seen an overview of service types (@pxref{Service Types and
25858 Services}). This section provides a reference on how to manipulate
25859 services and service types. This interface is provided by the
25860 @code{(gnu services)} module.
25861
25862 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service @var{type} [@var{value}]
25863 Return a new service of @var{type}, a @code{<service-type>} object (see
25864 below.) @var{value} can be any object; it represents the parameters of
25865 this particular service instance.
25866
25867 When @var{value} is omitted, the default value specified by @var{type}
25868 is used; if @var{type} does not specify a default value, an error is
25869 raised.
25870
25871 For instance, this:
25872
25873 @example
25874 (service openssh-service-type)
25875 @end example
25876
25877 @noindent
25878 is equivalent to this:
25879
25880 @example
25881 (service openssh-service-type
25882 (openssh-configuration))
25883 @end example
25884
25885 In both cases the result is an instance of @code{openssh-service-type}
25886 with the default configuration.
25887 @end deffn
25888
25889 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service? @var{obj}
25890 Return true if @var{obj} is a service.
25891 @end deffn
25892
25893 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service-kind @var{service}
25894 Return the type of @var{service}---i.e., a @code{<service-type>} object.
25895 @end deffn
25896
25897 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service-value @var{service}
25898 Return the value associated with @var{service}. It represents its
25899 parameters.
25900 @end deffn
25901
25902 Here is an example of how a service is created and manipulated:
25903
25904 @example
25905 (define s
25906 (service nginx-service-type
25907 (nginx-configuration
25908 (nginx nginx)
25909 (log-directory log-directory)
25910 (run-directory run-directory)
25911 (file config-file))))
25912
25913 (service? s)
25914 @result{} #t
25915
25916 (eq? (service-kind s) nginx-service-type)
25917 @result{} #t
25918 @end example
25919
25920 The @code{modify-services} form provides a handy way to change the
25921 parameters of some of the services of a list such as
25922 @code{%base-services} (@pxref{Base Services, @code{%base-services}}). It
25923 evaluates to a list of services. Of course, you could always use
25924 standard list combinators such as @code{map} and @code{fold} to do that
25925 (@pxref{SRFI-1, List Library,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual});
25926 @code{modify-services} simply provides a more concise form for this
25927 common pattern.
25928
25929 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} modify-services @var{services} @
25930 (@var{type} @var{variable} => @var{body}) @dots{}
25931
25932 Modify the services listed in @var{services} according to the given
25933 clauses. Each clause has the form:
25934
25935 @example
25936 (@var{type} @var{variable} => @var{body})
25937 @end example
25938
25939 where @var{type} is a service type---e.g.,
25940 @code{guix-service-type}---and @var{variable} is an identifier that is
25941 bound within the @var{body} to the service parameters---e.g., a
25942 @code{guix-configuration} instance---of the original service of that
25943 @var{type}.
25944
25945 The @var{body} should evaluate to the new service parameters, which will
25946 be used to configure the new service. This new service will replace the
25947 original in the resulting list. Because a service's service parameters
25948 are created using @code{define-record-type*}, you can write a succinct
25949 @var{body} that evaluates to the new service parameters by using the
25950 @code{inherit} feature that @code{define-record-type*} provides.
25951
25952 @xref{Using the Configuration System}, for example usage.
25953
25954 @end deffn
25955
25956 Next comes the programming interface for service types. This is
25957 something you want to know when writing new service definitions, but not
25958 necessarily when simply looking for ways to customize your
25959 @code{operating-system} declaration.
25960
25961 @deftp {Data Type} service-type
25962 @cindex service type
25963 This is the representation of a @dfn{service type} (@pxref{Service Types
25964 and Services}).
25965
25966 @table @asis
25967 @item @code{name}
25968 This is a symbol, used only to simplify inspection and debugging.
25969
25970 @item @code{extensions}
25971 A non-empty list of @code{<service-extension>} objects (see below).
25972
25973 @item @code{compose} (default: @code{#f})
25974 If this is @code{#f}, then the service type denotes services that cannot
25975 be extended---i.e., services that do not receive ``values'' from other
25976 services.
25977
25978 Otherwise, it must be a one-argument procedure. The procedure is called
25979 by @code{fold-services} and is passed a list of values collected from
25980 extensions. It may return any single value.
25981
25982 @item @code{extend} (default: @code{#f})
25983 If this is @code{#f}, services of this type cannot be extended.
25984
25985 Otherwise, it must be a two-argument procedure: @code{fold-services}
25986 calls it, passing it the initial value of the service as the first
25987 argument and the result of applying @code{compose} to the extension
25988 values as the second argument. It must return a value that is a valid
25989 parameter value for the service instance.
25990 @end table
25991
25992 @xref{Service Types and Services}, for examples.
25993 @end deftp
25994
25995 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service-extension @var{target-type} @
25996 @var{compute}
25997 Return a new extension for services of type @var{target-type}.
25998 @var{compute} must be a one-argument procedure: @code{fold-services}
25999 calls it, passing it the value associated with the service that provides
26000 the extension; it must return a valid value for the target service.
26001 @end deffn
26002
26003 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service-extension? @var{obj}
26004 Return true if @var{obj} is a service extension.
26005 @end deffn
26006
26007 Occasionally, you might want to simply extend an existing service. This
26008 involves creating a new service type and specifying the extension of
26009 interest, which can be verbose; the @code{simple-service} procedure
26010 provides a shorthand for this.
26011
26012 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} simple-service @var{name} @var{target} @var{value}
26013 Return a service that extends @var{target} with @var{value}. This works
26014 by creating a singleton service type @var{name}, of which the returned
26015 service is an instance.
26016
26017 For example, this extends mcron (@pxref{Scheduled Job Execution}) with
26018 an additional job:
26019
26020 @example
26021 (simple-service 'my-mcron-job mcron-service-type
26022 #~(job '(next-hour (3)) "guix gc -F 2G"))
26023 @end example
26024 @end deffn
26025
26026 At the core of the service abstraction lies the @code{fold-services}
26027 procedure, which is responsible for ``compiling'' a list of services
26028 down to a single directory that contains everything needed to boot and
26029 run the system---the directory shown by the @command{guix system build}
26030 command (@pxref{Invoking guix system}). In essence, it propagates
26031 service extensions down the service graph, updating each node parameters
26032 on the way, until it reaches the root node.
26033
26034 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} fold-services @var{services} @
26035 [#:target-type @var{system-service-type}]
26036 Fold @var{services} by propagating their extensions down to the root of
26037 type @var{target-type}; return the root service adjusted accordingly.
26038 @end deffn
26039
26040 Lastly, the @code{(gnu services)} module also defines several essential
26041 service types, some of which are listed below.
26042
26043 @defvr {Scheme Variable} system-service-type
26044 This is the root of the service graph. It produces the system directory
26045 as returned by the @command{guix system build} command.
26046 @end defvr
26047
26048 @defvr {Scheme Variable} boot-service-type
26049 The type of the ``boot service'', which produces the @dfn{boot script}.
26050 The boot script is what the initial RAM disk runs when booting.
26051 @end defvr
26052
26053 @defvr {Scheme Variable} etc-service-type
26054 The type of the @file{/etc} service. This service is used to create
26055 files under @file{/etc} and can be extended by
26056 passing it name/file tuples such as:
26057
26058 @example
26059 (list `("issue" ,(plain-file "issue" "Welcome!\n")))
26060 @end example
26061
26062 In this example, the effect would be to add an @file{/etc/issue} file
26063 pointing to the given file.
26064 @end defvr
26065
26066 @defvr {Scheme Variable} setuid-program-service-type
26067 Type for the ``setuid-program service''. This service collects lists of
26068 executable file names, passed as gexps, and adds them to the set of
26069 setuid-root programs on the system (@pxref{Setuid Programs}).
26070 @end defvr
26071
26072 @defvr {Scheme Variable} profile-service-type
26073 Type of the service that populates the @dfn{system profile}---i.e., the
26074 programs under @file{/run/current-system/profile}. Other services can
26075 extend it by passing it lists of packages to add to the system profile.
26076 @end defvr
26077
26078
26079 @node Shepherd Services
26080 @subsection Shepherd Services
26081
26082 @cindex shepherd services
26083 @cindex PID 1
26084 @cindex init system
26085 The @code{(gnu services shepherd)} module provides a way to define
26086 services managed by the GNU@tie{}Shepherd, which is the
26087 initialization system---the first process that is started when the
26088 system boots, also known as PID@tie{}1
26089 (@pxref{Introduction,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}).
26090
26091 Services in the Shepherd can depend on each other. For instance, the
26092 SSH daemon may need to be started after the syslog daemon has been
26093 started, which in turn can only happen once all the file systems have
26094 been mounted. The simple operating system defined earlier (@pxref{Using
26095 the Configuration System}) results in a service graph like this:
26096
26097 @image{images/shepherd-graph,,5in,Typical shepherd service graph.}
26098
26099 You can actually generate such a graph for any operating system
26100 definition using the @command{guix system shepherd-graph} command
26101 (@pxref{system-shepherd-graph, @command{guix system shepherd-graph}}).
26102
26103 The @code{%shepherd-root-service} is a service object representing
26104 PID@tie{}1, of type @code{shepherd-root-service-type}; it can be extended
26105 by passing it lists of @code{<shepherd-service>} objects.
26106
26107 @deftp {Data Type} shepherd-service
26108 The data type representing a service managed by the Shepherd.
26109
26110 @table @asis
26111 @item @code{provision}
26112 This is a list of symbols denoting what the service provides.
26113
26114 These are the names that may be passed to @command{herd start},
26115 @command{herd status}, and similar commands (@pxref{Invoking herd,,,
26116 shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}). @xref{Slots of services, the
26117 @code{provides} slot,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}, for details.
26118
26119 @item @code{requirement} (default: @code{'()})
26120 List of symbols denoting the Shepherd services this one depends on.
26121
26122 @cindex one-shot services, for the Shepherd
26123 @item @code{one-shot?} (default: @code{#f})
26124 Whether this service is @dfn{one-shot}. One-shot services stop immediately
26125 after their @code{start} action has completed. @xref{Slots of services,,,
26126 shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}, for more info.
26127
26128 @item @code{respawn?} (default: @code{#t})
26129 Whether to restart the service when it stops, for instance when the
26130 underlying process dies.
26131
26132 @item @code{start}
26133 @itemx @code{stop} (default: @code{#~(const #f)})
26134 The @code{start} and @code{stop} fields refer to the Shepherd's
26135 facilities to start and stop processes (@pxref{Service De- and
26136 Constructors,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}). They are given as
26137 G-expressions that get expanded in the Shepherd configuration file
26138 (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
26139
26140 @item @code{actions} (default: @code{'()})
26141 @cindex actions, of Shepherd services
26142 This is a list of @code{shepherd-action} objects (see below) defining
26143 @dfn{actions} supported by the service, in addition to the standard
26144 @code{start} and @code{stop} actions. Actions listed here become available as
26145 @command{herd} sub-commands:
26146
26147 @example
26148 herd @var{action} @var{service} [@var{arguments}@dots{}]
26149 @end example
26150
26151 @item @code{auto-start?} (default: @code{#t})
26152 Whether this service should be started automatically by the Shepherd. If it
26153 is @code{#f} the service has to be started manually with @code{herd start}.
26154
26155 @item @code{documentation}
26156 A documentation string, as shown when running:
26157
26158 @example
26159 herd doc @var{service-name}
26160 @end example
26161
26162 where @var{service-name} is one of the symbols in @code{provision}
26163 (@pxref{Invoking herd,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}).
26164
26165 @item @code{modules} (default: @code{%default-modules})
26166 This is the list of modules that must be in scope when @code{start} and
26167 @code{stop} are evaluated.
26168
26169 @end table
26170 @end deftp
26171
26172 @deftp {Data Type} shepherd-action
26173 This is the data type that defines additional actions implemented by a
26174 Shepherd service (see above).
26175
26176 @table @code
26177 @item name
26178 Symbol naming the action.
26179
26180 @item documentation
26181 This is a documentation string for the action. It can be viewed by running:
26182
26183 @example
26184 herd doc @var{service} action @var{action}
26185 @end example
26186
26187 @item procedure
26188 This should be a gexp that evaluates to a procedure of at least one argument,
26189 which is the ``running value'' of the service (@pxref{Slots of services,,,
26190 shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}).
26191 @end table
26192
26193 The following example defines an action called @code{say-hello} that kindly
26194 greets the user:
26195
26196 @example
26197 (shepherd-action
26198 (name 'say-hello)
26199 (documentation "Say hi!")
26200 (procedure #~(lambda (running . args)
26201 (format #t "Hello, friend! arguments: ~s\n"
26202 args)
26203 #t)))
26204 @end example
26205
26206 Assuming this action is added to the @code{example} service, then you can do:
26207
26208 @example
26209 # herd say-hello example
26210 Hello, friend! arguments: ()
26211 # herd say-hello example a b c
26212 Hello, friend! arguments: ("a" "b" "c")
26213 @end example
26214
26215 This, as you can see, is a fairly sophisticated way to say hello.
26216 @xref{Service Convenience,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}, for more
26217 info on actions.
26218 @end deftp
26219
26220 @defvr {Scheme Variable} shepherd-root-service-type
26221 The service type for the Shepherd ``root service''---i.e., PID@tie{}1.
26222
26223 This is the service type that extensions target when they want to create
26224 shepherd services (@pxref{Service Types and Services}, for an example).
26225 Each extension must pass a list of @code{<shepherd-service>}.
26226 @end defvr
26227
26228 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %shepherd-root-service
26229 This service represents PID@tie{}1.
26230 @end defvr
26231
26232
26233 @node Documentation
26234 @chapter Documentation
26235
26236 @cindex documentation, searching for
26237 @cindex searching for documentation
26238 @cindex Info, documentation format
26239 @cindex man pages
26240 @cindex manual pages
26241 In most cases packages installed with Guix come with documentation.
26242 There are two main documentation formats: ``Info'', a browseable
26243 hypertext format used for GNU software, and ``manual pages'' (or ``man
26244 pages''), the linear documentation format traditionally found on Unix.
26245 Info manuals are accessed with the @command{info} command or with Emacs,
26246 and man pages are accessed using @command{man}.
26247
26248 You can look for documentation of software installed on your system by
26249 keyword. For example, the following command searches for information
26250 about ``TLS'' in Info manuals:
26251
26252 @example
26253 $ info -k TLS
26254 "(emacs)Network Security" -- STARTTLS
26255 "(emacs)Network Security" -- TLS
26256 "(gnutls)Core TLS API" -- gnutls_certificate_set_verify_flags
26257 "(gnutls)Core TLS API" -- gnutls_certificate_set_verify_function
26258 @dots{}
26259 @end example
26260
26261 @noindent
26262 The command below searches for the same keyword in man pages:
26263
26264 @example
26265 $ man -k TLS
26266 SSL (7) - OpenSSL SSL/TLS library
26267 certtool (1) - GnuTLS certificate tool
26268 @dots {}
26269 @end example
26270
26271 These searches are purely local to your computer so you have the
26272 guarantee that documentation you find corresponds to what you have
26273 actually installed, you can access it off-line, and your privacy is
26274 respected.
26275
26276 Once you have these results, you can view the relevant documentation by
26277 running, say:
26278
26279 @example
26280 $ info "(gnutls)Core TLS API"
26281 @end example
26282
26283 @noindent
26284 or:
26285
26286 @example
26287 $ man certtool
26288 @end example
26289
26290 Info manuals contain sections and indices as well as hyperlinks like
26291 those found in Web pages. The @command{info} reader (@pxref{Top, Info
26292 reader,, info-stnd, Stand-alone GNU Info}) and its Emacs counterpart
26293 (@pxref{Misc Help,,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}) provide intuitive key
26294 bindings to navigate manuals. @xref{Getting Started,,, info, Info: An
26295 Introduction}, for an introduction to Info navigation.
26296
26297 @node Installing Debugging Files
26298 @chapter Installing Debugging Files
26299
26300 @cindex debugging files
26301 Program binaries, as produced by the GCC compilers for instance, are
26302 typically written in the ELF format, with a section containing
26303 @dfn{debugging information}. Debugging information is what allows the
26304 debugger, GDB, to map binary code to source code; it is required to
26305 debug a compiled program in good conditions.
26306
26307 The problem with debugging information is that is takes up a fair amount
26308 of disk space. For example, debugging information for the GNU C Library
26309 weighs in at more than 60 MiB. Thus, as a user, keeping all the
26310 debugging info of all the installed programs is usually not an option.
26311 Yet, space savings should not come at the cost of an impediment to
26312 debugging---especially in the GNU system, which should make it easier
26313 for users to exert their computing freedom (@pxref{GNU Distribution}).
26314
26315 Thankfully, the GNU Binary Utilities (Binutils) and GDB provide a
26316 mechanism that allows users to get the best of both worlds: debugging
26317 information can be stripped from the binaries and stored in separate
26318 files. GDB is then able to load debugging information from those files,
26319 when they are available (@pxref{Separate Debug Files,,, gdb, Debugging
26320 with GDB}).
26321
26322 The GNU distribution takes advantage of this by storing debugging
26323 information in the @code{lib/debug} sub-directory of a separate package
26324 output unimaginatively called @code{debug} (@pxref{Packages with
26325 Multiple Outputs}). Users can choose to install the @code{debug} output
26326 of a package when they need it. For instance, the following command
26327 installs the debugging information for the GNU C Library and for GNU
26328 Guile:
26329
26330 @example
26331 guix install glibc:debug guile:debug
26332 @end example
26333
26334 GDB must then be told to look for debug files in the user's profile, by
26335 setting the @code{debug-file-directory} variable (consider setting it
26336 from the @file{~/.gdbinit} file, @pxref{Startup,,, gdb, Debugging with
26337 GDB}):
26338
26339 @example
26340 (gdb) set debug-file-directory ~/.guix-profile/lib/debug
26341 @end example
26342
26343 From there on, GDB will pick up debugging information from the
26344 @code{.debug} files under @file{~/.guix-profile/lib/debug}.
26345
26346 In addition, you will most likely want GDB to be able to show the source
26347 code being debugged. To do that, you will have to unpack the source
26348 code of the package of interest (obtained with @code{guix build
26349 --source}, @pxref{Invoking guix build}), and to point GDB to that source
26350 directory using the @code{directory} command (@pxref{Source Path,
26351 @code{directory},, gdb, Debugging with GDB}).
26352
26353 @c XXX: keep me up-to-date
26354 The @code{debug} output mechanism in Guix is implemented by the
26355 @code{gnu-build-system} (@pxref{Build Systems}). Currently, it is
26356 opt-in---debugging information is available only for the packages
26357 with definitions explicitly declaring a @code{debug} output. This may be
26358 changed to opt-out in the future if our build farm servers can handle
26359 the load. To check whether a package has a @code{debug} output, use
26360 @command{guix package --list-available} (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
26361
26362
26363 @node Security Updates
26364 @chapter Security Updates
26365
26366 @cindex security updates
26367 @cindex security vulnerabilities
26368 Occasionally, important security vulnerabilities are discovered in software
26369 packages and must be patched. Guix developers try hard to keep track of
26370 known vulnerabilities and to apply fixes as soon as possible in the
26371 @code{master} branch of Guix (we do not yet provide a ``stable'' branch
26372 containing only security updates.) The @command{guix lint} tool helps
26373 developers find out about vulnerable versions of software packages in the
26374 distribution:
26375
26376 @smallexample
26377 $ guix lint -c cve
26378 gnu/packages/base.scm:652:2: glibc@@2.21: probably vulnerable to CVE-2015-1781, CVE-2015-7547
26379 gnu/packages/gcc.scm:334:2: gcc@@4.9.3: probably vulnerable to CVE-2015-5276
26380 gnu/packages/image.scm:312:2: openjpeg@@2.1.0: probably vulnerable to CVE-2016-1923, CVE-2016-1924
26381 @dots{}
26382 @end smallexample
26383
26384 @xref{Invoking guix lint}, for more information.
26385
26386 @quotation Note
26387 As of version @value{VERSION}, the feature described below is considered
26388 ``beta''.
26389 @end quotation
26390
26391 Guix follows a functional
26392 package management discipline (@pxref{Introduction}), which implies
26393 that, when a package is changed, @emph{every package that depends on it}
26394 must be rebuilt. This can significantly slow down the deployment of
26395 fixes in core packages such as libc or Bash, since basically the whole
26396 distribution would need to be rebuilt. Using pre-built binaries helps
26397 (@pxref{Substitutes}), but deployment may still take more time than
26398 desired.
26399
26400 @cindex grafts
26401 To address this, Guix implements @dfn{grafts}, a mechanism that allows
26402 for fast deployment of critical updates without the costs associated
26403 with a whole-distribution rebuild. The idea is to rebuild only the
26404 package that needs to be patched, and then to ``graft'' it onto packages
26405 explicitly installed by the user and that were previously referring to
26406 the original package. The cost of grafting is typically very low, and
26407 order of magnitudes lower than a full rebuild of the dependency chain.
26408
26409 @cindex replacements of packages, for grafts
26410 For instance, suppose a security update needs to be applied to Bash.
26411 Guix developers will provide a package definition for the ``fixed''
26412 Bash, say @code{bash-fixed}, in the usual way (@pxref{Defining
26413 Packages}). Then, the original package definition is augmented with a
26414 @code{replacement} field pointing to the package containing the bug fix:
26415
26416 @example
26417 (define bash
26418 (package
26419 (name "bash")
26420 ;; @dots{}
26421 (replacement bash-fixed)))
26422 @end example
26423
26424 From there on, any package depending directly or indirectly on Bash---as
26425 reported by @command{guix gc --requisites} (@pxref{Invoking guix
26426 gc})---that is installed is automatically ``rewritten'' to refer to
26427 @code{bash-fixed} instead of @code{bash}. This grafting process takes
26428 time proportional to the size of the package, usually less than a
26429 minute for an ``average'' package on a recent machine. Grafting is
26430 recursive: when an indirect dependency requires grafting, then grafting
26431 ``propagates'' up to the package that the user is installing.
26432
26433 Currently, the length of the name and version of the graft and that of
26434 the package it replaces (@code{bash-fixed} and @code{bash} in the example
26435 above) must be equal. This restriction mostly comes from the fact that
26436 grafting works by patching files, including binary files, directly.
26437 Other restrictions may apply: for instance, when adding a graft to a
26438 package providing a shared library, the original shared library and its
26439 replacement must have the same @code{SONAME} and be binary-compatible.
26440
26441 The @option{--no-grafts} command-line option allows you to forcefully
26442 avoid grafting (@pxref{Common Build Options, @option{--no-grafts}}).
26443 Thus, the command:
26444
26445 @example
26446 guix build bash --no-grafts
26447 @end example
26448
26449 @noindent
26450 returns the store file name of the original Bash, whereas:
26451
26452 @example
26453 guix build bash
26454 @end example
26455
26456 @noindent
26457 returns the store file name of the ``fixed'', replacement Bash. This
26458 allows you to distinguish between the two variants of Bash.
26459
26460 To verify which Bash your whole profile refers to, you can run
26461 (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}):
26462
26463 @example
26464 guix gc -R `readlink -f ~/.guix-profile` | grep bash
26465 @end example
26466
26467 @noindent
26468 @dots{} and compare the store file names that you get with those above.
26469 Likewise for a complete Guix system generation:
26470
26471 @example
26472 guix gc -R `guix system build my-config.scm` | grep bash
26473 @end example
26474
26475 Lastly, to check which Bash running processes are using, you can use the
26476 @command{lsof} command:
26477
26478 @example
26479 lsof | grep /gnu/store/.*bash
26480 @end example
26481
26482
26483 @node Bootstrapping
26484 @chapter Bootstrapping
26485
26486 @c Adapted from the ELS 2013 paper.
26487
26488 @cindex bootstrapping
26489
26490 Bootstrapping in our context refers to how the distribution gets built
26491 ``from nothing''. Remember that the build environment of a derivation
26492 contains nothing but its declared inputs (@pxref{Introduction}). So
26493 there's an obvious chicken-and-egg problem: how does the first package
26494 get built? How does the first compiler get compiled? Note that this is
26495 a question of interest only to the curious hacker, not to the regular
26496 user, so you can shamelessly skip this section if you consider yourself
26497 a ``regular user''.
26498
26499 @cindex bootstrap binaries
26500 The GNU system is primarily made of C code, with libc at its core. The
26501 GNU build system itself assumes the availability of a Bourne shell and
26502 command-line tools provided by GNU Coreutils, Awk, Findutils, `sed', and
26503 `grep'. Furthermore, build programs---programs that run
26504 @code{./configure}, @code{make}, etc.---are written in Guile Scheme
26505 (@pxref{Derivations}). Consequently, to be able to build anything at
26506 all, from scratch, Guix relies on pre-built binaries of Guile, GCC,
26507 Binutils, libc, and the other packages mentioned above---the
26508 @dfn{bootstrap binaries}.
26509
26510 These bootstrap binaries are ``taken for granted'', though we can also
26511 re-create them if needed (more on that later).
26512
26513 @unnumberedsec Preparing to Use the Bootstrap Binaries
26514
26515 @c As of Emacs 24.3, Info-mode displays the image, but since it's a
26516 @c large image, it's hard to scroll. Oh well.
26517 @image{images/bootstrap-graph,6in,,Dependency graph of the early bootstrap derivations}
26518
26519 The figure above shows the very beginning of the dependency graph of the
26520 distribution, corresponding to the package definitions of the @code{(gnu
26521 packages bootstrap)} module. A similar figure can be generated with
26522 @command{guix graph} (@pxref{Invoking guix graph}), along the lines of:
26523
26524 @example
26525 guix graph -t derivation \
26526 -e '(@@@@ (gnu packages bootstrap) %bootstrap-gcc)' \
26527 | dot -Tps > t.ps
26528 @end example
26529
26530 At this level of detail, things are
26531 slightly complex. First, Guile itself consists of an ELF executable,
26532 along with many source and compiled Scheme files that are dynamically
26533 loaded when it runs. This gets stored in the @file{guile-2.0.7.tar.xz}
26534 tarball shown in this graph. This tarball is part of Guix's ``source''
26535 distribution, and gets inserted into the store with @code{add-to-store}
26536 (@pxref{The Store}).
26537
26538 But how do we write a derivation that unpacks this tarball and adds it
26539 to the store? To solve this problem, the @code{guile-bootstrap-2.0.drv}
26540 derivation---the first one that gets built---uses @code{bash} as its
26541 builder, which runs @code{build-bootstrap-guile.sh}, which in turn calls
26542 @code{tar} to unpack the tarball. Thus, @file{bash}, @file{tar},
26543 @file{xz}, and @file{mkdir} are statically-linked binaries, also part of
26544 the Guix source distribution, whose sole purpose is to allow the Guile
26545 tarball to be unpacked.
26546
26547 Once @code{guile-bootstrap-2.0.drv} is built, we have a functioning
26548 Guile that can be used to run subsequent build programs. Its first task
26549 is to download tarballs containing the other pre-built binaries---this
26550 is what the @code{.tar.xz.drv} derivations do. Guix modules such as
26551 @code{ftp-client.scm} are used for this purpose. The
26552 @code{module-import.drv} derivations import those modules in a directory
26553 in the store, using the original layout. The
26554 @code{module-import-compiled.drv} derivations compile those modules, and
26555 write them in an output directory with the right layout. This
26556 corresponds to the @code{#:modules} argument of
26557 @code{build-expression->derivation} (@pxref{Derivations}).
26558
26559 Finally, the various tarballs are unpacked by the
26560 derivations @code{gcc-bootstrap-0.drv}, @code{glibc-bootstrap-0.drv},
26561 etc., at which point we have a working C tool chain.
26562
26563
26564 @unnumberedsec Building the Build Tools
26565
26566 Bootstrapping is complete when we have a full tool chain that does not
26567 depend on the pre-built bootstrap tools discussed above. This
26568 no-dependency requirement is verified by checking whether the files of
26569 the final tool chain contain references to the @file{/gnu/store}
26570 directories of the bootstrap inputs. The process that leads to this
26571 ``final'' tool chain is described by the package definitions found in
26572 the @code{(gnu packages commencement)} module.
26573
26574 The @command{guix graph} command allows us to ``zoom out'' compared to
26575 the graph above, by looking at the level of package objects instead of
26576 individual derivations---remember that a package may translate to
26577 several derivations, typically one derivation to download its source,
26578 one to build the Guile modules it needs, and one to actually build the
26579 package from source. The command:
26580
26581 @example
26582 guix graph -t bag \
26583 -e '(@@@@ (gnu packages commencement)
26584 glibc-final-with-bootstrap-bash)' | dot -Tps > t.ps
26585 @end example
26586
26587 @noindent
26588 produces the dependency graph leading to the ``final'' C
26589 library@footnote{You may notice the @code{glibc-intermediate} label,
26590 suggesting that it is not @emph{quite} final, but as a good
26591 approximation, we will consider it final.}, depicted below.
26592
26593 @image{images/bootstrap-packages,6in,,Dependency graph of the early packages}
26594
26595 @c See <https://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/gnu-system-discuss/2012-10/msg00000.html>.
26596 The first tool that gets built with the bootstrap binaries is
26597 GNU@tie{}Make---noted @code{make-boot0} above---which is a prerequisite
26598 for all the following packages. From there Findutils and Diffutils get
26599 built.
26600
26601 Then come the first-stage Binutils and GCC, built as pseudo cross
26602 tools---i.e., with @code{--target} equal to @code{--host}. They are
26603 used to build libc. Thanks to this cross-build trick, this libc is
26604 guaranteed not to hold any reference to the initial tool chain.
26605
26606 From there the final Binutils and GCC (not shown above) are built.
26607 GCC uses @code{ld}
26608 from the final Binutils, and links programs against the just-built libc.
26609 This tool chain is used to build the other packages used by Guix and by
26610 the GNU Build System: Guile, Bash, Coreutils, etc.
26611
26612 And voilà! At this point we have the complete set of build tools that
26613 the GNU Build System expects. These are in the @code{%final-inputs}
26614 variable of the @code{(gnu packages commencement)} module, and are
26615 implicitly used by any package that uses @code{gnu-build-system}
26616 (@pxref{Build Systems, @code{gnu-build-system}}).
26617
26618
26619 @unnumberedsec Building the Bootstrap Binaries
26620
26621 @cindex bootstrap binaries
26622 Because the final tool chain does not depend on the bootstrap binaries,
26623 those rarely need to be updated. Nevertheless, it is useful to have an
26624 automated way to produce them, should an update occur, and this is what
26625 the @code{(gnu packages make-bootstrap)} module provides.
26626
26627 The following command builds the tarballs containing the bootstrap
26628 binaries (Guile, Binutils, GCC, libc, and a tarball containing a mixture
26629 of Coreutils and other basic command-line tools):
26630
26631 @example
26632 guix build bootstrap-tarballs
26633 @end example
26634
26635 The generated tarballs are those that should be referred to in the
26636 @code{(gnu packages bootstrap)} module mentioned at the beginning of
26637 this section.
26638
26639 Still here? Then perhaps by now you've started to wonder: when do we
26640 reach a fixed point? That is an interesting question! The answer is
26641 unknown, but if you would like to investigate further (and have
26642 significant computational and storage resources to do so), then let us
26643 know.
26644
26645 @unnumberedsec Reducing the Set of Bootstrap Binaries
26646
26647 Our bootstrap binaries currently include GCC, Guile, etc. That's a lot
26648 of binary code! Why is that a problem? It's a problem because these
26649 big chunks of binary code are practically non-auditable, which makes it
26650 hard to establish what source code produced them. Every unauditable
26651 binary also leaves us vulnerable to compiler backdoors as described by
26652 Ken Thompson in the 1984 paper @emph{Reflections on Trusting Trust}.
26653
26654 This is mitigated by the fact that our bootstrap binaries were generated
26655 from an earlier Guix revision. Nevertheless it lacks the level of
26656 transparency that we get in the rest of the package dependency graph,
26657 where Guix always gives us a source-to-binary mapping. Thus, our goal
26658 is to reduce the set of bootstrap binaries to the bare minimum.
26659
26660 The @uref{http://bootstrappable.org, Bootstrappable.org web site} lists
26661 on-going projects to do that. One of these is about replacing the
26662 bootstrap GCC with a sequence of assemblers, interpreters, and compilers
26663 of increasing complexity, which could be built from source starting from
26664 a simple and auditable assembler. Your help is welcome!
26665
26666
26667 @node Porting
26668 @chapter Porting to a New Platform
26669
26670 As discussed above, the GNU distribution is self-contained, and
26671 self-containment is achieved by relying on pre-built ``bootstrap
26672 binaries'' (@pxref{Bootstrapping}). These binaries are specific to an
26673 operating system kernel, CPU architecture, and application binary
26674 interface (ABI). Thus, to port the distribution to a platform that is
26675 not yet supported, one must build those bootstrap binaries, and update
26676 the @code{(gnu packages bootstrap)} module to use them on that platform.
26677
26678 Fortunately, Guix can @emph{cross compile} those bootstrap binaries.
26679 When everything goes well, and assuming the GNU tool chain supports the
26680 target platform, this can be as simple as running a command like this
26681 one:
26682
26683 @example
26684 guix build --target=armv5tel-linux-gnueabi bootstrap-tarballs
26685 @end example
26686
26687 For this to work, the @code{glibc-dynamic-linker} procedure in
26688 @code{(gnu packages bootstrap)} must be augmented to return the right
26689 file name for libc's dynamic linker on that platform; likewise,
26690 @code{system->linux-architecture} in @code{(gnu packages linux)} must be
26691 taught about the new platform.
26692
26693 Once these are built, the @code{(gnu packages bootstrap)} module needs
26694 to be updated to refer to these binaries on the target platform. That
26695 is, the hashes and URLs of the bootstrap tarballs for the new platform
26696 must be added alongside those of the currently supported platforms. The
26697 bootstrap Guile tarball is treated specially: it is expected to be
26698 available locally, and @file{gnu/local.mk} has rules to download it for
26699 the supported architectures; a rule for the new platform must be added
26700 as well.
26701
26702 In practice, there may be some complications. First, it may be that the
26703 extended GNU triplet that specifies an ABI (like the @code{eabi} suffix
26704 above) is not recognized by all the GNU tools. Typically, glibc
26705 recognizes some of these, whereas GCC uses an extra @code{--with-abi}
26706 configure flag (see @code{gcc.scm} for examples of how to handle this).
26707 Second, some of the required packages could fail to build for that
26708 platform. Lastly, the generated binaries could be broken for some
26709 reason.
26710
26711 @c *********************************************************************
26712 @include contributing.texi
26713
26714 @c *********************************************************************
26715 @node Acknowledgments
26716 @chapter Acknowledgments
26717
26718 Guix is based on the @uref{https://nixos.org/nix/, Nix package manager},
26719 which was designed and
26720 implemented by Eelco Dolstra, with contributions from other people (see
26721 the @file{nix/AUTHORS} file in Guix.) Nix pioneered functional package
26722 management, and promoted unprecedented features, such as transactional
26723 package upgrades and rollbacks, per-user profiles, and referentially
26724 transparent build processes. Without this work, Guix would not exist.
26725
26726 The Nix-based software distributions, Nixpkgs and NixOS, have also been
26727 an inspiration for Guix.
26728
26729 GNU@tie{}Guix itself is a collective work with contributions from a
26730 number of people. See the @file{AUTHORS} file in Guix for more
26731 information on these fine people. The @file{THANKS} file lists people
26732 who have helped by reporting bugs, taking care of the infrastructure,
26733 providing artwork and themes, making suggestions, and more---thank you!
26734
26735
26736 @c *********************************************************************
26737 @node GNU Free Documentation License
26738 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
26739 @cindex license, GNU Free Documentation License
26740 @include fdl-1.3.texi
26741
26742 @c *********************************************************************
26743 @node Concept Index
26744 @unnumbered Concept Index
26745 @printindex cp
26746
26747 @node Programming Index
26748 @unnumbered Programming Index
26749 @syncodeindex tp fn
26750 @syncodeindex vr fn
26751 @printindex fn
26752
26753 @bye
26754
26755 @c Local Variables:
26756 @c ispell-local-dictionary: "american";
26757 @c End: